This is a modern-English version of Celebrated Travels and Travellers, Part 1.: The Exploration of the World, originally written by Verne, Jules.
It has been thoroughly updated, including changes to sentence structure, words, spelling,
and grammar—to ensure clarity for contemporary readers, while preserving the original spirit and nuance. If
you click on a paragraph, you will see the original text that we modified, and you can toggle between the two versions.
Scroll to the bottom of this page and you will find a free ePUB download link for this book.
![]() |
CELEBRATED TRAVELS AND TRAVELLERS.
THE EXPLORATION OF THE WORLD.
![]() |
CELEBRATED TRAVELS AND TRAVELLERS.
THE EXPLORATION OF THE WORLD.
BY JULES VERNE
AND 50 FAC-SIMILES OF ANCIENT DRAWINGS.
![]() |
SAMPSON LOW, MARSTON, SEARLE, & RIVINGTON,
CROWN BUILDINGS, 188, FLEET STREET.
1882.
[All rights reserved.]
|
EXPLORATION OF THE WORLD.
LIST OF MAPS AND ILLUSTRATIONS
REPRODUCED IN FAC-SIMILE FROM THE ORIGINAL DOCUMENTS,
GIVING THE SOURCES WHENCE THEY ARE DERIVED.
FIRST PART.
Approach to Constantinople. Anselmi Banduri Imperium orientale, tome II., p. 448. 2 vols. folio. Parisiis, 1711.
Approach to Constantinople. Anselmi Banduri Eastern Empire, volume II, p. 448. 2 volumes. folio. Paris, 1711.
Map of the World according to Marco Polo's ideas. Vol. I., p. 134 of the edition of Marco Polo published in London by Colonel Yule, 2 vols. 8vo.
Map of the World according to Marco Polo's ideas. Vol. I., p. 134 of the edition of Marco Polo published in London by Colonel Yule, 2 vols. 8vo.
Plan of Pekin in 1290. Yule's edition. Vol. I., p. 332.
Plan of Pekin in 1290. Yule's edition. Vol. I., p. 332.
Portrait of Jean de Béthencourt. "The discovery and conquest of the Canaries." Page 1, 12mo. Paris, 1630.
Portrait of Jean de Béthencourt. "The discovery and conquest of the Canaries." Page 1, 12mo. Paris, 1630.
Plan of Jerusalem. "Narrative of the journey beyond seas to the Holy Sepulchre of Jerusalem," by Antoine Régnant, p. 229, 4to. Lyons, 1573.
Plan of Jerusalem. "Story of the journey overseas to the Holy Sepulchre of Jerusalem," by Antoine Régnant, p. 229, 4to. Lyons, 1573.
Prince Henry the Navigator. From a miniature engraved in "The Discoveries of Prince Henry the Navigator," by H. Major. 8vo. London, 1877.
Prince Henry the Navigator. From a small engraving in "The Discoveries of Prince Henry the Navigator," by H. Major. 8vo. London, 1877.
Christopher Columbus. Taken from "Vitæ illustrium virorum," by Paul Jove. Folio. Basileæ, Perna.
Christopher Columbus. From "Lives of Illustrious Men," by Paul Jove. Folio. Basel, Perna.
Imaginary view of Seville. Th. de Bry. Grands Voyages, pl. I., part IV.
Imaginary view of Seville. Th. de Bry. Great Travels, vol. I., part IV.
Building of a caravel. Th. de Bry. Grands Voyages, Americæ, part IV., plate XIX.
Building of a caravel. Th. de Bry. Grand Voyages, America, part IV., plate XIX.
Christopher Columbus on board his caravel. Th. de Bry. Grands Voyages, Americæ, part IV., plate VI.
Christopher Columbus on board his caravel. Th. de Bry. Grand Voyages, America, part IV., plate VI.
Embarkation of Christopher Columbus. Th. de Bry. Grands Voyages, Americæ, part IV., plate VIII.
Embarkation of Christopher Columbus. Th. de Bry. Grand Voyages, America, part IV., plate VIII.
Map of the Antilles and the Gulf of Mexico. Th. de Bry. Grands Voyages, Americæ, part V.
Map of the Antilles and the Gulf of Mexico. Th. de Bry. Great Voyages, America, part V.
Fishing for Pearl oysters. Th. de Bry. Grands Voyages, Americæ, part IV., plate XII.
Fishing for Pearl oysters. Th. de Bry. Great Voyages, America, part IV., plate XII.
Gold-mines in Cuba. Th. de Bry. Grands Voyages, Americæ, part V., plate I.
Gold-mines in Cuba. Th. de Bry. Great Voyages, America, part V., plate I.
Vasco da Gama. From an engraving in the Cabinet des Estampes of the Bibl. Nat.
Vasco da Gama. From an engraving in the Prints Cabinet of the Bibl. Nat.
La Mina. "Histoire générale des Voyages," by the Abbé Prévost. Vol. III., p. 461, 4to. 20 vols. An X. 1746.
La Mina. "General History of Voyages," by Abbé Prévost. Vol. III., p. 461, 4to. 20 vols. Year 10, 1746.
Map of the East Coast of Africa, from the Cape of Good Hope to the Cape del Gado. From the French map of the Eastern Ocean, published in 1740 by order of the Comte de Maurepas.
Map of the East Coast of Africa, from the Cape of Good Hope to the Cape del Gado. From the French map of the Eastern Ocean, published in 1740 by order of the Count de Maurepas.
Map of Mozambique. Bibl. Nat. Estampes.
__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ National Library Prints.
Interview with the Zamorin. "Hist. Gén. des Voyages," by Prévost. Vol. I., p. 39. 4to. An X. 20 vols. 1746.
Interview with the Zamorin. "General History of Travels," by Prévost. Vol. I., p. 39. 4to. Year 10. 20 vols. 1746.
View of Quiloa. From an engraving in the Cabinet des Estampes. Topography. (Africa).
View of Quiloa. From an engraving in the Cabinet des Estampes. Topography. (Africa).
Map of the Coasts of Persia, Guzerat, and Malabar. From the French Map of the Eastern Ocean, pub. in 1740 by order of the Comte de Maurepas.
Map of the Coasts of Persia, Guzerat, and Malabar. From the French Map of the Eastern Ocean, published in 1740 by order of the Comte de Maurepas.
The Island of Ormuz. "Hist. Gén. des Voyages." Prévost. Vol. II., p. 98.
The Island of Ormuz. "Gen. History of Travels." Prévost. Vol. II., p. 98.
SECOND PART.
Americus Vespucius. From an engraving in the Cabinet des Estampes of the Bibliothèque Nationale.
Americus Vespucius. From an engraving in the Print Room of the National Library.
Indians devoured by dogs. Th. de Bry. Grands Voyages, Americæ, part IV., plate XXII.
Indians devoured by dogs. Th. de Bry. Grand Travels, America, part IV., plate XXII.
Punishment of Indians. Page 17 of Las Casas' "Narratio regionum indicarum per Hispanos quosdam devastatarum," 4to. Francofurti, sumptibus Th. de Bry, 1698.
Punishment of Indians. Page 17 of Las Casas' "Narratio regionum indicarum per Hispanos quosdam devastatarum," 4to. Francofurti, sumptibus Th. de Bry, 1698.
Portrait of F. Cortès. From an engraving after Velasquez in the Cabinet des Estampes of the Bibliothèque Nationale.
Portrait of F. Cortès. From an engraving after Velasquez in the Cabinet of Prints at the National Library.
Plan of Mexico. From Clavigero and Bernal Diaz del Castillo. Jourdanet's translation, 2nd Edition.
Plan of Mexico. From Clavigero and Bernal Diaz del Castillo. Jourdanet's translation, 2nd Edition.
Portrait of Pizarro. From an engraving in the Cabinet des Estampes of the Bib. Nat.
Portrait of Pizarro. From an engraving in the Cabinet des Estampes of the Bib. Nat.
Map of Peru. From Garcilasso de la Vega. History of the Incas. 4to. Bernard, Amsterdam, 1738.
Map of Peru. From Garcilasso de la Vega. History of the Incas. 4to. Bernard, Amsterdam, 1738.
Atahualpa taken prisoner. Th. de Bry. Grands Voyages, Americæ, part VI., plate VII.
Atahualpa taken prisoner. Th. de Bry. Great Voyages, America, part VI., plate VII.
Assassination of Pizarro. Th. de Bry. Grands Voyages, Americæ, part VI., plate XV.
Assassination of Pizarro. Th. de Bry. Great Voyages, America, part VI., plate XV.
Magellan on board his caravel. Th. de Bry. Grands Voyages, Americæ, part IV., plate XV.
Magellan on board his caravel. Th. de Bry. Great Journeys, America, part IV., plate XV.
Map of the Coast of Brazil. From the map called Henry 2nd's. Bibl. Nat., Geographical collections.
Map of the Coast of Brazil. From the map named Henry 2nd's. Bibl. Nat., Geographical collections.
The Ladrone Islands. Th. de Bry. Grands Voyages, Occidentalis Indiæ, pars VIII., p. 50.
The Ladrone Islands. Th. de Bry. Great Voyages, Western India, part VIII., p. 50.
Portrait of Sebastian Cabot. From a miniature engraved in "The remarkable Life, adventures, and discoveries of Sebastian Cabot," by Nicholls. 8vo. London, 1869.
Portrait of Sebastian Cabot. From a small engraving in "The Remarkable Life, Adventures, and Discoveries of Sebastian Cabot," by Nicholls. 8vo. London, 1869.
Fragment of Cabot's map. Bibl. Nat., Geographical collections.
__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__ National Library, Geographical collections.
Map of Newfoundland and of the Mouth of the St. Lawrence. Lescarbot, "Histoire de la Nouvelle France." 12mo. Perier, Paris, 1617.
Map of Newfoundland and of the Mouth of the St. Lawrence. Lescarbot, "History of New France." 12mo. Perier, Paris, 1617.
Portrait of Jacques Cartier. After Charlevoix. "History and general description of New France," translated by John Gilmary Shea, p. III. 6 vols. 4to. Shea, New York, 1866.
Portrait of Jacques Cartier. After Charlevoix. "History and general description of New France," translated by John Gilmary Shea, p. III. 6 vols. 4to. Shea, New York, 1866.
Barentz' ship fixed in the ice. Th. de Bry. Grands Voyages. Tertia pars Indiæ Orientales, plate XLIV.
Barentz' ship fixed in the ice. Th. de Bry. Great Voyages. Third part of the East Indies, plate XLIV.
Interior of Barentz' house. Th. de Bry. Grands Voyages. Tertia pars Indiæ Orientalis, plate XLVII.
Interior of Barentz' house. Th. de Bry. Grand Voyages. Third part of the East Indies, plate XLVII.
Exterior view of Barentz' house. Th. de Bry. Grands Voyages. Tertia pars Indiæ Orientalis, plate XLVIII.
Exterior view of Barentz' house. Th. de Bry. Grand Voyages. Third part of the East Indies, plate XLVIII.
Map of Nova Zembla. Th. de Bry. Grands Voyages. Tertia pars Indiæ Orientalis, plate LIX.
Map of Nova Zembla. Th. de Bry. Great Voyages. Third part of the East Indies, plate LIX.
A sea-lion hunt. Th. de Bry. Grands Voyages, Occidentalis Indiæ, pars VIII., p. 37.
A sea-lion hunt. Th. de Bry. Great Travels, Western Indies, part VIII., p. 37.
A fight between the Dutch and the Spaniards. Th. de Bry. Grands Voyages, "Historiarum novi orbis;" part IX., book II., page 87.
A fight between the Dutch and the Spaniards. Th. de Bry. Grands Voyages, "Historiarum novi orbis;" part IX., book II., page 87.
Portrait of Raleigh. From an engraving in the Cabinet des Estampes of the Bibl. Nat.
Portrait of Raleigh. From an engraving in the Cabinet des Estampes of the Bibl. Nat.
Berreo seized by Raleigh. Th. de Bry. Grands Voyages. Occid. Indiæ, part VIII., p. 64.
Berreo seized by Raleigh. Th. de Bry. Great Voyages. West Indies, part VIII., p. 64.
Portrait of Chardin. "Voyages de M. le Chevalier Chardin en Perse." Vol. I. 10 vols. 12mo. Ferrand, Rouen, 1723.
Portrait of Chardin. "The Travels of Mr. Chevalier Chardin in Persia." Vol. I. 10 vols. 12mo. Ferrand, Rouen, 1723.
Japanese Archer. From a Japanese print engraved by Yule, vol. II., p. 206.
Japanese Archer. From a Japanese print created by Yule, vol. II., p. 206.
Attack upon an Indian Town. "Voyages du Sieur de Champlain," p. 44. 12mo. Collet, Paris, 1727.
Attack upon an Indian Town. "Voyages of Sieur de Champlain," p. 44. 12mo. Collet, Paris, 1727.
NAMES OF THE PRINCIPAL TRAVELLERS
OF WHOM THE HISTORY AND TRAVELS ARE RELATED IN THIS VOLUME.
FIRST PART.
HANNO—HERODOTUS—PYTHEAS—NEARCHUS—EUDOXUS—CÆSAR—STRABO—PAUSANIAS—FA-HIAN—COSMOS INDICOPLEUSTES—ARCULPHE—WILLIBALD—SOLEYMAN—BENJAMIN OF TUDELA—PLAN DE CARPIN—RUBRUQUIS—MARCO POLO—IBN BATUTA—JEAN DE BÉTHENCOURT—CHRISTOPHER COLUMBUS—COVILHAM AND PAÏVA—VASCO DA GAMA—ALVARÈS CABRAL—JOAO DA NOVA—DA CUNHA—ALMEIDA—ALBUQUERQUE.
HANNO—HERODOTUS—PYTHEAS—NEARCHUS—EUDOXUS—CÆSAR—STRABO—PAUSANIAS—FA-HIAN—COSMOS INDICOPLEUSTES—ARCULPHE—WILLIBALD—SOLEYMAN—BENJAMIN OF TUDELA—PLAN DE CARPIN—RUBRUQUIS—MARCO POLO—IB BATUTA—JEAN DE BÉTHENCOURT—CHRISTOPHER COLUMBUS—COVILHAM AND PAÏVA—VASCO DA GAMA—ALVARÈS CABRAL—JOAO DA NOVA—DA CUNHA—ALMEIDA—ALBUQUERQUE.
SECOND PART.
HOJEDA—AMERICUS VESPUCIUS—JUAN DE LA COSA—YAÑEZ PINZON—DIAZ DE SOLIS—PONCE DE LEON—BALBOA—GRIJALVA—CORTÈS—PIZARRO—ALMAGRO—ALVARADO—ORELLANA—MAGELLAN—ERIC THE RED—THE ZENI—THE CORTEREALS—THE CABOTS—WILLOUGHBY—CHANCELLOR—VERRAZZANO—JACQUES CARTIER—FROBISHER—JOHN DAVIS—BARENTZ AND HEEMSKERKE—DRAKE—CAVENDISH—DE NOORT—W. RALEIGH—LEMAIRE AND SCHOUTEN—TASMAN—MENDANA—QUIROS AND TORRÈS—PYRARD DE LAVAL—PIETRO DELLA VALLE—TAVERNIER—THÉVENOT—BERNIER—ROBERT KNOX—CHARDIN—DE BRUYN—KÆMPFER—WILLIAM DAMPIER—HUDSON AND BAFFIN—CHAMPLAIN AND LA SALE.
HOJEDA—AMERICUS VESPUCIUS—JUAN DE LA COSA—YAÑEZ PINZON—DIAZ DE SOLIS—PONCE DE LEON—BALBOA—GRIJALVA—CORTÈS—PIZARRO—ALMAGRO—ALVARADO—ORELLANA—MAGELLAN—ERIC THE RED—THE ZENI—THE CORTEREALS—THE CABOTS—WILLOUGHBY—CHANCELLOR—VERRAZZANO—JACQUES CARTIER—FROBISHER—JOHN DAVIS—BARENTZ AND HEEMSKERKE—DRAKE—CAVENDISH—DE NOORT—W. RALEIGH—LEMAIRE AND SCHOUTEN—TASMAN—MENDANA—QUIROS AND TORRÈS—PYRARD DE LAVAL—PIETRO DELLA VALLE—TAVERNIER—THÉVENOT—BERNIER—ROBERT KNOX—CHARDIN—DE BRUYN—KÆMPFER—WILLIAM DAMPIER—HUDSON AND BAFFIN—CHAMPLAIN AND LA SALE.
PREFACE.
This narrative will comprehend not only all the explorations made in past ages, but also all the new discoveries which have of late years so greatly interested the scientific world. In order to give to this work—enlarged perforce by the recent labours of modern travellers,—all the accuracy possible, I have called in the aid of a man whom I with justice regard as one of the most competent geographers of the present day: M. Gabriel Marcel, attached to the Bibliothèque Nationale.
This narrative will cover not just all the explorations from the past, but also the new discoveries that have recently sparked a lot of interest in the scientific community. To ensure this work—expanded due to the recent efforts of modern travelers—is as accurate as possible, I have enlisted the help of someone I rightly consider one of today's most skilled geographers: M. Gabriel Marcel, affiliated with the Bibliothèque Nationale.
With the advantage of his acquaintance with several foreign languages which are unknown to me, we have been able to go to the fountain-head, and to derive all information from absolutely original documents. Our readers will, therefore, render to M. Marcel the credit due to him for his share in a work which will demonstrate what manner of men the great travellers have been, from the time of Hanno and Herodotus down to that of Livingstone and Stanley.
With his knowledge of several foreign languages that I don’t know, we’ve been able to go straight to the source and gather all our information from original documents. Our readers should, therefore, give M. Marcel the credit he deserves for his contribution to this work, which will show what kind of people the great travelers have been, from Hanno and Herodotus to Livingstone and Stanley.
TABLE OF CONTENTS.
FIRST PART.
CHAPTER I.
HANNO, 505; HERODOTUS, 484; PYTHEAS, 340; NEARCHUS, 326;
EUDOXUS, 146; CÆSAR, 100; STRABO, 50.
Hanno, the Carthaginian—Herodotus visits Egypt, Lybia, Ethiopia, Phoenicia, Arabia, Babylon, Persia, India, Media, Colchis, the Caspian Sea, Scythia, Thrace, and Greece—Pytheas explores the coasts of Iberia and Gaul, the English Channel, the Isle of Albion, the Orkney Islands, and the land of Thule—Nearchus visits the Asiatic coast, from the Indus to the Persian Gulf—Eudoxus reconnoitres the West Coast of Africa—Cæsar conquers Gaul and Great Britain—Strabo travels over the interior of Asia, and Egypt, Greece, and Italy
Hanno, the Carthaginian—Herodotus explores Egypt, Libya, Ethiopia, Phoenicia, Arabia, Babylon, Persia, India, Media, Colchis, the Caspian Sea, Scythia, Thrace, and Greece—Pytheas investigates the coasts of Iberia and Gaul, the English Channel, the Isle of Albion, the Orkney Islands, and the land of Thule—Nearchus travels along the Asiatic coast, from the Indus to the Persian Gulf—Eudoxus surveys the West Coast of Africa—Caesar conquers Gaul and Great Britain—Strabo journeys through the interior of Asia, as well as Egypt, Greece, and Italy
CHAPTER II.
PAUSANIAS, 174; FA-HIAN, 399; COSMOS INDICOPLEUSTES, 500;
ARCULPHE, 700; WILLIBALD, 725; SOLEYMAN, 851.
Pliny, Hippalus, Arian, and Ptolemy—Pausanias visits Attica, Corinth, Laconia, Messenia, Elis, Achaia, Arcadia, Boeotia, and Phocis—Fa-Hian explores Kan-tcheou, Tartary, Northern India, the Punjaub, Ceylon, and Java—Cosmos Indicopleustes, and the Christian Topography of the Universe—Arculphe describes Jerusalem, the valley of Jehoshaphat, the Mount of Olives, Bethlehem, Jericho, the river Jordan, Libanus, the Dead Sea, Capernaum, Nazareth, Mount Tabor, Damascus, Tyre, Alexandria, and Constantinople—Willibald and the Holy Land—Soleyman travels through Ceylon, and Sumatra, and crosses the Gulf of Siam and the China Sea
Pliny, Hippalus, Arian, and Ptolemy—Pausanias visits Attica, Corinth, Laconia, Messenia, Elis, Achaia, Arcadia, Boeotia, and Phocis—Fa-Hian explores Kan-tcheou, Tartary, Northern India, the Punjab, Ceylon, and Java—Cosmas Indicopleustes, along with the Christian Topography of the Universe—Arculphe describes Jerusalem, the valley of Jehoshaphat, the Mount of Olives, Bethlehem, Jericho, the Jordan River, Lebanon, the Dead Sea, Capernaum, Nazareth, Mount Tabor, Damascus, Tyre, Alexandria, and Constantinople—Willibald and the Holy Land—Soleyman travels through Ceylon and Sumatra, crossing the Gulf of Siam and the China Sea
CHAPTER III.
BENJAMIN OF TUDELA, 1159-1173; PLAN DE CARPIN, OR CARPINI, 1245-1247;
RUBRUQUIS, 1253-1254.
The Scandinavians in the North, Iceland and Greenland—Benjamin of Tudela visits Marseilles, Rome, Constantinople, the Archipelago, Palestine, Jerusalem, Bethlehem, Damascus, Baalbec, Nineveh, Baghdad, Babylon, Bassorah, Ispahan, Shiraz, Samarcand, Thibet, Malabar, Ceylon, the Red Sea, Egypt, Sicily, Italy, Germany, and France—Carpini explores Turkestan—Manners and customs of the Tartars—Rubruquis and the Sea of Azov, the Volga, Karakorum, Astrakhan, and Derbend
The Scandinavians in the North, Iceland, and Greenland—Benjamin of Tudela visits Marseille, Rome, Constantinople, the Aegean Islands, Palestine, Jerusalem, Bethlehem, Damascus, Baalbek, Nineveh, Baghdad, Babylon, Basra, Isfahan, Shiraz, Samarkand, Tibet, Malabar, Ceylon, the Red Sea, Egypt, Sicily, Italy, Germany, and France—Carpini explores Turkestan—customs and traditions of the Tartars—Rubruquis and the Sea of Azov, the Volga, Karakorum, Astrakhan, and Derbend
CHAPTER IV.
The interest of the Genoese and Venetian merchants in encouraging the exploration of Central Asia—The family of Polo, and its position in Venice—Nicholas and Matteo Polo, the two brothers—They go from Constantinople to the Court of the Emperor of China—Their reception at the Court of Kublaï-Khan—The Emperor appoints them his ambassadors to the Pope—Their return to Venice—Marco Polo—He leaves his father Nicholas and his uncle Matteo for the residence of the King of Tartary—The new Pope Gregory X.—The narrative of Marco Polo is written in French from his dictation, by Rusticien of Pisa
The interest of Genoese and Venetian merchants in promoting exploration of Central Asia—The Polo family and their status in Venice—Nicholas and Matteo Polo, the two brothers—They travel from Constantinople to the Court of the Emperor of China—Their reception at Kublaï-Khan's Court—The Emperor appoints them as his ambassadors to the Pope—Their return to Venice—Marco Polo—He leaves his father Nicholas and uncle Matteo to stay with the King of Tartary—The new Pope Gregory X.—Marco Polo's story is written in French from his dictation by Rusticien of Pisa.
Armenia Minor—Armenia—Mount Ararat—Georgia—Mosul, Baghdad, Bussorah, Tauris—Persia—The Province of Kirman—Comadi—Ormuz—The Old Man of the Mountain—Cheburgan—Balkh—Cashmir—Kashgar—Samarcand—Kotan—The Desert—Tangun—Kara-Korum—Signan-fu—The Great Wall—Chang-tou—The residence of Kublaï-Khan—Cambaluc, now Pekin—The Emperor's fêtes—His hunting—Description of Pekin—Chinese Mint and bank-notes—The system of posts in the Empire
Minor Armenia—Armenia—Mount Ararat—Georgia—Mosul, Baghdad, Bussorah, Tabriz—Persia—The Province of Kirman—Comadi—Ormuz—The Old Man of the Mountain—Cheburgan—Balkh—Kashmir—Kashgar—Samarkand—Kotan—The Desert—Tangun—Karakoram—Signan-fu—The Great Wall—Chang-tou—The residence of Kublai Khan—Cambaluc, now Beijing—The Emperor's celebrations—His hunting—Description of Beijing—Chinese Mint and banknotes—The postal system in the Empire
Tso-cheu—Tai-yen-fou—Pin-yang-fou—The Yellow River—Signan-fou—Szu-tchouan—Ching-tu-fou—Thibet—Li-kiang-fou—Carajan—Yung-tchang—Mien—Bengal—Annam—Tai-ping—Cintingui—Sindifoo—Té-cheu—Tsi-nan-fou—Lin-tsin-choo—Lin-sing—Mangi—Yang-tcheu-fou—Towns on the coast—Quin-say or Hang-tcheou-foo—Fo-kien
Tso-cheu—Tai-yen-fou—Pin-yang-fou—The Yellow River—Signan-fou—Szu-tchouan—Ching-tu-fou—Tibet—Li-kiang-fou—Carajan—Yung-tchang—Mien—Bengal—Annam—Tai-ping—Cintingui—Sindifoo—Té-cheu—Tsi-nan-fou—Lin-tsin-choo—Lin-sing—Mangi—Yang-tcheu-fou—Coastal towns—Quin-say or Hang-tcheou-foo—Fo-kien
Japan—Departure of the three Venetians with the Emperor's daughter and the Persian ambassadors—Sai-gon—Java—Condor—Bintang—Sumatra—The Nicobar Islands—Ceylon—The Coromandel coast—The Malabar coast—The Sea of Oman—The island of Socotra—Madagascar—Zanzibar and the coast of Africa—Abyssinia—Yemen—Hadramaut and Oman—Ormuz—The return to Venice—A feast in the household of Polo—Marco Polo a Genoese prisoner—Death of Marco Polo about 1323
Japan—The three Venetians depart with the Emperor's daughter and the Persian ambassadors—Sai-gon—Java—Condor—Bintang—Sumatra—The Nicobar Islands—Ceylon—The Coromandel coast—The Malabar coast—The Sea of Oman—The island of Socotra—Madagascar—Zanzibar and the African coast—Abyssinia—Yemen—Hadramaut and Oman—Ormuz—Returning to Venice—A feast at Polo's home—Marco Polo, a Genoese prisoner—Marco Polo's death around 1323
CHAPTER V.
Ibn Batuta—The Nile—Gaza, Tyre, Tiberias, Libanus, Baalbec, Damascus, Meshid, Bussorah, Baghdad, Tabriz, Mecca and Medina—Yemen—Abyssinia—The country of the Berbers—Zanguebar—Ormuz—Syria—Anatolia—Asia Minor—Astrakhan—Constantinople—Turkestan—Herat—The Indus—Delhi—Malabar—The Maldives—Ceylon—The Coromandel coast—Bengal—The Nicobar Islands—Sumatra—China—Africa—The Niger—Timbuctoo
Ibn Batuta—The Nile—Gaza, Tyre, Tiberias, Lebanon, Baalbek, Damascus, Meshid, Basra, Baghdad, Tabriz, Mecca and Medina—Yemen—Abyssinia—The Berber region—Zanzibar—Ormuz—Syria—Anatolia—Asia Minor—Astrakhan—Istanbul—Turkestan—Herat—The Indus—Delhi—Malabar—The Maldives—Sri Lanka—The Coromandel coast—Bengal—The Nicobar Islands—Sumatra—China—Africa—The Niger—Timbuktu
CHAPTER VI.
The Norman cavalier—His ideas of conquest—What was known of the Canary Islands—Cadiz—The Canary Archipelago—Graciosa—Lancerota—Fortaventura—Jean de Béthencourt returns to Spain—Revolt of Berneval—His interview with King Henry III.—Gadifer visits the Canary Archipelago—Canary Island or "Gran Canaria"—Ferro Island—Palma Island
The Norman knight—His concepts of conquest—What was known about the Canary Islands—Cadiz—The Canary Archipelago—Graciosa—Lanzarote—Fuerteventura—Jean de Béthencourt goes back to Spain—Revolt of Berneval—His meeting with King Henry III.—Gadifer visits the Canary Archipelago—Canary Island or "Gran Canaria"—Ferro Island—Palma Island
The return of Jean de Béthencourt—Gadifer's jealousy—Béthencourt visits his archipelago—Gadifer goes to conquer Gran Canaria—Disagreement of the two commanders—Their return to Spain—Gadifer blamed by the King—Return of Béthencourt—The natives of Fortaventura are baptized—Béthencourt revisits Caux—Returns to Lancerota—Lands on the African coast—Conquest of Gran Canaria, Ferro, and Palma Islands—Maciot appointed Governor of the archipelago—Béthencourt obtains the Pope's consent to the Canary Islands being made an Episcopal See—His return to his country and his death
The return of Jean de Béthencourt—Gadifer's jealousy—Béthencourt visits his islands—Gadifer heads to conquer Gran Canaria—Conflict between the two leaders—Their return to Spain—Gadifer is criticized by the King—Béthencourt returns—The natives of Fortaventura are baptized—Béthencourt visits Caux again—Returns to Lanzarote—Lands on the African coast—Conquest of Gran Canaria, Ferro, and Palma Islands—Maciot is appointed Governor of the islands—Béthencourt gets the Pope's approval for the Canary Islands to become an Episcopal See—His return to his home and his death
CHAPTER VII.
Discovery of Madeira, Cape de Verd Islands, the Azores, Congo, and Guinea—Bartholomew Diaz—Cabot and Labrador—The geographical and commercial tendencies of the middle ages—The erroneous idea of the distance between Europe and Asia—Birth of Christopher Columbus—His first voyages—His plans rejected—His sojourn at the Franciscan convent—His reception by Ferdinand and Isabella—Treaty of the 17th of April, 1492—The brothers Pinzon—Three armed caravels at the port of Palos—Departure on the 3rd of August, 1492
Discovery of Madeira, Cape Verde Islands, the Azores, Congo, and Guinea—Bartholomew Diaz—Cabot and Labrador—The geographical and commercial trends of the Middle Ages—The mistaken belief about the distance between Europe and Asia—Birth of Christopher Columbus—His early voyages—His plans turned down—His stay at the Franciscan convent—His reception by Ferdinand and Isabella—Treaty of April 17, 1492—The Pinzon brothers—Three armed caravels at the port of Palos—Departure on August 3, 1492
First voyage: The Great Canary—Gomera—Magnetic variation—Symptoms of revolt—Land, land—San Salvador—Taking possession—Conception—Fernandina or Great Exuma—Isabella, or Long Island—The Mucaras—Cuba—Description of the island—Archipelago of Notre-Dame—Hispaniola or San Domingo—Tortuga Island—The cacique on board the Santa-Maria—The caravel of Columbus goes aground and cannot be floated off—Island of Monte-Christi—Return—Tempest—Arrival in Spain—Homage rendered to Christopher Columbus
First voyage: The Great Canary—Gomera—Magnetic variation—Signs of revolt—Land, land—San Salvador—Claiming possession—Conception—Fernandina or Great Exuma—Isabella, or Long Island—The Mucaras—Cuba—Description of the island—Notre-Dame Archipelago—Hispaniola or San Domingo—Tortuga Island—The cacique on board the Santa-Maria—Columbus's caravel runs aground and can't be floated off—Monte-Christi Island—Return—Storm—Arrival in Spain—Tribute paid to Christopher Columbus
Second Voyage: Flotilla of seventeen vessels—Island of Ferro—Dominica—Marie-Galante—Guadaloupe—The Cannibals—Montserrat—Santa-Maria-la-Rodonda—St. Martin and Santa Cruz—Archipelago of the Eleven Thousand Virgins—The island of St. John Baptist, or Porto Rico—Hispaniola—The first Colonists massacred—Foundation of the town of Isabella—Twelve ships laden with treasure sent to Spain—Fort St. Thomas built in the Province of Cibao—Don Diego, Columbus' brother, named Governor of the Island—Jamaica—The Coast of Cuba—The Remora—Return to Isabella—The Cacique made prisoner—Revolt of the Natives—Famine—Columbus traduced in Spain—Juan Aguado sent as Commissary to Isabella—Gold-mines—Departure of Columbus—His arrival at Cadiz
Second Voyage: A flotilla of seventeen ships—Island of Ferro—Dominica—Marie-Galante—Guadaloupe—The Cannibals—Montserrat—Santa-Maria-la-Rodonda—St. Martin and Santa Cruz—Archipelago of the Eleven Thousand Virgins—The island of St. John Baptist, or Puerto Rico—Hispaniola—The first colonists killed—Foundation of the town of Isabella—Twelve ships filled with treasure sent to Spain—Fort St. Thomas built in the Province of Cibao—Don Diego, Columbus' brother, appointed Governor of the Island—Jamaica—The Coast of Cuba—The Remora—Return to Isabella—The Cacique captured—Revolt of the Natives—Famine—Columbus slandered in Spain—Juan Aguado sent as Commissary to Isabella—Gold mines—Columbus' departure—His arrival in Cadiz
Third Voyage: Madeira—Santiago in the Cape Verd Archipelago—Trinidad—First sight of the American Coast in Venezuela, beyond the Orinoco, now the Province of Cumana—Gulf of Paria—The Gardens—Tobago—Grenada—Margarita—Cubaga—Hispaniola during the absence of Columbus—Foundation of the town of San Domingo—Arrival of Columbus—Insubordination in the Colony—Complaints in Spain—Bovadilla sent by the king to inquire into the conduct of Columbus—Columbus sent to Europe in fetters with his two brothers—His appearance before Ferdinand and Isabella—Renewal of royal favour
Third Voyage: Madeira—Santiago in the Cape Verde Archipelago—Trinidad—First sight of the American coast in Venezuela, beyond the Orinoco, now the Province of Cumana—Gulf of Paria—The Gardens—Tobago—Grenada—Margarita—Cubagua—Hispaniola during Columbus's absence—Foundation of the town of San Domingo—Arrival of Columbus—Rebellion in the Colony—Complaints in Spain—Bovadilla sent by the king to investigate Columbus's conduct—Columbus sent to Europe in chains with his two brothers—His appearance before Ferdinand and Isabella—Renewal of royal favor
Fourth Voyage: A Flotilla of four vessels—Canary Islands—Martinique—Dominica—Santa-Cruz—Porto-Rico—Hispaniola—Jamaica—Cayman Island—Pinos Island—Island of Guanaja—Cape Honduras—The American Coast of Truxillo on the Gulf of Darien—The Limonare Islands—Huerta—The Coast of Veragua—Auriferous Strata—Revolt of the Natives—The Dream of Columbus—Porto-Bello—The Mulatas—Putting into port at Jamaica—Distress—Revolt of the Spaniards against Columbus—Lunar Eclipse—Arrival of Columbus at Hispaniola—Return of Columbus to Spain—His death, on the 20th of March, 1506
Fourth Voyage: A fleet of four ships—Canary Islands—Martinique—Dominica—Santa Cruz—Puerto Rico—Hispaniola—Jamaica—Cayman Islands—Pinos Island—Island of Guanaja—Cape Honduras—The American coast of Truxillo on the Gulf of Darien—The Limonare Islands—Huerta—The coast of Veragua—Gold-bearing regions—Native revolt—The dream of Columbus—Portobello—The Mulattoes—Docking in Jamaica—Struggles—Spanish revolt against Columbus—Lunar eclipse—Columbus's arrival in Hispaniola—Columbus's return to Spain—His death on March 20, 1506
CHAPTER VIII.
Covilham and Païva—Vasco da Gama—The Cape of Good Hope is doubled—Escalès at Sam-Braz—Mozambique, Mombaz, and Melinda—Arrival at Calicut—Treason of the Zamorin—Battles—Return to Europe—The scurvy—Death of Paul da Gama—Arrival at Lisbon
Covilham and Païva—Vasco da Gama—Round Cape of Good Hope—Escalès at Sam-Braz—Mozambique, Mombasa, and Melinda—Arrival in Calicut—Betrayal by the Zamorin—Battles—Return to Europe—Scurvy outbreak—Death of Paul da Gama—Arrival in Lisbon
Alvarès Cabral—Discovery of Brazil—The coast of Africa—Arrival at Calicut, Cochin, Cananore—Joao da Nova—Gama's second expedition—The King of Cochin—The early life of Albuquerque—The taking of Goa—The siege and capture of Malacca—Second expedition against Ormuz—Ceylon—The Moluccas—Death of Albuquerque—Fate of the Portuguese empire of the Indies
Alvarès Cabral—Discovery of Brazil—The coast of Africa—Arrival at Calicut, Cochin, Cananore—Joao da Nova—Gama's second expedition—The King of Cochin—The early life of Albuquerque—The capture of Goa—The siege and takeover of Malacca—Second expedition against Ormuz—Ceylon—The Moluccas—Death of Albuquerque—The fate of the Portuguese Empire in the Indies
SECOND PART.
CHAPTER I.
Hojeda—Americus Vespucius—The New World named after him—Juan de la Cosa—Vincent Yañez Pinzon—Bastidas—Diego de Lepe—Diaz de Solis—Ponce de Leon and Florida—Balboa discovers the Pacific Ocean—Grijalva explores the coast of Mexico
Hojeda—Americus Vespucius—The New World named after him—Juan de la Cosa—Vincent Yañez Pinzon—Bastidas—Diego de Lepe—Diaz de Solis—Ponce de Leon and Florida—Balboa discovers the Pacific Ocean—Grijalva explores the coast of Mexico
Ferdinand Cortès—His character—His appointment—Preparations for the expedition, and attempts of Velasquez to stop it—Landing at Vera-Cruz—Mexico and the Emperor Montezuma—The republic of Tlascala—March upon Mexico—The Emperor is made prisoner—Narvaez defeated—The Noche Triste—Battle of Otumba—The second siege and taking of Mexico—Expedition to Honduras—Voyage to Spain—Expeditions on the Pacific Ocean—Second Voyage of Cortès to Spain—His death
Ferdinand Cortès—His character—His appointment—Preparations for the expedition, and Velasquez's attempts to stop it—Landing at Vera-Cruz—Mexico and Emperor Montezuma—The republic of Tlascala—March to Mexico—The Emperor is captured—Narvaez is defeated—The Noche Triste—Battle of Otumba—The second siege and capture of Mexico—Expedition to Honduras—Voyage to Spain—Expeditions in the Pacific Ocean—Cortès's second voyage to Spain—His death
The triple alliance—Francisco Pizarro and his brothers—Don Diego d'Almagro—First attempts—Peru, its extent, people, and kings—Capture of Atahualpa, his ransom and death—Pedro d'Alvarado—Almagro in Chili—Strife among the conquerors—Trial and execution of Almagro—Expeditions of Gonzalo Pizarro and Orellana—Assassination of Francisco Pizarro—Rebellion and execution of his brother Gonzalo
The triple alliance—Francisco Pizarro and his brothers—Don Diego d'Almagro—Initial efforts—Peru, its size, people, and rulers—Capture of Atahualpa, his ransom and execution—Pedro d'Alvarado—Almagro in Chile—Conflict among the conquerors—Trial and execution of Almagro—Expeditions by Gonzalo Pizarro and Orellana—Assassination of Francisco Pizarro—Rebellion and execution of his brother Gonzalo
CHAPTER II.
Magellan—His early history—His disappointment—His change of nationality—Preparations for the expedition—Rio de Janeiro— St. Julian's Bay—Revolt of a part of the squadron—Terrible punishment of the guilty—Magellan's Strait—Patagonia—The Pacific—The Ladrone Islands—Zebu and the Philippine Islands— Death of Magellan—Borneo—The Moluccas and their Productions— Separation of the Trinidad and Victoria—Return to Europe by the Cape of Good Hope—Last misadventures
Magellan—His early life—His disappointment—His shift in nationality—Preparations for the expedition—Rio de Janeiro—St. Julian's Bay—Rebellion of part of the squadron—Severe punishment of the offenders—Magellan's Strait—Patagonia—The Pacific Ocean—The Ladrone Islands—Cebu and the Philippine Islands—Magellan's death—Borneo—The Moluccas and their products—Separation of the Trinidad and Victoria—Return to Europe via the Cape of Good Hope—Final misadventures
CHAPTER III.
The Northmen—Eric the Red—The Zenos—John Cabot—Cortereal—Sebastian Cabot—Willoughby—Chancellor
The Northmen—Eric the Red—The Zenos—John Cabot—Cortereal—Sebastian Cabot—Willoughby—Chancellor
John Verrazzano—Jacques Cartier and his three voyages to Canada—The town of Hochelaga—Tobacco—The scurvy—Voyage of Roberval—Martin Frobisher and his voyages—John Davis—Barentz and Heemskerke—Spitzbergen—Winter season at Nova Zembla— Return to Europe—Relics of the Expedition
John Verrazzano—Jacques Cartier and his three trips to Canada—The town of Hochelaga—Tobacco—Scurvy—Roberval's voyage—Martin Frobisher and his voyages—John Davis—Barentz and Heemskerke—Spitsbergen—Winter season in Nova Zembla—Return to Europe—Relics from the expedition
CHAPTER IV.
Drake—Cavendish—De Noort—Walter Raleigh
Drake—Cavendish—De Noort—Walter Raleigh
CHAPTER V.
Distinguishing characteristics of the Seventeenth Century—The more thorough exploration of regions previously discovered—To the thirst for gold succeeds Apostolic zeal—Italian Missionaries in Congo—Portuguese Missionaries in Abyssinia—Brue in Senegal and Flacourt in Madagascar—The Apostles of India, of Indo-China, and of Japan
Key Features of the Seventeenth Century—More in-depth exploration of areas that had already been discovered—Apostolic zeal replaces the quest for gold—Italian missionaries in the Congo—Portuguese missionaries in Abyssinia—Brue in Senegal and Flacourt in Madagascar—The Apostles of India, Indo-China, and Japan
The Dutch in the Spice Islands—Lemaire and Schouten—Tasman—Mendana—Queiros and Torrès—Pyrard de Laval—Pietro della Valle—Tavernier—Thévenot—Bernier—Robert Knox—Chardin—De Bruyn—Kæmpfer
The Dutch in the Spice Islands—Lemaire and Schouten—Tasman—Mendana—Queiros and Torrès—Pyrard de Laval—Pietro della Valle—Tavernier—Thévenot—Bernier—Robert Knox—Chardin—De Bruyn—Kæmpfer
CHAPTER VI.
THE GREAT CORSAIR.
William Dampier; or a Sea-King of the Seventeenth Century
William Dampier; or a Sea King of the Seventeenth Century
THE POLE AND AMERICA.
Hudson and Baffin—Champlain and La Sale—The English upon the coast of the Atlantic—The Spaniards in South America—Summary of the information acquired at the close of the 17th century—The measure of the terrestrial degree—Progress of cartography—Inauguration of Mathematical Geography
Hudson and Baffin—Champlain and La Salle—The English on the Atlantic coast—The Spaniards in South America—Summary of the knowledge gained by the end of the 17th century—The measurement of the terrestrial degree—Advancements in cartography—The beginning of Mathematical Geography
![]() |
CHAPTER I.
HANNO, 505; HERODOTUS, 484; PYTHEAS, 340; NEARCHUS, 326;
EUDOXUS, 146; CÆSAR, 100; STRABO, 50.
Hanno, the Carthaginian—Herodotus visits Egypt, Lybia, Ethiopia, Phoenicia, Arabia, Babylon, Persia, India, Media, Colchis, the Caspian Sea, Scythia, Thrace, and Greece—Pytheas explores the coasts of Iberia and Gaul, the English Channel, the Isle of Albion, the Orkney Islands, and the land of Thule—Nearchus visits the Asiatic coast, from the Indus to the Persian Gulf—Eudoxus reconnoitres the West Coast of Africa—Cæsar conquers Gaul and Great Britain—Strabo travels over the interior of Asia, and Egypt, Greece, and Italy.
Hanno, the Carthaginian—Herodotus explores Egypt, Libya, Ethiopia, Phoenicia, Arabia, Babylon, Persia, India, Media, Colchis, the Caspian Sea, Scythia, Thrace, and Greece—Pytheas investigates the coasts of Iberia and Gaul, the English Channel, the Isle of Albion, the Orkney Islands, and the land of Thule—Nearchus travels the Asian coast from the Indus to the Persian Gulf—Eudoxus surveys the West Coast of Africa—Cæsar conquers Gaul and Great Britain—Strabo journeys across the interior of Asia, along with Egypt, Greece, and Italy.
The first traveller of whom we have any account in history, is Hanno, who was sent by the Carthaginian senate to colonize some parts of the Western coast of Africa. The account of this expedition was written in the Carthaginian language and afterwards translated into Greek. It is known to us now by the name of the "Periplus of Hanno." At what period this explorer lived, historians are not agreed, but the most probable account assigns the date B.C. 505 to his exploration of the African coast.
The first traveler we know of in history is Hanno, who was sent by the Carthaginian senate to settle parts of the Western coast of Africa. The record of this expedition was written in Carthaginian and later translated into Greek. Today, we refer to it as the "Periplus of Hanno." Historians don’t agree on exactly when this explorer lived, but the most likely date for his exploration of the African coast is B.C. 505.
Hanno left Carthage with a fleet of sixty vessels of fifty oars each, carrying 30,000 persons, and provisions for a long voyage. These emigrants, for so we may call them, were destined to people the new towns that the Carthaginians hoped to found on the west coast of Libya, or as we now call it, Africa.
Hanno left Carthage with a fleet of sixty ships, each powered by fifty oars, carrying 30,000 people and enough supplies for an extended journey. These emigrants, as we might refer to them, were meant to settle in the new towns that the Carthaginians aimed to establish on the west coast of Libya, which we now call Africa.
The fleet successfully passed the Pillars of Hercules, the rocks of Gibraltar and Ceuta which command the Strait, and ventured on the Atlantic, taking a southerly course. Two days after passing the Straits, Hanno anchored on the coast, and laid the foundation of the town of Thumiaterion.
The fleet successfully sailed past the Pillars of Hercules, the rocks of Gibraltar and Ceuta that overlook the Strait, and headed into the Atlantic, taking a southern route. Two days after crossing the Straits, Hanno anchored on the coast and established the town of Thumiaterion.
Then he put to sea again, and doubling the cape of Soloïs, made fresh discoveries, and advanced to the mouth of a large African river, where he found a tribe of wandering shepherds camping on the banks. He only waited to conclude a treaty of alliance with them, before continuing his voyage southward. He next reached the Island of Cerne, situated in a bay, and measuring five stadia in circumference, or as we should say at the present day, nearly 925 yards. According to Hanno's own account, this island should be placed, with regard to the Pillars of Hercules, at an equal distance to that which separates these Pillars from Carthage.
Then he set sail again, rounded the cape of Soloïs, made new discoveries, and arrived at the mouth of a large African river, where he found a group of wandering shepherds camping on the riverbanks. He only paused to make a treaty of alliance with them before continuing his journey south. Next, he reached the Island of Cerne, located in a bay and measuring five stadia in circumference, or about 925 yards in today's terms. According to Hanno's own account, this island should be positioned, in relation to the Pillars of Hercules, at the same distance that separates those Pillars from Carthage.
They set sail again, and Hanno reached the mouth of the river Chretes, which forms a sort of natural harbour, but as they endeavoured to explore this river, they were assailed with showers of stones from the native negro race, inhabiting the surrounding country, and driven back, and after this inhospitable reception they returned to Cerne. We must not omit to add that Hanno mentions finding large numbers of crocodiles and hippopotami in this river. Twelve days after this unsuccessful expedition, the fleet reached a mountainous region, where fragrant trees and shrubs abounded, and it then entered a vast gulf which terminated in a plain. This region appeared quite calm during the day, but after nightfall it was illumined by tongues of flame, which might have proceeded from fires lighted by the natives, or from the natural ignition of the dry grass when the rainy season was over.
They set sail again, and Hanno arrived at the mouth of the Chretes River, which creates a kind of natural harbor. However, as they tried to explore this river, they were bombarded with stones from the local native people living in the surrounding area and were forced to turn back. After this unwelcoming experience, they returned to Cerne. It's worth noting that Hanno mentioned seeing large numbers of crocodiles and hippopotamuses in this river. Twelve days after this unsuccessful expedition, the fleet reached a hilly area filled with fragrant trees and shrubs, and then entered a vast gulf that led to a plain. This region seemed completely calm during the day, but at night it was lit up by flames, which could have come from fires started by the locals or from the natural ignition of dry grass once the rainy season was over.
In five days, Hanno doubled the Cape, known as the Hespera Keras, there, according to his own account, "he heard the sound of fifes, cymbals, and tambourines, and the clamour of a multitude of people." The soothsayers, who accompanied the party of Carthaginian explorers, counselled flight from this land of terrors, and, in obedience to their advice, they set sail again, still taking a southerly course. They arrived at a cape, which, stretching southwards, formed a gulf, called Notu Keras, and, according to M. D'Avezac, this gulf must have been the mouth of the river Ouro, which falls into the Atlantic almost within the Tropic of Cancer. At the lower end of this gulf, they found an island inhabited by a vast number of gorillas, which the Carthaginians mistook for hairy savages. They contrived to get possession of three female gorillas, but were obliged to kill them on account of their great ferocity.
In five days, Hanno reached the Cape, referred to as the Hespera Keras. There, according to his own account, "he heard the sound of flutes, cymbals, and tambourines, along with the chatter of a large crowd." The soothsayers who traveled with the Carthaginian explorers advised them to flee from this frightening land. Following their advice, they set sail again, continuing to head south. They arrived at a cape, which extended southward and formed a gulf called Notu Keras. According to M. D'Avezac, this gulf was likely the mouth of the river Ouro, which flows into the Atlantic just about at the Tropic of Cancer. At the lower end of this gulf, they discovered an island populated by a large number of gorillas, which the Carthaginians mistook for hairy savages. They managed to capture three female gorillas but were forced to kill them due to their extreme ferocity.
This Notu Keras must have been the extreme limit reached by the Carthaginian explorers, and though some historians incline to the belief that they only went to Bojador, which is two degrees North of the tropics, it is more probable that the former account is the true one, and that Hanno, finding himself short of provisions, returned northwards to Carthage, where he had the account of his voyage engraved in the temple of Baal Moloch.
This Notu Keras must have been the farthest point reached by the Carthaginian explorers, and while some historians think they only went as far as Bojador, which is two degrees north of the tropics, it’s more likely that the first account is the accurate one. Hanno, running low on supplies, probably sailed back north to Carthage, where he had a record of his journey carved in the temple of Baal Moloch.
After Hanno, the most illustrious of ancient travellers, was Herodotus, who has been called the "Father of History," and who was the nephew of the poet Panyasis, whose poems ranked with those of Homer and Hesiod. It will serve our purpose better if we only speak of Herodotus as a traveller, not an historian, as we wish to follow him so far as possible through the countries that he traversed.
After Hanno, the most famous of ancient travelers, came Herodotus, who is known as the "Father of History" and was the nephew of the poet Panyasis, whose works were on par with those of Homer and Hesiod. It will be more useful for us to think of Herodotus as a traveler rather than a historian, as we want to trace his journey through the lands he explored.
Herodotus was born at Halicarnassus, a town in Asia Minor, in the year B.C. 484. His family were rich, and having large commercial transactions they were able to encourage the taste for explorations which he showed. At this time there were many different opinions as to the shape of the earth: the Pythagorean school having even then begun to teach that it must be round, but Herodotus took no part in this discussion, which was of the deepest interest to learned men of that time, and, still young, he left home with a view of exploring with great care all the then known world, and especially those parts of it of which there were but few and uncertain data.
Herodotus was born in Halicarnassus, a town in Asia Minor, in the year B.C. 484. His family was wealthy, and because of their significant business dealings, they were able to support his interest in exploration. At that time, there were many different views on the shape of the Earth: the Pythagorean school had already started teaching that it must be round, but Herodotus didn’t get involved in this debate, which fascinated the educated people of his era. While still young, he left home with the aim of thoroughly exploring all parts of the known world, especially those areas with limited and uncertain information.
He left Halicarnassus in 464, being then twenty years of age, and probably directed his steps first to Egypt, visiting Memphis, Heliopolis, and Thebes. He seems to have specially turned his attention to the overflow of the banks of the Nile, and he gives an account of the different opinions held as to the source of this river, which the Egyptians worshipped as one of their deities. "When the Nile overflows its banks," he says, "you can see nothing but the towns rising out of the water, and they appear like the islands in the Ægean Sea." He tells of the religious ceremonies among the Egyptians, their sacrifices, their ardour in celebrating the feasts in honour of their goddess Isis, which took place principally at Busiris (whose ruins may still be seen near Bushir), and of the veneration paid to both wild and tame animals, which were looked upon almost as sacred, and to whom they even rendered funeral honours at their death. He depicts in the most faithful colours, the Nile crocodile, its form, habits, and the way in which it is caught, and the hippopotamus, the momot, the phoenix, the ibis, and the serpents that were consecrated to the god Jupiter. Nothing can be more life-like than his accounts of Egyptian customs, and the notices of their habits, their games, and their way of embalming the dead, in which the chemists of that period seem to have excelled. Then we have the history of the country from Menes, its first king, downwards to Herodotus' time, and he describes the building of the Pyramids under Cheops, the Labyrinth that was built a little above the Lake Moeris (of which the remains were discovered in A.D. 1799), Lake Moeris itself, whose origin he ascribes to the hand of man, and the two Pyramids which are situated a little above the lake. He seems to have admired many of the Egyptian temples, and especially that of Minerva at Sais, and of Vulcan and Isis at Memphis, and the colossal monolith that was three years in course of transportation from Elephantina to Sais, though 2000 men were employed on the gigantic work.
He left Halicarnassus in 464 at the age of twenty and likely headed first to Egypt, visiting Memphis, Heliopolis, and Thebes. He particularly focused on the flooding of the Nile and discusses various beliefs about the river's source, which the Egyptians regarded as a deity. "When the Nile overflows its banks," he says, "you can see nothing but towns emerging from the water, looking like islands in the Aegean Sea." He describes the religious ceremonies of the Egyptians, their sacrifices, and their enthusiasm for celebrating festivals in honor of their goddess Isis, primarily held at Busiris (the ruins of which can still be seen near Bushir). He notes the reverence for both wild and domesticated animals, which were regarded as almost sacred and even received funeral honors when they died. His accounts of the Nile crocodile, including its shape, behavior, and how it is captured, are vividly detailed, along with descriptions of the hippopotamus, the momot, the phoenix, the ibis, and the snakes dedicated to the god Jupiter. His depictions of Egyptian customs, their daily life, games, and the embalming process—where the chemists of that era seemed to excel—are exceptionally lifelike. He also provides a history of the country from Menes, its first king, to his own time, describing the construction of the Pyramids under Cheops, the Labyrinth built near Lake Moeris (whose remnants were uncovered in A.D. 1799), Lake Moeris itself, which he attributes to human creation, and the two Pyramids located just above the lake. He seems to have admired many Egyptian temples, especially the one dedicated to Minerva at Sais, as well as those of Vulcan and Isis at Memphis, and the massive monolith that took three years to transport from Elephantina to Sais, despite employing 2000 men for this monumental task.
After having carefully inspected everything of interest in Egypt, Herodotus went into Lybia, little thinking that the continent he was exploring, extended thence to the tropic of Cancer. He made special inquiries in Lybia as to the number of its inhabitants, who were a simple nomadic race principally living near the sea-coast, and he speaks of the Ammonians, who possessed the celebrated temple of Jupiter Ammon, the remains of which have been discovered on the north-east side of the Lybian desert, about 300 miles from Cairo. Herodotus furnishes us with some very valuable information on Lybian customs; he describes their habits; speaks of the animals that infest the country, serpents of a prodigious size, lions, elephants, bears, asps, horned asses (probably the rhinoceros of the present day), and cynocephali, "animals with no heads, and whose eyes are placed on their chest," to use his own expression; foxes, hyenas, porcupines, wild zarus, panthers, etc. He winds up his description by saying that the only two aboriginal nations that inhabit this region are the Lybians and Ethiopians.
After carefully checking out everything interesting in Egypt, Herodotus headed into Libya, not realizing that the continent he was exploring extended all the way to the Tropic of Cancer. He asked plenty of questions in Libya about the population, which consisted of a simple nomadic people mainly living along the coast. He mentions the Ammonians, who had the famous temple of Jupiter Ammon, the remains of which have been found on the northeast side of the Libyan desert, about 300 miles from Cairo. Herodotus provides us with valuable insights into Libyan customs; he describes their way of life and talks about the animals that inhabit the land, including enormous snakes, lions, elephants, bears, asps, horned donkeys (likely referring to the modern rhinoceros), and cynocephali, which he describes as "animals with no heads, whose eyes are on their chest." He also mentions foxes, hyenas, porcupines, wild zarus, panthers, and more. He concludes his description by stating that the only two indigenous nations living in this area are the Libyans and Ethiopians.
According to Herodotus the Ethiopians were at that time to be found above Elephantina, but commentators are induced to doubt if this learned explorer ever really visited Ethiopia, and if he did not, he may easily have learnt from the Egyptians the details that he gives of its capital, Meroe, of the worship of Jupiter and Bacchus, and the longevity of the natives. There can be no doubt, however, that he set sail for Tyre in Phoenicia, and that he was much struck with the beauty of the two magnificent temples of Hercules. He next visited Tarsus and took advantage of the information gathered on the spot, to write a short history of Phoenicia, Syria, and Palestine.
According to Herodotus, the Ethiopians were located above Elephantina at that time, but some commentators are skeptical about whether this knowledgeable explorer actually visited Ethiopia. If he didn’t, he could have easily learned from the Egyptians about its capital, Meroe, the worship of Jupiter and Bacchus, and the long lifespan of the local people. However, there’s no doubt that he set sail for Tyre in Phoenicia, and he was very impressed by the beauty of the two magnificent temples of Hercules. He then visited Tarsus and used the information he gathered there to write a short history of Phoenicia, Syria, and Palestine.
We next find that he went southward to Arabia, and he calls it the Ethiopia of Asia, for he thought the southern parts of Arabia were the limits of human habitation. He tells us of the remarkable way in which the Arabs kept any vow that they might have made; that their two deities were Uranius and Bacchus, and of the abundant growth of myrrh, cinnamon and other spices, and he gives a very interesting account of their culture and preparation.
We then see that he traveled south to Arabia, which he refers to as the Ethiopia of Asia because he believed the southern regions of Arabia marked the edge of human settlement. He describes how the Arabs honor any vows they make, mentions their two gods, Uranius and Bacchus, and talks about the rich variety of myrrh, cinnamon, and other spices. He provides a fascinating overview of their cultivation and preparation methods.
We cannot be quite sure which country he next visited, as he calls it both Assyria and Babylonia, but he gives a most minute account of the splendid city of Babylon (which was the home of the monarchs of that country, after the destruction of Nineveh), and whose ruins are now only in scattered heaps on either side of the Euphrates, which flowed a broad, deep, rapid river, dividing the city into two parts. On one side of the river the fortified palace of the king stood, and on the other the temple of Jupiter Belus, which may have been built on the site of the Tower of Babel. Herodotus next speaks of the two queens, Semiramis and Nitocris, telling us of all the means taken by the latter to increase the prosperity and safety of her capital, and passing on to speak of the natural products of the country, the wheat, barley, millet, sesame, the vine, fig-tree and palm-tree. He winds up with a description of the costume of the Babylonians, and their customs, especially that of celebrating their marriages by the public crier.
We can’t be completely sure which country he visited next, as he refers to it as both Assyria and Babylonia, but he provides a very detailed account of the magnificent city of Babylon (which was the residence of the kings of that region after Nineveh was destroyed). Now, its ruins are just scattered piles on either side of the Euphrates, which flows as a wide, deep, and fast river, splitting the city in two. On one side of the river stood the fortified palace of the king, while on the other side was the temple of Jupiter Belus, possibly built on the site of the Tower of Babel. Herodotus then mentions the two queens, Semiramis and Nitocris, describing all the actions taken by the latter to enhance the prosperity and safety of her capital and moving on to discuss the country’s natural products: wheat, barley, millet, sesame, grapes, figs, and palm trees. He concludes with a description of the Babylonians' clothing and their customs, particularly how they celebrate marriages with a public crier.
![]() |
The Marriage Ceremony. |
After exploring Babylonia he went to Persia, and as the express purpose of his travels was to collect all the information he could relating to the lengthy wars that had taken place between the Persians and Grecians, he was most anxious to visit the spots where the battles had been fought. He sets out by remarking upon the custom prevalent in Persia, of not clothing their deities in any human form, nor erecting temples nor altars where they might be worshipped, but contenting themselves with adoring them on the tops of the mountains. He notes their domestic habits, their disdain of animal food, their taste for delicacies, their passion for wine, and their custom of transacting business of the utmost importance when they had been drinking to excess; their curiosity as to the habits of other nations, their love of pleasure, their warlike qualities, their anxiety for the education of their children, their respect for the lives of all their fellow-creatures, even of their slaves, their horror both of debt and lying, and their repugnance to the disease of leprosy which they thought proved that the sufferer "had sinned in some way against the sun." The India of Herodotus, according to M. Vivien de St. Martin, only consisted of that part of the country that is watered by the five rivers of the Punjaub, adjoining Afghanistan, and this was the region where the young traveller turned his steps on leaving Persia. He thought that the population of India was larger than that of any other country, and he divided it into two classes, the first having settled habitations, the second leading a nomadic life. Those who lived in the eastern part of the country killed their sick and aged people, and ate them, while those in the north, who were a finer, braver, and more industrious race, employed themselves in collecting the auriferous sands. India was then the most easterly extremity of the inhabited world, as he thought, and he observes, "that the two extremities of the world seem to have shared nature's best gifts, as Greece enjoyed the most agreeable temperature possible," and that was his idea of the western limits of the world.
After exploring Babylonia, he traveled to Persia. His main goal was to gather as much information as possible about the long wars between the Persians and Greeks, so he was eager to visit the battle sites. He begins by noting a common practice in Persia: they don’t represent their gods in human form or build temples or altars for worship, instead choosing to venerate them on mountaintops. He observes their daily lives, their avoidance of meat, their preference for fine foods, their love of wine, and their habit of conducting important business while overly intoxicated; he also notes their curiosity about the customs of other nations, their enjoyment of life, their martial skills, their concern for their children's education, their respect for all living beings, even their slaves, their aversion to debt and deceit, and their disgust towards leprosy, which they believed indicated that the person had "sinned against the sun." According to M. Vivien de St. Martin, the India known to Herodotus consisted only of the area watered by the five rivers of Punjab, near Afghanistan, and this was where the young traveler headed after leaving Persia. He estimated that India's population was larger than that of any other country, categorizing it into two groups: those with permanent homes and those who lived a nomadic lifestyle. In the eastern part of the region, people would kill and consume their sick and elderly, while those in the north, who were a finer, braver, and more industrious group, were involved in gathering gold dust. He believed that India marked the farthest eastern point of the inhabited world and remarked, "that the two ends of the world seem to have shared nature's best gifts, as Greece enjoyed the most pleasant climate," which was his view of the western edge of the world.
Media is the next country visited by this indefatigable traveller, and he gives the history of the Medes, the nation which was the first to shake off the Assyrian yoke. They founded the great city of Ecbatana, and surrounded it with seven concentric walls. They became a separate nation in the reign of Deioces. After crossing the mountains that separate Media from Colchis, the Greek traveller entered the country, made famous by the valour of Jason, and studied its manners and customs with the care and attention that were among his most striking characteristics.
Media is the next destination for this tireless traveler, who shares the history of the Medes, the first nation to break free from Assyrian rule. They established the great city of Ecbatana, surrounded by seven concentric walls. They became an independent nation during the reign of Deioces. After crossing the mountains that separate Media from Colchis, the Greek traveler entered the region, known for the bravery of Jason, and examined its customs and traditions with the meticulous attention that were his most notable traits.
Herodotus seems to have been well acquainted with the geography of the Caspian Sea, for he speaks of it as a Sea "quite by itself" and having no communication with any other. He considered that it was bounded on the west by the Caucasian Mountains and on the east by a great plain inhabited by the Massagetæ, who, both Arian and Diodorus Siculus think, may have been Scythians. These Massagetæ worshipped the Sun as their only deity, and sacrificed horses in its honour. He speaks here of two large rivers, one of which, the Araxes, would be the Volga, and the other, that he calls the Ista, must be the Danube. The traveller then went into Scythia, and he thought that the Scythians were the different tribes inhabiting the country that lay between the Danube and the Don, in fact a considerable portion of European Russia. He found the barbarous custom of putting out the eyes of their prisoners was practised among them, and he notices that they only wandered from place to place without caring to cultivate their land. Herodotus relates many of the fables that make the origin of the Scythian nation so obscure, and in which Hercules plays a prominent part. He adds a list of the different tribes that composed the Scythian nation, but he does not seem to have visited the country lying to the north of the Euxine, or Black Sea. He gives a minute description of the habits of these people, and expresses his admiration for the Pontus Euxinus. The dimensions that he gives of the Black Sea, the Bosphorus, of the Propontis, the Palus Mæotis and of the Ægean Sea, are almost exactly the same as those given by geographers of the present day. He also names the large rivers that flow into these seas. The Ister or Danube, the Borysthenes or Dnieper, the Tanais, or Don; and he finishes by relating how the alliance, and afterwards the union between the Scythians and Amazons took place, which explains the reason why the young women of that country are not allowed to marry before they have killed an enemy and established their character for valour.
Herodotus seems to have been well familiar with the geography of the Caspian Sea, as he describes it as a sea "entirely on its own" with no connection to any others. He believed it was bordered on the west by the Caucasian Mountains and on the east by a vast plain inhabited by the Massagetæ, who both Arian and Diodorus Siculus think may have been Scythians. These Massagetæ worshipped the Sun as their only god and sacrificed horses in its honor. He mentions two large rivers, one of which, the Araxes, he indicates would be the Volga, and the other, which he calls the Ista, must be the Danube. The traveler then went into Scythia and thought that the Scythians were the various tribes living in the area between the Danube and the Don, essentially a significant part of European Russia. He observed the brutal custom of blinding their prisoners and noted that they only moved from place to place without any interest in farming their land. Herodotus recounts many of the myths that make the origins of the Scythian nation so unclear, with Hercules playing a key role. He lists the different tribes that made up the Scythian nation but does not seem to have traveled to the region north of the Euxine, or Black Sea. He provides a detailed description of the people's customs and expresses his admiration for the Pontus Euxinus. The measurements he gives for the Black Sea, the Bosphorus, the Propontis, the Palus Mæotis, and the Ægean Sea are almost exactly the same as those provided by modern geographers. He also names the major rivers flowing into these seas: the Ister or Danube, the Borysthenes or Dnieper, the Tanais or Don; and he concludes by explaining how the alliance and later the union between the Scythians and Amazons occurred, which accounts for why young women in that region are not allowed to marry until they have killed an enemy and proven their bravery.
After a short stay in Thrace, during which he was convinced that the Getæ were the bravest portion of this race, Herodotus arrived in Greece, which was to be the termination of his travels, to the country where he hoped to collect the only documents still wanting to complete his history, and he visited all the spots that had become illustrious by the great battles fought between the Greeks and Persians. He gives a minute description of the Pass of Thermopylæ, and of his visit to the plain of Marathon, the battlefield of Platæa, and his return to Asia Minor, whence he passed along the coast on which the Greeks had established several colonies. Herodotus can only have been twenty-eight years of age when he returned to Halicarnassus in Caria, for it was in B.C. 456 that he read the history of his travels at the Olympic Games. His country was at that time oppressed by Lygdamis, and he was exiled to Samos; but though he soon after rose in arms to overthrow the tyrant, the ingratitude of his fellow-citizens obliged him to return into exile. In 444 he took part in the games at the Pantheon, and there he read his completed work, which was received with enthusiasm, and towards the end of his life he retired to Thurium in Italy, where he died, B.C. 406, leaving behind him the reputation of being the greatest traveller and the most celebrated historian of antiquity.
After a short stay in Thrace, where he became convinced that the Getæ were the bravest part of that race, Herodotus arrived in Greece, which would be the end of his travels, to the country where he hoped to gather the last pieces needed to finish his history. He visited all the locations famous for the great battles fought between the Greeks and Persians. He provides a detailed account of the Pass of Thermopylæ, his visit to the plain of Marathon, the battlefield of Platæa, and his return to Asia Minor, where he traveled along the coast with several Greek colonies. Herodotus must have been only twenty-eight years old when he returned to Halicarnassus in Caria, as he read his travel history at the Olympic Games in B.C. 456. At that time, his homeland was under the rule of Lygdamis, and he was exiled to Samos; however, soon after, he rose in arms to overthrow the tyrant, but the ingratitude of his fellow citizens forced him back into exile. In 444, he participated in the games at the Pantheon, where he presented his completed work, which was met with great enthusiasm, and later in life, he moved to Thurium in Italy, where he died in B.C. 406, leaving behind a reputation as the greatest traveler and most renowned historian of antiquity.
After Herodotus we must pass over a century and a half, and only note, in passing, the Physician Ctesias, a contemporary of Xenophon, who published the account of a voyage to India that he really never made; and we shall come in chronological order to Pytheas, who was at once a traveller, geographer, and historian, one of the most celebrated men of his time. It was about the year B.C. 340 that Pytheas set out from the columns of Hercules with a single vessel, but instead of taking a southerly course like his Carthaginian predecessors, he went northwards, passing by the coasts of Iberia and Gaul to the furthest points which now form the Cape of Finisterre, and then he entered the English Channel and came upon the English coast—the British Isles—of which he was to be the first explorer. He disembarked at various points on the coast and made friends with the simple, honest, sober, industrious inhabitants, who traded largely in tin.
After Herodotus, we need to skip a century and a half and just briefly mention the physician Ctesias, who was a contemporary of Xenophon. He wrote an account of a journey to India that he never actually took. Next in chronological order is Pytheas, who was a traveler, geographer, and historian—one of the most famous figures of his time. Around the year B.C. 340, Pytheas set out from the Pillars of Hercules with just one ship. Instead of heading south like his Carthaginian predecessors, he went north, traveling along the coasts of Iberia and Gaul to the furthest points that now make up the Cape of Finisterre. He then entered the English Channel and arrived at the coast of England—the British Isles—where he became the first explorer. He landed at various points along the coast and befriended the simple, honest, sober, hardworking inhabitants, who engaged heavily in tin trading.
Pytheas ventured still further north, and went beyond the Orcades Islands to the furthest point of Scotland, and he must have reached a very high latitude, for during the summer the night only lasted two hours. After six days further sailing, he came to lands which he calls Thule, probably the Jutland or Norway of the present day, beyond which he could not pass, for he says, "there was neither land, sea, nor air there." He retraced his course, and changing it slightly, he came to the mouth of the Rhine, to the country of the Ostians, and, further inland, to Germany. Thence he visited the mouth of the Tanais, that is supposed to be the Elbe or the Oder, and he retuned to Marseilles, just a year after leaving his native town. Pytheas, besides being such a brave sailor, was a remarkably scientific man: he was the first to discover the influence that the moon exercises on the tides, and to notice that the polar star is not situated at the exact spot at which the axis of the globe is supposed to be. Some years after the time of Pytheas, about B.C. 326 a Greek traveller made his name famous. This was Nearchus, a native of Crete, one of Alexander's admirals, and he was charged to visit all the coast of Asia from the mouth of the Indus to that of the Euphrates. When Alexander first resolved that this expedition should take place, which had for its object the opening up of a communication between India and Egypt, he was at the upper part of the Indus. He furnished Nearchus with a fleet of thirty-three galleys, of some vessels with two decks, and a great number of transport ships, and 2000 men. Nearchus came down the Indus in about four months, escorted on either bank of the river by Alexander's armies, and after spending seven months in exploring the Delta, he set sail and followed the west line of what we call Beloochistan in the present day.
Pytheas traveled even further north, beyond the Orkney Islands to the northernmost point of Scotland, and he must have reached a very high latitude because during the summer, the night only lasted two hours. After another six days of sailing, he arrived at lands he called Thule, likely present-day Jutland or Norway, but he couldn’t go any further because he said, "there was neither land, sea, nor air there." He turned back, slightly changed his route, and arrived at the mouth of the Rhine, in the territory of the Ostians, and then further inland to Germany. From there, he explored the mouth of the Tanais, which is believed to be the Elbe or the Oder, and he returned to Marseilles just a year after leaving his hometown. Besides being a brave sailor, Pytheas was a very scientific man: he was the first to discover how the moon affects the tides and to observe that the North Star isn’t located exactly where the earth’s axis is supposed to be. Some years after Pytheas, around B.C. 326, a Greek traveler gained fame. This was Nearchus, a native of Crete and one of Alexander's admirals, who was tasked with exploring the entire coast of Asia from the mouth of the Indus to the Euphrates. When Alexander first decided to launch this mission to create a route between India and Egypt, he was in the upper region of the Indus. He provided Nearchus with a fleet of thirty-three galleys, some with two decks, many transport ships, and 2000 men. Nearchus traveled down the Indus in about four months, accompanied on both sides of the river by Alexander's armies, and after spending seven months exploring the Delta, he set sail and followed the western coastline of what we now call Beloochistan.
He put to sea on the second of October, a month before the winter storms had taken a direction that was favourable to his purpose, so that the commencement of his voyage was disastrous, and in forty days he had scarcely made eighty miles in a westerly direction. He touched first at Stura and at Corestis, which do not seem to answer to any of the now-existing villages on the coast; then at the Island of Crocala, which forms the bay of Caranthia. Beaten back by contrary winds, after doubling the cape of Monze, the fleet took refuge in a natural harbour that its commander thought that he could fortify as a defence against the attacks of the barbarous natives, who, even at the present day, keep up their character as pirates.
He set sail on October 2nd, a month before the winter storms turned favorable for his mission, so the start of his journey was disastrous. In forty days, he barely made eighty miles westward. He first stopped at Stura and Corestis, which don’t seem to match any of the villages that exist on the coast today; then he visited the Island of Crocala, which is part of the bay of Caranthia. Driven back by opposing winds, after rounding the cape of Monze, the fleet sought shelter in a natural harbor that its leader believed he could strengthen to defend against attacks from the local tribes, who still maintain their reputation as pirates.
After spending twenty-four days in this harbour, Nearchus put to sea again on the 3rd of November. Severe gales often obliged him to keep very near the coast, and when this was the case he was obliged to take all possible precautions to defend himself from the attacks of the ferocious Beloochees, who are described by eastern historians "as a barbarous nation, with long dishevelled hair, and long flowing beards, who are more like bears or satyrs than human beings." Up to this time, however, no serious disaster had happened to the fleet, but on the 10th of November in a heavy gale two galleys and a ship sank. Nearchus then anchored at Crocala, and there he was met by a ship laden with corn that Alexander had sent out to him, and he was able to supply each vessel with provisions for ten days.
After spending twenty-four days in this harbor, Nearchus set sail again on November 3rd. Severe storms often forced him to stay close to the coast, and when that happened, he had to take every possible precaution to protect himself from attacks by the fierce Beloochees, who eastern historians describe as "a barbarous nation, with long tangled hair and long flowing beards, who resemble bears or satyrs more than humans." Up to that point, however, no serious disaster had occurred to the fleet, but on November 10th, during a heavy storm, two galleys and a ship sank. Nearchus then anchored at Crocala, where he was met by a ship loaded with grain that Alexander had sent to him, allowing him to supply each vessel with provisions for ten days.
After many disasters and a skirmish with some of the natives, Nearchus reached the extreme point of the land of the Orites, which is marked in modern geography by Cape Morant. Here, he states in his narrative that the rays of the sun at mid-day are vertical, and therefore there are no shadows of any kind; but this is surely a mistake, for at this time in the Southern hemisphere the sun is in the Tropic of Capricorn; and, beyond this, his vessels were always some degrees distant from the Tropic of Cancer, therefore even in the height of summer this phenomenon could not have taken place, and we know that his voyage was in winter.
After many disasters and a conflict with some of the locals, Nearchus reached the farthest point of the land of the Orites, which is now known as Cape Morant. In his account, he mentions that at noon the sun is directly overhead, so there are no shadows at all; however, this is likely a mistake, because at that time in the Southern Hemisphere, the sun is at the Tropic of Capricorn. Additionally, his ships were always a few degrees away from the Tropic of Cancer, so even in the peak of summer, this situation couldn't have occurred, and we know that his journey took place in winter.
Circumstances seemed now rather more in his favour; for the time of the eastern monsoon was over, when he sailed along the coast which is inhabited by a tribe called Ichthyophagi, who subsist solely on fish, and from the failure of all vegetation are obliged to feed even their sheep upon the same food. The fleet was now becoming very short of provisions; so after doubling Cape Posmi Nearchus took a pilot from those shores on board his own vessel, and with the wind in their favour they made rapid progress, finding the country less bare as they advanced, a few scattered trees and shrubs being visible from the shore. They reached a little town, of the name of which we have no record, and as they were almost without food Nearchus surprised and took possession of it, the inhabitants making but little resistance. Canasida, or Churbar as we call it, was their next resting-place, and at the present day the ruins of a town are still visible in the bay. But their corn was now entirely exhausted, and though they tried successively at Canate, Trois, and Dagasira for further supplies, it was all in vain, these miserable little towns not being able to furnish more than enough for their own consumption. The fleet had neither corn nor meat, and they could not make up their minds to feed upon the tortoises that abound in that part of the coast.
Circumstances now seemed more favorable for him; the eastern monsoon was over as he sailed along the coast inhabited by a tribe called the Ichthyophagi, who lived solely on fish, and due to the lack of vegetation, even had to feed their sheep the same diet. The fleet was running very low on supplies, so after rounding Cape Posmi, Nearchus took a local pilot on board his ship, and with favorable winds, they made quick progress, noticing the land becoming less barren as they advanced, with a few scattered trees and shrubs visible from the shore. They arrived at a small town, the name of which is not recorded, and since they were almost out of food, Nearchus surprised and captured it, as the inhabitants offered little resistance. Canasida, or Churbar as we refer to it, was their next stop, and today, the ruins of a town are still visible in the bay. However, their grain supply was completely depleted, and although they tried at Canate, Trois, and Dagasira for more supplies, it was all in vain since these small towns could only provide for their own needs. The fleet had neither grain nor meat, and they couldn't bring themselves to eat the tortoises that were abundant along that part of the coast.
Just as they entered the Persian Gulf they encountered an immense number of whales, and the sailors were so terrified by their size and number, that they wished to fly; it was not without much difficulty that Nearchus at last prevailed upon them to advance boldly, and they soon scattered their formidable enemies.
Just as they entered the Persian Gulf, they came across a huge number of whales, and the sailors were so scared by their size and the sheer amount of them that they wanted to escape. It took a lot of effort for Nearchus to finally convince them to move forward bravely, and soon they drove away their intimidating foes.
![]() |
Nearchus leading on his followers against the monsters of the deep. |
Having changed their westerly course for a north-easterly one, they soon came upon fertile shores, and their eyes were refreshed by the sight of corn-fields and pasture-lands, interspersed with all kinds of fruit-trees except the olive. They put into Badis or Jask, and after leaving it and passing Maceta or Mussendon, they came in sight of the Persian Gulf, to which Nearchus, following the geography of the Arabs, gave the misnomer of the Red Sea.
Having changed their westerly course to a north-easterly one, they soon reached fertile shores, and their eyes were refreshed by the sight of cornfields and pastures, dotted with all kinds of fruit trees except the olive. They stopped at Badis or Jask, and after leaving there and passing Maceta or Mussendon, they finally saw the Persian Gulf, which Nearchus mistakenly called the Red Sea, based on Arab geography.
They sailed up the gulf, and after one halt reached Harmozia, which has since given its name to the little island of Ormuz. There he learnt that Alexander's army was only five days' march from him, and he disembarked at once, and hastened to meet it. No news of the fleet having reached the army for twenty-one weeks, they had given up all hope of seeing it again, and great was Alexander's joy when Nearchus appeared before him, though the hardships he had endured had altered him almost beyond recognition. Alexander ordered games to be celebrated and sacrifices offered up to the gods; then Nearchus returned to Harmozia, as he wished to go as far as Susa with the fleet, and set sail again, having invoked Jupiter the Deliverer.
They sailed up the gulf, and after one stop, they reached Harmozia, which later named the small island of Ormuz. There, he learned that Alexander's army was just five days' march away, so he got off the ship immediately and rushed to meet them. With no news from the fleet for twenty-one weeks, the army had lost all hope of seeing it again, and Alexander was overjoyed when Nearchus finally showed up, even though the hardships he had faced had almost changed him beyond recognition. Alexander ordered games to be held and sacrifices to be offered to the gods; then Nearchus went back to Harmozia, as he wanted to continue to Susa with the fleet, and set sail again after praying to Jupiter the Deliverer.
He touched at some of the neighbouring islands, probably those of Arek and Kismis, and soon afterwards the vessels ran aground, but the advancing tide floated them again, and after passing Bestion, they arrived at the island of Keish, that is sacred to Mercury and Venus. This was the boundary-line between Karmania and Persia. As they advanced along the Persian coast, they visited different places, Gillam, Indarabia, Shevou, &c., and at the last-named was found a quantity of wheat which Alexander had sent for the use of the explorers.
He stopped at some nearby islands, probably those of Arek and Kismis, and soon after, the ships ran aground. However, the rising tide lifted them back up, and after passing Bestion, they reached the island of Keish, which is dedicated to Mercury and Venus. This was the border between Karmania and Persia. As they traveled along the Persian coast, they explored various locations, including Gillam, Indarabia, Shevou, etc., and at the last-mentioned place, they discovered a large supply of wheat that Alexander had sent for the use of the explorers.
Some days after this they came to the mouth of the river Araxes, that separates Persia from Susiana, and thence they reached a large lake situated in the country now called Dorghestan, and finally anchored near the village of Degela, at the source of the Euphrates, having accomplished their project of visiting all the coast lying between the Euphrates and Indus. Nearchus returned a second time to Alexander, who rewarded him magnificently, and placed him in command of his fleet. Alexander's wish, that the whole of the Arabian coast should be explored as far as the Red Sea, was never fulfilled, as he died before the expedition was arranged.
Some days later, they arrived at the mouth of the Araxes River, which separates Persia from Susiana. From there, they reached a large lake in what is now called Dorghestan and finally anchored near the village of Degela, at the source of the Euphrates, having achieved their goal of exploring all the coast between the Euphrates and the Indus. Nearchus returned to Alexander once again, who rewarded him generously and put him in charge of his fleet. Alexander's desire to explore the entire Arabian coast all the way to the Red Sea was never realized, as he died before the expedition could be organized.
It is said that Nearchus became governor of Lysia and Pamphylia, but in his leisure time he wrote an account of his travels, which has unfortunately perished, though not before Arian had made a complete analysis of it in his Historia Indica. It seems probable that Nearchus fell in the battle of Ipsu, leaving behind him the reputation of being a very able commander; his voyage may be looked upon as an event of no small importance in the history of navigation.
It’s said that Nearchus became the governor of Lysia and Pamphylia, but during his free time, he wrote about his travels, which has sadly been lost, although Arian did provide a full analysis of it in his Historia Indica. It’s likely that Nearchus died in the battle of Ipsus, leaving a legacy as a highly skilled commander; his journey can be seen as a significant event in the history of navigation.
We must not omit to mention a most hazardous attempt made in B.C. 146, by Eudoxus of Cyzicus, a geographer living at the court of Euergetes II, to sail round Africa. He had visited Egypt and the coast of India, when this far greater project occurred to him, one which was only accomplished sixteen hundred years later by Vasco da Gama. Eudoxus fitted out a large vessel and two smaller ones, and set sail upon the unknown waters of the Atlantic. How far he took these vessels we do not know, but after having had communication with some natives, whom he thought were Ethiopians, he returned to Mauritania. Thence he went to Tiberia, and made preparations for another attempt to circumnavigate Africa, but whether he ever set out upon this voyage is not known; in fact some learned men are even inclined to consider Eudoxus an impostor.
We should definitely mention a very risky attempt made in B.C. 146 by Eudoxus of Cyzicus, a geographer at the court of Euergetes II, to sail around Africa. He had been to Egypt and the coast of India when this much bigger project came to his mind—one that wasn’t achieved until sixteen hundred years later by Vasco da Gama. Eudoxus outfitted a large ship and two smaller ones and set sail into the uncharted waters of the Atlantic. We don’t know how far he traveled with these vessels, but after interacting with some locals he thought were Ethiopians, he returned to Mauritania. From there, he went to Tiberia and made plans for another attempt to circumnavigate Africa, but it’s unclear if he ever actually set out on that journey; in fact, some scholars even think Eudoxus might have been a fraud.
We have still to mention two names of illustrious travellers, living before the Christian era; those of Cæsar and Strabo. Cæsar, born B.C. 100, was pre-eminently a conqueror, not an explorer, but we must remember, that in the year B.C. 58, he undertook the conquest of Gaul, and during the ten years that were occupied in this vast enterprise, he led his victorious Legions to the shores of Great Britain, where the inhabitants were of German extraction.
We still need to mention two famous travelers who lived before the Christian era: Caesar and Strabo. Caesar, born B.C. 100, was primarily a conqueror, not an explorer. However, it's important to note that in the year B.C. 58, he began the conquest of Gaul, and during the ten years spent on this massive project, he led his victorious legions to the shores of Great Britain, where the inhabitants were of German descent.
As to Strabo, who was born in Cappadocia B.C. 50, he distinguished himself more as a geographer than a traveller, but he travelled through the interior of Asia, and visited Egypt, Greece, and Italy, living many years in Rome, and dying there in the latter part of the reign of Tiberius. Strabo wrote a Geography in seventeen Books, of which the greater part has come down to us, and this work, with that of Ptolemy, are the two most valuable legacies of ancient to modern Geographers.
As for Strabo, who was born in Cappadocia around 50 B.C., he is known more as a geographer than as a traveler. However, he journeyed throughout Asia and visited Egypt, Greece, and Italy, spending many years in Rome before dying there during the later part of Tiberius's reign. Strabo wrote a Geography in seventeen books, most of which have survived, and this work, along with Ptolemy's, is one of the two most significant legacies from ancient to modern geographers.
CHAPTER II.
PAUSANIAS, 174; FA-HIAN, 399; COSMOS INDICOPLEUSTES, 500;
ARCULPHE, 700; WILLIBALD, 725; SOLEYMAN, 851.
Pliny, Hippalus, Arian, and Ptolemy—Pausanias visits Attica, Corinth, Laconia, Messenia, Elis, Achaia, Arcadia, Boeotia, and Phocis—Fa-Hian explores Kan-tcheou, Tartary, Northern India, the Punjaub, Ceylon, and Java—Cosmos Indicopleustes, and the Christian Topography of the Universe—Arculphe describes Jerusalem, the valley of Jehoshaphat, the Mount of Olives, Bethlehem, Jericho, the river Jordan, Libanus, the Dead Sea, Capernaum, Nazareth, Mount Tabor, Damascus, Tyre, Alexandria, and Constantinople—Willibald and the Holy Land—Soleyman travels through Ceylon, and Sumatra, and crosses the Gulf of Siam and the China Sea.
Pliny, Hippalus, Arian, and Ptolemy—Pausanias visits Attica, Corinth, Laconia, Messenia, Elis, Achaia, Arcadia, Boeotia, and Phocis—Fa-Hian explores Kan-tcheou, Tartary, Northern India, Punjab, Ceylon, and Java—Cosmos Indicopleustes, and the Christian Topography of the Universe—Arculphe describes Jerusalem, the valley of Jehoshaphat, the Mount of Olives, Bethlehem, Jericho, the Jordan River, Lebanon, the Dead Sea, Capernaum, Nazareth, Mount Tabor, Damascus, Tyre, Alexandria, and Constantinople—Willibald and the Holy Land—Soleyman travels through Ceylon and Sumatra, and crosses the Gulf of Siam and the China Sea.
In the first two centuries of the Christian era, the study of geography received a great stimulus from the advance of other branches of science, but travellers, or rather explorers of new countries were very few in number. Pliny in the year A.D. 23, devoted the third, fourth, fifth, and sixth books of his Natural History to geography, and in A.D. 50, Hippalus, a clever navigator, discovered the laws governing the monsoon in the Indian Ocean, and taught sailors how they might deviate from their usual course, so as to make these winds subservient to their being able to go to and return from India in one year. Arian, a Greek historian, born A.D. 105, wrote an account of the navigation of the Euxine or Black Sea, and pointed out as nearly as possible, the countries that had been discovered by explorers who had lived before his time; and Ptolemy the Egyptian, about A.D. 175, making use of the writings of his predecessors, published a celebrated geography, in which, for the first time, places and cities were marked in their relative latitude and longitude on a mathematical plan.
In the first two centuries of the Christian era, the study of geography was significantly boosted by advancements in other scientific fields, but there were very few travelers, or rather explorers, of new lands. Pliny, in the year A.D. 23, dedicated the third, fourth, fifth, and sixth books of his Natural History to geography. Then in A.D. 50, Hippalus, a skilled navigator, discovered the patterns of the monsoon in the Indian Ocean and taught sailors how they could adjust their routes to use these winds, allowing them to travel to and from India in a single year. Arian, a Greek historian born in A.D. 105, wrote a description of the navigation of the Euxine or Black Sea and identified as closely as possible the countries that had been discovered by earlier explorers. Ptolemy the Egyptian, around A.D. 175, utilized the works of his predecessors to publish a renowned geography that, for the first time, accurately plotted places and cities based on their relative latitude and longitude on a mathematical grid.
The first traveller of the Christian era, whose name has been handed down to us, was Pausanias, a Greek writer, living in Rome in the second century, and whose account of his travels bears the date of A.D. 175. Pausanias did for ancient Greece what Joanne, the industrious and clever Frenchman did for the other countries of Europe, in compiling the "Traveller's Guide." His account, a most reliable one on all points, and most exact even in details, was one upon which travellers of the second century might safely depend in their journeys through the different parts of Greece.
The first traveler of the Christian era whose name we still know was Pausanias, a Greek writer who lived in Rome during the second century, and his travel account is dated A.D. 175. Pausanias provided ancient Greece with the same thoroughness and insight that Joanne, the resourceful and sharp Frenchman, offered for other European countries in his "Traveller's Guide." His account is extremely reliable on all aspects, and very precise even in details, making it a trusted resource for travelers in the second century exploring various regions of Greece.
Pausanias gives a minute description of Attica, and especially of Athens and its monuments, tombs, temples, citadel, academy, columns, and of the Areopagus.
Pausanias provides a detailed description of Attica, particularly focusing on Athens and its monuments, tombs, temples, citadel, academy, columns, and the Areopagus.
From Attica Pausanias went to Corinth, and then explored the Islands of Ægina and Methana, Sparta, the Island of Cerigo, Messene, Achaia, Arcadia, Boeotia, and Phocis. The roads in the provinces and even the streets in the towns, are mentioned in his narrative, as well as the general character of the country through which he passed; although we can scarcely say that he added any fresh discoveries to those already made, he was one of those careful travellers whose object was more to obtain exact information, than to make new discoveries. His narrative has been of the greatest use to all geographers and writers upon Greece and the Peloponnesus, and an author of the sixteenth century has truly said that this book is "a most ancient and rare specimen of erudition."
From Attica, Pausanias traveled to Corinth, then explored the islands of Aegina and Methana, Sparta, the island of Cerigo, Messene, Achaia, Arcadia, Boeotia, and Phocis. He detailed the roads in the provinces and even the streets in the towns, along with the overall character of the regions he visited. Although we can hardly claim that he made any new discoveries, he was one of those diligent travelers whose goal was more to gather accurate information than to find new things. His accounts have been incredibly valuable to all geographers and writers on Greece and the Peloponnesus, and a sixteenth-century author rightly noted that this book is "a most ancient and rare specimen of erudition."
![]() |
It was about a hundred and thirty years after the Greek historian, in the fourth century, that a Chinese monk undertook the exploration of the countries lying to the west of China. The account of his travels is still extant, and we may well agree with M. Charton when he says that "this is a most valuable work, carrying us beyond our ordinarily narrow view of western civilization."
It was about one hundred thirty years after the Greek historian, in the fourth century, that a Chinese monk explored the countries west of China. His travel account still exists, and we can definitely agree with M. Charton when he says that "this is a highly valuable work, expanding our usually limited perspective on western civilization."
Fa-Hian, the traveller, was accompanied by several monks; wishing to leave China by the west, they crossed more than one chain of mountains, and reached the country now called Kan-tcheou, which is not far from the great wall. They crossed the river Cha-ho, and a desert that Marco Polo was to explore eight hundred years later. After seventeen days' march they reached the Lake of Lobnor in Turkestan. From this point all the countries that the monks visited were alike as to manners and customs, the languages alone differing. Being dissatisfied with the reception that they met with in the country of the Ourgas, who are not a hospitable people, they took a south-easterly course towards a desert country, where they had great difficulty in crossing the rivers; and, after a thirty-five days' march, the little caravan reached Tartary in the kingdom of Khotan, which contained, according to Fa-Hian, "Many times ten thousand holy men." Here they met with a cordial welcome, and after a residence of three months were allowed to assist at the "Procession of the Images," a great feast, in which both Brahmins and Buddhists join, when all the idols are placed upon magnificently decorated cars, and paraded through streets strewn with flowers, amid clouds of incense.
Fa-Hian, the traveler, was accompanied by several monks. They wanted to leave China from the west, so they crossed several mountain ranges and reached the area now known as Kan-tcheou, not far from the Great Wall. They crossed the Cha-ho River and a desert that Marco Polo would explore eight hundred years later. After a seventeen-day journey, they arrived at Lake Lobnor in Turkestan. From there, all the countries the monks visited shared similar customs and manners, with only the languages differing. Disappointed by their reception in the land of the Ourgas, who were not very welcoming, they headed southeast toward a desert region, where they faced great challenges crossing the rivers. After a thirty-five-day trek, the small caravan finally reached Tartary in the kingdom of Khotan, which Fa-Hian noted had “many tens of thousands of holy men.” Here, they received a warm welcome, and after staying for three months, they were allowed to take part in the "Procession of the Images," a grand festival that brought together both Brahmins and Buddhists. During this event, all the idols were placed on beautifully decorated carts and paraded through streets covered in flowers and filled with incense.
The feast over, the monks left Khotan for Koukonyar, and after resting there fifteen days, we find them further south in the Balistan country of the present day, a cold and mountainous district, where wheat was the only grain cultivated, and where Fa-Hian found in use the curious cylinders on which prayers are written, and which are turned by the faithful with the most extraordinary rapidity. Thence they went to the eastern part of Afghanistan; it took them four weeks to cross the mountains, in the midst of which, and the never-melting snow they are said to have found venomous dragons.
After the feast, the monks left Khotan for Koukonyar, and after resting there for fifteen days, we find them further south in the present-day Balistan region, which is cold and mountainous. The only grain grown there was wheat, and Fa-Hian discovered the interesting cylinders used to write prayers, which the faithful turn with remarkable speed. From there, they traveled to the eastern part of Afghanistan; it took them four weeks to cross the mountains, where they reportedly encountered venomous dragons amid the never-melting snow.
On the further side of this rocky chain the travellers found themselves in Northern India, where the country is watered by the streams which, further on, form the Sinde or Indus. After traversing the kingdoms of On-tchang, Su-ho-to, and Kian-tho-wei, they arrived at Fo-loo-cha, which must be the town of Peshawur, standing between Cabul and the Indus, and twenty-four leagues farther west, they came to the town of Hilo, built on the banks of a tributary of the river Kabout. In these towns Fa-Hian specially notices the feasts and religious ceremonies practised in the worship of Fo or Buddha.
On the other side of this rocky range, the travelers found themselves in Northern India, where the land is fed by the streams that eventually form the Sinde or Indus. After traveling through the kingdoms of On-tchang, Su-ho-to, and Kian-tho-wei, they reached Fo-loo-cha, which is likely the town of Peshawur, located between Cabul and the Indus. Twenty-four leagues further west, they arrived at the town of Hilo, which is built along the banks of a tributary of the Kabout River. In these towns, Fa-Hian specifically points out the festivals and religious ceremonies held in honor of Fo or Buddha.
![]() |
One of Fa-Hian's companions falls. |
When the monks left Kito, they were obliged to cross the Hindoo-Koosh mountains, lying between Turkestan and the Gandhara, the cold being so intense that one of their party sank under it. After enduring great hardships they reached Banoo, a town that is still standing, and then, after again crossing the Indus, they entered the Punjaub. Thence, descending towards the south-east, with a view of crossing the northern part of the Indian Peninsula, they reached Mathura, a town in the province of Agra, and crossing the great salt desert which lies to the east of the Indus, travelled through a country that Fa-Hian calls "a happy kingdom, where the inhabitants are good and honest, needing neither laws nor magistrates, and indebted to none for their support; without markets or wine merchants, and living happily, with plenty of all that they required, where the temperature was neither hot nor cold." This happy kingdom was India. Fa-Hian followed a south-easterly route, and came to Feroukh-abad, where Buddha is said to have alighted as he came down from heaven, the Chinese traveller dwelling much upon the Buddhist Creed. Thence he visited the town of Kanoji, standing on the right bank of the Ganges, that he calls Heng, and this is the very centre of Buddhism. Wherever Buddha is supposed to have rested, his followers have erected high towers in his honour. The travellers visited the temple of Tchihouan, where for twenty-five years Fo practised the most severe mortifications, and where he is said to have given sight to five hundred blind men. They are said to have been much moved by the sight of this temple.
When the monks left Kito, they had to cross the Hindu Kush mountains, which lie between Turkestan and Gandhara. The cold was so severe that one of their group couldn't handle it. After facing many difficulties, they arrived in Banoo, a town that still exists today. They then crossed the Indus River again and entered the Punjab. From there, traveling southeast to cross the northern part of the Indian Peninsula, they reached Mathura, a town in the Agra province. After crossing the vast salt desert east of the Indus, they traveled through a region that Fa-Hian describes as "a happy kingdom, where the people are good and honest, needing neither laws nor magistrates, and not relying on anyone for their livelihood; without markets or wine merchants, and living joyfully with all they needed, where the climate was neither too hot nor too cold." This happy kingdom was India. Fa-Hian took a southeast route and arrived in Feroukh-abad, where Buddha is said to have descended from heaven, with the Chinese traveler emphasizing the Buddhist teachings. From there, he visited the town of Kanoji, located on the right bank of the Ganges, which he referred to as Heng; this is the very heart of Buddhism. Wherever Buddha is believed to have rested, his followers built tall towers in his honor. The travelers visited the temple of Tchihouan, where for twenty-five years Buddha practiced severe self-discipline, and where he is said to have restored sight to five hundred blind men. They were deeply moved by the sight of this temple.
They set out again, passing Kapila and Goruckpoor, on the frontier of Nepaul, all made famous by Fo's miracles, and then reached the celebrated town of Palian-foo, in the delta of the Ganges, in the kingdom of Magadha. This was a fertile tract of country inhabited by a civilized, upright people, who loved all philosophic researches. After climbing the peak of Vautour, which stands at the source of the Dyardanes and Banourah rivers, Fa-Hian descended the Ganges, visited the temple of Issi-paten that was frequented by magicians and astrologers, reached Benares, "the kingdom of splendours," and a little lower down, the town of Tomo-li-ti, situated at the mouth of the river, a short distance from the site of Calcutta in the present day.
They set out again, passing Kapila and Goruckpoor, located on the border of Nepal, all made famous by Fo's miracles, and then reached the well-known town of Palian-foo, in the delta of the Ganges, in the kingdom of Magadha. This was a fertile area inhabited by a civilized, trustworthy people who loved all philosophical inquiries. After climbing the peak of Vautour, which stands at the source of the Dyardanes and Banourah rivers, Fa-Hian descended the Ganges, visited the temple of Issi-paten that was frequented by magicians and astrologers, reached Benares, "the kingdom of splendors," and a little further down, the town of Tomo-li-ti, located at the mouth of the river, not far from the site of present-day Calcutta.
Fa-Hian found a party of merchants just preparing to put to sea with the intention of going to Ceylon; he sailed with them, and in fourteen days landed on the shores of the ancient Taprobana, of which the Greek merchant, Jamboulos, had given a curious account some centuries previously. Here the Chinese monk found all the traditions and legends regarding the god Fo, and passed two years in searching ancient manuscripts. He left Ceylon for Java, where he landed after a very rough voyage, in the course of which, when the sky was overclouded, he says, "we saw nothing but great waves dashing one against another, lightning, crocodiles, tortoises, and monsters of the deep."
Fa-Hian discovered a group of merchants just getting ready to set sail for Ceylon; he joined them, and after fourteen days, he arrived on the shores of the ancient Taprobana, which the Greek merchant, Jamboulos, had described in an intriguing account centuries before. Here, the Chinese monk encountered all the traditions and legends about the god Fo and spent two years searching for ancient manuscripts. He left Ceylon for Java, where he arrived after a very turbulent journey, during which, when the sky was cloudy, he reported, "we saw nothing but huge waves crashing against each other, lightning, crocodiles, turtles, and monsters of the deep."
He spent five months in Java, and then set sail for Canton; but the winds were again unfavourable, and after undergoing great hardships he landed at the town of Chantoung of the present day; then having spent some time at Nankin he returned to Fi-an-foo, his native town, after an absence of eighteen months. Such is the account of Fa-Hian's travels, which have been well translated by M. Abel de Rémusat, and which give very interesting details of Indian and Tartar customs, especially those relating to their religious ceremonies.
He spent five months in Java and then set sail for Canton; however, the winds were once again unfavorable, and after enduring great hardships, he landed in what is now the town of Chantoung. After spending some time in Nankin, he returned to Fi-an-foo, his hometown, after being away for eighteen months. This is the account of Fa-Hian's travels, which have been well translated by M. Abel de Rémusat, providing very interesting details about Indian and Tartar customs, especially regarding their religious ceremonies.
The next traveller to the Chinese monk, in chronological order, is an Egyptian called Cosmos Indicopleustes, a name that M. Charton renders as "Cosmographic traveller in India." He lived in the sixth century, and was a merchant of Alexandria, who, on his return from visiting Ethiopia and part of Asia, entered a monastery.
The next traveler to the Chinese monk, in chronological order, is an Egyptian named Cosmos Indicopleustes, which M. Charton translates as "Cosmographic traveler in India." He lived in the sixth century and was a merchant from Alexandria. After visiting Ethiopia and parts of Asia, he entered a monastery on his way back.
His narrative is called the "Christian Topography of the Universe." It gives no details of its author's voyages, but begins with cosmographic discussions, to prove that the world is square, and enclosed in a great oblong coffer with all the other planets. This is followed by some dissertations on the function of the angels, and a description of the dress of the Jewish Priests. Cosmos also gives the natural history of the animals of India and Ceylon, and notices the rhinoceros and buffalo, which can be made of use for domestic purposes, the giraffe, the wild ox, the musk that is hunted for its "perfumed blood," the unicorn, which he considers a real animal and not a myth, the wild boar, the hippopotamus, the phoca, the dolphin, and the tortoise. Afterwards, Cosmos describes the pepper-plant, as a frail and delicate shrub, like the smallest tendrils of the vine, and the cocoa-tree, whose fruit has a fragrance "equal to that of a nut."
His narrative is called the "Christian Topography of the Universe." It doesn't provide details about the author's travels but starts with discussions about the universe to argue that the world is square and contained in a large rectangular box along with all the other planets. This is followed by some essays on the role of angels and a description of the attire of the Jewish priests. Cosmos also covers the natural history of animals from India and Ceylon, mentioning the rhinoceros and buffalo, which can be used for domestic purposes, the giraffe, the wild ox, the musk that is hunted for its "fragrant blood," the unicorn, which he believes is a real creature and not just a myth, the wild boar, the hippopotamus, the seal, the dolphin, and the turtle. Next, Cosmos describes the pepper plant as a delicate shrub, similar to the smallest tendrils of the vine, and the cocoa tree, whose fruit has a scent "similar to that of a nut."
From the earliest times of the Christian era there has been a great love for visiting the Holy Land, the cradle of the new religion. These pilgrimages became more and more frequent, and we have many names left to us of those who visited Palestine during the first centuries of Christianity.
From the earliest days of the Christian era, there has been a strong desire to visit the Holy Land, the birthplace of the new faith. These pilgrimages became increasingly common, and we have many names of those who traveled to Palestine during the first centuries of Christianity.
One of these pilgrims, the French Bishop Arculphe, who lived towards the end of the seventh century, has left us an account of his travels.
One of these pilgrims, the French Bishop Arculphe, who lived near the end of the seventh century, has given us a record of his travels.
He sets out by giving a topographical description of the site of Jerusalem, and describes the wall that surrounds the holy city, then the circular church built over the Holy Sepulchre, the tomb of our Lord Jesus Christ, and the stone that closed it, the church dedicated to the Virgin Mary, the church built upon Calvary, and the basilica of Constantine on the site of the place where the real cross was found. These various churches are united in one building, which also encloses the Tomb of Christ, and Calvary, where our Lord was crucified.
He starts by providing a description of Jerusalem's landscape, detailing the wall that encircles the holy city. Then he talks about the round church constructed over the Holy Sepulchre, which is the tomb of Jesus Christ, as well as the stone that sealed it. He mentions the church dedicated to the Virgin Mary, the church built on Calvary, and Constantine's basilica at the location where the true cross was discovered. These different churches come together in one structure, which also surrounds Christ's Tomb and Calvary, the site of our Lord's crucifixion.
Arculphe then descended into the Valley of Jehoshaphat, which is situated to the east of the city, and contains the church that covers the tomb of the Virgin; he also saw that of Absalom, which he calls the Tower of Jehoshaphat. He describes the Mount of Olives that faces the city beyond the valley, and he prayed in the cave where Jesus prayed. He also went to Mount Zion, which stands outside the town on the south side; he notices the gigantic fig-tree, on which, according to tradition, Judas Iscariot hanged himself, and he visited the church of the guest-chamber, now destroyed.
Arculphe then went down into the Valley of Jehoshaphat, located to the east of the city, where the church is built over the tomb of the Virgin. He also saw the tomb of Absalom, which he refers to as the Tower of Jehoshaphat. He describes the Mount of Olives that overlooks the city across the valley and prayed in the cave where Jesus prayed. He also visited Mount Zion, which is outside the town on the south side; he noticed the huge fig tree where, according to tradition, Judas Iscariot hanged himself, and he explored the church of the guest-chamber, which is now destroyed.
![]() |
Absalom's Tomb. |
After making the tour of the city by the Valley of Siloam, and ascending by the brook Cedron, the bishop returned to the Mount of Olives, which was covered with waving wheat and barley, grass and wild flowers, and he describes the place where Christ ascended from the summit of the mountain. On this spot a large church has been built, with three arched porticoes that are not roofed over or covered in any way, but are open to the sky. "They have not roofed in this church," says the bishop, "because it was the place whence our Saviour ascended upon a cloud, and the space open to heaven allows the prayers of the faithful to ascend thither. For when they paved this church they could not lay the pavement over the place where our Lord's feet had rested, as, when the stones were laid upon that spot, the earth, as though impatient of anything not divine resting upon it, threw them up again before the workmen. Beyond this, the dust bears the impress of the divine feet, and though, day by day, the faithful who visit the spot efface the marks, they immediately reappear and may be seen perpetually."
After touring the city via the Valley of Siloam and climbing up by the Cedron brook, the bishop returned to the Mount of Olives, which was filled with swaying wheat and barley, grass, and wildflowers. He describes the site where Christ ascended from the top of the mountain. A large church has been built there, featuring three arched porticoes that are open to the sky, without any roof. "They haven't roofed this church," the bishop says, "because it is the place from which our Savior ascended on a cloud, and the open space to heaven lets the prayers of the faithful rise up. When they paved this church, they couldn't cover the spot where our Lord's feet rested. Whenever stones were laid on that spot, the ground, as if resisting anything unholy resting on it, pushed them up again before the workers could finish. Additionally, the dust retains the impressions of the divine feet, and though the marks get erased daily by the faithful visiting the site, they quickly reappear and can be seen continuously."
After having explored the neighbourhood of Bethany in the midst of the grove of olives, where the grave of Lazarus is said to be, and where the church, standing on the right hand is supposed to mark the spot where our Lord usually conversed with His disciples, Arculphe went to Bethlehem, which is a short distance from the holy city. He describes the birthplace of our Lord, a natural cave, hollowed out of the rock at the eastern end of the village, the church, built by St. Helena, the tombs of the three shepherds, upon whom the heavenly light shone at the birth of our Saviour, the burial-places of the patriarchs, Abraham, Isaac, and Jacob, and that of Rachel, and he visited the oak of Mamre, under which Abraham received the visit of the angels. Thence, Arculphe went to Jericho, or rather the place where the town once stood, whose walls fell at the sound of Joshua's trumpets. He explored the place where the children of Israel first rested in the land of Canaan after crossing the river Jordan, and he speaks of the church of Galgala, where the twelve stones are placed, which the children of Israel took from the river when they entered the promised land. He followed the course of the Jordan, and found near one of the bends of the river on the right bank, and among the most beautiful scenery, about an hour's walk from the Dead Sea, the place where our Lord was baptized by St. John the Baptist. A cross is placed to mark the spot, but when the river is swollen, it is covered by the water.
After exploring the neighborhood of Bethany in the midst of the olive grove, where Lazarus is said to be buried, and where the church on the right is believed to mark the spot where our Lord typically talked with His disciples, Arculphe went to Bethlehem, which is not far from the holy city. He describes the birthplace of our Lord, a natural cave carved into the rock at the eastern edge of the village, the church built by St. Helena, the tombs of the three shepherds who saw the heavenly light at the birth of our Savior, and the burial sites of the patriarchs, Abraham, Isaac, and Jacob, as well as Rachel. He also visited the oak of Mamre, under which Abraham welcomed the angels. From there, Arculphe went to Jericho, or more accurately, the site where the town once stood, whose walls fell at the sound of Joshua's trumpets. He checked out the place where the Israelites first rested in the land of Canaan after crossing the Jordan River and mentioned the church of Galgala, where the twelve stones were placed, which the Israelites took from the river when they entered the promised land. He followed the Jordan River and found the spot where our Lord was baptized by St. John the Baptist, located near one of the bends of the river on the right bank, amidst beautiful scenery, about an hour's walk from the Dead Sea. A cross marks the spot, but when the river swells, it gets submerged by water.
After examining the banks of the Dead Sea and tasting its brackish water, he viewed the source of the Jordan, at the foot of Libanus, and explored the greater part of the Lake of Tiberias, visiting the well where the woman of Samaria gave our Lord the water He so much needed, seeing the fountain in the desert of which St. John the Baptist drank, and the great plain of Gaza, where our Lord blessed the five loaves and two fishes, and fed the multitude. Next he went down to Capernaum, of which there are now no remains; then visited Nazareth, where our Lord spent His childhood, and ended his journey at Mount Tabor in Galilee.
After checking out the shores of the Dead Sea and tasting its salty water, he looked at the source of the Jordan River, at the base of Mount Lebanon, and explored most of the Lake of Tiberias. He visited the well where the Samaritan woman gave our Lord the water He desperately needed, saw the spring in the desert where St. John the Baptist drank, and the large plain of Gaza, where our Lord blessed the five loaves and two fish to feed the crowd. Next, he headed down to Capernaum, which no longer has any remains; then he visited Nazareth, where our Lord spent His childhood, and concluded his journey at Mount Tabor in Galilee.
The bishop's narrative contains both geographical and historical accounts of other places, beyond those immediately connected with our Lord's life on earth. He visited the royal city of Damascus, which is watered by four large rivers. Also Tyre, the chief town of Phoenicia, which, though once separated from the mainland, was joined to it again by the jetty or pier made by the orders of Nabuchodonosor. He speaks of Alexandria, once the capital of Egypt, which he reached forty days after leaving Jaffa, and lastly, of Constantinople, where he often visited the large church in which "the wood of the cross is preserved, upon which the Saviour suffered for the salvation of the human race."
The bishop's story includes both geographical and historical accounts of places that are not just related to our Lord's life on earth. He visited the royal city of Damascus, which is fed by four big rivers. He also went to Tyre, the main city of Phoenicia, which, although it was once an island, was connected back to the mainland by the jetty or pier built on the orders of Nabuchodonosor. He talks about Alexandria, which was once the capital of Egypt and which he reached forty days after leaving Jaffa, and finally, he mentions Constantinople, where he often visited the large church that preserves "the wood of the cross upon which the Saviour suffered for the salvation of the human race."
The account of this journey was written by the Abbé de St. Columban at the dictation of the bishop, and not many years afterwards the same journey was undertaken by an English pilgrim, and accomplished in much the same way. The name of this pilgrim was Willibald, a member of a rich family living at Southampton, who, on his recovery from a long illness, dedicated him to God's service. All his early life was spent in holy exercises in the monastery of Woltheim; when he was grown up he had the most intense wish to see St. Peter's at Rome, and was so set upon this, that it induced his father, brother, and young sister to wish to go there also; they embarked at Southampton in the spring of 721, and making their way up the Seine, they landed at Rouen. We have but few details of the journey to Rome, but Willibald mentions that after passing through Cortona and Lucca, at which latter place his father sank under the fatigue of the journey and died, he reached Rome in safety with his brother and sister, and passed the winter there, but they were all in turn attacked with fever. When Willibald regained his health, he determined to continue his journey to the Holy Land. He sent his brother and sister back to England, while he joined some monks who were going in the same direction as himself. They went by Terracina and Gaeta to Naples, and set sail for Reggio in Calabria, and Catania and Syracuse in Sicily, whence they again embarked, and, after touching at Cos and Samos, landed at Ephesus in Asia Minor, where they visited the tombs of St. John the Evangelist, of Mary Magdalene, and of the seven sleepers of Ephesus, that is, seven Christians martyred in the time of the Emperor Decius.
The story of this journey was written by the Abbé de St. Columban as dictated by the bishop. Not long after, an English pilgrim undertook the same journey in a similar manner. This pilgrim was Willibald, a member of a wealthy family from Southampton, who, after recovering from a long illness, dedicated himself to God's service. He spent his early life engaged in religious activities at the monastery of Woltheim. As he grew older, he had a strong desire to see St. Peter's in Rome, and his determination inspired his father, brother, and younger sister to want to go there, too. They set sail from Southampton in the spring of 721, traveled up the Seine, and landed at Rouen. We have few details about the journey to Rome, but Willibald notes that after going through Cortona and Lucca—where his father succumbed to the fatigue of the journey and died—he arrived safely in Rome with his brother and sister and spent the winter there, although all of them eventually fell ill with fever. Once Willibald regained his health, he decided to continue his journey to the Holy Land. He sent his brother and sister back to England while he joined a group of monks heading in the same direction. They traveled through Terracina and Gaeta to Naples, set sail for Reggio in Calabria, and then visited Catania and Syracuse in Sicily before embarking again. After stopping at Cos and Samos, they landed in Ephesus in Asia Minor, where they visited the tombs of St. John the Evangelist, Mary Magdalene, and the seven sleepers of Ephesus—seven Christians who were martyred during the reign of Emperor Decius.
They made some stay at Patara and at Mitylene, and then went to Cyprus and Paphos; we next find the party, seven in number, at Edessa, visiting the tomb of St. Thomas the Apostle. Here they were arrested as spies, and thrown into prison by the Saracens, but the king, on the petition of a Spaniard, set them at liberty. As soon as they were set free they left the town in great haste, and from that time their route is almost the same as that of the Bishop Arculphe; they visited Damascus, Nazareth, Cana, where they saw a wonderful amphora on Mount Tabor, where our Lord was transfigured, and the Lake of Tiberias, where St. Peter walked upon the water; Magdala, where Lazarus and his sister dwelt; Capernaum, where our Lord raised to life the son of the nobleman; Bethsaida in Galilee, the native place of St. Peter and St. Andrew; Chorazin, where our Lord cured those possessed with devils; Cæsarea, and the spot where our Lord was baptized, as well as Jericho and Jerusalem.
They stopped for a bit in Patara and Mitylene, then headed to Cyprus and Paphos. We next find the group, seven people in total, in Edessa, visiting the tomb of St. Thomas the Apostle. Here, they were arrested as spies and thrown into prison by the Saracens, but the king, at the request of a Spaniard, set them free. As soon as they were released, they hurried out of the town, and from that point on, their route was almost the same as that of Bishop Arculphe. They visited Damascus, Nazareth, and Cana, where they saw a remarkable amphora on Mount Tabor, the site of the Transfiguration of our Lord, and the Lake of Tiberias, where St. Peter walked on water; Magdala, where Lazarus and his sister lived; Capernaum, where our Lord brought the son of the nobleman back to life; Bethsaida in Galilee, the hometown of St. Peter and St. Andrew; Chorazin, where our Lord healed those possessed by demons; Caesarea, along with the location where our Lord was baptized, as well as Jericho and Jerusalem.
They also went to the Valley of Jehoshaphat, the Mount of Olives, and to Bethlehem, the scene of the murder of the Innocents by Herod, and Gaza. While they were at Gaza, Willibald tells us that he suddenly became blind, while he was in the church of St. Matthias, and only recovered his sight two months afterwards, as he entered the church of the Holy Cross at Jerusalem. He went through the valley of Diospolis or Lydda, ten miles from Jerusalem, and then went to Tyre and Sidon, and thence, by Libanus, Damascus, Cæsarea, and Emmaus, back to Jerusalem, where the travellers spent the winter.
They also traveled to the Valley of Jehoshaphat, the Mount of Olives, and Bethlehem, the site of Herod's massacre of the Innocents, as well as Gaza. While they were in Gaza, Willibald tells us that he suddenly went blind while in the church of St. Matthias, and he only regained his sight two months later when he entered the church of the Holy Cross in Jerusalem. He passed through the valley of Diospolis or Lydda, ten miles from Jerusalem, and then went to Tyre and Sidon, and from there, via Lebanon, to Damascus, Caesarea, and Emmaus, returning to Jerusalem, where the travelers spent the winter.
This was not to be the limit of their exploration, for we hear of them at Ptolemais, Emesa, Jerusalem, Damascus, and Samaria, where St. John the Baptist is said to have been buried, and at Tyre, where it must be confessed that Willibald defrauded the revenue of that time by smuggling some balsam that was very celebrated, and on which a duty was levied. On quitting Tyre they went to Constantinople and lived there for two years before returning by Sicily, Calabria, Naples, and Capua. The English pilgrim reached the monastery of Monte Cassino, just ten years after his first setting out on his travels; but his time of rest had not yet come, as he was appointed to a bishopric in Franconia by Pope Gregory III. He was forty-one years of age when he was made bishop, and he lived forty years afterwards. In 938 he was canonized by Leo VII.
This wasn’t the end of their journey, as we hear about them in Ptolemais, Emesa, Jerusalem, Damascus, and Samaria, where St. John the Baptist is said to have been buried, and in Tyre, where it must be noted that Willibald evaded the taxes of that time by smuggling some highly praised balsam that was taxed. After leaving Tyre, they went to Constantinople and stayed there for two years before returning via Sicily, Calabria, Naples, and Capua. The English pilgrim reached the monastery of Monte Cassino just ten years after he first set out on his travels; however, his time for rest had not yet arrived, as Pope Gregory III appointed him to a bishopric in Franconia. He was forty-one years old when he became bishop and lived another forty years afterward. In 938, he was canonized by Leo VII.
We will conclude the list of celebrated travellers living between the first and ninth centuries, by giving a short account of Soleyman, a merchant of Bassorah, who, starting from the Persian Gulf, arrived eventually on the shores of China. This narrative is in two distinct parts, one written in 851, by Soleyman himself, who was the traveller, and the other in 878 by a geographer named Abou-Zeyd Hassan with the view of completing the first. Renaud, the orientalist, is of opinion that this narrative "has thrown quite a new light on the commercial transactions that existed in the ninth century between Egypt, Arabia, and the countries bordering on the Persian Gulf on one side, and the vast provinces of India and China on the other."
We will wrap up the list of famous travelers from the first to ninth centuries by sharing a brief story about Soleyman, a merchant from Bassorah, who set out from the Persian Gulf and eventually reached the shores of China. This account has two parts: one written in 851 by Soleyman himself, the traveler, and the other in 878 by a geographer named Abou-Zeyd Hassan to complement the first. Renaud, the orientalist, believes this narrative "has shed new light on the commercial interactions that took place in the ninth century between Egypt, Arabia, and the countries bordering the Persian Gulf on one side, and the vast regions of India and China on the other."
Soleyman, as we have said, started from the Persian Gulf after having taken in a good supply of fresh water at Muscat, and visited first, the second sea, or that of Oman. He noticed a fish of enormous size, probably a spermaceti whale, which the seamen endeavoured to frighten away by ringing a bell, then a shark, in whose stomach they found a smaller shark, enclosing in its turn one still smaller, "both alive," says the traveller, which is manifestly an exaggeration; then, after describing the remora, the dactyloptera, and the porpoise, he speaks of the sea near the Maldive Islands in which he counted an enormous number of islands, among them he mentions Ceylon by its Arabian name, with its pearl fisheries; Sumatra, inhabited by cannibals, and rich in gold-mines; Nicobar, and the Andaman Islands, where cannibalism still exists even at the present day. "This sea," he says, "is subject to fearful water-spouts which wreck the ships, and throw on its shores an immense number of dead fish and sometimes even large stones. When these tempests are at their height the sea seethes and boils." Soleyman imagined it to be infested by a sort of monster who preyed upon human beings; this is thought to have been a kind of dog-fish.
Soleyman, as we mentioned, set off from the Persian Gulf after filling up on fresh water in Muscat and first visited the second sea, or the sea of Oman. He spotted a gigantic fish, likely a sperm whale, which the sailors tried to scare away by ringing a bell. Then he saw a shark that had another smaller shark in its stomach, which itself contained an even smaller shark, "both alive," as the traveler claims, although that's obviously an exaggeration. After describing the remora, the flying gurnard, and the porpoise, he talks about the waters near the Maldives where he counted a huge number of islands. Among them, he mentions Ceylon by its Arabian name, known for its pearl fisheries; Sumatra, home to cannibals and rich in gold mines; Nicobar; and the Andaman Islands, where cannibalism still exists today. "This sea," he says, "experiences terrifying water spouts that wreck ships and wash ashore countless dead fish, and occasionally even large stones. When these storms reach their peak, the sea churns and bubbles." Soleyman imagined it to be haunted by a type of monster that preyed on humans; this is believed to have been a kind of dogfish.
![]() |
Soleyman noticed a shark in whose stomach they found a smaller shark. |
Arrived at Nicobar, Soleyman traded with the inhabitants, bartering some iron for cocoa-nuts, sugar-cane, bananas, &c.; he then crossed the sea, and seems to have made for Singapore, and northwards by the Gulf of Siam. Soleyman put into a harbour, near Cape Varella, to revictual his ships, and thence he went by the China Sea to Jehan-fou the port of the present town of Tche-kiang. The remainder of the account of Soleyman's travels, written by Abou-Zeyd Hassan, contains a detailed account of the manners and customs of the Indians and Chinese; but it is not the traveller himself who is speaking, and we shall find the same subjects spoken of in a more interesting manner by later authors.
Once he arrived at Nicobar, Soleyman traded with the locals, exchanging some iron for coconuts, sugarcane, bananas, etc. He then crossed the sea and appeared to head for Singapore, moving north through the Gulf of Siam. Soleyman stopped in a harbor near Cape Varella to restock his ships, and from there he traveled by the China Sea to Jehan-fou, the port of what is now Tche-kiang. The rest of Soleyman's travel account, written by Abou-Zeyd Hassan, includes a detailed description of the customs and traditions of the Indians and Chinese; however, it's not Soleyman speaking directly, and we will find these topics covered in a more engaging way by later writers.
We must add, in reviewing the discoveries made by travellers sixteen centuries before, and nine centuries after, the Christian era, that from Norway to the extreme boundaries of China, taking a line through the Atlantic ocean, the Mediterranean Sea, the Red Sea, the Indian Ocean, and the Sea of China, the immense extent of coast bordering these seas had been in a great measure visited. Some explorations had been attempted in the interior of these countries; for instance, in Egypt as far as Ethiopia, in Asia Minor to the Caucasus, in India and China; and if these old travellers may not have quite understood mathematical precision, as to some of the points they visited, at all events the manners and customs of the inhabitants, the productions of the different countries, the mode of trading with them, and their religious customs, were quite sufficiently understood. Ships could sail with more safety when the change of winds was no longer a subject of mere speculation, the caravans could take a more direct route in the interior of the countries, and the great increase of trade which took place in the middle ages is surely owing to the facilities afforded by the writings of travellers.
We should note, when looking back at the discoveries made by travelers sixteen centuries before and nine centuries after the start of the Christian era, that from Norway to the farthest edges of China, drawing a line through the Atlantic Ocean, the Mediterranean Sea, the Red Sea, the Indian Ocean, and the Sea of China, a vast amount of coastline surrounding these seas had been extensively explored. Some attempts were made to explore the interiors of these regions; for instance, in Egypt as far as Ethiopia, in Asia Minor to the Caucasus, in India and China. While these early travelers may not have been completely accurate with mathematical details about some places they visited, they did have a pretty good grasp of the local customs, the resources of various countries, how to trade with them, and their religious practices. Ships could navigate more safely now that the shifting of winds was no longer a guessing game, caravans could take more straightforward routes through the interior, and the significant growth in trade during the Middle Ages is certainly due to the insights provided by these travelers' accounts.
CHAPTER III.
BENJAMIN OF TUDELA, 1159-1173; PLAN DE CARPIN, OR CARPINI, 1245-1247;
RUBRUQUIS, 1253-1254.
The Scandinavians in the North, Iceland and Greenland—Benjamin of Tudela visits Marseilles, Rome, Constantinople, the Archipelago, Palestine, Jerusalem, Bethlehem, Damascus, Baalbec, Nineveh, Baghdad, Babylon, Bassorah, Ispahan, Shiraz, Samarcand, Thibet, Malabar, Ceylon, the Red Sea, Egypt, Sicily, Italy, Germany, and France—Carpini explores Turkestan—Manners and customs of the Tartars—Rubruquis and the Sea of Azov, the Volga, Karakorum, Astrakhan, and Derbend.
The Scandinavians in the North, Iceland, and Greenland—Benjamin of Tudela visits Marseille, Rome, Constantinople, the Archipelago, Palestine, Jerusalem, Bethlehem, Damascus, Baalbek, Nineveh, Baghdad, Babylon, Basra, Isfahan, Shiraz, Samarkand, Tibet, Malabar, Ceylon, the Red Sea, Egypt, Sicily, Italy, Germany, and France—Carpini explores Turkestan—Customs and traditions of the Tartars—Rubruquis and the Sea of Azov, the Volga, Karakorum, Astrakhan, and Derbend.
In the course of the tenth, and at the beginning of the eleventh century, a considerable amount of ardour for exploration had arisen in Northern Europe. Some Norwegians and adventurous Gauls had penetrated to the Northern seas, and, if we may trust to some accounts, they had gone as far as the White Sea and visited the country of the Samoyedes. Some documents say that Prince Madoc may have explored the American continent.
In the tenth and early eleventh centuries, there was a strong enthusiasm for exploration in Northern Europe. Some Norwegians and daring Gauls ventured into the Northern seas, and if we can believe some reports, they traveled as far as the White Sea and explored the land of the Samoyedes. Some documents suggest that Prince Madoc might have explored the American continent.
At all events we may be tolerably certain that Iceland was discovered about A.D. 861 by some Scandinavian adventurers, and that it was soon after colonized by Normans. About this same time a Norwegian had taken refuge on a newly discovered land, and surprised by its verdure he gave it the name of Greenland.
At any rate, we can be pretty sure that Iceland was discovered around A.D. 861 by some Scandinavian explorers, and it was quickly colonized by Normans after that. Around the same time, a Norwegian found safety on a newly discovered land, and amazed by its greenery, he named it Greenland.
The communication with this portion of the American continent was difficult and uncertain, and one geographer says "it took five years for a vessel to go from Norway to Greenland, and to return from Greenland to Norway." Sometimes in severe winters the Northern Ocean was completely frozen over, and a certain Hollur-Geit, guided by a goat, was able to cross on foot from Norway to Greenland. We should keep in mind that the period of which we are speaking is the time when legends and traditions were very plentiful, and gained ready credence.
The communication with this part of the American continent was tough and unpredictable, and one geographer mentions that "it took five years for a ship to travel from Norway to Greenland and back." During harsh winters, the Northern Ocean would completely freeze over, and a man named Hollur-Geit, led by a goat, managed to walk from Norway to Greenland. It's important to remember that this was a time filled with legends and traditions that were easily believed.
Let us return to well-authenticated facts, and relate the journey of a Spanish Jew, whose truthfulness is beyond question.
Let’s go back to well-established facts and tell the story of a Spanish Jew, whose honesty is unquestionable.
This Jew was the son of a rabbi of Tudela, a town in Navarre, and he was called Benjamin of Tudela. It seems probable that the object of his voyage was to make a census of his brother Jews scattered over the surface of the Globe, but whatever may have been his motive, he spent thirteen years, from 1160-1173, exploring nearly all the known world, and his narrative was considered the great authority on this subject up to the sixteenth century.
This Jew was the son of a rabbi from Tudela, a town in Navarre, and he was known as Benjamin of Tudela. It seems likely that the purpose of his journey was to count his fellow Jews spread across the world, but whatever his reason, he spent thirteen years, from 1160 to 1173, exploring almost all of the known world, and his account was regarded as the major authority on this topic until the sixteenth century.
Benjamin of Tudela left Barcelona, and travelling by Tarragona, Gironde, Narbonne, Béziers, Montpellier, Sunel, Pousquiers, St. Gilles, and Arles, reached Marseilles. Here he visited the two synagogues in the town and the principal Jews, and then set sail for Genoa, arriving there in four days. The Genoese were masters of the sea at that time, and were at war with the people of Pisa, a brave people, who, like the Genoese, says the traveller, "owned neither kings nor princes, but only the judges whom they appointed at their own pleasure."
Benjamin of Tudela left Barcelona and traveled through Tarragona, Gironde, Narbonne, Béziers, Montpellier, Sunel, Pousquiers, St. Gilles, and Arles, until he reached Marseilles. There, he visited the two synagogues in town and met with the main Jewish community, before setting sail for Genoa, where he arrived in four days. Back then, the Genoese were the rulers of the sea and were at war with the people of Pisa, who were courageous like the Genoese. According to the traveler, "neither owned kings nor princes, but only the judges they chose themselves."
After visiting Lucca, Benjamin of Tudela went to Rome. Alexander III. was Pope at that time, and according to this traveller, he included some Jews among his ministers. Among the monuments of special interest in the eternal city, he mentions St. Peter's and St. John Lateran, but his descriptions are not interesting. From Rome by Capua, and Pozzuoli, then partly inundated, he went to Naples, where he seems to have seen nothing but the five hundred Jews living there; then by Salerno, Amalfi, Benevento, Ascoli, Trani, St. Nicholas of Bari, and Brindisi, he arrived at Otranto, having crossed Italy and yet found nothing interesting to relate of this splendid country.
After visiting Lucca, Benjamin of Tudela went to Rome. Alexander III was Pope at that time, and according to this traveler, he had some Jews among his ministers. Among the notable sights in the eternal city, he mentions St. Peter's and St. John Lateran, but his descriptions aren't particularly engaging. From Rome, he traveled through Capua and Pozzuoli, which was partly flooded, and then headed to Naples, where it seems he encountered only the five hundred Jews living there; then through Salerno, Amalfi, Benevento, Ascoli, Trani, St. Nicholas of Bari, and Brindisi, he reached Otranto, having crossed Italy yet found nothing remarkable to share about this beautiful country.
The list of the places Benjamin of Tudela visited, is not interesting, but we must not omit to mention one of them, for his narrative is most precise, and it is useful to follow his route by the maps specially prepared for this purpose by Lelewel. From Otranto to Zeitun, his halting-places were Corfu, the Gulf of Arta, Achelous, an ancient town in Ætolia, Anatolia in Greece, on the Gulf of Patras, Patras, Lepanto, Crissa, at the foot of Mount Parnassus, Corinth, Thebes, whose two thousand Jewish inhabitants were the best makers of silk and purple in Greece, Negropont and Zeitoun. Here, according to the Spanish traveller, is the boundary-line of Wallachia; he says the Wallachians are as nimble as goats, and come down from the mountains to pillage the neighbouring Greek towns.
The list of places Benjamin of Tudela visited isn’t particularly exciting, but we should highlight one of them because his account is very detailed, and it’s helpful to follow his route using the maps created by Lelewel. From Otranto to Zeitun, his stops included Corfu, the Gulf of Arta, Achelous, an ancient town in Aetolia, Anatolia in Greece on the Gulf of Patras, Patras, Lepanto, Crissa at the base of Mount Parnassus, Corinth, Thebes—where the two thousand Jewish residents were the best silk and purple makers in Greece—Negropont, and Zeitoun. According to the Spanish traveler, this is the boundary of Wallachia; he notes that the Wallachians are as swift as goats and come down from the mountains to raid nearby Greek towns.
Benjamin of Tudela went on to Constantinople by way of Gardiki, a small township on the Gulf of Volo, Armyros, a port much frequented by the Venetians and Genoese, Bissina, a town of which no traces are left, Salonica, the ancient Thessalonica, and Abydos. He gives us some details of Constantinople; the Emperor Emmanuel Comnenus was reigning at that time and lived in a palace that he had built upon the sea-shore, containing columns of pure gold and silver, and "the golden throne studded with precious stones, above which a golden crown is suspended by a chain of the same precious metal, which rests upon the monarch's head as he sits upon the throne." In this crown are many precious stones, and one of priceless worth: "so brilliant are they," says this traveller, "that at night, there is no occasion for any further light than that thrown back by these jewels." He adds that there is a large population in the city, and for the number of merchants from all countries who assemble there, it can only be compared to Baghdad. The inhabitants are principally dressed in embroidered silk robes enriched with golden fringes, and to see them thus attired and mounted upon their horses, one would take them for princes, but they are not brave warriors, and they keep mercenaries from all nations to fight for them. One regret he expresses, and that is, that there are no Jews left in the City, and that they have all been transported to Galata, near the entrance of the port, where are nearly two thousand five hundred of the sects (Rabbinites and Caraites), and among them many rich merchants and silk manufacturers, but the Turks have a bitter hatred for them, and treat them with great severity. Only one of these rich Jews was allowed to ride on horseback, he was the Emperor's physician, Solomon, the Egyptian. As to the remarkable buildings of Constantinople, he mentions the Mosque of St. Sophia, in which the number of altars answers to the number of days in a year, and the columns and gold and silver candlesticks, are too numerous to be counted; also the Hippodrome, which at the present day is used as a horse-market, but was then the scene of combats between "lions, bears, tigers, other wild beasts, and even birds."
Benjamin of Tudela traveled to Constantinople via Gardiki, a small town on the Gulf of Volo, Armyros, a busy port for Venetians and Genoese, Bissina, a now-vanished town, Salonica, the ancient Thessalonica, and Abydos. He shares some insights about Constantinople; at that time, Emperor Emmanuel Comnenus was in power and resided in a palace he had constructed by the sea, featuring columns made of pure gold and silver, and "the golden throne adorned with precious stones, above which hangs a golden crown on a chain of the same metal, resting on the monarch's head as he sits upon the throne." This crown contains many gemstones, including one of immense value: "so brilliant are they," says the traveler, "that at night, there's no need for any light other than what these jewels reflect." He notes that the city has a large population, and with so many merchants from various countries gathering there, it can only be compared to Baghdad. The locals mainly wear embroidered silk robes embellished with golden fringes, and seeing them dressed like this and riding their horses, one might mistake them for royalty, even though they aren’t brave warriors; instead, they hire mercenaries from different nations to fight for them. He expresses one regret: there are no Jews left in the city, as they have all been moved to Galata, near the port's entrance, where nearly two thousand five hundred members of the community (Rabbinites and Karaites) reside, including many wealthy merchants and silk manufacturers. However, the Turks harbor a deep hatred for them and treat them harshly. Only one of these wealthy Jews, the Emperor's physician Solomon, the Egyptian, was allowed to ride a horse. Regarding Constantinople’s notable buildings, he mentions the Mosque of St. Sophia, which has as many altars as there are days in a year, with countless columns and gold and silver candlesticks; also, the Hippodrome, which today serves as a horse market but was once the venue for battles involving "lions, bears, tigers, other wild animals, and even birds."
![]() |
The approach to Constantinople. |
When Benjamin of Tudela left Constantinople, he visited Gallipoli and Kilia, a port on the Eastern coast, and went to the islands in the Archipelago, Mitylene, Chios, whence there was much trade in the juice of the pistachio-tree, Samos, Rhodes, and Cyprus. As he sailed towards the land of Aram, he passed by Messis, by Antioch, where he admired the arrangements for supplying the city with water, and by Latakia on his way to Tripoli, which he found had been recently shaken by an earthquake, that had been felt for miles round. We next hear of him at Beyrout, at Sidon, and Tyre, celebrated for its glass manufactory, at Acre, at Jaffa near Mount Carmel, at Capernaum, at the beautiful town of Cæsarea, at Samaria, which is built in the midst of a fertile tract, where are vineyards, gardens, orchards, and olive-yards, at Nablous, at Gibeon, and then at Jerusalem.
When Benjamin of Tudela left Constantinople, he visited Gallipoli and Kilia, a port on the eastern coast, and traveled to the islands in the Archipelago: Mitylene, Chios, where there was a lot of trade in pistachio tree sap, Samos, Rhodes, and Cyprus. As he sailed toward the land of Aram, he passed by Messis and Antioch, where he admired the city's water supply system, and by Latakia on his way to Tripoli, which he found had recently experienced an earthquake that was felt for miles around. We next hear about him in Beyrout, Sidon, and Tyre, known for its glass manufacturing, in Acre, in Jaffa near Mount Carmel, in Capernaum, in the beautiful town of Cæsarea, in Samaria, which is built in the middle of a fertile area with vineyards, gardens, orchards, and olive groves, in Nablous, in Gibeon, and finally in Jerusalem.
In the holy city, it was but natural that the Jew could see nothing that would have interested a Christian visitor. For him, Jerusalem appeared only a small town, defended by three walls and peopled with Jews, Syrians, Greeks, Georgians, and Franks of all languages and nations. He found four hundred horse-soldiers in the city ready for war at any moment, a great temple in which is the tomb of "that man," as the Talmud styles our Saviour, and a house in which the Jews had the privilege of carrying on the work of dyeing; but they were few in number, scarcely two hundred, and they lived under the tower of David at one corner of the city. Outside Jerusalem, the traveller mentions the tomb of Absalom, the sepulchre of Osias, the pool of Siloam, near the brook Cedron, the valley of Jehoshaphat, and the Mount of Olives, from whose summit one can see the Dead Sea. Two leagues from it stands the pillar of Lot's wife, and the traveller adds, "that though the flocks and herds which pass this pillar of salt are continually licking it, yet it never diminishes in size." From Jerusalem, Benjamin of Tudela went to Bethlehem, and inscribed his name on Rachel's tomb, as it was customary for all Jews to do who passed by it; and from Bethlehem, after counting twelve Jewish dyeing establishments, he went on to Hebron, which is now deserted and in ruins.
In the holy city, it was only natural that the Jew could see nothing that would interest a Christian visitor. To him, Jerusalem seemed like a small town, surrounded by three walls and inhabited by Jews, Syrians, Greeks, Georgians, and Franks from various languages and nations. He noted four hundred horse-soldiers in the city, ready for battle at any moment, a grand temple housing the tomb of "that man," as the Talmud refers to our Savior, and a place where Jews had the right to continue dyeing fabric. However, they were few in number, hardly two hundred, living under the tower of David at one corner of the city. Outside of Jerusalem, the traveler mentions the tomb of Absalom, the grave of Osias, the Pool of Siloam near the Kidron Brook, the Valley of Jehoshaphat, and the Mount of Olives, from which you can see the Dead Sea. Two leagues away stands the pillar of Lot's wife, and the traveler adds, "that although the flocks and herds passing this salt pillar are constantly licking it, it never decreases in size." From Jerusalem, Benjamin of Tudela went to Bethlehem and signed his name on Rachel's tomb, as was the custom for all Jews who passed by it; and from Bethlehem, after counting twelve Jewish dyeing businesses, he continued on to Hebron, which is now abandoned and in ruins.
After visiting, in the plain of Machpelah, the tombs of Abraham, Sarah, Isaac, Rebekah, Jacob, and Leah, and passing by Beth-Jairim, Scilo, Mount Moriah, Beth-Nubi, Ramah, Joppa, Jabneh, Azotus, Ascalon, built by Esdras, Lud, Tiberias, where are some hot springs, Gish and Merom, which is still a spot visited by Jewish pilgrims, Kedesh and Laish, near the cavern, where the Jordan takes its rise, the traveller left the land of Israel, and entered Damascus.
After visiting the tombs of Abraham, Sarah, Isaac, Rebekah, Jacob, and Leah in the plain of Machpelah, and passing by Beth-Jairim, Scilo, Mount Moriah, Beth-Nubi, Ramah, Joppa, Jabneh, Azotus, Ascalon, which was built by Esdras, Lud, Tiberias, known for its hot springs, Gish and Merom, still a site frequented by Jewish pilgrims, and Kedesh and Laish, near the cave where the Jordan River begins, the traveler left the land of Israel and entered Damascus.
The following is his description of this city, where the Turkish rule begins. "It is a very large and beautiful city, walled round, and outside the walls for fifteen miles are gardens and orchards, and of all the surrounding country, this is the most fertile spot. The town stands at the foot of Mount Hermon, whence rise the two rivers, Abana and Pharpar; the first passes through the city, and its waters are taken into the larger houses by means of aqueducts, as well as through the streets and markets. This town trades with all the world. The river Pharpar fertilizes the orchards and gardens outside the town. There is an Ishmaelitish mosque, called Goman-Dammesec, meaning the synagogue of Damascus, and this building has not its equal; it is said to have been Benhadad's palace, and it contains a glass wall, built apparently by magic. This wall has 365 holes in it, answering to the days of the year; as the sun rises and sets it shines through one or other of these holes, so that the hour of the day may thus always be known. Inside the palace or mosque are gold and silver houses, large enough to hold two or three persons at a time, if they wish to wash or bathe in them."
The following is his description of this city, where the Turkish rule begins. "It is a very large and beautiful city, surrounded by walls, and outside the walls for fifteen miles are gardens and orchards, and of all the nearby areas, this is the most fertile spot. The town sits at the base of Mount Hermon, where the two rivers, Abana and Pharpar, originate; the first flows through the city, and its waters are directed into the larger houses through aqueducts, as well as through the streets and markets. This town trades with the whole world. The river Pharpar nourishes the orchards and gardens outside the town. There is an Ishmaelite mosque, called Goman-Dammesec, meaning the synagogue of Damascus, and this building is unmatched; it is said to have been Benhadad's palace and features an apparently magical glass wall. This wall has 365 holes in it, corresponding to the days of the year; as the sun rises and sets, it shines through one of these holes, so you can always tell the time of day. Inside the palace or mosque are gold and silver structures, large enough to accommodate two or three people at a time, if they want to wash or bathe in them."
After going to Galad and Salkah, which are two days' journey from Damascus, Benjamin reached Baalbec, the Heliopolis of the Greeks and Romans, built by Solomon, in the valley of the Libanus, then to Tadmor, which is Palmyra, also built entirely of great stones. Then passing by Cariatin, he stopped at Hamah, which was partially destroyed by an earthquake in 1157, which overthrew many of the Syrian towns.
After visiting Galad and Salkah, which are two days' travel from Damascus, Benjamin arrived in Baalbec, known as Heliopolis to the Greeks and Romans, built by Solomon in the valley of Libanus. Then he traveled to Tadmor, also called Palmyra, which is all made of large stones. After passing by Cariatin, he stopped in Hamah, which was partly destroyed by an earthquake in 1157 that brought down many towns in Syria.
Now comes in the narrative a list of names, which are of no great interest: we may mention among them, Nineveh, whence the traveller returned towards the Euphrates; and finally that he reached Baghdad, the residence of the Caliph.
Now the story includes a list of names that aren’t very interesting: we can mention Nineveh, where the traveler headed back toward the Euphrates; and in the end, he arrived in Baghdad, the home of the Caliph.
Baghdad was of great interest to the Jewish traveller; he says it is a large town three miles in circumference, containing a hospital both for Jews and sick people of any nation. It is the centre for learned men, philosophers, and magicians from all parts of the world. It is the residence of the Caliph, who at this time was probably Mostaidjed, whose dominion included western Persia and the banks of the Tigris. He had a vast palace, standing in a park watered by a tributary of the Tigris and filled with wild beasts, he may be taken as a model sovereign on some points; he was a good and very truthful man, kind and considerate to all with whom he came in contact. He lived on the produce of his own toil, and made blankets, which, marked with his own seal, were sold in the market by the princes of his court, to defray the expense of his living. He only left his palace once a year, at the feast of Ramadan, when he went to the mosque near the Bassorah gate, and there acting as Iman, he explained the law to his people. He returned to his palace by a different route which was carefully guarded all the rest of the year, so that no other passer by might profane the marks of his footsteps. All the brothers of the Caliph inhabit the same palace as he does; they are all treated with much respect, and have the government of provinces and towns in their hands, the revenues from them enabling them to pass a pleasant life; only, as they once rebelled against their sovereign, they are now all fettered with chains of iron, and have guards mounted before their houses.
Baghdad fascinated the Jewish traveler; he describes it as a large town that's three miles around, with a hospital for both Jews and sick people from any nation. It's a hub for scholars, philosophers, and magicians from all over the world. It's also the home of the Caliph, who was likely Mostaidjed at that time, reigning over western Persia and the banks of the Tigris. He owned a vast palace in a park, irrigated by a branch of the Tigris, filled with wild animals. He could be seen as a model ruler in some respects; he was a good, honest man, kind and considerate to everyone he met. He earned his living by working with his own hands, making blankets that were sold in the market by the princes of his court, stamped with his seal to help cover his expenses. He only left his palace once a year during the feast of Ramadan, when he would go to the mosque near the Bassorah gate and serve as Iman, explaining the law to his people. He would return to his palace via a different, heavily guarded route, so that no one else could disturb the marks of his footsteps. All the Caliph's brothers lived in the same palace; they were treated with great respect and governed provinces and towns, collecting revenues that allowed them to live comfortably. However, since they once rebelled against their ruler, they were all shackled with iron chains and had guards stationed outside their homes.
Benjamin of Tudela visited that part of Turkey in Asia which is watered by the Euphrates and Tigris, and saw the ruined city of Babylon, passing by what is said to be the furnace into which Shadrach, Meshach, and Abednego were thrown, and the tower of Babel, which he describes as follows. "The tower built by the tribes that were dispersed is of bricks; its largest ground work must be two miles in circumference; its length is two hundred and forty cubits. At every ten cubits there is a passage leading to a spiral staircase, which goes to the upper part of the building; from the tower there is a view of the surrounding country for twenty miles; but the wrath of God fell upon it and it is now only a heap of ruins."
Benjamin of Tudela visited that part of Turkey in Asia that is along the Euphrates and Tigris rivers, and he saw the ruined city of Babylon, passing by what is said to be the furnace where Shadrach, Meshach, and Abednego were thrown, as well as the tower of Babel, which he describes like this: "The tower built by the tribes that were scattered is made of bricks; its base must be two miles around; its height is two hundred and forty cubits. At every ten cubits, there is a passage leading to a spiral staircase that goes to the top of the building; from the tower, you can see the surrounding area for twenty miles; but God's wrath fell upon it and now it's just a pile of ruins."
![]() |
The Tower of Babel. |
From Babel the traveller went to the Synagogue of Ezekiel, situated on the Euphrates, a real sanctuary where believers congregate to read the book written by the prophet. Then traversing Alkotzonath, &c., to Sura, once the site of a celebrated Jewish college, and Shafjathib, whose synagogue is built with stones from Jerusalem, and crossing the desert of Yemen he passed Themar, Tilimar, and Chaibar which contained a great number of Jewish inhabitants, to Waseth; and thence to Bassorah on the Tigris, nearly at the end of the Persian Gulf.
From Babel, the traveler went to the Synagogue of Ezekiel, located on the Euphrates, a true sanctuary where believers gather to read the book written by the prophet. Then, traveling through Alkotzonath, etc., to Sura, once the site of a famous Jewish college, and Shafjathib, whose synagogue is built with stones from Jerusalem. Crossing the desert of Yemen, he passed through Themar, Tilimar, and Chaibar, which had a large number of Jewish residents, to Waseth; and from there to Bassorah on the Tigris, close to the end of the Persian Gulf.
He gives no account of this important town; and thence he seems to have gone to Karna, to visit the tomb of the prophet Esdras; then he entered Persia and sojourned at Chuzestan, a large town, partly in ruins, which the river Tigris divides into two parts, one rich the other poor, joined by a bridge, over which hangs the coffin of Daniel the prophet. He went to Amaria, which is the boundary of Media, where he says the impostor David-el-roi appeared, the worker of false miracles, who is none other than our Lord Jesus Christ, but called among the Jews of that part by the former name. Then he went to Hamadan, where the tombs of Mordecai and Esther are found, and by Dabrestan he reached Ispahan, the capital of the kingdom, a city measuring twelve miles in circumference. At this point the narrative of the traveller becomes somewhat obscure; according to his notes we find him at Shiraz, then at Samarcand, then at the foot of the mountains in Thibet. This seems to have been his farthest point towards the north-east; he must have come back to Nizapur and Chuzestan on the banks of the Tigris; thence after a sea voyage of two days to El-Cachif, an Arabian town on the Persian Gulf, where the pearl fishery is carried on. Then, after another voyage of seven days and crossing the Sea of Oman, he seems to have reached Quilon on the coast of Malabar.
He doesn't really talk about this important town; it seems he went to Karna next to visit the tomb of the prophet Esdras. After that, he entered Persia and stayed in Chuzestan, a large town that’s partly in ruins, split in two by the river Tigris—one side is wealthy, the other is not. They’re connected by a bridge that supports the coffin of the prophet Daniel. He then traveled to Amaria, the border of Media, where he mentions the impostor David-el-roi, a miracle worker, who is actually our Lord Jesus Christ but is called by that name among the Jews there. Next, he visited Hamadan, where the tombs of Mordecai and Esther are located. By Dabrestan, he arrived in Ispahan, the capital of the kingdom, which has a circumference of twelve miles. At this point, the traveler’s narrative gets a bit unclear; according to his notes, he finds himself in Shiraz, then Samarcand, and then at the foot of the mountains in Tibet. This seems to be his farthest point northeast. He must have returned to Nizapur and Chuzestan along the Tigris; from there, he took a two-day sea voyage to El-Cachif, an Arabian town on the Persian Gulf, known for its pearl fishery. After another seven-day voyage across the Sea of Oman, he appears to have arrived in Quilon on the coast of Malabar.
He was at last in India, the kingdom of the worshippers of the Sun and of the descendants of Cush. This country produces pepper, ginger, and cinnamon. Twenty days after leaving Quilon he was among the fire-worshippers in Ceylon, and thence, perhaps, he went to China. He thought this voyage a very perilous one, and says that many vessels are lost on it, giving the following singular expedient for averting the danger. "You should take on board with you several skins of oxen, and, if the wind rises and threatens the vessel with danger, all who wish to escape envelope themselves each in a skin, sew up this skin so as to make it as far as possible water-tight, then throw themselves into the sea, and flocks of the great eagles called griffins, thinking that they are really oxen, will descend and bear them on their wings to some mountain or valley, there to devour their prey. Immediately on reaching land the man will kill the eagle with his knife, and leaving the skin, will walk towards the nearest habitation; many people," he adds, "have been saved by this means."
He was finally in India, the land of sun worshippers and the descendants of Cush. This country grows pepper, ginger, and cinnamon. Twenty days after leaving Quilon, he found himself among the fire-worshippers in Ceylon, and from there, he might have gone to China. He considered this journey very risky and noted that many ships are lost on it, sharing a unique method to avoid danger. "You should bring several ox hides on board, and if the wind picks up and puts the ship in danger, anyone who wants to survive wraps themselves in a hide, stitches it up to make it as waterproof as possible, then jumps into the sea. Flocks of large eagles called griffins, thinking they are actually oxen, will swoop down and carry them away to some mountain or valley, where they will feast on their catch. As soon as they reach land, the person should kill the eagle with a knife, leave the hide behind, and walk towards the nearest settlement; many people," he adds, "have been saved this way."
We find Benjamin of Tudela again at Ceylon, then at the Island of Socotra in the Persian Gulf, and after crossing the Red Sea he arrives in Abyssinia, which he styles "the India that is on terra firma." Thence he goes down the Nile, crosses the country of Assouan, reaches the town of Holvan, and by the Sahara, where the sand swallows up whole caravans, he goes to Zairlah, Kous, Faiouna and Misraim or Cairo.
We find Benjamin of Tudela again in Ceylon, then at the Island of Socotra in the Persian Gulf, and after crossing the Red Sea, he arrives in Abyssinia, which he refers to as "the India that is on solid ground." From there, he travels down the Nile, crosses the area of Assouan, reaches the town of Holvan, and through the Sahara, where the sand consumes entire caravans, he goes to Zairlah, Kous, Faiouna, and Misraim or Cairo.
This last is a large town containing fine squares and shops. It never rains there, but this want is supplied by the overflow of the Nile once a year, which waters the country and renders it very fertile.
This last is a large town with beautiful squares and shops. It never rains there, but this shortage is made up for by the Nile's overflow once a year, which irrigates the land and makes it very fertile.
![]() |
Benjamin of Tudela in the Desert of Sahara. |
He passed Gizeh on leaving Misraim but does not mention the pyramids, and just names Ain-Schams, Boutig, Zefita, and Damira; he stopped at Alexandria, built by Alexander the Great, a city of great commerce, frequented by merchants from all parts of the world. Its squares and streets are thronged with people, and so long that one cannot see from one end to another. A dike or causeway runs out a mile into the sea, on which a high tower was built by the conqueror, and on the top of it a glass mirror was placed, by which all vessels could be seen while still fifty days' sail away, coming from Greece or the east on their way to make war upon or otherwise harm the town. "This tower," if we may credit the writer, "is still of use as a signal to vessels coming to Alexandria, for it can be seen night or day, a great flaming torch being kept lighted at night, visible 100 miles off!" What are our light-houses when even with the electric light they are only visible thirty miles away? From Damietta, the traveller visited several neighbouring towns, then returning there he embarked on board a vessel and twenty days afterwards landed at Messina. He wished to continue the census that he was making, so by way of Rome and Lucca he went to St. Bernard. He mentions visiting several towns both in Germany and France, where Jews had settled, and according to Chateaubriand's account, Benjamin of Tudela's computation brought the number of Jews to about 768,165.
He passed Giza after leaving Egypt but doesn't mention the pyramids, only listing Ain-Shams, Boutig, Zefita, and Damira. He stopped in Alexandria, built by Alexander the Great, which is a bustling city of trade, filled with merchants from all over the world. Its squares and streets are crowded with people, stretching so far that you can't see from one end to the other. A dike or causeway extends a mile into the sea, where a tall tower was built by the conqueror. At the top, there was a glass mirror that could spot ships coming from as far as fifty days' sail away from Greece or the east, on their way to attack or threaten the town. "This tower," if we can trust the writer, "is still useful as a signal for ships coming to Alexandria, as it can be seen day or night, with a large flaming torch kept lit at night, visible from 100 miles away!" What do our lighthouses matter when, even with electric lights, they are only visible thirty miles away? From Damietta, the traveler visited several nearby towns, then returned there to board a ship, landing in Messina twenty days later. He wanted to continue the census he was conducting, so he traveled through Rome and Lucca to St. Bernard. He mentions visiting several towns in both Germany and France where Jews had settled, and according to Chateaubriand's account, Benjamin of Tudela estimated the number of Jews to be around 768,165.
In conclusion the traveller speaks of Paris, which he seems to have visited; he says, "This great town numbers among its inhabitants some remarkably learned men, who are unequalled for learning by any in the world; they spend all their time studying law, and at the same time are very hospitable to all strangers, but especially to all their Jewish brethren." Such is the account of Benjamin of Tudela's travels; they form an important part of the geographical science of the middle of the twelfth century. As we have used the modern names, it is easy to follow the short account of his route that we have given, on any atlas of the present day.
In conclusion, the traveler talks about Paris, which he seems to have visited. He says, "This great city is home to some remarkably learned men, unmatched in knowledge by anyone else in the world; they dedicate all their time to studying law and are also very welcoming to all strangers, especially to their Jewish fellow countrymen." This is the account of Benjamin of Tudela's travels; they play a crucial role in the geographical understanding of the mid-twelfth century. Since we've used modern names, it's easy to trace the brief overview of his journey on any contemporary map.
Next in order of succession we come to the name of Jean du Plan de Carpin, or as some authors render it simply, Carpini. He was a Franciscan or Grey Friar, born in 1182, at Perugia in Italy. It is well known what inroads the Mongolians had made under Gengis-Khan, and in 1206 this chieftain had made Karakorum, an ancient Turkish town, his capital. This town was a little north of China. His successor Ojadaï, extended the Mongolian dominion into the centre of China, and, after raising an army of 600,000 men, he even invaded Europe. Russia, Georgia, Poland, Moravia, Silesia, and Hungary, all became the scenes of sanguinary conflicts which almost always ended in favour of the invaders. The Mongols were looked upon as demons possessed with superhuman power, and Western Europe was terrified at their approach.
Next in line of succession, we come to the name Jean du Plan de Carpin, or as some writers simply put it, Carpini. He was a Franciscan or Grey Friar, born in 1182 in Perugia, Italy. It's well-known how much the Mongolians had advanced under Genghis Khan, who made Karakorum, an ancient Turkish town, his capital in 1206. This town was located just north of China. His successor Ojadaï expanded the Mongolian rule into central China, and after raising an army of 600,000 men, he even invaded Europe. Russia, Georgia, Poland, Moravia, Silesia, and Hungary all became battlegrounds for brutal conflicts that almost always favored the invaders. The Mongols were seen as demons with superhuman strength, and Western Europe was terrified by their approach.
Pope Innocent IV. sent an ambassador to the Tartars, but he was treated with arrogance; at the same time he sent other ambassadors to the Tartars living in North-Eastern Tartary, in the hope of stopping the Mongolian invasion, and as chief in this mission, the Franciscan Carpini was chosen, being known to be a clever and intelligent diplomatist. Carpini was accompanied by Stephen, a Bohemian; they set out on the 6th of April, 1245, and went first to Bohemia, where the king gave them letters to some relations living in Poland, who he hoped might facilitate their entrance into Russia. Carpini had no difficulty in reaching the territory of the Archduke of Russia, and by his advice they bought beaver and other furs as presents for the Tartar chiefs. Thus provided, they took a north-easterly route to Kiev, then the chief town of Russia and now the seat of Government of that part, but they travelled in fear of the Lithuanians, who scoured the country at that time.
Pope Innocent IV sent an ambassador to the Tartars, but he was treated with disrespect; at the same time, he sent other ambassadors to the Tartars living in Northeastern Tartary, hoping to stop the Mongolian invasion. For this mission, the Franciscan Carpini was chosen because he was known to be a clever and intelligent diplomat. Carpini was accompanied by Stephen, a Bohemian. They set out on April 6, 1245, and first went to Bohemia, where the king gave them letters to some relatives living in Poland, hoping they could help them enter Russia. Carpini had no trouble reaching the territory of the Archduke of Russia, and on his advice, they bought beaver and other furs as gifts for the Tartar chiefs. With these gifts, they took a northeast route to Kiev, then the main city of Russia and now the government seat for that region, but they traveled with fear of the Lithuanians, who were raiding the area at that time.
The Governor of Kiev advised the Pope's envoys to exchange their own for Tartar horses, who were accustomed to seek for their food under the snow, and thus mounted they had no difficulty in getting as far as Danilisha. There they both were attacked by severe illness; when nearly recovered they bought a carriage, and in spite of the intense cold set out again. Arrived at Kaniev, on the Dnieper, they found themselves in the frontier town of the Mongol empire, and hence they were conducted to the Tartar camp by one of the chiefs, whom they had made their friend by gifts. In the camp they were badly received at first, but being directed to the Duke of Corrensa, who commanded an army of 60,000 men forming the advanced guard: this general sent them with an escort of three Tartars to Prince Bathy, the next in command to the Emperor himself. Relays of horses were prepared for them on the road, they travelled night and day, and thus passed through the Comans' country lying between the Dnieper, the Tanais, the Volga, and the Yaik, frequently having to cross the frozen rivers, and finally reaching the court of Prince Bathy on the frontiers of the Comans' country. "As we were being conducted to the prince," says Carpini, "we were told that we should have to pass between two fires, in order to purify us from any infection we might carry, and also to do away with any evil designs we might have towards the prince, which we agreed to do that we might be freed from all suspicion."
The Governor of Kiev told the Pope's envoys to trade their horses for Tartar ones, which were used to finding food under the snow. With these horses, they had no trouble getting as far as Danilisha. There, both of them fell seriously ill; when they were almost better, they bought a carriage and, despite the bitter cold, set out again. Upon arriving at Kaniev on the Dnieper, they found themselves in the border town of the Mongol empire, and from there, one of the chiefs, whom they had befriended through gifts, took them to the Tartar camp. Initially, they were not welcomed warmly, but after being pointed to the Duke of Corrensa, who led an army of 60,000 men serving as the advance guard, the general sent them off with an escort of three Tartars to Prince Bathy, the Emperor’s second-in-command. They had relays of horses waiting for them along the way, traveled day and night, and passed through the Comans' territory situated between the Dnieper, the Tanais, the Volga, and the Yaik, often needing to cross frozen rivers, ultimately arriving at Prince Bathy’s court on the edge of Coman land. "As we were being led to the prince," Carpini recounts, "we were told that we would have to pass between two fires to cleanse us of any infections we might carry, as well as to eliminate any ill intentions we might have toward him, which we agreed to so we could avoid any suspicion."
The prince was seated on his throne in the midst of his courtiers and officers in a magnificent tent made of fine linen. He had the reputation of being a just and kind ruler of his people, but very cruel in war. Carpini and Stephen were placed on the left of the throne, and the papal letters, translated into a language composed of Tartar and Arabic, were presented to the prince. He read them attentively and then dismissed the envoys to their tents, where their only refreshment was a little porringer full of millet.
The prince was sitting on his throne surrounded by his courtiers and officials in an impressive tent made of fine linen. He was known for being a fair and compassionate leader to his people, but very ruthless in battle. Carpini and Stephen were positioned to the left of the throne, and the papal letters, translated into a mix of Tartar and Arabic, were given to the prince. He read them carefully and then sent the envoys back to their tents, where their only food was a small bowl of millet.
This interview took place on Good Friday, and the next day Bathy sent for the envoys, and told them they must go to the Emperor. They set out on Easter-day with two guides; but having lived upon nothing but millet, water, and salt, the travellers were but little fit for a journey; nevertheless their guides obliged them to travel very quickly, changing horses five or six times in a day. They passed through almost a desert country, the Tartars having driven away nearly all the inhabitants. They came next to the country of the Kangites to the east of Comania, where there was a great deficiency of water; in this province the people were mostly herdsmen, under the hard yoke of the Mongolians.
This interview happened on Good Friday, and the next day Bathy called for the envoys and told them they had to go to the Emperor. They set off on Easter Sunday with two guides; but after living on nothing but millet, water, and salt, the travelers were not really fit for a journey; still, their guides pushed them to travel very quickly, changing horses five or six times in a day. They went through almost a barren land, as the Tartars had driven away nearly all the people. They then reached the territory of the Kangites, to the east of Comania, where there was a significant lack of water; in this area, most people were herdsmen, living under the harsh rule of the Mongolians.
Carpini was travelling from Easter till Ascension-Day through the land of the Kangites, and thence he came into the Biserium country, or what we call Turkestan in the present day; on all sides the eye rested on towns and villages in ruins. After crossing a chain of mountains the envoys entered Kara-Kâty on the 1st of July; here the governor received them very hospitably, and made his sons and the principal officers of his court dance before them for their amusement.
Carpini traveled from Easter to Ascension Day through the land of the Kangites, then he moved into the Biserium region, which we now refer to as Turkestan. Everywhere he looked, there were towns and villages in ruins. After crossing a mountain range, the envoys arrived in Kara-Kâty on July 1st; the governor welcomed them warmly and had his sons and the key officers of his court perform a dance for their entertainment.
On leaving Kara-Kâty the envoys rode for some days along the banks of a lake lying to the north of the town of Zeman, which must be, according to M. de Rémusat, the Lake Balkash. There lived Ordu, the eldest of the Tartar captains, and here Carpini and Stephen took a day's rest before encountering the cold and mountainous country of the Maimans, a nomadic people living in tents. After some days the travellers reached the country of the Mongols, and on the 22nd of July arrived at the place where the Emperor was, or rather he who was to be Emperor, the election having not yet taken place.
On leaving Kara-Kâty, the envoys rode for several days along the shores of a lake north of the town of Zeman, which M. de Rémusat believes to be Lake Balkash. There, they found Ordu, the oldest of the Tartar captains, and Carpini and Stephen took a day to rest before facing the cold, mountainous territory of the Maimans, a nomadic group living in tents. After a few days, the travelers reached the Mongolian land and on July 22nd arrived at the location of the Emperor, or rather the man who was to become Emperor, as the election had not yet occurred.
This future Emperor was named Cunius; he received the envoys in a most friendly manner, a letter from Prince Bathy having explained to him the object of their visit; not being yet Emperor he could not entertain them nor take any part in public affairs, but from the time of Ojadaï's death, his widow, the mother of Prince Cunius had been Regent; she received the travellers in a purple and white tent capable of holding 2000 persons. Carpini gives the following account of the interview: "When we arrived we saw a large assembly of dukes and princes who had come from all parts with their attendants, who were on horseback in the neighbouring fields and on the hills. The first day they were all dressed in white and purple, on the second when Cunius appeared in the tent, in red, on the third day they wore violet, and on the fourth, scarlet, or crimson. Outside the tent, in the surrounding palisade were two great gates, by one of which the Emperor alone might enter; it was unguarded, but none dared to enter or leave by it; while the other, which was the general entrance, was guarded by soldiers with swords, and bows and arrows; if any one approached within the prescribed limits he was beaten, or else shot to death with arrows. We noticed several horsemen there, on whose harness cannot have been less than twenty marks' worth of silver."
This future Emperor was named Cunius; he welcomed the envoys very warmly, since a letter from Prince Bathy had explained the purpose of their visit. Although he wasn’t Emperor yet and couldn’t host them or get involved in public affairs, his mother, the widow of Ojadaï and the mother of Prince Cunius, had been acting as Regent. She welcomed the travelers in a purple and white tent that could hold 2,000 people. Carpini describes the meeting like this: "When we arrived, we saw a large gathering of dukes and princes from all over, along with their attendants who were on horseback in the nearby fields and on the hills. On the first day, they all wore white and purple, on the second day, when Cunius appeared in the tent, they wore red, on the third day they donned violet, and on the fourth, scarlet or crimson. Outside the tent, within the surrounding fence, were two large gates, one of which only the Emperor could use; it was unguarded, but no one dared to enter or leave through it. The other gate was the main entrance and was guarded by soldiers with swords, bows, and arrows; if anyone tried to come too close, they were beaten or shot with arrows. We saw several horsemen there, whose tack must have been worth at least twenty marks of silver."
![]() |
The Tartars. |
A whole month passed away before Cunius was proclaimed Emperor, and the envoys were obliged to wait patiently for this before they could be received by him. Carpini turned this leisure time to account by studying the habits of the people; he has given much interesting information on the subject in his account of his travels.
A whole month went by before Cunius was declared Emperor, and the envoys had to wait patiently for this before they could meet him. Carpini made the most of this free time by observing the people's habits; he provided a lot of fascinating information on this topic in his travel account.
The country seemed to him to be principally very hilly and the soil sandy, with but little vegetation. There is scarce any wood; but all classes are content with dung for fuel. Though the country is so bare, sheep seem to do well. The climate is very changeable; in summer, storms are very frequent, many fall victims to the vivid lightning, and the wind is often so strong as even to blow over men on horseback: during the winter there is no rain, which all falls in the summer, and then scarcely enough to lay the dust, while the storms of hail are terrible; during Carpini's residence in the country they were so severe that once 140 persons were drowned by the melting of the enormous mass of hail-stones that had fallen. It is a very extensive country, but miserable beyond expression.
The country seemed to him mostly very hilly with sandy soil and hardly any vegetation. There's hardly any wood, so everyone relies on dung for fuel. Even though the land is so barren, sheep seem to thrive. The climate is very unpredictable; in summer, storms are common, and many people are struck by lightning. The wind is often so strong it can even topple people on horseback. In winter, it doesn't rain at all; all the rain falls in summer, and even then, there’s barely enough to settle the dust, while the hail storms are severe. During Carpini's time in the country, the hailstorms were so bad that once 140 people drowned due to the enormous amount of melting hailstones. It's a vast country but incredibly miserable.
Carpini who seems to have been a man of great discernment took a very just idea of the Tartars themselves. He says, "Their eyes are set very far apart; they have very high cheek-bones, their noses are small and flat; their eyes small, and their eye-lashes and eyebrows seem to meet; they are of middle height with slender waists, they have small beards, some wear moustaches, and what are now called imperials. On the top of the head the hair is shaved off like monks, and to the width of three fingers between their ears they also shave off the hair, letting what is between the tonsure and the back of the head grow to some length; in fact it is as long as a woman's in many cases, and plaited and tied in two tails behind the ear. They have small feet. He says there is but little difference perceptible in the dress of the men and women, all alike wearing long robes trimmed with fur, and high buckram caps enlarged towards the upper part. Their houses are built like tents of rods and stakes, so that they can be easily taken down and packed on the beasts of burden. Other larger dwellings are sometimes carried whole as they stand, on carts, and thus follow their owner about the country.
Carpini, who seems to have been a very insightful person, had a pretty accurate perception of the Tartars themselves. He says, "Their eyes are set very far apart; they have high cheekbones, their noses are small and flat; their eyes are small, and their eyelashes and eyebrows seem to connect; they are of average height with slim waists, they have small beards, some wear mustaches, and what are now called imperial beards. The top of their heads is shaved like monks, and they also shave off their hair to a width of three fingers between their ears, allowing the hair from the tonsure to the back of their heads to grow quite long; in fact, in many cases, it’s as long as a woman’s and braided into two tails behind the ears. They have small feet. He notes that there is hardly any difference in the clothing of men and women, as they all wear long robes trimmed with fur and high caps that flare out towards the top. Their houses are constructed like tents made of rods and stakes, so they can be easily taken down and packed onto pack animals. Other larger homes are sometimes transported whole on carts and move along with their owners across the land."
"The Tartars believe in God as the Creator of the universe and as the Rewarder and Avenger of all, but they also worship the sun, moon, fire, earth, and water, and idols made in felt, like human beings. They have little toleration, and put Michael of Turnigoo and Féodor to death for not worshipping the sun at midday at the command of Prince Bathy. They are a superstitious people, believing in enchantment and sorcery, and looking upon fire as the purifier of all things. When one of their chiefs dies he is buried with a horse saddled and bridled, a table, a dish of meat, a cup of mare's milk, and a mare and foal.
"The Tartars believe in God as the Creator of the universe and as the one who rewards and punishes everyone, but they also worship the sun, moon, fire, earth, and water, as well as idols made of felt that resemble human figures. They have little tolerance and executed Michael of Turnigoo and Féodor for not worshipping the sun at noon on Prince Bathy's orders. They are a superstitious people, believing in magic and witchcraft, and view fire as the purifier of everything. When one of their chiefs dies, he is buried with a saddled and bridled horse, a table, a dish of meat, a cup of mare's milk, and a mare and foal."
"The Tartars are most obedient to their chiefs, and are truthful and not quarrelsome; murders and deeds of violence are rare, there is very little robbery, and articles of value are never guarded. They bear great fatigue and hunger without complaint, as well as heat and cold, singing and dancing under the most adverse circumstances. They are much prone to drink to excess; they are very proud and disdainful to strangers, and have no respect for the lives of human beings."
"The Tartars are very obedient to their leaders, honest, and not prone to conflict; murders and acts of violence are rare, theft is minimal, and valuable possessions are rarely protected. They endure extreme fatigue and hunger without complaining, as well as heat and cold, often singing and dancing even in the toughest conditions. They do tend to drink heavily; they are very proud and look down on outsiders, showing little regard for human life."
Carpini completes his sketch of the Tartar character by adding that they eat all kinds of animals, dogs, wolves, foxes, horses, and even sometimes their fellow-creatures. Their principal beverage is the milk of the mare, sheep, goat, cow, and camel. They have neither wine, cervisia, (a beverage composed of grain and herbs,) nor mead, but only intoxicating liquors. They are very dirty in their habits, scarcely ever washing their porringers, or only doing so in their broth; they hardly ever wash their clothes, more especially "when there is thunder about;" and they eat rats, mice, &c., if they are badly off for other food. The men are not brought up to any manual labour, their whole occupation consisting in hunting, shooting with bow and arrows, watching the flocks, and riding. The women and girls are very athletic and very brave, they prepare furs and make clothes, drive carts and camels, and as polygamy is practised among them, and a man buys as many wives as he can keep, there are enough women for all these employments.
Carpini finishes his description of the Tartar character by noting that they eat all sorts of animals, including dogs, wolves, foxes, horses, and sometimes even other humans. Their main drink is the milk of mares, sheep, goats, cows, and camels. They have no wine, beer (a drink made from grain and herbs), or mead, just strong alcoholic drinks. They have very poor hygiene habits, rarely washing their bowls unless it's in the broth; they hardly ever wash their clothes, especially "when there's thunder;" and they will eat rats, mice, etc., if they can't find other food. The men are not raised to do any manual labor; their entire focus is on hunting, shooting with bows and arrows, watching over the flocks, and riding. The women and girls are quite strong and brave; they prepare furs, make clothes, and drive carts and camels. Since polygamy is common among them, and a man can buy as many wives as he can support, there are plenty of women available for all these tasks.
Such is the résumé of Carpini's observations made during his residence at Syra-Orda while he was awaiting the Emperor's election. Soon he found that the election was about to take place; he noticed that the courtiers always sang before Cunius when he came out of his tent, and bowed down before him with beautiful little wands in their hands, having small pieces of scarlet wool attached to them. On a plain about four leagues from Syra-Orda, beside a stream, a tent was prepared for the Coronation, carpeted with scarlet, and supported on columns covered with gold. On St. Bartholomew's day a large concourse of people assembled, each one fell on his knees as he arrived, and remained praying towards the sun; but Carpini and his companion refused to join in this idolatrous worship of the sun. Then Cunius was placed on the imperial throne, and the dukes and all the assembled multitudes having done homage to him, he was consecrated.
Here's the summary of Carpini's observations made during his time at Syra-Orda while he waited for the Emperor's election. He soon realized that the election was about to occur; he noticed that the courtiers always sang when Cunius exited his tent and bowed before him, holding beautifully crafted little wands with small pieces of scarlet wool attached. On a plain about four leagues from Syra-Orda, a tent was set up for the Coronation, decorated with scarlet carpet and supported by columns covered in gold. On St. Bartholomew's day, a large crowd gathered, and everyone knelt upon arrival, praying towards the sun; however, Carpini and his companion refused to participate in what they viewed as idolatrous worship of the sun. Cunius then took his place on the imperial throne, and after the dukes and all the gathered crowd paid him homage, he was consecrated.
As soon as this ceremony was over, Carpini and Stephen were commanded to appear before the Emperor. They were first searched and then entered the imperial presence at the same time as other Ambassadors, the bearers of rich presents; the poor papal envoys had nothing to present; whether this had anything to do with the length of time they had to wait before his Imperial Majesty could attend to their affairs we do not know; but days passed slowly by, and they were nearly dying of hunger and thirst, before they received a summons to appear before the Secretary of the Emperor, and letters to the Pope were given to them, ending with these words, "we worship GOD, and by His help we shall destroy the whole earth from east to west."
As soon as the ceremony wrapped up, Carpini and Stephen were ordered to appear before the Emperor. They were searched first and then entered the imperial presence at the same time as other ambassadors, who brought lavish gifts; the unfortunate papal envoys had nothing to offer. It's unclear whether this influenced the long wait they had before His Imperial Majesty could attend to their matters; days dragged on, and they were nearly dying of hunger and thirst before they finally got a summons to appear before the Emperor’s Secretary. They were handed letters to the Pope, concluding with these words, "we worship GOD, and with His help, we shall destroy the entire earth from east to west."
The envoys had now nothing to wait for, and during the whole of the winter they travelled across icy deserts. About May they again arrived at the court of Prince Bathy, who gave them free passes, and they reached Kiev about the middle of June, 1247. On the 9th of October of the same year the Pope made Carpini Bishop of Antivari in Dalmatia, and this celebrated traveller died at Rome about the year 1251.
The envoys had nothing left to wait for, so they traveled across icy deserts all winter. By May, they arrived back at the court of Prince Bathy, who provided them with free passes, and they reached Kiev around mid-June 1247. On October 9th of the same year, the Pope appointed Carpini as Bishop of Antivari in Dalmatia, and this famous traveler passed away in Rome around 1251.
Carpini's mission was not of much use, and the Tartars remained much as they were before, a savage and ferocious tribe; but six years after his return another monk of the minor order of Franciscans, named William Rubruquis, of Belgian origin, was sent to the barbarians who lived in the country between the Volga and the Don. The object of this journey was as follows,—
Carpini's mission didn't have much impact, and the Tartars stayed pretty much the same, a savage and fierce tribe; but six years after his return, another monk from the minor order of Franciscans, named William Rubruquis, who was from Belgium, was sent to the barbarians living in the area between the Volga and the Don. The purpose of this journey was as follows,—
St. Louis was waging war against the Saracens of Syria at this time, and while he was engaging the Infidels, Erkalty, a Mongol prince, attacked them on the side nearest to Persia, and thus caused a diversion that was in favour of the King of France. The report arose that Prince Erkalty had become a Christian, and St. Louis, anxious to prove the truth of it, charged Rubruquis to go into the prince's own country and there make what observations he could upon the subject.
St. Louis was at war with the Saracens of Syria during this time, and while he was fighting against the Infidels, Erkalty, a Mongol prince, launched an attack on their side closest to Persia, creating a distraction that benefited the King of France. Word spread that Prince Erkalty had converted to Christianity, and St. Louis, eager to verify the claim, tasked Rubruquis with going to the prince's homeland to gather information on the matter.
In the month of June 1253, Rubruquis and his companions embarked for Constantinople. From thence they reached the mouth of the river Don on the Sea of Azov where they found a great number of Goths. On their arrival among the Tartars, their reception was at first very inhospitable, but after presenting the letters with which they were furnished, Zagathal, the governor of that province, gave them waggons, horses, and oxen for their journey.
In June 1253, Rubruquis and his companions set out for Constantinople. From there, they traveled to the mouth of the Don River on the Sea of Azov, where they encountered a large group of Goths. When they first arrived among the Tartars, they received a cold welcome, but after presenting the letters they carried, Zagathal, the governor of the area, supplied them with wagons, horses, and oxen for their journey.
Thus equipped they set out and were much surprised next day by meeting a moving village; that is to say, all the huts were placed on waggons and were being moved away. During the ten days that Rubruquis and his companions were passing through this part of the country they were very badly treated, and had it not been for their own store of biscuits, they must have died of starvation. After passing by the end of the Sea of Azov they went in an easterly direction and crossed a sandy desert on which neither tree nor stone was visible. This was the country of the Comans that Carpini had traversed, but in a more northerly part. Rubruquis left the mountains inhabited by the Circassians to the south, and after a wearisome journey of two months arrived at the camp of Prince Sartach on the banks of the Volga.
Thus prepared, they set out and were shocked the next day to encounter a moving village; that is, all the huts were loaded onto wagons and being relocated. During the ten days that Rubruquis and his companions spent in this area, they were treated very poorly, and if it hadn’t been for their own supply of biscuits, they would have starved. After passing the end of the Sea of Azov, they headed east and crossed a sandy desert where nothing—not a tree or stone—could be seen. This was the land of the Comans that Carpini had traveled through, but in a more northern region. Rubruquis moved away from the mountains occupied by the Circassians to the south, and following a grueling journey of two months, he reached the camp of Prince Sartach on the banks of the Volga.
This was the court of the prince, the son of Baatu-Khan; he had six wives, each of whom possessed a palace of her own, some houses, and a great number of chariots, some of them very large, being drawn by a team of twenty-two oxen harnessed in pairs.
This was the court of the prince, the son of Baatu-Khan; he had six wives, each with her own palace, some houses, and a lot of chariots, some of which were quite large, pulled by a team of twenty-two oxen arranged in pairs.
Sartach received the envoys of the King of France very graciously, and seeing their poverty, he supplied them with all that they required. They were to be presented to the prince in their sacerdotal dress, when, bearing on a cushion a splendid Bible, the gift of the King of France, a Psalter given by the Queen, a Missal, a crucifix and a censer, they entered the royal presence, taking good care not to touch the threshold of the door, which would have been considered profanation. Once in the royal presence, they sang the "Salve Regina." After the prince and those of the princesses who were present at the ceremony had examined the books, &c., that the monks had brought with them, the envoys were allowed to retire; it being impossible for Rubruquis to form any opinion as to Sartach's being a Christian, or not; but his work was not yet finished, the prince having pressed the envoys to go to his father's court. Rubruquis complied with the request, and crossing the country lying between the Volga and the Don, they arrived at their destination. There the same ceremonies had to be gone through as at the court of Prince Sartach. The monks had to prepare their books, &c., and be presented to the Khan, who was seated on a large gilded throne, but not wishing to treat with the envoys himself, he sent them to Karakorum, to the court of Mangu-khan.
Sartach welcomed the envoys from the King of France warmly, and noticing their poverty, he provided them with everything they needed. They were to be presented to the prince in their priestly robes, carrying on a cushion a beautiful Bible, a gift from the King of France, a Psalter from the Queen, a Missal, a crucifix, and a censer. They entered the royal presence, careful not to touch the threshold of the door, as that would have been seen as disrespectful. Once in front of the prince, they sang the "Salve Regina." After the prince and the princesses who were present had examined the books and other items the monks brought, the envoys were allowed to leave; Rubruquis couldn't decide if Sartach was a Christian or not. However, his mission wasn't over yet, as the prince urged the envoys to visit his father's court. Rubruquis agreed and traveled across the land between the Volga and the Don until they reached their destination. There, the same ceremonies awaited them as at Sartach's court. The monks had to prepare their books and be presented to the Khan, who was seated on a grand gilded throne. However, not wanting to deal directly with the envoys, he sent them to Karakorum, to the court of Mangu-khan.
They crossed the country of the Bashkirs and visited Kenchat, Talach, passed the Axiartes and reached Equius, a town of which the position cannot be accurately ascertained in the present day; then by the land of Organum, by the Lake of Balkash, and the territory of the Uigurs, they arrived at Karakorum, the capital of the Mongolian empire, where Carpini had stopped without entering the town.
They traveled through the land of the Bashkirs and visited Kenchat and Talach, crossed the Axiartes, and reached Equius, a town whose exact location is unknown today. Then, they continued through the land of Organum, around Lake Balkash, and the territory of the Uigurs, finally arriving at Karakorum, the capital of the Mongolian empire, where Carpini paused without entering the town.
This town, says Rubruquis, was surrounded with walls of earth, and had four gates in the walls. The principal buildings it contained were two mosques and a Christian church. While in this city, the monk made many interesting observations on the surrounding people, especially upon the Tangurs, whose oxen, of a remarkable race, are no other than the Yaks, so celebrated in Thibet. In speaking of the Thibetans he notices their most extraordinary custom of eating the bodies of their fathers and mothers, in order to secure their having an honourable sepulture.
This town, Rubruquis reports, was surrounded by earthen walls and had four gates. The main buildings included two mosques and a Christian church. While in the city, the monk made many interesting observations about the local people, especially the Tangurs, whose remarkable oxen are actually the Yaks, well-known in Tibet. When discussing the Tibetans, he mentions their unusual custom of consuming the bodies of their parents to ensure they receive an honorable burial.
When Rubruquis and his companions reached Karakorum, they found that the great khan was not in his capital, but in one of his palaces which was situated on the further side of the mountains which rise in the northern part of the country. They followed him there, and the next day after their arrival presented themselves before him with bare feet, according to the Franciscan custom, so securing for themselves frozen toes. Rubruquis thus describes the interview: "Mangu-Khan is a man of middle height with a flat nose; he was lying on a couch clad in a robe of bright fur, which was speckled like the skin of a sea-calf." He was surrounded with falcons and other birds. Several kinds of beverages, arrack punch, fermented mare's milk, and ball, a kind of mead, were offered to the envoys; but they refused them all. The khan, less prudent than they, soon became intoxicated on these drinks, and the audience had to be ended without any result being arrived at. Rubruquis remained several days at Mangu-Khan's court; he found there a great number of German and French prisoners, mostly employed in making different kinds of arms, or in working the mines of Bocol. The prisoners were well treated by the Tartars, and did not complain of their lot. After several interviews with the great khan, Rubruquis gained permission to leave, and he returned to Karakorum.
When Rubruquis and his companions arrived in Karakorum, they discovered that the great khan was not in his capital but at one of his palaces on the other side of the mountains in the northern part of the country. They followed him there, and the day after they arrived, they presented themselves before him with bare feet, adhering to the Franciscan custom, which left them with frozen toes. Rubruquis describes the meeting: "Mangu-Khan is of average height with a flat nose; he was lying on a couch wearing a brightly colored fur robe, speckled like the skin of a seal." He was surrounded by falcons and other birds. Various drinks were offered to the envoys—arrack punch, fermented mare's milk, and ball, a type of mead—but they declined them all. The khan, less cautious than they were, soon got drunk on these beverages, and the audience had to end without any conclusions being reached. Rubruquis stayed several days at Mangu-Khan's court, where he found many German and French prisoners, mostly working on different types of weapons or in the Bocol mines. The prisoners were treated well by the Tartars and did not complain about their situation. After several meetings with the great khan, Rubruquis received permission to leave and returned to Karakorum.
Near this town stood a magnificent palace, belonging to the khan; it was like a large church with nave and double aisles, here the sovereign sits at the northern end on a raised platform, the gentlemen being seated on his right, and the ladies on his left hand. It is at this palace that twice every year splendid fêtes are given, when all the nobles of the country are assembled round their sovereign.
Near this town stood a magnificent palace, belonging to the khan; it was like a large church with a central aisle and double side aisles, where the sovereign sits at the northern end on an elevated platform, with the gentlemen seated on his right and the ladies on his left. This palace hosts two grand celebrations each year, when all the nobles of the country gather around their sovereign.
While at Karakorum, Rubruquis collected many interesting documents relating to the Chinese, their customs, literature, &c.; then leaving the capital of the Mongols, he returned by the same route as he had come, as far as Astrakhan; but there he branched to the south and went to Syria with a Turkish escort, which was rendered necessary by the presence of tribes bent on pillage. He visited Derbend, and went thence by Nakshivan, Erzeroum, Sivas, Cæsarea, and Iconium, to the port of Kertch, whence he embarked for his own country. His route was much the same as that of Carpini, but his narrative is less interesting, and the Belgian does not seem to have been gifted with the spirit of observation which characterized the Italian monk.
While in Karakorum, Rubruquis gathered many intriguing documents about the Chinese, their customs, literature, etc.; then, after leaving the Mongol capital, he retraced his steps back to Astrakhan; but there he veered south and traveled to Syria with a Turkish escort, which was necessary due to the presence of tribes looking to plunder. He visited Derbend and then traveled through Nakshivan, Erzeroum, Sivas, Cæsarea, and Iconium, arriving at the port of Kertch, from where he took a ship back to his homeland. His route was very similar to Carpini's, but his account is less engaging, and the Belgian doesn't seem to have had the keen observational skills that characterized the Italian monk.
With Carpini and Rubruquis closes the list of celebrated travellers of the thirteenth century, but we have the brilliant career of Marco Polo now before us, whose travels extended over part of the thirteenth and fourteenth centuries.
With Carpini and Rubruquis, we conclude the list of famous travelers from the thirteenth century, but now we turn to the impressive journey of Marco Polo, whose travels spanned parts of the thirteenth and fourteenth centuries.
CHAPTER IV.
I.
The interest of the Genoese and Venetian merchants in encouraging the exploration of Central Asia—The family of Polo, and its position in Venice—Nicholas and Matteo Polo, the two brothers—They go from Constantinople to the Court of the Emperor of China—Their reception at the Court of Kublaï-Khan—The Emperor appoints them his ambassadors to the Pope—Their return to Venice—Marco Polo—He leaves his father Nicholas and his uncle Matteo for the residence of the King of Tartary—The new Pope Gregory X.—The narrative of Marco Polo is written in French from his dictation, by Rusticien of Pisa.
The Genoese and Venetian merchants were interested in promoting the exploration of Central Asia. The Polo family had a notable status in Venice, with brothers Nicholas and Matteo Polo. They traveled from Constantinople to the Court of the Emperor of China. At Kublaï Khan's court, they were warmly received. The Emperor appointed them as his ambassadors to the Pope. After returning to Venice, Marco Polo left his father Nicholas and uncle Matteo to stay with the King of Tartary. During this time, the new Pope Gregory X was in power. Marco Polo’s story was written in French from his dictation by Rusticien of Pisa.
The Genoese and Venetian merchants could not fail to be much interested in the explorations of the brave travellers in Central Asia, India, and China, for they saw that these countries would give them new openings for disposing of their merchandise, and also the great benefit to be derived by the West from being supplied with the productions of the East. The interests of commerce stimulated fresh explorations, and it was this motive that actuated two noble Venetians to leave their homes, and brave all the fatigue and danger of a perilous journey.
The merchants from Genoa and Venice were undoubtedly very intrigued by the adventures of the courageous travelers in Central Asia, India, and China. They realized that these regions would provide new opportunities to sell their goods and that the West would greatly benefit from having access to the products of the East. The drive for commerce encouraged more explorations, and it was this motivation that led two noble Venetians to leave their homes and face the hardships and dangers of a risky journey.
These two Venetians belonged to the family of Polo, which had come originally from Dalmatia, and, owing to successful trading, had become so opulent as to be reckoned among the patrician families of Venice. In 1260 the two brothers, Nicholas and Matteo, who had lived for some years in Constantinople, where they had established a branch house, went to the Crimea, with a considerable stock of precious stones, where their eldest brother, Andrea Polo, had his place of business. Thence, taking a north-easterly direction and crossing the country of the Comans, they reached the camp of Barkaï-Khan on the Volga. This Mongol prince received the two merchants very kindly, and bought all the jewels they offered him at double their value.
These two Venetians were part of the Polo family, which originally came from Dalmatia and had become wealthy through successful trading, earning a spot among Venice's patrician families. In 1260, the two brothers, Nicholas and Matteo, who had been living in Constantinople for several years where they set up a branch office, traveled to the Crimea with a significant stock of precious stones to visit their oldest brother, Andrea Polo, who had his business there. From there, headed northeast and crossing the land of the Comans, they arrived at the camp of Barkaï-Khan on the Volga. This Mongol prince welcomed the two merchants warmly and bought all the jewels they offered him at twice their value.
Nicolo and Matteo remained a year in the Mongolian camp, but a war breaking out at this time between Barkaï, and Houlagou, the conqueror of Persia, the two brothers, not wishing to be in the midst of a country where war was being waged, went to Bokhara, and there they remained three years. But when Barkaï was vanquished and his capital taken, the partisans of Houlagou induced the two Venetians to follow them to the residence of the grand Khan of Tartary, who was sure to give them a hearty welcome. This Kublaï-Khan, the fourth son of Gengis-Khan, was Emperor of China, and was then at his summer-palace in Mongolia, on the frontier of the Chinese empire.
Nicolo and Matteo stayed a year in the Mongolian camp, but when a war broke out between Barkaï and Houlagou, the conqueror of Persia, the two brothers, not wanting to be in the middle of a war-torn country, went to Bokhara, where they stayed for three years. However, after Barkaï was defeated and his capital was captured, Houlagou's supporters convinced the two Venetians to accompany them to the grand Khan of Tartary, who was sure to give them a warm welcome. This Kublaï Khan, the fourth son of Gengis Khan, was the Emperor of China and was then at his summer palace in Mongolia, on the border of the Chinese empire.
The Venetian merchants set out, and were a whole year crossing the immense extent of country lying between Bokhara and the northern limits of China. Kublaï-Khan was much pleased to receive these strangers from the distant West. He fêted them, and asked, with much eagerness, for any information that they could give him of what was happening in Europe, requiring details of the government of the various kings and emperors, and their methods of making war; and he then conversed at some length about the Pope and the state of the Latin Church. Matteo and Nicolo fortunately spoke the Tartar language fluently, so they could freely answer all the emperor's questions.
The Venetian merchants set off and spent an entire year traveling across the vast land between Bokhara and the northern edge of China. Kublai Khan was very pleased to welcome these visitors from the far West. He celebrated them and eagerly asked for any information they could share about what was happening in Europe, wanting details about the governments of different kings and emperors and their strategies for warfare. He also discussed the Pope and the condition of the Latin Church. Luckily, Matteo and Nicolo spoke Tartar fluently, allowing them to answer all the emperor's questions without any barriers.
![]() |
Kublaï-Khan's feast on the arrival of the Venetian Merchants. |
It had occurred to Kublaï-Khan to send messengers to the Pope; and he seized the opportunity to beg the two brothers to act as his ambassadors to his Holiness. The merchants thankfully accepted his proposal, for they foresaw that this new character would be very advantageous to them. The emperor had some charters drawn up in the Turkish language, asking the Pope to send a hundred learned men to convert his people to Christianity; then he appointed one of his barons named Cogatal to accompany them, and he charged them to bring him some oil from the sacred lamp, which is perpetually burning before the tomb of Christ at Jerusalem.
Kublaï Khan thought it would be a good idea to send messengers to the Pope, so he took the chance to ask the two brothers to be his ambassadors to His Holiness. The merchants gladly accepted his request because they realized this new role would benefit them greatly. The emperor had some documents prepared in Turkish, requesting the Pope to send a hundred educated men to convert his people to Christianity. He then chose one of his barons named Cogatal to accompany them and instructed them to bring back some oil from the sacred lamp that continuously burns before the tomb of Christ in Jerusalem.
The two brothers took leave of the khan, having been furnished with passports by him, which put both men and horses at their disposal throughout the empire, and in 1266 they set out on their journey. Soon the baron Cogatal fell ill, and the Venetians were obliged to leave him and continue their journey; but in spite of all the aid that had been given to them, they were three years in reaching the port of Laïas, in Armenia, now known by the name of Issus. Leaving this port, they arrived at Acre in 1269, where they heard of the death of Pope Clement IV., to whom they were sent, but the legate Theobald lived in Acre and received the Venetians; learning what was the object of their mission he begged them to wait for the election of the new Pope.
The two brothers said goodbye to the khan, who provided them with passports that allowed both them and their horses to travel throughout the empire. In 1266, they began their journey. Shortly after, Baron Cogatal got sick, and the Venetians had no choice but to leave him and continue on. Despite all the support they received, it took them three years to reach the port of Laïas in Armenia, now called Issus. After leaving this port, they got to Acre in 1269, where they learned about the death of Pope Clement IV, who they were supposed to meet. However, the legate Theobald was in Acre and welcomed the Venetians; upon discovering the purpose of their mission, he asked them to wait for the election of the new Pope.
The brothers had been absent from their country for fifteen years, so they resolved to return to Venice, and at Negropont they embarked on board a vessel that was going direct to their native town.
The brothers had been away from their country for fifteen years, so they decided to go back to Venice, and at Negropont they boarded a ship that was going straight to their hometown.
On landing there, Nicolo was met by news of the death of his wife, and of the birth of his son, who had been born shortly after his departure in 1254; this son was the celebrated Marco Polo. The two brothers waited at Venice for the election of the Pope, but at the end of two years, as it had not taken place, they thought they could no longer defer their return to the Emperor of the Mongols; accordingly they started for Acre, taking Marco Polo with them, who could not then have been more than seventeen. At Acre they had an interview with the legate Theobald, who authorized them to go to Jerusalem and there to procure some of the sacred oil. This mission accomplished, the Venetians returned to Acre and asked the legate to give them letters to Kublaï-Khan, mentioning the death of Pope Clement IV.; he complied with their request, and they returned to Laïas or Issus. There, to their great joy, they learnt that the legate Theobald had just been made Pope with the title of Gregory X., on the 1st of September, 1271. The newly-elected Pope sent at once for the Venetian envoys, and the King of Armenia placed a galley at their disposal to expedite their return to Acre. The Pope received them with much affection, and gave them letters to the Emperor of China; he added two preaching friars, Nicholas of Vicenza and William of Tripoli, to their party, and gave them his blessing on their departure. They went back to Laïas, but had scarcely arrived before they were made prisoners by the soldiers of the Mameluke Sultan Bibars, who was then ravaging Armenia. The two preaching friars were so discouraged at this outset of the expedition that they gave up all idea of going to China, and left the two Venetians and Marco Polo to prosecute the journey together as best they could.
On arriving there, Nicolo was greeted with the news of his wife's death and the birth of his son, who had been born shortly after his departure in 1254; this son was the famous Marco Polo. The two brothers waited in Venice for the election of the Pope, but after two years, since it had not happened, they decided they could no longer postpone their return to the Emperor of the Mongols; so they set off for Acre, bringing Marco Polo with them, who couldn’t have been more than seventeen at the time. In Acre, they met with the legate Theobald, who authorized them to go to Jerusalem to obtain some of the sacred oil. Once this mission was completed, the Venetians returned to Acre and requested the legate to give them letters to Kublaï-Khan, mentioning the death of Pope Clement IV.; he agreed to their request, and they went back to Laïas or Issus. There, to their great joy, they learned that the legate Theobald had just been made Pope with the title of Gregory X. on September 1, 1271. The newly-elected Pope immediately called for the Venetian envoys, and the King of Armenia provided a galley to speed up their return to Acre. The Pope welcomed them warmly and gave them letters to the Emperor of China; he also added two friars, Nicholas of Vicenza and William of Tripoli, to their group and blessed them as they set out. They returned to Laïas, but had barely arrived when they were captured by the soldiers of the Mameluke Sultan Bibars, who was then ravaging Armenia. The two friars were so disheartened by this setback that they abandoned all thoughts of going to China and left the two Venetians and Marco Polo to continue the journey together as best they could.
![]() |
Marco Polo. |
Here begins what may properly be called Marco Polo's travels. It is a question if he really visited all the places that he describes, and it seems probable that he did not; in fact, in the narrative written at his dictation by Rusticien of Pisa it is stated "Marco-Polo, a wise and noble citizen of Venice, saw nearly all herein described with his own eyes, and what he did not see he learnt from the lips of truthful and credible witnesses;" but we must add that the greater part of the kingdoms and towns spoken of by Marco Polo he certainly did visit. We will follow the route he describes, simply pointing out what the traveller learnt by hearsay, during the important missions with which he was charged by Kublaï-Khan. During this second journey the travellers did not follow exactly the same road as on the first occasion of their visit to the Emperor of China. They had lengthened their route by passing to the north of the celestial mountains, but now they turned to the south of them, and though this route was shorter than the other, they were three years and a half in accomplishing their journey, being much impeded by the rains and the difficulty of crossing the great rivers. Their course may be easily followed with the help of a map of Asia, as we have substituted the modern names in place of the ancient ones used by Marco Polo in his narrative.
Here starts what can be properly called Marco Polo's travels. There's some debate about whether he actually visited all the places he describes, and it's likely that he didn't; in fact, the account written at his direction by Rusticien of Pisa states, "Marco Polo, a wise and noble citizen of Venice, saw almost everything described here with his own eyes, and what he didn’t see he learned from the words of honest and reliable witnesses." However, we must add that he certainly visited most of the kingdoms and towns mentioned by Marco Polo. We will follow the route he outlines, simply noting what the traveler learned by hearsay during the important missions he was assigned by Kublai Khan. During this second journey, the travelers did not take the exact same path as when they first visited the Emperor of China. They extended their route by going north of the celestial mountains, but now they turned south of them. Although this route was shorter, it took them three and a half years to complete their journey, due to heavy rains and the challenges of crossing the large rivers. Their path can be easily traced with the help of a map of Asia, as we have replaced the ancient names used by Marco Polo with modern ones in his narrative.
MARCO POLO.
Armenia Minor—Armenia—Mount Ararat—Georgia—Mosul, Baghdad, Bussorah, Tauris—Persia—The Province of Kirman—Comadi—Ormuz—The Old Man of the Mountain—Cheburgan—Balkh—Cashmir—Kashgar—Samarcand—Kotan—The Desert—Tangun—Kara-Korum—Signan-fu—The Great Wall—Chang-tou—The residence of Kublaï-Khan—Cambaluc, now Pekin—The Emperor's fêtes—His hunting—Description of Pekin—Chinese Mint and bank-notes—The system of posts in the Empire.
Minor Armenia—Armenia—Mount Ararat—Georgia—Mosul, Baghdad, Bussorah, Tauris—Persia—The Province of Kirman—Comadi—Ormuz—The Old Man of the Mountain—Cheburgan—Balkh—Kashmir—Kashgar—Samarkand—Kotan—The Desert—Tangun—Karakoram—Signan-fu—The Great Wall—Chang-tou—The residence of Kublai Khan—Cambaluc, now Beijing—The Emperor's festivals—His hunting—Description of Beijing—Chinese Mint and banknotes—The postal system in the Empire.
Marco Polo left the town of Issus; he describes Armenia Minor as a very unhealthy place, the inhabitants of which, though once valiant, are now cowardly and wretched, their only talent seeming to lie in their capacity for drinking to excess. From Armenia Minor he went to Turcomania, whose inhabitants, though somewhat of savages, are clever in cultivating pastures and breeding horses and mules; and the townspeople excel in the manufacture of carpets and silk. Armenia Proper, that Marco Polo next visited, affords a good camping-ground to the Tartar armies during the summer. There the traveller saw Mount Ararat, where Noah's Ark rested after the Deluge. He noticed that the lands bordering on the Caspian Sea afford large supplies of naphtha, which forms an important item in the trade of that neighbourhood.
Marco Polo left the town of Issus and described Minor Armenia as a really unhealthy place. The people who live there, once brave, are now timid and miserable, with their main skill seeming to be their ability to drink a lot. From Minor Armenia, he traveled to Turcomania, where the locals, although a bit uncivilized, are skilled at raising livestock and breeding horses and mules. The townspeople are particularly good at making carpets and silk. Next, Marco Polo visited Armenia Proper, which provides a good camping area for Tartar armies during the summer. There, the traveler saw Mount Ararat, where Noah's Ark is said to have landed after the flood. He also noticed that the lands around the Caspian Sea have plenty of naphtha, which is a significant part of the local trade.
When he left Armenia he took a north-easterly course towards Georgia, a kingdom lying on the south side of the Caucasus, whose ancient kings, says the legend, "were born with an eagle traced on their right shoulders." The Georgians, he describes as good archers and men of war, and also as clever in working in gold and manufacturing silk. Here is a celebrated defile, four leagues in length, which lies between the Caucasus and the Caspian Sea, that the Turks call the Iron Door, and Europeans the Pass of Derbend, and here too is the miraculous lake, where fish are said to exist only during Lent. Hence the travellers descended towards the kingdom of Mosul, and arrived at the town of the same name on the right bank of the Tigris, thence going to Baghdad, the residence of the Caliph of all the Saracens. Marco Polo gives an account of the taking of Baghdad by the Tartars in 1255; mentioning a wonderful story in support of the Christian idea of Faith, "that can remove mountains;" he points out the route from this town to the Persian Gulf, which may be reached in eighteen days by the river, passing Bussorah, the country of dates.
When he left Armenia, he headed northeast towards Georgia, a kingdom on the south side of the Caucasus. Legend has it that its ancient kings "were born with an eagle marked on their right shoulders." He describes the Georgians as skilled archers and warriors, as well as talented in goldsmithing and silk production. There's a famous narrow pass, four leagues long, nestled between the Caucasus and the Caspian Sea, which the Turks call the Iron Door and Europeans refer to as the Pass of Derbend. There's also an incredible lake where fish are said to only appear during Lent. From there, the travelers made their way down to the kingdom of Mosul and arrived at the town of the same name on the right bank of the Tigris, then proceeded to Baghdad, the home of the Caliph of all the Saracens. Marco Polo recounts the capture of Baghdad by the Tartars in 1255 and shares an amazing story highlighting the Christian concept of Faith, "that can move mountains." He also outlines the route from this town to the Persian Gulf, which can be reached in eighteen days by river, passing through Bussorah, the land of dates.
From this point to Tauris, a Persian town in the province of Adzer-baidjan, Marco Polo's route seems to be doubtful. He takes up his narrative at Tauris, which he describes as a large flourishing town built in the midst of beautiful gardens and carrying on a great traffic in precious stones and other valuable merchandise, but its Saracen inhabitants are disloyal and treacherous. Here he seems to divide Persia geographically into eight provinces. The natives of Persia, according to him, are formidable enemies to the merchants, who are obliged to travel armed with bows and arrows. The principal trade of the country seems to be in horses and asses, which are sent to Kis or Ormuz and thence to India. The natural productions of the country are wheat, barley, millet, and grapes, which grow in abundance.
From this point to Tabriz, a Persian town in the province of Azerbaijan, Marco Polo's route appears uncertain. He begins his account in Tabriz, which he describes as a large, thriving town surrounded by beautiful gardens and heavily involved in trading precious stones and other valuable goods, but its Saracen residents are disloyal and treacherous. Here, he seems to divide Persia into eight geographical provinces. According to him, the natives of Persia pose a serious threat to merchants, who must travel armed with bows and arrows. The main trade of the country seems to be in horses and donkeys, which are sent to Kis or Ormuz and then to India. The natural products of the land include wheat, barley, millet, and grapes, all of which grow abundantly.
Marco Polo went next to Yezd, the most easterly town of Persia Proper; on leaving it, after a ride of seven days through magnificent forests abounding in game, he came to the province of Kirman. Here the mines yield large quantities of turquoise, as well as iron and antimony; the manufacture of arms and harness as well as embroidery and the training of falcons for hunting occupy a great number of the inhabitants. On leaving Kirman Marco Polo and his two companions set out on a nine days' journey across a rich and populous country to the town of Comadi, which is supposed to be the Memaun of the present day, and was even then sinking into decay. The country was superb; on all sides were to be seen fine fat sheep, great oxen, white as snow, with short strong horns, and thousands of domestic fowls and other birds; also there were magnificent date, orange, and pistachio trees.
Marco Polo next traveled to Yezd, the easternmost town of Persia. After leaving Yezd, he rode for seven days through beautiful forests full of game until he reached the province of Kirman. This area had rich mines that produced large amounts of turquoise, as well as iron and antimony. Many locals were involved in making weapons and harnesses, crafting embroidery, and training falcons for hunting. After leaving Kirman, Marco Polo and his two companions embarked on a nine-day journey through a prosperous and populous region to the town of Comadi, which is believed to be the modern-day Memaun, although it was already declining. The landscape was stunning, with plenty of fat sheep, large white oxen with short, strong horns, and thousands of domestic fowls and other birds. There were also magnificent date, orange, and pistachio trees everywhere.
After travelling for five days they entered the beautiful and well watered plain of Cormos or Ormuz, and after two days' further march they reached the shores of the Persian Gulf and the town of Ormuz, which forms the sea-port of the kingdom of Kirman. This country they found very warm und unhealthy, but rich in date and spice trees, in grain, precious stones, silk and golden stuffs, and elephants' tusks, wine made from the date and other merchandise being brought into the town ready for shipment on board ships with but one mast, which came in numbers to the port; but many were lost on the voyage to India, as they were only built with wooden pegs, not iron nails, to fasten them together.
After traveling for five days, they arrived at the beautiful and well-watered plain of Cormos or Ormuz. After another two days of marching, they reached the shores of the Persian Gulf and the town of Ormuz, which is the seaport of the kingdom of Kirman. They found this country to be very warm and unhealthy, but rich in date and spice trees, grains, precious stones, silk, golden textiles, and elephant tusks. Wine made from dates and other goods were brought into the town, ready to be loaded onto ships with just one mast that frequently arrived at the port. However, many ships were lost on the journey to India because they were built using wooden pegs instead of iron nails to hold them together.
From Ormuz, Marco Polo, going up again towards the north-east, visited Kirman; then he ventured by dangerous roads across a sandy desert, where there was only brackish water to be found, the desert across which, 1500 years before, Alexander had led his army to meet Nearchus. Seven days afterwards he entered the town of Khabis. On leaving this town he crossed for eight days the great plains to Tonokan, the capital of the province of Kumis, probably Damaghan. At this point of his narrative Marco Polo gives an account of the "Old Man of the Mountain," the chief of the Mahometan sect called the Hashishins, who were noted for their religious fanaticism and terrible cruelty. He next visited the Khorassan town of Cheburgan, a city celebrated for its sweet melons, and then the noble city of Balkh, situated near the source of the Oxus. Next he crossed a country infested by lions to Taikan, a great salt-market frequented by a large number of merchants, and to Scasem; this town seems to be the Kashme spoken of by Marsden, the Kishin or Krishin of Hiouen-Tsang, which Sir Henry Rawlinson has identified with the hill of Kharesm of Zend-Avesta, that some commentators think must be the modern Koundouz. In this part of the country he says porcupines abound, and when they are hunted they curl themselves up, darting out the prickles on their sides and backs at the dogs that are hunting them. We now know how much faith to put in this pretended power of defence said to be possessed by the porcupine.
From Ormuz, Marco Polo headed northeast and visited Kirman. He then took risky routes across a sandy desert, where he could only find brackish water— the same desert where Alexander had led his army to meet Nearchus 1500 years earlier. Seven days later, he arrived in the town of Khabis. After leaving this town, he traveled for eight days across vast plains to Tonokan, the capital of the province of Kumis, likely Damaghan. At this point in his story, Marco Polo describes the "Old Man of the Mountain," the leader of the Muslim sect known as the Hashishins, who were famous for their religious zeal and brutal cruelty. He then visited the Khorassan town of Cheburgan, known for its sweet melons, and afterward, the impressive city of Balkh, located near the source of the Oxus River. Next, he crossed a region filled with lions to reach Taikan, a major salt market visited by many merchants, and then to Scasem. This town seems to be the Kashme mentioned by Marsden, which is identified as the Kishin or Krishin of Hiouen-Tsang, and Sir Henry Rawlinson has linked it to the hill of Kharesm in the Zend-Avesta— some commentators believe it could be the modern Koundouz. In this region, he notes that porcupines are plentiful, and when they are hunted, they curl up, shooting out their quills from their sides and backs at the dogs chasing them. We now understand how much credibility to give this supposed defense mechanism attributed to porcupines.
Marco Polo now entered the rocky mountainous kingdom of the Balkhs, whose kings claim descent from Alexander the Great; a cold country, producing good fast horses, excellent falcons, and all kinds of game. Here, too, are prolific ruby-mines worked by the king and which yield large quantities, but they are so strictly enclosed that no one on pain of death may set foot on the Sighinan mountain containing the mines. In other places silver is found, and many precious stones, of which he says "they make the finest azure in the world," meaning lapis-lazuli; his stay in this part of the country must have been a long one to have enabled him to observe so many of its characteristics. Ten days' journey from hence he entered a province which must be the Peshawur of the present day, whose dark-skinned inhabitants were idolaters; then after seven days' further march, about mid-day he came to the kingdom of Cashmere, where the temperature is cool, and towns and villages are very numerous. Had Marco Polo continued his route in the same direction he would soon have reached the territory of India, but instead of that he took a northerly course, and in twelve days was in Vaccan, a land watered by the Upper Oxus, which runs through splendid pastures, where feed immense flocks of wild sheep, called mufflons. Thence he went through a mountainous country, lying between the Altai and Himalayan ranges to Kashgar. Here Marco Polo's route is the same as that of his uncle and his father during their first voyage, when from Bokhara they were taken to the residence of the great khan. From Kashgar, Marco Polo diverged a little to the west, to Samarcand, a large town inhabited by Saracens and Christians, then to Yarkand, a city frequented by caravans trading between India and Northern Asia; passing by Khotan, the capital of the province of that name, and by Pein, a town whose situation is uncertain, but in a part of the country where chalcedony and jasper abound. He came to the kingdom of Kharachar, which extends along the borders of the desert of Jobe; then after five days' further travelling over sandy plains, where there was no water fit to drink, he rested for eight days in the city of Lob, a place now in ruins, while he prepared to cross the desert lying to the east, "so great a desert," he says, "that it would require a year to traverse its whole length, a haunted wilderness, where drums and other instruments are heard, though invisible."
Marco Polo now entered the rocky mountainous kingdom of the Balkhs, whose kings claim descent from Alexander the Great; it's a cold country that produces fast horses, excellent falcons, and all kinds of game. There are also rich ruby mines managed by the king, which yield large quantities, but they are so strictly guarded that no one, under the threat of death, may step foot on the Sighinan mountain containing the mines. In other areas, silver can be found, along with many precious stones, among which he says "they make the finest azure in the world," referring to lapis lazuli; his time in this part of the country must have been lengthy to observe so many of its characteristics. Ten days' journey from there, he entered a province that must be present-day Peshawur, inhabited by dark-skinned idolaters; then after another seven days' march, around noon, he arrived at the kingdom of Cashmere, where the climate is cool and there are many towns and villages. If Marco Polo had continued on the same path, he would have soon reached India, but instead, he took a northern route and, in twelve days, arrived in Vaccan, a land irrigated by the Upper Oxus, which flows through beautiful pastures, home to enormous flocks of wild sheep called mufflons. From there, he traveled through mountainous terrain between the Altai and Himalayan ranges to Kashgar. Here, Marco Polo's route was the same as that of his uncle and father during their first journey when they were taken from Bokhara to the residence of the great khan. From Kashgar, Marco Polo diverged a bit to the west, reaching Samarcand, a large town populated by Saracens and Christians, then moved on to Yarkand, a city frequently visited by caravans trading between India and Northern Asia; he passed through Khotan, the capital of the province of the same name, and Pein, a town with an uncertain location, but in an area where chalcedony and jasper are plentiful. He arrived in the kingdom of Kharachar, which stretches along the borders of the Jobe desert; after five more days of traveling through sandy plains with no drinkable water, he rested for eight days in the city of Lob, a now-ruined place, while he prepared to cross the desert to the east, "so vast a desert," he says, "that it would take a year to cross its entire length, a haunted wilderness where drums and other instruments can be heard, though their sources are invisible."
After spending a year crossing this desert, Marco Polo reached Tcha-tcheou, in the province of Tangaut, a town built on the western limits of the Chinese empire. There are but few merchants here, the greater part of the population being agricultural. The custom that seems to have struck him the most in the province of Tangaut, was that of burning their dead only on a day fixed by the astrologers; "all the time that the dead remain in their houses, the relations stay there with them, preparing a place at each meal as well as providing both food and drink for the corpse, as though it were still alive."
After spending a year crossing this desert, Marco Polo reached Tcha-tcheou, in the Tangaut province, a town located at the western edge of the Chinese empire. There are only a few merchants here; most of the population is involved in farming. The custom that seemed to impress him the most in Tangaut was the practice of burning their dead only on a day chosen by the astrologers; "as long as the dead remain in their homes, the relatives stay there with them, setting a place at each meal and providing both food and drink for the body, as if it were still alive."
Marco Polo and his companions made an excursion to the north-east, to the city of Amil, going on as far as Ginchintalas, a town inhabited by idolaters, Mahometans, and Nestorian Christians, whose situation is disputed. From this town Marco Polo returned to Tcha-tcheou, and went eastward across Tangaut, by the town of So-ceu, over a tract of country particularly favourable to the cultivation of rhubarb, and by Kanpiceon, the Khan-tcheou of the Chinese, then the capital of the province of Tangaut, an important town, whose numerous chiefs are idolaters and polygamists. The three Venetians remained a year in this large city; it is easy to understand, from their long halts and deviations, why they required three years for their journey across Central Asia.
Marco Polo and his companions took a trip to the northeast, reaching the city of Amil and continuing on to Ginchintalas, a town populated by idol worshipers, Muslims, and Nestorian Christians, whose exact location is still debated. From there, Marco Polo returned to Tcha-tcheou and traveled eastward through Tangaut, passing through So-ceu, over an area particularly good for growing rhubarb, and by Kanpiceon, known as Khan-tcheou in Chinese, which was then the capital of the Tangaut province, an important city where many leaders were idolaters and practiced polygamy. The three Venetians spent a year in this large city; it’s easy to see from their many stops and detours why their journey across Central Asia took three years.
They left Khan-tcheou, and after riding for twelve days they reached the borders of a sandy desert, and entered the city of Etzina. This was another détour, as it lay directly north of their route, but they wished to visit Kara-Korum, the celebrated capital of Tartary, where Rubruquis had been in 1254. Marco Polo was certainly an explorer by nature; fatigue was nothing to him if he had any geographical studies to complete, which is proved by his spending forty days crossing an uninhabited desert without vegetation, in order to reach the Tartar town.
They left Khan-tcheou and, after riding for twelve days, reached the edge of a sandy desert and entered the city of Etzina. This was another detour, as it was directly north of their route, but they wanted to visit Kara-Korum, the famous capital of Tartary, where Rubruquis had been in 1254. Marco Polo was definitely an explorer at heart; fatigue meant nothing to him if he had any geographical studies to finish, as shown by his spending forty days crossing a lifeless desert with no vegetation to get to the Tartar town.
When he arrived there, he found a city measuring three miles in circumference, which had been for a long time the capital of the Empire, before it was conquered by Gengis-Khan, the grandfather of the reigning emperor. Here Marco Polo makes an historical digression, in which he gives an account of the wars of the Tartar chiefs against the famous Prester John who held all this part of the country under his dominion.
When he got there, he found a city that was three miles around, which had long been the capital of the Empire before it was taken over by Gengis-Khan, the grandfather of the current emperor. Here, Marco Polo takes a historical detour, where he talks about the wars between the Tartar leaders and the famous Prester John, who ruled over this whole region.
Marco Polo after returning to Khan-tcheou left it again, marching five days towards the east, and arriving at the town of Erginul. Thence he went a little to the south to visit Sining-foo, across a tract of country where grazed great wild oxen and the valuable species of goat which is called the "musk-bearer." Returning to Erginul, they went eastward to Cialis, where there is the best manufactory of cloth made from camels' hair in the world, to Tenduc, a town in the province of the same name, where a descendant of Prester John reigned, but who had given in his submission to the great khan; this was a busy flourishing town: from hence the travellers went to Sinda-tchou, and on beyond the great wall of China as far as Ciagannor, which must be Tzin-balgassa, a pretty town where the emperor lives when he wishes to hawk; for cranes, storks, pheasants, and partridges abound in this neighbourhood.
Marco Polo, after returning to Khan-tcheou, left again, traveling five days east and arriving in the town of Erginul. From there, he headed a bit south to visit Sining-foo, across an area where large wild oxen and the valuable type of goat known as the "musk-bearer" grazed. After returning to Erginul, they went east to Cialis, which has the best camel-hair cloth factory in the world. Then they traveled to Tenduc, a town in the same-named province, where a descendant of Prester John ruled, but who had submitted to the great khan; this was a busy, thriving town. From there, the travelers went to Sinda-tchou and passed beyond the Great Wall of China as far as Ciagannor, which must be Tzin-balgassa, a lovely town where the emperor stays when he wants to hunt; cranes, storks, pheasants, and partridges are plentiful in this area.
At last Marco Polo, his father, and his uncle, reached Ciandu or Tchan-tchou of the present day, called elsewhere in this narrative Clemen-foo. Here Kublaï-Khan received the papal envoys, for he was occupying his summer palace beyond the great wall, north of Pekin, which was then the capital of the empire. The traveller does not tell us what reception he met with, but he describes most carefully the palace, the grandeur of the building of stone and marble, standing in the middle of a park surrounded by walls, enclosing menageries and fountains. Also a building made of reeds, so closely interlaced as to be impenetrable to water; it was a sort of movable kiosk that the great khan inhabited during the fine months of June, July, and August. The weather during the emperor's sojourn in this summer palace could not but be beautiful, for, according to Marco Polo, the astrologers who were attached to the khan's court were charged to scatter all rain and fog by their sorcery, and the travellers seem to believe in the power of these magicians. "These astrologers," he says, "belong to two races, both idolaters; they are learned in all magic and enchantments, above any other men, and what they do is done by the aid of the devil, but they make others believe that they owe their power to the help of God, and their own holiness. These people have the following strange custom: when a man has been condemned and put to death, they take the body, cook, and eat it; but in the case of a natural death they do not eat the body. And you must know that these people of whom I am speaking, who know so many kinds of enchantments, work the wonder I am about to relate. When the great khan is seated at dinner in the principal dining-hall, the table of which is eight cubits in length, and the cups are on the floor ten paces from the table, filled with wine, milk, and other good beverages, these clever magicians, by their arts, make these cups rise by themselves, and without any one touching them, they are placed before the great khan. This has been done before an immense number of people, and is the exact truth; and those skilled in necromancy will tell you that it is quite possible to do this."
At last, Marco Polo, his father, and his uncle arrived at Ciandu, or Tchan-tchou as it's called today, also referred to in this narrative as Clemen-foo. Here, Kublai Khan welcomed the papal envoys while staying in his summer palace beyond the Great Wall, north of Beijing, which was then the capital of the empire. The traveler doesn’t detail how he was received, but he carefully describes the palace, the impressive stone and marble structure set in the middle of a park surrounded by walls, which included menageries and fountains. There was also a building made of reeds, so tightly woven that it was waterproof; it served as a movable kiosk that the great khan occupied during the pleasant months of June, July, and August. The weather during the emperor's stay in this summer palace was undoubtedly beautiful because, as Marco Polo noted, the astrologers at the khan's court were tasked with using their sorcery to clear away rain and fog, and the travelers seem to believe in the power of these wizards. “These astrologers,” he says, “belong to two races, both idolaters; they are knowledgeable in all magic and enchantments, more than anyone else, and their abilities come from the aid of the devil, though they make others believe that their power is granted by God and their own holiness. These people have a strange custom: when a man has been condemned and executed, they take the body, cook it, and eat it; however, in the case of a natural death, they do not consume the body. And you should know that these people, who possess so many kinds of enchantments, perform the remarkable feat I’m about to describe. When the great khan sits down for dinner in the main dining hall, where the table is eight cubits long and the cups are placed on the floor ten paces away, filled with wine, milk, and other fine drinks, these skilled magicians, through their arts, make these cups rise by themselves, and without anyone touching them, they are presented to the great khan. This has happened in front of a huge crowd and is absolutely true; those who excel in necromancy will tell you that it is entirely possible to do this.”
Marco Polo next gives a history of Kublaï, whom he considers to possess more lands and treasures than any man since our first father, Adam. He tells how the great khan ascended the throne in the year 1256, being then eighty-five; he was a man of middle height, rather stout, but of a fine figure, with a good complexion and black eyes. He was a good commander in war, and his talents were put to the proof when his uncle Naïan, having rebelled against him, wished to dispute his power at the head of 400,000 cavalry. Kublaï-Khan collected (in secret) a force of 300,000 horsemen, and 100,000 foot-soldiers, and marched against his uncle. The battle was a most terrible one, so many men being killed, but the khan was victorious, and Naïan, as a prince of the blood royal, was condemned to be sewn up tightly in a carpet, and died in great suffering. After his victory the khan made a triumphal entry into Cathay, capital of Cambaluc, or, as it is now called, Pekin. When Marco Polo arrived at this city he made a long stay there, remaining until the emperor needed his services to undertake various missions into the interior of China. The emperor had a splendid palace at Cambaluc, and the traveller gives so graphic an account of the riches and magnificence of the Mongol sovereigns, that we give it word for word. "The palace is surrounded by a great wall, a mile long each way, four miles in length altogether, very thick, ten feet in height, all white and battlemented. At each corner of this wall is a palace beautiful and rich, in which all the trappings of war belonging to the great khan are kept; his bows, quivers, the saddles and bridles of the horses, the bow-strings, in fact everything that would be wanted in time of war; in the midst of each square is another building, like those at the corner, so that there are eight in all, and each building contains one particular kind of harness or trapping. In the wall on the south side are five doors, the middle or large door only being opened when the emperor wishes to go in or out; near this great gate on either side is a smaller one through which other people may pass, and two others for the same purpose. Inside this wall is another, having also eight buildings to be used in the same manner."
Marco Polo next shares the history of Kublai, whom he believes to have more land and treasure than any man since our first father, Adam. He recounts how the great khan took the throne in 1256 at the age of eighty-five. He was of average height, somewhat stout, but had an impressive figure, good complexion, and black eyes. He was a skilled commander in battle, and his abilities were tested when his uncle Naïan rebelled against him, trying to challenge his power with 400,000 cavalry. Kublai Khan secretly gathered a force of 300,000 horsemen and 100,000 foot soldiers and marched against his uncle. The battle was extremely brutal, with many men killed, but the khan emerged victorious. Naïan, as a member of the royal bloodline, was condemned to be tightly sewn up in a carpet and died in great pain. After his victory, the khan made a triumphant entry into Cathay, the capital of Cambaluc, now known as Beijing. When Marco Polo arrived in this city, he stayed for an extended period until the emperor needed him for various missions into the interior of China. The emperor had an impressive palace in Cambaluc, and the traveler provides such a vivid account of the wealth and grandeur of the Mongol sovereigns that we present it verbatim. "The palace is surrounded by a large wall, a mile long on each side, four miles in total, very thick, ten feet high, all white and battlemented. At each corner of this wall is a beautiful and rich palace where all the war equipment belonging to the great khan is stored; his bows, quivers, saddles, bridles, bowstrings, essentially everything needed in wartime. In the center of each square, there is another building like those at the corners, totaling eight, and each building holds a specific kind of equipment or harness. The wall on the south side has five doors, with the middle or large door only opened when the emperor wants to enter or exit; near this main gate on either side are smaller doors for other people to pass through, plus two additional doors for the same purpose. Inside this wall is another one, also featuring eight buildings used in the same way."
![]() |
Plan of Pekin. |
Thus we see that all these buildings constituted the emperor's armoury and harness-store; we shall not be surprised that there was so much harness to be kept when we know that the emperor possessed a race of horses white as snow, and among them ten thousand mares, whose milk was reserved for the sole use of princes of the blood royal.
Thus we can see that all these buildings made up the emperor's armory and equipment storage. It’s no wonder there was so much equipment to maintain when we know that the emperor had a breed of horses as white as snow, including ten thousand mares, whose milk was exclusively reserved for the royal family.
![]() |
The Emperor's palace at Pekin. |
Marco Polo continues his narrative thus:—"The inner wall has five gates on the south side, answering to those in the outer wall, but on the other sides the walls have only one gate each. In the centre of the enclosure made by these walls, stands the palace, the largest in the world. It has no second story, but the ground-floor is raised about eight feet above the ground. The roof is very high, the walls of the rooms are covered with gold and silver, and on this gold and silver are paintings of dragons, birds, horses, and other animals, so that nothing can be seen but gilding and pictures. The dining-hall is large enough to hold 6000 men, and the number of other rooms is marvellous, and all is so well arranged that it could not be improved. The ceilings are painted vermillion, green, blue, yellow, and all kinds of colours, varnished so as to shine like crystal, and the roof is so well built that it will last for many years. Between the two walls the land is laid out in fields with fine trees in them, containing different species of animals, the musk-ox, white deer, roe-buck, fallow-deer, and other animals, who fill the space between the walls, except the roads reserved for human beings. On the north-western side is a great lake, full of fishes of divers kinds, for the great khan has had several species placed there, and each time that he desires it to be done, he has his will in it. A river rises in this lake and flows out from the grounds of the palace, but no fish escape in it, there being iron and brass nets to prevent their doing so. On the northern side, near an arched doorway, the emperor has had a mound made, a hundred feet in height and more than a mile in circumference; it is covered with evergreen trees, and the emperor, being very fond of horticulture, whenever he hears of a fine tree, sends for it and has it brought by his elephants, with the roots and surrounding soil, the size of the tree being no impediment, and thus he has the finest collection of trees in the world. The hill is called 'green hill,' from its being covered with evergreen trees and green turf, and on the top of the hill is a house. This hill is altogether so beautiful that it is the admiration of every one."
Marco Polo continues his story like this:—"The inner wall has five gates on the south side, matching those in the outer wall, but on the other sides, the walls each have just one gate. In the center of the area enclosed by these walls stands the palace, the largest in the world. It doesn't have a second story, but the ground floor is about eight feet above the ground. The roof is very high, the room walls are covered in gold and silver, and on this gold and silver are paintings of dragons, birds, horses, and other animals, making it look like everything is gilded and decorated. The dining hall is big enough to hold 6000 people, and the number of other rooms is incredible, all arranged so perfectly that it couldn’t be better. The ceilings are painted in vermillion, green, blue, yellow, and all sorts of colors, varnished to shine like crystal, and the roof is built so well that it will last for many years. Between the two walls, the land is divided into fields with fine trees, home to different animal species like musk-oxen, white deer, roe deer, fallow deer, and others, filling the space between the walls, except for the paths reserved for people. On the northwestern side, there’s a large lake, full of various fish, because the great khan has had several species placed there, and whenever he desires, he has it done. A river rises from this lake and flows out from the palace grounds, but no fish can escape it, as there are iron and brass nets in place to prevent that. On the northern side, near an arched doorway, the emperor has built a mound a hundred feet high and more than a mile in circumference; it’s covered with evergreen trees. The emperor, who loves gardening, whenever he hears of a beautiful tree, sends for it and has it brought by elephants, along with its roots and surrounding soil, regardless of the tree’s size, and so he has the finest collection of trees in the world. This hill is called 'green hill' because it’s covered with evergreen trees and green grass, and at the top of the hill is a house. This hill is so beautiful that it amazes everyone."
After Marco Polo has concluded his description of this palace, he gives one of that of the emperor's son and heir; then he speaks of the town of Cambaluc, the old town which is separated from the modern town of Taidu by a canal, the same which divides the Chinese and Tartar quarters of Pekin. The traveller gives many particulars of the emperor's habits, and among other things, he says that Kublaï-Khan has a body-guard of 2000 horse-soldiers; but he adds, "it is not fear that causes him to keep this guard." His meals are real ceremonies, and etiquette is most rigidly enforced. His table is raised above the others, and he always sits on the north side with his principal wife on his right, and lower down his sons, nephews, and relations; he is waited upon by noble barons, who are careful to envelope their mouths and noses in fine cloth of gold, "so that their breath and their odour may not contaminate the food or drink of their lord." When the emperor is about to drink, a band of music plays, and when he takes the cup in his hand, all the barons and every one present, fall on their knees.
After Marco Polo finishes describing the palace, he talks about the emperor's son and heir; then he discusses the town of Cambaluc, the old town that’s separated from the modern town of Taidu by a canal, which also divides the Chinese and Tartar sections of Beijing. The traveler shares many details about the emperor's habits, including that Kublaï-Khan has a bodyguard of 2000 horse-soldiers; however, he notes, "it's not fear that makes him keep this guard." His meals are elaborate ceremonies, and etiquette is strictly observed. His table is raised above the others, and he always sits on the north side with his main wife on his right, and below him are his sons, nephews, and relatives. He is served by noble barons, who make sure to cover their mouths and noses with fine gold cloth, "so that their breath and scent do not contaminate the food or drink of their lord." When the emperor is about to drink, a band plays music, and as soon as he takes the cup in his hand, all the barons and everyone present kneel down.
The principal fêtes given by the grand khan were on the anniversary of his birth, and on the first day of the year. At the first, 12,000 barons were accustomed to assemble round the throne, and to them were presented annually 150,000 garments made of gold and silk and ornamented with pearls, whilst the subjects, idolaters as well as Christians, offered up public prayers. At the second of these fêtes, on the first day of the year, the whole population, men and women alike, appeared dressed in white, following the tradition that white brings good fortune, and every one brought gifts to the king of great value. One hundred thousand richly-caparisoned horses, five thousand elephants covered with handsome cloths and carrying the imperial plate, as well as a large number of camels, passed in procession before the emperor.
The main celebrations held by the grand khan were on his birthday and on the first day of the year. During the birthday celebration, 12,000 barons would gather around the throne, and each year, they received 150,000 garments made of gold and silk, adorned with pearls, while people, both idolaters and Christians, offered public prayers. For the New Year celebration, the entire population, men and women, came dressed in white, following the belief that white brings good luck, and everyone brought valuable gifts for the king. A procession of one hundred thousand beautifully adorned horses, five thousand elephants draped in fine cloth carrying the imperial treasures, and many camels paraded before the emperor.
During the three winter months of December, January, and February, when the khan is living in his winter palace, all the nobles within a radius of sixty days' march are obliged to supply him with boars, stags, fallow-deer, roes, and bears. Besides, Kublaï is a great huntsman himself, and his hunting-train is superbly mounted and kept up. He has leopards, lynxes and fine lions trained to hunt for wild animals, eagles strong enough to chase wolves, foxes, fallow and roe-deer, and, as Marco Polo says, "often to take them too," and his dogs may be counted by thousands. It is about March when the emperor begins his principal hunting in the direction of the sea, and he is accompanied by no less than 10,000 falconers, 500 gerfalcons, and many goshawks, peregrine, and sacred falcons. During the hunting excursion, a portable palace, covered outside with lions' skins and inside with cloth of gold, and carried on four elephants harnessed together, accompanies the emperor everywhere, who seems to enjoy all this oriental pomp and display. He goes as far as the camp of Chachiri-Mongou, which is situated on a stream, a tributary of the river Amoor, and the tent is set up, which is large enough to hold ten thousand nobles. This is his reception-saloon where he gives audiences; and when he wishes to sleep he goes into a tent which is hung all round with ermine and sable furs of almost priceless value. The emperor lives thus till about Easter, hunting cranes, swans, hares, stags, roebucks, &c., and then returns to his capital, Cambaluc.
During the three winter months of December, January, and February, when the khan is at his winter palace, all the nobles within a sixty-day march are required to provide him with boars, stags, fallow deer, roe deer, and bears. Additionally, Kublaï is an avid hunter himself, and his hunting party is exceptionally well-equipped. He has leopards, lynxes, and impressive lions trained to hunt wild animals, as well as eagles powerful enough to chase wolves, foxes, fallow deer, and roe deer, and, as Marco Polo notes, "often catch them too," along with thousands of dogs. Around March, the emperor starts his main hunting expedition toward the sea, accompanied by at least 10,000 falconers, 500 gerfalcons, and many goshawks, peregrine falcons, and sacred falcons. During the hunting trip, a portable palace, covered on the outside with lions' skins and lined inside with cloth of gold, is carried on four elephants working together, accompanying the emperor everywhere, who seems to revel in this display of opulence. He travels as far as the camp of Chachiri-Mongou, located by a stream that is a tributary of the river Amoor, where a large tent is set up that can accommodate ten thousand nobles. This serves as his reception area for audiences; when he wishes to sleep, he retreats to a tent lined with extremely valuable ermine and sable furs. The emperor lives like this until around Easter, hunting cranes, swans, hares, stags, roebucks, etc., before returning to his capital, Cambaluc.
Marco Polo now completes his description of this fine city and enumerates the twelve quarters it contains, in many of which the rich merchants have their palatial houses, for commerce flourishes in this town, and more valuable merchandise is brought to it than to any other in the world. It is the depôt and market for the richest productions of India, such as pearls and precious stones, and merchants come from long distances round to purchase them. The khan has established a mint here for the benefit of trade, and it is an inexhaustible source of revenue to him. The bank-notes, sealed with the emperor's seal, are made of a kind of card-board manufactured from the bark of the mulberry-tree. The card-board thus prepared is cut into various thicknesses according to the value of the money it is supposed to represent. The currency of this money is enforced, none daring to refuse it "on pain of death;" the emperor using it in all his payments, and enforcing its circulation throughout his dominions. Besides this, several times in the year the possessors of precious stones, pearls, gold, or silver, are obliged to bring their treasures to the mint and receive in exchange for them these pieces of card-board, so that, in fact, the emperor becomes the possessor of all the riches in his empire.
Marco Polo now finishes his description of this amazing city and lists the twelve districts it has, many of which have grand houses owned by wealthy merchants, since commerce thrives here. More valuable goods are brought to this city than anywhere else in the world. It's the main hub and market for the richest products from India, like pearls and precious stones, and merchants travel from far away to buy them. The khan has set up a mint here to benefit trade, which serves as a never-ending source of income for him. The banknotes, stamped with the emperor's seal, are made from a type of cardboard produced from mulberry bark. This cardboard is cut into different thicknesses based on the value it represents. The use of this currency is mandatory, with nobody daring to refuse it "on pain of death;" the emperor uses it for all his transactions and enforces its circulation throughout his territory. Additionally, several times a year, owners of precious stones, pearls, gold, or silver must bring their treasures to the mint and exchange them for these cardboard pieces, effectively making the emperor the holder of all the wealth in his empire.
According to Marco Polo the system of the Imperial Government was wonderfully centralized. "The kingdom is divided into thirty-four provinces, and is governed by twelve of the greatest barons living in Cambaluc; in the same palace also reside the intendants and secretaries, who conduct the business of each province. From this central city a great number of roads diverge to the various parts of the kingdom, and on these roads are now post-houses stationed at intervals of twenty-two miles, where well-mounted messengers are always ready to carry the emperor's messages. Besides this, at every three miles on the road there is a little hamlet of about fourteen houses where the couriers live, who carry messages on foot; these men wear a belt round their waists and have a girdle with bells attached to it, that are heard at a long distance; they start at a gallop, quickly accomplishing the three miles and giving the message to the courier who is waiting for it at the next hamlet; thus the emperor receives news from places at long distances from the capital in a comparatively short time." This mode of communication also involved but small expense to Kublaï-Khan, as the only remuneration he gave these couriers was their exemption from taxation, and as to the horses, they were furnished gratuitously by the provinces.
According to Marco Polo, the Imperial Government was incredibly centralized. "The kingdom is split into thirty-four provinces and is run by twelve of the top barons living in Cambaluc; the intendants and secretaries who manage the affairs of each province also live in the same palace. From this central city, many roads branch out to different parts of the kingdom, and along these roads, there are post houses set up every twenty-two miles, where well-mounted messengers are always ready to deliver the emperor's messages. Additionally, every three miles on the road, there is a small settlement of about fourteen houses where the foot couriers live; these couriers wear a belt around their waists and have a girdle with bells attached that can be heard from a long distance; they take off at a gallop, quickly covering the three miles and handing the message to the courier waiting at the next settlement; this way, the emperor receives news from distant areas in a relatively short time." This communication method also cost Kublaï-Khan very little because the only payment he gave these couriers was tax exemption, and the horses were provided free of charge by the provinces.
But if the emperor used his power in this manner to lay heavy burdens upon his subjects, he exerted himself actively for their good, and was always ready to help them; for instance, when their crops were damaged by hail-storms, he not only remitted all taxes, but gave them corn from his own stores, and when there was any great mortality among the flocks and herds in any particular province, he always replaced them at his own expense. He was careful to have a large quantity of wheat, barley, millet, and rice, stored up in years of abundant harvest, so as to keep the price of grain at a uniform rate when the harvest failed. He was particularly careful of the poor who lived in Cambaluc. "He had a list made of all the poorest houses in the town, where they were usually short of food, and supplied them liberally with wheat and other grain according to the size of their families, and bread was never refused to any applying at the palace for it; it is computed that at least 30,000 persons avail themselves of this daily throughout the year. His kindness to his poor subjects makes them almost worship him." The whole affairs of the empire are administered with great care, the roads well kept up and planted with fine trees, so that from a distance their direction can easily be traced. There is no want of wood, and in Cathay they work a number of coal-pits which supply abundance of coal.
But if the emperor used his power to place heavy burdens on his subjects, he also actively worked for their benefit and was always ready to help them. For example, when their crops were damaged by hailstorms, he not only canceled all taxes but also gave them grain from his own stores. When there was a significant loss of livestock in any province, he always replaced them at his own expense. He made sure to store a large amount of wheat, barley, millet, and rice during years of plentiful harvests to keep grain prices stable when the harvests failed. He paid special attention to the poor living in Cambaluc. "He created a list of all the poorest households in the town, where food was usually scarce, and generously supplied them with wheat and other grains based on the size of their families. Bread was never denied to anyone who applied at the palace for it; it's estimated that at least 30,000 people benefit from this daily throughout the year. His kindness to his poor subjects makes them almost revere him." The entire administration of the empire is handled with great care; the roads are well-maintained and lined with beautiful trees, making their paths easy to see from a distance. There's an abundance of wood, and in Cathay, there are several coal pits that supply plenty of coal.
![]() |
Marco Polo remained a long time at Cambaluc, and his intelligence, spirit, and readiness in adapting himself, made him a great favourite with the emperor. He was intrusted with various missions, not only in China, but also to places on the coast of India, Ceylon, the Coromandel and Malabar coasts, and a part of Cochin-China near Cambogia, and between the years 1277 and 1280 he was made governor of Yang-tcheou, and of twenty-seven other towns which were joined with it under the same government. Thanks to the missions on which he was sent, he travelled over an immense extent of country, and gained a great amount of ethnological and geographical knowledge. We can now follow him map in hand through some of these journeys, which were of the greatest service to science.
Marco Polo stayed in Cambaluc for a long time, and his intelligence, charm, and ability to adapt made him a favorite of the emperor. He was assigned various missions, not just in China, but also to places along the coast of India, Ceylon, the Coromandel and Malabar coasts, and parts of Cochin-China near Cambodia. Between 1277 and 1280, he was appointed governor of Yang-tcheou and twenty-seven other towns that were governed together. Because of the missions he undertook, he traveled across a vast area and gained a wealth of ethnological and geographical knowledge. We can now trace his journeys on a map, which were extremely valuable to science.
MARCO POLO.
Tso-cheu—Tai-yen-fou—Pin-yang-fou—The Yellow River—Signan-fou—Szu-tchouan—Ching-tu-fou—Thibet—Li-kiang-fou—Carajan—Yung-tchang—Mien—Bengal—Annam—Tai-ping—Cintingui—Sindifoo—Té-cheu—Tsi-nan-fou—Lin-tsin-choo—Lin-sing—Mangi—Yang-tcheu-fou—Towns on the coast—Quin-say or Hang-tcheou-foo—Fo-kien.
Tso-cheu—Tai-yen-fou—Pin-yang-fou—The Yellow River—Signan-fou—Szu-tchouan—Ching-tu-fou—Tibet—Li-kiang-fou—Carajan—Yung-tchang—Mien—Bengal—Annam—Tai-ping—Cintingui—Sindifoo—Té-cheu—Tsi-nan-fou—Lin-tsin-choo—Lin-sing—Mangi—Yang-tcheu-fou—Coastal towns—Quin-say or Hang-tcheou-foo—Fo-kien.
When Marco Polo had been at Cambaluc some time, he was sent on a mission that kept him absent from the capital for four months. Ten miles southwards from Cambaluc, he crossed the fine river Pe-ho-nor (which he calls the Pulisanghi), by a stone bridge of twenty-four arches, and 300 feet in length, which was then without parallel in the world. Thirty miles further on he came to the town of Tso-cheu, where a large trade in sandal-wood is carried on; at ten days' journey from hence he came to the modern town of Tai-yen-fou, which was once the seat of an independent government. All the province of Shan-si seemed rich in vines and mulberry-trees; the principal industry in the towns was the making of armour for the emperor's use.
When Marco Polo had been in Cambaluc for a while, he was sent on a mission that kept him away from the capital for four months. Ten miles south of Cambaluc, he crossed the beautiful river Pe-ho-nor (which he refers to as the Pulisanghi) on a stone bridge with twenty-four arches, 300 feet long, which was unmatched in the world at that time. Thirty miles later, he arrived at the town of Tso-cheu, where there was a big trade in sandalwood; ten days' journey from there, he reached the modern town of Tai-yen-fou, which used to be the center of an independent government. The entire province of Shan-si seemed rich in vineyards and mulberry trees; the main industry in the towns was producing armor for the emperor.
![]() |
A fine bridge of stone built on twenty-four arches. |
Seven days' journey further on they came to the beautiful commercial city of Pianfou, now called Pin-yang-foo, where the manufacture of silk was carried on. He soon afterwards came to the banks of the Yellow River, which he calls Caramoran or Black River, probably on account of its waters being darkened by the aquatic plants growing in them; at two days' journey from hence he came to the town of Cacianfu, whose position is not now clearly defined. He found nothing remarkable in this town, and leaving it he rode across a beautiful country, covered with towns, country-houses, and gardens, and abounding in game.
Seven days later, they arrived at the beautiful trading city of Pianfou, now known as Pin-yang-foo, famous for its silk production. Soon after, he reached the banks of the Yellow River, which he referred to as Caramoran or Black River, likely due to the dark waters caused by the aquatic plants in it. After a two-day journey from there, he reached the town of Cacianfu, although its exact location is not clearly defined today. He found nothing notable in this town, and after leaving, he rode through a picturesque landscape filled with towns, country houses, and gardens, teeming with wildlife.
In eight days he reached the fine city of Quangianfoo, the ancient capital of the Tâng dynasty, now called Signanfoo, and the capital of Shensi; here reigned Prince Mangalai, the emperor's son, an upright and amiable prince, much loved by his people. He lived in a magnificent palace outside the town, built in the midst of a park, of which the battlemented wall cannot have been less than five miles in circumference.
In eight days, he arrived at the beautiful city of Quangianfoo, the ancient capital of the Tâng dynasty, now known as Signanfoo, and the capital of Shensi. Here ruled Prince Mangalai, the emperor's son, an honest and friendly prince who was very much loved by his people. He resided in a stunning palace just outside the town, set in the middle of a park, with a fortified wall that must have been at least five miles around.
From Signanfoo, the traveller went towards Thibet, across the modern province of Szu-tchouan, a mountainous country intersected by deep valleys, where lions, bears, lynxes, &c., abounded, and after twenty-eight days' march he found himself on the borders of the great plain of Acmelic-mangi. This is a fertile country and produces all kinds of vegetation; ginger is especially cultivated; there is sufficient to supply all the province of Cathay, and so fertile is the soil that according to a French traveller, M. E. Simon, an acre is now worth 15,000 francs, or three francs the metre. In the thirteenth century this plain was covered with towns and country-houses, and the inhabitants lived upon the fruits of the ground, and the produce of their flocks and herds, while the large quantity of game furnished hunters with abundant occupation.
From Signanfoo, the traveler headed toward Tibet, crossing through the modern province of Sichuan, a mountainous area filled with deep valleys, where lions, bears, lynxes, etc., were plentiful. After twenty-eight days of travel, he found himself on the edge of the vast plain of Acmelic-mangi. This is a fertile region that produces all sorts of crops; ginger is particularly cultivated there, and there's enough to supply the entire province of Cathay. The soil is so rich that, according to a French traveler, M. E. Simon, an acre is now worth 15,000 francs, or three francs per meter. In the thirteenth century, this plain was dotted with towns and country houses, and the residents thrived on the fruits of the land and the products of their flocks and herds, while the abundance of game provided hunters with plenty of work.
Marco Polo next visited the town of Sindafou (now Tching-too-foo), the capital of the province of Se-tchu-an, whose population at the present day exceeds 1,500,000 souls. Sindafu, measuring at that time twenty miles round, was divided into three parts, each surrounded with its own wall, and each part had a king of its own before Kublaï-Khan took possession of the town. The great river Kiang ran through the town: it contained large quantities of fish, and from its size resembled a sea more than a river; its waters were covered by a vast number of vessels. Five days after leaving this busy, thriving town Marco Polo reached the province of Thibet, which he says "is very desolate, for it has been destroyed by the war."
Marco Polo next visited the town of Sindafou (now Tching-too-foo), the capital of the province of Se-tchu-an, which today has a population of over 1,500,000 people. Sindafu, which at that time measured twenty miles around, was divided into three sections, each surrounded by its own wall, and each section had its own king before Kublai Khan took control of the town. The great river Kiang flowed through the town; it had a large amount of fish and, because of its size, looked more like a sea than a river; its waters were filled with a vast number of boats. Five days after leaving this busy, thriving town, Marco Polo reached the province of Thibet, which he described as "very desolate, for it has been destroyed by the war."
Thibet abounds in lions, bears, and other savage animals, from which the travellers would have much difficulty in defending themselves had it not been for the quantity of large thick canes that grow there, which are probably bamboos: he says, "the merchants and travellers passing through these countries at night collect a quantity of these canes and make a large fire of them, for when they are burning they make such a noise and crackle so much, that the lions, bears, and other wild beasts take flight to a distance, and would not approach these fires on any account; thus both men, horses, and camels are safe. In another way, too, protection is afforded by throwing a number of these canes on a wood fire, and when they become heated and split, and the sap hisses, the sound is heard at least ten miles off. When any one is not accustomed to this noise, it is so terrifying that even the horses will break away from their cords and tethers; so their owners often bandage their eyes and tie their feet together to prevent their running away." This method of burning canes is still used in countries where the bamboo grows, and indeed the noise may be compared to the loudest explosion of fire-works.
Thibet is full of lions, bears, and other wild animals, making it difficult for travelers to protect themselves. Luckily, there are many large, thick canes growing there, likely bamboos. He explains, "Merchants and travelers passing through these areas at night gather a bunch of these canes and build a big fire. When they burn, they crackle and make a loud noise, causing lions, bears, and other wild creatures to flee far away and not come near the fire. This keeps men, horses, and camels safe. Additionally, throwing some of these canes on a wood fire provides protection. When heated, they split open and the sap hisses, and the sound can be heard at least ten miles away. For anyone not used to that noise, it's so frightening that even horses will break free from their ropes and restraints; to stop this, owners often blindfold them and tie their feet together. This method of burning canes is still practiced in areas where bamboo grows, and the noise can be compared to the loudest firework explosions."
According to Marco Polo, Thibet is a very large province, having its own language; and its inhabitants, who are idolaters, are a race of bold thieves. A large river, the Khin-cha-kiang, flows over auriferous sands through the province; a quantity of coral is found in it which is much used for idols, and for the adornment of the women. Thibet was at this time under the dominion of the great khan.
According to Marco Polo, Tibet is a huge province with its own language, and its residents, who practice idol worship, are known for being daring thieves. A big river, the Khin-cha-kiang, flows through the province over gold-bearing sands; there's a lot of coral found in it that is commonly used for making idols and for decorating women. At this time, Tibet was ruled by the great khan.
The traveller took a westerly direction when he left Sindafou, and crossing the kingdom of Gaindu he must have come to Li-kiang-foo, the capital of the country that is now called Tsi-mong. In this province he visited a beautiful lake which produces pearl-oysters; the fishing is the emperor's property; he also found great quantities of cinnamon, ginger, cloves, and other spices under cultivation.
The traveler headed west when he left Sindafou, and after passing through the kingdom of Gaindu, he likely arrived at Li-kiang-foo, the capital of what is now called Tsi-mong. In this province, he visited a beautiful lake that produces pearl oysters; fishing there is owned by the emperor. He also discovered large amounts of cinnamon, ginger, cloves, and other spices being cultivated.
After leaving the province of Gaindu, and crossing a large river, probably the Irrawaddy, Marco Polo took a south-easterly course to the province of Carajan, which probably forms the north-western part of Yunnan. According to his account all the inhabitants of this province, who are mostly great riders, live on the raw flesh of fowls, sheep, buffaloes, and oxen; the rich seasoning their raw meat with garlic sauce and good spices. This country is infested with great adders, and serpents, "hideous to look upon." These reptiles, probably alligators, were ten feet long, had two legs armed with claws, and with their large heads and great jaws could at one gulp swallow a man.
After leaving the province of Gaindu and crossing a large river, likely the Irrawaddy, Marco Polo headed southeast to the province of Carajan, which probably makes up the northwestern part of Yunnan. According to his account, all the people in this province, who are mostly skilled riders, survive on raw meat from chickens, sheep, buffaloes, and oxen; the wealthy spice up their raw meat with garlic sauce and good seasonings. This area is plagued by huge snakes and "hideous to look at" reptiles. These creatures, probably alligators, were ten feet long, had two legs with claws, and with their large heads and massive jaws, could swallow a man whole in one bite.
Five days' journey west of Carajan, Marco Polo took a new route to the south, and entered the province of Zardandan, whose capital Nocian, is the modern town of Yung-chang. All the inhabitants of the city had teeth of gold; that is to say, they covered their teeth with little plates of gold which they removed before eating. The men of this province employed themselves only in hunting, catching birds, and making war, the hard work all devolving upon the women and slaves. These Zardanians have neither idols nor churches, but they each worship their ancestor, the patriarch of the family. Their tradesmen carry their goods about on barrows like the bakers in France. They have no doctors, but only enchanters, who jump, dance, and play musical instruments around the invalid's bed till he either dies or recovers.
Five days' journey west of Carajan, Marco Polo took a new route south and entered the province of Zardandan, with its capital Nocian, which is the modern town of Yung-chang. All the city's inhabitants had gold teeth; that is, they covered their teeth with small plates of gold that they removed before eating. The men in this province spent their time hunting, catching birds, and waging war, while the hard work fell entirely on the women and slaves. The Zardanians have no idols or churches; instead, each person worships their ancestor, the family patriarch. Their traders transport goods on carts similar to those used by bakers in France. They don't have doctors, only enchanters who jump, dance, and play music around the sick person's bed until they either die or recover.
![]() |
Marco Polo in the midst of the forests. |
Leaving these people with gilded teeth, Marco Polo took the great road which conveys all the traffic between India and Indo-China, and passed by Bhamo, where a market is held three times a week, which attracts merchants from the most distant countries. After riding for fifteen days through forests filled with elephants, unicorns, and other wild animals, he came to the great city of Mien; that is to say, to that part of Upper Burmah, of which the present capital, of recent erection, is called Amarapura. This city of Mien, which may be, perhaps, the old town of Ava now in ruins, or the old town of Paghan situated on the Irrawaddy, possessed a veritable architectural marvel, in two towers, one built of fine stone, and entirely covered with a coating of gold about an inch in thickness, and the other, also of stone, coated with silver, both intended to serve as a tomb for the king of Mien, before his kingdom fell under the dominion of the khan. After visiting this province, the traveller went to Bangala, the Bengal of the present day, which at this time, 1290, did not belong to Kublaï-Khan. The emperor's forces were then engaged in trying to conquer this fertile country, rich in cotton plants, in sugar-canes, &c., and whose magnificent oxen were like elephants in height. From thence, the traveller ventured as far as the city of Cancigu, in the province of the same name, probably the modern town of Kassaye. The natives here tattooed their bodies, and with needles drew pictures of lions, dragons, and birds on their faces, necks, bellies, hands, legs, and bodies, and he who had the greatest number of these pictures they considered the most beautiful of human beings.
Leaving these people with golden teeth, Marco Polo took the main route that carries all the traffic between India and Southeast Asia, passing by Bhamo, where a market is held three times a week, attracting merchants from distant lands. After riding for fifteen days through forests filled with elephants, unicorns, and other wild animals, he arrived at the great city of Mien; that is to say, the part of Upper Burma, where the current capital, recently built, is called Amarapura. This city of Mien may possibly be the old town of Ava, now in ruins, or the old town of Paghan located on the Irrawaddy River, known for a true architectural wonder: two towers, one made of fine stone and completely covered with a gold layer about an inch thick, and the other, also of stone, covered in silver, both intended to serve as tombs for the king of Mien, before his kingdom fell under the rule of the khan. After exploring this province, the traveler went to Bangala, modern-day Bengal, which at this time, in 1290, was not yet under Kublaï Khan's control. The emperor's forces were then trying to conquer this fertile land, rich in cotton, sugarcane, and boasting magnificent oxen that were as tall as elephants. From there, the traveler ventured as far as the city of Cancigu, in the province of the same name, likely the current town of Kassaye. The locals here tattooed their bodies, using needles to create images of lions, dragons, and birds on their faces, necks, bellies, hands, legs, and bodies, and those with the most tattoos were considered the most beautiful humans.
Cancigu was the most southerly point visited by Marco Polo, during this journey. Leaving this city, he went towards the north-east, and by the country of Amu, Anam, and Tonkin, he reached Toloman, now called Tai-ping, after fifteen days' march. There he found that fine race of men, of dark colour, who have crowned their mountains with strong castles, and whose ordinary food is the flesh of animals, milk, rice, and spices.
Cancigu was the southernmost point Marco Polo visited on this journey. After leaving the city, he headed northeast, and through the regions of Amu, Anam, and Tonkin, he reached Toloman, now known as Tai-ping, after a fifteen-day march. There, he encountered a remarkable group of people with dark skin, who have fortified their mountains with strong castles, and their usual diet consists of meat, milk, rice, and spices.
On leaving Toloman, he followed the course of a river for twelve days, and found numerous towns on its banks. Here, as M. Charton truly observes, the traveller is leaving the country known as India beyond the Ganges, and returning towards China. In fact, Marco Polo after leaving Toloman visited the province of Guigui with its capital of the same name, and what struck him most in this country, (and we cannot but think that the bold explorer was also a keen hunter) was the great number of lions that were to be seen about its mountains and plains. Only, commentators are of opinion that the lions he speaks of must have been tigers, for no lions are found in China, but we will give his own words: he says, "There are so many lions in this country, that it is not safe to sleep out of doors for fear of being devoured. And when you are on the river and stop for the night, you must be careful to anchor far from land, for otherwise the lions come to the vessel, seize upon a man, and devour him. The inhabitants of this part of the country are well aware of this, and so take measures to guard against it. These lions are very large and very dangerous, but there are dogs in this country brave enough to attack these lions; it requires two dogs and a man to overcome each lion."
On leaving Toloman, he followed the river for twelve days and found many towns along its banks. Here, as M. Charton rightly points out, the traveler is leaving the region known as India beyond the Ganges and heading back toward China. In fact, after leaving Toloman, Marco Polo visited the province of Guigui, which has the same name as its capital. What amazed him most in this area— and we can't help but think that the daring explorer was also an enthusiastic hunter— was the large number of lions visible in the mountains and plains. However, some commentators believe that the lions he mentions must have actually been tigers, since no lions exist in China. But we will stick to his own words: he says, "There are so many lions in this country that it's not safe to sleep outdoors for fear of being eaten. When you're on the river and stop for the night, you have to be careful to anchor far from shore, or the lions will come to the boat, grab a man, and eat him. The people in this region know this well and take precautions against it. These lions are very large and very dangerous, but there are dogs here brave enough to take on these lions; it takes two dogs and a man to take down each lion."
From this province Marco Polo returned to Sindifu, the capital of the province of Se-chuen, whence he had started on his excursion into Thibet; and retracing the route by which he had set out, he returned to Kublaï-Khan, after having brought his mission to Indo-China to a satisfactory termination. It was probably at this time that the traveller was first entrusted by the emperor with another mission to the south-east of China. M. Pauthier, in his fine work upon the Venetian traveller, speaks of this south-easterly part of China as "the richest and most flourishing quarter of this vast empire and that also about which, since the 16th century, Europeans have had the most information."
From this province, Marco Polo returned to Sindifu, the capital of Se-chuen, where he had begun his trip to Thibet; retracing his route, he went back to Kublaï-Khan after successfully completing his mission in Indo-China. It was probably at this point that the emperor assigned him another mission to the southeast of China. M. Pauthier, in his excellent work on the Venetian traveler, describes this southeastern region of China as "the richest and most prosperous part of this vast empire, and the area about which Europeans have had the most information since the 16th century."
As we return to the route that M. Pauthier has traced on his map, we find that Marco Polo went southwards to Ciangli, probably the town of Ti-choo, and at six days' journey from thence he came to Condinfoo, the present city of Tsi-nan, the capital of the province of Shan-tung, the birthplace of Confucius. It was at that time a fine town and much frequented by silk-merchants, and its beautiful gardens produced abundance of excellent fruit. Three days' march from hence, the traveller came to the town of Lin-tsing, standing at the mouth of the Yu-ho canal, the principal rendezvous for the innumerable boats that carry so much merchandise to the provinces of Mangi and Cathay. Eight days afterwards he passed by Ligui, which seems to correspond to the modern town of Lin-tsin, and the town of Piceu, the first city in the province of Tchang-su; then by the town of Cingui, he arrived at Caramoran, the Yellow River, which he had crossed higher up when he was on his way to Indo-China; here Marco Polo was not more than a league from the mouth of this great river. After crossing it he was in the province of Mangi, a territory included in the Empire of the Soongs.
As we follow the route mapped out by M. Pauthier, we see that Marco Polo traveled south to Ciangli, likely the town of Ti-choo. Six days later, he arrived at Condinfoo, the present city of Tsi-nan, the capital of the Shan-tung province and the birthplace of Confucius. At that time, it was a thriving town popular with silk merchants, and its beautiful gardens were filled with excellent fruits. Three days later, the traveler reached the town of Lin-tsing, located at the mouth of the Yu-ho canal, which served as a major hub for the countless boats transporting a vast amount of goods to the provinces of Mangi and Cathay. Eight days after that, he passed Ligui, which appears to correspond to the modern town of Lin-tsin, and then the town of Piceu, the first city in the province of Tchang-su. Continuing through Cingui, he arrived at Caramoran, the Yellow River, which he had crossed earlier on his journey to Indo-China; at this point, Marco Polo was no more than a league from the mouth of this great river. After crossing it, he found himself in the province of Mangi, a region that was part of the Soong Empire.
Before this province of Mangi belonged to Kublaï-Khan it was governed by a very pacific king, who shunned war, and was very merciful to all his subjects. Marco Polo describes him so well that we will quote his own words. "This last emperor of the Soong dynasty was most generous, and I will cite but two noble traits to show this; every year he had nearly 20,000 infants brought up at the royal charge, for it was the custom in these provinces, when a poor woman could not bring up a child herself, to cast it away as soon as it was born, to die. The king had all these children taken care of, and a record kept of the sign and the planet under which each was born, and then they were sent to different places to be brought up, for there are a quantity of nurses. When a rich man had no sons, he came to the king and asked of him some of his wards, who were immediately given to him. As the children grew up they intermarried, and the king gave them sufficient incomes to live upon. When he went through his dominions and saw a small house among several much larger ones, he inquired why this house was smaller than those near it, and if he found it was on account of the poverty of the owner, he immediately had it made as large as the others at his own expense. He was always waited upon by a thousand pages and a thousand girls. He kept up such rigorous discipline throughout his kingdom that there was never any crime; at night, houses and shops remained open, and nothing was taken from them, and travelling was as safe by night as by day."
Before the province of Mangi was governed by Kublaï Khan, it was ruled by a very peaceful king who avoided war and treated all his subjects with great mercy. Marco Polo describes him so well that we’ll quote his exact words: "This last emperor of the Song dynasty was incredibly generous, and I'll highlight two noble traits to illustrate this; each year, he had nearly 20,000 infants raised at the royal expense, as it was common in these provinces for a poor woman unable to care for her child to abandon it right after birth to die. The king ensured all these children were well cared for and kept a record of the sign and planet under which each was born, then they were sent to various places to be raised, as there were many nurses available. When a wealthy man had no sons, he would approach the king and request some of his wards, who were immediately given to him. As the children grew up, they intermarried, and the king provided them with enough income to live on. When he toured his lands and noticed a small house among larger ones, he would ask why it was smaller, and if he discovered it was due to the owner’s poverty, he would immediately have it enlarged to match the others at his own expense. He was always attended by a thousand pages and a thousand girls. He maintained such strict discipline throughout his kingdom that there was never any crime; at night, houses and shops remained open, and nothing was stolen, making travel just as safe at night as it was during the day."
Marco Polo came first to the town of Coigangui, now called Hoang-fou, on the banks of the Yellow River, where the principal industry is the preparation of the salt found in the salt marshes. One day's journey from this town he came to Pau-in-chen, famous for its cloth of gold, and the town of Caiu, now Kao-yu, whose inhabitants are clever fishermen and hunters, then to the city of Tai-cheu, where numerous vessels are generally to be found, and at last to the city of Yangui.
Marco Polo first arrived in the town of Coigangui, now known as Hoang-fou, located by the Yellow River, where the main industry is processing the salt from the salt marshes. After a day's journey from this town, he reached Pau-in-chen, known for its gold cloth, and the town of Caiu, now Kao-yu, whose people are skilled fishermen and hunters. He then traveled to the city of Tai-cheu, which typically has many vessels, and finally arrived in the city of Yangui.
This town of Yangui, of which Marco Polo was the governor for three years, is the modern Yang-tchou; it is a very populous and busy town, and cannot be less than two leagues in circumference. It was from Yangui that the traveller set out on the various expeditions which enabled him to see so much of the inland and sea-coast towns.
This town of Yangui, where Marco Polo was the governor for three years, is today's Yang-tchou; it is a very crowded and active town, and it must be at least two leagues around. From Yangui, the traveler embarked on the various journeys that allowed him to explore many inland and coastal towns.
First, the traveller went westward to Nan-ghin, which must not be confounded with Nan-kin of the present day. Its modern name is Ngan-khing, and it stands in the midst of a remarkably fertile province. Further on in the same direction he came to Saianfu, which is now called Siang-yang, and is built in the northern part of the province of Hou-pe. This was the last town in the province of Mangi that resisted the dominion of Kublaï-Khan; he besieged it for three years, and he owed his taking it at last to the help of the three Polos, who constructed some powerful balistas and crushed the besieged under a perfect hail-storm of stones, some of which weighed as much as three hundred pounds. From Saianfu Marco Polo retraced his steps that he might visit some of the towns on the sea-coast. He visited Kui-kiang on the river Kiang, which is very broad here, and upon which 5000 ships can sail at the same moment; Kain-gui, which supplies the Emperor's palace with corn; Ching-kiang where are two Nestorian Christian churches; Ginguigui, now Tchang-tcheou, a busy thriving city; and Singui, now called Soo-choo, a large town, which, according to the very exaggerated account of the Venetian traveller, has no less than 6000 bridges.
First, the traveler went west to Nan-ghin, which shouldn't be confused with present-day Nan-kin. Its modern name is Ngan-khing, and it’s located in the heart of a highly fertile province. Continuing in the same direction, he reached Saianfu, now known as Siang-yang, situated in the northern part of the province of Hou-pe. This was the last town in the province of Mangi to resist Kublaï Khan's rule; he besieged it for three years, and he finally captured it with help from the three Polos, who built powerful ballistae and pummeled the defenders under a relentless storm of stones, some weighing as much as three hundred pounds. After Saianfu, Marco Polo retraced his steps to visit some towns along the coast. He visited Kui-kiang on the Kiang River, which is very wide here, allowing 5,000 ships to sail simultaneously; Kain-gui, which provides corn for the Emperor's palace; Ching-kiang, home to two Nestorian Christian churches; Ginguigui, now Tchang-tcheou, a busy and thriving city; and Singui, now called Soo-choo, a large town that, according to the very exaggerated account of the Venetian traveler, has no fewer than 6,000 bridges.
After spending some time at Vugui, probably Hou-tcheou, and at Ciangan, now Kia-hing, Marco Polo reached the fine city of Quinsay, after three days' march. This name means the "City of Heaven," but it is now called Hang-chow-foo. It is six leagues round; the river Tsien-tang-kiang flows through it, and by its constant windings, makes Quinsay almost a second Venice. This ancient capital of the Soongs is almost as populous as Pekin; its streets are paved with stones and bricks, and if we may credit Marco Polo's statement, it contained "600,000 houses, 4000 bathing establishments, and 12,000 stone bridges." In this city dwell the richest merchants in the world with their wives, who are "beautiful and angelic creatures." It is the residence of a viceroy, who has besides, 140 other cities under his dominion. Here was to be seen also the palace of the Mangi sovereigns surrounded by beautiful gardens, lakes, and fountains, the palace itself containing more than a thousand rooms. Kublaï-Khan draws immense revenues from this town and province, and it is by tens of thousands of pounds we must reckon the income derived from the sugar, salt, spices, and silk, which form the principal productions of this country. At one day's journey south from Quinsay, Marco Polo visited Chao-hing, Vugui, or Hou-tcheou, Ghengui or Kui-tcheou, Cianscian or Yo-tcheou-fou (according to M. Charton), and Sonï-tchang-fou (according to M. Pauthier), and Cugui or Kiou-tcheou, the last town in the kingdom of Quinsay; thence he entered the kingdom of Fugui, whose chief town of the same name is now called Fou-tcheou-foo, the capital of the province of Fo-kien. According to Marco Polo, the inhabitants of this province are a cruel warlike race, never sparing their enemies, of whom, after they have killed them, they drink the blood and eat the flesh. After passing by Quenlifu, now Kien-ning-foo, and Unguen, the traveller entered Fugui, probably the modern town of Kuant-tcheou (called Canton amongst us), and the chief town of the province, where a large trade in pearls and precious stones was carried on, and in five days he reached the port of Zaitem, probably the Chinese town of Tsiuen-tcheou, which was the extreme point reached by him in this exploration of south-eastern China.
After spending some time at Vugui, likely Hou-tcheou, and at Ciangan, now Kia-hing, Marco Polo arrived at the impressive city of Quinsay after a three-day journey. This name means "City of Heaven," but it is now called Hang-chow-foo. It covers an area of six leagues; the Tsien-tang-kiang river flows through it, and its meandering paths make Quinsay almost like a second Venice. This ancient capital of the Soongs is nearly as populated as Beijing; its streets are paved with stone and brick, and if we trust Marco Polo's account, it had "600,000 houses, 4,000 baths, and 12,000 stone bridges." The wealthiest merchants in the world live here with their "beautiful and angelic" wives. It is also home to a viceroy who oversees 140 other cities. Here one could also see the palace of the Mangi sovereigns surrounded by stunning gardens, lakes, and fountains, with the palace itself having more than a thousand rooms. Kublaï Khan collects significant taxes from this city and province, and the income from sugar, salt, spices, and silk, the main products of this area, amounts to tens of thousands of pounds. A day's journey south from Quinsay, Marco Polo visited Chao-hing, Vugui or Hou-tcheou, Ghengui or Kui-tcheou, Cianscian or Yo-tcheou-fou (according to M. Charton), Sonï-tchang-fou (according to M. Pauthier), and Cugui or Kiou-tcheou, the last town in the kingdom of Quinsay; from there, he entered the kingdom of Fugui, whose main town of the same name is now called Fou-tcheou-foo, the capital of Fo-kien province. According to Marco Polo, the people of this province are a brutal warlike group, showing no mercy to their enemies, of whom they reportedly drink the blood and eat the flesh after killing. After passing Quenlifu, now Kien-ning-foo, and Unguen, the traveler entered Fugui, likely the modern town of Kuant-tcheou (known as Canton to us), the main town of the province, where a large trade in pearls and precious stones was conducted, and in five days he reached the port of Zaitem, probably the Chinese town of Tsiuen-tcheou, which was the farthest point he reached in this exploration of southeastern China.
MARCO POLO.
Japan—Departure of the three Venetians with the Emperor's daughter and the Persian ambassadors—Sai-gon—Java—Condor—Bintang—Sumatra—The Nicobar Islands—Ceylon—The Coromandel coast—The Malabar coast—The Sea of Oman—The island of Socotra—Madagascar—Zanzibar and the coast of Africa—Abyssinia—Yemen—Hadramaut and Oman—Ormuz—The return to Venice—A feast in the household of Polo—Marco Polo a Genoese prisoner—Death of Marco Polo about 1323.
Japan—The departure of three Venetians with the Emperor's daughter and the Persian ambassadors—Sai-gon—Java—Condor—Bintang—Sumatra—The Nicobar Islands—Ceylon—The Coromandel coast—The Malabar coast—The Sea of Oman—The island of Socotra—Madagascar—Zanzibar and the coast of Africa—Abyssinia—Yemen—Hadramaut and Oman—Ormuz—The return to Venice—A feast in the Polo household—Marco Polo as a Genoese prisoner—Death of Marco Polo around 1323.
Marco Polo returned to the court of Kublaï-Khan when he had finished the expedition of which we spoke in the last chapter. He was then entrusted with several other missions, in which he found his knowledge of the Turkish, Chinese, Mongolian, and Mantchorian languages of the greatest use. He seems to have taken part in an expedition to the islands in the Indian Ocean, and he brought back a detailed account of this hitherto little known sea. There is a want of clearness as to dates at this part of his life, which makes it difficult to give a correct narrative of these voyages in their right order. He gives a circumstantial account of the Island of Cipango, a name applying to the group of islands which make up Japan; but it does not appear that he actually entered that kingdom. This country was famous for its wealth, and about 1264, some years before Marco Polo arrived at the Tartar court, Kublaï-Khan had tried to conquer it and sent his fleet there with that purpose. They had taken possession of a citadel and put all its valiant defenders to the edge of the sword, but just at the moment of apparent victory a storm arose and dispersed all the enemy's fleet, and thus the expedition was useless. Marco Polo gives a long account of this attempt, and adds many curious particulars as to Japanese customs.
Marco Polo returned to the court of Kublai Khan after completing the expedition we discussed in the last chapter. He was then given several other assignments, where his knowledge of Turkish, Chinese, Mongolian, and Manchurian languages proved incredibly useful. He seems to have participated in an expedition to the islands in the Indian Ocean, bringing back a detailed account of this previously little-known sea. There’s some ambiguity regarding the dates during this period of his life, making it challenging to provide an accurate timeline of these journeys. He provides a detailed description of the Island of Cipango, which refers to the group of islands that make up Japan; however, it doesn’t seem that he actually entered that nation. This country was known for its riches, and around 1264, a few years before Marco Polo arrived at the Tartar court, Kublai Khan had attempted to conquer it and sent his fleet for that purpose. They captured a citadel and executed all of its brave defenders, but just at the moment of seeming victory, a storm struck and scattered the entire fleet, making the expedition a failure. Marco Polo offers a lengthy account of this attempt and includes many interesting details about Japanese customs.
Marco Polo, with his father and uncle, had now been seventeen years in the service of Kublaï-Khan, and even longer absent from their own country; they had a great wish to revisit it, but the Emperor had become so much attached to them, and valued their services so highly, that he could not make up his mind to part with them. He tried in every way to shake their resolution, offering them riches and honour if only they would remain with him, but they still held to their plan of returning to Europe; the Emperor then absolutely refused to allow them to go, and Marco Polo could find no means of eluding the surveillance of which he was the object, until circumstances arose which quite changed Kublaï-Khan's resolution.
Marco Polo had been with his father and uncle in the service of Kublai Khan for seventeen years, and they had been away from their homeland even longer. They really wanted to go back, but the Emperor had grown so fond of them and valued their contributions so much that he struggled to let them go. He tried everything to convince them to stay, offering them wealth and status, but they were determined to return to Europe. The Emperor then outright refused to let them leave, and Marco Polo couldn’t figure out a way to escape the watchful eye he was under, until a situation arose that completely changed Kublai Khan's mind.
A Mongol prince, named Arghun, whose dominions were in Persia, had sent an ambassador to the Emperor to ask one of the princesses of the blood royal, in marriage. Kublaï-Khan acceded to his request and sent off his daughter Cogatra to Prince Arghun, attended by a numerous suite; but the countries by which they endeavoured to travel were not safe; the caravan was soon stopped by disturbances and rebellions, and after some months was obliged to return to the Emperor's palace. The Persian ambassadors had heard Marco Polo spoken of as a clever navigator who had had some experience of the Indian Ocean, and they begged the Emperor to confide the Princess Cogatra to his care, that he might conduct her to her future husband, thinking that the voyage by sea would probably be attended by less danger than a land journey.
A Mongol prince named Arghun, who ruled in Persia, sent an ambassador to the Emperor asking for one of the royal princesses to marry. Kublai Khan agreed to his request and sent his daughter Cogatra to Prince Arghun, accompanied by a large entourage. However, the routes they attempted to take were unsafe; the caravan was quickly halted by unrest and rebellions, and after several months, they had to return to the Emperor's palace. The Persian ambassadors had heard of Marco Polo as a skilled navigator with experience in the Indian Ocean, and they asked the Emperor to trust him with the Princess Cogatra, so he could take her to her future husband, believing that traveling by sea would likely be safer than a land journey.
After some demur Kublaï-Khan acceded to their request, and equipped a fleet of forty four-masted vessels, provisioning them for two years. Some of these were very large, having a crew of 250 men, for this was an important expedition worthy of the opulent Emperor of China. Matteo, Nicolo, and Marco Polo set out with the Chinese princess and the Persian ambassadors, and it was during this voyage, which lasted eighteen months, that it seems most probable that Marco Polo visited the islands of Sunda and other islands in the Indian Ocean, as well as Ceylon and the towns on the coast of India. We will follow him in his voyage and give his description of the places that he visited in this hitherto little known portion of the globe.
After some hesitation, Kublai Khan agreed to their request and prepared a fleet of forty ships with four masts, stocking them for two years. Some of these ships were quite large, manned by 250 crew members, as this was an important expedition worthy of the wealthy Emperor of China. Matteo, Nicolo, and Marco Polo set off with the Chinese princess and the Persian ambassadors, and during this trip, which lasted eighteen months, it’s most probable that Marco Polo visited the Sunda Islands and various other islands in the Indian Ocean, as well as Ceylon and the towns along the coast of India. We will follow his journey and share his descriptions of the places he explored in this previously little-known part of the world.
![]() |
Kublaï-Khan equips a fleet. |
It must have been about 1291 or 1292 that the fleet left the port of Zaitem, under the command of Marco Polo. He steered first for Tchampa, a great country situated at the south of Cochin China, and which contains the present province of Saïgon, belonging to France. This was not a new country to Marco Polo, as he had visited it about 1280, when he was on a mission for the Emperor. At this time, Tchampa was under the dominion of the grand khan, and paid him an annual tribute in elephants; when Marco Polo visited this country before its conquest by Kublaï-Khan, he found the reigning king had no less than 326 children, of whom 150 were old enough to carry arms.
It was around 1291 or 1292 when the fleet left the port of Zaitem, led by Marco Polo. He headed first for Tchampa, a large region located south of Cochin China, which includes the modern province of Saïgon, currently part of France. This wasn’t a new place for Marco Polo, as he had been there around 1280 on a mission for the Emperor. At that time, Tchampa was under the rule of the grand khan and paid him an annual tribute in elephants. When Marco Polo visited before its conquest by Kublaï-Khan, he discovered that the reigning king had no less than 326 children, of whom 150 were old enough to bear arms.
Leaving the peninsula of Cambodia, the fleet went in the direction of Java, the rich island that Kublaï-Khan had never been able to subjugate, where abundance of pepper, cloves, nutmegs, &c., grew. After putting into port at Condor and Sandur, at the extremity of the peninsular of Cochin China, they reached the island of Pentam (Bintang), situated near the eastern entrance of the straits of Malacca, and the island of Sumatra, called Little Java. "This island is so much in the south," he says, "that they never see there the polar star," which is true as far as the inhabitants of the southern part are concerned. It is very fertile, aloes growing most luxuriantly; and here wild elephants and rhinoceroses (called by Marco Polo unicorns) are found, and apes, too, in large numbers. The fleet was detained five months on these shores by contrary winds, and the traveller made the most of his time in visiting the principal provinces of the island, such as Samara, Dagraian, and Labrin (which boasts a great number of men with tails—evidently apes), and the island of Fandur or Panchor, where the sago-tree grows, from which a kind of flour is obtained that makes very good bread.
Leaving the peninsula of Cambodia, the fleet headed toward Java, the wealthy island that Kublai Khan had never managed to conquer, known for its abundance of pepper, cloves, nutmeg, and other spices. After stopping at Condor and Sandur at the far end of the Cochin China peninsula, they arrived at the island of Pentam (Bintang), located near the eastern entrance of the Strait of Malacca, and then reached Sumatra, referred to as Little Java. "This island is so far south," he says, "that they never see the polar star," which is true for the inhabitants of the southern region. It is very fertile, with aloes growing abundantly; wild elephants and rhinoceroses (which Marco Polo called unicorns) are found there, as well as a large number of apes. The fleet was stuck on these shores for five months due to unfavorable winds, and the traveler took this opportunity to explore the main provinces of the island, including Samara, Dagraian, and Labrin (which claims to have many men with tails—clearly referring to apes), and the island of Fandur or Panchor, where the sago tree grows, providing a type of flour that makes excellent bread.
At last the wind changed, and enabled the vessels to leave Little Java, and after touching at Necaran, which must be one of the Nicobar Islands, and at the Andaman group, whose inhabitants are still cannibals, as they were in the time of Marco Polo, the fleet took a south-westerly course and arrived on the coast of Ceylon. "This island," says the traveller in his narrative, "was once much larger, for according to the map of the world that the pilots of these seas carry, it was once 3600 miles in circumference but the north wind blows with such force in these parts that it caused a part of the island to be submerged." This tradition is still held by the inhabitants of Ceylon. Here are collected in abundance, rubies, sapphires, topaz, amethysts, and other precious stones, such as garnets, opals, agates, and sardonyx. The king of the country was the possessor at this time of a most splendid ruby as long as the palm of the hand, as thick as a man's arm, and red as fire, which excited the envy of the grand khan, who vainly tried to induce its possessor to part with it, offering a whole city in exchange, but that could not tempt the King to let him have the jewel.
At last, the wind changed, allowing the ships to leave Little Java. After stopping at Necaran, one of the Nicobar Islands, and the Andaman group, whose people are still cannibals like they were in Marco Polo's time, the fleet headed southwest and arrived on the coast of Ceylon. "This island," the traveler notes in his narrative, "was once much larger; according to the world map that the pilots of these seas carry, it used to be 3,600 miles in circumference, but the north wind blows so forcefully in these parts that it caused a part of the island to sink." This belief is still held by the inhabitants of Ceylon. The island is rich in rubies, sapphires, topaz, amethysts, and other precious stones like garnets, opals, agates, and sardonyx. At that time, the king of the country owned a magnificent ruby the size of a person's palm, as thick as a man's arm, and as red as fire, which sparked envy in the grand khan. He tried in vain to persuade the king to part with it, even offering an entire city in exchange, but the king was not tempted to give up the jewel.
Sixty miles west of Ceylon the travellers came to Maabar, a great province on the coast of India. This must not be mistaken for Malabar, which is situated on the west coast of the Indian peninsula. This Maabar forms the southern part of the Coromandel coast, and is celebrated for its pearl fisheries. Here the magicians are at work, and are said to render the monsters of the deep harmless to the fishermen; they are astrologers whose race is perpetuated even to modern times. Marco Polo gives some interesting details of the customs of the natives, one is that when a king dies, the nobles throw themselves into the fire in his honour; another strange custom is that of the religious purifications twice every day, and their blind faith in astrologers and diviners; he also speaks of the frequency of religious suicides, and the sacrifice of widows whom the funeral pile awaits on the death of their husbands. He also notices the skill in physiognomy evinced by the natives.
Sixty miles west of Sri Lanka, the travelers arrived at Maabar, a large province on the coast of India. This shouldn’t be confused with Malabar, which is on the west coast of the Indian peninsula. Maabar makes up the southern part of the Coromandel coast and is famous for its pearl fisheries. Here, magicians are said to make the creatures of the sea safe for fishermen; they are astrologers whose legacy continues into modern times. Marco Polo shares some fascinating details about the locals' customs: one is that when a king dies, the nobles throw themselves into the fire to honor him; another unusual custom is that of religious purifications performed twice daily, along with their unwavering belief in astrologers and diviners. He also mentions the high rate of religious suicides and the sacrifice of widows who are expected to join their husbands on the funeral pyre. He also notes the natives' skill in reading faces.
The next resting-place of the fleet was Muftili, of which the capital is now called Masulipatam, the chief city of the kingdom of Golconda. This country was well governed by a queen, a widow for forty years, who desired to remain faithful to the memory of her husband. The country contained many valuable diamond mines, but these were unfortunately among mountains where serpents abounded; the miners had recourse to a strange device when collecting the precious stones, to protect themselves from these reptiles, which we may believe or not as we choose. Marco Polo says: "They take several pieces of meat, and throw them among the pointed rocks, where no man can go, and the meat, falling upon the diamonds, they become attached to it. Now, among these mountains live a number of white eagles, who hunt the serpents, and when they see the meat at the foot of the precipices they swoop down and carry it away. At the moment the men who have been following the eagles' movements see them alight to eat the meat, they raise fearful cries, the meat is dropped and the eagles take to flight, and thus the men have no difficulty in taking the diamonds that are attached to the meat. Diamonds are often found on the mountains, mingled with the excrement of the eagles."
The fleet's next stop was Muftili, which is now known as Masulipatam, the main city of the kingdom of Golconda. This area was well ruled by a queen, who had been a widow for forty years and wanted to stay true to her husband's memory. The country was rich with valuable diamond mines, but they were located in mountainous regions filled with snakes. To protect themselves from these reptiles while mining for the precious stones, the miners employed a peculiar method, which we can either believe or not. Marco Polo writes: "They take several pieces of meat and throw them among the jagged rocks, where no man can go. The meat falls onto the diamonds and sticks to them. In these mountains, there are many white eagles that hunt the snakes. When they see the meat at the base of the cliffs, they swoop down and grab it. When the miners, who have been watching the eagles, see them land to eat the meat, they shout loudly, causing the eagles to drop the meat and fly off. This way, the miners can easily gather the diamonds stuck to the meat. Diamonds are often found in the mountains mixed with the eagles' droppings."
After visiting the small town of St. Thomas, situated some miles to the south of Madras, where St. Thomas the apostle is said to be buried, the travellers explored the kingdom of Maabar and especially the province of Lar, from whence spring all the "Abrahamites" of the world, probably the Brahmins. These men, he says, live to a great age, owing to their abstinence and sobriety; some have been known to attain 150 and even 200 years of age; their diet is principally rice and milk, and they drink a mixture of sulphur and quicksilver. These "Abrahamites" are clever merchants, superstitious, however, but remarkably sincere, and never guilty of theft of any kind; they never kill any living thing, and they worship the ox, which is a sacred animal among them.
After visiting the small town of St. Thomas, located a few miles south of Madras, where St. Thomas the apostle is said to be buried, the travelers explored the kingdom of Maabar, especially the province of Lar, the origin of all the "Abrahamites" in the world, likely the Brahmins. These individuals, he notes, live to a great age due to their abstinence and sobriety; some are known to reach 150 and even 200 years of age. Their diet mainly consists of rice and milk, and they drink a mixture of sulfur and quicksilver. These "Abrahamites" are skilled merchants, although superstitious, yet remarkably sincere, never engaging in any form of theft. They refrain from killing any living creature and worship the ox, which is considered a sacred animal to them.
The fleet now returned to Ceylon, where in 1284 Kublaï-Khan had sent an ambassador who had brought him back some pretended relics of Adam, and among other things two of his molar teeth; for, if we can believe the Saracen traditions, the tomb of our first father must have been on the summit of one of the precipitous mountains, which forms the highest ground in the island. After losing sight of Ceylon, Marco Polo went to Cail, a port that we do not find marked on any of the modern maps, but a place where all the vessels touched coming from Ormuz, Kiss, Aden, and the coasts of Arabia. Thence doubling Cape Comorin they came to Coilum, now Quilon, which was a very thriving city in the thirteenth century. It is there that a great quantity of sandal-wood and indigo is found, and merchants come in large numbers from the Levant and from the West to trade in both. The country of Malabar produces a great quantity of rice, and wild animals are found there, such as leopards, which Marco Polo calls "black lions," also peacocks of much greater beauty than those of Europe, as well as different kinds of parroquets.
The fleet returned to Ceylon, where in 1284 Kublai Khan sent an ambassador who brought back some supposed relics of Adam, including two of his molar teeth. According to Saracen traditions, the tomb of our first father is believed to be on the summit of one of the steep mountains, which is the highest point in the island. After losing sight of Ceylon, Marco Polo went to Cail, a port not found on any modern maps, but a place where all ships passed through coming from Ormuz, Kiss, Aden, and the Arabian coasts. From there, they rounded Cape Comorin and arrived at Coilum, now called Quilon, which was a bustling city in the thirteenth century. A large quantity of sandalwood and indigo can be found there, attracting many merchants from the Levant and the West to trade. The Malabar region produces a great amount of rice and is home to wild animals like leopards, which Marco Polo refers to as "black lions," as well as peacocks that are far more beautiful than those in Europe and various types of parrots.
The fleet, leaving Coilum, and advancing northwards along the Malabar coast, arrived at the shores of the kingdom of Maundallay, which derives its name from a mountain situated on the borders of Kanara and Malabar; here pepper, ginger, saffron, and other spices abound. To the north of this kingdom extended that country which the Venetian traveller calls Melibar, and which is situated to the north of Malabar proper. The vessels of the Mangalore merchants came here to trade with the natives of this part of India for cargoes of spices, a fine kind of cloth called buckram and other valuable wares; but their vessels were frequently attacked, and too often pillaged by the pirates who infested these seas, and who were justly regarded as formidable enemies. These pirates principally inhabit the peninsula of Gohourat, now called Gujerat, where the fleet was on its way after calling at Tana—a country where is collected the frankincense—and Canboat, now Kambay, a town where there is a great trade in leather. Visiting Sumenath, a city of the peninsula, whose inhabitants are cruel, ferocious, and idolaters, and Kesmacoran, the modern city of Kedje, the capital of Makran, situated on the Indus near the sea, and the last town in India on the northwest, Marco Polo went westward across the sea of Oman, instead of going to Persia, which was the destination of the princess.
The fleet left Coilum and headed north along the Malabar coast, reaching the shores of the kingdom of Maundallay, named after a mountain at the border of Kanara and Malabar; this area is rich in pepper, ginger, saffron, and other spices. To the north of this kingdom lies the region known as Melibar, located above Malabar. The ships of Mangalore merchants came here to trade with the locals for spice cargoes, a fine cloth called buckram, and other valuable goods; however, their ships were often attacked and frequently looted by the pirates who plagued these waters, seen as serious threats. These pirates mainly reside in the peninsula of Gohourat, now called Gujerat, where the fleet was heading after stopping at Tana—a place known for its frankincense—and Canboat, now Kambay, a town with a significant leather trade. After visiting Sumenath, a city known for its cruel and fierce inhabitants who practice idol worship, and Kesmacoran, the present-day city of Kedje, the capital of Makran located on the Indus near the sea and the last town in India to the northwest, Marco Polo traveled west across the sea of Oman, instead of heading to Persia, which was the intended destination of the princess.
His insatiable love of exploration led him 500 miles away to the shores of Arabia, where he stopped at the Male and Female Islands, so called from the men usually living on one island, and their wives on the other. Thence they sailed to the south towards the island of Socotra, at the entrance of the Gulf of Aden, which, Marco Polo partially explored. He speaks of the inhabitants of Socotra as clever magicians, who, by their enchantments, obtain the fulfilment of all their wishes as well as the power of stilling storms and tempests. Then, taking a southerly course of 1000 miles, he arrived at the shores of Madagascar. This island appeared to him to be one of the grandest in the world. Its inhabitants are very much occupied with commerce, especially in elephants' tusks. They live principally upon camels' flesh, which is better and more wholesome food than any other. The merchants on their way from the coast of India are usually only twenty days crossing the Sea of Oman; but when they return they are often three months on the voyage on account of the opposing currents which take them always southwards. Nevertheless, they visit Madagascar very constantly, for there are whole forests of sandal-wood, and amber is also found there, from which they can obtain great profit by bartering it for gold and silk stuffs. Wild animals and game are plentiful; according to Marco Polo, leopards, bears, lions, wild boars, giraffes, wild asses, roebucks, deer, stags, and cattle were to be found in great numbers; but what seemed most marvellous of all to him was the fabulous griffin, the roc, of which we hear so much in the "Thousand and one Nights," which is not, he says, "an animal, half-lion and half-bird, able to raise and carry away an elephant in its claws." It was probably the "epyornis maximus," for some eggs of this bird are still to be found in Madagascar.
His insatiable love for exploration took him 500 miles to the shores of Arabia, where he visited the Male and Female Islands, named for the men who typically lived on one island and their wives on the other. From there, they sailed south towards the island of Socotra, at the entrance of the Gulf of Aden, which Marco Polo partially explored. He describes the inhabitants of Socotra as skilled magicians who, through their enchantments, get their wishes granted and have the ability to calm storms and tempests. Then, heading south for 1,000 miles, he reached the shores of Madagascar. He thought this island was one of the most impressive in the world. The people there are heavily involved in trade, particularly with elephant tusks. They mainly survive on camel meat, which he considers healthier than any other food. Merchants making the journey from the coast of India typically take only twenty days to cross the Sea of Oman; however, on their return, they often spend three months on the voyage due to the opposing currents that always push them southward. Still, they frequently visit Madagascar because there are extensive forests of sandalwood, and amber is also found there, allowing them to make a good profit by trading it for gold and silk. Wild animals and game are abundant; according to Marco Polo, leopards, bears, lions, wild boars, giraffes, wild donkeys, roebucks, deer, stags, and cattle can be found in large numbers. But what impressed him the most was the legendary griffin, the roc, mentioned in the "Thousand and One Nights," which he said is "an animal, half-lion and half-bird, capable of lifting and carrying away an elephant in its claws." It likely referred to the "epyornis maximus," as some eggs of this bird can still be found in Madagascar.
![]() |
This wonderful bird was probably the epyornis maximus. |
From this island Marco Polo went in a north-westerly direction to Zanzibar and the coast of Africa. The inhabitants seemed to him remarkably stout, but strong and able to carry the burdens of four ordinary men, "which is not strange," he says, "for they each eat as much as five other men;" these natives were black and wore no clothing, they had large mouths and turned-up noses, thick lips, and large eyes, a description that agrees exactly with that of the natives of that part of Africa now. They live upon rice, meat, milk, and dates, and make a kind of wine of rice, sugar, and spices. They are brave warriors and fearless of death; they are usually in war mounted on camels and elephants, and armed with a leathern shield, a sword, and a lance; they give their animals an intoxicating drink to excite them on going into action.
From this island, Marco Polo headed northwest to Zanzibar and the coast of Africa. He found the people here to be surprisingly robust, capable of carrying the loads of four average men, "which isn't surprising," he notes, "since they each eat as much as five other men." These locals were black and wore no clothing; they had large mouths, turned-up noses, thick lips, and big eyes, a description that matches the natives in that region of Africa today. Their diet consists of rice, meat, milk, and dates, and they produce a type of wine made from rice, sugar, and spices. They are courageous warriors unafraid of death, often going into battle mounted on camels and elephants, armed with a leather shield, a sword, and a lance. They also give their animals a stimulating drink to energize them before combat.
In Marco Polo's time, says M. Charton, the countries comprised under the title of India were divided into three parts; Greater India or Hindostan, that is, the country lying between the Indus and the Ganges; Lesser India, that is, all the country lying beyond the Ganges, between the western coast of the peninsula and the coast of Cochin China; lastly, Middle India, that is, Abyssinia and the Arabian coast to the Persian Gulf. After leaving Zanzibar it was Middle India whose coast Marco Polo explored, sailing towards the north, and first Abassy or Abyssinia, a fertile country where the manufacture of fine cotton cloths and buckram is largely carried on. Then the fleet went to Zaila, almost at the entrance of the straits of Bab-el-Mandeb, and at last by the coast of Yemen and Hadramaut they came to Aden, the port frequented by all the ships trading with India and China; then to Escier, whence a great quantity of fine horses are exported; Dafar, which produces incense of the finest quality, and Galatu, now Kalajate, on the coast of Oman; then to Ormuz, that Marco Polo had visited once before when he was on his way from Venice to the court of Kublaï-Khan. This was the furthest point that the fleet had to reach, as the princess was now on the borders of Persia, after a voyage of eighteen months. But on their arrival they were met by the sad news of the death of Prince Arghun, the fiancé of the princess, and they found the country involved in civil war. The poor princess was put under the care of Prince Ghazan, the son of Prince Arghun, who did not ascend the throne until 1295, when his uncle, the usurper, was strangled. What became of the princess we do not hear, but on parting with Nicolo, Matteo, and Marco Polo, she bestowed on them great marks of favour. It was probably during Marco Polo's residence in Persia that he collected some curious documents upon Turkey in Asia; they are disconnected pieces, which he gives at the close of his narrative, and they form a genuine history of the Mongol Khans of Persia. His travels for exploration were at an end, and after taking leave of the Tartar princess, the three Venetians well escorted, and with all expenses paid, set out on their way home. They went to Trebizond, then to Constantinople, and thence to Negropont, where they embarked for Venice.
In Marco Polo's time, M. Charton explains that the regions referred to as India were divided into three parts: Greater India or Hindostan, which is the area between the Indus and the Ganges; Lesser India, which includes everything beyond the Ganges, between the western coast of the peninsula and the coast of Cochin China; and finally, Middle India, encompassing Abyssinia and the Arabian coast to the Persian Gulf. After leaving Zanzibar, Marco Polo explored the coast of Middle India, sailing north and first reaching Abassy or Abyssinia, a fertile area known for producing fine cotton cloth and buckram. The fleet then went to Zaila, located near the entrance of the Bab-el-Mandeb straits, and continued along the coast of Yemen and Hadramaut until they arrived at Aden, the port visited by ships trading with India and China. After that, they went to Escier, known for exporting high-quality horses; Dafar, which produces top-quality incense; and Galatu, now known as Kalajate, on the coast of Oman. They then traveled to Ormuz, which Marco Polo had previously visited on his journey from Venice to the court of Kublaï-Khan. This was the furthest point of the fleet's journey, as the princess was now nearing Persia after an eighteen-month voyage. However, upon arrival, they received the tragic news of Prince Arghun's death, the princess's fiancé, and discovered that the country was caught in civil war. The unfortunate princess was taken care of by Prince Ghazan, the son of Prince Arghun, who would not become king until 1295 when his uncle, the usurper, was killed. We don’t learn what happened to the princess afterward, but as she parted ways with Nicolo, Matteo, and Marco Polo, she showed them great kindness. It is likely that during Marco Polo's time in Persia, he gathered some interesting documents about Turkey in Asia; these are disjointed pieces he includes at the end of his narrative, providing a genuine history of the Mongol Khans of Persia. His explorative travels had come to an end, and after bidding farewell to the Tartar princess, the three Venetians set out for home, well-escorted and with all expenses covered. They traveled to Trebizond, then to Constantinople, and from there to Negropont, where they boarded a ship for Venice.
It was in the year 1295, twenty-four years after leaving it, that Marco Polo and his companions returned to their native town. They were bronzed by exposure to the air and sun, coarsely clad in Tartar costume, and both in manners and language were so much more Mongolian than Venetian, that even their nearest relatives failed to recognize them. Beyond this, a report had been widely spread that they were dead, and it had gained so much credence that their friends never expected to see them again. They went to their own house in the part of Venice called St. John Chrysostom, and found it occupied by different members of the Polo family, who received the travellers with every mark of distrust, which their pitiable appearance did not tend to lessen, and placed no faith in the somewhat marvellous stories related to them by Marco Polo. After some persuasion, however, they gained admittance into their own house. When they had been a few days in Venice, the three travellers gave a magnificent banquet, followed by a splendid fête, to do away with any remaining doubts as to their identity. They invited the nobility of Venice and all the members of their own family, and when all the guests were assembled the three hosts appeared dressed in crimson satin robes; the guests then entered the dining-room, and the feast began. After the first course was over the three travellers retired for a few moments and then reappeared, clad in robes of splendid silk damask, which they proceeded to tear, and to present each of their guests with a piece. After the second course they dressed themselves in even more splendid robes of crimson velvet, which they wore until the feast was over, when they appeared in simple Venetian costume. The astonished guests marvelled at the magnificence of these garments, and wondered what their hosts would next show them; then the coarse rough clothes that they had worn on the voyage were brought in, and when the linings and seams were undone, rubies, sapphires, emeralds, diamonds, and carbuncles of great value were poured forth from them; great riches had been hidden in these rags. This unexpected sight cleared away all doubt; the three travellers were recognized at once as Marco, Nicolo, and Matteo Polo, and congratulations upon their return were showered upon them.
It was in 1295, twenty-four years after they left, that Marco Polo and his companions returned to their hometown. They were tanned from being outdoors in the sun, dressed in Tartar clothing, and their manners and language were so much more Mongolian than Venetian that even their closest relatives didn’t recognize them. Additionally, news had spread widely that they were dead, and it had been believed so strongly that their friends never expected to see them again. They went to their home in the part of Venice called St. John Chrysostom and found it occupied by other members of the Polo family, who greeted the travelers with skepticism, which their disheveled appearance did not help, and they couldn’t believe the somewhat incredible stories Marco Polo told. After some convincing, however, they were allowed into their own house. Once they had spent a few days in Venice, the three travelers hosted a lavish banquet, followed by a grand celebration, to prove their identity. They invited the nobility of Venice and all their family members, and when all the guests arrived, the three hosts appeared dressed in crimson satin robes; the guests then entered the dining room, and the feast began. After the first course, the three travelers stepped away briefly and then returned wearing magnificent silk damask robes, which they began to tear, handing pieces of it to each of their guests. After the second course, they donned even more luxurious crimson velvet robes, which they wore until the feast ended, at which point they appeared in simple Venetian attire. The astonished guests marveled at the splendor of these garments and wondered what else their hosts would reveal; then the rough clothes they had worn during their journey were brought in, and when the seams were opened, rubies, sapphires, emeralds, diamonds, and large garnets spilled out from them; great wealth had been hidden in those rags. This surprising sight dispelled all doubts immediately; the three travelers were recognized at once as Marco, Nicolo, and Matteo Polo, and they were showered with congratulations on their return.
So celebrated a man as Marco Polo could not escape civic honours. He was made first magistrate in Venice, and as he was continually speaking of the "millions" of the Grand Khan, who commanded "millions" of subjects, he gained the soubriquet of Signor Million.
So well-known a man as Marco Polo couldn’t avoid civic honors. He was appointed the first magistrate in Venice, and since he was always talking about the "millions" of the Grand Khan, who ruled over "millions" of subjects, he earned the nickname Signor Million.
It was about 1296 that a war broke out between Venice and Genoa. A Genoese fleet under the command of Lamba Doria crossed the Adriatic, and threatened the sea coast. The Venetian Admiral Andrea Dandolo immediately manned a larger fleet and entrusted the command of a galley to Marco Polo who was justly considered an able commander. The Venetians were beaten in a naval battle on the 8th of September, 1296, and Marco Polo, badly wounded, fell into the hands of the Genoese, who, knowing and appreciating the value of their prisoner, treated him with great kindness. He was taken to Genoa, and there met with a hearty welcome from the most distinguished people, who were anxious to hear the account of his travels. It was during his captivity, in 1298, that he made acquaintance with Pisano Rusticien, and, tired of repeating his story again and again, dictated his narrative to him.
It was around 1296 when a war started between Venice and Genoa. A Genoese fleet led by Lamba Doria crossed the Adriatic and threatened the coast. The Venetian Admiral Andrea Dandolo quickly gathered a larger fleet and put Marco Polo in command of a galley, as he was recognized as a skilled commander. The Venetians were defeated in a naval battle on September 8, 1296, and Marco Polo, seriously injured, was captured by the Genoese, who, understanding his value, treated him very well. He was taken to Genoa, where he received a warm welcome from prominent people eager to hear about his travels. During his captivity in 1298, he met Pisano Rusticien and, tired of repeating his story over and over, decided to dictate his narrative to him.
About 1299 Marco Polo was set at liberty; he returned to Venice, and there married. From this time we hear no more of the incidents of his life, and only know from his will that he left three daughters; he is thought to have died about the 9th of January, 1323, at the age of seventy.
About 1299, Marco Polo was released; he returned to Venice and got married. After this, we don't hear anything more about the events of his life, and we only know from his will that he had three daughters. He is believed to have died around January 9, 1323, at the age of seventy.
Such is the life of this celebrated traveller, whose narrative had a marked influence on the progress of geographical science. He was gifted with great power of observation, and could see and describe equally well; and all later explorers have confirmed the truth of his statements. Until the middle of the eighteenth century, the documents founded on this narrative formed the basis of geographical books, and were used as a guide in commercial expeditions to China, India, and Central Asia. Posterity will concur in the suitability of the title that the first copyists gave to Marco Polo's work, that of "The Book of the Wonders of the World."
Such is the life of this famous traveler, whose story significantly impacted the development of geography. He had a remarkable ability to observe, and could both see and describe things effectively; all later explorers have verified the accuracy of his accounts. Until the mid-eighteenth century, the documents based on his narrative served as the foundation for geography books and were used as guides for commercial ventures to China, India, and Central Asia. Future generations will agree with the appropriateness of the title that the first transcribers gave to Marco Polo's work, "The Book of the Wonders of the World."
CHAPTER V.
Ibn Batuta—The Nile—Gaza, Tyre, Tiberias, Libanus, Baalbec, Damascus, Meshid, Bussorah, Baghdad, Tabriz, Mecca and Medina—Yemen—Abyssinia—The country of the Berbers—Zanguebar—Ormuz—Syria—Anatolia—Asia Minor—Astrakhan—Constantinople—Turkestan—Herat—The Indus—Delhi—Malabar—The Maldives—Ceylon—The Coromandel coast—Bengal—The Nicobar Islands—Sumatra—China—Africa—The Niger—Timbuctoo.
Ibn Batuta—The Nile—Gaza, Tyre, Tiberias, Lebanon, Baalbek, Damascus, Meshid, Basra, Baghdad, Tabriz, Mecca and Medina—Yemen—Abyssinia—The land of the Berbers—Zanzibar—Hormuz—Syria—Anatolia—Asia Minor—Astrakhan—Istanbul—Turkestan—Herat—The Indus—Delhi—Malabar—The Maldives—Sri Lanka—The Coromandel coast—Bengal—The Nicobar Islands—Sumatra—China—Africa—The Niger—Timbuktu.
Marco Polo had returned to his native land now nearly twenty-five years, when a Franciscan monk traversed the whole of Asia, from the Black Sea to the extreme limits of China, passing by Trebizond, Mount Ararat, Babel, and the island of Java; but he was so credulous of all that was told him, and his narrative is so confused, that but little reliance can be placed upon it. It is the same with the fabulous travels of Jean de Mandeville. Cooley says of them, "They are so utterly untrue, that they have not their parallel in any language."
Marco Polo had been back in his homeland for nearly twenty-five years when a Franciscan monk journeyed across all of Asia, from the Black Sea to the farthest reaches of China, passing through Trebizond, Mount Ararat, Babel, and the island of Java. However, he was so gullible about everything he was told, and his story is so disorganized, that we can hardly trust it. The same goes for the exaggerated travels of Jean de Mandeville. Cooley remarks about them, "They are so completely untrue that there's nothing like them in any language."
But we find a worthy successor to the Venetian traveller in an Arabian theologian, named Abdallah El Lawati, better known by the name of Ibn Batuta. He did for Egypt, Arabia, Anatolia, Tartary, India, China, Bengal, and Soudan, what Marco Polo had done for Central Asia, and he is worthy to be placed in the foremost rank as a brave traveller and bold explorer. In the year 1324, the 725th year of the Hegira, he resolved to make a pilgrimage to Mecca, and starting from Tangier, his native town, he went first to Alexandria, and thence to Cairo. During his stay in Egypt he turned his attention to the Nile, and especially to the Delta; then he tried to sail up the river, but being stopped by disturbances on the Nubian frontier, he was obliged to return to the mouth of the river, and then set sail for Asia Minor.
But we find a worthy successor to the Venetian traveler in an Arabian theologian named Abdallah El Lawati, better known as Ibn Batuta. He explored Egypt, Arabia, Anatolia, Tartary, India, China, Bengal, and Sudan in a way similar to what Marco Polo did for Central Asia, and he deserves to be recognized as a brave traveler and bold explorer. In 1324, the 725th year of the Hegira, he decided to make a pilgrimage to Mecca, starting from Tangier, his hometown. He first traveled to Alexandria, and then to Cairo. While in Egypt, he focused on the Nile, especially the Delta; however, when he attempted to sail upriver, he was halted by conflicts on the Nubian frontier and had to return to the mouth of the river before setting sail for Asia Minor.
![]() |
Ibn Batuta in Egypt. |
After visiting Gaza, the tombs of Abraham, Isaac, and Jacob, Tyre, then strongly fortified and unassailable on three sides, and Tiberias, which was in ruins, and whose celebrated baths were completely destroyed, Ibn Batuta was attracted by the wonders of Lebanon, the centre for all the hermits of that day, who had judiciously chosen one of the most lovely spots in the whole world wherein to end their days. Then passing Baalbec, and going on to Damascus, he found the city (in the year 1345) decimated by the plague. This fearful scourge devoured "24,000 persons daily," if we may believe his report, and Damascus would have been depopulated, had not the prayers of all the people offered up in the mosque containing the stone with the print of Moses' foot upon it, been heard and answered. On leaving Damascus, Ibn Batuta went to Mesjid, where he visited the tomb of Ali, which attracts a large number of paralytic pilgrims who need only to spend one night in prayer beside it, to be completely cured. Batuta does not seem to doubt the authenticity of this miracle, well known in the East under the title of "the Night of Cure."
After visiting Gaza, the tombs of Abraham, Isaac, and Jacob, Tyre, which was strongly fortified and protected on three sides, and Tiberias, which was in ruins with its famous baths completely destroyed, Ibn Batuta was drawn to the wonders of Lebanon, the hub for all the hermits of that time, who wisely chose one of the most beautiful spots in the world to spend their final days. After passing through Baalbec and continuing to Damascus, he found the city (in the year 1345) devastated by the plague. This terrible scourge was said to take "24,000 lives daily," according to his account, and Damascus might have become deserted if it weren't for the prayers of the people offered in the mosque that housed the stone with the imprint of Moses' foot, which were heard and answered. Upon leaving Damascus, Ibn Batuta traveled to Mesjid, where he visited the tomb of Ali, which draws many paralyzed pilgrims who believe that spending just one night in prayer beside it can completely heal them. Batuta seems to have no doubt about the authenticity of this miracle, well known in the East as "the Night of Cure."
From Mesjid, the traveller went to Bussorah, and entered the kingdom of Ispahan, and then the province of Shiraz, where he wished to converse with the celebrated worker of miracles, Magd Oddin. From Shiraz he went to Baghdad, to Tabriz, then to Medina, where he prayed beside the tomb of the Prophet, and finally to Mecca, where he remained three years. It is well known that from Mecca, caravans are continually starting for the surrounding country, and it was in company with some of these bold merchants that Ibn Batuta was able to visit the towns of Yemen. He went as far as Aden, at the mouth of the Red Sea, and embarked for Zaila, one of the Abyssinian ports. He was now once more on African ground, and advanced into the country of the Berbers, that he might study the manners and customs of those dirty and repulsive tribes; he found their diet consisted wholly of fish and camels' flesh. But in the town of Makdasbu, there was an attempt at comfort and civilization, presenting a most agreeable contrast with the surrounding squalor. The inhabitants were very fat, each of them, to use Ibn's own expression, "eating enough to feed a convent;" they were very fond of delicacies, such as plantains boiled in milk, preserved citrons, pods of fresh pepper, and green ginger.
From the mosque, the traveler went to Basra and entered the kingdom of Isfahan, then the province of Shiraz, where he wanted to talk to the famous miracle worker, Magd Oddin. After Shiraz, he traveled to Baghdad, then to Tabriz, and on to Medina, where he prayed next to the Prophet's tomb, and finally to Mecca, where he stayed for three years. It’s well known that from Mecca, caravans are always leaving for nearby areas, and it was with some of these daring merchants that Ibn Batuta managed to visit the towns of Yemen. He traveled as far as Aden, at the mouth of the Red Sea, and boarded a ship to Zaila, one of the Abyssinian ports. He was now back on African soil and made his way into the land of the Berbers to learn about the customs and habits of those unsightly and unappealing tribes; he discovered that their diet consisted entirely of fish and camel meat. However, in the town of Makdasbu, he found an attempt at comfort and civilization, which stood in stark contrast to the surrounding filth. The locals were quite overweight, each of them, in Ibn’s own words, "eating enough to feed a monastery;" they particularly enjoyed delicacies like plantains boiled in milk, preserved citrons, fresh pepper pods, and green ginger.
After seeing all he wished of the country of the Berbers, chiefly on the coast, he resolved to go to Zanguebar, and then, crossing the Red Sea and following the coast of Arabia, he came to Zafar, a town situated upon the Indian Ocean. The vegetation of this country is most luxuriant, the betel, cocoa-nut, and incense-trees forming there great forests; still the traveller pushed on, and came to Ormuz on the Persian Gulf, and passed through several provinces of Persia. We find him a second time at Mecca in the year 1332, three years after he had left it.
After seeing everything he wanted in the land of the Berbers, mainly along the coast, he decided to head to Zanguebar. Then, after crossing the Red Sea and following the Arabian coast, he arrived at Zafar, a town by the Indian Ocean. The vegetation in this area is incredibly lush, with forests of betel, coconut, and incense trees. Still, the traveler continued onward and reached Ormuz on the Persian Gulf, passing through several provinces of Persia. We find him back in Mecca in 1332, three years after he had left.
But this was only to be a short rest for the traveller, for now, leaving Asia for Africa, he went to Upper Egypt, a region but little known, and thence to Cairo. He next visited Syria, making a short stay at Jerusalem and Tripoli, and thence he visited the Turkomans of Anatolia, where the "confraternity of young men" gave him a most hearty welcome.
But this was only a brief break for the traveler, as he left Asia for Africa, heading to Upper Egypt, a region not very well known, and then to Cairo. He then went on to Syria, stopping briefly in Jerusalem and Tripoli, before visiting the Turkomans of Anatolia, where the "brotherhood of young men" gave him a warm welcome.
After Anatolia, the Arabian narrative speaks of Asia Minor. Ibn Batuta advanced as far as Erzeroum, where he was shown an aerolite weighing 620 pounds. Then, crossing the Black Sea, he visited the Crimea, Kaffa, and Bulgar, a town of sufficiently high latitude for the unequal length of day and night to be very marked; and at last he reached Astrakhan, at the mouth of the Volga, where the Khan of Tartary lived during the winter months.
After Anatolia, the Arabian account discusses Asia Minor. Ibn Batuta traveled all the way to Erzeroum, where he was shown a meteorite weighing 620 pounds. Then, after crossing the Black Sea, he visited Crimea, Kaffa, and Bulgar, a town far north enough that the difference in day and night length was quite noticeable; and finally, he arrived in Astrakhan, at the mouth of the Volga, where the Khan of Tartary resided during the winter months.
The Princess Bailun, the wife of the khan, and daughter of the Emperor of Constantinople, was wishing to visit her father, and it was an opportunity not to be lost by Ibn Batuta for exploring Turkey in Europe; he gained permission to accompany the princess, who set out attended by 5000 men, and followed by a portable mosque, which was set up at every place where they stayed. The princess's reception at Constantinople was very magnificent, the bells being rung with such spirit that he says, "even the horizon seemed full of the vibration."
The Princess Bailun, the khan's wife and the daughter of the Emperor of Constantinople, wanted to visit her father. This was a chance Ibn Batuta couldn’t miss to explore Turkey in Europe. He got permission to join the princess, who set out with 5,000 men and a portable mosque that was set up wherever they stopped. The princess's welcome in Constantinople was grand, with bells ringing so energetically that he remarked, "even the horizon seemed full of the vibration."
The welcome given to the theologian by the princes of the country was worthy of his fame; he remained in the city thirty-six days, so that he was able to study it in all its details.
The welcome the theologian received from the country's princes matched his reputation; he stayed in the city for thirty-six days, allowing him to explore it in all its details.
This was a time when communication between the different countries was both dangerous and difficult, and Ibn Batuta was considered a very bold traveller. Egypt, Arabia, Turkey in Asia, the Caucasian provinces had all in turn been explored by him. After such hard work he might well have taken rest and been satisfied with the laurels that he had gained, for he was without doubt the most celebrated traveller of the fourteenth century; but his insatiable passion for travelling remained, and the circle of his explorations was still to widen considerably.
This was a time when communicating between different countries was both risky and challenging, and Ibn Batuta was seen as a very daring traveler. He had explored Egypt, Arabia, Turkey in Asia, and the Caucasian provinces, each in turn. After such effort, he could have easily taken a break and been content with the recognition he had earned, as he was undoubtedly the most famous traveler of the fourteenth century. However, his endless passion for traveling persisted, and the scope of his explorations was still set to expand significantly.
On leaving Constantinople, Ibn Batuta went again to Astrakhan, thence crossing the sandy wastes of the present Turkestan, he arrived at Khovarezen, a large populous town, then at Bokhara, half destroyed by the armies of Gengis-Khan. Some time after we hear of him at Samarcand, a religious town which greatly pleased the learned traveller, and then at Balkh which he could not reach without crossing the desert of Khorassan. This town was all in ruins and desolate, for the armies of the barbarians had been there, and Ibn Batuta could not remain in it, but wished to go westward to the frontier of Afghanistan. The mountainous country, near the Hindoo Koosh range, confronted him, but this was no barrier to him, and after great fatigue, which he bore with equal patience and good-humour, he reached the important town of Herat. This was the most westerly point reached by the traveller; he now resolved to change his course for an easterly one, and in going to the extreme limits of Asia, to reach the shores of the Pacific: if he could succeed in this he would pass the bounds of the explorations of the celebrated Marco Polo.
On leaving Constantinople, Ibn Batuta traveled again to Astrakhan, then crossed the sandy deserts of what is now Turkestan, arriving at Khovarezen, a large, bustling town, followed by Bokhara, which was half-destroyed by Genghis Khan's armies. Soon after, we find him in Samarcand, a religious town that greatly pleased the learned traveler, and then in Balkh, which he could only reach by crossing the desert of Khorassan. This town was in ruins and desolate because the armies of the barbarians had passed through, and Ibn Batuta could not stay there, so he wanted to head westward to the border of Afghanistan. The mountainous region near the Hindu Kush confronted him, but this did not deter him, and after considerable fatigue, which he endured with patience and good humor, he reached the important town of Herat. This was the farthest west he traveled; he then decided to change his course to the east, aiming to reach the farthest limits of Asia and the shores of the Pacific. If he succeeded, he would surpass the explorations of the famous Marco Polo.
He set out, and following the course of the river Kabul and the frontiers of Afghanistan, he came to the Sindhu, the modern Indus, and descended it to its mouth. From the town of Lahore, he went to Delhi, which great and beautiful city had been deserted by its inhabitants, who had fled from the Emperor Mohammed.
He set out and followed the path of the Kabul River along the borders of Afghanistan. He arrived at the Sindhu, known today as the Indus, and traveled down it to where it meets the sea. From the city of Lahore, he went to Delhi, a once-great and beautiful city that had been abandoned by its residents who had fled from Emperor Mohammed.
This tyrant, who was occasionally both generous and magnificent, received the Arabian traveller very well, made him a judge in Delhi, and gave him a grant of land with some pecuniary advantages that were attached to the post, but these honours were not to be of any long duration, for Ibn Batuta being implicated in a pretended conspiracy, thought it best to give up his place, and make himself a fakir to escape the Emperor's displeasure. Mohammed, however, pardoned him, and made him his ambassador to China.
This tyrant, who was sometimes both generous and grand, welcomed the Arabian traveler warmly, appointed him as a judge in Delhi, and gave him a land grant along with some financial benefits tied to the position. However, these honors weren't meant to last long because Ibn Batuta, being involved in a false conspiracy, decided it was best to resign and become a wandering ascetic to avoid the Emperor's wrath. Mohammed, however, forgave him and made him his ambassador to China.
Fortune again smiled upon the courageous traveller, and he had now the prospect of seeing these distant lands under exceptionally good and safe circumstances. He was charged with presents for the Emperor of China, and 2000 horse-soldiers were given him as an escort.
Fortune smiled again on the brave traveler, and now he had the chance to see these distant lands under very favorable and safe conditions. He was tasked with delivering gifts to the Emperor of China, and he was provided with 2,000 cavalry soldiers as his escort.
But Ibn Batuta had not thought of the insurgents who occupied the surrounding countries; a skirmish took place between the escort and the Hindoos, and the traveller, being separated from his companions, was taken prisoner, robbed, garotted, and carried off he knew not whither; but his courage and hopefulness did not forsake him, and he contrived to escape from the hands of these robbers. After wandering about for seven days, he was received into his house by a negro, who at length led him back to the emperor's palace at Delhi.
But Ibn Batuta hadn’t considered the rebels in the neighboring countries; a clash occurred between his escort and the Hindus, and the traveler, getting separated from his group, was captured, robbed, strangled, and taken away to an unknown place. However, he didn’t lose his courage or hope, and he managed to escape from his captors. After wandering for seven days, he was welcomed into a home by a man of African descent, who eventually brought him back to the emperor’s palace in Delhi.
Mohammed fitted out another expedition, and again appointed the Arabian traveller as his ambassador. This time they passed through the enemy's country without molestation, and by way of Kanoje, Mersa, Gwalior, and Barun, they reached Malabar. Some time after, they arrived at the great port of Calicut, an important place which became afterwards the chief town of Malabar; here they were detained by contrary winds for three months, and made use of this time to study the Chinese mercantile marine which frequented this port. Ibn speaks with great admiration of these junks which are like floating gardens, where ginger and herbs are grown on deck; they are each like a separate village, and some merchants were the possessors of a great number of these junks.
Mohammed organized another expedition and once again chose the Arabian traveler as his ambassador. This time, they traveled through enemy territory without any issues, passing through Kanoje, Mersa, Gwalior, and Barun, until they reached Malabar. After some time, they arrived at the major port of Calicut, an important location that later became the main town of Malabar. They were held up by unfavorable winds for three months, using that time to study the Chinese merchant ships that frequented the port. Ibn speaks highly of these junks, describing them as floating gardens where ginger and herbs are grown on deck; each junk resembles a separate village, and some merchants owned many of these boats.
At last the wind changed; Ibn Batuta chose a small junk well fitted up, to take him to China, and had all his property put on board. Thirteen other junks were to receive the presents sent by the King of Delhi to the Emperor of China, but during the night a violent storm arose, and all the vessels sank. Fortunately for Ibn he had remained on shore to attend the service at the mosque, and thus his piety saved his life, but he had lost everything except "the carpet which he used at his devotions." After this second misfortune he could not make up his mind to appear before the King of Delhi. This catastrophe was enough to weary the patience of a more long-suffering emperor than Mohammed.
At last the wind changed, and Ibn Batuta chose a small, well-equipped junk to take him to China, loading all his belongings onto it. Thirteen other junks were set to carry presents from the King of Delhi to the Emperor of China, but during the night a fierce storm came up, and all the vessels sank. Luckily for Ibn, he had stayed on shore to attend the service at the mosque, so his devotion saved his life, but he lost everything except "the carpet he used for his prayers." After this second misfortune, he couldn’t bring himself to face the King of Delhi. This disaster would have tested the patience of even the most enduring emperor, far more than Mohammed.
Ibn soon made up his mind what to do. Leaving the service of the emperor, and the advantages attaching to the post of ambassador, he embarked for the Maldive Islands, which were governed by a woman, and where a large trade in cocoa was carried on. Here he was again made a judge, but this was only of short duration, for the vizier became jealous of his success, and, after marrying three wives, Ibn was obliged to take refuge in flight. He hoped to reach the Coromandel coast, but contrary winds drove his vessel towards Ceylon, where he was very well received, and gained the king's permission to climb the sacred mountain of Serendid, or Adam's Peak. His object was to see the wonderful impression of a foot at the summit, which the Hindoos call "Buddha's," and the Mahometans "Adam's, foot." He pretends, in his narrative, that this impression measures eleven hands in length, a very different account from that of an historian of the ninth century, who declared it to be seventy-nine cubits long! This historian also adds that while one of the feet of our forefather rested on the mountain, the other was in the Indian ocean.
Ibn soon decided what to do. Leaving the service of the emperor and the perks of being an ambassador, he set sail for the Maldives, which were ruled by a woman and had a thriving cocoa trade. There, he became a judge again, but this didn’t last long because the vizier became envious of his success. After marrying three wives, Ibn had to flee for his life. He aimed for the Coromandel coast, but contrary winds pushed his ship towards Ceylon, where he was welcomed warmly and received permission from the king to climb the sacred mountain of Serendid, or Adam's Peak. His goal was to see the remarkable footprint at the top, which the Hindus call "Buddha's" and the Muslims refer to as "Adam's foot." In his account, he claims that this impression measures eleven hands long, which is quite different from a ninth-century historian who said it was seventy-nine cubits long! This historian also noted that while one foot of our forefather rested on the mountain, the other was in the Indian Ocean.
Ibn Batuta speaks also of large bearded apes, forming a considerable item in the population of the island, and said to be under a king of their own, crowned with leaves. We can give what credit we like to such fables as these, which were propagated by the credulity of the Hindoos.
Ibn Batuta also talks about large bearded apes that make up a significant part of the island's population and are said to have their own king, who is crowned with leaves. We can choose how much we want to believe these stories, which were spread by the gullibility of the Hindoos.
From Ceylon, the traveller made his way to the Coromandel coast, but not without experiencing some severe storms. He crossed to the other side of the Indian peninsula, and again embarked.
From Ceylon, the traveler headed to the Coromandel coast, but not without facing some serious storms. He crossed over to the other side of the Indian peninsula and boarded another vessel.
![]() |
Ibn Batuta's vessel was seized by pirates. |
But his vessel was seized by pirates, and Ibn Batuta arrived at Calicut almost without clothes, robbed, and worn out with fatigue. No misfortune could damp his ardour, his was one of those great spirits which seem only invigorated by trouble and disasters. As soon as he was enabled by the kindness of some Delhi merchants to resume his travels, he embarked for the Maldive Islands, went on to Bengal, there set sail for Sumatra, and disembarked at one of the Nicobar Islands after a very bad passage which had lasted fifty days. Fifteen days afterwards he arrived at Sumatra, where the king gave him a hearty welcome and furnished him with means to continue his journey to China.
But his ship was taken by pirates, and Ibn Batuta arrived in Calicut almost shirtless, robbed, and exhausted. No setback could diminish his enthusiasm; he was one of those remarkable spirits that seem to thrive on hardship and adversity. Once he was able to resume his travels thanks to the generosity of some Delhi merchants, he set off for the Maldives, then moved on to Bengal, where he sailed to Sumatra and landed on one of the Nicobar Islands after a difficult journey that lasted fifty days. Fifteen days later, he reached Sumatra, where the king warmly welcomed him and provided him with the resources to continue his journey to China.
A junk took him in seventy-one days to the port Kailuka, capital of a country somewhat problematical, of which the brave and handsome inhabitants excelled in making arms. From Kailuka, Ibn passed into the Chinese provinces, and went first to the splendid town of Zaitem, probably the present Tsieun-tcheou of the Chinese, a little to the north of Nankin. He passed through various cities of this great empire, studying the customs of the people and admiring everywhere the riches, industry, and civilization that he found, but he did not get as far as the Great Wall, which he calls "The obstacle of Gog and Magog." It was while he was exploring this immense tract of country that he made a short stay in the city of Tchensi, which is composed of six fortified towns standing together. It happened that during his wanderings he was able to be present at the funeral of a khan, who was buried with four slaves, six of his favourites, and four horses.
A junk took him seventy-one days to reach the port of Kailuka, the capital of a somewhat uncertain country, whose brave and handsome people were known for their skill in making weapons. From Kailuka, Ibn traveled into the Chinese provinces, beginning with the magnificent town of Zaitem, probably what is now known as Tsieun-tcheou, located just north of Nankin. He traveled through various cities of this vast empire, observing the customs of the people and appreciating the wealth, industry, and civilization he encountered, but he did not make it as far as the Great Wall, which he referred to as "The obstacle of Gog and Magog." While exploring this immense region, he made a brief stop in the city of Tchensi, which is made up of six fortified towns. During his travels, he was fortunate enough to attend the funeral of a khan, who was buried alongside four slaves, six of his favorites, and four horses.
In the meanwhile, disturbances had occurred at Zaitem, which obliged Ibn to leave this town, so he set sail for Sumatra, and then after touching at Calicut and Ormuz, he returned to Mecca in 1348, having made the tour of Persia and Syria.
In the meantime, there were disturbances in Zaitem, which forced Ibn to leave the town, so he sailed to Sumatra, and after stopping in Calicut and Ormuz, he returned to Mecca in 1348, having traveled through Persia and Syria.
But the time of rest had not yet come for this indefatigable explorer; the following year he revisited his native place Tangier, and then after travelling in the southern countries of Europe he returned to Morocco, went to Soudan and the countries watered by the Niger, crossed the Great Desert and entered Timbuctoo, thus making a journey which would have rendered illustrious a less ambitious traveller.
But the time to rest hadn't come yet for this tireless explorer; the next year he went back to his hometown, Tangier, and after traveling through southern Europe, he returned to Morocco, traveled to Sudan and the regions by the Niger River, crossed the Great Desert, and entered Timbuktu, completing a journey that would have made a less ambitious traveler famous.
This was to be his last expedition. In 1353, twenty-nine years after leaving Tangier for the first time, he returned to Morocco, and settled at Fez. He has earned the reputation of being the most intrepid explorer of the fourteenth century, and well merits to be ranked next after Marco Polo, the illustrious Venetian.
This was his final expedition. In 1353, twenty-nine years after first leaving Tangier, he returned to Morocco and settled in Fez. He gained the reputation of being the most fearless explorer of the fourteenth century and truly deserves to be ranked right after Marco Polo, the famous Venetian.
CHAPTER VI.
I.
The Norman cavalier—His ideas of conquest—What was known of the Canary Islands—Cadiz—The Canary Archipelago—Graciosa—Lancerota—Fortaventura—Jean de Béthencourt returns to Spain—Revolt of Berneval—His interview with King Henry III.—Gadifer visits the Canary Archipelago—Canary Island or "Gran Canaria"—Ferro Island—Palma Island.
The Norman knight—His thoughts on conquest—What was known about the Canary Islands—Cadiz—The Canary Archipelago—Graciosa—Lanzarote—Fuerteventura—Jean de Béthencourt goes back to Spain—Revolt of Berneval—His meeting with King Henry III.—Gadifer explores the Canary Archipelago—Canary Island or "Gran Canaria"—Ferro Island—Palma Island.
Jean de Béthencourt was born about the year 1339, at Eu in Normandy. He was of good family, and Baron of St. Martin-le-Gaillard, and had distinguished himself both as a navigator and warrior; he was made chamberlain to Charles VI. But his tastes were more for travelling than a life at court; he resolved to make himself a still more illustrious name by further conquests, and soon an opportunity offered for him to carry out his plans.
Jean de Béthencourt was born around 1339 in Eu, Normandy. He came from a respectable family and was the Baron of St. Martin-le-Gaillard. He had made a name for himself as both a navigator and a warrior, and he was appointed chamberlain to Charles VI. However, he preferred traveling to life at court; he decided to seek even greater fame through further conquests, and soon an opportunity arose for him to pursue his ambitions.
![]() |
Jean de Béthencourt. |
On the coast of Africa there is a group of islands called the Canaries, which were once known as the Fortunate Islands. Juba, a son of one of the Numidian kings, is said to have been their first explorer, about the year of Rome 776. In the middle ages, according to some accounts, Arabs, Genoese, Portuguese, Spaniards, and Biscayans, had partially visited this interesting group of islands. In 1393, a Spanish gentleman named Almonaster, who was commanding an expedition, succeeded in landing on Lancerota, one of these islands, and brought back, with several prisoners, some produce which was a sufficient guarantee of the fertility of this archipelago.
On the coast of Africa, there's a group of islands called the Canaries, which were once known as the Fortunate Islands. Juba, a son of one of the Numidian kings, is said to have been their first explorer around the year 776 AD. During the Middle Ages, according to some accounts, Arabs, Genoese, Portuguese, Spaniards, and Biscayans partially explored this fascinating group of islands. In 1393, a Spanish gentleman named Almonaster, who was leading an expedition, managed to land on Lanzarote, one of these islands, and returned with several prisoners as well as some produce that clearly indicated the fertility of this archipelago.
The Norman cavalier now found the opening that he sought, and he determined to conquer the Canary Islands and try to convert the inhabitants to the Catholic faith. He was as intelligent, brave, and full of resources as he was energetic; and leaving his house of Grainville-la-Teinturière at Caux, he went to La Rochelle, where he met the Chevalier Gadifer de la Salle, and having explained his project to him, they decided to go to the Canary Islands together. Jean de Béthencourt having collected an army and made his preparations, and had vessels fitted out and manned, Gadifer and he set sail; after experiencing adverse winds on the way to the Ile de Ré, and being much harassed by the constant dissensions on board, they arrived at Vivero, and then at Corunna. Here they remained eight days, then set sail again, and doubling Cape Finisterre, followed the Portuguese coast to Cape St. Vincent, and arrived at Cadiz, where they made a longer stay. Here Béthencourt had a dispute with some Genoese merchants, who accused him of having taken their vessel, and he had to go to Seville, where King Henry III. heard his complaint and acquitted him from all blame. On his return to Cadiz he found part of his crew in open mutiny, and some of his sailors so frightened that they refused to continue the voyage, so the chevalier sent back the cowardly sailors, and set sail with those who were more courageous.
The Norman knight finally found the opportunity he was looking for, and he decided to conquer the Canary Islands and try to convert the locals to the Catholic faith. He was intelligent, brave, resourceful, and full of energy. Leaving his home in Grainville-la-Teinturière at Caux, he went to La Rochelle, where he met Chevalier Gadifer de la Salle. After explaining his plan to him, they agreed to go to the Canary Islands together. Jean de Béthencourt gathered an army, made his preparations, and fitted out and manned the ships. He and Gadifer set sail; after facing tough winds on the way to Ile de Ré and dealing with constant arguments on board, they arrived at Vivero and then at Corunna. They stayed there for eight days, then set sail again, rounding Cape Finisterre and following the Portuguese coast to Cape St. Vincent, eventually arriving in Cadiz, where they stayed longer. While there, Béthencourt had a conflict with some Genoese merchants who accused him of taking their ship, and he had to go to Seville, where King Henry III heard his case and cleared him of all charges. Upon returning to Cadiz, he found part of his crew in open mutiny, and some of his sailors were so scared that they refused to continue the voyage. So, the knight sent back the cowardly sailors and set sail with those who were braver.
The vessel in which Jean de Béthencourt sailed was becalmed for three days, then, the weather improving, he reached the island of Graziosa, one of the smaller of the Canary group, in five days, and then the larger island of Lancerota, which is nearly the same size as the island of Rhodes. Lancerota has excellent pasturage, and arable land, which is particularly good for the cultivation of barley; its numerous fountains and cisterns are well supplied with excellent water. The orchilla, which is so much used in dyeing, grows abundantly here. The inhabitants of this island, who as a rule wear scarce any clothing, are tall and well-made, and the women, who wear leathern great-coats reaching to the ground, are very good-looking and honest.
The ship that Jean de Béthencourt was on was stuck in calm waters for three days, but when the weather improved, he reached the island of Graziosa, one of the smaller islands in the Canary group, in five days. He then made it to the larger island of Lanzarote, which is about the same size as Rhodes. Lanzarote has great pastures and fertile land, especially good for growing barley. Its many fountains and cisterns provide excellent water. The orchilla, which is widely used for dyeing, grows plentifully here. The people on this island typically wear very little clothing; they are tall and well-built, and the women, who wear leather coats that reach the ground, are particularly attractive and honest.
The traveller, prior to disclosing his plans of conquest, wished to possess himself of some of the natives, but his ignorance of the country made this a difficult matter, so, anchoring under the shelter of a small island in the archipelago, he called a meeting of his companions to decide upon a plan of action. They all agreed that the only thing to be done was to take some of the natives by fair means or foul. Guardafia, the king of the island, treated Béthencourt more as a friend than a subject. A castle or rather fort was built at the south-western extremity of the island, and some men left there under the command of Berthin de Berneval, while Béthencourt set out with the rest of his followers for the island of Erbania or Fortaventura. Gadifer counselled a debarcation by night, which was done, and then he took the command of a small body of men and scoured the island with them for eight days without meeting one native, they having all fled to the mountains. Provisions failing, Gadifer was forced to return, and he went to the island of Lobos between Lancerota and Fortaventura; but there his chief sailor mutinied and it was not without difficulty that Gadifer and Béthencourt reached the fort on Lancerota.
The traveler, before revealing his plans for conquest, wanted to capture some of the natives, but his lack of knowledge about the area made this a challenging task. So, he anchored near a small island in the archipelago and called a meeting with his companions to come up with a plan. They all agreed that their only option was to take some of the natives by any means necessary. Guardafia, the king of the island, treated Béthencourt more like a friend than a subject. A castle, or rather a fort, was built at the southwestern tip of the island, and some men were left there under the command of Berthin de Berneval, while Béthencourt set out with the rest of his followers for the island of Erbania or Fortaventura. Gadifer suggested landing at night, which they did, and he then took command of a small group of men to search the island for eight days without encountering a single native, as they had all fled to the mountains. Running low on supplies, Gadifer had to return, and he went to the island of Lobos between Lancerota and Fortaventura; however, his chief sailor mutinied, and it took a lot of effort for Gadifer and Béthencourt to reach the fort on Lancerota.
Béthencourt resolved to return to Spain to get provisions and a new contingent of soldiers, for his crew he could not depend upon; so he left Gadifer in command and set sail for Spain in one of Gadifer's ships.
Béthencourt decided to head back to Spain to gather supplies and recruit more soldiers, as he couldn't rely on his current crew. He left Gadifer in charge and sailed for Spain in one of Gadifer's ships.
It will be remembered that Berthin de Berneval had been left in command of the fort on Lancerota Island. Unfortunately he was Gadifer's bitter enemy, and no sooner had Béthencourt set out than he tried to poison the minds of Gadifer's men against him; he succeeded in inducing some, especially the Gascons, to revolt against the governor, who, quite innocent of Berneval's base designs, was spending his time hunting sea-wolves on the island of Lobos with Remonnet de Levéden and several others. Remonnet having been sent to Lancerota for provisions, found no Berneval there, he having deserted the island with his accomplices for a port on Graziosa, where a coxswain, deceived by his promises, had placed his vessel at his disposal. From Graziosa, the traitor Berneval returned to Lancerota, and put the finishing stroke to his villany by pretending to make an alliance with the king of the island. The king, thinking that no officer of Béthencourt's, in whom he had implicit confidence, could deceive him, came with twenty-four of his subjects to see Berneval, who seized them when asleep, had them bound, and then carried them off to Graziosa. The king managed to break his bonds, set three of his men free, and succeeded in escaping, but the remainder of his unfortunate companions were still prisoners, and Berneval gave them up to some Spanish thieves, who took them away to sell in a foreign land.
It’s important to remember that Berthin de Berneval was left in charge of the fort on Lancerota Island. Unfortunately, he was a bitter enemy of Gadifer, and as soon as Béthencourt set out, Berneval started to turn Gadifer’s men against him. He managed to convince some, especially the Gascons, to rebel against the governor, who was completely unaware of Berneval’s treacherous schemes and was busy hunting sea lions on the island of Lobos with Remonnet de Levéden and a few others. When Remonnet went to Lancerota for supplies, he found no trace of Berneval, who had deserted the island with his accomplices for a port on Graziosa, where a coxswain, misled by his promises, had let him use his ship. From Graziosa, the traitor Berneval returned to Lancerota and completed his betrayal by pretending to ally with the king of the island. The king, confident that none of Béthencourt's officers could trick him, came with twenty-four of his subjects to meet Berneval, who captured them while they were asleep, tied them up, and took them to Graziosa. The king managed to break free, rescued three of his men, and escaped, but the rest of his unfortunate companions remained prisoners, and Berneval handed them over to some Spanish thieves, who took them away to sell in another country.
Berneval's evil deeds did not stop here. By his order the vessel that Gadifer had sent to the fort at Lancerota was seized; Remonnet tried resistance, but his numbers were too small, and his supplications were useless to prevent Berneval's men, and even Berneval himself, from destroying all the arms, furniture, and goods, which Béthencourt had placed in the fort at Lancerota. Insults were showered upon the governor, and Berneval cried, "I should like Gadifer de la Salle to know that if he were as young as I, I would kill him, but as he is not, I will spare him. If he is put above me I shall have him drowned, and then he can fish for sea-wolves."
Berneval's wicked actions didn’t end there. He ordered the capture of the ship that Gadifer had sent to the fort at Lancerota. Remonnet attempted to fight back, but his forces were too few, and his pleas were ineffective in stopping Berneval's men, including Berneval himself, from destroying all the weapons, furniture, and supplies that Béthencourt had placed in the fort at Lancerota. The governor was bombarded with insults, and Berneval shouted, "I want Gadifer de la Salle to know that if he were as young as I am, I would kill him. But since he’s not, I’ll let him live. If he’s put in a higher position than me, I’ll have him drowned, and then he can go fishing for sea-wolves."
Meanwhile, Gadifer and his ten companions were in danger of perishing on the island of Lobos for want of food and fresh water, but happily the two chaplains of the fort of Lancerota had gone to Graziosa, and met the coxswain, who had been the victim of Berneval's treason, and he sent one of his men named Ximenes with them back to Lancerota. There they found a small boat which they filled with provisions, and embarking with four men who were faithful to Gadifer, they succeeded in reaching Lobos, four leagues off, after a most dangerous passage.
Meanwhile, Gadifer and his ten companions were at risk of dying on the island of Lobos due to a lack of food and fresh water. Fortunately, the two chaplains from the fort of Lancerota had gone to Graziosa and ran into the coxswain, who had suffered from Berneval's betrayal. He sent one of his men, named Ximenes, back with them to Lancerota. There, they found a small boat that they loaded with supplies, and after taking on four men loyal to Gadifer, they managed to reach Lobos, which was four leagues away, after a very perilous journey.
Gadifer and his companions were suffering fearfully from hunger and thirst, when Ximenes arrived just in time to save them from perishing, and the governor learning Berneval's treachery embarked in the boat for Lancerota, as soon as he was a little restored to health. He was grieved at Berneval's conduct towards the poor islanders whom Béthencourt and he had sworn to protect. No! he never could have expected such wickedness in one who was looked upon as the most able of the whole band.
Gadifer and his friends were enduring terrible hunger and thirst when Ximenes showed up just in time to save them from dying. After the governor learned about Berneval's betrayal, he got into the boat for Lancerota as soon as he felt a bit better. He was upset by Berneval's treatment of the poor islanders that Béthencourt and he had pledged to protect. No! He never could have anticipated such evil from someone who was considered the most capable of the entire group.
But what was Berneval doing meanwhile? After having betrayed his master, he did the same to the companions who had aided him in his evil deeds; he had twelve of them killed and then he set out for Spain to rejoin Béthencourt and make his own case good by representing all that had happened in his own way. It was to his interest to get rid of inconvenient witnesses, and therefore he abandoned his companions. These unfortunate men at first meditated imploring the pardon of the governor; they confessed all to the chaplains, but then, fearing the consequences of their deeds, they seized a boat and fled towards Morocco. The boat reached the coast of Barbary, where ten of the crew were drowned and the two others taken for slaves.
But what was Berneval doing in the meantime? After betraying his master, he did the same to the companions who had helped him with his wrongdoing; he had twelve of them killed and then headed for Spain to reunite with Béthencourt and spin the story to make himself look good. It was in his best interest to eliminate any inconvenient witnesses, so he abandoned his companions. These unfortunate men initially thought about asking the governor for forgiveness; they confessed everything to the chaplains, but then, fearing the fallout from their actions, they grabbed a boat and fled to Morocco. The boat made it to the Barbary coast, where ten of the crew drowned and the other two were captured as slaves.
While all this was happening at Lancerota, Béthencourt arrived at Cadiz, where he took strong measures against his mutinous crew, and had the ringleaders imprisoned. Then he sent his vessel to Seville, where King Henry III. was at that time; but the ship sank in the Guadalquiver, a great loss to Gadifer, her owner.
While all this was happening at Lanzarote, Béthencourt arrived in Cadiz, where he took tough action against his rebellious crew and had the ringleaders locked up. Then he sent his ship to Seville, where King Henry III was at the time; unfortunately, the ship sank in the Guadalquivir, which was a big loss for Gadifer, her owner.
Béthencourt having arrived at Seville, met a certain Francisque Calve who had lately come from the Canaries, and who offered to return thither with all the things needed by the governor, but Béthencourt could not agree to this proposal before he had seen the king.
Béthencourt arrived in Seville and met a man named Francisque Calve, who had recently come from the Canaries. Francisque offered to go back there with all the supplies needed by the governor, but Béthencourt couldn’t agree to this plan until he had spoken with the king.
Just at this time, Berneval arrived with some of his accomplices, and some islanders whom he intended to sell as slaves. He hoped to be able to deceive Béthencourt, but he had not reckoned upon a certain Courtille who was with him, who lost no time in denouncing the villany of Berneval, and on whose word the traitors were all imprisoned at Cadiz. Courtille also told of the treatment that the poor islanders had received; as Béthencourt could not leave Seville till he had had an audience with the king, he gave orders that they should receive every kindness, but while these preliminaries were being concluded, the vessel that contained them was taken to Aragon, and they were sold for slaves.
Just then, Berneval showed up with some of his partners and a few islanders he planned to sell as slaves. He thought he could trick Béthencourt, but he didn't count on a certain Courtille being with him, who quickly exposed Berneval's wrongdoing. Thanks to Courtille, all the traitors were locked up in Cadiz. Courtille also described how badly the islanders had been treated. Since Béthencourt couldn't leave Seville until he met with the king, he ordered that the islanders be treated well. However, while these arrangements were being made, the ship that held them was taken to Aragon, and they were sold as slaves.
Béthencourt obtained the audience that he sought with the king of Castille, and after telling him the result of his expedition he said, "Sire, I come to ask your assistance and your leave to conquer the Canary Islands for the Catholic faith, and as you are king and lord of all the surrounding country, and the nearest Christian king to these islands, I beg you to receive the homage of your humble servant." The king was very gracious to him and gave him dominion over these islands, and beyond this, a fifth of all the merchandise that should be brought from them to Spain. He gave him 20,000 maravédis, about 600l., to buy all that he needed, and also the right to coin money in the Canary Islands. Most unfortunately these 20,000 maravédis were confided to the care of a dishonest man, who fled to France, carrying the money with him.
Béthencourt got the meeting he wanted with the king of Castile, and after sharing the results of his expedition, he said, "Sir, I'm here to ask for your help and permission to conquer the Canary Islands for the Catholic faith. Since you are the king and lord of all the nearby lands and the closest Christian king to these islands, I ask you to accept the loyalty of your humble servant." The king was very kind to him and granted him control over these islands, along with a fifth of all the goods that would be brought from them to Spain. He also gave him 20,000 maravédis, about 600 l., to purchase everything he needed, as well as the right to mint money in the Canary Islands. Unfortunately, these 20,000 maravédis were entrusted to an untrustworthy man, who escaped to France with the money.
However, Henry III. gave Béthencourt a well-rigged vessel manned by eighty men, and stocked with provisions, arms, &c. He was most grateful for this fresh bounty, and sent Gadifer an account of all that had happened, and his extreme disappointment and disgust at Berneval's conduct, in whom he had so much confidence, announcing at the same time the speedy departure of the vessel given by the King of Castille.
However, Henry III gave Béthencourt a well-equipped ship crewed by eighty men, stocked with provisions, arms, etc. He was very grateful for this new gift and sent Gadifer a report of everything that had happened, expressing his deep disappointment and disgust at Berneval's behavior, in whom he had placed so much trust, while also announcing the imminent departure of the vessel provided by the King of Castile.
![]() |
Plan of Jerusalem. |
But meanwhile very serious troubles had arisen on Lancerota. King Guardafia was so hurt at Berneval's conduct that he had revolted, and some of Gadifer's companions had been killed by the islanders. Gadifer insisted upon these subjects being punished, when one of the king's relations named Ache, came to him proposing to dethrone the king, and put himself in his place. This Ache was a villain, who after having betrayed his king, proposed to betray the Normans, and to chase them from the country. Gadifer had no suspicion of his motives; wishing to avenge the death of his men, he accepted Ache's proposal, and a short time afterwards, on the vigil of St. Catherine's day, the king was seized, and conveyed to the fort in chains.
But meanwhile, very serious problems had come up on Lancerota. King Guardafia was so hurt by Berneval's actions that he rebelled, and some of Gadifer's companions were killed by the islanders. Gadifer insisted that these individuals be punished, when one of the king's relatives named Ache approached him with a plan to dethrone the king and take his place. Ache was a villain who, after betraying his king, proposed to betray the Normans and drive them out of the country. Gadifer had no suspicion of his motives; wanting to avenge the deaths of his men, he accepted Ache's proposal, and shortly afterward, on the eve of St. Catherine's Day, the king was captured and taken to the fort in chains.
Some days afterwards, Ache, the new king of the island attacked Gadifer's companions, mortally wounding several of them, but the following night Guardafia having made his escape from the fort seized Ache, had him stoned to death, and his body burnt. The governor (Gadifer) was so grieved by these scenes of violence, which were renewed daily, that he resolved to kill all the men on the island, and save only the women and children, whom he hoped to have baptized. But just at this time, the vessel that Béthencourt had freighted for the governor arrived, and brought besides the eighty men, provisions, &c., a letter which told him among other things that Béthencourt had done homage to the King of Castille for the Canary Islands. The governor was not well pleased at this news, for he thought that he ought to have had his share in the islands; but he concealed his displeasure, and gave the new comers a hearty welcome.
Some days later, Ache, the new king of the island, attacked Gadifer's men, seriously injuring several of them. However, that night Guardafia escaped from the fort, captured Ache, had him stoned to death, and burned his body. The governor, Gadifer, was so troubled by these acts of violence, which occurred daily, that he decided to kill all the men on the island and only save the women and children, whom he hoped to have baptized. Just then, the ship that Béthencourt had sent for the governor arrived, bringing not only eighty men and supplies but also a letter stating that Béthencourt had pledged loyalty to the King of Castile for the Canary Islands. The governor was not happy with this news because he believed he should have had a share in the islands, but he hid his displeasure and welcomed the newcomers warmly.
The arms were at once disembarked, and then Gadifer went on board the vessel to explore the neighbouring islands. Remonnet and several others joined him in this expedition, and they took two of the islanders with them to serve as guides.
The weapons were unloaded right away, and then Gadifer boarded the ship to check out the nearby islands. Remonnet and a few others joined him on this trip, and they brought along two of the islanders to act as guides.
They arrived safely at Fortaventura island; a few days after landing on the island, Gadifer set out with thirty-five men to explore the country; but soon the greater part of his followers deserted him, only thirteen men, including two archers, remaining with him. But he did not give up his project; after wading through a large stream, he found himself in a lovely valley shaded by numberless palm-trees; here having rested and refreshed himself, he set out again and climbed a hill. At the summit he found about fifty natives, who surrounded the small party and threatened to murder them. Gadifer and his companions showed no signs of fear, and succeeded in putting their enemies to flight; by the evening they were able to regain their vessel, carrying away four of the native women as prisoners.
They arrived safely at Fortaventura Island. A few days after landing, Gadifer set out with thirty-five men to explore the area, but soon most of his followers deserted him, leaving only thirteen men, including two archers, with him. However, he didn’t abandon his plan; after crossing a large stream, he found himself in a beautiful valley filled with palm trees. After resting and recharging, he set out again and climbed a hill. At the top, he encountered about fifty natives who surrounded the small group and threatened to kill them. Gadifer and his companions showed no fear and managed to drive their enemies away; by evening, they were able to return to their ship, taking four of the native women as captives.
![]() |
Gadifer found himself in a lovely valley. |
The next day Gadifer left the island and went to the Gran Canaria island anchoring in a large harbour lying between Telde and Argonney. Five hundred of the natives confronted them, but apparently with no hostile intentions; they gave them some fish-hooks and old iron in exchange for some of the natural productions of the island, such as figs, and dragon's blood, a resinous substance taken from the dragon-tree, which has a very pleasant balsamic odour. The natives were very much on their guard with the strangers, for twenty years before this some of Captain Lopez' men had invaded the island; so they would not allow Gadifer to land.
The next day, Gadifer left the island and headed to Gran Canaria, anchoring in a large harbor between Telde and Argonney. Five hundred locals confronted them, but they seemed to have no hostile intentions; they offered fish-hooks and old iron in exchange for some of the island’s natural products, like figs and dragon's blood, a resin from the dragon-tree that has a pleasant balsamic scent. The locals were very cautious around the strangers because, twenty years earlier, some of Captain Lopez's men had invaded the island, so they wouldn’t let Gadifer land.
The governor was obliged to weigh anchor without exploring the island; he went to Ferro Island, and coasting along it arrived next at Gomera; it was night, and the sailors were attracted by the fires that the natives had lighted on the shore. When day broke Gadifer and his companions wished to land; but the islanders would not allow them to proceed when they reached the shore, and drove them back to their vessel. Much disappointed by his reception, Gadifer determined to make another attempt at Ferro Island; there he found that he could land without opposition, and he remained on the island twenty-two days. The interior of the island was very beautiful. Pine-trees grew in abundance, and clear streams of water added to its fertility. Quails were found in large numbers, as well as pigs, goats, and sheep.
The governor had to set sail without checking out the island; he headed to Ferro Island and then moved along its coast, reaching Gomera next. It was night, and the sailors were drawn to the fires the locals had lit on the shore. When morning came, Gadifer and his companions wanted to go ashore, but the islanders wouldn't let them land and pushed them back to their ship. Feeling let down by their reception, Gadifer decided to try again at Ferro Island; there, he found he could land without any issues and stayed on the island for twenty-two days. The landscape was stunning. Pine trees were plentiful, and clear streams of water contributed to its richness. Quails were abundant, as well as pigs, goats, and sheep.
From this fertile island the party of explorers went to Palma, and anchored in a harbour situated to the right of a large river. This is the furthest island of the Canary group; it is covered with pine and dragon-trees; from the abundance of fresh water the pasturage is excellent and the land might be cultivated with much profit. Its inhabitants are a tall, robust race, well made, with good features and very white skin. Gadifer remained a short time on this island; on leaving it he spent two days and two nights sailing round the other islands, and then returned to the fort on Lancerota. They had been absent three months. In the meantime, those of the party who had been left in the fort had waged a petty war with the natives, and had made a great number of prisoners. The Canarians, demoralized, now came daily to cast themselves on their mercy, and to pray for the consecration of baptism. Gadifer was so pleased to hear of this, that he sent one of his companions to Spain to inform Béthencourt of the state of the colony.
From this fertile island, the group of explorers headed to Palma and anchored in a harbor next to a large river. This is the furthest island in the Canary group; it's filled with pine and dragon trees. The plentiful fresh water makes it great for grazing, and the land could be farmed for a good profit. The locals are a tall, strong people, well-built, with attractive features and very light skin. Gadifer stayed a short time on this island; after leaving, he spent two days and two nights sailing around the other islands before returning to the fort on Lanzarote. They had been away for three months. Meanwhile, the members of the group who stayed at the fort were engaged in minor conflicts with the locals and captured many prisoners. The Canarians, demoralized, now came daily to seek their mercy and to ask for baptism. Gadifer was thrilled to hear this, so he sent one of his companions to Spain to update Béthencourt on the condition of the colony.
JEAN DE BÉTHENCOURT.
The return of Jean de Béthencourt—Gadifer's jealousy—Béthencourt visits his archipelago—Gadifer goes to conquer Gran Canaria—Disagreement of the two commanders—Their return to Spain—Gadifer blamed by the King—Return of Béthencourt—The natives of Fortaventura are baptized—Béthencourt revisits Caux—Returns to Lancerota—Lands on the African coast—Conquest of Gran Canaria, Ferro, and Palma Islands—Maciot appointed Governor of the archipelago—Béthencourt obtains the Pope's consent to the Canary Islands being made an Episcopal See—His return to his country and his death.
The return of Jean de Béthencourt—Gadifer's jealousy—Béthencourt visits his archipelago—Gadifer sets out to conquer Gran Canaria—Disagreement between the two commanders—Their return to Spain—Gadifer is blamed by the King—Béthencourt's return—The natives of Fortaventura are baptized—Béthencourt goes back to Caux—Returns to Lanzarote—Lands on the African coast—Conquest of Gran Canaria, Ferro, and Palma Islands—Maciot is appointed Governor of the archipelago—Béthencourt gets the Pope's approval for the Canary Islands to be designated an Episcopal See—His return to his homeland and his death.
The envoy had not reached Cadiz when Béthencourt landed at the fort on Lancerota. Gadifer gave him a hearty welcome, and so did the Canary islanders who had been baptized. A few days afterwards, King Guardafia came and threw himself on their mercy. He was baptized on the 20th of February, 1404, with all his followers. Béthencourt's chaplains drew up a very simple form of instruction for their use, embracing the principal elements of Christianity, the creation, Adam and Eve's fall, the history of Noah, the lives of the patriarchs, the life of our Saviour and His crucifixion by the Jews, finishing with an exhortation to believe the ten commandments, the Holy Sacrament of the Altar, Easter, confession, and some other points.
The envoy hadn’t arrived in Cadiz when Béthencourt landed at the fort on Lanzarote. Gadifer gave him a warm welcome, as did the baptized Canary Islanders. A few days later, King Guardafia came and begged for their mercy. He was baptized on February 20, 1404, along with all his followers. Béthencourt’s chaplains created a very simple guide for them, covering the main points of Christianity: creation, the fall of Adam and Eve, the story of Noah, the lives of the patriarchs, the life of our Savior, His crucifixion by the Jews, and concluding with an encouragement to believe in the ten commandments, the Holy Sacrament of the Altar, Easter, confession, and some other key topics.
Béthencourt was an ambitious man. Not content with having explored, and so to speak, gained possession of the Canary Islands, he desired to conquer the African countries bordering on the ocean. This was his secret wish in returning to Lancerota, and meanwhile, he had full occupation in establishing his authority in these islands, of which he was only the nominal sovereign. He gave himself wholly to the task, and first visited the islands which Gadifer had explored.
Béthencourt was an ambitious man. Not satisfied with having explored and, in a way, taken ownership of the Canary Islands, he wanted to conquer the African countries along the coast. This was his hidden ambition when he returned to Lanzarote, and in the meantime, he was focused on establishing his authority in these islands, where he was only the nominal ruler. He devoted himself entirely to this task and first visited the islands that Gadifer had explored.
But before he set out, a conversation took place between Gadifer and himself, which we must not omit to notice. Gadifer began boasting of all he had done, and asked for the gift of Fortaventura, Teneriffe, and Gomera Islands, as a recompense.
But before he left, a conversation happened between Gadifer and himself that we shouldn’t overlook. Gadifer started bragging about everything he had accomplished and asked for the gift of Fortaventura, Teneriffe, and Gomera Islands as a reward.
"My friend," replied Béthencourt, "the islands that you ask me to give you are not yet conquered, but I do not intend you to be at any loss for your trouble, nor that you should be unrequited; but let us accomplish our project, and meanwhile remain the friends we have always been."
"My friend," replied Béthencourt, "the islands you're asking me to give you haven’t been conquered yet, but I don't want you to feel like your efforts are in vain, nor do I want you to go unrewarded; so let’s go ahead with our plan, and in the meantime, let’s stay the friends we've always been."
"That is all very well," replied Gadifer, "but there is one point on which I do not feel at all satisfied, and that is that you have done homage to the King of Castille for these islands, and so you call yourself absolute master over them."
"That's all well and good," Gadifer replied, "but there's one thing I'm not happy about, and that's that you have pledged loyalty to the King of Castile for these islands, which makes you call yourself the sole master of them."
"With regard to that," said Béthencourt, "I certainly have done homage for them, and so I am their rightful master, but if you will only patiently wait the end of our affair, I will give you what I feel sure will quite content you."
"About that," said Béthencourt, "I definitely have paid my respects to them, so I am their rightful master. But if you can just wait patiently for the end of our situation, I will give you something that I’m sure will satisfy you completely."
"I shall not remain here," replied Gadifer, "I am going back to France, and have no wish to be here any longer."
"I’m not staying here," Gadifer replied, "I’m going back to France, and I don’t want to be here any longer."
Upon this they separated, but Gadifer gradually cooled down and agreed to accompany Béthencourt in his exploration of the islands.
Upon this, they parted ways, but Gadifer gradually calmed down and agreed to join Béthencourt in exploring the islands.
They set out for Fortaventura well armed and with plenty of provisions. They remained there three months, and began by seizing a number of the natives, and sending them to Lancerota. This was such a usual mode of proceeding at that time that we are less surprised at it than we should be at the present day. The whole island was explored and a fort named Richeroque built on the slope of a high mountain; traces of it may still be found in a hamlet there.
They left for Fortaventura well-armed and stocked with plenty of supplies. They stayed there for three months, starting by capturing several of the locals and sending them to Lancerota. This was such a common practice back then that we are less shocked by it than we would be today. The entire island was explored, and a fort called Richeroque was built on the side of a tall mountain; remnants of it can still be found in a nearby village.
Just at this time, and when he had scarcely had time to forget his grievances and ill-humour, Gadifer accepted the command of a small band of men who were to conquer Gran Canaria.
Just at that moment, and when he had barely had time to forget his grievances and bad mood, Gadifer took on the leadership of a small group of men who were set to conquer Gran Canaria.
He set out on the 25th July, 1404, but this expedition was not fated to meet with any good results, winds and waves were against it. At last they reached the port of Telde, but as it was nearly dark and a strong wind blowing they dared not land, and they went on to the little town of Aginmez, where they remained eleven days at anchor; the natives, encouraged by their king, laid an ambush for Gadifer and his followers; there was a skirmish, blood was shed, and the Castilians, feeling themselves outnumbered, went to Telde for two days, and thence to Lancerota.
He set out on July 25, 1404, but this expedition wasn't destined for success; the winds and waves were against them. Eventually, they arrived at the port of Telde, but since it was nearly dark and a strong wind was blowing, they didn't dare to land and continued on to the small town of Aginmez, where they anchored for eleven days. The locals, encouraged by their king, set a trap for Gadifer and his followers; there was a skirmish, blood was spilled, and the Castilians, feeling outnumbered, retreated to Telde for two days before heading to Lanzarote.
Gadifer was much disappointed at his want of success, and began to be discontented with everything around him. Above all, his jealousy of Béthencourt increased daily, and he gave way to violent recriminations, saying openly that the chief had not done everything himself, and that things would not have been in so advanced a stage as they were if others had not aided him. This reached Béthencourt's ears; he was much incensed, and reproached Gadifer. High words followed, Gadifer insisted upon leaving the country, and as Béthencourt had just made arrangements for returning to Spain, he proposed to Gadifer to accompany him, that their cause of disagreement might be inquired into. This proposal being accepted, they set sail, but each in his own ship. When they reached Seville, Gadifer laid his complaints before the king, but as the king gave judgment against him, fully approving of Béthencourt's conduct, he left Spain, and returning to France, never revisited the Canary Islands which he had so fondly hoped to conquer for himself.
Gadifer was really disappointed with his lack of success and started to feel unhappy with everything around him. His jealousy of Béthencourt grew every day, and he was openly critical, claiming that the chief hadn't done everything by himself and that things wouldn't have progressed as far as they had without others' help. This gossip reached Béthencourt, who was furious and confronted Gadifer. They exchanged harsh words, and Gadifer insisted on leaving the country. Since Béthencourt had just made plans to return to Spain, he suggested that Gadifer join him so they could sort out their differences. Gadifer agreed to this proposal, and they set sail, each on their own ship. When they arrived in Seville, Gadifer presented his complaints to the king. However, the king ruled against him and fully supported Béthencourt’s actions, so Gadifer left Spain and returned to France, never to visit the Canary Islands again, which he had so eagerly hoped to conquer for himself.
Béthencourt took leave of the king almost at the same time, for the new colony demanded his immediate presence there; but before he left, the inhabitants of Seville, with whom he was a great favourite, showed him much kindness; what he valued more highly than anything else was the supply of arms, gold, silver, and provisions that they gave him. He went to Fortaventura, where his companions were delighted to see him. Gadifer had left his son Hannibal in his place, but Béthencourt treated him with much cordiality.
Béthencourt said goodbye to the king around the same time, as the new colony needed him right away; however, before he departed, the people of Seville, who were very fond of him, showed him a lot of kindness. What he appreciated the most was the shipment of weapons, gold, silver, and food that they provided. He went to Fortaventura, where his companions were thrilled to see him. Gadifer had left his son Hannibal in his absence, but Béthencourt greeted him warmly.
The first days of the installation of Béthencourt were far from peaceful; skirmishes were of constant occurrence, the natives even destroying the fortress of Richeroque, after burning and pillaging a chapel. Béthencourt was determined to overcome them, and in the end succeeded. He sent for several of his men from Lancerota, and gave orders that the fortress should be rebuilt.
The early days of Béthencourt's settlement were anything but peaceful; there were constant skirmishes, with the natives even destroying the fortress of Richeroque after burning down and looting a chapel. Béthencourt was set on overcoming them, and eventually, he did succeed. He called for several of his men from Lancerota and ordered the fortress to be rebuilt.
In spite of all this the combats began again, and many of the islanders fell, among others a giant of nine feet high, whom Béthencourt would have liked to have made prisoner. The governor could not trust Gadifer's son nor the men who followed him, for Hannibal seemed to have inherited his father's jealousy, but as Béthencourt needed his help, he concealed his distrust. Happily, Béthencourt's men outnumbered those who were faithful to Gadifer, but Hannibal's taunts became so unbearable that Jean de Courtois was sent to remind him of his oath of obedience and to advise him to keep it.
Despite all this, the fights started up again, and many of the islanders were killed, including a nine-foot-tall giant whom Béthencourt would have liked to capture. The governor couldn't trust Gadifer's son or the men who followed him, since Hannibal seemed to have inherited his father's jealousy. However, since Béthencourt needed his help, he hid his distrust. Fortunately, Béthencourt's men were more numerous than those loyal to Gadifer, but Hannibal's taunts became so unbearable that Jean de Courtois was sent to remind him of his oath of obedience and to urge him to stick to it.
Courtois was very badly received, he having a crow to pick with Hannibal with regard to some native prisoners whom Gadifer's followers had kept and would not give up. Hannibal was obliged to obey the orders, but Courtois represented his conduct to Béthencourt on his return in the very worst light, and tried to excite his master's anger against him. "No, sir," answered the upright Béthencourt, "I do not wish him to be wronged, we must never carry our power to its utmost limits, we should always endeavour to control ourselves and preserve our honour rather than seek for profit."
Courtois was received very poorly because he had a personal issue with Hannibal regarding some local prisoners that Gadifer's men had captured and refused to release. Although Hannibal had to follow orders, Courtois returned to Béthencourt and painted Hannibal's actions in the worst possible light, trying to stir up his master's anger against him. "No, sir," replied the honorable Béthencourt, "I don’t want him to be treated unfairly. We must never push our authority to its absolute limits; we should always strive to control ourselves and maintain our integrity instead of pursuing profit."
In spite of these intestine discords, the war continued between the natives and the conquerors, but the latter being well-armed always came off victorious. The kings of Fortaventura sent a native to Béthencourt saying that they wished to make peace with him, and to become Christians. This news delighted the conqueror, and he sent word that they would be well received if they would come to him. Almost immediately on receiving this reply, King Maxorata, who governed the north-westerly part of the island, set out, and with his suite of twenty-two persons, was baptized on the 18th of January, 1405. Three days afterwards twenty-two other natives received the sacrament of baptism. On the 25th of January the king who governed the peninsula of Handia, the south-eastern part of the island, came with twenty-six of his subjects, and was baptized. In a short time all the inhabitants of Fortaventura had embraced the Christian religion.
Despite these internal conflicts, the war persisted between the natives and the conquerors, with the latter always emerging victorious due to their superior weaponry. The kings of Fortaventura sent a messenger to Béthencourt, expressing their desire to make peace and convert to Christianity. This news thrilled the conqueror, and he responded that they would be warmly welcomed if they came to him. Almost immediately after receiving this reply, King Maxorata, who ruled the northwestern part of the island, set out and, along with his entourage of twenty-two people, was baptized on January 18, 1405. Three days later, another twenty-two natives received the sacrament of baptism. On January 25, the king who governed the Handia peninsula in the southeastern part of the island arrived with twenty-six of his subjects and was baptized. Soon, all the inhabitants of Fortaventura had embraced Christianity.
![]() |
The King of Maxorata arrived with his suite. |
Béthencourt was so elated with these happy results, that he arranged to revisit his own country, leaving Courtois as governor during his absence. He set out on the last day of January amid the prayers and blessings of his people, taking with him three native men and one woman, to whom he wished to show something of France. He reached Harfleur in twenty-one days, and two days later was at his own house, where he only intended making a short stay, and then returning to the Canary Islands. He met with a very warm reception from everybody. One of his chief motives in returning to France was the hope of finding people of all classes ready to return with him, on the promise of grants of land in the island. He succeeded in finding a certain number of emigrants, amongst whom were twenty-eight soldiers, of whom twenty-three took their wives. Two vessels were prepared to transport the party, and the 6th of May was the day named for them to set out. On the 9th of May they set sail, and landed on Lancerota just four mouths and a half after Béthencourt had quitted it.
Béthencourt was so thrilled with these positive outcomes that he decided to go back to his home country, leaving Courtois as governor in his absence. He set out on the last day of January, receiving prayers and blessings from his people, and took three native men and one woman with him to show them a bit of France. He reached Harfleur in twenty-one days, and two days later arrived at his own house, where he only planned to stay briefly before returning to the Canary Islands. He was warmly welcomed by everyone. One of his main reasons for coming back to France was the hope of finding people from all backgrounds eager to join him in exchange for land grants on the island. He managed to find a good number of settlers, including twenty-eight soldiers, twenty-three of whom brought their wives. Two ships were readied to transport the group, with May 6th set as the departure date. On May 9th, they set sail and landed on Lanzarote just four and a half months after Béthencourt had left it.
He was received with trumpets, clarionets, tambourines, harps, and other musical instruments. Thunder could scarcely have been heard above the sound of this music. The natives celebrated his return by dancing and singing, and crying out, "Here comes our king." Jean de Courtois hastened to welcome his master, who asked him how everything was going on; he replied, "Sir, all is going on as well as possible."
He was welcomed with trumpets, clarinets, tambourines, harps, and other musical instruments. Thunder could barely be heard over the music. The locals celebrated his return by dancing and singing, shouting, "Here comes our king." Jean de Courtois rushed to greet his master, who asked him how everything was going; he replied, "Sir, everything is going as well as it can."
Béthencourt's companions stayed with him at the fort of Lancerota; they appeared much pleased with the country, enjoying the dates and other fruits on the island, "and nothing seemed to harm them." After they had been a short time at Lancerota, Béthencourt went with them to see Fortaventura, and here his reception was as warm as it had been at Lancerota, especially from the islanders and their two kings. The kings supped with them at the fortress of Richeroque, which Courtois had rebuilt.
Béthencourt's companions stayed with him at the fort of Lancerota; they seemed really happy with the place, enjoying the dates and other fruits found on the island, "and nothing seemed to bother them." After spending some time at Lancerota, Béthencourt went with them to visit Fortaventura, where he was welcomed just as warmly as he had been at Lancerota, especially by the islanders and their two kings. The kings dined with them at the fortress of Richeroque, which Courtois had rebuilt.
Béthencourt announced his intention of conquering Gran Canaria Island, as he had done Lancerota and Fortaventura; his hope was that his nephew Maciot, whom he had brought with him from France, would succeed him in the government of these islands, so that the name of Béthencourt might be perpetuated there. He imparted his project to Courtois, who highly approved of it, and added, "Sir, when you return to France, I will go with you. I am a bad husband. It is five years since I saw my wife, and, by my troth, she did not much care about it."
Béthencourt announced his plan to conquer Gran Canaria Island, just as he had done with Lanzarote and Fuerteventura. He hoped that his nephew Maciot, whom he had brought with him from France, would take over the governance of these islands so that the name of Béthencourt would live on there. He shared his plan with Courtois, who fully supported it and added, "Sir, when you return to France, I will come with you. I’m a terrible husband. It’s been five years since I last saw my wife, and honestly, she didn’t seem to mind."
The 6th of October, 1405, was the day fixed for starting for Gran Canaria, but contrary winds carried the ships towards the African coast, and they passed by Cape Bojador, where Béthencourt landed. He made an expedition twenty-four miles inland, and seized some natives and a great number of camels that he took to his vessels. They put as many of the camels as possible on board, wishing to acclimatize them in the Canary Islands, and the baron set sail again, leaving Cape Bojador, which he had the honour of seeing thirty years before the Portuguese navigators.
The 6th of October, 1405, was the planned departure date for Gran Canaria, but unfavorable winds pushed the ships toward the African coast, and they passed by Cape Bojador, where Béthencourt landed. He made an expedition twenty-four miles inland, capturing some locals and a large number of camels that he brought back to his ships. They loaded as many camels as they could on board, hoping to acclimate them in the Canary Islands, and the baron set sail again, leaving Cape Bojador, which he had the honor of seeing thirty years before the Portuguese navigators.
During this voyage from the coast of Africa to Gran Canaria, the three vessels were separated in stormy weather, one going to Palma, and another to Fortaventura, but finally they all reached Gran Canaria. This island is sixty miles long and thirty-six miles broad; at the northern end it is flat, but very hilly towards the south. Firs, dragon-trees, olive, fig, and date-trees form large forests, and sheep, goats, and wild dogs are found here in large numbers. The soil is very fertile, and produces two crops of corn every year, and that without any means of improving it. Its inhabitants form a large body of people, and consider themselves all on an equality.
During this journey from the coast of Africa to Gran Canaria, the three ships got separated in rough weather—one headed to Palma, and another to Fuerteventura—but eventually, they all made it to Gran Canaria. This island is sixty miles long and thirty-six miles wide; the northern end is flat, while the southern part is quite hilly. There are large forests of firs, dragon trees, olive trees, fig trees, and date palms, and you can find plenty of sheep, goats, and wild dogs here. The soil is very fertile and produces two harvests of grain each year, all without any improvements. The people living here form a large community and see themselves as equals.
When Béthencourt had landed he set to work at once to conquer the island. Unfortunately his Norman soldiers were so proud of their success on the coast of Africa, that they thought they could conquer this island with its ten thousand natives, with a mere handful of men. Béthencourt seeing that they were so confident of success, recommended them to be prudent, but they took no heed of this and bitterly they rued their confidence. After a skirmish, in which they seemed to have got the better of the islanders, they had left their ranks, when the natives surprised them, massacring twenty-two of them, including Jean de Courtois and Hannibal, Gadifer's son.
When Béthencourt landed, he immediately set out to conquer the island. Unfortunately, his Norman soldiers were so proud of their success on the coast of Africa that they believed they could take this island, populated by ten thousand natives, with just a small group of men. Béthencourt noticed their overconfidence and advised them to be cautious, but they ignored his warning and later regretted their arrogance. After a skirmish where they seemed to have the upper hand against the islanders, they let their guard down, allowing the natives to surprise them and kill twenty-two of them, including Jean de Courtois and Hannibal, Gadifer's son.
After this sad affair Béthencourt left Gran Canaria and went to try to subdue Palma. The natives of this island were very clever in slinging stones, rarely missing their aim, and in the encounters with these islanders many fell on both sides, but more natives than Normans, whose loss, however, amounted to one hundred.
After this unfortunate event, Béthencourt left Gran Canaria to attempt to conquer Palma. The locals on this island were very skilled at slinging stones, rarely missing their target, and in the clashes with these islanders, many were lost on both sides, though more natives than Normans, whose losses totaled one hundred.
After six weeks of skirmishing, Béthencourt left Palma, and went to Ferro for three months, a large island twenty-one miles long and fifteen broad. It is a flat table-land, and large woods of pine and laurel-trees shade it in many places. The mists, which are frequent, moisten the soil and make it especially favourable for the cultivation of corn and the vine. Game is abundant; pigs, goats, and sheep run wild about the country; there are also great lizards in shape like the iguana of America. The inhabitants both men and women are a very fine race, healthy, lively, agile and particularly well made, in fact Ferro is one of the pleasantest islands of the group.
After six weeks of skirmishing, Béthencourt left Palma and went to Ferro for three months, a large island that's twenty-one miles long and fifteen miles wide. It's a flat plateau, with large pine and laurel forests providing shade in many areas. The frequent mists keep the soil moist, making it especially favorable for growing corn and grapes. Game is plentiful; wild pigs, goats, and sheep roam the land, and there are also large lizards similar to the iguanas found in America. The inhabitants, both men and women, are a very attractive people, healthy, lively, agile, and particularly well-built. In fact, Ferro is one of the most pleasant islands in the group.
Béthencourt returned to Fortaventura with his ships after conquering Ferro and Palma. This island is fifty-one miles in length by twenty-four in breadth, and has high mountains as well as large plains, but its surface is less undulating than that of the other islands. Large streams of fresh water run through the island; the euphorbia, a deadly poison, grows largely here, and date and olive-trees are abundant, as well as a plant that is invaluable for dyeing and whose cultivation would be most remunerative. The coast of Fortaventura has no good harbours for large vessels, but small ones can anchor there quite safely. It was in this island that Béthencourt began to make a partition of land to the colonists, and he succeeded in doing it so evenly that every one was satisfied with his portion. Those colonists whom he had brought with him were to be exempted from taxes for nine years.
Béthencourt returned to Fortaventura with his ships after conquering Ferro and Palma. This island is fifty-one miles long and twenty-four miles wide, featuring high mountains as well as large plains, but its surface is less hilly than that of the other islands. Large streams of fresh water flow through the island; the euphorbia, which is highly toxic, grows abundantly here, along with plenty of date and olive trees, as well as a valuable plant that is great for dyeing and whose cultivation would be very profitable. The coast of Fortaventura doesn’t have good harbors for large ships, but smaller ones can anchor there quite safely. It was on this island that Béthencourt began to distribute land to the colonists, and he managed to do it so fairly that everyone was happy with their share. The colonists he brought with him would be exempt from taxes for nine years.
The question of religion, and religious administration could not fail to be of the deepest interest to so pious a man as Béthencourt, so he resolved to go to Rome and try to obtain a bishop for this country, who "would order and adorn the Roman Catholic faith." Before setting out he appointed his nephew Maciot as lieutenant and governor of the islands. Under his orders two sergeants were to act, and enforce justice; he desired that twice a year news of the colony should be sent to him in Normandy, and the revenue from Lancerota and Fortaventura was to be devoted to building two churches. He said to his nephew Maciot, "I give you full authority in everything to do whatever you think best, and I believe you will do all for my honour and to my advantage. Follow as nearly as possible Norman and French customs, especially in the administration of justice. Above all things, try and keep peace and unity among yourselves, and care for each other as brothers, and specially try that there shall be no rivalry among the gentlemen; I have given to each one his share and the country is quite large enough for each to have his own sphere. I can tell you nothing further beyond again impressing the importance of your all living as good friends together, and then all will be well."
The issue of religion and how it was managed was incredibly important to someone as devout as Béthencourt, so he decided to go to Rome and try to get a bishop for this country who would "lead and enhance the Roman Catholic faith." Before he left, he appointed his nephew Maciot as lieutenant and governor of the islands. Two sergeants would report to him and enforce justice; he wanted updates from the colony sent to him in Normandy twice a year, and the income from Lancerota and Fortaventura was to be used to build two churches. He told his nephew Maciot, "I give you full authority to do whatever you think is best, and I trust that you will act for my honor and benefit. Stick to Norman and French customs as much as you can, especially in administering justice. Above all, try to maintain peace and unity among yourselves and support each other like brothers, and make sure there is no rivalry among the gentlemen; I've assigned each of them their share, and the country is more than big enough for everyone to have their own space. I don’t have anything else to add other than to emphasize the importance of all of you living together as good friends, and everything will be fine."
Béthencourt remained three months in Fortaventura and the other islands. He rode about among the people on his mule, and found many of the natives beginning to speak Norman-French. Maciot and the other gentlemen accompanied him, he pointing out what was best to be done and the most honest way of doing it. Then he gave notice that he would set out for Rome on the ensuing 15th of December. Returning to Lancerota, he remained there till his departure, and ordered all the gentlemen he had brought with him, the workmen, and the three kings to appear before him two days before his departure, to tell them what he wished done, and to commend himself and them to God's protection.
Béthencourt stayed three months in Fortaventura and the other islands. He rode around on his mule, interacting with the locals, and noticed that many of them were starting to speak Norman-French. Maciot and the other gentlemen went with him, as he indicated the best and most honest ways to proceed. Then he announced that he would leave for Rome on the upcoming 15th of December. After returning to Lancerota, he stayed there until his departure and instructed all the gentlemen he brought with him, the workers, and the three kings to meet with him two days before he left, to share his wishes for what needed to be done, and to commend himself and them to God's protection.
None failed to appear at this meeting; they were all received at the fort on Lancerota, and sumptuously entertained. When the repast was over, he spoke to them, especially impressing the duty of obedience to his nephew Maciot upon them, the retention of the fifth of everything for himself, and also the exercise of all Christian virtues and of fervent love to God. This done, he chose those who were to accompany him to Rome, and prepared to set out.
None missed the meeting; they were all welcomed at the fort on Lancerota and treated lavishly. After the meal, he addressed them, particularly stressing the importance of obeying his nephew Maciot, keeping a fifth of everything for himself, and practicing all Christian virtues along with sincere love for God. Once that was taken care of, he selected those who would travel with him to Rome and got ready to leave.
His vessel had scarcely set sail when cries and groans were heard on all sides, both Europeans and natives alike regretting this just master, who they feared would never return to them. A great number waded into the water, and tried to stop the vessel that carried him away from them, but the sails were set and Béthencourt was really gone. "May God keep him safe from all harm," was the utterance of many that day. In a week he was at Seville, from thence he went to Valladolid, where the king received him very graciously. He related the narrative of his conquests to the king, and requested from him letters recommending him to the Pope, that he might have a bishop appointed for the islands. The king gave him the letters, and loaded him with gifts, and then Béthencourt set out for Rome with a numerous retinue.
His ship had barely set sail when cries and moans filled the air, with both Europeans and locals lamenting the loss of their kind leader, who they feared would never come back. Many waded into the water, trying to halt the vessel that was taking him away, but the sails were up, and Béthencourt was truly gone. "May God keep him safe from all harm," was the wish of many that day. Within a week, he arrived in Seville, and then he traveled to Valladolid, where the king welcomed him warmly. He shared the story of his conquests with the king and asked for letters of recommendation to the Pope so that a bishop could be appointed for the islands. The king granted him the letters, showered him with gifts, and then Béthencourt set off for Rome with a large entourage.
He remained three weeks in the eternal city, and was admitted to kiss Pope Innocent VII.'s foot, who complimented him on his having made so many proselytes to the Christian faith, and on his bravery in having ventured so far from his native country. When the bulls were prepared as Béthencourt had requested, and Albert des Maisons was appointed Bishop of the Canary Islands, the Norman took leave of the Pope after receiving his blessing.
He spent three weeks in the eternal city and was allowed to kiss Pope Innocent VII's foot, who praised him for converting so many people to the Christian faith and for his courage in traveling so far from his homeland. When the bulls were prepared as Béthencourt had requested, and Albert des Maisons was appointed Bishop of the Canary Islands, the Norman took his leave of the Pope after receiving his blessing.
The new prelate took leave of Béthencourt, and set out at once for his diocese. He went by way of Spain, taking with him some letters from Béthencourt to the king. Then he set sail for Fortaventura and arrived there without any obstacle. Maciot gave him a cordial reception, and the bishop at once began to organize his diocese, governing with gentleness and courtesy, preaching now in one island, now in another, and offering up public prayers for Béthencourt's safety. Maciot was universally beloved, but especially by the natives. This happy, peaceful time only lasted for five years, for later on, Maciot began to abuse his unlimited power, and levied such heavy exactions that he was obliged to fly the country to save his life.
The new bishop said goodbye to Béthencourt and immediately headed to his diocese. He traveled through Spain, bringing some letters from Béthencourt to the king. Then he set sail for Fortaventura and arrived there without any issues. Maciot welcomed him warmly, and the bishop quickly started organizing his diocese, ruling with kindness and respect, preaching on different islands, and offering public prayers for Béthencourt's safety. Maciot was loved by everyone, especially the locals. This happy and peaceful period only lasted for five years because later on, Maciot began to misuse his unchecked power and imposed such heavy taxes that he had to flee the country to save his life.
Béthencourt after leaving Rome went to Florence and to Paris, and then to his own chateau, where a great number of people came to pay their respects to the king of the Canary Islands, and if on his return the first time he was much thought of, his reception this second time far exceeded it. Béthencourt established himself at Grainville; although he was an old man, his wife was still young. He had frequent accounts from Maciot of his beloved islands, and he hoped one day to return to his kingdom, but God willed otherwise. One day in the year 1425 he was seized with what proved to be fatal illness; he was aware that the end was near; and after making his will and receiving the last sacraments of the church he passed away. "May God keep him and pardon his sins," says the narrative of his life; "he is buried in the church of Grainville la Teinturière, in front of the high altar."
Béthencourt, after leaving Rome, traveled to Florence and then to Paris, before returning to his own chateau. There, a large number of people came to pay their respects to the king of the Canary Islands, and while he was well-received when he returned the first time, his welcome on this second visit was even greater. Béthencourt settled in Grainville; although he was an old man, his wife was still young. He often received updates from Maciot about his beloved islands and hoped to return to his kingdom one day, but that was not God's plan. One day in 1425, he fell ill with what turned out to be a fatal condition; he realized that the end was near. After making his will and receiving the last rites from the church, he passed away. "May God keep him and forgive his sins," the account of his life states; "he is buried in the church of Grainville la Teinturière, in front of the high altar."
![]() |
Jean de Béthencourt makes his will. |
CHAPTER VII.
I.
Discovery of Madeira, Cape de Verd Islands, the Azores, Congo, and Guinea—Bartholomew Diaz—Cabot and Labrador—The geographical and commercial tendencies of the middle ages—The erroneous idea of the distance between Europe and Asia—Birth of Christopher Columbus—His first voyages—His plans rejected—His sojourn at the Franciscan convent—His reception by Ferdinand and Isabella—Treaty of the 17th of April, 1492—The brothers Pinzon—Three armed caravels at the port of Palos—Departure on the 3rd of August, 1492.
Discovery of Madeira, Cape Verde Islands, the Azores, Congo, and Guinea—Bartholomew Diaz—Cabot and Labrador—The geographical and commercial trends of the Middle Ages—The mistaken belief about the distance between Europe and Asia—Birth of Christopher Columbus—His initial voyages—His plans turned down—His stay at the Franciscan convent—His meeting with Ferdinand and Isabella—Treaty of April 17, 1492—The Pinzon brothers—Three armed caravels at the port of Palos—Departure on August 3, 1492.
The year 1492 is an era in geographical annals. It is the date of the discovery of America. The genius of one man was fated to complete the terrestrial globe, and to show the truth of Gagliuffi's saying,—
The year 1492 is a significant point in geographical history. It marks the discovery of America. The brilliance of one man was destined to complete the world's map and to validate Gagliuffi's saying,—
The old world was to be entrusted with the moral and political education of the new. Was it equal to the task, with its ideas still limited, its tendencies still semi-barbarous, and its bitter religious animosities? We must leave the answer to these questions to the facts that follow.
The old world was supposed to teach the new one about morals and politics. Was it really up to the challenge, with its narrow ideas, partly savage tendencies, and deep religious hatred? We’ll have to let the following facts provide the answer to these questions.
Between the year 1405, when Béthencourt had just accomplished the colonization of the Canary Islands, and the year 1492, what had taken place? We will give a short sketch of the geographical enterprise of the intervening years. A considerable impetus had been given to science by the Arabs (who were soon to be expelled from Spain), and had spread throughout the peninsula. In all the ports, but more especially in those of Portugal, there was much talk of the continent of Africa, and the rich and wonderful countries beyond the sea. "A thousand anecdotes," says Michelet, "stimulated curiosity, valour and avarice, every one wishing to see these mysterious countries where monsters abounded and gold was scattered over the surface of the land." A young prince, Don Henry, duke of Viseu, third son of John I., who was very fond of the study of astronomy and geography, exercised a considerable influence over his contemporaries; it is to him that Portugal owes her colonial power and wealth and the expeditions so repeatedly made, which were vividly described, and their results spoken of as so wonderful, that they may have aided in awakening Columbus' love of adventure. Don Henry had an observatory built in the southern part of the province of Algarve, at Sagres, commanding a most splendid view over the sea, and seeming as though it must have been placed there to seek for some unknown land; he also established a naval college, where learned geographers traced correct maps and taught the use of the mariner's compass. The young prince surrounded himself with learned men, and especially gathered all the information he could as to the possibility of circumnavigating Africa, and thus reaching India. Though he had never taken part in any maritime expedition, his encouragement and care for seamen gave him the soubriquet of "the Navigator," by which name he is known in history. Two gentlemen belonging to Don Henry's court, Juan Gonzales Zarco, and Tristram Vaz Teixeira had passed Cape Nun, the terror of ancient navigators, when they were carried out to sea and passed near an island to which they gave the name of Porto-Santo. Sometime afterwards, as they were sailing towards a black point that remained on the horizon, they came to a large island covered with splendid forests; this was Madeira.
Between 1405, when Béthencourt had just finished colonizing the Canary Islands, and 1492, what happened? Here’s a brief overview of the geographical ventures during those years. The Arabs, who were soon to be expelled from Spain, had given a significant boost to science, which spread throughout the peninsula. In all the ports, especially in Portugal, there was a lot of chatter about the continent of Africa and the rich, amazing lands beyond the sea. "A thousand stories," says Michelet, "sparked curiosity, bravery, and greed, with everyone eager to see these mysterious places filled with monsters and land covered in gold." A young prince, Don Henry, Duke of Viseu, the third son of John I, who had a strong interest in astronomy and geography, greatly influenced his peers. Portugal owes its colonial power and wealth, as well as the many expeditions—vividly described and deemed so wonderful—that likely inspired Columbus' adventurous spirit, to him. Don Henry had an observatory built in the southern Algarve province at Sagres, which offered a stunning view of the sea, making it seem like the perfect spot to search for unknown lands. He also established a naval college, where learned geographers created accurate maps and taught students how to use the mariner's compass. The young prince surrounded himself with scholars and collected as much information as he could about the possibility of sailing around Africa to reach India. Although he never participated in any maritime expedition, his support and care for sailors earned him the nickname "the Navigator," by which he is known in history. Two gentlemen from Don Henry's court, Juan Gonzales Zarco and Tristram Vaz Teixeira, had passed Cape Nun, which was feared by ancient navigators, when they were carried out to sea and passed by an island they named Porto-Santo. Some time later, as they sailed toward a dark point on the horizon, they discovered a large island covered in magnificent forests; this was Madeira.
![]() |
Prince Henry of Portugal—"The Navigator." |
In 1433, Cape Bojador, which had for long been such a difficulty to navigators, was first doubled by the two Portuguese sailors, Gillianès and Gonzalès Baldaya, who passed more than forty leagues beyond it.
In 1433, Cape Bojador, which had long been a challenge for navigators, was first rounded by the two Portuguese sailors, Gillianès and Gonzalès Baldaya, who sailed more than forty leagues past it.
Encouraged by their example, Antonio Gonzalès, and Nuño Tristram, in 1441, sailed as far as Cape Blanco, "a feat," says Faria y Souza "that is generally looked upon as being little short of the labours of Hercules," and they brought back with them to Lisbon some gold-dust taken from the Rio del Ouro. In a second voyage Tristram noticed some of the Cape de Verd Islands, and went as far south as Sierra Leone. In the course of this expedition, he bought from some Moors off the coast of Guinea, ten negroes, whom he took back with him to Lisbon and parted with for a very high price, they having excited great curiosity. This was the origin of the slave-trade in Europe, which for the next 400 years robbed Africa of so many of her people, and was a disgrace to humanity.
Encouraged by their example, Antonio Gonzalès and Nuño Tristram, in 1441, sailed as far as Cape Blanco, "a feat," says Faria y Souza, "that is generally viewed as being nearly on par with the labors of Hercules." They returned to Lisbon with some gold dust taken from the Rio del Ouro. On a second voyage, Tristram observed some of the Cape Verde Islands and traveled as far south as Sierra Leone. During this expedition, he purchased ten Black people from some Moors off the coast of Guinea, bringing them back to Lisbon, where he sold them for a very high price, as they sparked great curiosity. This marked the beginning of the slave trade in Europe, which for the next 400 years robbed Africa of many of its people and was a shameful chapter in human history.
In 1441, Cada Mosto doubled Cape Verd, and explored a part of the coast below it. About 1446, the Portuguese, advancing further into the open sea than their predecessors, came upon the group of the Azores. From this time all fear vanished, for the formidable line had been passed, beyond which the air was said to scorch like fire; expeditions succeeded each other without intermission, and each brought home accounts of newly-discovered regions. It seemed as if the African continent was really endless, for the further they advanced towards the south, the further the cape they sought appeared to recede. Some little time before this King John II. had added the title of Seigneur of Guinea to his other titles, and to the discovery of Congo had been added that of some stars in the southern hemisphere hitherto unknown, when Diogo Cam, in three successive voyages, went further south than any preceding navigator, and bore away from Diaz the honour of being the discoverer of the southern point of the African continent. This cape is called Cape Cross, and here he raised a monument called a padrao or padron in memory of his discovery, which is still standing. On his way back, he visited the King of Congo in his capital, and took back with him an ambassador and numerous suite of natives, who were all baptized, and taught the elements of the Christian religion, which they were to propagate on their return to Congo.
In 1441, Cada Mosto doubled Cape Verde and explored part of the coast below it. Around 1446, the Portuguese, venturing further into the open sea than their predecessors, came across the Azores. From that point on, all fear vanished, as they had crossed a formidable line, beyond which the air was said to burn like fire; expeditions followed one after another without pause, each bringing back reports of newly discovered regions. It seemed like the African continent was truly endless, as the further they traveled south, the more the cape they sought seemed to move away. Not long before this, King John II had added the title Seigneur of Guinea to his other titles, and alongside the discovery of Congo, he noted some previously unknown stars in the southern hemisphere. Diogo Cam, on three successive voyages, went further south than any previous navigator and took from Diaz the honor of discovering the southern point of the African continent. This cape is called Cape Cross, where he erected a monument known as a padrao in memory of his discovery, which still stands today. On his way back, he visited the King of Congo in his capital and returned with an ambassador and a large group of natives, all of whom were baptized and taught the basics of Christianity to share upon their return to Congo.
A short time after Diogo Cam's return in the month of August, 1487, three caravels left the Tagus under the command of Bartholomew Diaz, a gentleman attached to the king's household, and an old sailor on the Guinea seas. He had an experienced mariner under him, and the smallest of the three vessels freighted with provisions, was commanded by his brother Pedro Diaz. We have no record of the earlier part of this expedition; we only know, from Joao de Barros, to whom we owe nearly all we learn of Portuguese navigation, that beyond Congo he followed the coast for some distance, and came to an anchorage that he named "Das Voltas" on account of the manner in which he had to tack to reach it, and there he left the smallest of the caravels under the care of nine sailors. After having been detained here five days by stress of weather, Diaz stood out to sea, and took a southerly course, but for thirteen days his vessels were tossed hither and thither by the tempest.
A little while after Diogo Cam returned in August 1487, three caravels set sail from the Tagus under the command of Bartholomew Diaz, a gentleman associated with the king's court and an experienced sailor on the Guinea seas. He had a skilled mariner working with him, and the smallest of the three ships, loaded with supplies, was commanded by his brother Pedro Diaz. We don’t have records of the earlier part of this expedition; all we know, thanks to Joao de Barros, who has informed us about much of Portuguese navigation, is that past the Congo, he followed the coast for a while and reached an anchorage he called "Das Voltas" because of the way he had to tack to get there. He left the smallest caravel there, in the care of nine sailors. After being stuck there for five days due to bad weather, Diaz ventured back out to sea and took a southern route, but for thirteen days, his ships were tossed around by the storm.
As he went further south the temperature fell and the air became very cold; at last the fury of the elements abated, and Diaz took an easterly course hoping to sight the land, but after several days had passed, and being in about 42° south latitude, he anchored in the bay "dos Vaquieros," so named from the numbers of horned animals and shepherds, who fled inland at the sight of the two vessels.
As he traveled further south, the temperature dropped, and the air became very cold; eventually, the storm settled down, and Diaz headed east, hoping to see land. But after several days, and being around 42° south latitude, he anchored in the bay "dos Vaquieros," named for the many horned animals and shepherds who ran inland when they saw the two ships.
At this time Diaz was about 120 miles east of the Cape of Good Hope, which he had doubled without seeing it. They then went to Sam Braz (now Mossel) bay, and coasted as far as Algoa bay and to an island called Da Cruz where they set up a padrao. But here the crews being much discouraged by the dangers they had passed through, and feeling much the scarcity and bad quality of the provisions, refused to go any farther. "Besides," they said, "as the land is now on our left, let us go back and see the Cape, which we have doubled without knowing it."
At this point, Diaz was about 120 miles east of the Cape of Good Hope, which he had rounded without seeing it. They then headed to Sam Braz (now Mossel) Bay and followed the coast as far as Algoa Bay and to an island called Da Cruz, where they set up a padrao. However, the crews, feeling disheartened by the dangers they had faced and struggling with the poor quality and scarcity of supplies, refused to go any further. "Besides," they said, "since the land is now on our left, let's turn back and check out the Cape, which we passed without realizing it."
Diaz called a council, and decided that they should go forwards in a north-easterly direction for two or three days longer. We owe it to his firmness of purpose that he was able to reach a river, 75 miles from Da Cruz that he called Rio Infante, but then the crew refusing to go farther, Diaz was obliged to return to Europe. Barros says, "When Diaz left the pillar that he had erected, it was with such sorrow and so much bitterness, that it seemed almost as though he were leaving an exiled son, and especially when he thought of all the dangers that he and his companions had passed through, and the long distance which they had come with only this memorial as a remembrance: it was indeed painful to break off when the task was but half completed." At last they saw the Cape of Good Hope, or as Diaz and his followers called it then, the "Cape of Torments," in remembrance of all the storms and tempests they had passed through before they could double it. With the foresight which so often accompanies genius, John II. substituted for the "Cape of Torments," the name of the "Cape of Good Hope," for he saw that now the route to India was open at last, and his vast plans for the extension of the commerce and influence of his country were about to be realized.
Diaz called a meeting and decided they should head northeast for another two or three days. Thanks to his determination, he managed to reach a river, 75 miles from Da Cruz, which he named Rio Infante. However, since the crew refused to go any further, Diaz had to turn back to Europe. Barros writes, "When Diaz left the pillar he had set up, it was with such sorrow and bitterness that it felt almost like leaving an exiled son, especially when he thought of all the dangers he and his companions had faced and the long distance they had traveled with only this memorial as a reminder: it was truly painful to stop when the mission was only half finished." Eventually, they sighted the Cape of Good Hope, which Diaz and his followers had initially called the "Cape of Torments," in memory of all the storms and tempests they had endured before they could round it. With the insight that often comes with genius, John II renamed the "Cape of Torments" to the "Cape of Good Hope," recognizing that the route to India was finally open and that his grand plans to expand his country's trade and influence were about to come to fruition.
On the 24th of August, 1488, Diaz returned to Angra das Voltas, where he had left his smallest caravel. He found six of his nine men dead, and the seventh was so overcome with joy at seeing his companions again that he died also. No particular incident marked the voyage home; they reached Lisbon in December, 1488, after staying at Benin, where they traded, and at La Mina to receive the money gained by the commerce of the colony.
On August 24, 1488, Diaz returned to Angra das Voltas, where he had left his smallest caravel. He found six of his nine crew members dead, and the seventh was so overwhelmed with joy at seeing his companions again that he died as well. Nothing noteworthy happened on the voyage home; they reached Lisbon in December 1488, after stopping at Benin to trade and at La Mina to collect the money earned from the colony's commerce.
It is strange but true, that Diaz not only received no reward of any kind for this voyage which had been so successful, but he seemed to be treated rather as though he had disgraced himself, for he was not employed again for ten years. More than this the command of the expedition that was sent to double the cape which Diaz had discovered, was given to Vasco da Gama, and Diaz was only to accompany it to La Mina holding a subordinate position. He was to hear of the marvellous campaign of his successful rival in India, and to see what an effect such an event would have upon the destiny of his country.
It's odd but true that Diaz not only received no reward for this successful voyage, but he was treated as if he had embarrassed himself, as he wasn't employed again for ten years. In addition, the command of the expedition to round the cape that Diaz had discovered was given to Vasco da Gama, with Diaz only accompanying it to La Mina in a subordinate role. He was to hear about the incredible campaign of his successful rival in India and witness how such events would impact the fate of his country.
He took part in Cabral's expedition which discovered Brazil, but he had not the pleasure of seeing the shores to which he had been the pioneer, for the fleet had only just left the American shore, when a fearful storm arose; four vessels sank, and among them the one that Diaz commanded. It is in allusion to his sad fate that Camoens puts the following prediction into the mouth of Adamastor, the spirit of the Cape of Tempests. "I will make a terrible example of the first fleet that shall pass near these rocks, and I will wreak my vengeance on him who first comes to brave me in my dwelling."
He participated in Cabral's expedition that discovered Brazil, but he never got to see the shores where he had been a pioneer. Just as the fleet departed from the American shore, a terrible storm hit; four ships sank, including the one commanded by Diaz. Camoens refers to his tragic fate through a prediction made by Adamastor, the spirit of the Cape of Tempests: "I will make a terrible example of the first fleet that passes near these rocks, and I will take my revenge on anyone who dares to confront me in my home."
In fact it was only in 1497, maybe five years after the discovery of America, that the southern point of Africa was passed by Vasco da Gama, and it may be affirmed that if this latter had preceded Columbus, the discovery of the new continent might have been delayed for several centuries. The navigators of this period were very timorous, and did not dare to sail out into mid-ocean; not liking to venture upon seas that were but little known, they always followed the coast-line of Africa, rather than go further from land. If the Cape of Tempests had been doubled, the sailors would have gone by this route to India, and none would have thought of going to the "Land of Spices," that is to say Asia, by venturing across the Atlantic. Who, in fact, would have thought of seeking for the east by the route to the west? But in truth this was the great idea of that day, for Cooley says, "The principal object of Portuguese maritime enterprise in the fifteenth century was to search for a passage to India by the Ocean." The most learned men had not gone so far as to imagine the existence of another continent to complete the equilibrium and balance of the terrestrial globe. Some parts of the American continent had been already discovered, for an Italian navigator Sebastian Cabot had landed on Labrador in 1487, and the Scandinavians had certainly disembarked on this unknown land. The colonists of Greenland, too had explored Winland, but so little disposition was there at this time to believe in the existence of a new world, that Greenland, Winland, and Labrador were all thought to be a continuation of the European continent.
In fact, it was only in 1497, about five years after the discovery of America, that Vasco da Gama rounded the southern tip of Africa. It can be said that if he had preceded Columbus, the discovery of the new continent might have been delayed for several centuries. The navigators of this time were very timid and didn’t dare to sail out into the open ocean; avoiding the lesser-known seas, they preferred to follow the coastline of Africa instead of venturing further from land. If the Cape of Tempests had been rounded, sailors would have taken that route to India, and no one would have thought of going to the "Land of Spices," meaning Asia, by crossing the Atlantic. Who, really, would have thought about finding the east by going west? But in reality, this was the big idea of that time, as Cooley says, "The main goal of Portuguese maritime efforts in the fifteenth century was to find a route to India via the Ocean." The most knowledgeable scholars hadn’t even considered the existence of another continent to maintain the balance of the Earth’s surface. Some parts of the American continent had already been discovered; an Italian navigator, Sebastian Cabot, landed in Labrador in 1487, and the Scandinavians had certainly arrived on this unknown land as well. The colonists of Greenland had explored Vinland, but there was so little inclination at that time to believe in the existence of a new world that Greenland, Vinland, and Labrador were all thought to be extensions of the European continent.
The main question before the navigators of the fifteenth century was the opening up of an easier communication with the shores of Asia. The route to India, China, and Japan (countries already known through the wonderful narrative of Marco Polo), viâ, Asia Minor, Persia, and Tartary, was long and dangerous. The transport of goods was too difficult and costly for these "ways terrestrial" ever to become roads for commerce. A more practicable means of communication must be found. Thus all the dwellers on the coasts, from England to Spain, as well as the people living on the shores of the Mediterranean, seeing the great Atlantic ocean open to their vessels, began to inquire, whether indeed this new route might not conduct them to the shores of Asia.
The main question for the navigators of the 15th century was how to establish easier communication with the shores of Asia. The route to India, China, and Japan (countries already known through the amazing stories of Marco Polo) via Asia Minor, Persia, and Tartary was long and dangerous. Transporting goods was too hard and expensive for these "land routes" to ever become major trade paths. A more practical way to communicate had to be found. So, all the people along the coasts, from England to Spain, as well as those living on the Mediterranean shores, seeing the vast Atlantic Ocean open to their ships, started to wonder if this new route might lead them to the shores of Asia.
The sphericity of the Globe being established, this reasoning was correct, for going always westward, the traveller must necessarily at last reach the east, and as to the route across the ocean, it would certainly be open. Who could, indeed, have suspected the existence of an obstacle 9750 miles in length, lying between Europe and Asia, and called America?
The roundness of the Earth being established, this argument was right, because if a traveler keeps going west, they will eventually reach the east. As for the path across the ocean, it would definitely be available. Who could have possibly guessed that there was a barrier 9,750 miles long between Europe and Asia, known as America?
We must observe also that the scientific men of the Middle Ages believed that the shores of Asia were not more than 6000 miles distant from those of Europe. Aristotle supposed the terrestrial globe to be smaller than it really is. Seneca said "How far is it from the shores of Spain to India? A very few days' sail, should the wind be favourable." This was also the opinion of Strabo. So it seemed that the route between Europe and Asia must be short, and there being such places for ships to touch at as the Azores and Antilles, of which the existence was known in the fifteenth century, the transoceanic communication promised not to be difficult. This popular error as to distance had the happy effect of inducing navigators to try to cross the Atlantic, a feat which, had they been aware of the 15,000 miles of ocean separating Europe from Asia, they would scarcely have dared to attempt.
We also need to note that scientists in the Middle Ages believed that the coasts of Asia were no more than 6,000 miles away from those of Europe. Aristotle thought the Earth was smaller than it actually is. Seneca asked, "How far is it from the shores of Spain to India? A very few days' sail, if the wind is favorable." Strabo shared this view as well. It seemed that the journey between Europe and Asia must be short, and given the known stopping points for ships like the Azores and Antilles in the fifteenth century, crossing the ocean didn’t seem too difficult. This common misconception about distance encouraged navigators to attempt to cross the Atlantic, a challenge they likely wouldn’t have tried if they had known about the 15,000 miles of ocean separating Europe from Asia.
We must in justice allow that certain facts gave, or seemed to give, reason to the partisans of Aristotle and Strabo for their belief in the proximity of the eastern shores. Thus, a pilot in the service of the King of Portugal, while sailing at 1350 miles' distance from Cape St. Vincent, the south-western point of the Portuguese province of Algarve, met with a piece of wood ornamented with ancient sculptures, which he considered must have come from a continent not far off. Again, some fishermen had found near the island of Madeira, a sculptured post and some bamboos, which in shape resembled those found in India. The inhabitants of the Azores also, often picked up gigantic pine-trees, of an unknown species, and one day two human bodies were cast upon their shores, "corpses with broad faces," says the chronicler Herrera, "and not resembling Christians."
We have to acknowledge that certain facts gave, or appeared to give, the supporters of Aristotle and Strabo a reason to believe in the closeness of the eastern shores. For instance, a pilot working for the King of Portugal, while sailing 1,350 miles away from Cape St. Vincent, the southwestern tip of the Portuguese province of Algarve, came across a piece of wood decorated with ancient carvings, which he thought must have come from a nearby continent. Additionally, some fishermen found a carved post and some bamboo near the island of Madeira, which resembled those found in India. The people of the Azores also frequently discovered huge pine trees of an unknown type, and one day two human bodies washed up on their shores, "corpses with broad faces," as chronicler Herrera notes, "that did not look like Christians."
These various facts tended to inflame imagination. As in the fifteenth century men had no knowledge of that great Gulf-stream, which, in nearing the European coasts, brings with it waifs and strays from America, so they could only imagine that these various débris must come from Asia. Therefore, they argued, Asia could not be far off, and the communication between these two extremes of the old continent must be easy. One point must be clearly borne in mind, no geographer of this period had any notion of the existence of a new world; it was not even a desire of adding to geographical knowledge which led to the exploration of the western route. It was the men of commerce who were the leaders in this movement, and who first undertook to cross the Atlantic. Their only thought was of traffic, and of carrying it on by the shortest road.
These various facts tended to spark the imagination. Just like in the fifteenth century, when people didn’t know about the great Gulf Stream that brings debris from America to the European coasts, they could only guess that these remnants must come from Asia. So, they concluded that Asia couldn't be far away and that communication between these two ends of the old continent must be easy. One important thing to remember is that no geographer of this time had any idea about the existence of a new world; the exploration of the western route wasn’t driven by a desire to expand geographical knowledge. It was primarily merchants who led this movement and first attempted to cross the Atlantic. Their main focus was trade and finding the shortest route for it.
The mariner's compass, invented, according to the generally received opinion, about 1302, by one Flavio Gioja of Amalfi, enabled vessels to sail at a distance from the coasts, and to guide themselves when out of sight of land. Martin Béhaim, with two physicians in the service of Prince Henry of Portugal, had also added to nautical science by discovering the way of directing the voyager's course according to the position of the sun in the heavens, and by applying the astrolabe to the purposes of navigation. These improvements being adopted, the commercial question of the western route increased daily in importance in Spain, Portugal, and Italy, countries in which three-quarters of the science is made up of imagination. There was discussion, there were writings. The excited world of commerce disputed with the world of science. Facts, systems, doctrines, were grouped together. The time was come when there was needed one single intelligence to collect together and assimilate the various floating ideas. This intelligence was found. At length all the scattered notions were gathered together in the mind of one man, who possessed in a remarkable degree genius, perseverance, and boldness.
The mariner's compass, which was invented around 1302 by Flavio Gioja of Amalfi, allowed ships to travel away from the shore and navigate when they couldn't see land. Martin Béhaim, along with two doctors serving Prince Henry of Portugal, contributed to navigation by figuring out how to steer a ship based on the sun's position in the sky and using the astrolabe for navigation purposes. As these advancements took hold, the commercial interest in the western route grew increasingly significant in Spain, Portugal, and Italy—countries where much of the science relied on imagination. There was a lot of debate and writing happening. The vibrant world of commerce clashed with the world of science. Facts, theories, and principles were all brought together. It was time for a single brilliant mind to bring together and make sense of the various ideas emerging. That mind was found. Eventually, all the scattered thoughts were unified in the mind of one person, who was remarkably gifted with genius, perseverance, and courage.
![]() |
Christopher Columbus. |
This man was no other than Christopher Columbus, born, probably near Genoa, about the year 1436. We say "probably," for the towns of Cogoreo and Nervi dispute with Savona and Genoa, the honour of having given him birth. The date of his birth varies, with different biographers, from 1430 to 1445, but the year 1436 would appear to be the correct one, according to the most reliable documents. The family of Columbus was of humble origin; his father, Domenic Columbus, a manufacturer of woollen stuffs, seems, however, to have been in sufficiently easy circumstances to enable him to give his children a more than ordinarily good education. The young Christopher, the eldest of the family, was sent to the University of Pavia, there to study Grammar, Latin, Geography, Astronomy, and Navigation.
This man was none other than Christopher Columbus, likely born near Genoa around 1436. We say "likely" because the towns of Cogoreo and Nervi argue with Savona and Genoa over the honor of being his birthplace. Different biographers place his birth date anywhere between 1430 and 1445, but 1436 seems to be the accurate year according to the most reliable documents. Columbus came from a humble background; his father, Domenic Columbus, was a wool manufacturer who was well-off enough to provide his children with a better-than-average education. The young Christopher, the oldest in the family, was sent to the University of Pavia to study grammar, Latin, geography, astronomy, and navigation.
At fourteen years of age Christopher left school and went to sea; from this time until 1487, very little is known of his career. It is interesting to give the remark of Humboldt on this subject, as reported by M. Charton; he said, "that he regretted the more this uncertainty about the early life of Columbus when he remembered all that the chroniclers have so minutely preserved for us upon the life of the dog Becerillo, or the elephant Aboulababat, which Haroun-al-Raschid sent to Charlemagne!" The most probable account to be gathered from contemporary documents and from the writings of Columbus himself, is that the young sailor visited the Levant, the west, the north, England several times, Portugal, the coast of Guinea, and the islands of Africa, perhaps even Greenland, for, by the age of forty "he had sailed to every part that had ever been sailed to before." He was looked upon as a thoroughly competent mariner, and his reputation led to his being chosen for the command of the Genoese galleys, in the war which that Republic was waging against Venice. He afterwards made an expedition, in the service of René, king of Anjou, to the coasts of Barbary, and in 1477, he went to explore the countries beyond Iceland.
At fourteen years old, Christopher left school and went to sea; from that time until 1487, very little is known about his career. It's interesting to mention Humboldt's comment on this topic, as reported by M. Charton; he said, "he regretted even more this uncertainty about Columbus's early life when he remembered all the details chroniclers have preserved about the dog Becerillo or the elephant Aboulababat, which Haroun-al-Raschid sent to Charlemagne!" The most likely account gathered from contemporary documents and Columbus's own writings is that the young sailor traveled to the Levant, the west, the north, England several times, Portugal, the coast of Guinea, and the islands of Africa, and possibly even Greenland, because by the age of forty "he had sailed to every part that had ever been sailed to before." He was regarded as a highly skilled mariner, and his reputation led to him being chosen to command the Genoese galleys in the war that the Republic was waging against Venice. He later undertook an expedition, in the service of René, king of Anjou, to the coasts of Barbary, and in 1477, he went to explore the lands beyond Iceland.
This voyage being successfully terminated, Christopher Columbus returned to his home at Lisbon. He there married the daughter of an Italian gentleman, Bartolomeo Munez Perestrello, a sailor like himself and deeply interested in the geographical ideas of the day. The wife of Columbus, Dona Filippa, was without fortune, and Columbus, having none himself, felt he must work for the support of himself and his family. The future discoverer, therefore, set to work to make picture-books, terrestrial globes, maps, and nautical charts, and continued in this employment until 1481, but without at the same time abandoning his scientific and literary pursuits. It seems probable even, that during this period he studied deeply, and attained to knowledge far beyond that possessed by most of the sailors of his time. Can it have been that at this time "the Great Idea" first arose in his mind? It may well have been so. He was following assiduously the discussions relative to the western routes, and the facility of communication by the west, between Europe and Asia. His correspondence proves that he shared the opinion of Aristotle as to the relatively short distance separating the extreme shores of the old Continent. He wrote frequently to the most distinguished savants of his time. Martin Béhaim, of whom we have already spoken, was amongst his correspondents, and also the celebrated Florentine astronomer, Toscanelli, whose opinions in some degree influenced those of Columbus.
This journey successfully completed, Christopher Columbus returned home to Lisbon. There, he married the daughter of an Italian gentleman, Bartolomeo Munez Perestrello, who was also a sailor and very interested in the geographical ideas of the time. Columbus's wife, Dona Filippa, had no fortune, and since he had none either, Columbus felt he needed to work to support himself and his family. Therefore, the future discoverer started making picture books, terrestrial globes, maps, and nautical charts, continuing this work until 1481, while still pursuing his scientific and literary interests. It seems likely that during this time he studied deeply and gained knowledge far beyond what most sailors of his era possessed. Could it have been during this period that "the Great Idea" first formed in his mind? It's quite possible. He was closely following the discussions about western routes and the ease of communication between Europe and Asia. His letters show that he agreed with Aristotle about the relatively short distance between the far edges of the old continent. He frequently wrote to the most prominent scholars of his time. Martin Béhaim, whom we have already mentioned, was one of his correspondents, as well as the famous Florentine astronomer, Toscanelli, whose ideas somewhat influenced Columbus's thoughts.
![]() |
A Spanish Port. |
At this time Columbus, according to the portrait of him given by his biographer Washington Irving, was a tall man, of robust and noble presence. His face was long, he had an aquiline nose, high cheek bones, eyes clear and full of fire; he had a bright complexion, and his face was much covered with freckles. He was a truly Christian man, and it was with the liveliest faith that he fulfilled all the duties of the Catholic religion.
At this time, Columbus, as portrayed by his biographer Washington Irving, was a tall man with a strong and dignified presence. He had a long face, an aquiline nose, high cheekbones, and eyes that were clear and full of intensity; his complexion was bright, and his face was quite freckled. He was a genuinely Christian man, and he carried out all the responsibilities of the Catholic faith with great enthusiasm.
At the time when Christopher Columbus was in correspondence with the astronomer Toscanelli, he learnt that the latter, at the request of Alphonso V., King of Portugal, had sent to the king a learned Memoir upon the possibility of reaching the Indies by the western route. Columbus was consulted, and supported the ideas of Toscanelli with all his influence; but without result, for the King of Portugal, who was engaged at the time in war with Spain, died, without having been able to give any attention to maritime discoveries. His successor, John II., adopted the plans of Columbus and Toscanelli with enthusiasm. At the same time, with most reprehensible cunning, he tried to deprive these two savants of the benefit of their proposition; without telling them, he sent out a caravel to attempt this great enterprise, and to reach China by crossing the Atlantic. But he had not reckoned upon the inexperience of his pilots, nor upon the violence of the storms which they might encounter; the result was, that some days after their departure, a hurricane brought back to Lisbon the sailors of the Portuguese king. Columbus was justly wounded by this unworthy action, and felt that he could not reckon upon a king who had so deceived him. His wife being dead, he left Spain with his son Diego, towards the end of the year 1484. It is thought that he went to Genoa and to Venice, where his projects of transoceanic navigation were but badly received.
At the time when Christopher Columbus was in contact with the astronomer Toscanelli, he learned that Toscanelli, at the request of Alphonso V., King of Portugal, had sent the king an insightful Memoir discussing the possibility of reaching the Indies by traveling west. Columbus was consulted and used all his influence to support Toscanelli's ideas, but it was of no use, as the King of Portugal, who was busy fighting against Spain, died before he could pay any attention to maritime discoveries. His successor, John II., embraced the plans of Columbus and Toscanelli with enthusiasm. At the same time, with a shameful deceit, he tried to take credit for their proposal; without informing them, he sent out a caravel to attempt this ambitious mission and reach China by crossing the Atlantic. However, he hadn't considered the inexperience of his pilots or the severity of the storms they might face; as a result, a few days after their departure, a hurricane returned the Portuguese sailors to Lisbon. Columbus was justifiably hurt by this dishonorable action and realized he could not rely on a king who had betrayed him. After the death of his wife, he left Spain with his son Diego toward the end of 1484. It's believed he went to Genoa and Venice, where his plans for transoceanic navigation were poorly received.
![]() |
Columbus knocks at a convent door. |
However it may have been, in 1485 we find him again in Spain. This great man was poor, without resources. He travelled on foot, carrying Diego his little son of ten years old, in his arms. From this period of his life, history follows him step by step; she no more loses sight of him, and she has preserved to posterity the smallest incidents of this grand existence. We find Columbus arrived in Andalusia, only half a league from the port of Palos. Destitute, and dying of hunger, he knocked at the door of a Franciscan convent, dedicated to Santa Maria de Rabida, and asked for a little bread and water for his poor child and for himself. The superior of the convent, Juan Perez de Marchena, gave hospitality to the unfortunate traveller. He questioned him, and was surprised by the nobleness of his language, but still more astonished was he, by the boldness of the ideas of Columbus, who made the good Father the confidant of his aspirations. For several months the wandering sailor remained in this hospitable convent; some of the monks were learned men, and interested themselves about him and his projects; they studied his plans; they mentioned him to some of the well-known navigators of the time; and we must give them the credit of having been the first to believe in the genius of Christopher Columbus. Juan Perez showed still greater kindness; he offered to take upon himself the charge of the education of Diego, and he gave to Columbus a letter of recommendation addressed to the confessor of the Queen of Castille.
However it may have been, in 1485 we find him again in Spain. This great man was poor and lacking resources. He traveled on foot, carrying his ten-year-old son, Diego, in his arms. From this point in his life, history follows him closely; it never loses sight of him, preserving even the smallest details of this remarkable existence. We find Columbus arriving in Andalusia, just half a league from the port of Palos. Destitute and starving, he knocked on the door of a Franciscan convent dedicated to Santa Maria de Rabida, asking for a little bread and water for himself and his poor child. The head of the convent, Juan Perez de Marchena, welcomed the unfortunate traveler. He questioned him and was struck by the nobility of his speech, but even more astonished by Columbus's bold ideas, which he confided to the good Father. For several months, the wandering sailor stayed in this welcoming convent; some of the monks were scholars who took an interest in him and his plans; they studied his proposals and mentioned him to some of the well-known navigators of the time. We must credit them for being the first to believe in the genius of Christopher Columbus. Juan Perez showed even greater kindness; he offered to take responsibility for Diego's education and gave Columbus a letter of recommendation addressed to the confessor of the Queen of Castile.
This confessor, prior of the monastery of Prado, was deep in the confidence of Ferdinand and Isabella; but he did not approve of the projects of the Genoese navigator, and he rendered him no service whatever with his royal penitent. Columbus must still resign himself to wait. He went to live at Cordova, where the court was soon to come, and for livelihood he resumed his trade of picture-seller. Is it possible to quote from the lives of illustrious men an instance of a more trying existence than this of the great navigator? Could ill-fortune have assailed any man with more cruel blows? But this indomitable, indefatigable man of genius, rising up again after each trial, did not despair. He felt within him the sacred fire of genius, he worked on unceasingly, he visited influential persons, spreading his ideas and defending them, and combating all objections with the most heroic energy. At length he obtained the protection of the great cardinal-archbishop of Toledo, Pedro Gonzalez de Mendoza, and thanks to him, was admitted into the presence of the King and Queen of Spain.
This confessor, prior of the monastery of Prado, was well trusted by Ferdinand and Isabella; however, he didn’t support the plans of the Genoese navigator, and he provided no help to his royal penitent. Columbus had to keep waiting. He moved to Cordova, where the court was soon to arrive, and to make a living he went back to selling pictures. Is there an example from the lives of famous people that shows a more challenging existence than that of the great navigator? Could bad luck have struck anyone with more harsh blows? Yet this unyielding, tireless genius, rising up again after every setback, did not lose hope. He felt the sacred fire of creativity within him, he worked tirelessly, he reached out to influential people, sharing and defending his ideas, and fighting against all objections with incredible energy. Finally, he gained the support of the great cardinal-archbishop of Toledo, Pedro Gonzalez de Mendoza, and thanks to him, he was granted an audience with the King and Queen of Spain.
Christopher Columbus must have imagined himself now at the end of all his troubles. Ferdinand and Isabella received his project favourably, and caused it to be submitted for examination to a council of learned men, consisting of bishops and monks who were gathered together ad hoc in a Dominican convent at Salamanca. But the unfortunate pleader was not yet at the end of his vicissitudes. In this meeting at Salamanca all his judges were against him. The truth was, that his ideas interfered with the intolerant religious notions of the fifteenth century. The Fathers of the Church had denied the sphericity of the earth, and since the earth was not round they declared that a voyage of circumnavigation was absolutely contrary to the Bible, and could not therefore, on any logical theory, be undertaken. "Besides," said these theologians, "if any one should ever succeed in descending into the other hemisphere, how could he ever mount up again into this one?" This manner of arguing was a very formidable one at this period; for Christopher Columbus saw himself, in consequence, almost accused of heresy, the most unpardonable crime which could be committed in these intolerant countries. He escaped any evil consequences from the hostile disposition of the Council, but the execution of his project was again adjourned.
Christopher Columbus must have thought he was finally at the end of all his troubles. Ferdinand and Isabella received his proposal positively and arranged for it to be reviewed by a council of scholars, made up of bishops and monks who gathered specifically for this purpose in a Dominican convent at Salamanca. However, the unfortunate advocate was not yet done with his struggles. In this meeting at Salamanca, all his judges were against him. The truth was that his ideas clashed with the strict religious beliefs of the fifteenth century. The Church Fathers had denied the earth’s roundness, and since the earth wasn’t round, they declared that a voyage around the globe was completely against the Bible and therefore couldn’t logically be undertaken. "Besides," said these theologians, "if someone were to succeed in reaching the other hemisphere, how could they possibly return to this one?" This line of reasoning was very powerful at the time; as a result, Christopher Columbus found himself nearly accused of heresy, the most unforgivable crime in these intolerant regions. Although he avoided any negative consequences from the Council's hostility, the execution of his project was once again postponed.
![]() |
Building a caravel. |
Long years passed away. The unfortunate man of genius, despairing of success in Spain, sent his brother to England to make an offer of his services to the king, Henry VII. But it is probable that the king gave no answer. Then Christopher Columbus turned again with unabated perseverance to Ferdinand, but Ferdinand was at this time engaged in a war of extermination against the Moors, and it was not until 1492, when he had chased the Moors from Spain, that he was able again to listen to the solicitations of the Genoese sailor.
Years went by. The unfortunate man of genius, losing hope for success in Spain, sent his brother to England to offer his services to King Henry VII. However, it's likely the king didn’t respond. So, Christopher Columbus once again approached Ferdinand, but Ferdinand was busy waging a war of extermination against the Moors. It wasn’t until 1492, after he had driven the Moors out of Spain, that he was able to listen to the requests of the Genoese sailor again.
This time the affair was thoroughly considered, and the king consented to the enterprise. But Columbus, as is the manner of proud natures, wished to impose his own conditions. They bargained over that which should enrich Spain! Columbus, in disgust, was without doubt ready to quit, and for ever, this ungrateful country, but Isabella, touched by the thought of the unbelievers of Asia, whom she hoped to convert to the Catholic faith, ordered Columbus to be recalled, and then acceded to all his demands.
This time, the situation was carefully thought out, and the king agreed to the plan. However, Columbus, as is typical of prideful individuals, wanted to set his own terms. They negotiated over what would enrich Spain! Columbus, frustrated, was definitely ready to leave this ungrateful country for good, but Isabella, moved by the idea of converting the non-believers in Asia to the Catholic faith, ordered Columbus to be brought back and then agreed to all his demands.
Columbus was in the fifty-sixth year of his age when he signed a treaty with the King of Spain at Santa-Feta on the 17th of April, 1492, being eighteen years after he had first conceived his project, and seven years from the time of his quitting the monastery of Palos. By this solemn convention, the dignity of high admiral was to belong to Columbus in all the lands which he might discover, and this dignity was to descend in perpetuity to his heirs and successors. He was named viceroy and governor of the new possessions which he hoped to conquer in the rich countries of Asia, and one-tenth part of the pearls, precious stones, gold, silver, spices, provisions, and merchandise of whatever kind, which might be acquired in any manner whatsoever, within the limits of his jurisdiction, was of right to belong to him.
Columbus was 56 years old when he signed a treaty with the King of Spain in Santa Feta on April 17, 1492, eighteen years after he first came up with his idea and seven years after leaving the monastery in Palos. Through this formal agreement, Columbus was granted the title of high admiral over all the lands he might discover, a title that would be passed down to his heirs and successors. He was also appointed as viceroy and governor of the new territories he hoped to conquer in the rich regions of Asia, and he was entitled to one-tenth of the pearls, precious stones, gold, silver, spices, food, and any other merchandise acquired in any way within his jurisdiction.
All was arranged, and at length Columbus was to put his cherished projects in execution. But let us repeat, he had no thought of meeting with the New World, of the existence of which he had not the faintest suspicion. His aim was "to explore the East by the West, and to pass by the way of the West to the Land whence come the spices." One may even aver that Columbus died in the belief that he had arrived at the shores of Asia, and never knew himself that he had made the discovery of America. But this in no way lessens his glory; the meeting with the new Continent was but an accident. The real cause of the immortal renown of Columbus was that audacity of genius which induced him to brave the dangers of an unknown ocean, to separate himself afar from those familiar shores, which, until now, navigators had never ventured to quit, to adventure himself upon the waves of the Atlantic Ocean in the frail ships of the period, which the first tempest might engulf, to launch himself, in a word, upon the deep darkness of an unknown sea.
Everything was set, and finally, Columbus was about to put his long-held dreams into action. But let’s be clear, he had no idea he would encounter the New World; he didn’t have the slightest hint of its existence. His goal was "to explore the East by traveling West, and to reach the land where the spices come from." One could even argue that Columbus died believing he had arrived at the shores of Asia and never realized he had discovered America. But this doesn’t diminish his legacy; the encounter with the new continent was merely a coincidence. The real reason for Columbus's lasting fame was his remarkable boldness that drove him to face the dangers of an unknown ocean, to distance himself from familiar shores which navigators had never dared to leave, and to venture into the Atlantic Ocean on the fragile ships of his time, which could easily be swallowed by the first storm, to embark, in short, into the deep unknown of an unfamiliar sea.
The preparations began, Columbus entering into an arrangement with some rich navigators of Palos, the three brothers Pinzon, who made the necessary advances for defraying the expenses of fitting out the ships. Three caravels, named the Gallega, the Nina, and the Pinta, were equipped in the port of Palos. The Gallega was destined to carry the admiral, who changed her name to the Santa-Maria. The Pinta was commanded by Martin Alonzo Pinzon, and the Nina by his two brothers, Francis Martin, and Vincent Yanez Pinzon. It was difficult to man the ships, sailors generally being frightened at the enterprise, but at last the captains succeeded in getting together one hundred and twenty men, and on Friday, August 3rd, 1492, the admiral crossing at eight o'clock in the morning the bar of Saltez, off the town of Huelva, in Andalusia, adventured himself with his three half-decked caravels upon the Atlantic waves.
The preparations began, with Columbus making a deal with some wealthy navigators from Palos, the three Pinzon brothers, who provided the funds to cover the costs of outfitting the ships. Three caravels, named the Gallega, the Nina, and the Pinta, were outfitted in the port of Palos. The Gallega was set to carry the admiral, who renamed it the Santa-Maria. The Pinta was led by Martin Alonzo Pinzon, while his two brothers, Francis Martin and Vincent Yanez Pinzon, commanded the Nina. It was challenging to crew the ships, as sailors were generally scared of the venture, but eventually, the captains managed to gather one hundred and twenty men. On Friday, August 3rd, 1492, the admiral crossed the bar of Saltez at eight o'clock in the morning, off the town of Huelva in Andalusia, venturing into the Atlantic with his three partially decked caravels.
CHRISTOPHER COLUMBUS.
First voyage: The Great Canary—Gomera—Magnetic variation—Symptoms of revolt—Land, land—San Salvador—Taking possession—Conception—Fernandina or Great Exuma—Isabella, or Long Island—The Mucaras—Cuba—Description of the island—Archipelago of Notre-Dame—Hispaniola or San Domingo—Tortuga Island—The cacique on board the Santa-Maria—The caravel of Columbus goes aground and cannot be floated off—Island of Monte-Christi—Return—Tempest—Arrival in Spain—Homage rendered to Christopher Columbus.
First voyage: The Great Canary—Gomera—Magnetic variation—Signs of rebellion—Land, land—San Salvador—Claiming territory—Conception—Fernandina or Great Exuma—Isabella, or Long Island—The Mucaras—Cuba—Description of the island—Archipelago of Notre-Dame—Hispaniola or San Domingo—Tortuga Island—The chief on board the Santa-Maria—Columbus’s caravel runs aground and can't be floated off—Island of Monte-Christi—Return—Storm—Arrival in Spain—Tribute paid to Christopher Columbus.
During the first day's voyage, the admiral—the title by which he is usually known in the various accounts of his exploits—bearing directly southwards, sailed forty-five miles before sunset; turning then to the south-east, he steered for the Canaries, in order to repair the Pinta, which had unshipped her rudder, an accident caused perhaps by the ill-will of the steersman, who dreaded the voyage. Ten days later Columbus cast anchor before the Great Canary Island, where the rudder of the caravel was repaired. Nineteen days afterwards he arrived before Gomera, where the inhabitants assured him of the existence of an unknown land in the west of the Archipelago. He did not leave Gomera until the 6th of September. He had received warning that three Portuguese ships awaited him in the open sea, with the intention of barring his passage; however, without taking any heed of this news, he put to sea, cleverly avoided meeting his enemies, and steering directly westward, he lost all sight of land. During the voyage the admiral took care to conceal from his companions the true distance traversed each day; he made it appear less than it really was in the daily abstracts of his observations, that he might not add to the fear already felt by the sailors, by letting them know the real distance which separated them from Europe. Each day he watched the compasses with attention, and it is to him we owe the discovery of the magnetic variation, of which he took account in his calculations. The pilots, however, were much disturbed on seeing the compasses all "north-westers," as they expressed it.
During the first day's journey, the admiral—what he's usually called in the various stories about his adventures—headed directly south and sailed forty-five miles before sunset. Then, turning southeast, he headed for the Canaries to fix the Pinta, which had lost her rudder, possibly due to the steersman's reluctance about the voyage. Ten days later, Columbus dropped anchor off Great Canary Island, where the caravel's rudder was repaired. Nineteen days after that, he reached Gomera, where the locals assured him there was an unknown land to the west of the Archipelago. He didn’t leave Gomera until September 6th. He had been warned that three Portuguese ships were waiting for him at sea, planning to block his path; however, disregarding this news, he set sail, skillfully avoiding his enemies, and headed directly west, losing sight of land entirely. During the journey, the admiral made sure to hide from his crew the actual distance they traveled each day; he made it seem shorter in the daily summaries of his observations, so he wouldn’t increase the sailors’ anxiety by revealing how far they were from Europe. Each day, he watched the compasses closely, and he's credited with discovering magnetic variation, which he considered in his calculations. The pilots, however, were very unsettled seeing the compasses all pointing "north-west," as they called it.
![]() |
Christopher Columbus on board his caravel. |
On the 14th of September the sailors saw a swallow and some tropic-birds. The sight of these birds was an evidence of land being near, for they do not usually fly more than about seventy miles out to sea. The temperature was very mild, the weather magnificent; the wind blew from the east and wafted the caravels in the desired direction. But it was exactly this continuance of east wind which frightened the greater part of the sailors, who saw in this persistence, so favourable for the outward voyage, the promise of a formidable obstacle to their return home. On the 16th of September some tufts of seaweed, still fresh, were seen floating on the waves. But no land was to be seen, and this seaweed might possibly indicate the presence of submarine rocks, and not of the shores of a continent. On the 17th, thirty-five days after the departure of the expedition, floating weeds were frequently seen, and upon one mass of weed was found a live cray-fish, a sure sign this of the proximity of land.
On September 14th, the sailors spotted a swallow and some tropic birds. Seeing these birds indicated that land was nearby, as they typically don’t fly more than about seventy miles out to sea. The temperature was very mild, and the weather was beautiful; the wind blew from the east, pushing the caravels in the right direction. However, this ongoing east wind scared most of the sailors, who viewed its consistency, so beneficial for the outward journey, as a potential major problem for their return home. On September 16th, they saw some fresh seaweed floating on the waves. Still, no land was visible, and this seaweed could mean there were underwater rocks instead of the shores of a continent. On the 17th, thirty-five days after the expedition set off, floating weeds were often seen, and on one pile of weeds, they found a live crayfish, a clear sign that land was close.
During the following days a large number of birds, such as gannets, sea-swallows, and tropic-birds, flew around the caravels. Columbus turned their presence to account as a means of reassuring his companions, who were beginning to be terribly frightened at not meeting with land after six weeks of sailing. His own confidence never abated, but putting firm trust in God, he often addressed energetic words of comfort to those around him, and made them each evening chant the Salve Regina, or some other hymn to the Virgin. At the words of this heroic man, so noble, so sure of himself, so superior to all human weaknesses, the courage of the sailors revived, and they again went onwards.
During the next few days, a lot of birds, like gannets, sea-swallows, and tropic-birds, flew around the caravels. Columbus used their presence to reassure his companions, who were starting to get really scared after six weeks of sailing without sighting land. His own confidence never wavered; with firm trust in God, he often spoke encouraging words to those around him and had them chant the Salve Regina or another hymn to the Virgin every evening. At the words of this heroic man, so noble, so self-assured, and so above all human weaknesses, the sailors' courage was rekindled, and they continued their journey.
We can well imagine how anxiously both officers and men scanned the western horizon towards which they were steering. Each one had a pecuniary motive for wishing to be the first to descry the New Continent, King Ferdinand having promised a reward of 10,000 maravédis, or 400 pounds sterling, to the first discoverer. The latter days of the month of September were enlivened by the presence of numerous large birds, petrels, man-of-war birds, and damiers, flying in couples, a sign that they were not far away from home. So Columbus retained his unshaken conviction that land could not be far off.
We can easily imagine how anxiously both the officers and crew scanned the western horizon as they sailed. Each person had a financial incentive to be the first to spot the New World, as King Ferdinand had promised a reward of 10,000 maravédis, or 400 pounds sterling, to the first person to discover it. The later days of September were brightened by the sight of numerous large birds—petrels, frigate birds, and gannets—flying in pairs, a sign that they were close to land. So, Columbus held on to his strong belief that land was not far away.
On the 1st of October, the admiral announced to his companions that they had made 1272 miles to the west since leaving Ferro; in reality, the distance traversed exceeded 2100 miles, and of this Columbus was quite aware, but persisted in his policy of disguising the truth in this particular. On the 7th of October, the crews were excited by hearing discharges of musketry from the Nina, the commanders of which, the two brothers Pinzon, thought they had descried the land; they soon found, however, that they had been mistaken. Still, on their representing that they had seen some parroquets flying in a south-westerly direction, the admiral consented to change his route so far as to steer some points to the south, a change which had happy consequences in the future, for had they continued to run directly westward, the caravels would have been aground upon the great Bahama Bank, and would probably have been altogether destroyed.
On October 1st, the admiral told his companions that they had traveled 1,272 miles west since leaving Ferro; in reality, they had covered over 2,100 miles, and Columbus knew this but chose to hide the truth about it. On October 7th, the crews were thrilled to hear gunfire from the Nina, captained by the Pinzon brothers, who thought they had spotted land; however, they soon realized they were mistaken. Still, after claiming to see some parrots flying southwest, the admiral agreed to adjust their course slightly to the south, a decision that would prove beneficial later on, as continuing directly west would have run the caravels aground on the great Bahama Bank, likely resulting in their total destruction.
Still the ardently desired land did not appear. Each evening the sun as it went down dipped behind an interminable horizon of water. The crews who had several times been the victims of an optical illusion, now began to murmur against Columbus, "the Genoese, the foreigner," who had enticed them so far away from their country. Some symptoms of mutiny had already shown themselves on board the vessels, when, on the 10th of October, the sailors openly declared that they would go no further. In treating of this part of the voyage, the historians would seem to have drawn somewhat upon their imagination; they narrate scenes of serious import which took place upon the admiral's caravel, the sailors going so far as even to threaten his life. They say also, that the recriminations ended by a kind of arrangement, granting a respite of three days to Columbus, at the end of which time, should land not have been then discovered, the fleet was to set out on its return to Europe. All these statements we may look upon as pure fiction; there is nothing in the accounts given by Columbus himself which lends them the smallest credibility. But it has been needful to touch upon them, for nothing must be omitted relating to the great Genoese Navigator, and some amount of legend mixed up with history does not ill beseem the grand figure of Christopher Columbus. Still, it is an undoubted fact that there was much murmuring on board the caravels, but it would seem that the crews, cheered by the words of the admiral, and by his brave attitude in the midst of uncertainty, did not refuse to do their duty in working the ships.
Still, the much-desired land did not appear. Each evening, as the sun set, it sank behind an endless horizon of water. The crews, who had fallen victim to an optical illusion several times, began to grumble against Columbus, "the Genoese, the outsider," who had led them so far from home. Some signs of mutiny had already surfaced on board the vessels when, on October 10th, the sailors openly declared they wouldn’t go any further. In recounting this part of the voyage, historians seem to have used their imagination; they tell of serious scenes on the admiral’s caravel, where the sailors even threatened his life. They also say that the complaints ended with a sort of agreement, giving Columbus a three-day grace period, after which, if land hadn’t been found, the fleet would head back to Europe. We can view all these statements as pure fiction; nothing in Columbus's own accounts supports their credibility. But it's important to mention them because nothing about the great Genoese Navigator should be left out, and a bit of legend intertwined with history suits the grand figure of Christopher Columbus. Still, it’s a clear fact that there was a lot of grumbling on the caravels, but it seems the crews, encouraged by the admiral's words and his brave stance amid uncertainty, did not hesitate to carry out their duty in operating the ships.
On the 11th of October, the admiral noticed alongside of his vessel, a reed still green, floating upon the top of a large wave: at the same time the crew of the Pinta hoisted on board another reed, a small board, and a little stick, which appeared to have been cut with an instrument of iron; it was evident that human hands had been employed upon these things. Almost at the same moment, the men of the Nina perceived a branch of some thorny tree covered with blossoms. At all this every one rejoiced exceedingly; there could be no doubt now of the proximity of the coast. Night fell over the sea. The Pinta, the best sailor of the three vessels, was leading. Already, Columbus himself, and one Rodrigo Sanchez, comptroller of the expedition, had thought they had seen a light moving amidst the shadows of the horizon, when a sailor named Rodrigo, on board the Pinta, cried out, "Land, land."
On October 11th, the admiral spotted a green reed floating on top of a large wave next to his ship. At the same time, the crew of the Pinta brought onboard another reed, a small plank, and a little stick that looked like it had been cut with an iron tool; it was clear that these items had been made by human hands. Almost instantly, the men on the Nina saw a branch from a thorny tree covered in blossoms. Everyone was extremely happy; there was no doubt anymore about how close they were to the coast. Night fell over the sea. The Pinta, the best sailor of the three ships, was in the lead. Columbus himself, along with Rodrigo Sanchez, the expedition's comptroller, thought they saw a light flickering on the horizon when a sailor named Rodrigo from the Pinta shouted, "Land, land."
![]() |
What must have been the feelings in the breast of Columbus at that moment? |
What must have been the feelings in the breast of Columbus at that moment? Never had any man, since the first creation of the human race experienced a similar emotion to that now felt by the great navigator. Perhaps even it is allowable to think that the eye which first saw this New Continent, was indeed that of the admiral himself. But what matters it? The glory of Columbus consisted not in the having arrived, his glory was in the having set out. It was at two o'clock in the morning that the land was first seen, when the caravels were not two hours' sail away from it. At once all the crews deeply moved, joined in singing together the Salve Regina. With the first rays of the sun they saw a little island, six miles to windward of them. It was one of the Bahama group; Columbus named it San Salvador, and immediately falling on his knees, he began to repeat the hymn of Saint Ambrose and Saint Augustine: "Te Deum laudamus, Te Deum confitemur."
What must Columbus have felt at that moment? No one in human history had experienced an emotion quite like what the great navigator felt now. It’s even possible to think that the first eye to see this New Continent was Columbus’s own. But what does it matter? Columbus's glory didn't lie in having arrived; it lay in having set out. The land was first spotted at two o'clock in the morning, when the ships were less than two hours away. All the crew, deeply moved, began to sing the Salve Regina together. With the first rays of sunlight, they saw a small island, six miles upwind from them. It was part of the Bahamas; Columbus named it San Salvador, and right away he fell to his knees, repeating the hymn of Saint Ambrose and Saint Augustine: "Te Deum laudamus, Te Deum confitemur."
At this moment, some naked savages appeared upon the newly discovered coast. Columbus had his long boat lowered, and got into it with Alonzo and Yanez Pinzon, the comptroller Rodrigo, the secretary Descovedo, and some others. He landed upon the shore, carrying in his hand the royal banner, whilst the two captains bore between them the green banner of the Cross, upon which were interlaced, the initials of Ferdinand and Isabella. Then the admiral solemnly took possession of the island in the name of the King and Queen of Spain, and caused a record of the act to be drawn up. During this ceremony the natives came round Columbus and his companions. M. Charton gives the account of the scene in the very words of Columbus: "Desiring to inspire them (the natives) with friendship for us, and being persuaded, on seeing them, that they would confide the more readily in us, and be the better disposed towards embracing our Holy Faith, if we used mildness in persuading them, rather than if we had recourse to force, I caused to be given to several amongst them, coloured caps, and also glass beads, which they put around their necks. I added various other articles of small value; they testified great joy, and showed so much gratitude that we marvelled greatly at it. When we were re-embarking, they swam towards us, to offer us parroquets, balls of cotton thread, zagayes (or long darts), and many other things; in exchange we gave them some small glass beads, little bells, and other objects. They gave us all they had, but they appeared to me to be very poor. The men and women both were as naked as when they were born. Amongst those whom we saw, one woman was rather young, and none of the men appeared to be more than thirty years of age. They were well made, their figures handsome, and their faces agreeable. Their hair, coarse as that of a horse's tail, hung down in front as low as their eyebrows, behind it formed a long mass, which they never cut. There are some who paint themselves with a blackish pigment; their natural colour being neither black nor white, but similar to that of the inhabitants of the Canary islands; some paint themselves with white, some with red, or any other colour, either covering the whole body with it, or the whole face, or perhaps only the eyes, or the nose. They do not carry arms like our people, and do not even know what they are. When I showed them some swords, they laid hold of them by the blades, and cut their fingers. They have no iron; their zagayes are sticks, the tip is not of iron, but sometimes made of a fish tooth, or of some other hard substance. They have much grace in their movements. I remarked that several had scars upon their bodies, and I asked them by means of signs, how they had been wounded. They answered in the same manner, that the inhabitants of the neighbouring islands had come to attack them, and make them prisoners, and that they had defended themselves. I thought then and I still think that they must have come from the mainland to make them prisoners for slaves; they would be faithful and gentle servants. They seem to have the power of repeating quickly what they hear. I am persuaded that they might be converted to Christianity without difficulty, for I believe that they belong to no sect."
At that moment, some naked natives appeared on the newly discovered coast. Columbus had his longboat lowered and got in with Alonzo and Yanez Pinzon, the comptroller Rodrigo, the secretary Descovedo, and a few others. He landed on the shore, carrying the royal banner, while the two captains held the green banner of the Cross, which had the initials of Ferdinand and Isabella interwoven. The admiral then solemnly claimed the island in the name of the King and Queen of Spain and had a record of the event documented. During this ceremony, the locals gathered around Columbus and his companions. M. Charton shares the account of the scene in Columbus's own words: "Wanting to inspire them (the natives) with friendship for us, and believing that they would be more likely to trust us and be open to embracing our Holy Faith if we approached them gently rather than with force, I had several of them given colored caps and glass beads, which they wore around their necks. I also gave them various other small items of little value; they showed great joy and gratitude, which amazed us. When we were getting back in the boat, they swam toward us to offer us parrots, balls of cotton thread, long darts, and many other things; in return, we gave them small glass beads, little bells, and other objects. They offered us everything they had, but they seemed very poor. Both the men and women were as naked as they were born. Among those we saw, there was one young woman, and none of the men appeared to be over thirty. They were well-built, their figures attractive, and their faces pleasing. Their hair, coarse like a horse's tail, hung low over their eyebrows, and they kept it long, never cutting it. Some painted themselves with a dark pigment; their natural skin tone was neither black nor white, but rather similar to that of the inhabitants of the Canary Islands. Some painted themselves white, some red, or any other color, covering their entire body, their whole face, or just their eyes or nose. They don’t carry weapons like ours and don’t even know what they are. When I showed them some swords, they picked them up by the blades and cut their fingers. They have no iron; their long darts are made from sticks, and the tips are not made of iron but can be made from fish teeth or other hard materials. They move with a lot of grace. I noticed that several had scars on their bodies and asked them through gestures how they were wounded. They indicated that the inhabitants of nearby islands had come to attack and capture them and that they had defended themselves. I thought then, and I still believe, that these attackers must have come from the mainland to take them as slaves; they would likely make loyal and gentle servants. They seem capable of quickly repeating what they hear. I’m convinced they could be converted to Christianity easily, as I believe they belong to no particular faith."
When Columbus returned on board, several of the savages swam after his boat; the next day, the 13th, they came in crowds around the ships, on board of enormous canoes shaped out of the trunks of trees; they were guided by means of a kind of baker's shovel, and some of the canoes were capable of holding forty men. Several natives wore little plates of gold hanging from their nostrils; they appeared much surprised at the arrival of the strangers, and quite believed that these white men must have fallen from the skies. It was with a mixture of respect and curiosity that they touched the garments of the Spaniards, considering them doubtless, a kind of natural plumage. The scarlet coat of the admiral excited their admiration above everything, and it was evident they looked upon Columbus as a parroquet of a superior species; at once they seemed to recognize him as the chief amongst the strangers.
When Columbus came back on board, several of the locals swam after his boat; the next day, the 13th, they gathered in large groups around the ships, on massive canoes made from tree trunks. They were steered with a sort of baker's shovel, and some of the canoes could hold up to forty men. Many of the natives had small gold plates hanging from their nostrils; they seemed quite surprised by the arrival of the newcomers and genuinely believed that these white men must have fallen from the sky. They touched the Spaniards’ clothing with a mix of respect and curiosity, likely seeing it as a form of natural adornment. The admiral's red coat impressed them more than anything else, and it was clear they regarded Columbus as a bird of a superior kind; they immediately recognized him as the leader among the strangers.
So Columbus and his followers visited this new island of San Salvador. They were never tired of admiring the beauty of its situation, its magnificent groves, its running streams, and verdant meadows. The fauna of the island offered little variety; parroquets of radiant plumage abounded amongst the trees, but they appeared to be the only species of birds upon the island. San Salvador presented an almost flat plateau of which no mountain broke the uniformity; a small lake occupied the centre of the island. The explorers imagined that San Salvador must contain great mineral riches, since the inhabitants were adorned with ornaments of gold. But was this precious metal derived from the island itself? Upon this point the admiral questioned one of the natives, and succeeded in learning from him by means of signs, that in turning the island and sailing towards the south, the admiral would find a country of which the king possessed great vessels of gold and immense riches. The next morning, at daybreak, Columbus gave orders to have the ships prepared for sea; he set sail, and steered towards the continent of which the natives had spoken, which, as he imagined, could be none other than Cipango.
So Columbus and his crew visited the new island of San Salvador. They were constantly amazed by the beauty of its location, its stunning groves, flowing streams, and lush meadows. The island's wildlife was not very diverse; colorful parrots filled the trees, but they seemed to be the only type of bird present. San Salvador had an almost flat landscape with no mountains disrupting its uniformity; a small lake sat in the center of the island. The explorers believed that San Salvador must be rich in minerals since the locals decorated themselves with gold ornaments. But where did this precious metal come from? On this subject, the admiral asked one of the natives and managed to communicate through gestures that if he sailed south, he would find a land where the king owned great gold vessels and immense wealth. The next morning at dawn, Columbus ordered the ships to be prepared for departure; he set sail and headed toward the continent the natives had described, which he thought could only be Cipango.
Here an important observation must be made, showing the state of geographical knowledge at this period: viz. that Columbus now believed himself to have arrived at Asia, Cipango being the name given by Marco Polo to Japan. This error of the admiral, shared in by all his companions, was not rectified for many years afterwards, and thus, as we have already remarked, the great navigator after four successive voyages to the islands, died, without knowing that he had discovered a new world. It is beyond doubt that the sailors of Columbus, and Columbus himself, imagined that they had arrived, during that night of the 12th October, 1492, either at Japan, or China, or the Indies. This is the reason why America so long bore the name of the "Western Indies," and why the aborigines of this continent, in Brazil and in Mexico, as well as in the United States, are still classed under the general appellation of "Indians."
Here, an important observation needs to be made about the state of geographical knowledge at that time: Columbus believed he had arrived in Asia, referring to Japan as Cipango, a name given by Marco Polo. This misunderstanding was shared by all his crew and wasn't corrected for many years. As we've noted before, the great navigator died after making four voyages to the islands, completely unaware that he had discovered a new world. It's clear that Columbus and his sailors thought they had reached Japan, China, or the Indies on the night of October 12, 1492. This is why America was long referred to as the "Western Indies," and why the native peoples in Brazil, Mexico, and the United States are still commonly labeled as "Indians."
So Columbus dreamt only of reaching the shores of Japan. He coasted along San Salvador, exploring its western side. The natives, running down to the shore, offered him water and cassava bread, made from the root of a plant called the "Yucca." Several times the admiral landed upon the coast at different points, and with a sad want of humanity, he carried away some of the natives, that he might take them with him to Spain. Poor men! already the strangers began to tear them from their country; it would not be long before they began to sell them! At last the caravels lost sight of San Salvador, and were again upon the wide ocean.
So Columbus only dreamed of reaching the shores of Japan. He sailed along San Salvador, exploring its western side. The locals ran down to the shore, offering him water and cassava bread, made from the root of a plant called "Yucca." Several times, the admiral landed on the coast at different spots, and with a troubling lack of humanity, he took some of the locals with him to Spain. Poor men! The strangers had already begun to tear them from their homeland; it wouldn't be long before they started selling them! Eventually, the caravels lost sight of San Salvador and were back out on the vast ocean.
Fortune had favoured Columbus in thus guiding him into the centre of one of the most beautiful archipelagos which the world contains. These new lands which he discovered were as a casket of precious stones, which needed only to be opened, and the hands of the discoverer were full of treasures. On the 15th October, at sunset, the flotilla came to anchor near the western point of a second island, at a distance of only fifteen miles from San Salvador; this island was named Conception; on the morrow the admiral landed upon the shore, having his men well armed for fear of surprise; the natives, however, proved to be of the same race as those of San Salvador, and gave a kind welcome to the Spaniards. A south-easterly wind having arisen, Columbus soon put to sea again, and twenty-seven miles further westward, he discovered a third island, which he called Fernandina, but which now goes by the name of the Great Exuma. All night they lay-to, and next day, the 17th October, large native canoes came off to the vessels. The relations with the natives were excellent, the savages peacefully exchanging fruit, and small balls of cotton for glass beads, tambourines, needles, which took their fancy greatly, and some molasses, of which they appeared very fond. These natives of Fernandina wore some clothing, and appeared altogether more civilized than those of San Salvador; they inhabited houses made in the shape of tents and having high chimneys; the interiors of these dwellings were remarkably clean and well kept. The western side of the island, with its deeply indented shore, formed a grand natural harbour, capable of containing a hundred vessels.
Fortune had smiled on Columbus by guiding him to the center of one of the most beautiful archipelagos in the world. The new lands he discovered were like a treasure chest, just waiting to be opened, and the discoverer’s hands were full of riches. On October 15th, at sunset, the fleet anchored near the western tip of a second island, just fifteen miles from San Salvador; this island was named Conception. The next day, the admiral landed on the shore, having armed his men in case of surprise; however, the natives turned out to be of the same group as those in San Salvador and welcomed the Spaniards warmly. With a south-easterly wind picking up, Columbus soon set sail again and, twenty-seven miles further west, discovered a third island, which he named Fernandina but is now known as Great Exuma. They stayed anchored all night, and the next day, October 17th, large native canoes approached the ships. Relations with the natives were excellent, with the locals peacefully trading fruit and small balls of cotton for glass beads, tambourines, needles—which they were very interested in—and some molasses, which they seemed to enjoy. The natives of Fernandina wore some clothing and seemed much more civilized than those of San Salvador; they lived in tent-shaped houses with tall chimneys, and the insides of these homes were remarkably clean and well-kept. The western side of the island, with its deeply indented shore, formed a grand natural harbor capable of holding a hundred ships.
But Fernandina did not afford the riches so much coveted by the Spaniards as spoils to take back to Europe; there were no gold-mines here; the natives who were on board the flotilla always spoke, however, of a larger island, situated to the south and called Saometo, in which the precious metal was found. Columbus steered in the direction indicated, and during the night of Friday, the 19th of October, he cast anchor near this Saometo, calling it Isabella; in modern maps it goes by the name of Long Island. According to the natives of San Salvador, there was a powerful king in this island, but the admiral for several days awaited in vain the advent of this great personage; he did not show himself. The island of Isabella was beautiful of aspect, with its clear lakes, and thick forests; the Spaniards were never tired of admiring the new type of nature presented to their view, and of which the intense verdure was wonderful to European eyes. Parroquets in innumerable flocks were flying amongst the thick trees, and great lizards, doubtless iguanas, glided with rapid movements in the high grass. The inhabitants of the island fled at first at the sight of the foreigners, but soon becoming bolder, they trafficked with the Spaniards in the productions of their country.
But Fernandina didn’t provide the wealth that the Spaniards were so eager for as treasures to take back to Europe; there were no gold mines here. However, the natives on board the flotilla always talked about a larger island to the south called Saometo, where the precious metal could be found. Columbus headed in the direction they indicated, and during the night of Friday, October 19th, he anchored near this Saometo, naming it Isabella; on modern maps, it's known as Long Island. According to the natives of San Salvador, there was a powerful king on this island, but the admiral waited in vain for days for this great figure to appear; he never showed up. The island of Isabella was beautiful, with its clear lakes and dense forests; the Spaniards couldn't get enough of admiring the new landscape before them, and the vibrant greenery was incredible to European eyes. Parrots flew in huge flocks among the thick trees, and large lizards, probably iguanas, moved quickly through the tall grass. The island's inhabitants initially fled at the sight of the foreigners but soon grew bolder and began to trade with the Spaniards for the products of their land.
Still Columbus held firmly to the notion of reaching the shores of Japan. The natives had mentioned to him a large island a little to the west which they called Cuba, and this the admiral supposed must form part of the kingdom of Cipango; he felt little doubt but that he would soon arrive at the town of Quinsay, or Hang-tchoo-foo, formerly the capital of China. With this object, as soon as the winds permitted, the fleet weighed anchor. On Thursday, the 25th of October, seven or eight islands lying in a straight line were sighted, these were probably the Mucaras. Columbus did not stop to visit them, and on the Sunday he came in sight of Cuba. The caravels were moored in a river, to which the Spaniards gave the name of San Salvador; after a short stay, they sailed again towards the west, and entered a harbour situated at the mouth of a large river which was afterwards called the harbour of Las Nuevitas del Principe.
Still, Columbus held firmly to the idea of reaching the shores of Japan. The locals had mentioned a large island a little to the west that they called Cuba, and the admiral believed it must be part of the kingdom of Cipango; he had no doubt that he would soon arrive at the town of Quinsay, or Hang-tchoo-foo, which was once the capital of China. With this goal in mind, as soon as the winds allowed, the fleet set sail. On Thursday, October 25th, seven or eight islands in a straight line were sighted, likely the Mucaras. Columbus didn’t stop to explore them, and on Sunday he spotted Cuba. The caravels were anchored in a river, which the Spaniards named San Salvador; after a brief stay, they sailed again towards the west and entered a harbor located at the mouth of a large river, which was later called the harbor of Las Nuevitas del Principe.
Numerous palm-trees were growing upon the shores of the island, having leaves so broad that only one was required for roofing a native hut. The natives had fled at the approach of the Spaniards, who found upon the shore idols of female form, tame birds, bones of animals, also dumb dogs, and some fishing instruments. The Cuban savages, however, were ready to be enticed like the others, and they consented to barter their goods with the Spaniards. Columbus believed himself to be now on the mainland, and only a few leagues from Hang-tchoo-foo; this idea being so rooted in his mind, that he even busied himself in despatching some presents to the great Khan of China. On the 2nd of November he desired one of the officers of his ship, and a Jew who could speak Hebrew, Chaldee, and Arabic, to set out to seek this native monarch. The ambassadors, carrying with them strings of beads, and having six days given to them for the fulfilment of their mission, started, taking a route leading towards the interior of this so-called continent.
Numerous palm trees were growing along the island's shores, with leaves so wide that just one was enough to cover a native hut. The locals had escaped when the Spaniards arrived, who found idols of women, tame birds, animal bones, mute dogs, and some fishing tools on the beach. However, the Cuban natives were ready to be swayed like others, and they agreed to trade their goods with the Spaniards. Columbus thought he was now on the mainland, just a few leagues from Hang-tchoo-foo; this belief was so strong that he even started sending gifts to the great Khan of China. On November 2nd, he asked one of his ship's officers and a Jewish man who could speak Hebrew, Chaldee, and Arabic to go seek this native king. The ambassadors, carrying strings of beads and given six days to complete their mission, set off, taking a route deeper into this so-called continent.
In the meantime, Columbus explored for nearly six miles a splendid river which flowed beneath the shade of woods of odoriferous trees. The inhabitants freely bartered their goods with the Spaniards, and frequently mentioned to them a place named Bohio, where gold and pearls might be obtained in abundance. They added that men lived there who had dogs' heads, and who fed upon human flesh.
In the meantime, Columbus explored a beautiful river for almost six miles, which flowed under the shade of fragrant trees. The locals eagerly traded their goods with the Spaniards and often talked about a place called Bohio, where gold and pearls could be found in plenty. They also mentioned that there were people living there who had dog heads and feasted on human flesh.
The admiral's envoys returned to the port on the 6th of November, after a four days' absence. Two days had sufficed to bring them to a village composed of about fifty huts, where they were received with every mark of respect; the natives kissing their feet and hands, and taking them for deities descended from the skies. Among other details of native customs, they reported that both men and women smoked tobacco by means of a forked pipe, drawing up the smoke through their nostrils. These savages were acquainted with the secret of obtaining fire by rubbing briskly two pieces of wood against each other. Cotton was found in large quantities in the houses, made up into the form of tents, one of these containing as much as 11,000 pounds of the material. As to the grand khan they saw no vestige of him.
The admiral's envoys returned to the port on November 6th, after being away for four days. They reached a village with about fifty huts in just two days, where they were treated with great respect; the locals kissed their feet and hands, believing them to be gods from the sky. Among other details of local customs, they reported that both men and women smoked tobacco using a forked pipe, inhaling the smoke through their nostrils. These people knew how to create fire by swiftly rubbing two pieces of wood together. They discovered large amounts of cotton in the houses, which were made into tents, with one tent containing as much as 11,000 pounds of cotton. As for the grand khan, they found no trace of him.
Another consequence of the error of Columbus must be noticed here, one which, according to Irving, changed the whole series of his discoveries. He believed himself to be on the coast of Asia, and therefore looked upon Cuba as a portion of that continent. In consequence, he never thought of making the tour of Cuba, but decided on returning towards the east. Now, had he not been deceived on this occasion, and had he continued to follow the same direction as at first, the results of his enterprise would have been greatly modified. He might then have drifted towards Florida at the south-eastern point of North America, or he might have run direct to Mexico. In this latter case, instead of ignorant and savage natives, what would he have found? The inhabitants of the great Aztec Empire, of the half-civilized kingdom of Montezuma. There he would have seen towns, armies, enormous wealth, and his rôle would no doubt have been the same as that afterwards played by Fernando Cortès. But it was not to be thus, and the admiral, persevering in his mistake, directed his flotilla towards the east, weighing anchor on the 12th of November, 1492.
Another consequence of Columbus's mistake needs to be mentioned here, one that, according to Irving, changed the entire course of his discoveries. He believed he was on the coast of Asia and therefore viewed Cuba as part of that continent. As a result, he never considered exploring Cuba but chose to head back east instead. Had he not been misled this time and had he continued on the same path as before, the outcomes of his journey would have been significantly different. He might have drifted toward Florida at the southeastern tip of North America, or he could have gone straight to Mexico. In the latter case, instead of encountering ignorant and savage natives, what would he have found? The people of the great Aztec Empire, the semi-civilized kingdom of Montezuma. There he would have witnessed towns, armies, enormous wealth, and his role would likely have been the same as that later played by Fernando Cortès. But that was not to be, and the admiral, sticking to his mistake, directed his flotilla eastward, weighing anchor on November 12, 1492.
Columbus tacked in and out along the Cuban coast; he saw the two mountains—Cristal and Moa; he explored a harbour to which he gave the name of Puerto del Principe, and an archipelago which he called the Sea of Nuestra Señora. Each night the fishermen's fires were seen upon the numerous islands, the inhabitants of which lived upon spiders and huge worms. Several times the Spaniards landed upon different points of the coast, and there planted the cross as a sign of taking possession of the country. The natives often spoke to the admiral about a certain island of Babeque, where gold abounded, and thither Columbus resolved to go, but Martin-Alonzo Pinzon, the captain of the Pinta, the best sailer of the three ships, was beforehand with him, and at day-break on the 21st of November, he had completely disappeared from sight. The admiral was very angry at this separation, his feelings on the subject appearing plainly in his narrative, where he says, "Pinzon has said and done to me many like things." Continuing his exploration of the coast of Cuba, Columbus discovered the Bay of Moa, the Point of Mangle, Point Vaez, and the harbour of Barracoa, but nowhere did he meet with cannibals, although the huts of the natives were often to be seen adorned with human skulls, a sight which appeared to give great satisfaction to the islanders on board the fleet. On the following days, they saw the Boma River, and the caravels, doubling the point of Los Azules, found themselves upon the eastern part of the island, whose coast they had now reconnoitred for a distance of 375 miles. But Columbus instead of continuing his route to the south turned off to the east, and on the 5th of December perceived a large island, called by the natives Bohio. This was Hayti, or San Domingo.
Columbus navigated back and forth along the Cuban coast; he saw the two mountains—Cristal and Moa; he explored a harbor that he named Puerto del Principe, and an archipelago that he called the Sea of Nuestra Señora. Each night, the fishermen's fires lit up the many islands, where the locals lived on spiders and giant worms. Several times, the Spaniards landed at different points on the coast and placed a cross as a sign of claiming the land. The natives often told the admiral about a certain island called Babeque, where gold was plentiful, and Columbus decided to go there. However, Martin-Alonzo Pinzon, the captain of the Pinta, the fastest of the three ships, got there first and completely vanished from sight by dawn on November 21st. The admiral was very upset about this separation, and his feelings are clear in his narrative, where he says, "Pinzon has said and done many similar things to me." While continuing his exploration of the Cuban coast, Columbus discovered the Bay of Moa, Point of Mangle, Point Vaez, and the harbor of Barracoa, but he never encountered cannibals, even though the huts of the natives were often decorated with human skulls, which seemed to please the islanders on board the fleet. In the following days, they saw the Boma River, and the caravels, after rounding the point of Los Azules, found themselves on the eastern part of the island, which they had now surveyed for a distance of 375 miles. Instead of continuing south, Columbus turned east and on December 5th noticed a large island called Bohio by the natives. This was Hayti, or San Domingo.
In the evening, the Nina by the admiral's orders, entered a harbour which was named Port Mary; it is situated at the north-western extremity of the island, and, with the cape near which it lies, is now called St. Nicholas. The next day the Spaniards discovered a number of headlands, and an islet, called Tortuga Island. Everywhere on the appearance of the ships, the Indian canoes took to flight. The island, along which they were now coasting, appeared very large and very high, from which latter peculiarity it gained, later on, its name of Hayti, which signifies High Land. The coast was explored by the Spaniards as far as Mosquito Bay; its natural features, its plains and hills, its plants and the birds which fluttered amongst the beautiful trees of the island, all recalled to the memory the landscapes of Castille, and for this reason Columbus named it Hispaniola, or Spanish Island. The inhabitants were extremely timid and distrustful; they fled away into the interior and no communication could be held with them. Some sailors, however, succeeded in capturing a young woman, whom they carried on board with them. She was young and rather pretty. The admiral gave her, besides rings and beads, some clothing, of which she had great need, and after most generous treatment, he sent her back to shore.
In the evening, the Nina, following the admiral's orders, entered a harbor called Port Mary, located at the northwestern tip of the island, which is now known as St. Nicholas. The next day, the Spaniards discovered several headlands and an islet named Tortuga Island. Whenever the ships appeared, the Indian canoes quickly fled. The island they were now sailing along appeared very large and tall, which later earned it the name Hayti, meaning High Land. The Spaniards explored the coast as far as Mosquito Bay; its natural features, plains and hills, plants, and the birds fluttering among the beautiful trees reminded them of the landscapes of Castille, which is why Columbus named it Hispaniola, or Spanish Island. The inhabitants were very timid and distrustful; they ran into the interior, making communication impossible. However, some sailors managed to capture a young woman, whom they brought aboard with them. She was young and quite pretty. The admiral gave her rings and beads, as well as some much-needed clothing, and after treating her generously, he sent her back to shore.
This good conduct had the result of taming the natives, and the next day, when nine of the sailors, well armed, ventured as far as sixteen miles inland, they were received with respect, the savages running to them in crowds, and offering them everything which their country produced. The sailors returned to the ships enchanted with their excursion. The interior of the island they had found rich in cotton plants, mastic-trees and aloes, while a fine river, named afterwards the Three Rivers, flowed gently along its limpid course. On December 15th, Columbus again set sail, and was carried by the wind towards Tortuga Island, upon which he saw a navigable stream of water, and a valley so beautiful that he called it the Vale of Paradise. The day following, having tacked into a deep gulf, an Indian was seen who, notwithstanding the violence of the wind, was skilfully manoeuvring a light canoe. This Indian was invited to come on board, was loaded with presents by the admiral, and then put on shore again, at one of the harbours of Hispaniola, now called the Puerto de Paz. This kindness tended to attach the natives to the admiral, and from that day they came in numbers round the caravels; their king came with them, a strong, vigorous, and somewhat stout young man of twenty years of age; he was naked, like his subjects of both sexes, who showed him much respect, but with no appearance of servility. Columbus ordered royal honours to be rendered to him, and in return, the king, or rather cacique, informed the admiral that the provinces to the east abounded in gold.
This good behavior helped to calm the locals, and the next day, when nine of the sailors, well-armed, ventured about sixteen miles inland, they were met with respect, as the natives rushed to them in crowds, offering everything their land produced. The sailors returned to the ships thrilled by their adventure. They found the interior of the island rich in cotton plants, mastic trees, and aloes, while a lovely river, later named the Three Rivers, flowed gently along its clear course. On December 15th, Columbus set sail again, and the wind took him toward Tortuga Island, where he saw a navigable stream and a valley so beautiful that he called it the Vale of Paradise. The following day, after sailing into a deep bay, they spotted an Indian who, despite the strong wind, skillfully maneuvered a light canoe. This Indian was invited to come on board, received gifts from the admiral, and was then taken ashore at one of the harbors of Hispaniola, now called Puerto de Paz. This kindness helped to win the natives' favor with the admiral, and from that day on, they came in large numbers around the caravels; their king accompanied them, a strong, sturdy young man about twenty years old; he was naked, like his subjects of both genders, who showed him great respect but without any sign of subservience. Columbus ordered royal honors to be given to him, and in return, the king, or cacique, informed the admiral that the provinces to the east were rich in gold.
![]() |
Columbus named it the Vale of Paradise. |
Next day another cacique arrived, offering to place all the treasures of his country at the service of the Spaniards. He was present at a fête in honour of the Virgin Mary, that Columbus caused to be celebrated with great pomp on board his vessel, which was gaily dressed with flags on the occasion. The cacique dined at the admiral's table, apparently enjoying the repast; after he had himself tasted of the different viands and beverages, he sent the dishes and goblets to the members of his suite; he had good manners, spoke little, but showed great politeness. After the feast, he gave the admiral some thin leaves of gold, while Columbus, on his side, presented him with some coins, upon which were engraved the portraits of Ferdinand and Isabella, and after explaining to him by signs that these were the representations of the most powerful sovereigns in the world, he caused the royal banners of Castille to be displayed before the savage prince. When night fell, the cacique retired, highly delighted with his visit; and on his departure he was saluted with a salvo of artillery. On the day following, the crews before quitting this hospitable coast, set up a large cross in the middle of the little town. In issuing from the gulf formed by Tortuga Island and Hispaniola, they discovered several harbours, capes, bays, and rivers; at the point of Limbé, a small island which Columbus named St. Thomas, and finally, an enormous harbour safe and sheltered, hidden between the island and the Bay of Acul, and to which access was given by a canal surrounded by high mountains covered with trees.
The next day, another chief arrived, offering to put all the treasures of his land at the service of the Spaniards. He attended a celebration in honor of the Virgin Mary, which Columbus hosted with great fanfare on board his ship, beautifully decorated with flags for the occasion. The chief dined at the admiral's table, seemingly enjoying the meal; after sampling the various dishes and drinks himself, he passed the plates and cups to his companions. He was well-mannered, spoke little, but showed great courtesy. After the feast, he presented the admiral with some thin gold leaves, while Columbus, in return, gave him some coins featuring the portraits of Ferdinand and Isabella. After explaining to him with gestures that these were the images of the most powerful monarchs in the world, he had the royal banners of Castile displayed before the chief. When night fell, the chief left, pleased with his visit, and was sent off with a salute of cannon fire. The following day, before departing from this welcoming coast, the crews erected a large cross in the center of the small town. As they exited the gulf formed by Tortuga Island and Hispaniola, they discovered several harbors, capes, bays, and rivers; at the point of Limbé, they spotted a small island that Columbus named St. Thomas, and finally, a vast and safe harbor hidden between the island and the Bay of Acul, accessible by a canal surrounded by tall mountains covered in trees.
The admiral often disembarked upon this coast, the natives receiving him as an ambassador from heaven, and imploring him to remain among them. Columbus gave them quantities of little bells, brass rings, glass beads, and other toys, which they eagerly accepted. A cacique named Guacanagari, reigning over the province of Marien, sent to the admiral a belt adorned with the figure of an animal with large ears, of which the nose and tongue were made of beaten gold. Gold appeared to be abundant in the island, and the natives soon brought a considerable quantity of it to the strangers. The inhabitants of this part of Hispaniola seemed to be superior in intelligence and appearance to those of that portion of the island which had been first visited; in the opinion of Columbus, the paint, red, black, or white, with which the natives covered their bodies, served to protect them from sunstroke. The huts of these savages were pretty and well built. Upon Columbus questioning them as to the country which produced gold, they always indicated one towards the east, a country which they called Cibao, and which the admiral continued to identify with Cipango or Japan.
The admiral frequently landed on this coast, and the local people welcomed him as a messenger from heaven, begging him to stay with them. Columbus gave them lots of small bells, brass rings, glass beads, and other trinkets, which they eagerly accepted. A chief named Guacanagari, who ruled the province of Marien, sent the admiral a belt decorated with the image of an animal with large ears, its nose and tongue made of beaten gold. Gold seemed to be plentiful on the island, and the locals soon brought a considerable amount of it to the newcomers. The inhabitants of this part of Hispaniola appeared to be more intelligent and better looking than those from the area previously visited; Columbus believed that the paint—red, black, or white—that the locals covered their bodies with helped protect them from sunstroke. The huts of these people were attractive and well-built. When Columbus asked them about the land where gold came from, they always pointed towards the east, to a place they called Cibao, which the admiral continued to associate with Cipango or Japan.
On Christmas Day a serious accident occurred to the admiral's caravel, the first damage sustained in this hitherto prosperous voyage. An inexperienced steersman was at the helm of the Santa-Maria during an excursion outside the Gulf of St. Thomas; night came on, and he allowed the vessel to be caught in some currents which threw her upon the rocks; the caravel grounded and her rudder stuck fast. The admiral, awakened by the shock, ran upon deck; he ordered an anchor to be fastened forward, by which the ship might warp herself off and so float again. The master and some of the sailors charged with the execution of this order, jumped into the long boat, but seized with a sudden panic, they rowed away in haste to the Nina. Meantime the tide fell, and the Santa-Maria ran further aground; it became necessary to cut away the masts to lighten her, and soon it was evident that everything on board must be removed to the other ship. The cacique Guacanagari, quite understanding the dangerous situation of the caravel, came with his brothers and other relations, accompanied by a great number of the Indians, and helped in unlading the ship. Thanks to this prince, not a single article of the cargo was stolen, and during the whole night armed natives kept watch around the stores of provisions.
On Christmas Day, a serious accident happened to the admiral's caravel, the first damage experienced on this otherwise successful voyage. An inexperienced helmsman was steering the Santa-Maria during an outing outside the Gulf of St. Thomas; night fell, and he let the vessel get caught in some currents that slammed her against the rocks; the caravel ran aground and her rudder got stuck. The admiral, awakened by the impact, rushed to the deck; he ordered an anchor to be secured at the front so the ship could pull herself off and float again. The captain and some of the sailors tasked with this order jumped into the lifeboat, but in a sudden panic, they rowed away quickly to the Nina. Meanwhile, the tide receded, and the Santa-Maria drifted further aground; it became necessary to cut down the masts to lighten her load, and soon it was clear that everything on board needed to be moved to the other ship. The cacique Guacanagari, fully understanding the perilous situation of the caravel, came with his brothers and other relatives, along with a large number of Indians, and helped unload the ship. Thanks to this prince, not a single item of the cargo was stolen, and throughout the night, armed natives kept watch around the food supplies.
The next day Guacanagari went on board the Nina, to console the admiral, and to place all his own possessions at his disposal, at the same time offering him a repast of bread, doe's flesh, fish, roots, and fruit. Columbus, much moved by these tokens of friendship, formed the design of founding an establishment on this island. With this purpose in view, he addressed himself to gain the hearts of the Indians by presents and kindness, and wishing also to give them an adequate notion of his power, he ordered the discharge of an arquebuse and a small cannon, of which the reports frightened the poor savages terribly. On December 26th, the Spaniards commenced the construction of a fort upon this part of the coast, the intention of the admiral being to leave there a certain number of men, with a year's provision of bread, wine, and seed, and to give them the long boat belonging to the Santa-Maria. The works at the fort were pushed forward with rapidity. It was also on the 26th that they received news of the Pinta, which had been separated from the flotilla since November 21st. The natives announced that she was at anchor in a river at the extreme point of the island, but a canoe despatched by Guacanagari returned without having found her. Then Columbus, not wishing to continue his explorations under the present conditions, since the loss of the Santa-Maria, which could not be floated again, left him but one caravel, decided to return to Spain, and preparations for the departure began.
The next day, Guacanagari boarded the Nina to comfort the admiral and offered all his belongings for his use, while also providing a meal of bread, deer meat, fish, roots, and fruit. Columbus, deeply touched by these signs of friendship, planned to establish a settlement on the island. To achieve this, he aimed to win the Indians' hearts with gifts and kindness, while also wanting to show them his power. He ordered the discharge of a arquebus and a small cannon, which terrified the poor natives. On December 26th, the Spaniards started building a fort on this part of the coast, intending for the admiral to leave a number of men there with a year's worth of bread, wine, and seed, along with the long boat from the Santa-Maria. The construction of the fort moved quickly. It was also on the 26th that they learned about the Pinta, which had been separated from the flotilla since November 21st. The natives reported that it was anchored in a river at the far end of the island, but a canoe sent by Guacanagari returned without finding her. Columbus, not wanting to continue his explorations under these circumstances since the loss of the Santa-Maria, which could not be salvaged, left him with only one caravel and decided to return to Spain, so preparations for departure began.
On the 2nd of January Columbus caused his soldiers to act a mimic battle, greatly to the admiration of the cacique and his subjects. Afterwards the admiral chose out thirty-nine men to form the garrison of the fortress during his absence, naming Rodrigo de Escovedo as their commander. The greater part of the cargo of the Santa-Maria was to be left behind with them, for their year's provision. Amongst these first colonists of the New World were included a writer, an alguazil, a cooper, a doctor, and a tailor. These Spaniards were charged with the mission of seeking for gold-mines, and of choosing a suitable site for the building of a town. On the 3rd of January, after solemn leave-takings of the cacique and the new colonists, the Nina weighed anchor and sailed out of the harbour. An island was soon discovered, having upon it a very high mountain; to this was given the name of Monte-Christi. Columbus had already sailed for two days along the coast, when he was aware of the approach of the Pinta, and very soon her captain, Martin Alonzo Pinzon, came on board the Nina, endeavouring to excuse his conduct. The real truth was that Pinzon had taken the lead with the view of being the first to reach the pretended island of Babeque, of which the riches had been described in glowing colours by the natives. The admiral was very ready to accept the bad reasons given him by Captain Pinzon, and learnt from him that the Pinta had done nothing but coast along the shores of Hispaniola, without discovering any new island.
On January 2nd, Columbus had his soldiers perform a mock battle, which really impressed the cacique and his people. Afterwards, the admiral picked thirty-nine men to serve as the garrison for the fortress while he was away, appointing Rodrigo de Escovedo as their leader. Most of the cargo from the Santa-Maria was to be left with them for a year’s supply. Among these first colonists of the New World were a writer, a sheriff, a cooper, a doctor, and a tailor. These Spaniards were tasked with looking for gold mines and finding a good spot to build a town. On January 3rd, after saying formal goodbyes to the cacique and the new colonists, the Nina set sail out of the harbor. They soon discovered an island with a very tall mountain, naming it Monte-Christi. Columbus had sailed along the coast for two days when he noticed the approaching Pinta, and shortly after, her captain, Martin Alonzo Pinzon, came aboard the Nina, trying to explain his actions. The truth was that Pinzon had taken the lead with hopes of being the first to reach the rumored island of Babeque, which the natives had described as rich in resources. The admiral was quick to accept the poor excuses given by Captain Pinzon and learned that the Pinta had done nothing but cruise along the shores of Hispaniola, without finding any new islands.
On the 7th of January the ships lay to, to stop a leak which had sprung in the hold of the Nina. Columbus profited by this delay to explore a wide river, situated about three miles from Monte-Christi, and which carried so much gold-dust along with it, that he gave it the name of the Golden River. The admiral would have desired to visit this part of Hispaniola with greater care, but the crews were in haste to return home, and under the influence of the brothers Pinzon, began to murmur against his authority.
On January 7th, the ships stopped to fix a leak that had developed in the hold of the Nina. Columbus took advantage of this delay to explore a large river about three miles from Monte-Christi, which carried so much gold dust that he named it the Golden River. The admiral wanted to explore this area of Hispaniola more thoroughly, but the crew was eager to go home and, influenced by the Pinzon brothers, started grumbling against his leadership.
On the 9th of January the caravels set sail and steered towards the east-south-east, skirting the coast, and distinguishing by names even its smallest sinuosities; of such were point Isabella, the cape of La Roca, French Cape, Cape Cabron, and the Bay of Samana, situated at the eastern extremity of the island, where was a port, in which the fleet, being becalmed, came to anchor. At first the relations between the foreigners and the natives were excellent, but a change was suddenly perceived, the savages ceasing to barter, and making some hostile demonstrations, which left no doubt of the bad intentions entertained by them. On the 13th of January the savages made a sudden and unexpected attack upon the Spaniards, who, however, put a bold face on the matter, and by the aid of their weapons, put their enemies to flight after a few minutes' combat. Thus, for the first time, the blood of the Indian flowed beneath the hand of the European.
On January 9th, the caravels set sail heading east-southeast, hugging the coastline and naming even its smallest curves; these included Point Isabella, La Roca Cape, French Cape, Cape Cabron, and Samana Bay, located at the eastern tip of the island, where there was a port where the fleet anchored after being stuck in calm waters. Initially, the relationship between the foreigners and the natives was great, but a sudden change was noticed, with the natives stopping trade and showing some hostile signs, which made their bad intentions clear. On January 13th, the natives unexpectedly attacked the Spaniards, who, however, stood their ground and, with the help of their weapons, drove their attackers away after a few minutes of fighting. Thus, for the first time, the blood of an Indian was shed by a European hand.
On the morrow Columbus again set sail, having on board four young natives, whom, notwithstanding their objections, he persisted in carrying off with him. His crews, embittered and fatigued, caused him great uneasiness, and in his narrative of the voyage, this great man, superior though he were to all human weaknesses, and a being whom adverse fate could not humble, bemoans himself bitterly over this trial. It was on the 16th of January that the homeward voyage commenced in good earnest, and Cape Samana, the extreme point of Hispaniola, disappeared below the horizon. The passage proved a quick one, and no incident is recorded until the 12th of February, when the vessels encountered a fearful storm lasting three days, with furious wind, enormous waves, and much lightning from the north-north-east. Three times did the terrified sailors make a vow of pilgrimage to St. Mary of Guadalupe, to our Lady of Loretto, and to St. Clara of Moguer, and at length, in extremity of fear, the whole crew swore to go and pray in their shirts and with naked feet in some church dedicated to the Virgin. But in spite of all, the storm raged with redoubled fury, and even the admiral feared for the result. In case of a catastrophe, he thought it well hastily to write upon a parchment an abstract of his discoveries, with a request that who ever should find the document would forward it to the King of Spain; wrapping the parchment in oil-cloth, he enclosed it in a wooden barrel, which was thrown into the sea.
On the next day, Columbus set sail again, taking four young natives with him despite their protests. His crew, frustrated and exhausted, caused him a lot of worry, and in his account of the voyage, this great man—though he rose above all human weaknesses and couldn’t be brought low by bad luck—lamented this hardship. It was on January 16 that the journey home truly began as Cape Samana, the furthest point of Hispaniola, vanished from sight. The passage was quick, and there were no notable events until February 12, when the ships faced a terrible storm that lasted three days, bringing strong winds, huge waves, and a lot of lightning from the north-northeast. The frightened sailors made vows to go on pilgrimages to St. Mary of Guadalupe, Our Lady of Loretto, and St. Clara of Moguer, and in their utmost fear, the entire crew promised to pray in their shirts and bare feet in any church dedicated to the Virgin. But despite all this, the storm continued to rage with even more violence, and even the admiral was worried about the outcome. Anticipating a disaster, he thought it wise to quickly write a summary of his discoveries on a piece of parchment, asking whoever found the document to send it to the King of Spain; after wrapping the parchment in oilcloth, he placed it in a wooden barrel, which was then cast into the sea.
At sunrise on the 15th of February the hurricane abated, the two caravels which had been separated by the storm again joined company, and after three days they cast anchor at the island of St. Mary, one of the Azores; as soon as they arrived there, the admiral sought to further the accomplishment of the vows made during the storm, and with this object, sent half of his people on shore; but these were unhappily made prisoners by the Portuguese, who did not restore them to liberty for five days, notwithstanding the urgent remonstrances made by Columbus. The admiral put to sea again on the 23rd of February; again the winds were contrary, and again, amidst a violent tempest, he took fresh vows in company with all his crew, promising to fast on the first Saturday which should follow their arrival in Spain. At last, on the 4th of March, the pilots sighted the mouth of the Tagus, in which the Nina took refuge, whilst the Pinta, caught by the wind, was carried away into the Bay of Biscay.
At sunrise on February 15th, the hurricane calmed down, and the two caravels that had been separated by the storm reunited. After three days, they anchored at St. Mary’s Island, one of the Azores. As soon as they got there, the admiral wanted to fulfill the vows he made during the storm, so he sent half of his crew ashore. Unfortunately, they were captured by the Portuguese and weren’t released for five days, despite Columbus's desperate pleas. The admiral set sail again on February 23rd; once more, the winds were against them, and amid a violent storm, he made new vows with the entire crew, promising to fast on the first Saturday after their arrival in Spain. Finally, on March 4th, the pilots spotted the mouth of the Tagus River, where the Nina found refuge, while the Pinta, caught by the wind, was swept away into the Bay of Biscay.
The Portuguese welcomed the admiral kindly, the king even admitting him to an audience. Columbus was in haste to return to Spain; as soon as the weather permitted, the Nina again set sail, and at mid-day on the 15th of March, she cast anchor in the port of Palos, after seven months and a half of navigation, during which Columbus had discovered the islands of San Salvador, Conception, Great Exuma, Long Island, the Mucaras, Cuba, and San Domingo.
The Portuguese treated the admiral warmly, and the king even granted him an audience. Columbus was eager to get back to Spain; as soon as the weather allowed, the Nina set sail again, and at noon on March 15th, she anchored in the port of Palos, after seven and a half months at sea, during which Columbus had discovered the islands of San Salvador, Conception, Great Exuma, Long Island, the Mucaras, Cuba, and San Domingo.
The court of Ferdinand and Isabella was then at Barcelona, whither the admiral was summoned. He set out immediately, taking with him the Indians whom he had brought from the New World. The enthusiasm he excited was extreme; from all parts the people ran to look at him as he passed, rendering him royal honours. His entry into Barcelona was magnificent. The king and queen, with the grandees of Spain, received him with great pomp at the palace of the Deputation. He there gave an account of his wonderful voyage, and presented the specimens of gold which he had brought with him; then all the assembly knelt down and chanted the Te Deum. Christopher Columbus was afterwards ennobled by letters patent, and the king granted him a coat of arms bearing this device: "To Castille and Leon, Columbus gives a New World." The fame of the Genoese navigator rang through the whole of Europe; the Indians whom he had brought with him were baptized in presence of the whole court; and thus, the man of genius, so long poor and unknown, had now risen to the highest point of celebrity.
The court of Ferdinand and Isabella was in Barcelona at that time, where the admiral was summoned. He left right away, bringing with him the Indigenous people he had brought from the New World. The excitement he generated was immense; people rushed from all directions to see him as he passed by, giving him royal honors. His entrance into Barcelona was grand. The king and queen, along with the nobility of Spain, greeted him with great pomp at the palace of the Deputation. There, he recounted his amazing voyage and presented the gold samples he had brought back; then the entire assembly knelt and sang the Te Deum. Christopher Columbus was later honored with letters patent, and the king granted him a coat of arms featuring this motto: "To Castille and Leon, Columbus gives a New World." The fame of the Genoese navigator spread throughout all of Europe; the Indigenous people he had brought with him were baptized in front of the entire court; thus, the once poor and unknown genius had risen to the pinnacle of fame.
CHRISTOPHER COLUMBUS.
Second Voyage: Flotilla of seventeen vessels—Island of Ferro—Dominica—Marie-Galante—Guadaloupe—The Cannibals—Montserrat—Santa-Maria-la-Rodonda—St. Martin and Santa Cruz—Archipelago of the Eleven Thousand Virgins—The island of St. John Baptist, or Porto Rico—Hispaniola—The first Colonists massacred—Foundation of the town of Isabella—Twelve ships laden with treasure sent to Spain—Fort St. Thomas built in the Province of Cibao—Don Diego, Columbus' brother, named Governor of the Island—Jamaica—The Coast of Cuba—The Remora—Return to Isabella—The Cacique made prisoner—Revolt of the Natives—Famine—Columbus traduced in Spain—Juan Aguado sent as Commissary to Isabella—Gold-mines—Departure of Columbus—His arrival at Cadiz.
Second Voyage: A fleet of seventeen ships—Island of Ferro—Dominica—Marie-Galante—Guadaloupe—The Cannibals—Montserrat—Santa-Maria-la-Rodonda—St. Martin and Santa Cruz—Archipelago of the Eleven Thousand Virgins—The island of St. John Baptist, or Puerto Rico—Hispaniola—The first colonists massacred—Foundation of the town of Isabella—Twelve ships filled with treasure sent to Spain—Fort St. Thomas built in the Province of Cibao—Don Diego, Columbus' brother, appointed Governor of the Island—Jamaica—The Coast of Cuba—The Remora—Return to Isabella—The Cacique taken prisoner—Native revolt—Famine—Columbus slandered in Spain—Juan Aguado sent as Commissary to Isabella—Gold mines—Departure of Columbus—His arrival in Cadiz.
The narrative of the adventures of the great Genoese navigator had over-excited the minds of the hearers. Imagination already caught glimpses of golden continents situated beyond the seas. All the passions which are engendered by cupidity were seething in the people's hearts. The admiral, under pressure of public opinion, must set forth again with the most brief delay. He was himself also, eager to return to the theatre of his conquests, and to yet enrich the maps of the day with more new discoveries. He declared himself, therefore, ready to start.
The story of the adventures of the great Genoese navigator had really stirred up the minds of the listeners. Their imaginations were already catching glimpses of golden continents beyond the seas. All the greed-fueled passions were bubbling up in people's hearts. The admiral, facing public pressure, had to set off again at the earliest opportunity. He was also eager to return to the scene of his victories and to add more new discoveries to the maps of the time. So, he said he was ready to go.
The king and queen placed at his disposal a flotilla composed of three large ships and fourteen caravels. Twelve hundred men were to sail in them. Several Castilian nobles, with firm faith in the lucky star of Columbus, decided to try their fortune with him beyond seas. In the holds of the vessels were horses, cattle, instruments of all kinds for collecting and purifying gold, grain of various kinds; in a word, everything that might be needful in the establishing an important colony. Of the ten natives brought to Europe, five returned to their country, three, who were ill, remained behind in Europe, the other two were dead. Columbus was named captain-general of the squadron, with unlimited powers.
The king and queen provided him with a fleet of three large ships and fourteen caravels. A total of 1,200 men were set to sail on them. Several Castilian nobles, believing strongly in Columbus's lucky star, decided to join him in seeking their fortunes overseas. The ships were loaded with horses, cattle, various tools for collecting and refining gold, and different types of grain; in short, everything necessary to establish a significant colony. Of the ten natives brought to Europe, five returned home, three who were sick stayed in Europe, and the other two died. Columbus was appointed as the captain-general of the squadron, with full authority.
On the 25th of September, 1493, the seventeen ships left Cadiz, with all sails set, amidst the acclamations of an immense crowd of people and on the 1st of October, they cast anchor at the island of Ferro, the most westerly of the Canary group. On sailing again, the fleet was favoured by wind and sea, and after twenty-three days of navigation came in sight of new land. At sunrise on the 3rd of November, being the Sunday in the octave of All Saints, the pilot of the flag-ship, the Marie-Galante, cried out, "Good news, there is land." This land proved to be an island covered with trees; the admiral, thinking it uninhabited, did not stop; but, after passing several scattered islets, he arrived before a second island. The first he named Dominica, the second Marie-Galante, names which they retain to the present day. The next day a still larger island was in sight, and, says the narrative of this voyage given by Peter Martyr, the contemporary of Columbus, "When they were arrived, they saw it was the island of the infamous cannibals, or Caribbees, of whom they had only heard a rumour during the first voyage."
On September 25, 1493, the seventeen ships set sail from Cadiz, all sails full, amid cheers from a huge crowd. By October 1, they dropped anchor at the island of Ferro, the westernmost of the Canary Islands. As they sailed on, the fleet had favorable winds and seas, and after twenty-three days at sea, they spotted new land. At sunrise on November 3, which was the Sunday during the week of All Saints, the pilot of the flagship, the Marie-Galante, shouted, "Good news, there’s land!" This land turned out to be an island covered in trees; the admiral, thinking it was uninhabited, didn’t stop. After passing several small islets, he reached a second island. He named the first Dominica and the second Marie-Galante, names that still exist today. The next day, they saw an even larger island, and according to the account of this voyage given by Peter Martyr, a contemporary of Columbus, "When they arrived, they saw that it was the island of the infamous cannibals, or Caribbees, of whom they had only heard rumors during the first voyage."
The Spaniards, well armed, landed upon the shore, where they found about thirty circular houses built of wood and covered with palm leaves. In the interior of the huts were suspended hammocks made of cotton. In the centre of the village were placed two trees or posts around which were entwined the dead bodies of two serpents. At the approach of the strangers the natives fled in haste, leaving behind them several prisoners whom they were preparing to devour. The sailors searched the houses, and found both leg and arm bones, heads so newly cut off that the blood was still moist, and other human remains, which left no doubt as to the food consumed by these Caribbees. This island, which, with its principal rivers, the admiral caused to be partially explored, was named Guadaloupe, on account of the resemblance it bore to one of the Spanish provinces. Some Indian women were carried off by the sailors, but, after having been kindly treated on board the admiral's ship, they were sent back to land, Columbus hoping that this conduct towards the females would induce the men of the place to come on board, but in this he was disappointed.
The Spaniards, well-armed, landed on the shore, where they found about thirty circular houses made of wood and covered with palm leaves. Inside the huts were hammocks made of cotton hanging up. In the center of the village were two trees or posts entwined with the dead bodies of two snakes. When the strangers approached, the natives quickly fled, leaving behind several prisoners they were getting ready to eat. The sailors searched the houses and found leg and arm bones, heads that had just been severed with blood still fresh, and other human remains, confirming what these Caribbeans had been eating. This island, which the admiral had partially explored along with its main rivers, was named Guadaloupe because it resembled one of the Spanish provinces. Some Indian women were taken by the sailors, but after being treated kindly aboard the admiral's ship, they were sent back to land, hoping that this would encourage the local men to come on board, though he was disappointed in that expectation.
![]() |
The sailors find some recently-severed heads. |
On the 8th of November the signal for departure was given, and the whole fleet sailed for Hispaniola, the present San Domingo, and the island upon which Columbus had left thirty-nine of the companions of his first voyage. In turning again towards the north, a large island was discovered, to which the natives who had been kept on board after having been saved from the jaws of the Caribbees, gave the name of Mandanino. They declared that it was inhabited only by women, and as Marco Polo had mentioned an Asiatic country which possessed an exclusively feminine population, Columbus was confirmed in the idea that he was sailing upon the coast of Asia. He felt a great desire to explore this island, but the contrary winds completely prevented his doing so. Thirty miles from thence an island was seen surrounded by high mountains; it received the name of Montserrat; on the next day another, which was called Santa-Maria la Rodonda; and on the day following two more islands, St. Martin and Santa Cruz.
On November 8th, the signal to set sail was given, and the entire fleet headed for Hispaniola, now known as San Domingo, where Columbus had left thirty-nine of his companions from his first journey. As they turned north again, they discovered a large island that the natives, who had been rescued from the Caribs and were onboard, called Mandanino. They claimed it was inhabited only by women, and since Marco Polo mentioned an Asian country with an all-female population, Columbus became even more convinced that he was navigating along the coast of Asia. He was eager to explore this island, but unfavorable winds completely prevented him from doing so. Thirty miles away, they spotted another island surrounded by tall mountains, which was named Montserrat. The next day, they discovered another island called Santa Maria la Rodonda, and the following day, they found two more islands: St. Martin and Santa Cruz.
The squadron anchored before Santa Cruz, to take in water. There occurred a scene of grave import, reported by Peter Martyr in such expressive words, that we cannot do better than quote them: "The admiral," he says, "ordered thirty men from his ship to go ashore and explore the island; and these men, being landed on the coast, were aware of four dogs and as many young men and women coming towards them, extending their arms in supplication, and praying for help and deliverance from the cruel people. The cannibals on seeing this fled, as in the island of Guadaloupe, and all retired into the forests. And our people remained two days on the island to visit it.
The squadron anchored off Santa Cruz to take on water. A significant event occurred, reported by Peter Martyr in such vivid terms that we should quote him directly: "The admiral," he says, "ordered thirty men from his ship to go ashore and explore the island; and when these men landed on the coast, they saw four dogs and several young men and women coming towards them, raising their arms in plea and praying for help and rescue from the cruel people. The cannibals, upon seeing this, fled, just like in the island of Guadaloupe, retreating into the forests. Our people stayed on the island for two days to explore it."
"During that time, those who had remained with the boat saw a canoe coming towards them from a distance, containing eight men and as many women; to these our people made signs; but they on approaching, began to transpierce ours with their arrows, before they had time to cover themselves with their bucklers, so that one Spaniard was killed by a shaft aimed by a woman, who also transfixed another with a second arrow. These savages had poisoned arrows, the poison being contained in the tip; amongst them was a woman whom all the others obeyed, bowing before her. And this was, as they conjectured, a queen, having a son of cruel appearance, robust, and with the face of a lion, who followed her.
"At that time, those who stayed with the boat saw a canoe coming toward them from a distance, carrying eight men and as many women; our people signaled to them, but as they got closer, they started shooting arrows at us before we had a chance to defend ourselves with our shields. One Spaniard was killed by an arrow shot by a woman, who also hit another with a second arrow. These natives had poisoned arrows, with the poison placed at the tip; among them was a woman whom everyone else obeyed, bowing to her. They guessed that she was a queen, accompanied by a son who looked cruel, strong, and had the face of a lion."
"Ours then, considering that it was better to fight hand to hand, than to wait for greater evils in thus fighting at a distance, advanced their boat by rowing, and by so great violence did they make it move forward, that the stern of the said boat came with such velocity, it caused the enemies' canoe to founder.
"Ours then, thinking it was better to fight up close than to wait for worse problems while fighting from a distance, pushed their boat forward by rowing, and with such force did they propel it that the back of the boat moved with such speed it caused the enemies' canoe to sink."
"But these Indians, being very good swimmers, without moving themselves either more slowly or more rapidly, did not cease, both men and women, to shoot arrows with all their might, at our people. And they succeeded in reaching, by swimming, a rock covered with the water, upon which they mounted, and still fought manfully. Nevertheless, they were finally taken, and one of them slain, and the son of the queen, pierced in two places; when they were taken to the admiral's ship they showed no less ferociousness and atrocity of mien, than if they had been lions of Libya who felt themselves taken in the net. And such were they that no man could have even looked upon them without his heart trembling with horror, so greatly was their look hideous, terrible, and infernal."
"But these Indians, being excellent swimmers, without changing their speed, didn’t stop, both men and women, from shooting arrows at our people with all their strength. They managed to swim to a rock that was partly submerged, onto which they climbed, still fighting bravely. However, they were eventually captured, and one of them was killed, while the queen's son was injured in two places. When they were brought to the admiral's ship, they displayed no less ferocity and aggression than if they were lions from Libya caught in a net. They were so fearsome that no one could look at them without feeling a chill of horror, as their appearance was hideous, terrifying, and hellish."
From all this it is clear that the strife between the Indians and the Europeans was beginning to be serious. Columbus sailed again towards the north, going in the midst of islands "pleasant and innumerable," covered with forests overshadowed by mountains of various hues. This collection of islands was called the Archipelago of the Eleven Thousand Virgins. Soon appeared the island of St. John Baptist (now Porto Rico), a place infested by Caribbees, but cultivated with care, and appearing truly superb from its immense woods. Some sailors landed upon the shore, but only found there a dozen uninhabited huts. The admiral put to sea again, and sailed along the southern coast of Porto Rico for about one hundred and fifty miles.
From all this, it’s clear that the conflict between the Native Americans and the Europeans was starting to get serious. Columbus sailed north again, passing through countless beautiful islands, lush with forests and overshadowed by mountains in various colors. This group of islands was called the Archipelago of the Eleven Thousand Virgins. Soon, he spotted the island of St. John Baptist (now Puerto Rico), a place plagued by Caribs, but well-cultivated and truly impressive because of its vast forests. Some sailors went ashore but found only a few uninhabited huts. The admiral set sail again, cruising along the southern coast of Puerto Rico for about one hundred and fifty miles.
On Friday, the 12th of November, Columbus at last reached the island of Hispaniola. With what emotions must he not have been agitated in revisiting the theatre of his first success, in seeking to behold that fortress in which he had left his companions! What might not have happened in the course of a year to those Europeans left alone in this barbarous land? Soon a great canoe, bringing the brother of the Cacique Guacanagari, came alongside of the Marie-Galante, and the Indian prince springing on board, offered two images of gold to the admiral. Still Columbus sought for his fortress, but, although he had anchored opposite its site, there was no trace whatever to be seen of it. With feelings of the deepest anxiety as to the fate of his companions, he went on shore. What was his dismay, when he found nothing left of the fortress but a few ashes! What could have become of his compatriots? Had their lives been the forfeit of this first attempt at colonization? The admiral ordered the simultaneous discharge of the cannon from all the ships to announce his arrival at Hispaniola. But none of his companions appeared. Columbus, in despair, immediately despatched messengers to the Cacique Guacanagari; who, on their return brought sad news. If Guacanagari might be believed, some other caciques, irritated by the presence of the foreigners in their island, had attacked the unfortunate colonists, and had massacred them to the last man. Guacanagari himself had received a wound in endeavouring to defend them, and to corroborate his story he showed his leg enveloped in a cotton bandage.
On Friday, November 12th, Columbus finally arrived at the island of Hispaniola. Imagine the emotions he must have felt revisiting the place of his first achievement, eager to see the fort where he had left his crew! What could have happened to those Europeans left alone in this wild land over the past year? Soon, a large canoe approached the Marie-Galante, and the brother of Cacique Guacanagari jumped aboard, offering the admiral two gold figurines. Columbus continued searching for his fort, but even though he anchored right across from where it used to be, there was no sign of it. Filled with deep anxiety about his friends' fate, he went ashore. He was horrified to discover that all that remained of the fort was a few ashes! What had happened to his fellow countrymen? Had they lost their lives during this first attempt at colonization? The admiral ordered all the ships to fire their cannons simultaneously to announce his arrival in Hispaniola. But none of his companions came forward. In despair, Columbus quickly sent messengers to Cacique Guacanagari, who brought back heartbreaking news. If Guacanagari was to be believed, some other chiefs, angered by the presence of foreigners on their island, had attacked the unfortunate colonists and killed them all. Guacanagari himself had been wounded while trying to protect them, and to prove his story, he showed his leg wrapped in a cotton bandage.
Columbus did not believe in this intervention of the cacique, but, resolving to dissimulate, he welcomed Guacanagari kindly when he came on board the next day; the cacique accepted an image of the Virgin, suspending it on his bosom. He appeared astonished at the sight of the horses which they showed him, these animals having been hitherto quite unknown to himself and his companions. When his visit was over, he returned to the shore, regained the region of mountains, and was seen no more.
Columbus didn’t trust the cacique’s interference, but deciding to play along, he warmly welcomed Guacanagari when he came on board the next day. The cacique accepted a statue of the Virgin, hanging it around his neck. He seemed amazed by the horses they showed him, as he and his companions had never seen such animals before. After his visit, he went back to the shore, returned to the mountains, and was never seen again.
The admiral then despatched one of his captains with three hundred men under his orders, to scour the country and carry off the cacique. This captain penetrated far into the interior, but found no traces of the cacique, nor of the unfortunate colonists. During this excursion, a great river was discovered, and also a fine sheltered harbour, which was named Port Royal. However, in spite of the bad success of his first attempt, Columbus had resolved to found a new colony upon this island, which appeared to be rich both in gold and silver. The natives constantly spoke of mines situated in the province of Cibao, and in the month of January two gentlemen, Alonzo de Hojeda and Corvalan, set out accompanied by a numerous escort to verify these assertions. They discovered four rivers having auriferous sands, and brought back with them a nugget which weighed nine ounces. The admiral on seeing these riches was confirmed in his idea that Hispaniola was the famous Ophir, spoken of in the Book of Kings. After looking for a site upon which to build a town, he laid the foundation of Isabella in a spot at the mouth of a river which formed a harbour, and at a distance of thirty miles east from Monte Christi. On the Feast of the Epiphany, thirteen priests officiated in the church in presence of an immense crowd of natives.
The admiral then sent one of his captains with three hundred men to explore the area and capture the cacique. This captain ventured deep into the interior but found no signs of the cacique or the unfortunate colonists. During this expedition, they discovered a large river and a great sheltered harbor, which was named Port Royal. However, despite the poor outcome of his first attempt, Columbus was determined to establish a new colony on this island, which seemed rich in gold and silver. The natives frequently mentioned mines located in the province of Cibao, and in January, two gentlemen, Alonzo de Hojeda and Corvalan, set out with a large escort to confirm these claims. They found four rivers with gold-bearing sands and returned with a nugget weighing nine ounces. When the admiral saw these riches, he became convinced that Hispaniola was the legendary Ophir mentioned in the Book of Kings. After searching for a location to build a town, he laid the foundation for Isabella at the mouth of a river that formed a harbor, about thirty miles east of Monte Christi. On the Feast of the Epiphany, thirteen priests conducted a service in the church in front of a huge crowd of natives.
Columbus was now anxious to send news of the colony to the King and Queen of Spain. Twelve ships laden with gold collected in the island, and with various specimens of the produce of the soil, were prepared to return to Europe under the command of Captain Torrès. This flotilla set sail on the 2nd of February, 1494, and a short time afterwards Columbus sent back one more of the five ships which remained to him, with the Lieutenant Bernard of Pisa, against whom he had cause of complaint.
Columbus was now eager to send updates about the colony to the King and Queen of Spain. Twelve ships filled with gold collected from the island and various samples of the local produce were readied to return to Europe under Captain Torrès. This fleet set sail on February 2, 1494, and shortly after, Columbus sent back one more of the five ships he had left, with Lieutenant Bernard of Pisa, whom he had grievances against.
As soon as order was established in the colony of Isabella, the admiral, leaving his brother behind as governor, set out, accompanied by five hundred men, to visit the mines of Cibao. The country they traversed seemed to be splendidly fertile; vegetables came to perfection in thirteen days; corn sown in February was in full ear in April, and each year yielded two abundant harvests. They crossed successively mountains and valleys, where often the pick-axe had to be used to clear a way over these still virgin lands; at last the Spaniards arrived at Cibao. There the admiral caused a fort to be constructed of wood and stone on a hill near the brink of a large river; it was surrounded with a deep ditch, and Columbus bestowed upon it the name of St. Thomas, in derision of some of his officers who were incredulous upon the subject of the gold-mines. It ill became them to doubt, for from all parts the natives brought nuggets and gold dust, which they were eager to exchange for beads, and above all for the hawks' bells, of which the silvery sound excited them to dance. This country was not only a land of gold, it was also a country rich in spices and aromatic gums, the trees which bore them forming quite large forests. The Spaniards considered the conquest of this wealthy island a cause of unmixed congratulation.
As soon as order was established in the colony of Isabella, the admiral, leaving his brother behind as governor, set out with five hundred men to visit the Cibao mines. The territory they traveled through appeared to be incredibly fertile; vegetables reached maturity in just thirteen days; corn planted in February was ready for harvest in April, resulting in two plentiful harvests each year. They moved through mountains and valleys, often needing to use pickaxes to clear paths in these untouched lands; eventually, the Spaniards reached Cibao. There, the admiral had a fort built of wood and stone on a hill near the edge of a large river; it was surrounded by a deep ditch, and Columbus named it St. Thomas, mocking some skeptical officers regarding the gold mines. They had no reason to doubt, as the natives from all around brought nuggets and gold dust, eager to trade for beads, especially the hawks' bells, whose silvery sound made them dance. This region was not only a land of gold but also rich in spices and aromatic gums, with large forests of trees that produced them. The Spaniards viewed the conquest of this wealthy island as a reason for unqualified celebration.
Columbus left fifty-six men to guard the Fort of St. Thomas, under the command of Don Pedro de Margarita, while he returned to Isabella, towards the beginning of April, being much hindered on the road by excessive rain. On his arrival he found the infant colony in great disorder; famine was threatening from the want of flour, which could not be obtained, for there were no mills; both soldiers and workmen were exhausted with fatigue. Columbus sought to oblige the gentlemen to aid them; but these proud Hidalgos, anxious as they were to conquer fortune, would not stoop to pick it up, and refused to perform any manual labour. The priests upholding them in this conduct, Columbus, who was forced to act with vigour, was obliged to place the churches under an interdict. He could not spare time to remain any longer at Isabella, but was in haste to make further discoveries; therefore, having formed a council, composed of three gentlemen and the chief of the missionaries, under the presidency of Don Diego, to govern the colony, he set out on the 24th of April with three vessels, to complete the cycle of his discoveries.
Columbus left fifty-six men to guard Fort St. Thomas, led by Don Pedro de Margarita, while he returned to Isabella at the beginning of April, significantly delayed by heavy rain. When he arrived, he found the struggling colony in chaos; they were facing famine due to a lack of flour, which was unavailable because there were no mills. Both the soldiers and laborers were worn out from fatigue. Columbus tried to urge the gentlemen to help, but these proud Hidalgos, eager to find their fortunes, refused to do any manual labor. The priests supported their stance, and Columbus, needing to take decisive action, had to place the churches under interdict. He couldn't afford to stay any longer in Isabella, as he was eager to make more discoveries. So, he formed a council made up of three gentlemen and the head of the missionaries, led by Don Diego, to govern the colony and set out on April 24th with three ships to continue his explorations.
The flotilla sailing towards the south, a new island was soon discovered, which was called by the natives Jamaica. The highest point of the island was a mountain of which the sides sloped gently down. The inhabitants appeared clever, and much given to the mechanical arts, but they were far from pacific in character, and several times opposed the landing of the Spaniards, who, however, repulsed them, and at length the savages were induced to conclude a treaty of alliance with the admiral. From Jamaica Columbus pushed his researches more towards the west. He imagined himself to be arrived at the point where the old geographers placed the golden region of the west, Chersonesus. Strong currents carried him towards Cuba, along whose coast he sailed for a distance of six hundred and sixty-six miles. During this dangerous navigation amongst shallows and narrow passages, he named more than seven hundred islands, discovered a great number of harbours, and often entered into communication with the natives.
The flotilla sailing south soon discovered a new island called Jamaica by the locals. The highest point of the island was a gently sloping mountain. The inhabitants seemed intelligent and skilled in crafts, but they were far from peaceful in nature, often trying to block the Spaniards from landing. However, the Spaniards managed to push them back, and eventually, the natives agreed to form an alliance with the admiral. From Jamaica, Columbus continued his exploration westward. He believed he had reached the location where ancient geographers had placed the golden region of the west, Chersonesus. Strong currents carried him toward Cuba, along whose coast he sailed for about six hundred and sixty-six miles. During this perilous journey through shallow waters and narrow passages, he named more than seven hundred islands, discovered numerous harbors, and frequently interacted with the locals.
![]() |
Fishermen on the coast of Cuba. |
In the month of May, the look-out-men on board the ships descried a large number of grassy islands, fertile and inhabited. Columbus, on approaching the shore, entered a river, of which the water was so warm that the hand could not remain in it, a fact evidently of exaggeration, and one which later researches have not authenticated. The fishermen of this coast employed a certain fish called the Remora or sucking-fish, "which fulfilled for them the same office as the dog does for the hunter. This fish was of an unknown species, having a body like a great eel, and upon the back of his head a very tenacious skin, in fashion like a purse, wherewith to take the fishes. They keep this fish fastened by a cord to the boat, always in the water, for it cannot bear the look of the air. And when they see a fish or a turtle, which there are larger than great bucklers, then they loose the fish by slackening the rope. And when he feels himself at liberty, suddenly, and more rapidly than the flight of an arrow, he (the remora) assails the said fish or turtle, throws over him his skin in the manner of a purse, and holds his prey so firmly, be it fish or turtle, by the part visible beyond the shell, that none can wrest it from him, if he be not drawn to the surface of the water; the cord is therefore pulled up, and gathered in little by little; and no sooner does he see the splendour of the air, than incontinent he lets go of his prey. And the fishermen descend as far as is necessary to take the prey, and they put it on board the boat, and fasten the fish-hunter with as much of rope as is necessary for him to regain his old position and place; then, by means of another rope, they give him for reward a small piece of the flesh of his prey."
In May, the lookout men on the ships spotted a lot of grassy islands that were fertile and inhabited. As Columbus approached the shore, he entered a river with water so warm that you couldn't keep your hand in it, although this claim has been considered exaggerated and hasn’t been confirmed by later research. The fishermen along this coast used a fish called the Remora or sucking-fish, which served them like a dog serves a hunter. This fish was an unknown species, resembling a large eel, with a tough skin on the back of its head shaped like a purse, which it used to catch other fish. They kept this fish attached by a cord to the boat, always submerged because it couldn't tolerate being in the air. When they spotted a fish or a turtle, which were sometimes bigger than large shields, they would loosen the fish by letting out some of the rope. Once it felt free, it would dart out faster than an arrow, attack the fish or turtle, wrap its skin around it like a purse, and hold onto its catch so tightly that it couldn’t be pulled away unless it was brought to the surface. They would then pull up the cord gradually, and as soon as the Remora saw the light of the air, it would release its catch. The fishermen would dive down as needed to retrieve the catch and place it on the boat, and they would secure the fish-hunter with just enough rope for it to return to its previous spot. As a reward, they would give it a small piece of the flesh from its prey using another rope.
The exploration of the coasts continued towards the west. The admiral visited several countries, in which abounded goslings, ducks, herons, and those dumb dogs which the natives eat, as we should kids, and which were probably either almigui or racoons. As the ships advanced, the sandy channels became narrower and narrower, and navigation more and more difficult, but the admiral adhered to his resolution of continuing the exploration of these coasts. One day, he imagined he saw upon a point of land some men dressed in white, whom he took for brothers of the order of Santa Maria de la Merced; he sent some sailors to open communication with them, when it proved to be simply an optical illusion; these so-called monks turning out to be great tropical herons, to whom distance had lent the appearance of human beings.
The exploration of the coasts continued westward. The admiral visited several countries, where there were plenty of goslings, ducks, herons, and those mute dogs that the locals ate, just like we eat kids, which were probably either raccoons or another type of animal. As the ships moved forward, the sandy channels got narrower and narrower, making navigation increasingly difficult, but the admiral remained determined to keep exploring these coasts. One day, he thought he saw some men dressed in white on a piece of land, whom he believed were brothers of the order of Santa Maria de la Merced; he sent some sailors to make contact with them, but it turned out to be just an optical illusion; these so-called monks were actually large tropical herons, which from a distance looked like humans.
During the first days of June, Columbus was obliged to stop to repair the ships, of which the keels were much damaged by the shallow water on the coast. On the seventh day of the month he caused a solemn mass to be celebrated on the shore: during the service an old cacique arrived, who, the ceremony being over, offered the admiral some fruits, and then this native sovereign pronounced some words which the interpreters thus translated:—
During the first days of June, Columbus had to stop to fix the ships, which had suffered significant damage to their keels from the shallow water along the coast. On the seventh day of the month, he arranged for a solemn mass to be held on the shore. After the service, an old cacique arrived who, once the ceremony was over, offered the admiral some fruits. Then, this native leader said a few words that the interpreters translated as follows:—
"It hath been told us after what manner thou hast invested and enveloped with thy power these lands, which were to you unknown, and how thy presence has caused great terror to the people and the inhabitants. But I hold it my duty to exhort and to warn thee that two roads present themselves before the souls, when they are separated from the bodies: the one, filled with shadows and sadness destined for those who are harmful and hurtful to the human species; the other, pleasant and delightful, reserved for those who in their life-time have loved peace and the repose of the people. Therefore, if thou rememberest that thou art mortal, and that the future retribution will be meted out according to the works of the present life, thou wilt take care to do harm to nobody." What philosopher of ancient or modern time could have spoken better or in sounder language! All the human side of Christianity is expressed in these magnificent words, and they came from the mouth of a savage! Columbus and the cacique separated, charmed with one another, and the more astonished of the two was not, perhaps, the old native. The rest of his tribe appeared to live in the practice of the excellent precepts indicated by their chief. Land was common property amongst the natives, as much so as sun, air, and water. The Meum and Tuum, cause of all strife, did not exist amongst them, and they lived content with little. "They enjoy the Golden Age," says the narrative, "they protect not their possessions with ditches and hedges, they leave their gardens open; without laws, without books, without judges, they by nature follow what is right, and hold as bad and unjust whatever sins against, or causes harm to another."
"It has been said how you have invested and surrounded these lands, which were unknown to you, with your power, and how your presence has instilled great fear in the people and the inhabitants. But I feel it is my duty to advise and warn you that there are two paths that souls face when they are separated from their bodies: one, filled with shadows and sadness, meant for those who are harmful and hurtful to humanity; the other, pleasant and delightful, reserved for those who have loved peace and the well-being of others in their lifetime. So, if you remember that you are mortal, and that future consequences will be based on the actions of this life, you will be careful not to harm anyone." What philosopher, ancient or modern, could have spoken better or more wisely! The human side of Christianity is summed up in these magnificent words, and they came from the mouth of a savage! Columbus and the cacique parted, both impressed with one another, and perhaps it was the old native who was more astonished. The rest of his tribe seemed to live according to the excellent principles outlined by their chief. Land was shared equally among the natives, just like the sun, air, and water. The concepts of 'mine' and 'yours,' the source of all conflict, did not exist among them, and they lived content with little. "They enjoy the Golden Age," the narrative states, "they don’t defend their possessions with ditches and hedges, they keep their gardens open; without laws, without books, without judges, they naturally follow what is right and view as bad and unjust anything that harms another."
Leaving Cuba, Columbus returned towards Jamaica, and sailed along the whole of the southern coast as far as the eastern extremity of the island. His intention was to attack the islands of the Caribbees, and destroy that mischievous brood. But the admiral was at this time seized with an illness, brought on by watching and fatigue, which obliged him to suspend his projects. He was forced to return to Isabella, where, under the influence of good air and repose, and the care of his brother and his friends, he recovered his health. The colony greatly needed his presence. The governor of St. Thomas had aroused the indignation of the natives by his cruel exactions, and had refused to listen to the remonstrances upon the subject addressed to him by Don Diego, the brother of Columbus; he had returned to Isabella from St. Thomas during the absence of the admiral and he embarked for Spain upon one of the ships which had just brought Don Bartolomeo, the second brother of Columbus, to Hispaniola. When the admiral regained his health he resolved to punish the cacique who had revolted against the governor of St. Thomas, feeling that it would be unwise to allow his authority, in the person of his delegates, to be set at nought. In the first place he sent nine men well armed to take prisoner a bold cacique named Caonabo. The leader Hojeda, with an intrepidity of which we shall have further instances in the future, carried off the cacique from the midst of his own people, and brought him prisoner to Isabella. Columbus afterwards sent Caonabo to Europe, but the ship in which he sailed was wrecked during the voyage, and he was never heard of more.
Leaving Cuba, Columbus headed back toward Jamaica and sailed along the entire southern coast until he reached the eastern end of the island. His plan was to attack the Caribbean islands and wipe out that troublesome group. However, the admiral became ill due to stress and fatigue, which forced him to pause his plans. He had to return to Isabella, where, thanks to the good air, rest, and care from his brother and friends, he regained his health. The colony greatly needed him. The governor of St. Thomas had angered the locals with his harsh demands and ignored the complaints from Don Diego, Columbus's brother. He had come back to Isabella from St. Thomas while the admiral was away and boarded one of the ships that had just brought Don Bartolomeo, Columbus's second brother, to Hispaniola. Once Columbus was well again, he decided to punish the cacique who had revolted against the governor of St. Thomas, believing it would be unwise to let his authority be challenged in the person of his representatives. First, he sent nine armed men to capture a daring cacique named Caonabo. The leader, Hojeda, displayed a bravery we will see more of later as he seized Caonabo from his people and brought him back to Isabella as a prisoner. Columbus later sent Caonabo to Europe, but the ship he was on sank during the journey, and he was never heard from again.
In the meantime, Antonio de Torrès, sent by the King and Queen of Spain to compliment Columbus in their names, arrived at San Domingo with four vessels. Ferdinand declared himself highly content with the successes of the admiral, and informed him that he was about to establish a monthly service of transport between Spain and Hispaniola.
In the meantime, Antonio de Torrès, sent by the King and Queen of Spain to congratulate Columbus on their behalf, arrived at San Domingo with four ships. Ferdinand expressed his great satisfaction with the admiral's successes and informed him that he was about to set up a monthly transportation service between Spain and Hispaniola.
The carrying off of Caonabo had excited a general revolt amongst the natives, who burned to revenge the chief, so deeply insulted and unjustly carried away. The Cacique Guacanagari, notwithstanding the share he had had in the murder of the first colonists, alone remained faithful to the Spaniards. Columbus, accompanied by his brother Bartolomeo and the cacique, marched against the rebels and soon met with an army of natives, the numbers of which, with manifest exaggeration, he places at 100,000 men. However numerous it may have been, this army was quickly routed by a small detachment, composed of 200 infantry, twenty-five cavalry, and twenty-five dogs. This victory to all appearance re-established the admiral's authority. The Indians were condemned to pay tribute to the Spaniards, those living near the mines were ordered to furnish every three months a small quantity of gold, while the others, more distant, were to contribute twenty-five pounds of cotton. But rebellion had been only curbed, not extinguished. At the voice of a woman, Anacaona, widow of Caonabo, the natives rose a second time; and even succeeded in drawing over the hitherto faithful Guacanagari to their side; the rebels destroyed all the fields of maize, and everything else which had been planted, and then retired into the mountains. The Spaniards, seeing themselves thus reduced to all the horrors of famine, indulged their anger by terrible reprisals against the natives; it is calculated that one-third of the island population perished from hunger, sickness, and the weapons of the companions of Columbus. These unfortunate Indians paid dearly indeed for their intercourse with the conquering Europeans.
The capture of Caonabo had sparked a widespread revolt among the natives, who were eager to avenge the chief, so deeply insulted and unjustly taken away. The Cacique Guacanagari, despite his involvement in the murder of the first colonists, remained loyal to the Spaniards. Columbus, along with his brother Bartolomeo and the cacique, marched against the rebels and soon encountered an army of natives, which he exaggeratedly claimed numbered 100,000. Regardless of its actual size, this army was quickly defeated by a small group consisting of 200 infantry, 25 cavalry, and 25 dogs. This victory seemingly restored the admiral's authority. The Indians were forced to pay tribute to the Spaniards; those living near the mines were ordered to provide a small amount of gold every three months, while others, farther away, were to supply 25 pounds of cotton. However, the rebellion was only suppressed, not completely extinguished. At the urging of a woman, Anacaona, the widow of Caonabo, the natives rose up again and even managed to sway the previously loyal Guacanagari to their side. The rebels destroyed all the corn fields and everything else that had been planted before retreating to the mountains. The Spaniards, now facing the horrors of famine, took out their anger on the natives with terrible reprisals; it is estimated that one-third of the island's population perished from hunger, disease, and the weapons of Columbus's men. These unfortunate Indians paid a steep price for their interactions with the conquering Europeans.
The good fortune of Columbus was by this time on the wane. While his authority in Hispaniola was continually more and more compromised, his reputation and his character were the objects of violent attack in Europe. The officers whom he had sent back to the mother country, loudly accused him of injustice and cruelty; they even insinuated that he sought to render himself independent of the king; and against all these attacks, Columbus, being absent, could not defend himself. Ferdinand, influenced by this unworthy discourse, chose a commissioner, whom he ordered to proceed to the West Indies and to examine into the truth of the accusations. This gentleman was named Juan d'Aguado, and the choice of such a man to fulfil such a mission, possessing as he did a mind both prejudiced and partial, was not a happy one. Aguado arrived at Isabella in the month of October, at the time when the admiral was absent on an exploring expedition, and began at once to treat the brother of Columbus with extreme haughtiness, while Diego on his side, relying upon his title of governor-general, refused to submit to the commands of the royal commissioner. Aguado soon considered himself ready to return to Spain, although the examination he had made was a most incomplete one, when a fearful hurricane occurred, which sank the vessels which had brought him over in the harbour. There now remained only two caravels at Hispaniola, but Columbus, who had returned to the colony, acting with a greatness of soul which cannot be too much admired, placed one of these ships at the disposal of the commissioner, with the proviso that he himself would embark in the other, to plead his cause in person before the king.
The good luck of Columbus was starting to fade. As his power in Hispaniola continued to be undermined, his reputation and character faced fierce attacks in Europe. The officers he had sent back to Spain loudly accused him of injustice and cruelty, even implying that he was trying to make himself independent from the king. Columbus, being away, couldn’t defend himself against these accusations. Ferdinand, swayed by this unworthy talk, chose a commissioner to go to the West Indies and investigate the claims. This man was named Juan d'Aguado, and it was not a wise choice to send someone with a biased and partial mindset to carry out such a mission. Aguado arrived at Isabella in October, while the admiral was away on an exploration, and immediately began to treat Columbus's brother with great arrogance. Diego, for his part, relying on his title as governor-general, refused to obey the commands of the royal commissioner. Aguado soon decided he was ready to return to Spain, even though his investigation was very incomplete, when a terrible hurricane hit and sank the ships that had brought him over in the harbor. Only two caravels were left in Hispaniola, but Columbus, having returned to the colony, acted with a nobility that deserves admiration. He offered one of these ships to the commissioner, on the condition that he would take the other ship himself to personally plead his case before the king.
So matters stood, when the news arriving of the discovery of fresh gold-mines in Hispaniola, caused the admiral to put off his departure. Covetousness was a power strong enough to cut short all discussions; there was no longer any mention of the King of Spain, nor of the inquiry which he had ordered; officers were sent off to the new auriferous ground, finding there nuggets of which some weighed as much as twenty ounces, and a lump of amber of the weight of 300 pounds. Columbus ordered two fortresses to be erected for the protection of the miners, one on the boundary of the province of Cibao, the other upon the banks of the River Hayna. Having taken this precaution, he set out for Europe, full of eagerness to justify himself. The two caravels sailed from the harbour of St. Isabella on the 10th of March, 1496. On board of the admiral's ship were 225 persons and thirty Indians. On the 9th of April he touched at Marie-Galante, and on the 10th at Guadaloupe, to take in water; here there occurred a sharp skirmish with the natives. On the 20th he left this inhospitable island, and for a whole month he had to contend with contrary winds. On the 11th of June land was sighted in Europe, and on the next day the caravels entered the harbour of Cadiz.
So, things were as they were when news came in about the discovery of new gold mines in Hispaniola, which made the admiral postpone his departure. Greed was strong enough to end all discussions; there was no more talk of the King of Spain or the inquiry he had ordered. Officers were dispatched to the new gold-rich area, where they found nuggets weighing as much as twenty ounces and a lump of amber that weighed 300 pounds. Columbus ordered two forts to be built for protecting the miners, one at the boundary of the province of Cibao and the other along the banks of the River Hayna. After taking this precaution, he set off for Europe, eager to clear his name. The two caravels sailed from the harbor of St. Isabella on March 10, 1496. On board the admiral's ship were 225 people and thirty Indians. On April 9, he stopped at Marie-Galante and on April 10 at Guadaloupe to pick up water; there, a sharp skirmish broke out with the locals. On April 20, he left that hostile island, and for a whole month, he had to deal with headwinds. On June 11, land was spotted in Europe, and the next day, the caravels entered the harbor of Cadiz.
This second return of the great navigator was not welcomed, as the first had been, by the acclamations of the populace. To enthusiasm had succeeded coldness and envy; the companions even of the admiral took part against him. Discouraged as they were, with illusions destroyed, and not bringing back that wealth, for the acquisition of which they had encountered so many dangers, and submitted to so much fatigue, they became unjust, and forgot that it was not the fault of Columbus if the mines hitherto worked had been a source of expense rather than of profit.
This second return of the great navigator wasn't welcomed like the first one had been, with cheers from the crowd. Instead, there was coldness and jealousy; even the admiral's companions turned against him. Feeling discouraged, their dreams shattered, and without the riches they had risked so much to find, they became unfair and overlooked that it wasn't Columbus's fault that the mines they had worked were a source of expenses rather than profit.
However, the admiral was received at court with a certain measure of favour, the narrative of his second voyage doing much to reinstate him in public opinion. And who could deny that during that expedition he had discovered the islands of Dominica, Marie-Galante, Guadaloupe, Montserrat, Santa-Maria, Santa Cruz, Porto Rico, Jamaica? Had he not also carried out a new survey of Cuba and San Domingo? Columbus fought bravely against his adversaries, even employing against them the weapon of irony. To those who denied the merit of his discoveries, he proposed the experiment of making an egg remain upright while resting upon one end, and when they could not succeed in doing this, the admiral, breaking the top of the shell, made the egg stand upon the broken part. "You had not thought of that," said he; "but behold! it is done."
However, the admiral was welcomed at court with some favor, as the story of his second voyage helped to restore his reputation. And who could argue that during that trip he discovered the islands of Dominica, Marie-Galante, Guadeloupe, Montserrat, Santa-Maria, Santa Cruz, Puerto Rico, and Jamaica? Had he not also conducted a new survey of Cuba and Santo Domingo? Columbus bravely fought against his critics, even using irony as a weapon. To those who questioned the value of his discoveries, he suggested the challenge of making an egg stand upright on one end, and when they failed to do it, the admiral, by breaking the top of the shell, made the egg stand on the broken part. "You hadn’t thought of that," he said; "but look! It’s done."
CHRISTOPHER COLUMBUS.
Third Voyage: Madeira—Santiago in the Cape Verd Archipelago—Trinidad—First sight of the American Coast in Venezuela, beyond the Orinoco, now the Province of Cumana—Gulf of Paria—The Gardens—Tobago—Grenada—Margarita—Cubaga—Hispaniola during the absence of Columbus—Foundation of the town of San Domingo—Arrival of Columbus—Insubordination in the Colony—Complaints in Spain—Bovadilla sent by the king to inquire into the conduct of Columbus—Columbus sent to Europe in fetters with his two brothers—His appearance before Ferdinand and Isabella—Renewal of royal favour.
Third Voyage: Madeira—Santiago in the Cape Verde Archipelago—Trinidad—First sight of the American coast in Venezuela, beyond the Orinoco, now the Province of Cumana—Gulf of Paria—The Gardens—Tobago—Grenada—Margarita—Cubaga—Hispaniola during Columbus's absence—Foundation of the town of San Domingo—Columbus's arrival—Rebellion in the colony—Complaints in Spain—Bovadilla sent by the king to investigate Columbus's actions—Columbus sent to Europe in chains with his two brothers—His appearance before Ferdinand and Isabella—Restoration of royal favor.
Columbus had not yet given up the hope of pursuing his conquests on the further side of the Atlantic Ocean. No fatigue, no injustice from his fellow-men could stop him. After having triumphed, although not without difficulty, over the malice of his enemies, he succeeded in organizing a third expedition under the auspices of the Spanish government. The king granted him eight vessels, forty cavalry soldiers, and one hundred infantry, sixty sailors, twenty miners, fifty labourers, twenty workmen of various trades, thirty women, some doctors, and even some musicians. The admiral obtained the concession besides, that all the punishments in use in Spain should be changed into transportation to the islands. He was thus the precursor of the English in the intelligent idea of peopling new colonies with convicts, whom labour was to reform.
Columbus still had hopes of continuing his conquests on the other side of the Atlantic Ocean. No exhaustion or unfair treatment from others could deter him. After overcoming the hostility of his enemies, he managed to organize a third expedition with the support of the Spanish government. The king provided him with eight ships, forty cavalry soldiers, one hundred infantry, sixty sailors, twenty miners, fifty laborers, twenty skilled workers, thirty women, some doctors, and even a few musicians. The admiral also secured the agreement that all punishments in Spain would be replaced with transportation to the islands. In this way, he was a pioneer for the English in the smart idea of populating new colonies with convicts, whom hard work was meant to reform.
![]() |
Embarkation of Christopher Columbus. |
Columbus put to sea on the 30th of May, 1498, although he was still suffering from gout, and from the various mental trials which he had experienced since his return. Before starting, he learnt that a French fleet was lying in wait off Cape St. Vincent, with the purpose of hindering the expedition. To avoid it, Columbus made for Madeira, and anchored there; from that island he dispatched all his vessels, except three, to Hispaniola under the command of the Captains Pedro de Arana, Alonzo Sanchez of Carabajal, and Juan Antonio Columbus, one of his own relations, while he, with a large ship and two caravels bore down to the south with the intention of crossing the equator, and seeking for more southern countries, which, according to the general opinion, must be even richer in all kinds of productions. On the 27th of June the small flotilla touched at the islands of Sel and of Santiago, which form part of the Cape Verd group. It sailed again on the 4th of July, and made 360 miles to the south-west, experiencing long calms and intense heat; on arriving abreast of Sierra Leone, it steered due west, and at mid-day on the 31st of July, one of the sailors raised the cry of "land." It was an island situated at the north-eastern extremity of South America, and very near the coast. The admiral gave it the name of Trinidad, and all the crews chanted the Salve Regina in sign of thankfulness. On the morrow, the 1st of August, at fifteen miles from the part of the land which had been first seen, the three vessels were moored near to the Point of Alcatraz, and the admiral sent some of his sailors ashore to obtain water and wood. The coast appeared to be uninhabited, but numerous footprints of animals were observed, made, as was thought, by goats.
Columbus set sail on May 30, 1498, even though he was still dealing with gout and various mental challenges he had faced since returning. Before leaving, he found out that a French fleet was waiting off Cape St. Vincent to disrupt his expedition. To avoid them, Columbus headed for Madeira and anchored there. From that island, he sent all his ships except three to Hispaniola under the command of Captains Pedro de Arana, Alonzo Sanchez of Carabajal, and Juan Antonio Columbus, a relative of his. Meanwhile, he took a large ship and two caravels south, aiming to cross the equator and search for southern lands, which many believed would be even richer in resources. On June 27, the small fleet stopped at the islands of Sel and Santiago, part of the Cape Verde group. They sailed again on July 4, traveling 360 miles southwest while dealing with long periods of calm and intense heat. When they reached the Sierra Leone area, they turned due west, and at midday on July 31, one of the sailors cried out "land." It was an island located at the northeastern tip of South America, very close to the coast. The admiral named it Trinidad, and the crews sang the Salve Regina as a sign of gratitude. The next day, August 1, about fifteen miles from where they first spotted land, the three vessels anchored near Alcatraz Point. The admiral sent some of his sailors ashore to gather water and wood. The coast looked uninhabited, but they observed many animal footprints, which they believed were made by goats.
On the 2nd of August a long canoe, manned by twenty-four natives, came towards the ships. These Indians, tall of stature, and paler in colour than those of Hispaniola, wore upon the head a turban formed of a cotton scarf of brilliant colours, and a small skirt of the same material around the body. The Spaniards endeavoured to entice them on board, by showing them mirrors and glass trinkets; the sailors even executing lively dances, in the hope of inspiring them with confidence; but the savages, taking fright at the sound of a tambourine, which seemed to them a sign of hostility, discharged a flight of arrows, and directed their canoe towards one of the caravels, whose pilot endeavoured to reassure them by steering towards them; but in vain, the canoe soon made off, and was seen no more.
On August 2nd, a long canoe carrying twenty-four natives approached the ships. These Indians were taller and lighter-skinned than those from Hispaniola, wearing colorful cotton turbans and small skirts made of the same material. The Spaniards tried to entice them onboard by showing mirrors and glass trinkets. The sailors even performed lively dances to inspire confidence, but the natives got scared at the sound of a tambourine, which they saw as a sign of aggression. They shot a flurry of arrows and paddled their canoe towards one of the caravels, whose pilot tried to calm them by steering closer, but it was in vain; the canoe quickly left and was never seen again.
Columbus again set sail, and discovered a new island which he called Gracia; but what he imagined to be an island, was, in reality, a portion of the American coast, and that part of the shore of Venezuela, which, being intersected by the numerous branches of the Orinoco, forms the Delta of that river. On this day the Continent of America, although unknown to him, was really discovered by Christopher Columbus, in that part of Venezuela which goes by the name of the Province of Cumana. Between this coast and the Island of Trinidad there is a dangerous gulf, the Gulf of Paria, in which a ship can with difficulty resist the currents which flow towards the west with great rapidity. The admiral, who believed himself to be in the open sea, was exposed to great peril in this gulf, where the rivers, falling into the sea from the continent, and being swollen at that time by an accidental flood, poured great masses of water upon the ships. Columbus, in writing to the king and queen, describes this incident in the following terms:—
Columbus set sail again and discovered a new island that he named Gracia; however, what he thought was an island was actually a part of the American coast, specifically the section of Venezuela's shoreline that, intersected by the many branches of the Orinoco River, forms its Delta. On this day, although he didn't know it, Christopher Columbus actually discovered the continent of America in the area of Venezuela known as the Province of Cumana. Between this coast and the Island of Trinidad lies a dangerous gulf, the Gulf of Paria, where ships can struggle against the strong westward currents. The admiral, who believed he was in open sea, faced significant danger in this gulf, as the rivers flowing into the ocean from the continent, swollen by an unexpected flood at the time, unleashed large amounts of water onto the ships. Columbus, in his letter to the king and queen, described this incident in the following terms:—
"Being up on deck, at an advanced hour of the night, I heard a kind of terrible roaring; I tried to see through the darkness, and all at once I beheld a sea like a hill, as high as the ship, advancing slowly from the south towards my vessels. Opposing this great wave was a current, which met it with a frightful noise. I had no doubt then that we should be engulfed, and even now the remembrance causes me a feeling of horror. By good fortune, however, the current and the wave passed us, going towards the mouth of the canal, where, after long strife, they gradually sank to rest."
"While I was on deck late at night, I heard a terrible roar. I tried to see through the darkness, and suddenly I saw a wave like a hill, as high as the ship, slowly approaching from the south. There was a current pushing against this massive wave, creating a horrifying noise. I was sure we were going to be overwhelmed, and even now, thinking about it fills me with dread. Fortunately, the current and the wave moved past us toward the mouth of the canal, where, after a long struggle, they finally calmed down."
![]() |
Notwithstanding the difficulties of the navigation, Columbus continued to explore this sea, of which the waters became gradually calmer as he sailed northwards; he discovered various headlands, one of them was to the east of the Island of Trinidad, and called the Cape of Pera Blanca. Another was on the west of the promontory of Paria, and named Cape Lapa. Several harbours were also noticed, amongst others one situated at the mouth of the Orinoco, to which was given the name of the Port of Monkeys. Columbus landed on the shore, west of Point Cumana, and received a kindly welcome from the numerous inhabitants. Towards the west, beyond the point of Alcatraz, the country was magnificent, and there according to the natives, much gold and pearls were to be obtained. Here the admiral would gladly have remained for some time if he could have found a safe anchorage. But as this was impossible, he felt it best to make for Port Isabella, especially as his crews were worn down by fatigue, and his own health much affected, besides the sufferings he experienced from the bad state of his eyesight. So he sailed onwards along the Venezuelan coast, making friends as far as possible with the natives. These Indians were agreeable in feature, and of magnificent physique; their dwellings displayed a certain amount of taste, their houses being built with façades in front, and containing articles of furniture ingeniously made. The natives wore plates of gold as ornaments upon their necks. As to the country, it was superb; the rivers, the mountains, the immense forests made it a real land of delight. So the admiral gave this beautiful country the name of Gracia, and by many arguments he tried to prove that in this spot was situated that terrestrial Paradise once inhabited by Adam and Eve, being the cradle of the whole human race. To explain to a certain degree this idea of the great navigator, we must not forget that he imagined himself all this time to be on the shores of Asia. This spot which delighted him so much, he called "the Gardens."
Despite the challenges of navigation, Columbus kept exploring this sea, which gradually became calmer as he sailed north. He discovered various headlands, one of which was to the east of Trinidad Island, and he named it Cape of Pera Blanca. Another was on the west of the Paria promontory, called Cape Lapa. He also noted several harbors, including one at the mouth of the Orinoco, which he named the Port of Monkeys. Columbus landed on the shore west of Point Cumana and was warmly welcomed by the many inhabitants. To the west, beyond Alcatraz Point, the land was stunning, and according to the locals, there was plenty of gold and pearls to be found. The admiral would have liked to stay there for a while if he could have found a safe place to anchor. But since that was impossible, he decided it was best to head for Port Isabella, especially because his crew was exhausted and his own health was suffering, along with issues from his poor eyesight. So, he continued sailing along the Venezuelan coast, trying to befriend the natives as much as he could. The Indians were pleasant-looking and in great shape; their homes showed a degree of style, built with façades and furnished with cleverly made items. The locals wore gold plates as jewelry around their necks. The land was beautiful; the rivers, mountains, and vast forests made it a true paradise. The admiral named this lovely country Gracia, and he argued in various ways that this was the site of the earthly Paradise once inhabited by Adam and Eve, the cradle of the entire human race. To understand this idea of the great navigator, we must remember that he thought he was on the shores of Asia all along. This place that thrilled him so much, he called "the Gardens."
On the 23rd of August, after having at the expense of much danger and fatigue, overcome the perils of this bay, Columbus issued from the Gulf of Paria by the narrow strait to which he gave the name, retained to this day, of the Dragon's Mouth. Arrived in the open sea, the Spaniards discovered the Island of Tobago situated to the north-east of Trinidad, and then, more to the north, the Island of Conception, now known as Grenada. They next steered to the south-west and returned towards the American coast; after sailing along which for 120 miles, they discovered, on the 25th of August, the populous Island of Margarita, and afterwards the Island of Cubaga, situated very close to the mainland. At this place the natives had established a pearl-fishery, and busied themselves in collecting this valuable product. Columbus sent a boat on shore, when a very profitable traffic was carried on, the natives giving in exchange for broken pottery or hawks' bells, pounds' weight of pearls, some of which were very large, and of the finest water.
On August 23rd, after facing significant danger and exhaustion to navigate through this bay, Columbus emerged from the Gulf of Paria via the narrow strait he named, and which is still known today, the Dragon's Mouth. Once in open water, the Spaniards spotted the Island of Tobago to the north-east of Trinidad, and then further north, the Island of Conception, which is now called Grenada. They then headed southwest and made their way back towards the American coast; after traveling along the coast for 120 miles, they found the populated Island of Margarita on August 25th, followed by the nearby Island of Cubaga, which is very close to the mainland. Here, the natives were engaged in a pearl fishery, collecting this valuable resource. Columbus sent a boat to shore, and a very lucrative trade ensued, with the natives exchanging substantial amounts of pearls, some of which were quite large and of excellent quality, for broken pottery or hawks' bells.
![]() |
Pearl-fishers. |
The admiral stopped at this point of his discoveries; the temptation was strong to explore this country, but both officers and crews were exhausted. Orders were therefore given to start for San Domingo, where matters of the gravest moment demanded the presence of Columbus. Before his departure from Hispaniola he had authorized his brother to lay the foundations of a new town. With this end Don Bartolomeo had explored the different portions of the island, and having discovered at the distance of 150 miles from Isabella a magnificent harbour at the mouth of a fine river, he there marked out the first streets of a town which became later on the city of San Domingo. Here Don Bartolomeo fixed his residence, while Don Diego remained as Governor of Isabella. By this arrangement Columbus' two brothers had the whole administration of the colony in their hands. But there were many malcontents who were ready to revolt against their authority, and it was while this bad spirit was abroad that the admiral arrived at San Domingo. He approved of all that his brothers had done, their administration having been in fact, marked by great wisdom, and he published a proclamation recalling to their obedience the Spaniards who had revolted. On the 18th of October he despatched five ships to Spain, and with them an officer commissioned to inform the king of the new discoveries, and of the state of the colony, endangered by the fomenters of disorder.
The admiral paused at this point in his discoveries; the urge to explore this land was strong, but both the officers and crews were tired. Therefore, he ordered them to head back to San Domingo, where Columbus needed to address serious issues. Before leaving Hispaniola, he had given his brother permission to start building a new town. To this end, Don Bartolomeo had explored various areas of the island and found a beautiful harbor at the mouth of a great river, 150 miles from Isabella. There, he laid out the first streets of what would later become the city of San Domingo. Don Bartolomeo set up his home there, while Don Diego stayed on as Governor of Isabella. With this arrangement, Columbus' two brothers held the entire administration of the colony. However, there were many disgruntled individuals ready to rebel against their rule, and it was amid this unrest that the admiral arrived in San Domingo. He approved of everything his brothers had done, as their leadership was notably wise, and he issued a proclamation urging the rebellious Spaniards to return to obedience. On October 18th, he sent five ships to Spain, along with an officer tasked with informing the king about the new discoveries and the precarious situation of the colony, which was threatened by those causing trouble.
Meanwhile, the affairs of Columbus had taken a bad turn in Europe. Since his departure calumnies against himself and his brothers had been ever on the increase. Some rebels who had been expelled the colony, denounced the encroaching dynasty of the Columbus family, thus exciting the jealousy of a vain and ungrateful monarch. Even the queen, until now the constant patroness of the Genoese navigator, was indignant at the arrival on board the vessels of three hundred Indians who had been torn from their country, and who were treated as slaves. Isabella did not know that this abuse of power had been carried out unknown to Columbus and during his absence; he was held responsible for it, and to inquire into his conduct, the Court sent to Hispaniola a commander of the order of Calatrava, named Francis de Bovadilla, to whom were given the titles of Governor-general, and Intendant of Justice. He was in reality meant to supersede Columbus. Bovadilla, invested with discretionary powers, set out with two caravels towards the end of June, 1500. On the 23rd of August, the colonists sighted the two ships, which were then endeavouring to enter the harbour of San Domingo.
Meanwhile, Columbus's situation had worsened in Europe. Since he left, rumors and slander against him and his brothers had been escalating. Some rebels, who had been kicked out of the colony, spoke out against the growing power of the Columbus family, stirring up the jealousy of a vain and ungrateful king. Even Queen Isabella, who had been a loyal supporter of the Genoese navigator, was furious about the arrival of three hundred Indians on the ships who had been taken from their homeland and treated as slaves. Isabella didn't realize that this abuse of power had occurred without Columbus’s knowledge and during his absence; he was being held accountable for it. To investigate his actions, the Court sent a commander from the order of Calatrava, named Francis de Bovadilla, to Hispaniola. He was given the titles of Governor-general and Intendant of Justice, essentially to replace Columbus. Bovadilla, armed with broad powers, departed with two caravels at the end of June 1500. On August 23rd, the colonists spotted the two ships as they were trying to enter the harbor of San Domingo.
At this time Christopher Columbus and his brother Bartolomeo were absent, engaged in superintending the erection of a fort in the province of Xaragua; Don Diego was commanding in their absence. Bovadilla landed and went to hear mass, displaying during the ceremony a very significant ostentation; then, having summoned Don Diego before him, he ordered him to resign his office into his hands. The admiral, warned by a messenger of what was occurring, arrived in great haste. He examined the letters patent brought by Bovadilla, and having read them, he declared his willingness to recognize him as intendant of justice, but not as governor-general of the colony.
At this time, Christopher Columbus and his brother Bartolomeo were away, overseeing the construction of a fort in the province of Xaragua; Don Diego was in charge in their absence. Bovadilla landed and went to attend mass, showing off quite a bit during the ceremony. Then, after calling Don Diego in front of him, he ordered him to hand over his position. The admiral, alerted by a messenger about what was happening, rushed over. He reviewed the letters Bovadilla presented and, after reading them, said he was willing to recognize him as the intendant of justice, but not as the governor-general of the colony.
Then Bovadilla gave him a letter from the king and queen, couched in the following terms:—
Then Bovadilla handed him a letter from the king and queen, written in the following words:—
"Don Christopher Columbus, our Admiral in the ocean,
"Don Christopher Columbus, our Admiral of the Sea,
"We have ordered Commander Don Francis Bovadilla to explain to you our intentions. We command you to give credit to, and to execute, whatever he shall order on our part.
"We have instructed Commander Don Francis Bovadilla to outline our intentions to you. We require you to give him the necessary authority and to carry out whatever he directs on our behalf."
In this letter, the title of Viceroy appertaining to Columbus by the solemn conventions signed by Ferdinand and Isabella, was not even mentioned. Columbus, suppressing his just indignation, quietly submitted. Then arose against the fallen admiral a whole host of false friends. All those who owed their fortune to Columbus turned against him; accusing him of having desired to render himself independent. Foolish calumnies! How could this idea have occurred to the mind of a foreigner, a Genoese, alone in the midst of a Spanish colony!
In this letter, the title of Viceroy that Columbus was granted by the formal agreements signed by Ferdinand and Isabella wasn't even mentioned. Columbus, holding back his rightful anger, quietly accepted it. Then a whole bunch of fake friends turned against the fallen admiral. All those who owed their success to Columbus turned on him, accusing him of wanting to make himself independent. What ridiculous slanders! How could a foreigner, a Genoese, alone in the middle of a Spanish colony even come up with such an idea!
Bovadilla found the moment propitious for harsh measures. Don Diego was already imprisoned, and the governor soon ordered Don Bartolomeo and Christopher Columbus himself to be put in fetters. The admiral, accused of high treason, was placed with his two brothers on board a vessel bound for Spain, under the command of Alphonso de Villejo. That officer, a man of feeling, and ashamed of the treatment to which Columbus was exposed, wished to strike off his chains; but Columbus refused. He, the conqueror of a new world, would arrive loaded with chains in that kingdom of Spain, which he had so greatly enriched!
Bovadilla saw the moment as right for tough actions. Don Diego was already in prison, and the governor quickly ordered that Don Bartolomeo and Christopher Columbus himself be put in chains. The admiral, accused of treason, was placed with his two brothers on a ship headed for Spain, under the command of Alphonso de Villejo. That officer, a compassionate man, felt ashamed of how Columbus was being treated and wanted to remove his chains; however, Columbus refused. He, the conqueror of a new world, would arrive in Spain, a kingdom he had enriched, burdened with chains!
![]() |
Columbus bound like a felon. |
The admiral judged rightly in thus acting, for public opinion was revolted by the sight of him in this depth of humiliation, bound like a felon, and treated as a criminal. Gratitude towards the man of genius asserted itself against the bad passions which had been so unjustly excited, and there arose a cry of indignation against Bovadilla. The king and queen, swayed by the feelings of the people, loudly blamed the conduct of the commander, and addressed an affectionate letter to Columbus, inviting him to present himself at court.
The admiral made the right call in taking action, as public opinion was outraged by the sight of him in such humiliation, tied up like a criminal and treated as one. Gratitude for the brilliant man pushed back against the unjustly stirred bad feelings, leading to a strong outcry against Bovadilla. The king and queen, influenced by the people's emotions, openly criticized the commander's actions and sent a heartfelt letter to Columbus, inviting him to come to court.
Thus a bright day again dawned for Columbus. He appeared before Ferdinand, not as the accused, but as himself the accuser; then, his fortitude giving way under the remembrance of the unworthy treatment he had experienced, this unfortunate great man wept, and caused those around to weep with him. He pointed proudly to the story of his life. He showed himself to be almost without resources, he whom they accused of ambition, and of enriching himself out of the government of the colony! Verily, the man who had made the discovery of a world, did not possess a roof to shelter his own head!
Thus a bright day once again arrived for Columbus. He stood before Ferdinand, not as the accused, but as the accuser; then, as he recalled the unworthy treatment he had faced, this unfortunate great man broke down in tears, causing those around him to weep too. He pointed proudly to the story of his life. He showed himself to be almost devoid of resources, he who was accused of ambition and of profiting from the government of the colony! Truly, the man who had discovered a new world did not have a roof to cover his own head!
Isabella, ever good and compassionate, wept in company with the old sailor, and for sometime could not make him any answer, so choked was she with her tears. At length she was able to utter some affectionate words; in assuring Columbus of her protection, she promised to avenge him of his enemies; she excused the bad choice they had made in sending this Bovadilla to the islands, and she declared he should expiate his guilt by an exemplary punishment. In addition, she desired the admiral to allow some time to elapse before returning to his government, in order that the minds prejudiced against him might return to sentiments of honour and justice.
Isabella, always kind and caring, cried alongside the old sailor and for a while couldn't respond to him because she was so overwhelmed with tears. Eventually, she managed to say some kind words; she assured Columbus of her support and promised to take revenge on his enemies. She criticized the poor decision to send this Bovadilla to the islands and stated that he should face a fitting punishment for his wrongdoings. Additionally, she asked the admiral to wait some time before returning to his position so that those who had been biased against him could regain feelings of honor and justice.
The mind of Christopher Columbus was calmed by the gracious words of the queen; he showed himself content with his reception, and admitted the necessity of the delay enjoined upon him by Isabella. The chief wish of his heart was again to serve his adopted country and its sovereigns, and he sketched out grand designs of what still remained to be attempted in the way of discovery. His third voyage, in spite of its short duration, had not been without fruit, but had enriched the map with such new names as Trinidad, the Gulf of Paria, the coast of Cumana, the Islands of Tobago, of Grenada, of Margarita, and of Cubaga.
The words of the queen calmed Christopher Columbus's mind; he appeared satisfied with how he was received and recognized the need for the delay that Isabella imposed on him. His main desire was to serve his adopted country and its rulers again, and he outlined ambitious plans for further exploration. Although his third voyage was short, it was not without results, as it added new names to the map, including Trinidad, the Gulf of Paria, the coast of Cumana, and the Islands of Tobago, Grenada, Margarita, and Cubaga.
CHRISTOPHER COLUMBUS.
Fourth Voyage: A Flotilla of four vessels—Canary Islands—Martinique—Dominica—Santa-Cruz—Porto-Rico—Hispaniola—Jamaica—Cayman Island—Pinos Island—Island of Guanaja—Cape Honduras—The American Coast of Truxillo on the Gulf of Darien—The Limonare Islands—Huerta—The Coast of Veragua—Auriferous Strata—Revolt of the Natives—The Dream of Columbus—Porto-Bello—The Mulatas—Putting into port at Jamaica—Distress—Revolt of the Spaniards against Columbus—Lunar Eclipse—Arrival of Columbus at Hispaniola—Return of Columbus to Spain—His death, on the 20th of March, 1506.
Fourth Voyage: A flotilla of four ships—Canary Islands—Martinique—Dominica—Santa Cruz—Puerto Rico—Hispaniola—Jamaica—Cayman Islands—Pinos Island—Guanaja Island—Cape Honduras—The American Coast of Truxillo on the Gulf of Darien—The Limonare Islands—Huerta—The Coast of Veragua—Gold-bearing areas—Rebellion of the natives—The dream of Columbus—Portobelo—The Mulattos—Docking in Jamaica—Hardship—Revolt of the Spaniards against Columbus—Lunar eclipse—Columbus arrives in Hispaniola—Return of Columbus to Spain—His death on March 20, 1506.
Christopher Columbus saw himself now reinstated in favour, as he deserved to be, at the court of Ferdinand and Isabella. Perhaps the king may have still evinced a certain degree of coldness towards him, but the queen was his avowed and enthusiastic protectress. His official title as viceroy had not, however, been restored to him, but the admiral, with his usual magnanimity, did not demand it. He had the satisfaction of seeing Bovadilla deposed, partly for his abuse of power, and partly because his conduct towards the Indians had become atrocious; his inhuman proceedings towards them being pushed to such a length, that under his administration the native population of Hispaniola, sensibly decreased.
Christopher Columbus saw himself reinstated in favor, as he deserved, at the court of Ferdinand and Isabella. The king might still have shown some degree of coldness towards him, but the queen was his open and enthusiastic supporter. His official title as viceroy had not been restored, but the admiral, with his usual generosity, did not ask for it. He took satisfaction in seeing Bovadilla removed from power, partly for his abuse of authority and partly because his treatment of the Indians had become horrific; his inhumane actions against them were so extreme that under his administration, the native population of Hispaniola noticeably decreased.
During this time the island began to fulfil the hopes of Columbus, who had prophesied that in three years the crown would derive from it a revenue of sixty millions. Gold was obtained in abundance from the best worked mines; a slave had dug up on the banks of the Hayna, a mass, equal in weight to 3600 golden crowns; it was easy to foresee that the new colonies would yield incalculable riches.
During this time, the island started to meet Columbus's expectations, who had predicted that in three years the crown would get a revenue of sixty million. Gold was plentiful from the most productive mines; a slave had uncovered a mass of gold on the banks of the Hayna that weighed as much as 3,600 golden crowns. It was easy to see that the new colonies would bring in unimaginable wealth.
The admiral, who could not bear to remain inactive, earnestly demanded to be sent on a fourth voyage, although he was by this time sixty-six years of age. In support of his request he adduced some very plausible reasons. One year before the return of Columbus, the Portuguese navigator, Vasco da Gama, had returned from the Indies, after having doubled the Cape of Good Hope. Columbus felt certain that by sailing to India by the much safer and shorter western route, the Spaniards might enter into profitable competition with the Portuguese traders. He constantly maintained, believing as he did that he had been alongside the Asiatic territory, that the islands and continents discovered by him were only separated by a strait from the Moluccas. He therefore wished, without even returning to Hispaniola and the colonies already settled, to direct his course at once to the Indies. It is evident that the ex-Viceroy had again become the hardy navigator of his earlier years. The king agreed to the admiral's request, and placed him in command of a flotilla composed of four vessels, the Santiago, Gallego, Vizcaino, and a caravel, as admiral's galley. These ships were of small tonnage, the largest being only of seventy tons, and the smallest of fifty; they were in fact, little better than coasting-vessels.
The admiral, who couldn't stand being inactive, urgently asked to be sent on a fourth voyage, even though he was sixty-six years old. To back up his request, he provided some pretty convincing reasons. One year before Columbus returned, the Portuguese navigator, Vasco da Gama, had come back from the Indies after successfully rounding the Cape of Good Hope. Columbus believed that by taking the much safer and shorter western route to India, the Spaniards could enter into profitable competition with the Portuguese traders. He consistently argued that, since he was close to Asian territory, the islands and continents he discovered were only separated by a strait from the Moluccas. Therefore, he wanted to head straight to the Indies without even returning to Hispaniola and the established colonies. It was clear that the former Viceroy had become the bold navigator he had been in his earlier years. The king approved the admiral's request and put him in charge of a flotilla made up of four ships: the Santiago, Gallego, Vizcaino, and a caravel serving as the admiral's galley. These ships were relatively small, with the largest being only seventy tons and the smallest fifty; they were essentially little better than coastal vessels.
Columbus left Cadiz on the 9th of May, 1502, with crews numbering in all 150 men. He took with him his brother Bartolomeo, and his son Fernando, the child of his second marriage, and at this time scarcely thirteen years old. On the 20th of May, the vessels stopped at Gran Canaria, and on the 15th of June arrived at Martinique, one of the Windward Islands; afterwards they touched at Dominica, Santa-Cruz, and Porto-Rico, and at length, after a prosperous voyage, reached Hispaniola, on the 29th of June. The intention of Columbus, acting on the queen's advice, was not to land upon the island whence he had been so unworthily expelled; but his badly-constructed ship was scarcely sea-worthy, and repairs to the keel were greatly needed. Therefore the admiral demanded permission of the governor to enter the harbour.
Columbus set sail from Cadiz on May 9, 1502, with a crew of 150 men. He brought along his brother Bartolomeo and his son Fernando, who was just about thirteen years old at the time, the child of his second marriage. On May 20, the ships made a stop at Gran Canaria, and on June 15, they arrived at Martinique, one of the Windward Islands. After that, they visited Dominica, Santa Cruz, and Puerto Rico, and finally, after a successful voyage, they reached Hispaniola on June 29. Following the queen's advice, Columbus intended not to land on the island from which he had been unjustly expelled. However, his poorly built ship was barely seaworthy, and the keel needed significant repairs. Therefore, the admiral requested permission from the governor to enter the harbor.
The new governor, successor to Bovadilla, was a just and moderate man, a knight of the order of Alcantara, named Nicholas Ovando. His excessive caution, however, made him fear that the presence of Columbus in the colony might be a cause of disorder; he therefore thought it right to refuse the request. The admiral concealed the indignation which such treatment could not but cause him, and returned good for evil, by offering wise counsel to the governor in the following instance. The fleet which was to take Bovadilla back to Europe, and to bear with it, besides the enormous lump of gold already mentioned, other treasures of great value, was ready to put to sea. But the weather was very threatening, and Columbus, with a sailor's penetration, having observed the signs of an approaching storm, implored the governor not to expose the ships and passengers to such danger. Ovando would not listen to the advice, and the ships put to sea; scarcely had they reached the eastern point of the island before a terrible hurricane arose, causing twenty-one of the ships to founder with all on board. Bovadilla was drowned, and with him the greater part of the enemies of Columbus, but by an exception which may be called providential, the ship which carried the poor remains of the admiral's fortune, escaped destruction. In this storm ten millions' worth of gold and precious stones was engulfed by the ocean.
The new governor, who succeeded Bovadilla, was a fair and moderate man, a knight of the Order of Alcántara, named Nicholas Ovando. However, his excessive caution made him worry that Columbus's presence in the colony might lead to chaos; he decided it was best to deny the request. The admiral hid the anger such treatment inevitably brought him and responded with kindness by offering wise advice to the governor in this instance. The fleet set to take Bovadilla back to Europe, along with the enormous amount of gold already mentioned and other treasures of great value, was ready to sail. But the weather looked ominous, and Columbus, with a sailor's intuition, noticed the signs of an approaching storm, pleading with the governor not to put the ships and passengers in jeopardy. Ovando ignored the advice, and the ships set out to sea; they had barely reached the eastern point of the island when a severe hurricane struck, causing twenty-one of the ships to sink with everyone on board. Bovadilla was drowned, taking with him most of Columbus's enemies, but in a twist of fate, the ship carrying what remained of the admiral's fortune survived the wreck. In this storm, treasures worth ten million were lost to the ocean.
Meanwhile, the four caravels of Columbus, denied access to the harbour, had been driven before the storm. They were separated one from the other, and disabled, but they succeeded in meeting together again, and by the 14th of July, the squall had carried them within sight of Jamaica. Arrived there, strong currents bore them towards the islands called the Queen's Garden, and then in the direction of east-south-east. The little flotilla contended for sixty days against the wind without making more than 210 miles, and at length was driven towards the coast of Cuba, which led to the discovery of Cayman and Pinos Islands.
Meanwhile, Columbus's four caravels, blocked from entering the harbor, were pushed along by the storm. They got separated from each other and were damaged, but they managed to regroup. By July 14th, the storm had carried them into view of Jamaica. Once they arrived, strong currents pulled them towards the islands known as the Queen's Garden, and then further east-southeast. The small fleet battled against the wind for sixty days, covering no more than 210 miles, and eventually got pushed toward the coast of Cuba, leading to the discovery of the Cayman and Pinos Islands.
Columbus then steered to the south-west, sailing upon seas hitherto unvisited by any European ship, and throwing himself once more into the course of discovery with all the passionate ardour of a navigator. Chance conducted him towards the southern coast of America; he discovered the island of Guanaja, on the 30th of July, and on the 14th of August he touched at Cape Honduras, that narrow strip of land, which, prolonged by the Isthmus of Panama, unites the two continents of America. Thus, for the second time Columbus, without being aware of it, approached the real soil of America. For more than nine months he followed the windings of these shores, in the face of all kinds of perils and difficulties, and succeeded in laying down the chart of the coast from the part since named Truxillo, as far as the Gulf of Darien. Each night he cast anchor, that he might not be driven far from the shore, and at length reached that eastern extremity of the coast where it ends abruptly in the Cape Gracias a Dios.
Columbus then headed southwest, sailing across seas that had never been visited by any European ship before, diving back into the spirit of exploration with the intense passion of a navigator. By chance, he found himself along the southern coast of America; he discovered the island of Guanaja on July 30, and on August 14, he landed at Cape Honduras, that narrow strip of land that, extending by the Isthmus of Panama, connects the two continents of America. So, for the second time, Columbus unknowingly approached the actual land of America. For over nine months, he navigated the twists and turns of these shores, facing all types of dangers and challenges, and managed to chart the coastline from what is now Truxillo all the way to the Gulf of Darien. Each night he dropped anchor so he wouldn’t drift too far from the shore, and eventually reached that easternmost point of the coast where it abruptly ends at Cape Gracias a Dios.
This cape was doubled on the 14th of September, but the ships encountered contrary winds so violent, that even the admiral, himself the oldest sailor of the crews, had never before experienced the like. He relates this terrible episode in his letter to the king of Spain in the following terms: "During eighty-four days the waves continued their assaults, nor did my eyes perceive sun, nor stars, nor any planet; the seams of my vessels gaped, my sails were torn; tackle, boats, rigging, all were lost; my sailors, ill and frightened, devoted themselves to the pious duties of religion; no one failed to promise pilgrimages, and all confessed to each other, thinking that each moment might prove their last. I have seen many tempests, but never have I experienced any of such duration and violence. Many of my men who passed for intrepid sailors, lost courage; but that which broke my heart, was the pain of my son, whose tender age added to my despair, and whom I saw the prey of greater suffering, greater torments, than fell to the lot of any one amongst us; but it was doubtless no other than God, who bestowed upon him such energy, that it was He alone who animated the courage, and reawakened the patience of the sailors under their severe toil; in a word, looking upon him, one might have fancied him a sailor who had grown old in contending with storms, an astonishing fact, almost incredible, but one which awakened some gleam of joy amidst the sorrows which overwhelmed me. I was ill, and several times I thought my last hour was near.... To complete my misery comes the thought that twenty years of service, of fatigues and perils, have brought me no profit, and I find myself to-day unpossessed of even a roof to shelter me in Spain, and forced to betake myself to an inn when I would obtain repose or food; and when there I often find myself unable to pay my reckoning." Do not these lines indicate clearly the intensity of sorrow which overwhelmed the soul of Columbus? In the midst of such dangers and anxieties, how could he preserve the energy needful to command an expedition?
This cape was crossed on September 14, but the ships faced such violent winds that even the admiral, the most experienced sailor among the crews, had never encountered anything like it before. He describes this terrible experience in his letter to the king of Spain as follows: "For eighty-four days, the waves kept attacking us, and I didn’t see the sun, stars, or any planets; the seams of my ships were coming apart, my sails were torn; gear, boats, and rigging were all lost; my sailors, sick and scared, turned to their religious duties; everyone promised pilgrimages, and all confessed to one another, thinking that each moment could be their last. I have seen many storms, but never one that lasted and was as violent as this. Many of my men, who were considered brave sailors, lost their courage; but what broke my heart was the suffering of my son, whose young age added to my despair, and whom I saw enduring greater pain and torment than anyone among us; but surely it was God who gave him such strength that He alone inspired the courage and renewed the patience of the sailors in their severe toil; in other words, when I looked at him, you might have thought he was a sailor who had grown old fighting against storms, an astonishing and almost unbelievable fact, but one that brought a small glimmer of joy amid the sorrows that weighed me down. I was ill, and several times I thought my last hour was near... To make my misery worse, I think about how twenty years of service, fatigue, and danger have brought me no benefit, and I find myself today without even a roof over my head in Spain, forced to stay at an inn when I want to rest or eat; and even there, I often find myself unable to pay my bill." Don’t these words clearly show the depth of sorrow that overwhelmed Columbus's soul? Amid such dangers and worries, how could he maintain the energy needed to lead an expedition?
Throughout the duration of the storm, the ships had been following the line of coast which successively bears the names of Honduras, Mosquito, Nicaragua, Costa-Rica, Veragua, and Panama, the twelve Limonare Islands being also discovered at this time, and at last, on the 25th of September, Columbus cast anchor between the small island of Huerta and the continent. On the 5th of October he again set sail, and after having taken the bearings of the Bay of Almirante, he anchored opposite to the village of Cariaz. There he remained until the 15th of October, the repairs of the vessels meanwhile going actively forward.
Throughout the storm, the ships had been sailing along the coast, which is known as Honduras, Mosquito, Nicaragua, Costa Rica, Veragua, and Panama, with the twelve Limonare Islands also spotted at this time. Finally, on September 25th, Columbus dropped anchor between the small island of Huerta and the mainland. On October 5th, he set sail again, and after checking the location of the Bay of Almirante, he anchored near the village of Cariaz. He stayed there until October 15th while the repairs on the ships were actively being done.
Columbus now believed himself to be arrived near the mouth of the Ganges, and from the natives speaking of a certain province of Ciguare, which was surrounded by the sea, he felt himself confirmed in this opinion. They declared that it was a country containing rich gold-mines, of which the most important was situated seventy-five miles to the south. When the admiral again set sail, he followed the wooded coast of Veragua, where the Indians appeared to be very wild. On the 26th of November, the flotilla entered the harbour of El Retrete, which is now the port of Escribanos. The ships battered by the winds, were now in a most miserable plight; it was absolutely necessary to repair the damage they had sustained, and for this purpose to prolong the stay at El Retrete. Upon quitting this harbour Columbus was met by a storm even more dreadful than those which had preceded it: "During nine days," he says, "I remained without hope of being saved. Never did any man see a more violent or terrible sea; it was covered with foam, the wind permitted no ships to advance, nor to steer towards any cape; I was kept in that sea, of which the waves seemed to be of blood, and the surges boiled as though heated by fire. Never have I seen so appalling an aspect of the heavens: on fire during one whole day and night like a furnace, they sent forth thunder and flame incessantly, and I feared each moment that the masts and sails would be carried away. The growling of the thunder was so horrible that it appeared sufficient to crush our vessels; and during the whole time the rain fell with such violence that one could scarcely call it rain, but rather a second Deluge. My sailors, overcome by so much trouble and suffering, prayed for death as putting a term to their miseries; my ships opened in all directions, and boats, anchors, ropes, and sails were once again lost."
Columbus now thought he had reached the mouth of the Ganges, and the locals talking about a province called Ciguare that was surrounded by the sea confirmed his belief. They said it was a land with rich gold mines, the most significant one located seventy-five miles to the south. After setting sail again, the admiral followed the wooded coast of Veragua, where the native people seemed quite wild. On November 26th, the flotilla entered the harbor of El Retrete, which is now the port of Escribanos. The ships, battered by the winds, were in terrible condition; it was absolutely necessary to repair the damage they had incurred, which meant they had to stay longer at El Retrete. When Columbus left this harbor, he encountered an even more dreadful storm than the previous ones: "For nine days," he says, "I was without hope of being saved. Never had anyone witnessed a more violent or terrifying sea; it was covered in foam, the wind prevented any ships from moving forward or steering toward any cape; I was trapped in that sea, where the waves looked like blood, and the surges boiled as if they were heated by fire. I had never seen such a frightening appearance in the sky: on fire for an entire day and night like a furnace, it unleashed relentless thunder and flames, and I feared every moment that the masts and sails would be torn away. The rumbling of the thunder was so terrifying that it felt like it could crush our vessels; and throughout it all, the rain fell with such ferocity that it could barely be called rain, but more like a second Deluge. My sailors, overwhelmed by such distress and suffering, prayed for death to end their misery; my ships were torn apart everywhere, and boats, anchors, ropes, and sails were lost once again."
During this long and painful navigation, the admiral had sailed one thousand and fifty miles. His crews were by this time quite exhausted; he was therefore obliged to turn back and to regain the river of Veragua, but not being able to find safe shelter there for his ships, he went a short distance off to the mouth of Bethlehem river, now called the Yebra, in which he cast anchor on the feast of the Epiphany in the year 1503. On the morrow the tempest was again renewed, and on the 24th of January, a sudden increase of water in the river caused the cables which held the ships to snap, and the vessels were only saved with great trouble.
During this long and difficult journey, the admiral had traveled one thousand and fifty miles. By this point, his crews were completely worn out, so he had to turn back and return to the Veragua river. However, not being able to find a safe place to anchor his ships there, he went a little further to the mouth of the Bethlehem river, now called the Yebra, where he dropped anchor on the feast of the Epiphany in the year 1503. The next day, the storm picked up again, and on January 24th, a sudden rise in the river's water caused the cables holding the ships to snap, making it very difficult to save the vessels.
In spite of all this, the admiral, who never forgot the principal object of his mission in these new countries, had succeeded in establishing regular intercourse with the natives. The cacique of Bethlehem showed a friendly disposition, and pointed out a country fifteen miles inland, where he said the gold-mines were very rich. On the 6th of February, Columbus despatched a force of seventy men to the spot indicated, under the command of his brother Bartolomeo. After travelling through a very undulating country, watered by rivers so winding that one of them had to be crossed thirty-nine times, the Spaniards arrived at the auriferous tracts. They were immense, and extended quite out of sight. Gold was so abundant that one man alone could collect enough of it in ten days to fill a measure. In four hours, Bartolomeo and his men had picked up gold to an enormous amount. They returned to the admiral, who, when he heard their narrative, resolved to settle upon this coast, and to have some wooden barracks constructed.
Despite all of this, the admiral, who never lost sight of the main goal of his mission in these new lands, managed to establish regular communication with the locals. The chief of Bethlehem was friendly and pointed out an area fifteen miles inland, claiming that the gold mines there were very rich. On February 6th, Columbus sent a group of seventy men to the indicated location, led by his brother Bartolomeo. After traveling through a very hilly terrain, crossed by rivers so winding that they had to cross one of them thirty-nine times, the Spaniards finally reached the gold-rich lands. They were vast and stretched out of view. Gold was so plentiful that one person could gather enough in ten days to fill a container. In just four hours, Bartolomeo and his team collected a huge amount of gold. They returned to the admiral, who, upon hearing their story, decided to settle on this coast and have some wooden barracks built.
![]() |
Gold-mines in Cuba. From an old print. |
The mines of this region were indeed of incomparable richness; they appeared to be inexhaustible, and quite made Columbus forget Cuba and San Domingo. His letter to King Ferdinand evinces his enthusiasm on the subject; one may feel some astonishment at reading the following sentiment from the pen of this great man, one indeed which is neither that of a philosopher nor of a Christian. "Gold! gold! excellent thing! It is from gold that spring riches! it is by means of gold that everything in the world is done, and its power suffices often to place souls in Paradise."
The mines in this area were incredibly rich; they seemed endless and made Columbus forget all about Cuba and San Domingo. His letter to King Ferdinand shows how excited he was about it; it's surprising to read this comment from such a notable figure—it's not exactly the view of a philosopher or a Christian. "Gold! Gold! What a fantastic thing! It's gold that brings wealth! Everything in the world is accomplished through gold, and its power often can save souls and take them to Paradise."
The Spaniards set to work with ardour to store up this gold in their ships. Hitherto the relations with the natives had been peaceable, although these people were of fierce disposition. But after a time the cacique, irritated by the usurpation of the foreigners, resolved to murder them and burn their dwellings. One day the natives suddenly attacked the Spaniards in considerable force, and a very severe battle ensued, ending in the repulse of the Indians. The cacique had been taken prisoner with all his family, but he succeeded with his children in escaping from custody, and took refuge in the mountains in company with a great number of his followers. In the month of April, a considerable troop of the natives again attacked the Spaniards, who exterminated a large proportion of them.
The Spaniards eagerly got to work storing the gold in their ships. Until then, their relations with the natives had been peaceful, even though the natives were quite fierce. However, after a while, the cacique, angered by the foreigners' takeover, decided to kill them and burn their homes. One day, the natives suddenly attacked the Spaniards with a large force, leading to a fierce battle that ended with the Indians being driven back. The cacique was captured along with his entire family, but he managed to escape with his children and took refuge in the mountains with many of his followers. In April, a large group of natives attacked the Spaniards again, who ended up killing many of them.
Meanwhile, the health of Columbus became more and more enfeebled; the wind failed him for quitting the harbour, and he was in despair. One day, exhausted by fatigue, he fell asleep, and heard a pitying voice which addressed him as follows:—words which shall be given verbatim, for they bear the imprint of that kind of ecstatic religious fervour which gives a finishing touch to the picture of the great navigator.
Meanwhile, Columbus's health continued to decline; he couldn't find the wind to leave the harbor, and he was filled with despair. One day, completely worn out, he fell asleep and heard a compassionate voice that spoke to him as follows:—words that will be quoted exactly, as they capture the essence of the ecstatic religious fervor that adds the final touch to the image of the great navigator.
"'O foolish man! why such unwillingness to believe in and to serve thy God, the God of the Universe? What did He more for Moses His servant, and for David? Since thy birth, has He not had for thee the most tender solicitude; and when he saw thee of an age in which His designs for thee could be matured, has He not made thy name resound gloriously through the world? Has He not bestowed upon thee the Indies, the richest part of the earth? Has He not set thee free to make an offering of them to Him according to thine own will? Who but He has lent thee the means of executing His designs? Bounds were placed at the entrance of the ocean; they were formed of chains which could not be broken through. To thee were given the keys. Thy power was recognized in distant lands, and thy glory was proclaimed by all Christians. Did God even show Himself more favourable to the people of Israel, when He rescued them from Egypt? Did He favour David more, when from a shepherd boy He made him king of Judah? Turn to Him, confessing thy fault, for His compassion is infinite. Thine old age will prove no obstacle in the great actions which await thee: He holds in His hands a heritage the most brilliant. Was not Abraham a hundred years old, and had not Sarah already passed the flower of her youth when Isaac was born? Thou seekest an uncertain help. Answer me: who has exposed thee so often to so many dangers? Is it God, or the world? God never withholds the blessings promised to His servants. It is not His manner after receiving a service to pretend that His intentions have not been carried out, and to give a new interpretation to His desires; it is not He who seeks to give to arbitrary acts a favourable colour. His words are to be taken literally; all that He promises He gives with usury. Thus does He ever. I have told thee all that the Creator has done for thee; at this very moment He is showing thee the prize and the reward of the perils and sufferings to which thou hast been exposed in the service of thy fellow-men.' And I listened to this voice, overcome though I were with suffering; but I could not muster strength to reply to these assured promises; I contented myself by deploring my fault with tears. The voice concluded with these words:—'Take confidence, hope on; the record of thy labours will, with justice, be engraved on marble.'"
"'O foolish person! Why are you so unwilling to believe in and serve your God, the God of the Universe? What more did He do for Moses, His servant, and for David? Since your birth, hasn’t He cared for you with the utmost tenderness? And when He saw that you were old enough for His plans to come together, didn’t He make your name echo gloriously around the world? Hasn’t He given you the Indies, the richest part of the earth? Hasn’t He set you free to offer them to Him as you wish? Who but He has given you the means to carry out His plans? Boundaries were set at the edge of the ocean; they were made of chains that couldn’t be broken. You were given the keys. Your power was recognized in far-off lands, and your glory was proclaimed by all Christians. Did God even show more favor to the people of Israel when He saved them from Egypt? Did He favor David more when He turned him from a shepherd boy into the king of Judah? Turn to Him, confess your faults, for His compassion is limitless. Your old age won’t hinder the great things that are waiting for you: He holds in His hands an extraordinary inheritance. Wasn’t Abraham a hundred years old, and hadn’t Sarah already passed her prime when Isaac was born? You’re looking for unreliable help. Answer me: who has put you in so many dangers? Is it God or the world? God never withholds the blessings promised to His servants. It’s not His way to act as if His intentions haven’t been fulfilled after receiving a service and to reinterpret His desires; it’s not He who tries to give arbitrary actions a favorable appearance. His words should be taken literally; all that He promises, He gives generously. That is always how He operates. I have told you all that the Creator has done for you; even now, He is showing you the prize and reward for the dangers and sufferings you have faced in the service of your fellow human beings.' And I listened to this voice, though I was overcome with suffering; but I could not gather the strength to respond to these confident promises; I settled for lamenting my faults with tears. The voice ended with these words:—'Be confident, hold on to hope; the record of your labors will justly be engraved in marble.'"
Columbus, as soon as he recovered, was anxious to leave this coast. He had desired to found a colony here, but his crews were not sufficiently numerous to justify the risk of leaving a part of them on land. The four caravels were full of worm-holes, and one of them had to be left behind at Bethlehem. On Easter day the admiral put to sea, but scarcely had he gone ninety miles before a leak was discovered in one of the ships; it was necessary to steer for the coast with all speed, and happily Porto-Bello was reached in safety, where the ship was abandoned, her injuries being irreparable. The flotilla consisted now of but two caravels, without boats, almost without provisions, and with 7000 miles of ocean to traverse. It sailed along the coast, passed the port of El Retrete, discovered the group of islands called the Mulatas, and at length entered the Gulf of Darien. This was the farthest point east reached by Columbus.
Columbus, as soon as he recovered, was eager to leave this coast. He had wanted to start a colony here, but his crews weren't large enough to take the risk of leaving some members on land. The four caravels were full of wormholes, and one of them had to be left behind at Bethlehem. On Easter Sunday, the admiral set sail, but barely had he traveled ninety miles when a leak was found in one of the ships; it was necessary to head back to the coast quickly, and fortunately, they reached Porto-Bello safely, where the ship was abandoned due to irreparable damage. The flotilla now consisted of only two caravels, without boats, almost out of provisions, and with 7,000 miles of ocean to cross. They sailed along the coast, passed the port of El Retrete, discovered the group of islands called the Mulatas, and finally entered the Gulf of Darien. This was the farthest point east that Columbus reached.
On the 1st of May the admiral steered for Hispaniola; by the 10th he was in sight of the Cayman Islands, but he found it impossible to make head against the winds which drove him to the north-west nearly as far as Cuba. There, while in shallow water, he encountered a storm, during which anchors and sails were carried away, and the two ships came into collision during the night. The hurricane then drove them southwards, and the admiral at length reached Jamaica with his shattered vessels, casting anchor on the 23rd of June in the harbour of San-Gloria, now called the bay of Don Christopher. Columbus wished to have gone to Hispaniola, where he would have found the stores needful for revictualling the ships, resources which were absolutely wanting in Jamaica; but his two caravels, full of worm-holes, "like to bee-hives," could not without danger attempt the ninety miles' voyage; the question now arose, how to send a message to Ovando, the governor of Hispaniola.
On May 1st, the admiral headed towards Hispaniola; by the 10th, he could see the Cayman Islands, but he found it impossible to make progress against the winds that pushed him northwest almost as far as Cuba. There, while in shallow water, he faced a storm that ripped away anchors and sails, and the two ships collided during the night. The hurricane then pushed them southward, and the admiral finally reached Jamaica with his damaged vessels, anchoring on June 23rd in the harbor of San-Gloria, now known as the bay of Don Christopher. Columbus wanted to go to Hispaniola, where he would have found the supplies needed to restock the ships—resources that were completely lacking in Jamaica; however, his two caravels, filled with wormholes "like beehives," could not risk attempting the ninety-mile journey. The question now was how to send a message to Ovando, the governor of Hispaniola.
![]() |
The Admiral is obliged to run the caravels aground. |
The caravels let in water in every direction, and the admiral was obliged to run them aground; he then tried to organize a life in common upon shore. The Indians at first gave him assistance, and furnished the crews with the provisions of which they were in need, but the miserable and much tried sailors showed resentment against the admiral; they were ready for revolt, while the unfortunate Columbus, exhausted by illness, was confined to a bed of pain. It was in these trying circumstances that two brave officers, Mendez and Fieschi, proposed to the admiral to attempt to cross from Jamaica to Hispaniola in Indian canoes. This was in reality a voyage of six hundred miles, for it was necessary to row along the coast as far as the port where the colony was established. But these courageous officers were ready to face every peril, when it was a question of saving their companions. Columbus, appreciating the boldness of a proposal, which under other circumstances he would himself have been the first to make, gave the required permission to Mendez and Fieschi, who set out, while he, without ships, almost without provisions, remained with his crew upon this uncultivated island.
The caravels were taking on water from all sides, and the admiral had no choice but to run them aground. He then tried to create a communal life on the shore. At first, the Indigenous people helped him by providing the crews with the supplies they needed, but the poor, weary sailors grew resentful towards the admiral; they were on the brink of revolt, while the unfortunate Columbus, weakened by illness, was stuck in bed suffering. In these tough conditions, two brave officers, Mendez and Fieschi, suggested to the admiral that they attempt to cross from Jamaica to Hispaniola in Indian canoes. This was actually a journey of six hundred miles, as they needed to paddle along the coast to reach the port where the colony was located. But these daring officers were willing to face any danger if it meant saving their fellow sailors. Recognizing the boldness of a suggestion that he would have been the first to make under normal circumstances, Columbus gave Mendez and Fieschi the go-ahead. They set off while he, left without ships and nearly out of supplies, stayed behind with his crew on this wild island.
![]() |
Indian Boats. From an old print. |
Soon the misery of the shipwrecked people—for so we may fairly call them—became so great that a revolt ensued. The admiral's companions, blinded by their sufferings, imagined that their chief dared not return to the harbour in Hispaniola, to which Ovando had already denied him entrance. They thought this proscription applied to them equally with the admiral, and said among themselves that the governor, in excluding the flotilla from the harbours of the colony, must have acted under orders from the king. These absurd reasonings irritated minds already badly disposed, and at length on the 2nd of January, 1504, two brothers named Porras, one the captain of one of the caravels and the other the military treasurer, placed themselves at the head of the malcontents. Their wish was to return to Europe, and they rushed towards the admiral's tent, crying, "Castille! Castille!" Columbus was ill and in bed. His brother and his son threw themselves between him and the mutineers to defend him. At the sight of the aged admiral, the rebels stopped, and their violence abated; but they would not listen to the admiral's remonstrances and counsels; they did not understand that nothing could save them but general concord, and each, in unselfish forgetfulness, working for the public good. No! their decision was taken to quit the island, no matter by what means. Porras and his followers ran down to the shore, took possession of the canoes of the natives, and steered for the eastern extremity of the island. Arrived there, with no respect left for anything, and drunk with fury, they pillaged the Indians' dwellings—thus rendering the admiral responsible for their deeds of violence—and they dragged some unfortunate natives on board of the canoes which they had stolen. Porras and his companions continued their navigation; but when several leagues from shore, they were struck by a gust of wind which placed them in peril: with the object of lightening the canoes, they threw their prisoners overboard. After this barbarous execution, the canoes endeavoured, following the example of Mendez and Fieschi, to gain the island of Hispaniola, but in vain, they were continually thrown back upon the coasts of Jamaica.
Soon, the suffering of the shipwrecked people—if we can call them that—became so intense that a rebellion broke out. The admiral's companions, overwhelmed by their pain, believed that their leader was too scared to return to the harbor in Hispaniola, where Ovando had already denied him entry. They assumed this ban applied to them just like it did to the admiral and reasoned among themselves that the governor’s decision to exclude the flotilla from the colony’s harbors must have come from orders by the king. These ridiculous thoughts aggravated the already troubled minds, and finally, on January 2, 1504, two brothers named Porras—one the captain of one of the caravels and the other the military treasurer—led the discontented. They wanted to return to Europe, and they ran towards the admiral's tent shouting, "Castille! Castille!" Columbus was ill and in bed. His brother and son stood between him and the mutineers to protect him. When the rebels saw the elderly admiral, they paused, and their aggression lessened; however, they ignored his pleas and advice. They did not grasp that their only hope was unity, with everyone working for the common good, setting their selfishness aside. No! They had already decided to leave the island, no matter how. Porras and his followers rushed to the shore, took the natives' canoes, and headed toward the eastern end of the island. Once there, with no respect for anything and fueled by rage, they looted the Indians' homes—thus making the admiral liable for their violent actions—and forcibly took some unfortunate natives aboard the stolen canoes. Porras and his companions continued their journey; but several leagues offshore, they were hit by a strong wind that put them in danger. To lighten the canoes, they tossed their prisoners overboard. After this brutal act, the canoes tried to follow the paths of Méndez and Fieschi to reach the island of Hispaniola, but they were unsuccessful, continually being pushed back to the shores of Jamaica.
Meanwhile the admiral, left alone with his friends and the sick, succeeded in establishing order in his little world. But the distress increased, and famine threatened. The natives wearied of providing food for these foreigners, whose sojourn upon their island was so prolonged; besides, they had seen the Spaniards fighting amongst themselves, a sight which had much destroyed their prestige, and convinced the Indians that these Europeans were nothing more than ordinary mortals; thus, they no longer respected nor feared them. The authority of Columbus over the native population was diminishing day by day, and an accidental circumstance was needed, of which the admiral cleverly took advantage, to bring back a renown which was necessary for the safety of his companions.
Meanwhile, the admiral, left alone with his friends and the sick, managed to bring order to his small world. But the distress grew, and famine became a real threat. The locals grew tired of providing food for these foreigners, whose stay on their island was dragging on; besides, they had witnessed the Spaniards fighting among themselves, which greatly damaged their prestige and convinced the Indians that these Europeans were just regular people; as a result, they no longer respected or feared them. Columbus's authority over the native population was fading day by day, and a chance event was needed, which the admiral cleverly took advantage of, to restore the reputation necessary for the safety of his companions.
A lunar eclipse, foreseen and calculated by Columbus, was due on a certain day. On the morning of this day, the admiral sent to request an interview with the caciques of the island. They accepted the invitation, and when they were assembled in the tent of Columbus, the latter announced to them that God, desirous of punishing them for their inhospitable conduct, and their bad feeling towards the Spaniards, would that evening refuse them the light of the moon. All came to pass as the admiral had foretold; the shadow of the earth began to conceal the moon, whose disc had the appearance of being eaten away by some formidable monster. The savages in terror cast themselves at the feet of Columbus, praying him to intercede with Heaven on their behalf, and promising to place all they had at his disposal. Columbus, after some well feigned hesitation, pretended to yield to the prayers of the natives. Under pretext of supplicating the Deity, he remained in his tent during the whole time of the eclipse, only reappearing at the moment when the phenomenon was nearly over. Then he told the caciques that God had heard his prayer, and extending his arm he commanded the moon to reappear. Soon the disc was seen to issue from the cone of the shadow, and the queen of night shone forth in all her splendour. From that day forward, the grateful and submissive Indians accepted the admiral's authority as one manifestly delegated to him by the celestial powers.
A lunar eclipse, predicted and calculated by Columbus, was set to occur on a specific day. On the morning of that day, the admiral sent a message requesting a meeting with the island's leaders. They accepted the invitation, and when they gathered in Columbus's tent, he informed them that God, wanting to punish them for their unwelcoming behavior and their hostility towards the Spaniards, would deny them the moon's light that evening. Everything happened just as the admiral had predicted; the Earth's shadow began to cover the moon, making it look like it was being devoured by some terrifying creature. The terrified natives fell at Columbus's feet, begging him to plead with Heaven for them and vowing to give him everything they had. Columbus, after feigning hesitation, pretended to agree to the natives' requests. Under the guise of praying to God, he stayed in his tent for the entire duration of the eclipse, only emerging when the phenomenon was almost over. He then told the leaders that God had heard his prayer and, raising his arm, commanded the moon to reappear. Soon, the moon emerged from the shadow, shining brightly in all her glory. From that day on, the grateful and obedient natives accepted the admiral's authority as one clearly given to him by heavenly powers.
While these events were passing at Jamaica, Mendez and Fieschi had long ago arrived at their destination. These brave officers had reached Hispaniola after a voyage of four days, little short of miraculous, accomplished as it was in a frail canoe. They immediately made the governor acquainted with the desperate condition of Columbus and his companions. Ovando, in a spirit of malice and injustice, detained these officers, and after a delay of eight months, under pretext of ascertaining the real condition of affairs, he despatched to Jamaica one of his own followers, a man named Diego Escobar, who was an especial enemy to Columbus. Escobar, on his arrival at Jamaica, would not communicate with Columbus; he did not even land, but contented himself with putting on shore, for the use of the distressed crews, "a side of pork and a barrel of wine;" then he again set sail without having allowed a single person to come on board. This infamous behaviour is but too real, although humanity almost refuses to believe in it.
While these events were unfolding in Jamaica, Mendez and Fieschi had long reached their destination. These brave officers arrived in Hispaniola after a four-day journey, almost miraculous considering they traveled in a fragile canoe. They immediately informed the governor about the desperate situation of Columbus and his crew. Ovando, acting out of malice and unfairness, detained these officers, and after an eight-month delay, under the guise of checking the real situation, he sent one of his own men, Diego Escobar, who was a known enemy of Columbus, to Jamaica. Upon arriving in Jamaica, Escobar refused to communicate with Columbus; he didn't even land but simply sent ashore, for the use of the stranded crews, "a side of pork and a barrel of wine," before sailing away without letting anyone come on board. This despicable behavior is all too real, even though it's hard to believe.
The admiral was indignant over this cruel mockery; but he showed no violence, used no recrimination. The arrival of Escobar somewhat reassured the shipwrecked men, for at least it proved that their situation was known. Deliverance was therefore only a matter of time, and the morale of the Spaniards gradually improved.
The admiral was furious over this cruel mockery, but he didn't react with violence or blame. The arrival of Escobar somewhat comforted the shipwrecked men, as it showed that their situation was acknowledged. Rescue was just a matter of time, and the morale of the Spaniards gradually got better.
The admiral was desirous of bringing about a reconciliation with Porras and the rebels, who, since their separation, had incessantly ravaged the island, and been guilty of odious cruelties towards the unfortunate natives. Columbus proposed to restore them to favour, but these foolish people only answered his generous overtures by advancing to attack him in his retreat. Those Spaniards who had remained faithful to the cause of order, were obliged to take up arms, and they valiantly defended the admiral, losing but one man in this sad affair. They took both the brothers Porras prisoners, and remained masters of the field of battle: then the rebels threw themselves on their knees before Columbus, who, in compassion for their sufferings, granted them pardon.
The admiral wanted to reconcile with Porras and the rebels, who had continuously devastated the island since breaking away and committed terrible acts against the unfortunate natives. Columbus suggested restoring their favor, but these foolish people only responded to his generous offers by moving to attack him as he retreated. The Spaniards who remained loyal to the cause of order had to take up arms and bravely defended the admiral, losing just one man in this unfortunate conflict. They captured both Porras brothers and took control of the battlefield; then the rebels knelt before Columbus, who, feeling compassion for their suffering, granted them forgiveness.
At length, just one year after the departure of Mendez and Fieschi, a ship appeared, equipped by them at the expense of Columbus, which was destined to restore the shipwrecked company to their homes. On the 24th of June, 1504, every one went on board, and quitting Jamaica, the theatre of accumulated miseries, both moral and physical, they set sail for Hispaniola. Arrived in harbour, after a prosperous voyage, Columbus, to his no small surprise, found himself at first received with much respect, the governor Ovando, as a shrewd man not willing to go against public opinion, doing him honour. But this happy temper did not last. Soon the quarrels recommenced, and then Columbus, unable as well as unwilling to hear more, humiliated, and even maltreated, freighted two ships, of which he shared the command with his brother Bartolomeo, and on the 12th of September, 1504, he for the last time set out for Europe.
At last, just a year after Mendez and Fieschi left, a ship appeared, funded by them at Columbus's expense, which was meant to take the shipwrecked crew back home. On June 24, 1504, everyone boarded the ship, leaving Jamaica, a place filled with suffering, both emotional and physical, and set sail for Hispaniola. Upon arriving in the harbor after a successful voyage, Columbus was initially surprised to be greeted with a great deal of respect, as the governor Ovando, being a clever man, wanted to align himself with public opinion. However, this good mood didn’t last. Conflicts soon erupted again, and Columbus, both unwilling and unable to endure it any longer, feeling humiliated and even mistreated, loaded two ships, sharing command with his brother Bartolomeo, and on September 12, 1504, he set out for Europe one last time.
His fourth voyage had increased geographical knowledge by the discovery of the Cayman Islands, Martinique, Guanaja, the Limonare Islands, with the coasts of Honduras, Mosquito, Nicaragua, Veragua, Costa-Rica, Porto-Bello, and Panama, the Mulatas Islands, and the Gulf of Darien.
His fourth voyage expanded geographical knowledge by discovering the Cayman Islands, Martinique, Guanaja, the Limonare Islands, as well as the coasts of Honduras, Mosquito, Nicaragua, Veragua, Costa Rica, Porto Bello, and Panama, along with the Mulatas Islands and the Gulf of Darien.
During this, his last voyage across the ocean, Columbus was destined to be again tried by storms. His own vessel was disabled, and he and his crew were obliged to go on board his brother's ship. On the 19th of October, another fearful hurricane broke the mast of this vessel, which had then to make more than two thousand miles with incomplete sails. At last, on the 7th of November, the admiral entered the harbour of San-Lucar. Here a sad piece of news was awaiting him. Isabella, his generous protectress, was dead. Who was there now to take an interest in the old Genoese?
During his final voyage across the ocean, Columbus faced yet another round of storms. His ship was damaged, and he and his crew had to board his brother's ship. On October 19th, another terrible hurricane broke the mast of this vessel, which then had to travel more than two thousand miles with damaged sails. Finally, on November 7th, the admiral arrived in the harbor of San-Lucar. Here, he was met with tragic news. Isabella, his generous supporter, had died. Who was left to care about the old Genoese now?
The admiral was coldly received by the ungrateful and jealous king Ferdinand, who did not even disdain to use subterfuges and delays, hoping thus to evade the solemn treaties given under his sign manual; he ended by proposing to Columbus the acceptance of a small Castilian town, Camon de los Condes, in exchange for his titles and dignities. This ingratitude and faithlessness overwhelmed the aged man; his health, already so much impaired, did not improve, and grief carried him to the grave. On the 20th of May, at Valladolid, at the age of seventy, he rendered up his soul to God with these words: "O Lord, into Thy hands I resign my soul and body."
The admiral was met with coldness by the ungrateful and jealous King Ferdinand, who even resorted to tricks and delays, hoping to dodge the serious treaties he had signed. Ultimately, he proposed that Columbus accept a small Castilian town, Camon de los Condes, in exchange for his titles and honors. This ingratitude and betrayal crushed the elderly man; his already poor health didn’t improve, and sorrow took him to his grave. On May 20th, in Valladolid, at the age of seventy, he surrendered his soul to God with these words: "O Lord, into Thy hands I resign my soul and body."
The remains of Columbus were at first laid in the monastery of St. Francis; in 1513, they were removed to the Carthusian monastery of Seville. But it seemed as if, even after death, repose were to be denied to the great navigator, for in 1536 his body was transported to the cathedral of San Domingo. Local tradition affirms that when, after the Treaty of Basle in 1795, the Spanish government, before giving up to France the eastern portion of the island of San Domingo, ordered the removal of the ashes of the great sailor to Havana, a canon substituted some other remains for those of Christopher Columbus, and that the latter were deposited in the choir of the cathedral, to the left of the altar. Thanks to this manoeuvre of the canon, whether dictated by a sentiment of local patriotism or by respect to the last wishes of Columbus who had indicated San Domingo as his chosen place of sepulture, it is not the dust of the illustrious navigator which Spain possesses at Havana, but probably that of his brother Diego. The discovery so lately made in the cathedral of San Domingo, on the 10th of September, 1877, of a leaden chest containing human bones, and bearing an inscription stating that it encloses the remains of the Discoverer of America, seems to confirm in every particular the tradition which has been just mentioned.
The remains of Columbus were initially placed in the monastery of St. Francis; in 1513, they were moved to the Carthusian monastery of Seville. However, it seemed that even in death, the great navigator could not find peace, for in 1536, his body was transferred to the cathedral of San Domingo. Local tradition claims that after the Treaty of Basle in 1795, when the Spanish government decided to give up the eastern part of the island of San Domingo to France, they ordered the ashes of the great sailor to be moved to Havana. A canon allegedly swapped in some other remains for those of Christopher Columbus, and the latter were laid to rest in the choir of the cathedral, to the left of the altar. Thanks to this action by the canon, motivated either by local patriotism or by respect for Columbus's last wishes to be buried in San Domingo, Spain likely possesses not the remains of the illustrious navigator in Havana, but instead those of his brother Diego. The discovery made on September 10, 1877, in the cathedral of San Domingo, of a leaden chest containing human bones and inscribed as holding the remains of the Discoverer of America, seems to validate the aforementioned tradition.
But after all, it matters little whether the body of Columbus be at San Domingo or at Havana; his name and his glory are everywhere.
But in the end, it doesn't really matter if Columbus's remains are in San Domingo or Havana; his name and legacy are known everywhere.
CHAPTER VIII.
I.
Covilham and Païva—Vasco da Gama—The Cape of Good Hope is doubled—Escalès at Sam-Braz—Mozambique, Mombaz, and Melinda—Arrival at Calicut—Treason of the Zamorin—Battles—Return to Europe—The scurvy—Death of Paul da Gama—Arrival at Lisbon.
Covilham and Païva—Vasco da Gama—The Cape of Good Hope is rounded—Escalès at Sam-Braz—Mozambique, Mombaz, and Melinda—Arrival in Calicut—Betrayal by the Zamorin—Battles—Return to Europe—The scurvy—Death of Paul da Gama—Arrival in Lisbon.
At the same time that the King of Portugal, John II., despatched Diaz to seek in the south of Africa the route to the Indies, he ordered two gentlemen of his court to find out if it would not be possible to attain the same end by an easier, safer, and more rapid means; by way of the isthmus of Suez, the Red Sea, and the Indian Ocean.
At the same time that the King of Portugal, John II, sent Diaz to search for the route to the Indies in southern Africa, he instructed two noblemen from his court to investigate whether it would be possible to reach the same goal using an easier, safer, and faster method; through the isthmus of Suez, the Red Sea, and the Indian Ocean.
For carrying out such a mission there was needed a clever, enterprising man, well acquainted with the difficulties of a journey in those regions, and possessing a knowledge of the Oriental languages, or at the very least, of Arabic. This agent must be of a versatile disposition, and able to dissemble; capable, in a word, of concealing the real meaning of projects which aimed at nothing less than withdrawing all the commerce of Asia from the hands of the Mussulmans and Arabs, and through them from the Venetians, in order to enrich Portugal with it.
To carry out such a mission, a clever and resourceful person was needed, someone who understood the challenges of traveling in those areas and had knowledge of Eastern languages, or at least Arabic. This agent had to be adaptable and able to disguise their true intentions; in short, capable of hiding the true goals of plans that aimed to take all of Asia's trade away from the Muslims and Arabs, and through them from the Venetians, to enrich Portugal.
There was living at this time an experienced navigator, Pedro de Covilham, who had served with distinction under Alonzo V. in the war with Castille, and who had made a long stay in Africa. It was upon him that John II. cast his eye, and Alonzo de Païva was given him as a colleague. They left Lisbon in the month of May, 1487, furnished with detailed instructions, and with a chart drawn according to Bishop Calsadilla's map of the World, by the help of which the tour of Africa might be made.
There was an experienced navigator named Pedro de Covilham, who had served with distinction under Alonzo V. during the war with Castille and had spent a significant amount of time in Africa. John II. decided to enlist him, and Alonzo de Païva was appointed as his partner. They left Lisbon in May 1487, equipped with detailed instructions and a map based on Bishop Calsadilla's World map, which would help them navigate around Africa.
The two travellers reached Alexandria and Cairo, where they were much gratified at meeting with some Moorish traders from Fez and Tlemcen, who conducted them to Tor—the ancient Ezion-geber—at the foot of Sinai, where they were able to procure some valuable information upon the trade of Calicut. Covilham resolved to take advantage of this fortunate circumstance to visit a country which, for more than a century, had been regarded by Portugal with covetous longing, while Païva set out to penetrate into those regions then so vaguely designated as Ethiopia, in quest of the famous Prester John, who, according to old travellers, reigned over a marvellously rich and fertile country in Africa. Païva doubtless perished in his adventurous enterprise, being never again heard of.
The two travelers arrived in Alexandria and Cairo, where they were thrilled to meet some Moorish traders from Fez and Tlemcen, who guided them to Tor—the ancient Ezion-geber—at the base of Sinai, where they gathered some valuable information about the trade in Calicut. Covilham decided to take advantage of this lucky opportunity to visit a country that had been desired by Portugal for over a century, while Païva set off to explore the regions then vaguely known as Ethiopia, in search of the legendary Prester John, who, according to old travelers, ruled over an incredibly rich and fertile land in Africa. Unfortunately, Païva likely perished in his daring quest, as he was never heard from again.
As for Covilham, he travelled to Aden, whence he embarked for the Malabar coast. He visited in succession Cananore, Calicut, and Goa, and collected accurate information upon the commerce and productions of the countries bordering on the Indian Ocean, without arousing the fears of the Hindoos, who could not suspect that the kind and friendly welcome they accorded to the traveller would bring about in the future the enthralment and ruin of their country. Covilham, not considering that he had yet done enough for his country, quitted India, and went to the eastern coast of Africa, where he visited Mozambique, Sofala—long famous for its gold-mines, of which the reputation, by means of the Arabs, had even reached Europe—and Zeila, the Avalites portus of the ancients, and the principal town of the Adel coast, upon the Gulf of Oman, at the entrance of the Arabian Sea. After a somewhat long stay in that country, he returned by Aden, then the principal entrepôt of the commerce of the east, went as far as Ormuz, at the entrance of the Persian Gulf, and then again passing up the Red Sea, he arrived at Cairo.
As for Covilham, he traveled to Aden, from where he boarded a ship to the Malabar coast. He visited Cananore, Calicut, and Goa in turn and gathered detailed information about the trade and resources of the countries along the Indian Ocean, without raising the suspicions of the Hindus, who could not imagine that the warm and friendly welcome they gave to the traveler would eventually lead to the subjugation and downfall of their land. Covilham, believing he hadn't done enough for his country, left India and headed to the eastern coast of Africa, where he visited Mozambique, Sofala—renowned for its gold mines, which even had a reputation that reached Europe thanks to the Arabs—and Zeila, the Avalites portus of the ancients, and the main town of the Adel coast, located on the Gulf of Oman, at the entrance of the Arabian Sea. After staying there for a while, he returned via Aden, which was then the main hub of eastern trade, traveled as far as Ormuz, at the entrance of the Persian Gulf, and then made his way back up the Red Sea to arrive in Cairo.
John II. had sent to Cairo two learned Jews to await the arrival of Covilham, and to one of these, the Rabbi Abraham Beja, the traveller gave his notes, the itinerary of his journey, and a map of Africa given to him by a Mussulman, charging Beja to carry them all to Lisbon with the least possible delay. For himself, not content with all that he had done hitherto, and wishing to execute the mission which death had prevented Païva from accomplishing, he went into Abyssinia, where the "negus" or king, known by the name of Prester John, flattered by seeing his alliance sought by one of the most powerful sovereigns of Europe, received him with the greatest kindness, and gave him a high position at his court, but to make sure of retaining his services, he constantly refused him permission to leave the country. Although he had married there and had some children, Covilham still longed for his native country, and when, in 1525, a Portuguese embassy, of which Alvarès was a member, came into Abyssinia, he witnessed the departure of his countrymen with the deepest regret, and the chaplain of the expedition has naïvely re-echoed his complaints and his grief.
John II had sent two learned Jews to Cairo to wait for Covilham's arrival, and to one of them, Rabbi Abraham Beja, the traveler gave his notes, the itinerary of his journey, and a map of Africa that a Muslim had given him, asking Beja to take them all to Lisbon as quickly as possible. For himself, not satisfied with everything he had done so far, and wishing to complete the mission that death had prevented Païva from finishing, he went to Abyssinia, where the "negus," or king, known as Prester John, pleased by the alliance sought by one of the most powerful rulers in Europe, welcomed him warmly and gave him a high position at his court. However, to ensure that he would stay, the king constantly denied him permission to leave the country. Although Covilham married and had children there, he still yearned for his homeland, and when, in 1525, a Portuguese embassy that included Alvarès arrived in Abyssinia, he watched his fellow countrymen depart with deep sadness. The chaplain of the expedition candidly echoed his complaints and sorrow.
M. Ferdinand Denis says, "By furnishing precise information upon the possibility of circumnavigating Africa, by indicating the route to the Indies, by giving more positive and extended ideas upon the commerce of these countries, and above all, by describing the gold-mines of Sofala, and so exciting the cupidity of the Portuguese, Covilham contributed greatly to accelerate the expedition of Gama."
M. Ferdinand Denis says, "By providing accurate information on the possibility of sailing around Africa, by pointing out the route to the Indies, by offering clearer and more detailed insights into the trade of these regions, and especially by describing the gold mines of Sofala, which stirred the greed of the Portuguese, Covilham significantly helped speed up Gama's expedition."
![]() |
Vasco da Gama. From an old print. |
If one may believe an old tradition, but one which is unsupported by any authentic document, Gama was descended by an illegitimate line from Alphonso III., King of Portugal. His father, Estevam Eanez da Gama, grand alcalde of Sinès and of Silvès, in the kingdom of Algarve, and commander of Seizal, occupied a high position at the court of John II. He enjoyed great reputation as a sailor, so much so, that just at the moment when his own unexpected death occurred, King John was thinking of giving Gama the command of the fleet which he was desirous of sending to the Indies. By his marriage with Dona Isabella Sodré, daughter of Juan de Resende, proveditore of the fortifications of Santarem, he had several children, and amongst them Vasco, who first reached India by doubling the Cape of Good Hope, and Paul, who accompanied him in that memorable expedition. It is known that Vasco was born at Sinès, but the date of his birth is uncertain; the year 1469 is that generally given, but besides the fact that if this be the correct date, Gama would have been very young—not more than eight and twenty—when the important command of the expedition to the Indies was confided to him, there was discovered twenty years ago, amongst the Spanish archives, a safe-conduct to Tangier granted in 1478 to two persons, Vasco da Gama and Lemos. It is scarcely probable that such a passport would have been given to a child of nine years of age, so that this discovery would appear to carry back the birth of the celebrated voyager to an earlier date.
If you can trust an old tradition, though there's no real proof for it, Gama was said to be an illegitimate descendant of Alphonso III, King of Portugal. His father, Estevam Eanez da Gama, the grand alcalde of Sinès and Silvès in the Algarve region, and commander of Seizal, held a prominent position at the court of John II. He was highly regarded as a sailor, so much so that right before his unexpected death, King John was considering giving Gama command of the fleet he wanted to send to the Indies. Through his marriage to Dona Isabella Sodré, daughter of Juan de Resende, who oversaw the fortifications of Santarem, he had several children, including Vasco, who first reached India by sailing around the Cape of Good Hope, and Paul, who accompanied him on that historic journey. It is known that Vasco was born in Sinès, but the exact date of his birth is unclear; 1469 is the year commonly cited. However, if that year is correct, Gama would have been quite young—only about twenty-eight—when he was entrusted with the significant mission to the Indies. Additionally, twenty years ago, a safe-conduct to Tangier from 1478 was found among the Spanish archives, which was issued to two people, Vasco da Gama and Lemos. It's unlikely that a passport would be granted to a nine-year-old, suggesting that the birth year of the famous explorer might be earlier than generally believed.
It seems that from an early period of his life, Vasco da Gama was destined to follow the career of a sailor, in which his father had distinguished himself. The first historian of the Indies, Lopez de Castañeda, delights in recalling the fact that he had signalized himself upon the African seas. At one time he was ordered to seize all the French ships lying in the Portuguese ports, in revenge for the capture by French pirates during a time of peace of a rich Portuguese galleon returning from Mina. Such a mission would only have been confided to an active, energetic and well-tried captain, a clear proof that Gama's valour and cleverness were highly appreciated by the king.
It seems that from an early age, Vasco da Gama was meant to become a sailor, just like his father, who had made a name for himself in that profession. The first historian of the Indies, Lopez de Castañeda, enjoys mentioning how Gama had distinguished himself on the African seas. At one point, he was ordered to capture all the French ships in Portuguese ports as retaliation for French pirates seizing a wealthy Portuguese galleon returning from Mina during peacetime. Such a mission would only have been entrusted to an active, energetic, and experienced captain, clearly showing that Gama's bravery and skill were highly valued by the king.
About this time he married Dona Caterina de Ataïde, one of the highest ladies about the court, and by her he had several children, amongst others Estevam da Gama, who became governor of the Indies, and Dom Christovam, who, says Gaucher, by his struggle with Ahmed Guerad in Abyssinia, and by his romantic death, deserves to be reckoned amongst the famous adventurers of the sixteenth century.
Around this time, he married Dona Caterina de Ataïde, one of the most prominent ladies at court, and they had several children, including Estevam da Gama, who became governor of the Indies, and Dom Christovam, who, according to Gaucher, should be regarded as one of the famous adventurers of the sixteenth century due to his fight with Ahmed Guerad in Abyssinia and his dramatic death.
All doubt as to the precise date of Gama's first voyage is now at an end, thanks to the document in the public library at Oporto, a paper with which Castañeda must have been acquainted, and of which M. Ferdinand Denis has published a translation in the Ancient and Modern Travellers of M. E. Charton. The date may be fixed with certainty for Saturday, the 8th of July, 1497.
All uncertainty about the exact date of Gama's first voyage is now resolved, thanks to a document in the public library in Oporto, a paper that Castañeda must have known about, and which M. Ferdinand Denis has published a translation of in the Ancient and Modern Travellers by M. E. Charton. The date can be confidently set as Saturday, July 8, 1497.
This expedition had been long ago determined upon, and all its details were minutely arranged. It was to be composed of four vessels of medium size, "in order," says Pacheco, "that they may enter everywhere and again issue forth rapidly." They were solidly constructed, and provided with a triple supply of sails and hawsers; all the barrels destined to contain water, oil, or wine had been strengthened with iron hoops; large provisions of all kinds had been made, such as flour, wine, vegetables, drugs, and artillery; the personnel of the expedition consisted of the best sailors, the cleverest pilots, and the most experienced captains.
This expedition had been planned long ago, with all its details carefully arranged. It was to consist of four medium-sized vessels, "so that," as Pacheco puts it, "they can enter anywhere and quickly come back out." They were built sturdy and equipped with triple the supplies of sails and ropes; all the barrels meant for water, oil, or wine were reinforced with iron bands; ample provisions of everything like flour, wine, vegetables, medicine, and weaponry had been stocked. The crew of the expedition included the best sailors, the smartest pilots, and the most experienced captains.
Gama, who had received the title of Capitam mõr, hoisted his flag upon the Sam-Gabriel of 120 tons. His brother Paul da Gama was on board the Sam-Raphael of 100 tons. A caravel of 50 tons, the Berrio, so named in memory of the pilot Berrio, who had sold her to Emmanuel I., was commanded by an experienced sailor, Nicolo Coelho, while Pedro Nuñes was the captain of a large barque, laden with provisions and merchandise, destined for exchange with the natives of the countries which should be visited. Pero de Alemquer, who had been pilot to Bartholomew Diaz, was to regulate the course of the vessels. The crews, including ten criminals who were put on board to be employed on any dangerous service, amounted to one hundred and sixty persons. What feeble means these, what almost absurd resources, compared with the grandeur of the mission which these men were to accomplish!
Gama, who had been given the title of Capitam mõr, raised his flag on the Sam-Gabriel, which was 120 tons. His brother Paul da Gama was on the Sam-Raphael, a 100-ton vessel. A 50-ton caravel, the Berrio, named after the pilot Berrio who sold it to Emmanuel I., was captained by an experienced sailor, Nicolo Coelho. Pedro Nuñes was in charge of a large barque loaded with supplies and goods meant for trading with the natives of the lands they would visit. Pero de Alemquer, who had been the pilot for Bartholomew Diaz, was responsible for navigating the ships. The crews, which included ten criminals assigned to dangerous tasks, totaled one hundred and sixty people. What weak resources these were, what almost ridiculous means, compared to the grand mission these men were set to undertake!
On the 8th of July, at sunrise, Gama advanced towards the vessels, followed by his officers through an immense crowd of people. Around him were a number of monks and religious persons, who chanted sacred hymns, and besought Heaven's protection for the voyagers. This departure from Rastello must have been a singularly moving scene; all, whether actors or spectators, mingling their chants, their cries, their adieux and their tears, while the sails, filled by a favourable breeze, bore away Gama and the fortune of Portugal towards the open sea. A large caravel and a smaller barque, which were bound for Mina under the command of Bartholomew Diaz, sailed in company with Gama's fleet. On the following Saturday, the ships were in sight of the Canaries, and passed the night windward of Lancerota. When they arrived parallel with the Rio de Ouro, a thick fog separated Paul da Gama, Coelho, and Diaz from the rest of the fleet, but they joined again near the Cape de Verd Islands, which were soon reached. At Santiago fresh stores of meat, water, and wood were taken on board, and the ships were again put into good sailing order.
On July 8th, at sunrise, Gama moved towards the ships, followed by his officers through a huge crowd of people. Surrounding him were several monks and religious figures who sang sacred hymns, asking for Heaven’s protection for the travelers. The departure from Rastello must have been an incredibly emotional scene; everyone, whether they were part of the journey or just watching, mixed their songs, cries, farewells, and tears, while the sails, filled with a favorable breeze, carried Gama and the fortune of Portugal out to the open sea. A large caravel and a smaller barque, headed for Mina under Bartholomew Diaz's command, sailed alongside Gama's fleet. The next Saturday, the ships spotted the Canaries and spent the night off the coast of Lancerota. When they reached the area near the Rio de Ouro, a thick fog separated Paul da Gama, Coelho, and Diaz from the rest of the fleet, but they regrouped near the Cape Verde Islands, which they soon reached. In Santiago, they took on fresh supplies of meat, water, and wood, and got the ships back into good sailing condition.
![]() |
La Mina. From an old print. |
They quitted the shore of Santa Maria on the 3rd of August. The voyage was accomplished without any remarkable incidents, and on the 4th of November, anchors were dropped upon the African Coast in a bay which received the name of Santa-Ellena. Eight days were spent there in shipping wood, and in putting everything in order on board the vessels. It was there that they saw for the first time the Bushmen, a miserable and degraded race of people who fed upon the flesh of sea-wolves and whales, as well as upon roots. The Portuguese carried off some of these natives, and treated them with kindness. The savages knew nothing of the value of the merchandize which was offered to them, they saw the objects for the first time and were ignorant of their use. Copper was the only thing which they appeared to prize, wearing in their ears small chains of that metal. They understood well the use of the zagayes—a kind of javelin, of which the point is hardened in the fire—of which three or four of the sailors and even Gama himself had unpleasant experience, while endeavouring to rescue from their hands a certain Velloso, a man who had imprudently ventured into the interior of the country. This incident has furnished Camoens with one of the most charming episodes of the "Lusiad."
They left the shore of Santa Maria on August 3rd. The journey went smoothly without any significant incidents, and on November 4th, they dropped anchor on the African coast in a bay they named Santa-Ellena. They spent eight days there gathering wood and organizing everything on board the vessels. It was here that they encountered the Bushmen for the first time, a poor and troubled group of people who lived on the flesh of sea lions and whales, as well as on roots. The Portuguese took some of these natives with them and treated them kindly. The natives didn’t understand the value of the goods offered to them; they saw these objects for the first time and were unaware of their purpose. The only thing they seemed to value was copper, wearing small chains of the metal in their ears. They were very familiar with the use of zagayes—a type of javelin with a fire-hardened tip—of which three or four sailors, including Gama himself, had unpleasant experiences while trying to rescue a man named Velloso who had foolishly ventured into the interior of the country. This incident inspired Camoens to write one of the most delightful episodes in the "Lusiad."
On leaving Santa-Ellena, Pero de Alemquer, formerly pilot to Diaz, declared his belief that they were then ninety miles from the Cape, but in the uncertainty the fleet stood off to sea; on the 18th of November the Cape of Good Hope was seen, and the next day it was doubled by the fleet sailing before the wind. On the 25th the vessels were moored in the Bay of Sam-Braz, where they remained thirteen days, during which time the boat which carried the stores was demolished, and her cargo divided amongst the three other vessels. During their stay the Portuguese gave the Bushmen some hawks' bells and other objects, which, to their surprise, were accepted, for in the time of Diaz the negroes had shown themselves timid and even hostile, and had thrown stones to prevent the crews from procuring water. Now they brought oxen and sheep, and to show their pleasure at the visit of the Portuguese, "they began," says Nicolas Velho, "to play upon four or five flutes, some set high, some low, a wonderful harmony for negroes, from whom one scarcely looks for music. They danced also, as dance the blacks, and the Capitam mõr commanded the trumpets to sound, and we in our boats danced too, the Capitam mõr himself dancing, as soon as he had returned amongst us."
On leaving Santa-Ellena, Pero de Alemquer, who used to be the pilot for Diaz, expressed his belief that they were about ninety miles from the Cape. However, due to uncertainty, the fleet sailed out to sea; on November 18th, they sighted the Cape of Good Hope, and the following day, the fleet sailed around it with the wind at their backs. On the 25th, the ships anchored in the Bay of Sam-Braz, where they stayed for thirteen days. During this time, the boat carrying their supplies was destroyed, and its cargo was divided among the three other ships. While they were there, the Portuguese gave the Bushmen some hawks' bells and other items, which they were surprised to see accepted. In Diaz's time, the local negroes had been shy and even hostile, throwing stones to keep the crews from getting water. Now, they brought oxen and sheep, and to show their happiness at the Portuguese visit, "they began," as Nicolas Velho noted, "to play on four or five flutes, some high and some low, creating a wonderful harmony for negroes, from whom one hardly expects music. They also danced as black people do, and the Capitam mõr ordered the trumpets to sound, and we danced in our boats too, with the Capitam mõr himself joining in as soon as he returned to us."
What shall we say to this little fête and this mutual serenade between the Portuguese and the negroes? Would any one have expected to behold Gama, a grave man, as his portraits represent him, initiating the negroes into the charms of the pavane. Unhappily these favourable dispositions were transient, and it was found necessary to have recourse to some hostile demonstrations by means of repeated discharges of artillery.
What should we say about this little party and the mutual serenade between the Portuguese and the Black people? Would anyone have expected to see Gama, a serious man as his portraits show him, teaching the Black people the pleasures of the pavane? Unfortunately, these friendly feelings were short-lived, and it became necessary to resort to some aggressive displays through repeated cannon fire.
In this Bay of Sam-Braz Gama erected a padrao, which was thrown down as soon as he was gone. The fleet soon passed the Rio Infante, the furthest point reached by Diaz. Here the ships experienced the effects of a strong current, but of which the violence was neutralized thanks to a favourable wind. On the 25th of December, Christmas Day, the country of Natal was discovered.
In this Bay of Sam-Braz, Gama set up a stone monument, which was knocked down as soon as he left. The fleet quickly moved past the Rio Infante, the farthest point reached by Diaz. Here, the ships felt the impact of a strong current, but its force was lessened thanks to a good wind. On December 25th, Christmas Day, the land of Natal was found.
The ships had sustained some damage, and fresh water was needed; it was therefore urgent for them to find some harbour, which they succeeded in doing on the 10th of January, 1498. The blacks whom the Portuguese saw here upon landing were people of greater stature than those whom they had hitherto met with. Their arms were a large bow with long arrows, and a zagaye tipped with iron. They were Caffres, a race very superior to the Bushmen. Such happy relations were quickly established with them that Gama gave the country the name of the Land of Good People (Terra da bon Gente).
The ships had taken some damage, and they needed fresh water; so it was urgent for them to find a harbor, which they managed to do on January 10, 1498. The locals the Portuguese encountered upon landing were taller than those they had met before. Their weapons included a large bow with long arrows and a zagaye with an iron tip. They were Caffres, a group considered much superior to the Bushmen. Relations were established so positively that Gama named the area the Land of Good People (Terra da bon Gente).
![]() |
A little further on, while still sailing up the coast, two Mussulman traders, one wearing a turban, the other a hood of green satin, came to visit the Portuguese, with a young man who, "from what could be understood from their signs, belonged to a very distant country, and who said he had already seen ships as large as ours." Vasco da Gama, took this as a proof that he was now approaching those Indian lands, which had been so long and so eagerly sought. For this reason he named the river which flowed into the sea at this place Rio dos Bonis Signaes (River of good tokens). Unhappily the first symptoms of scurvy appeared at this time amongst the crews, and soon there were many sailors upon the sick list.
A little further along, while still sailing up the coast, two Muslim traders, one wearing a turban and the other in a green satin hood, came to visit the Portuguese, along with a young man who, from what could be gathered from their gestures, was from a very distant country and claimed he had already seen ships as large as theirs. Vasco da Gama saw this as a sign that he was getting closer to those Indian lands that had been sought after for so long. For this reason, he named the river that flowed into the sea at this spot Rio dos Bonis Signaes (River of good signs). Unfortunately, the first signs of scurvy appeared among the crew at this time, and soon many sailors were on the sick list.
On the 10th of March the expedition cast anchor before the Island of Mozambique, where, as Gama learnt through his Arab interpreters, there were several merchants of Mahometan extraction, who carried on trade with India. Gold and silver, cloth and spices, pearls and rubies, formed the staple of their commerce. Gama at the same time was assured that in pursuing the line of the coast, he would find numerous cities; "Whereat we were so joyful," says Velho in his naïve and valuable narrative, "that we wept for pleasure, praying God to grant us health that we might see all that which we had so much desired."
On March 10th, the expedition dropped anchor near the Island of Mozambique, where Gama learned from his Arab interpreters that there were several Muslim merchants who traded with India. Gold and silver, cloth and spices, pearls and rubies were the main items of their commerce. At the same time, Gama was told that as he continued along the coast, he would discover many cities. "This made us so happy," Velho describes in his simple yet valuable account, "that we cried from joy, praying to God for good health so we could see all that we had longed for."
![]() |
Mozambique Channel. |
The Viceroy Colyytam, who imagined he was dealing with Mussulmen, came on board several times and was magnificently entertained; he returned the civility by sending presents, and even furnished Gama with two skilful pilots, but when some Moorish merchants who had traded in Europe told him that these foreigners, far from being Turks, were in reality the worst enemies of the Mahometans, the viceroy, disgusted at his mistake, made preparations for seizing the Portuguese by treachery, and killing them. Gama was obliged to point his artillery at the town and threaten to reduce it to ashes before he could obtain the water needed for the prosecution of his voyage. Blood flowed, and Paul da Gama captured two barques, whose rich cargo was divided amongst the sailors. The ships quitted this inhospitable town, on the 29th of March, and the voyage continued, a close surveillance being kept over the Arab pilots, whom Gama was obliged to cause to be flogged.
The Viceroy Colyytam, who thought he was dealing with Muslims, visited several times and was hosted lavishly; in return, he sent gifts and even provided Gama with two skilled pilots. However, when some Moorish merchants who had traded in Europe informed him that these outsiders, far from being Turks, were actually the worst enemies of the Muslims, the viceroy, upset about his mistake, began planning to capture the Portuguese through deceit and eliminate them. Gama had to aim his artillery at the town and threaten to destroy it before he could secure the water necessary for his journey. Blood was shed, and Paul da Gama seized two ships, distributing the valuable cargo among the crew. The ships left this hostile town on March 29th, and the voyage continued, with close watch kept on the Arab pilots, whom Gama had to order to be whipped.
On the 4th of April the coast was seen, and on the 8th Mombasa or Mombaz was reached, a town, according to the pilots, inhabited by Christians and Mussulmen. The fleet dropped anchor outside the harbour, and did not enter it, notwithstanding the enthusiastic reception given to them. Already the Portuguese were reckoning upon meeting at mass the next day with the Christians of the Island, when during the night, the flag-ship was approached by a zacra, having on board a hundred armed men, who endeavoured to enter the ships in a body, which was refused them. The king of Mombaz was informed of all that had occurred at Mozambique, but pretending ignorance, he sent presents to Gama, proposing to him to establish a factory in his capital, and assuring him that so soon as he should have entered the port, he might take on board a cargo of spices and aromatics. The Capitam mõr, suspecting nothing, immediately sent two men to announce his entry for the morrow; already they were weighing anchor when the flag-ship refusing to tack, the anchor was let fall again. In graceful and poetic fiction, Camoens affirms that it was the Nereids led by Venus, the protectress of the Portuguese, who stayed their ships when on the point of entering the port. At this moment all the Moors on board the fleet quitted it simultaneously, whilst the Mozambique pilots threw themselves into the sea.
On April 4th, the coast was sighted, and by the 8th, Mombasa, also known as Mombaz, was reached. According to the pilots, it was a town inhabited by both Christians and Muslims. The fleet anchored just outside the harbor and didn’t go in, despite the enthusiastic welcome they received. The Portuguese were already looking forward to attending mass with the Christians on the island the next day when, during the night, a zacra approached the flagship, carrying a hundred armed men who tried to board the ships as a group, which they were denied. The king of Mombaz was informed about everything that happened at Mozambique, but he feigned ignorance and sent gifts to Gama, suggesting he set up a trading post in his capital and assuring him that as soon as he entered the port, he could load up on spices and other fragrant goods. The captain, suspecting nothing, immediately sent two men to announce his arrival for the next day; they were already weighing anchor when the flagship refused to change course, and the anchor was dropped once more. In a graceful and poetic tale, Camoens claims that it was the Nereids, led by Venus, the protector of the Portuguese, who held their ships back at the moment they were about to enter the port. At this point, all the Moors on board the fleet simultaneously left, while the Mozambique pilots jumped overboard.
Two Moors who were put to the question with a drop of hot oil, confessed that the intention was to take all the Portuguese prisoners as soon as they should be inside the harbour. During the night the Moors endeavoured several times to climb on board and to cut the cables in order to run the ships aground, but each time they were discovered. Under these circumstances no prolonged stay was possible at Mombaz, but it had been long enough for all those ill of scurvy to recover their health.
Two Moors who were tortured with hot oil confessed that their plan was to capture all the Portuguese prisoners as soon as they entered the harbor. During the night, the Moors tried several times to board the ships and cut the cables to run them aground, but they were caught each time. Given the situation, staying at Mombaz any longer wasn't feasible, but it had been long enough for those sick with scurvy to regain their health.
At the distance of four-and-twenty miles from land, the fleet captured a barque richly laden with gold, silver, and provisions. The next day Gama arrived at Melinda, a rich and flourishing city, whose gilded minarets, sparkling in the sunshine, and whose mosques of dazzling whiteness, stood out against a sky of the most intense blue. The reception of the Portuguese at Melinda was at first very cold, the capture of the barque the evening before being already known there, but as soon as explanations had been given, the people became cordial. The king's son came to visit the admiral, accompanied by a train of courtiers splendidly dressed, and a choir of musicians, who played upon various instruments. The greatest astonishment was shown at the artillery practice, for the invention of gunpowder was not yet known on the east coast of Africa. A solemn treaty was made, ratified by oaths upon the Gospel and the Koran, and cemented by an interchange of presents. From this moment the ill-will, the treachery, the difficulties of all kinds which had hitherto beset the expedition, ceased as if by magic: this must be attributed to the generosity of the King of Melinda, and to the aid which he furnished to the Portuguese.
At a distance of twenty-four miles from land, the fleet captured a ship loaded with gold, silver, and supplies. The next day, Gama arrived at Melinda, a wealthy and thriving city, with its golden minarets shining in the sunlight and its brilliantly white mosques standing out against an intensely blue sky. The Portuguese were initially received coldly in Melinda, as news of the ship's capture the evening before had already reached them. However, once explanations were provided, the locals became friendly. The king's son came to visit the admiral, accompanied by a group of elegantly dressed courtiers and a choir of musicians playing various instruments. People were amazed by the artillery display, as gunpowder had not yet been introduced on the east coast of Africa. A formal treaty was created, confirmed by oaths on both the Gospel and the Koran, and solidified through the exchange of gifts. From that moment on, the animosity, deceit, and various challenges that had plagued the expedition vanished as if by magic; this was due to the kindness of the King of Melinda and the support he provided to the Portuguese.
Faithful to the promise which he had made to Vasco da Gama, the king sent him a Gujerat pilot named Malemo Cana, a man well instructed in navigation, understanding the use of charts, of the compass and the quadrant, and who rendered the most important service to the expedition. After a stay of nine days the fleet weighed anchor for Calicut. The coasting plan hitherto pursued was now to be abandoned, and the time was come when, in reliance upon the blessing of God, the Portuguese must venture out upon the wide ocean, without other guide than an unknown pilot furnished by a king whose kind welcome had not sufficed to lull to sleep the suspicions of the foreigners. And yet, thanks to the ability and loyalty of this pilot, thanks also to the clemency of the sea, and to the wind being constantly in its favour, the fleet, after a twenty-three days' voyage, reached the land on the 17th May, and the next day anchored at the distance of six miles below Calicut. The enthusiasm on board was great. At last they had arrived in those rich and wonderful countries. Fatigues, dangers, sickness, all were forgotten. The object of their long labours was attained! Or rather, it seemed to be so, for there was still needed the possession of the treasures and rich productions of India.
True to the promise he made to Vasco da Gama, the king sent him a pilot from Gujerat named Malemo Cana, a skilled navigator who understood charts, the compass, and the quadrant, and who provided crucial support to the expedition. After a nine-day stay, the fleet set sail for Calicut. The coastal route they'd been taking was now to be abandoned, and the time had come when, trusting in God's blessing, the Portuguese had to venture out into the open ocean, guided only by an unknown pilot supplied by a king whose warm welcome hadn't eased the suspicions of the foreigners. Yet, thanks to this pilot's skill and loyalty, as well as the calmness of the sea and favorable winds, the fleet reached land after twenty-three days on May 17th, and the next day anchored six miles from Calicut. The excitement on board was immense. They had finally arrived in those rich and marvelous lands. Exhaustion, danger, and sickness were all forgotten. They had achieved the goal of their long efforts! Or so it seemed, because they still needed to possess the treasures and valuable products of India.
Scarcely were the anchors dropped when four boats came off from the shore, performing evolutions around the fleet, and apparently inviting the sailors to disembark. But Gama, rendered cautious by the occurrences at Mozambique and Mombaz, sent on shore one of the criminals who were on board, to act as a scout; ordering him to walk through the town and endeavour to ascertain the temper of its inhabitants. Surrounded by an inquisitive crowd, assailed by questions to which he could not reply, this man was conducted to the house of a Moor named Mouçaïda, who spoke Spanish, and to whom he gave a short account of the voyage of the fleet. Mouçaïda returned with him on board, and his first words on setting foot on the ship were "Good luck! good luck! quantities of rubies, quantities of emeralds!" Whereupon, Mouçaïda was at once engaged as interpreter.
Scarcely had the anchors been dropped when four boats came off from the shore, circling around the fleet and seemingly inviting the sailors to disembark. But Gama, wary from the events at Mozambique and Mombaz, sent one of the criminals on board to act as a scout; he instructed him to walk through the town and try to gauge the mood of its residents. Surrounded by a curious crowd and bombarded with questions he couldn't answer, the man was taken to the house of a Moor named Mouçaïda, who spoke Spanish. He gave Mouçaïda a brief summary of the fleet's journey. Mouçaïda returned with him to the ship, and his first words upon stepping aboard were, "Good luck! Good luck! Lots of rubies, lots of emeralds!" At that point, Mouçaïda was immediately hired as an interpreter.
The King of Calicut was at this time at a distance of forty-five miles from his capital, so the Capitam mõr despatched two men to announce the arrival of an ambassador from the King of Portugal, being the bearer of letters to him from his sovereign. The king at once sent a pilot, with orders to take the Portuguese ships into the safer roadstead of Pandarany, and promised to return himself on the morrow to Calicut; this he did, and ordered his Intendant or Catoual to invite Gama to land and open negotiations. In spite of the supplications of his brother, Paul da Gama, who represented to him the dangers which he might incur, and those to which his death would expose the expedition, the Capitam mõr set out for the shore, upon which an enormous crowd of people were awaiting him.
The King of Calicut was about forty-five miles away from his capital at that time, so the Capitam mõr sent two men to announce that an ambassador from the King of Portugal had arrived, carrying letters from his sovereign. The king immediately sent a pilot with orders to guide the Portuguese ships into the safer waters of Pandarany, and promised to return himself to Calicut the next day; he kept his word and instructed his Intendant or Catoual to invite Gama to land and start negotiations. Despite the pleas from his brother, Paul da Gama, who warned him about the dangers he might face and how his death could jeopardize the expedition, the Capitam mõr headed for the shore, where a huge crowd was waiting for him.
The idea that they were in the midst of a Christian population was so rooted in the minds of all the members of the expedition, that Gama, on passing by a pagoda on the way, entered it to perform his devotions. One of his companions, however, Juan de Saa, noticing the hideous pictures upon the walls, was less credulous, and whilst throwing himself upon his knees, said aloud, "If that be a devil, I intend nevertheless to adore only the true God!" A mental reservation which caused amusement to the admiral.
The belief that they were surrounded by a Christian population was so ingrained in everyone on the expedition that Gama, when he passed by a pagoda, went in to pray. However, one of his companions, Juan de Saa, noticing the grotesque images on the walls, was not as convinced. As he knelt down, he said loudly, "If that’s a devil, I’m still going to worship only the true God!" This mental reservation amused the admiral.
Near the gates of the town the crowd was even more closely packed. Gama and his companions, under the guidance of the Catoual, had some difficulty in reaching the palace, where the king, who in the narrative is called the "Zamorin," was awaiting them with extreme impatience. Ushered into halls splendidly decorated with silken stuffs and carpets, and in which burned the most exquisite perfumes, the Portuguese found themselves in the presence of the Zamorin. He was magnificently attired, and loaded with jewels, the pearls and diamonds which he wore being of extraordinary size. The king ordered refreshments to be served to the strangers, and permitted them to be seated, a peculiar mark of favour in a country where the sovereign is usually only addressed with the most lowly prostrations. The Zamorin afterwards passed into another apartment, to hear with his own ears, as was proudly demanded by Gama, the reasons for the embassy and the desire felt by the King of Portugal to conclude a treaty of commerce and alliance with the King of Calicut. The Zamorin listened to Gama's discourse, and replied that he should be happy to consider himself the friend and brother of King Emmanuel, and that he would, by the aid of Gama, send ambassadors to Portugal.
Near the town gates, the crowd was even more tightly packed. Gama and his companions, guided by the Catoual, struggled to reach the palace, where the king, referred to in the story as the "Zamorin," was waiting for them with great impatience. Led into beautifully decorated halls filled with silk fabrics and carpets and infused with the most exquisite perfumes, the Portuguese found themselves face-to-face with the Zamorin. He was dressed magnificently and adorned with jewels, with pearls and diamonds of extraordinary size. The king ordered refreshments for the visitors and allowed them to take a seat, which was a special sign of favor in a land where the sovereign is usually addressed with deep prostrations. The Zamorin then moved to another room to hear directly from Gama the reasons behind the embassy and the King of Portugal's desire to establish a trade and alliance treaty with the King of Calicut. The Zamorin listened to Gama's speech and responded that he would be pleased to consider himself a friend and brother to King Emmanuel, and that with Gama's help, he would send ambassadors to Portugal.
![]() |
Gama's interview with the Zamorin. From an old print. |
There are certain proverbs of which the force is not affected by change of latitude, and the truth of that one which says, "The days succeed each other and have no similarity," was proved the next day at Calicut. The enthusiasm which had been aroused in the mind of the Zamorin by the ingenious discourse of Gama, and the hope it had awakened of the establishment of a profitable trade with Portugal, vanished at the sight of the presents which were to be given him. "Twelve pieces of striped cloth, twelve cloaks with scarlet hoods, six hats, and four branches of coral, accompanied by a box containing six large basons, a chest of sugar, and four kegs, two filled with oil, and two with honey," certainly did not constitute a very magnificent offering. At sight of it, the prime minister laughed, declaring that the poorest merchant from Mecca brought richer presents, and that the king would never accept of such ridiculous trifles. After this affront Gama again visited the Zamorin, but it was only after long waiting in the midst of a mocking crowd, that he was admitted to the presence of the king. The latter reproached him in a contemptuous manner for having nothing to offer him, while pretending to be the subject of a rich and powerful king. Gama replied with boldness, and produced the letters of Emmanuel, which were couched in flattering terms, and contained a formal promise to send merchandise to Calicut. The Zamorin, pleased at this prospect, then inquired with interest about the productions and resources of Portugal, and gave permission to Gama to disembark and sell his goods.
There are certain proverbs that retain their meaning regardless of where you are, and the truth of the saying, "The days follow one another and have no similarity," was proven the next day in Calicut. The excitement that Gama's clever talk had sparked in the Zamorin, along with the hope for a profitable trade with Portugal, faded when he saw the gifts meant for him. "Twelve pieces of striped cloth, twelve cloaks with red hoods, six hats, and four branches of coral, accompanied by a box containing six large basins, a chest of sugar, and four kegs, two filled with oil and two with honey," definitely didn’t make for a very impressive offering. Upon seeing it, the prime minister laughed, saying that even the poorest merchant from Mecca brought richer gifts and that the king would never accept such ridiculous trinkets. After this insult, Gama tried to see the Zamorin again, but only after a long wait amid a taunting crowd was he finally allowed into the king’s presence. The king scornfully criticized him for having nothing to offer while claiming to represent a wealthy and powerful king. Gama responded confidently and presented the letters from Emmanuel, which contained flattering language and a formal promise to send goods to Calicut. The Zamorin, intrigued by this possibility, then asked about the products and resources of Portugal and gave Gama permission to disembark and sell his goods.
But this abrupt change in the humour of the Zamorin was not at all agreeable to the Moorish and Arab traders, whose dealings made the prosperity of Calicut. They could not look on quietly whilst foreigners were endeavouring for their own advantage to turn aside the commerce which had been hitherto entirely in their hands; they resolved, therefore, to leave no stone unturned to drive away once for all these formidable rivals from the shores of India. Their first care was to gain the ear of the Catoual; then they painted in the blackest colours these insatiable adventurers, these bold robbers, whose only object was to spy out the strength and resources of the town, that they might return in force to pillage it, and to massacre those who should venture to oppose their designs.
But this sudden shift in the Zamorin's attitude didn't sit well with the Moorish and Arab traders, who had been essential to Calicut's prosperity. They couldn't just stand by while outsiders tried to take away the trade that had always been theirs. So, they decided to do everything they could to drive these powerful rivals off the shores of India for good. Their first move was to win over the Catoual; then they painted a dire picture of these greedy adventurers, these daring thieves, whose only aim was to scout out the town’s strengths and resources so they could come back in force to loot it and slaughter anyone who dared to stand in their way.
Upon arriving at the roadstead of Pandarany, Gama found no boat to take him off to the ships, and was forced to sleep on shore. The Catoual never left him, continually seeking to prove to him the necessity of bringing the ships nearer to the land; and when the admiral positively refused to consent to this, he declared him to be his prisoner. He had very little idea as yet of the firmness of Gama's character. Some armed boats were sent to surprise the ships, but the Portuguese, having received secret intelligence from the admiral of all that had happened, were on their guard, and their enemies dared not use open force. Gama, still a prisoner, threatened the Catoual with the anger of the Zamorin, whom he imagined could never thus have violated the duties of hospitality, but seeing that his menaces produced no effect, he tried bribery, presenting the minister with several pieces of stuff, who, thereupon at once altered his demeanour. "If the Portuguese," said he, "had but kept the promise they had made to the king, of disembarking their merchandise, the admiral would long ago have returned on board his ships." Gama at once sent an order to bring the goods to land, opened a shop for their sale, of which the superintendence was given to Diego Diaz, brother to the discoverer of the Cape of Good Hope, and was then allowed to go back to his ships.
Upon arriving at the harbor of Pandarany, Gama found no boat to take him to the ships, so he had to sleep on shore. The Catoual never left his side, constantly trying to convince him of the need to bring the ships closer to land; when the admiral firmly refused, he declared Gama his prisoner. He had no idea how strong Gama's character was. Some armed boats were sent to ambush the ships, but the Portuguese, having received secret information from the admiral about everything that had happened, were prepared, and their enemies didn’t dare to attack openly. As a prisoner, Gama threatened the Catoual with the wrath of the Zamorin, believing he could never have violated the duties of hospitality, but when he saw that his threats had no impact, he resorted to bribery, offering the minister several pieces of fabric. This immediately changed the minister's attitude. "If the Portuguese," he said, "had only kept their promise to the king to unload their goods, the admiral would have returned to his ships a long time ago." Gama immediately ordered the goods to be brought ashore, opened a shop for their sale, and assigned Diego Diaz, brother of the discoverer of the Cape of Good Hope, to oversee it, after which he was allowed to return to his ships.
The Mussulmen placed obstacles in the way of the sale of the merchandise by depreciating its value; Gama sent his agent Diaz to the Zamorin to complain of the perfidy of the Moors and of the bad treatment to which he had been subjected, requesting at the same time permission to move his place of sale to Calicut, where he hoped that the goods would be more easily disposed of. This request was favourably received, and friendly relations were maintained, in spite of the Moorish intrigues, until the 10th of August, 1498. On that day Diaz went to announce Gama's impending departure to the king, reminding him of his promise to send an embassy to Portugal, and asking him to allow Gama a specimen of each of the productions of the country. These were to be paid for on the first sale of goods which should take place after the departure of the fleet, it being intended that the employés of the factory should remain at Calicut during Gama's absence. The Zamorin, instigated by the Arab traders, not only refused to execute his promise, but demanded the payment of 600 seraphins as customs' duty, ordering at the same time the seizure of the merchandise, and making prisoners of the men employed in the factory.
The Muslims created barriers to the sale of the goods by lowering their value; Gama sent his agent Diaz to the Zamorin to complain about the betrayal of the Moors and the mistreatment he had faced, while also asking for permission to move his sales location to Calicut, where he believed the goods would sell more easily. This request was positively received, and friendly relations were kept intact despite the Moorish plots, until August 10, 1498. On that day, Diaz went to inform the king of Gama's upcoming departure, reminding him of his promise to send an embassy to Portugal, and asking him to provide Gama with one of each local product. These would be paid for during the first sale of goods after the fleet's departure, with plans for the factory employees to stay in Calicut during Gama's absence. The Zamorin, influenced by the Arab traders, not only refused to fulfill his promise but also demanded a payment of 600 seraphins as customs duty, ordering the seizure of the goods and the arrest of the factory workers.
Such an outrage, such contempt for the rights of nations, called for prompt vengeance, but Gama understood the art of dissimulation; however, on receiving a visit on board from some rich merchants, he detained them, and sent to the Zamorin to demand an exchange of prisoners. The king's reply not being sent within the time specified by the admiral, the latter set sail and anchored at the distance of sixteen miles from Calicut. After another fruitless attack by the Hindoos, the two agents returned on board, and a portion of the hostages whom Gama had secured were given up. Diaz brought back with him a curious letter from the Zamorin to the King of Portugal. It was written upon a palm leaf, and shall be quoted in all its strange laconicism, so different from the usual grandiloquence of the oriental style:—
Such an outrage, such disregard for the rights of nations, called for immediate retaliation, but Gama knew how to play the game of deception; however, after some wealthy merchants visited him on board, he detained them and sent a message to the Zamorin to demand an exchange of prisoners. Since the king's response didn’t arrive within the time the admiral had set, he set sail and anchored sixteen miles from Calicut. After another unsuccessful attack by the Hindoos, the two agents returned on board, and some of the hostages that Gama had secured were released. Diaz returned with an intriguing letter from the Zamorin to the King of Portugal. It was written on a palm leaf and will be quoted in its unusual brevity, which is so different from the typical grandiosity of the oriental style:—
"Vasco da Gama, a noble of thy palace, is come into my country which I have permitted. In my kingdom there is much cinnamon, cloves, and pepper, with many precious stones, and what I desire from thy country is gold, silver, coral, and scarlet. Adieu."
"Vasco da Gama, a noble from your palace, has come to my country, which I have allowed. In my kingdom, there is plenty of cinnamon, cloves, and pepper, along with many precious stones, and what I want from your country is gold, silver, coral, and red dye. Goodbye."
On the morrow, Mouçaïda the Moor of Tunis who had served as interpreter to the Portuguese, and had been a great assistance to them in their negotiations with the Zamorin, came to seek an asylum on board the ships. The merchandise had not been brought back on the appointed day, and the Capitam mõr now resolved to carry away with him the men whom he had kept as hostages, but the fleet was becalmed at several miles distance from Calicut, and was attacked by twenty armed boats, which were with difficulty kept at a distance by the artillery, until they were forced by a violent storm to take shelter under the coast.
On the next day, Mouçaïda, the Moor from Tunis who had worked as an interpreter for the Portuguese and had been a huge help in their talks with the Zamorin, came to ask for refuge on board the ships. The goods hadn’t been returned on the scheduled day, and the captain now decided to take the men he had been holding as hostages. However, the fleet was stuck several miles away from Calicut and was attacked by twenty armed boats, which they managed to hold off with their cannons until a violent storm forced the boats to seek shelter along the coast.
The admiral was sailing along the coast of the Deccan, and had permitted some of the sailors to go on shore to gather fruit and collect cinnamon bark, when he perceived eight boats, which appeared to be coming towards him. Gama recalled the men, and sailed forward to meet the Hindoos, who made the greatest haste to flee from him, but not without leaving a boat laden with cocoa, and provisions, in the hands of the Portuguese. On arriving at the Laccadive Archipelago, Gama had the Berrio recalked, and his own ship drawn up on shore for repairs. The sailors were busy over this work when they were again attacked, but without more success than heretofore. The next day witnessed the arrival of an individual forty years of age, dressed in Hindoo style, who began to speak to the Portuguese in excellent Italian, telling them that he was a native of Venice, and had been torn from his country while still young, that he was a Christian, but without the possibility of practising his religion. He was in a high position at the court of the king of the country, who had sent him to them, to place at their disposal all that the country contained which could minister to their comfort. These offers of service, so different from the welcome accorded to them hitherto, excited the suspicions of the Portuguese, and they were not long in discovering that this adventurer was in command of the boats which had attacked them the day before. Upon this they had him scourged until he confessed that he had come to discover whether it were possible to attack the fleet with advantage, and he ended by affirming that all the inhabitants of the sea-shore were in league to destroy the Portuguese. He was retained on board, the work upon the ships was hurried forward, and as soon as water and provisions had been taken in, sail was made for a return to Europe.
The admiral was sailing along the coast of the Deccan and had allowed some of the sailors to go ashore to gather fruit and collect cinnamon bark when he noticed eight boats approaching him. Gama called the men back and sailed out to meet the Hindoos, who hastily tried to flee from him, but not before leaving behind a boat loaded with cocoa and supplies for the Portuguese. Upon reaching the Laccadive Archipelago, Gama had the Berrio recalled and his own ship pulled up on the shore for repairs. The sailors were busy with this work when they were attacked again, but with no more success than before. The next day, a man about forty years old, dressed in traditional Hindoo clothing, approached the Portuguese and spoke to them in perfect Italian. He claimed to be a native of Venice who had been taken from his homeland when he was young. He said he was a Christian but couldn't practice his faith. He held a high position at the court of the local king, who had sent him to offer all that the country had to help the Portuguese. These generous offers, unlike the hostile reception they had previously received, raised suspicions among the Portuguese, and they soon discovered that this man was in charge of the boats that had attacked them the day before. They had him whipped until he confessed that he had come to see if an attack on the fleet would be possible, and he ultimately insisted that all the coastal inhabitants were united in a plot to destroy the Portuguese. He was kept onboard, the work on the ships was expedited, and as soon as they replenished water and supplies, they set sail to return to Europe.
In consequence of dead calms and contrary winds, the expedition was three months, all but three days, in reaching the African coast. During this long voyage the crews suffered terribly from scurvy, and thirty sailors perished. In each ship, only seven or eight men were in a condition to work the vessel, and very often the officers themselves were forced to lend a hand. "Whence I can affirm," says Velho, "that if the time in which we sailed across those seas had been prolonged a fortnight, nobody from hence would have navigated them after us.... And the captains having held a council upon the matter, it was resolved that in case of similar winds catching us again, to return towards India, there to take refuge." On the 2nd of February, 1499, the Portuguese found themselves at last abreast of a great town on the coast of Ajan, called Magadoxo, distant 300 miles from Melinda.
Due to dead calm and unfavorable winds, the expedition took nearly three months to reach the African coast, just three days shy. During this long journey, the crews suffered greatly from scurvy, leading to the death of thirty sailors. In each ship, only seven or eight crew members were fit to operate the vessel, and often the officers themselves had to pitch in. "From this, I can confirm," says Velho, "that if our crossing of those seas had lasted another fortnight, no one would have dared to navigate them after us... After discussing the situation, the captains decided that if we faced similar winds again, we would head back toward India for shelter." On February 2, 1499, the Portuguese finally found themselves alongside a major town on the coast of Ajan, called Magadoxo, located 300 miles from Melinda.
Gama, dreading another reception like the one given to him at Mozambique, would not stop here, but while passing within sight of the town, ordered a general discharge of the guns. A few days afterwards the rich and salubrious plains of Melinda came in sight, and here they cast anchor. The king hastened to send off fresh provisions and oranges for the invalids on board. The reception given by him to the Portuguese was in every particular most affectionate, and the friendship which had arisen during Gama's first visit to Melinda was greatly strengthened. The Sheik of Melinda sent for the King of Portugal a horn made of ivory and a number of other presents, entreating Gama at the same time to receive a young Moor on board his ship, that through him the king might learn how earnestly he desired his friendship.
Gama, fearing another reception like the one he had at Mozambique, decided not to stop here. As they passed within view of the town, he ordered a general discharge of the guns. A few days later, the rich and healthy plains of Melinda came into view, and they dropped anchor here. The king quickly sent fresh provisions and oranges for the sick on board. The reception he gave the Portuguese was warm in every way, and the friendship that had formed during Gama's first visit to Melinda was even stronger. The Sheik of Melinda sent an ivory horn and several other gifts to the King of Portugal, while also asking Gama to take a young Moor on board his ship so that the king could see how much he valued their friendship.
The five days' rest at Melinda was of the greatest benefit to the Portuguese, at its expiration they again set sail. Soon after passing Mombaz they were obliged to burn the Sam-Raphael, the crews being too much reduced to be able to work three ships. They discovered the Island of Zanzibar, anchored in the Bay of Sam-Braz, and on the 20th February, a favourable wind enabled them to double the Cape of Good Hope, when they again found themselves upon the Atlantic Ocean. The breeze remaining favourable, helped forward the return of the mariners, and at the end of twenty-seven days, they had arrived in the neighbourhood of the Island of Santiago. On the 25th of April Nicholas Coelho, captain of the Berrio, eager to be the first to carry to Emmanuel the news of the discovery of the Indies, separated himself from his chief, and without touching, as had been arranged, at the Cape de Verd Islands, made sail direct for Portugal, arriving there on the 10th of July.
The five days of rest at Melinda were incredibly beneficial for the Portuguese. Once that time was up, they set sail again. Shortly after passing Mombaz, they had to burn the Sam-Raphael because their crews were too small to manage three ships. They discovered the Island of Zanzibar and anchored in the Bay of Sam-Braz. On February 20th, a favorable wind allowed them to round the Cape of Good Hope, putting them back in the Atlantic Ocean. The continuing good breeze helped speed up the sailors' return, and after twenty-seven days, they reached the area near the Island of Santiago. On April 25th, Nicholas Coelho, captain of the Berrio, eager to be the first to inform Emmanuel about the discovery of the Indies, broke away from his leader. Instead of stopping at the Cape Verde Islands as planned, he sailed directly to Portugal, arriving there on July 10th.
During this time the unfortunate Gama was plunged in the most profound sorrow, for his brother, Paul da Gama, who had shared his fatigues and sufferings, and who was to be a partaker of his glory, seemed to be slowly dying. At Santiago, Vasco da Gama, now returned to well known and much frequented seas, gave up the command of his ships to Joao da Saa, and chartered a fast-sailing caravel, to hasten as much as possible his beloved invalid's return to his native country. But all hope was vain, and the caravel only arrived at Terceira in time to inter there the body of the brave and sympathizing Paul da Gama.
During this time, the unfortunate Gama was deeply saddened because his brother, Paul da Gama, who had shared in his hardships and was supposed to share in his success, appeared to be slowly dying. At Santiago, Vasco da Gama, now back in familiar and well-traveled waters, handed over command of his ships to Joao da Saa and chartered a fast-sailing caravel to hurry his beloved brother's return to their homeland. But all hope was in vain, and the caravel only reached Terceira in time to bury the brave and compassionate Paul da Gama.
Upon his arrival in Portugal, which must have taken place during the early part of September, the admiral was received with stately festivals. Of the 160 Portuguese whom he had taken with him, fifty-five only returned with him. The loss was great certainly, but what was it compared with the great advantages to be hoped for? The public realized this, and gave the most enthusiastic reception to Gama. The King, Emmanuel II., added to his own titles that of Lord of the conquests and of the navigation of Ethiopia, Arabia, Persia, and the Indies; but he allowed two years to pass before rewarding Gama. He then bestowed upon him the title of Admiral of the Indies, and authorized him to use the prefix of Dom before his name, a privilege then rarely granted. Also, doubtless to make Vasco da Gama forget the tardiness with which his services had been rewarded, the king gave him 1000 crowns, a considerable sum for that period, and also conceded to him certain privileges in connexion with the commerce of the Indies, which were likely speedily to make his fortune.
Upon arriving in Portugal, which must have happened in early September, the admiral was welcomed with grand celebrations. Out of the 160 Portuguese he had taken with him, only fifty-five returned. The loss was significant, but what did it matter compared to the great benefits that could be anticipated? The public recognized this and gave Gama an incredibly warm welcome. King Emmanuel II. added to his titles the Lord of the conquests and navigation of Ethiopia, Arabia, Persia, and the Indies; however, he waited two years before rewarding Gama. He then granted him the title of Admiral of the Indies and allowed him to use the prefix Dom before his name, a privilege that was rarely given at that time. Also, likely to help Vasco da Gama forget how long it took to reward him for his services, the king gave him 1000 crowns, a substantial amount for that time, and also granted him certain privileges related to the commerce of the Indies, which were likely to make him wealthy quickly.
THE CONQUEST OF INDIA, AND OF THE SPICE COUNTRIES.
Alvarès Cabral—Discovery of Brazil—The coast of Africa—Arrival at Calicut, Cochin, Cananore—Joao da Nova—Gama's second expedition—The King of Cochin—The early life of Albuquerque—The taking of Goa—The siege and capture of Malacca—Second expedition against Ormuz—Ceylon—The Moluccas—Death of Albuquerque—Fate of the Portuguese empire of the Indies.
Alvarès Cabral—Discovery of Brazil—The coast of Africa—Arrival at Calicut, Cochin, Cananore—Joao da Nova—Gama's second expedition—The King of Cochin—The early life of Albuquerque—The capture of Goa—The siege and takeover of Malacca—Second expedition against Ormuz—Ceylon—The Moluccas—Death of Albuquerque—The fate of the Portuguese empire in the Indies.
On the 9th of March, 1500, a fleet of thirteen vessels left Rastello, under the command of Pedro Alvarès Cabral; on board, as a volunteer, was Luiz de Camoens, who in his poem the "Lusiad," was to render illustrious the valour and adventurous spirit of his countrymen. But little is known of Cabral, and nothing of the reason which had gained him the command of this important expedition. Cabral belonged to one of the most illustrious families in Portugal, and his father, Fernando Cabral, lord of Zurara da Beira, was Alcalde mõr of Belmonte. Pedro Alvarès Cabral had married Isabel de Castro, first lady in waiting to the Infanta Dona Maria, daughter of John III. If it be asked whether Cabral had made himself famous by some important maritime discovery, we answer there is no reason to think so, for in that case the historians would have recorded it. But it is difficult to believe that he owed to court favour alone the command of an expedition in which such men as Bartholomew Diaz, Nicholas Coelho the companion of Gama, and Sancho de Thovar sailed under his orders. Why had not this mission been confided to Gama, who had been at home for six months, and whose knowledge of the countries to be visited and of the manners of their inhabitants, seemed to point him out as the fittest man for the service? Had he not yet recovered from the fatigues of his first voyage? Or had his grief for the loss of a brother who had died almost within sight of the coasts of Portugal so deeply affected him, that he desired to remain in retirement? May it not rather have been that King Emmanuel was jealous of the fame of Gama, and did not wish to give him the opportunity of increasing his renown? These are problems which perhaps history may be for ever unable to solve.
On March 9, 1500, a fleet of thirteen ships set sail from Rastello, led by Pedro Alvarès Cabral. On board, as a volunteer, was Luiz de Camoens, who would later glorify the bravery and adventurous spirit of his fellow countrymen in his poem, "Lusiad." Not much is known about Cabral, and there's no explanation for how he got command of this significant expedition. Cabral came from one of the most distinguished families in Portugal, and his father, Fernando Cabral, was the lord of Zurara da Beira and Alcalde mór of Belmonte. Pedro Alvarès Cabral had married Isabel de Castro, who was the first lady in waiting to Infanta Dona Maria, daughter of John III. If we ask whether Cabral became famous through any major maritime discoveries, the answer is that there's no evidence to suggest so; otherwise, historians would have noted it. However, it's hard to believe that he solely relied on royal favor to lead an expedition that included notable figures like Bartholomew Diaz, Nicholas Coelho, a companion of Gama, and Sancho de Thovar. Why wasn’t this mission given to Gama, who had been back for six months and seemed best suited for the job due to his knowledge of the regions to be explored and the behavior of their inhabitants? Was he still recovering from the hardships of his first voyage? Or did his sorrow over the loss of a brother, who died almost within sight of Portugal’s shores, lead him to seek solitude? Could it be that King Emmanuel was envious of Gama’s achievements and didn’t want him to have the chance to earn even more fame? These are questions that history may never fully answer.
It is easy to believe in the realization of those things which we ardently desire. Emmanuel imagined that the Zamorin of Calicut would not object to the establishment of Portuguese shops and factories in his country, and Cabral, the bearer of presents of such magnificence as to obliterate the memory of the shabbiness of those offered by Gama, received orders to obtain from the Zamorin an interdict, forbidding any Moor to carry on trade in his capital. The new Capitam mõr was in the first place to visit Melinda, to offer rich presents to its king, and to restore to him the Moor who had come to Portugal with Gama. Sixteen friars were sent out on board the fleet, charged to carry the knowledge of the Gospel to the distant countries of Asia.
It’s easy to believe in the fulfillment of things we deeply desire. Emmanuel thought that the Zamorin of Calicut would welcome the establishment of Portuguese shops and factories in his land, and Cabral, who brought gifts so impressive that they made Gama's offerings seem insignificant, was instructed to get an order from the Zamorin to prohibit any Moor from trading in his capital. The new captain was first to visit Melinda, offer generous gifts to its king, and return the Moor who had come to Portugal with Gama. Sixteen friars were sent out with the fleet, tasked with spreading the knowledge of the Gospel to the far-off lands of Asia.
The fleet had sailed for thirteen days and had passed the Cape de Verd Islands, when it was discovered that one of the ships, under the command of Vasco d'Ataïde, was no longer in company. The rest of the ships lay to for some time to await her, but in vain, and the twelve vessels then continued their navigation upon the open sea, and not, as had been the manner hitherto, steering simply from cape to cape along the shores of Africa. Cabral hoped by this means to avoid the calms in the Gulf of Guinea, which had proved so great a cause of delay to the preceding expeditions. Perhaps even the Capitam mõr, who must, in common with the rest of his countrymen, have been acquainted with the discoveries of Christopher Columbus, may have had the secret hope, by keeping to the west, of arriving at some region unvisited by the great navigator.
The fleet had been sailing for thirteen days and had passed the Cape Verde Islands when it was noticed that one of the ships, commanded by Vasco d'Ataïde, was no longer in sight. The other ships waited for a while, but there was no sign of her, so the twelve vessels continued on their journey across the open sea, instead of sticking to the usual route along the African coast from cape to cape. Cabral hoped this would help them avoid the calm waters in the Gulf of Guinea, which had delayed previous expeditions. It's possible that even the Capitam mãr, like his fellow countrymen, was aware of Christopher Columbus's discoveries and secretly hoped that by heading west, they might reach a place that hadn’t yet been explored by the famous navigator.
The fact remains, whether it is to be accounted for by a storm or by some secret design, that the fleet was out of the right way for doubling the Cape of Good Hope when, on the 22nd of April, a high mountain was seen, and soon afterwards a long stretch of coast, which received the name of Vera Cruz, changed afterwards to that of Santa Cruz. This was Brazil, and the point where now stands Porto Seguro. On the 28th, after a skilful reconnaissance of the coasts had been made by Coelho, the Portuguese sailors landed upon the American shores, and became aware of a delicious mildness of temperature, with a luxuriance of vegetation greatly exceeding anything which they had seen on the coasts of Africa or of Malabar. The natives formed themselves in groups around the sailors, without showing the least sign of fear. They were almost naked, and bore upon the wrist a tame parroquet, after the fashion in which the gentlemen of Europe carry their hawks or their gerfalcons.
The truth is, whether it's due to a storm or some hidden plan, the fleet was off course for rounding the Cape of Good Hope when, on April 22nd, they spotted a tall mountain, followed soon after by a long stretch of coastline, which was named Vera Cruz, later changed to Santa Cruz. This was Brazil, specifically the area where Porto Seguro now stands. On the 28th, after a careful scouting of the coasts by Coelho, the Portuguese sailors landed on American shores and experienced a wonderfully mild climate, with lush vegetation far beyond anything they had seen along the coasts of Africa or Malabar. The locals gathered around the sailors in groups, showing no signs of fear. They were nearly naked and had tame parrots on their wrists, similar to how European gentlemen carry their hawks or gerfalcons.
On Easter Sunday, the 26th of April, a solemn mass was celebrated on the shore in sight of the Indians, whose silence and attitude of respect excited the admiration of the Portuguese. On the 1st of May a large cross and a padrao were erected on the shore, and Cabral formally took possession of the country in the name of the King of Portugal. His first care after this formality was accomplished was to despatch Gaspard de Lemos to Lisbon, to announce the discovery of this rich and fertile country. Lemos took with him the narrative of the expedition written by Pedro Vaz de Caminha, and an important astronomical document, the work of Master Joao, in which was doubtless stated the exact situation of the new conquest. Before setting out for Asia, Cabral put on land two criminals, whom he ordered to ascertain the resources and riches of the country, as well as the manners and customs of the inhabitants. These wise and far-sighted measures speak much for Cabral's prudence and sagacity.
On Easter Sunday, April 26th, a solemn mass was held on the shore where the Indians could see it. Their silence and respectful demeanor impressed the Portuguese. On May 1st, a large cross and a padrao were set up on the shore, and Cabral officially claimed the land on behalf of the King of Portugal. Once this formal claim was made, Cabral immediately sent Gaspard de Lemos to Lisbon to announce the discovery of this rich and fertile land. Lemos took with him a written account of the expedition by Pedro Vaz de Caminha, along with an important astronomical document by Master Joao, which likely detailed the exact location of the new territory. Before heading to Asia, Cabral landed two criminals, instructing them to investigate the country’s resources and wealth, as well as the customs and ways of the local people. These wise and forward-thinking actions highlight Cabral's prudence and insight.
![]() |
Cabral takes formal possession of Brazil. |
It was the 2nd of May when the fleet lost sight of Brazil. All on board, rejoicing over this happy commencement of the voyage, believed in the prospect of an easy and rapid success, when the appearance of a brilliant comet on eight consecutive days struck the ignorant and simple minds of the sailors with terror; they considered it must be a bad omen, and for this once events appeared to justify superstition. A fearful storm arose, waves mountains high broke over the ships, whilst the wind blew furiously and rain fell without ceasing. When the sun at length succeeded in piercing the thick curtain of clouds which almost entirely intercepted his rays, a horrible scene was disclosed. The water looked thick and black, large patches of a livid white colour flecked the foaming, crested waves, while during the night phosphorescent lights, streaking the immense plain of water, marked out the course of the ships with a train of fire. For two-and-twenty days, without truce or mercy, the Portuguese ships were battered by the furious elements. The terrified sailors were utterly prostrate; they vainly exhausted their prayers and vows, and obeyed the orders of their officers only from the force of habit; from the first day they had given up any hope of their lives being spared, and only awaited the moment when they should all be submerged. When light at length returned and the billows became calm, each crew, thinking themselves to be perhaps the sole survivors, looked eagerly over the sea in search of their companions. Three ships met together again with a joy which the sad reality soon abated. Eight vessels were missing; four had been engulfed by a gigantic water-spout during the last days of the storm. One of these had been commanded by Bartholomew Diaz, the discoverer of the Cape of Good Hope: he had been drowned by these murderous waves, the defenders, according to Camoens, of the empire of the east against the nations of the west, who had for so many centuries coveted her marvellous riches.
It was May 2nd when the fleet lost sight of Brazil. Everyone on board, celebrating the promising start of the voyage, believed in the prospects of an easy and quick success. However, the sight of a brilliant comet for eight consecutive days filled the sailors with dread; they saw it as a bad omen, and this time events seemed to confirm their superstitions. A terrible storm broke out, with towering waves crashing over the ships, while the wind howled fiercely and rain poured continuously. When the sun finally managed to break through the thick clouds that almost completely blocked its light, a horrific scene unfolded. The water looked thick and black, with large patches of a sickly white color dotting the foaming, crested waves. During the night, phosphorescent lights streaked across the vast expanse of water, marking the ships' path with a blazing trail. For twenty-two days, the Portuguese ships were relentlessly assaulted by the furious elements. The frightened sailors were utterly exhausted; their prayers and vows were in vain, and they followed their officers' orders only out of habit. From the very first day, they had abandoned all hope of survival and awaited the moment they would be completely submerged. When light finally returned and the waves calmed down, each crew, thinking they might be the only survivors, eagerly scanned the sea for their fellow sailors. Three ships came together again with joy, a happiness that quickly faded when they realized the grim truth. Eight vessels were missing; four had been swallowed by a massive waterspout in the final days of the storm. One of those was commanded by Bartholomew Diaz, the discoverer of the Cape of Good Hope, who was drowned by those deadly waves, the protectors, according to Camoens, of the eastern empire against the western nations that had coveted its incredible riches for centuries.
During this long series of storms the Cape had been doubled and the fleet was approaching the coast of Africa. On the 20th of July Mozambique was signalled. The Moors of this place showed a more agreeable disposition than they had done when Gama was there, and furnished the Portuguese with two pilots, who conducted them to Quiloa, an island famed for the trade in gold-dust which was carried on with Sofala. There Cabral found two of the missing ships, which had been driven to this island by the wind. A plot was on foot in Quiloa for a wholesale massacre of the Europeans, but this was frustrated by a prompt departure from the island, and the ships arrived at Melinda without any untoward incident. The stay of the fleet in this port was the occasion of fêtes and rejoicings without number, and soon, revictualled, repaired, and furnished with excellent pilots, the Portuguese vessels sailed for Calicut, where they arrived on the 13th of December, 1500.
During this long series of storms, the Cape had been rounded, and the fleet was approaching the coast of Africa. On July 20th, Mozambique was signaled. The locals here were more welcoming than they had been when Gama was present, and they provided the Portuguese with two pilots who guided them to Quiloa, an island known for its trade in gold dust with Sofala. There, Cabral discovered two of the missing ships that had been driven to the island by the wind. A plot was underway in Quiloa to carry out a mass slaughter of the Europeans, but this was thwarted by a quick departure from the island, and the ships reached Melinda without any problems. The fleet's stay in this port was filled with countless celebrations and festivities, and soon, restocked, repaired, and equipped with excellent pilots, the Portuguese ships set sail for Calicut, where they arrived on December 13, 1500.
![]() |
View of Quiloa. From an old print. |
This time, thanks to the power of their arms as well as to the richness of the presents offered to the Zamorin, the reception was different, and the versatile prince agreed to all the demands of Cabral: namely, a monopoly of the trade in aromatics and spicery, and the right of seizure upon all vessels which should infringe this privilege. For some time the Moors dissembled their resentment, but when they had succeeded in thoroughly exasperating the population against the foreigners, they rushed at a given signal into the factory which was under the direction of Ayrès Correa, and massacred fifty of the Portuguese, whom they surprised in it. Vengeance for this outrage was not slow; ten boats moored in the port were taken, pillaged, and burnt before the eyes of the Hindoos, who were powerless to render opposition; afterwards the town was bombarded, and was half-buried under its ruins.
This time, thanks to their strong military might and the generous gifts given to the Zamorin, the reception was different, and the adaptable prince agreed to all of Cabral's demands: specifically, a monopoly on the trade of spices and the right to seize any ships that violated this privilege. For a while, the Moors hid their anger, but once they managed to incite the local population against the foreigners, they quickly launched a surprise attack on the factory run by Ayrès Correa, killing fifty Portuguese who were caught off guard. Retribution for this attack came swiftly; ten boats moored in the port were captured, looted, and burned right in front of the Hindoos, who were unable to resist. Later, the town was bombarded and left in ruins.
When this affair was concluded, Cabral, continuing the exploration of the Malabar coast, arrived at Cochin, where the Rajah, a vassal of the Zamorin, hastened to conclude an alliance with the Portuguese, eagerly seizing this opportunity to declare himself independent. Although by this time his fleet was richly laden, Cabral made a visit to Cananore, where he entered into a treaty with the Rajah of the country; then, being impatient to return home, he set sail for Europe. While coasting along that shore of Africa, which is washed by the Indian Ocean, he discovered Sofala, a place which had escaped the observation of Gama. On the 13th of July, 1501, Cabral arrived at Lisbon, where he had the joy of finding the two remaining ships which he had imagined to be lost.
When this matter was finished, Cabral, continuing his exploration of the Malabar coast, arrived at Cochin, where the Rajah, a vassal of the Zamorin, quickly sought to form an alliance with the Portuguese, eagerly taking this chance to assert his independence. Although his fleet was already heavily loaded, Cabral visited Cananore, where he made a treaty with the local Rajah; then, eager to get back home, he set sail for Europe. While sailing along the African coast, which is washed by the Indian Ocean, he discovered Sofala, a place that Gama had overlooked. On July 13, 1501, Cabral reached Lisbon, where he was overjoyed to find the two remaining ships he had thought were lost.
It is pleasant to believe that he received the welcome merited by the important results obtained in this memorable expedition. Although contemporary historians are silent upon the incidents of his life after his return, recent research has been rewarded by the discovery of his tomb at Santarem, and M. Ferdinand Denis has happily proved that, like Vasco da Gama, he received the title of Dom as a reward for his glorious deeds.
It’s nice to think that he got the recognition he deserved for the significant achievements of this memorable expedition. While modern historians have little to say about the events of his life after his return, recent research has uncovered his tomb in Santarem, and M. Ferdinand Denis has successfully shown that, like Vasco da Gama, he was granted the title of Dom as a reward for his heroic actions.
Whilst he was returning to Europe Alvarès Cabral might have encountered a fleet of four caravels under the command of Joao da Nova, which King Emmanuel had despatched to give fresh vigour to the commercial relations which Cabral had been charged to establish in the Indies. This new expedition doubled the Cape of Good Hope without misadventure, discovered between Mozambique and Quiloa an unknown island, which was named after the commander of the fleet, and arrived at Melinda, where Da Nova was informed of the events which had taken place at Calicut. He felt that he had not forces at his disposal sufficient to justify him in going to punish the Zamorin, and not wishing to endanger the prestige of Portuguese arms by the risk of a reverse, he steered for Cochin and Cananore, of which the kings, although tributaries of the Zamorin, had entered into alliance with Alvarès Cabral. Da Nova had already taken on board 1000 hundredweights of pepper, 50 of ginger, and 450 of cinnamon, when he received warning that a considerable fleet, coming apparently from Calicut, was advancing with hostile intentions. If he had hitherto been more concerned with trade than with war, he did not the less in these critical circumstances display a bold and courageous spirit worthy of his predecessors. He accepted the combat, notwithstanding the apparent superiority of the Hindoos, and partly by the skilful arrangements which he made, partly by the power of his guns, he managed to disperse, to take, or to sink the hostile vessels. Perhaps Da Nova ought to have profited by the terror which his victory had spread along the coast, and the temporary exhaustion of the Moorish resources, to strike a great blow by the taking of Calicut. But we are too far removed in time from the events, and know too little of their details, to appreciate with impartiality the reasons which induced the admiral to return immediately to Europe.
While he was heading back to Europe, Alvarès Cabral might have run into a fleet of four caravels led by Joao da Nova, which King Emmanuel had sent out to boost the trade relations Cabral had been tasked with establishing in the Indies. This new expedition successfully navigated around the Cape of Good Hope, discovered an unknown island between Mozambique and Quiloa—which was named after the fleet's commander—and arrived at Melinda, where Da Nova learned about the events that had unfolded in Calicut. He felt that he didn't have enough forces to justify going after the Zamorin, and not wanting to jeopardize the reputation of Portuguese arms by risking defeat, he set his course for Cochin and Cananore, whose kings, although tributaries of the Zamorin, had allied with Alvarès Cabral. Da Nova had already loaded 1,000 hundredweights of pepper, 50 of ginger, and 450 of cinnamon when he was warned that a significant fleet, apparently coming from Calicut, was approaching with hostile intentions. Although he had been more focused on trade than warfare until then, in this critical moment, he showed a bold and courageous spirit worthy of his predecessors. He accepted the battle, despite the apparent superiority of the Hindoos, and partly through his tactical arrangements and partly through the firepower of his cannons, he managed to disperse, capture, or sink the hostile vessels. Perhaps Da Nova should have taken advantage of the fear his victory had instilled along the coast and the temporary depletion of Moorish resources to launch a significant attack on Calicut. But we are too far removed in time from these events and know too little about their specifics to fairly assess the reasons that led the admiral to return to Europe immediately.
It was during this latter part of his voyage that Nova discovered the small island of Saint Helena in the midst of the Atlantic. A curious story attaches to this discovery. A certain Fernando Lopez had followed Gama to the Indies; this man, wishing to marry a Hindoo, was forced for this purpose to renounce Christianity and become a Mahometan. Upon Nova's visit, having had enough either of his wife or of her religion, he begged to be taken back to his country, and returned to his old creed. Upon arriving at Saint Helena, Lopez, in obedience to a sudden idea, which he regarded as an inspiration from on high, requested to be landed there, in order, as he said, to expiate his detestable apostasy and to atone for it by his devotion to humanity. His will appeared so fixed that Da Nova was forced to consent, and he left him there, having given him at his request various seeds of fruits and vegetables. It must be added that this singular hermit worked for four years at the clearing and planting of the island with such success, that ships were soon able to call there to revictual during their long passage from Europe to the Cape of Good Hope.
It was during the latter part of his journey that Nova discovered the small island of Saint Helena in the middle of the Atlantic. A curious story is linked to this discovery. A man named Fernando Lopez had followed Gama to the Indies; he wanted to marry a Hindu woman and was compelled to give up Christianity and convert to Islam for this reason. When Nova visited, having grown tired of either his wife or her religion, he asked to be taken back to his homeland and returned to his old faith. Upon arriving at Saint Helena, Lopez, struck by a sudden idea that he thought was a divine inspiration, requested to be dropped off there to make amends for his shameful apostasy and to atone through his service to humanity. His determination was so strong that Da Nova had no choice but to agree, and he left him there, having given him various seeds of fruits and vegetables at his request. It should be noted that this unique hermit worked for four years clearing and planting the island with such success that ships were soon able to stop there to restock during their long journey from Europe to the Cape of Good Hope.
The successive expeditious of Gama, Cabral, and Da Nova had conclusively proved that an uninterrupted commerce must not be reckoned upon, nor a continued exchange of merchandise, with the population of the Malabar Coast, who, while their own independence and liberty were respected had each time leagued together against the Portuguese. That trade with Europeans which they so persistently refused, must be forced upon them, and for that purpose permanent military establishments must be formed, capable of overawing the malcontents, and even in case of necessity of taking possession of the country. But to whom should such an important mission be entrusted? The choice could scarcely be doubtful, and Vasco da Gama was unanimously chosen to take the command of the powerful armament which was in preparation.
The successive expeditions of Gama, Cabral, and Da Nova had clearly shown that we couldn't rely on a steady trade or ongoing exchange of goods with the people of the Malabar Coast. As long as their independence and freedom were respected, they had consistently united against the Portuguese. The trade with Europeans that they stubbornly rejected had to be imposed on them, and for that, we needed to establish permanent military bases capable of intimidating those who opposed us and, if necessary, taking control of the region. But who should be given such an important mission? The choice was obvious, and Vasco da Gama was unanimously selected to lead the powerful fleet that was being prepared.
Vasco had ten ships under his own immediate command, while his second brother Stephen da Gama, and his cousin Vincent Sodrez, had each five ships under his orders, but they were both to recognise Vasco da Gama as their chief. The ceremonies which preceded the departure of the fleet from Lisbon were of a particularly grave and solemn character. King Emmanuel, followed by the whole court, repaired to the cathedral in the midst of an enormous crowd, and there called down blessings from heaven upon this expedition, partly religious, partly military, while the Archbishop blessed the banner which was entrusted to Gama.
Vasco had ten ships directly under his command, while his brother Stephen da Gama and his cousin Vincent Sodrez each had five ships under their command, but both were to acknowledge Vasco da Gama as their leader. The ceremonies before the fleet's departure from Lisbon were particularly serious and solemn. King Emmanuel, followed by the entire court, went to the cathedral amidst a huge crowd and called down blessings from heaven for this expedition, which was both religious and military in nature, while the Archbishop blessed the banner that was given to Gama.
The admiral's first care was to visit Sofala and Mozambique, towns of which he had had reason to complain in the course of his first voyage. Being anxious to establish harbours for refuge, and revictualling of ships, he established there merchants' offices, and laid the foundations of forts. He also levied a heavy tribute upon the Sheik of Quiloa, and then sailed for the coast of Hindostan. When Gama had arrived off Calicut, he perceived on the 3rd of October a vessel of large tonnage, which appeared to him to be richly laden. It was the Merii bringing back from Mecca a great number of pilgrims belonging to all the countries of Asia. Gama attacked the ship without provocation, captured her and put to death more than three hundred men who were on board. Twenty children alone were saved and taken to Lisbon, where they were baptized, and entered the army of Portugal. This frightful massacre, besides being quite in accordance with the ideas of the period, was calculated according to Gama, to strike terror into the Hindoo mind: it did nothing of the sort. This hateful and useless cruelty has left a stain of blood upon the hitherto pure fame of the admiral.
The admiral's first priority was to visit Sofala and Mozambique, towns he had reason to complain about during his first voyage. Eager to establish safe harbors for refuge and resupplying ships, he set up merchant offices and laid the groundwork for forts. He also imposed a heavy tax on the Sheik of Quiloa before sailing for the coast of India. When Gama arrived near Calicut, he spotted a large ship on October 3rd that seemed to be heavily loaded. It was the Merii, returning from Mecca with many pilgrims from all over Asia. Gama attacked the ship without any provocation, captured it, and killed more than three hundred men on board. Only twenty children were saved and taken to Lisbon, where they were baptized and joined the Portuguese army. This horrific massacre, while consistent with the mindset of the time, according to Gama, was meant to instill fear in the Hindus: it had the opposite effect. This despicable and pointless cruelty has tarnished the previously untarnished reputation of the admiral.
![]() |
As soon as he arrived at Cananore, Gama obtained an audience of the Rajah, who authorized him to establish a counting-house, and to build a fort. At the same time a treaty of alliance, offensive and defensive was concluded. After setting the labourers to work, and installing his agent, the admiral set sail for Calicut, where he intended to summon the Zamorin to a reckoning for his disloyalty, as well as for the murder of the Portuguese who had been surprised in the factory. Although the Rajah of Calicut had been informed of the arrival in the Indies of his formidable enemies, he had taken no military precautions, and thus, when Gama presented himself before the town, he was able to seize some vessels anchored in the port and to make a hundred prisoners, without encountering any resistance; afterwards he granted the Zamorin a respite of four days, in which to make atonement to the Portuguese for the murder of Correa, and to refund the value of the merchandise which had been stolen on that occasion.
As soon as he got to Cananore, Gama met with the Rajah, who gave him permission to set up a counting house and build a fort. At the same time, they signed an offensive and defensive alliance. After putting the workers to task and appointing his agent, the admiral sailed to Calicut, where he planned to hold the Zamorin accountable for his disloyalty and for the murder of the Portuguese who had been caught off guard at the factory. Even though the Rajah of Calicut had been warned about the arrival of his powerful enemies, he hadn’t taken any military precautions. So, when Gama arrived at the town, he was able to seize some ships anchored in the port and take a hundred prisoners without facing any resistance. He then gave the Zamorin a four-day deadline to make amends to the Portuguese for Correa’s murder and to pay back the value of the goods stolen during that event.
The time specified had scarcely elapsed when the bodies of fifty of the prisoners were strung up at the yard-arms of the vessels, where they remained exposed to the view of the town during the whole day. In the evening the feet and hands of these expiatory victims were cut off and taken on shore, with a letter from the admiral, declaring that his vengeance would not be limited to this execution. Accordingly, under cover of the night, the broadsides of the vessels were brought to bear upon the town, which was bombarded for the space of three days. It will never be known what was the exact number of the slain, but it must have been considerable. Without reckoning those killed by the fire of the cannon and the muskets, a great number of Hindoos were buried beneath the ruins of the buildings, or perished in the conflagration, which destroyed a portion of the town of Calicut. The Rajah had been one of the first to take flight, and fortunate was it for him that he had done so, for his palace was amongst the buildings which were demolished. At length, satisfied with having transformed this heretofore rich and populous city into a heap of ruins, and considering his vengeance satiated, and that the lesson so taught would be profitable, Gama set sail for Cochin, leaving behind him Vincent Sodrez, with several ships, to continue the blockade.
The specified time had barely passed when the bodies of fifty prisoners were hung up at the yard-arms of the ships, where they remained visible to the town throughout the day. In the evening, the feet and hands of these sacrificial victims were cut off and taken ashore, along with a letter from the admiral, stating that his revenge wouldn’t stop with this execution. So, under the cover of night, the side guns of the ships were aimed at the town, which was bombarded for three days. The exact number of casualties will never be known, but it was certainly significant. Besides those killed by cannon fire and gunshots, many Hindoos were buried under the rubble of the buildings or died in the fire that destroyed part of Calicut. The Rajah was one of the first to flee, and he was fortunate to have done so, as his palace was one of the buildings that was demolished. Finally, satisfied with having turned this once-rich and populated city into a pile of ruins, and believing his vengeance was fulfilled and that the lesson would be valuable, Gama set sail for Cochin, leaving Vincent Sodrez and several ships behind to continue the blockade.
Triumpara, the sovereign of Cochin, informed the admiral that he had been eagerly solicited by the Zamorin to take advantage of the confidence reposed in him by the Portuguese, to surprise and seize them, in consequence of which intelligence, and to reward the integrity of the king whose loyalty had exposed him to the enmity of the Rajah of Calicut, Gama, when starting for Lisbon with a valuable cargo, left with Triumpara ships sufficient to enable him to await in safety the arrival of another squadron. During Gama's return voyage the only noteworthy incident that occurred was the defeat of another Malabar fleet. The admiral arrived in Europe on the 20th of December, 1503.
Triumpara, the ruler of Cochin, informed the admiral that the Zamorin had been eagerly urging him to exploit the trust placed in him by the Portuguese to launch a surprise attack and capture them. In response to this information, and to honor the loyalty of the king who had risked his safety due to the animosity from the Rajah of Calicut, Gama, when he set off for Lisbon with a valuable cargo, left enough ships with Triumpara to ensure he could safely wait for the arrival of another fleet. During Gama's return journey, the only significant event that took place was the defeat of another Malabar fleet. The admiral reached Europe on December 20, 1503.
Once more the eminent services rendered by this great man went unrecognised, or rather they were not appreciated as they deserved. Gama, who had just laid the foundations of the colonial empire of Portugal in India, remained for one and twenty years without employment, and it was only through the intercession of the Duke of Braganza, that he obtained the title of Count de Vidigueyra. A too common instance this of ingratitude, but one which it is never mal à propos to stigmatize as it deserves.
Once again, the remarkable contributions of this great man went unrecognized, or rather, they weren’t appreciated as they should have been. Gama, who had just established the colonial empire of Portugal in India, spent twenty-one years without any position, and it was only through the intervention of the Duke of Braganza that he received the title of Count de Vidigueyra. This is a common example of ingratitude, but one that should never be highlighted as it deserves.
Scarcely had Gama set out for Europe, before the Zamorin at the instigation of the Musselmen, who saw their commercial supremacy more and more compromised, assembled his allies at Pani with the object of attacking the King of Cochin and of punishing him for the counsel and assistance which he had given to the Portuguese. The unfortunate Rajah's fidelity was now put to a hard proof. Besieged in his capital by a large force, he saw himself all at once deprived of the aid of those for whose advantage he had incurred so great a risk. Sodrez and several of his captains had deserted the post, where both honour and gratitude required them to remain, and if need were, to die in the discharge of their duty; they forsook Triumpara to go and cruise in the neighbourhood of Ormuz, and at the entrance to the Red Sea, where they calculated that the annual pilgrimage to Mecca was likely to ensure them some rich booty. The Portuguese agent vainly represented to them the unworthiness of their conduct, they set out in haste, to escape from these inconvenient reproaches.
Scarcely had Gama set off for Europe when the Zamorin, influenced by the Musselmen who felt their commercial dominance slipping away, gathered his allies at Pani to plan an attack on the King of Cochin. They wanted to punish him for the advice and support he had given to the Portuguese. The unfortunate Rajah’s loyalty was now being put to a tough test. Surrounded in his capital by a large army, he suddenly found himself without the help of those he had risked so much for. Sodrez and several of his captains had abandoned their posts, where both honor and gratitude demanded they stay, even if it meant dying in the line of duty. They left Triumpara to sail around near Ormuz and at the entrance to the Red Sea, where they hoped to find valuable loot from the annual pilgrimage to Mecca. The Portuguese agent unsuccessfully tried to appeal to their sense of duty, but they hurried away to avoid his uncomfortable accusations.
The King of Cochin, betrayed by some of the Nairs (military nobles) of his palace, who had been gained over by the Zamorin, soon saw his capital carried by assault, and was obliged to seek refuge upon an inaccessible rock in the little Island of Viopia, with those Portuguese who had remained faithful to him. When he was reduced to the last extremity, an emissary was sent to him by the Zamorin, to promise him pardon and oblivion of his offences if he would give up to him the Portuguese. But Triumpara, whose fidelity cannot be sufficiently commended, answered, "that the Zamorin might use his rights of victory; that he was not ignorant of the perils by which he was menaced, but that it was not in the power of any man to make him a traitor and a perjurer." No one could have made a nobler return than this for the desertion and cowardice of Sodrez.
The King of Cochin, betrayed by some of the Nairs (military nobles) in his palace who had been swayed by the Zamorin, quickly saw his capital fall under attack and had to seek refuge on a remote rock in the small Island of Viopia, along with the Portuguese who had stayed loyal to him. When he was in dire straits, the Zamorin sent a messenger to offer him forgiveness and forgetfulness of his wrongdoings if he would surrender the Portuguese to him. However, Triumpara, whose loyalty is highly admirable, responded, "Let the Zamorin exercise his rights of victory; I am aware of the dangers I face, but no one can force me to become a traitor and a liar." No one could have made a nobler reply to the betrayal and cowardice of Sodrez.
Vincent Sodrez had arrived at the Straits of Bab-el-Mandeb, when a fearful tempest occurred, in which his ship split upon the rocks, and he and his brother perished. The survivors regarded this event as a judgment of Providence for their bad conduct, and they made haste, with all sails set to return to Cochin. They were detained by contrary winds at the Laccadive Islands, and were there joined by another Portuguese squadron under the command of Francisco d'Albuquerque, who had sailed from Lisbon almost at the same time as his cousin Alfonzo d'Albuquerque the most distinguished captain of the period, who with the title of Capitam mõr had started from Belem at the beginning of April, 1503.
Vincent Sodrez had arrived at the Straits of Bab-el-Mandeb when a terrifying storm hit, causing his ship to crash into the rocks, leading to the death of him and his brother. The survivors viewed this incident as a sign of divine judgment for their wrongdoings, and they quickly set sail to return to Cochin. They were held up by unfavorable winds at the Laccadive Islands, where they were joined by another Portuguese squadron led by Francisco d'Albuquerque, who had departed from Lisbon almost at the same time as his cousin Alfonzo d'Albuquerque, the most renowned captain of the era, who had set sail from Belem at the beginning of April, 1503.
The arrival of Francisco d'Albuquerque placed the Portuguese affairs, which had been so gravely compromised by the criminal conduct of Sodrez, upon a better footing, and at the same time effected the rescue of Triumpara, their sole and faithful ally. The besiegers fled at the sight of the Portuguese squadron, without even a show of resistance, and the Europeans in conjunction with the troops of the King of Cochin ravaged the Malabar Coast. As a consequence of these events, Triumpara allowed his allies to construct a second fortress in his dominions, and authorised an augmentation of the number and importance of their mercantile houses. This was the moment that witnessed the arrival of Alfonzo d'Albuquerque, the man destined to be the real creator of the Portuguese Empire in the Indies. Diaz, Cabral, and Gama, had prepared the way, but Albuquerque was the leader of large views who was needed to determine which were the principal towns that must be seized in order to place the Portuguese dominion upon a solid and lasting basis. Thus every particular of the history of this man who showed so great a genius for colonisation, is of the deepest interest, and it is well worth while to record some particulars of his family, his education, and his early exploits.
The arrival of Francisco d'Albuquerque improved the situation for the Portuguese, which had been severely jeopardized by Sodrez's wrongdoing, and also rescued Triumpara, their only loyal ally. The attackers fled at the sight of the Portuguese fleet without even putting up a fight, and together, the Europeans and the troops of the King of Cochin devastated the Malabar Coast. As a result of these events, Triumpara allowed his allies to build a second fortress in his territory and approved an increase in the number and significance of their trading posts. This was the time when Alfonzo d'Albuquerque arrived, the man destined to be the true architect of the Portuguese Empire in the Indies. Diaz, Cabral, and Gama had laid the groundwork, but Albuquerque was the visionary leader needed to identify which key towns must be captured to establish Portuguese control on a strong and enduring foundation. Therefore, every detail about the life of this man, who displayed remarkable talent for colonization, is profoundly interesting, and it is worth noting some details about his family, education, and early achievements.
Alfonzo d'Alboquerque or d'Albuquerque, was born in 1453 at Alhandra, eighteen miles from Lisbon. Through his father Gonzalo d'Albuquerque, the Lord of Villaverde, he was descended, but illegitimately, from King Diniz; and through his mother from the Menezez, the great explorers. Brought up at the court of Alphonzo V., he there received as liberal and thorough an education as was possible at the period. He made an especial study of the great writers of antiquity, whose influence may be traced in the majesty and accuracy of his own style, and of mathematics of which he knew as much as could be learnt at that time. After staying for some years at Arzila, an African town which was under the dominion of Alphonzo V., he returned to Portugal, and was appointed Master of the Horse to John II., a prince whose chief anxiety was to extend the name and power of Portugal beyond the seas. It is evident that it was to the constant attendance upon the king imposed upon him by the duties of his office, that Albuquerque owed the inclination of his mind towards geographical studies, and his anxious desire to find the means of giving to his country the Empire of the Indies. He had already taken part in an expedition sent to the succour of the King of Naples against an incursion of the Turks, and in 1489, had been charged with the commission of revictualling and defending the fortress of Graciosa, upon the coast of Larache.
Alfonzo d'Alboquerque, or d'Albuquerque, was born in 1453 in Alhandra, about eighteen miles from Lisbon. He was the illegitimate descendant of King Diniz through his father, Gonzalo d'Albuquerque, Lord of Villaverde, and he traced his lineage through his mother to the Menezez, the famous explorers. Raised at the court of Alphonzo V, he received one of the best educations available at that time. He particularly focused on the great writers of antiquity, whose influence is evident in the grandeur and precision of his own writing. He also studied mathematics to the extent that was possible then. After spending several years in Arzila, a North African town under Alphonzo V's rule, he returned to Portugal and became the Master of the Horse for John II, a prince who was primarily concerned with extending Portugal's name and power overseas. It is clear that his constant presence with the king, due to his official duties, sparked his interest in geography and his strong desire to secure India for his country. He had already participated in a mission to support the King of Naples against a Turkish invasion and, in 1489, was tasked with resupplying and defending the fortress of Graciosa on the coast of Larache.
We must now return from this digression and take up the history of Albuquerque, from the time of his arrival in India in 1503. It took him but a few days to become thoroughly aware of the position of affairs; he perceived that the commerce of Portugal must depend upon conquest for its power of development. But his first enterprise was proportioned to the feebleness of his resources; he laid siege to Raphelim, which he wished to make a military station for his countrymen, and then with two ships he undertook a reconnaissance of the coast of Hindostan. Being attacked quite unexpectedly both by land and sea, he was on the point of yielding when the fortunate arrival of his cousin Francisco turned the combat, and put the Zamorin's troops to flight. The importance of this victory was considerable; the conquerors remained masters of an immense booty and quantities of precious stones, which had the result of stimulating the Portuguese spirit of covetousness; at the same time it confirmed Albuquerque in his designs, for the execution of which the consent of the king was needful, and also more considerable resources. He therefore set out on his return to Lisbon, where he arrived in July, 1504.
We need to get back from this digression and pick up the story of Albuquerque, starting from when he arrived in India in 1503. It took him only a few days to fully understand the situation; he realized that Portugal's trade depended on conquest to grow. However, his first mission matched the limited resources he had; he laid siege to Raphelim, which he wanted to turn into a military base for his fellow countrymen, and then with two ships, he conducted a coastal reconnaissance of Hindostan. He was unexpectedly attacked from both land and sea and was about to give in when his cousin Francisco's timely arrival changed the tide of battle, sending the Zamorin's troops fleeing. This victory was significant; the conquerors gained a huge amount of loot and precious stones, which fueled the Portuguese desire for more riches. It also encouraged Albuquerque in his plans that required the king's approval and more substantial resources. He then set off back to Lisbon, arriving in July 1504.
This same year, King Emmanuel wishing to organize a regular government in the Indies, had made Tristan da Cunha his viceroy, but Da Cunha having become temporarily blind was obliged to resign his power before he had exercised it. The king's choice next fell upon Francisco d'Almeida, who set out with his son in 1505. It will be soon seen what were the means which he considered should be employed to assure the triumph of his countrymen.
This same year, King Emmanuel wanted to establish a regular government in the Indies, so he appointed Tristan da Cunha as his viceroy. However, Da Cunha temporarily lost his sight and had to step down before he could take on his role. The king then chose Francisco d'Almeida, who set out with his son in 1505. Soon, we will see what methods he believed should be used to ensure the success of his fellow countrymen.
On the 6th of March, 1506, sixteen vessels left Lisbon under the command of Tristan da Cunha, who had by that time regained his health. With him went Alfonzo Albuquerque, carrying with him, but unknown to himself, his patent of Viceroy of India. He was ordered not to open the sealed packet until three years should have expired, when Almeida would have completed the term of his mission.
On March 6, 1506, sixteen ships set sail from Lisbon under the command of Tristan da Cunha, who had by then recovered his health. Accompanying him was Alfonzo Albuquerque, who, without realizing it, carried his Viceroy of India appointment. He was instructed not to open the sealed packet until three years had passed, at which point Almeida would have finished his mission.
This numerous fleet, after having stopped at the Cape de Verd Islands and discovered Cape St. Augustine in Brazil, steered directly for the unexplored parts of the South Atlantic, and went so far south that the old chroniclers assert that several sailors being too lightly clad died from cold, while the others were scarcely able to work the ships. In 37° 8' south latitude, and 14° 21' west longitude, Da Cunha discovered three small uninhabited islands, of which the largest still bears his name. A storm prevented a landing there, and so completely dispersed the fleet that the admiral could not get his vessels together again before he arrived at Mozambique. In sailing along this African coast he explored the island of Madagascar or Sam-Lorenzo, which had just been discovered by Soarez, who was in command of eight vessels which Almeida was sending back to Europe; it was not thought advisable to make a settlement upon the island.
This large fleet, after stopping at the Cape Verde Islands and discovering Cape St. Augustine in Brazil, headed straight for the unexplored areas of the South Atlantic. They went so far south that old chroniclers say several sailors, dressed too lightly, died from the cold, while others could barely manage the ships. At 37° 8' south latitude and 14° 21' west longitude, Da Cunha found three small uninhabited islands, with the largest still named after him. A storm stopped them from landing there and scattered the fleet so much that the admiral couldn't regroup his ships until he reached Mozambique. While sailing along the African coast, he explored the island of Madagascar, or Sam-Lorenzo, which had just been discovered by Soarez, who was in charge of eight vessels that Almeida was sending back to Europe; it was decided not to establish a settlement on the island.
After having wintered at Mozambique, Da Cunha landed three ambassadors at Melinda, who were to reach Abyssinia by travelling overland, then he anchored at Brava, which Coutinho, one of his lieutenants had been unable to subjugate. The Portuguese now laid siege to this town, which resisted bravely but which yielded in the end, thanks to the courage of the enemy and the perfection of their arms. The population was massacred without mercy, and the town pillaged and burnt. Upon Magadoxo, another town on the African Coast, Cunha tried but in vain, to impose his authority. The strength of the town and the stubborn resolution shown by the numerous population as well as the approach of winter forced him to raise the siege. He then turned his arms against Socotra, at the entrance of the Gulf of Aden, where he carried the fortress. The whole of the garrison were put to the sword, the only man spared being an old blind soldier, who was discovered hidden in a well. When asked how he had been able to get down there, he answered,—"The blind only see the road which leads to liberty." At Socotra, the two Portuguese chiefs constructed the fort of Çoco, intended by Albuquerque to command the Gulf of Aden and the Red Sea, by the Strait of Bab-el-Mandeb, thus cutting one of the lines of communication with the Indies, which was the most used by the Venetians.
After spending the winter in Mozambique, Da Cunha dropped off three ambassadors at Melinda, who were set to reach Abyssinia by traveling overland. He then anchored at Brava, which Coutinho, one of his lieutenants, had failed to conquer. The Portuguese laid siege to this town, which put up a brave fight but ultimately fell due to the enemy's courage and the effectiveness of their weapons. The population was mercilessly slaughtered, and the town was pillaged and burned. In Magadoxo, another town on the African coast, Cunha tried unsuccessfully to assert his authority. The town's strength and the determined resistance of the large population, along with the approach of winter, forced him to lift the siege. He then turned his efforts against Socotra, at the entrance of the Gulf of Aden, where he captured the fortress. The entire garrison was killed, except for an old blind soldier who was found hiding in a well. When asked how he got down there, he replied, "The blind only see the road that leads to freedom." At Socotra, the two Portuguese leaders built the fort of Çoco, which was intended by Albuquerque to control the Gulf of Aden and the Red Sea via the Strait of Bab-el-Mandeb, thereby cutting one of the main routes to the Indies, heavily used by the Venetians.
Here Da Cunha and Albuquerque separated, the former going to India to obtain a cargo of spices, the latter officially invested with the title of Capitam mõr, and bent on the realization of his vast schemes, setting out on the 10th of August, 1507, for Ormuz, having left his nephew Alfonzo da Noronha in charge of the new fortress. He took in succession, and as if to get his hand in for the work, Calayati, where were found immense stores, Curiaty and Mascati, which he gave up to pillage, fire, and destruction, in order to avenge a series of acts of treachery easily understood by those who know the duplicity of these eastern people. The success which he had just gained at Mascati, important as it was, did not content Albuquerque. He dreamed of other and grander projects, of which the execution was, however, much compromised by the jealousy of the captains under his orders, and notably of Joao da Nova, who contemplated abandoning his chief, and whom Albuquerque was obliged to place under arrest on board his own ship. After having suppressed these beginnings of disobedience and rebellion, the Capitam mõr reached Orfacati, which was taken after a vigorous resistance.
Here Da Cunha and Albuquerque parted ways, with Da Cunha heading to India to get a shipment of spices, while Albuquerque, officially titled Captain Major, focused on his ambitious plans. He set out on August 10, 1507, for Ormuz, leaving his nephew Alfonzo da Noronha in charge of the new fortress. As if to get accustomed to the task, he successively attacked Calayati, which had vast supplies, Curiaty, and Mascati, which he allowed to be looted, burned, and destroyed, seeking revenge for a series of betrayals that those familiar with the deceit of these eastern people would easily understand. Despite the significant victory at Mascati, Albuquerque was not satisfied. He envisioned even bigger projects, though their execution was jeopardized by the jealousy of the captains under his command, particularly Joao da Nova, who considered abandoning his leader, forcing Albuquerque to arrest him on his own ship. After quelling these early signs of disobedience and rebellion, the Captain Major arrived at Orfacati, which he captured after intense resistance.
It is a curious fact that Albuquerque had long heard Ormuz spoken of, but that as yet he was ignorant of its position. He knew that this town served as an entrepôt for all the merchandise passing from Asia into Europe. Its riches and power, the number of its inhabitants and the beauty of its monuments were at that time celebrated throughout the East, so much so that there was a common saying, "If the world be a ring, Ormuz is the precious stone set in it." Albuquerque had resolved to take this town, not only because in itself it was a prize worth having, but also because it commanded the whole of the Persian Gulf, which was the second of the great commercial roads between the East and West. Without saying anything to the captains of his fleet, who, without doubt, would have rebelled at the idea of attacking so strong a town, and the capital of a powerful empire, Albuquerque gave orders to double Cape Mussendom, and the fleet soon entered the Strait of Ormuz, the door of the Persian Gulf, from whence was seen rising in all its magnificence a busy town built upon a rocky island, provided with formidable artillery, and protected by an army amounting to not less than from fifteen to twenty thousand men, while its harbour enclosed a fleet more numerous than could have been suspected at first sight. At this sight the captains made urgent representations upon the danger that Albuquerque would run in attacking so well-prepared a town, and made the most of the plea how very bad an influence a reverse would exercise. To this discourse Albuquerque answered, that indeed "it was a very great affair, but that it was too late to draw back, and that he had greater need of determination than of good advice."
It’s interesting to note that Albuquerque had heard a lot about Ormuz, but he didn’t actually know where it was. He understood that this town was a hub for all the goods moving from Asia to Europe. Its wealth and power, the size of its population, and the beauty of its landmarks were well-known throughout the East, to the point that there was a saying, “If the world is a ring, Ormuz is the precious stone set in it.” Albuquerque was determined to capture this town, not just because it was a valuable target, but also because it controlled the entire Persian Gulf, which was one of the major trade routes between the East and the West. Without telling his fleet’s captains, who probably would have opposed the idea of attacking such a stronghold and the capital of a powerful empire, Albuquerque ordered them to round Cape Mussendom, and soon the fleet entered the Strait of Ormuz, the gateway to the Persian Gulf. There, they saw a bustling town built on a rocky island, complete with heavy artillery and defended by an army of at least fifteen to twenty thousand men, while its harbor held a fleet larger than they could have imagined. Seeing this, the captains urgently expressed their concerns about the risks Albuquerque would face in attacking such a well-defended town and argued about the negative impact a failure would have. In response, Albuquerque said that while it was indeed a serious matter, it was too late to back out, and that what he needed now was determination rather than more advice.
![]() |
Albuquerque before Ormuz. |
Scarcely was the anchor dropped before Albuquerque declared his ultimatum. Although the forces under his orders were very disproportionate in numbers, the Capitam mõr imperiously demanded that Ormuz should recognize the suzerainty of the King of Portugal and submit to his envoy, if it did not wish to share the same fate as Mascati. The King, Seif-Ed-din, who was then reigning over Ormuz, was still a child, and his Prime Minister, Kodja-Atar, a skilful and cunning diplomatist, governed in the king's name. Without denying in principle the pretensions of Albuquerque, the Prime Minister wished to gain time, to allow contingents to arrive for the help of the capital; but the admiral, who guessed his object, did not hesitate, after waiting three days, to attack the formidable fleet at anchor under the guns of Ormuz, with his five vessels and the Flor de la Mar, the finest and largest ship of that time. The combat was bloody and long undecided, but when they saw fortune was against them the Moors, abandoning their vessels, endeavoured to swim on shore. The Portuguese upon this jumped into their boats, pursuing the Moors vigorously, and causing horrible carnage. Albuquerque next directed his efforts against a large wooden jetty defended by numerous guns and by archers, whose well-aimed arrows wounded a number of the Portuguese and the general himself, who, however, was not hindered thereby from landing and proceeding to burn the suburbs of the town. Convinced that resistance would soon be impossible, and that their capital was in danger of being destroyed, the Moors hoisted a flag of truce, and signed a treaty, by which Seif-Ed-din declared himself the vassal of King Emmanuel, promised to pay him an annual tribute of 15,000 seraphins or xarafins, and gave to the conquerors a site for a fortress, which, in spite of the repugnance and reproaches of the Portuguese captains, was soon put into a condition of resistance. Unfortunately some deserters quickly brought these unworthy dissensions to the knowledge of Kodja-Atar, who profited by them to avoid, under various pretexts, fulfilling the execution of the articles of the new treaty. Some days afterwards Joao da Nova and two other captains, jealous of the successes of Albuquerque, and trampling in the dust every sentiment of honour, discipline, and patriotism, left him to go to the Indies; while Albuquerque was obliged by this cowardly desertion to withdraw without being able even to guard the fortress which he had been at so much pains to construct. He went to Socotra, where the garrison was in need of help, and then returned to cruise before Ormuz, but thinking himself too weak to undertake anything, he retired for a time to Goa, arriving there at the end of the year 1508.
Scarcely had the anchor been dropped before Albuquerque made his demands clear. Despite his forces being vastly outnumbered, the Captain demanded that Ormuz acknowledge the authority of the King of Portugal and submit to his envoy, or face the same fate as Mascati. The reigning King, Seif-Ed-din, was still a child, and his Prime Minister, Kodja-Atar, a skilled and cunning diplomat, was running the kingdom in his name. While the Prime Minister didn’t outright reject Albuquerque’s claims, he aimed to buy time to let reinforcements arrive to defend the capital. However, after waiting three days and sensing his intentions, the admiral decided to attack the strong Moorish fleet anchored under the protection of Ormuz with his five ships, including the Flor de la Mar, the largest and finest ship of that time. The battle was bloody and fought to a standstill, but seeing their fortune turn against them, the Moors abandoned their ships and tried to swim to shore. The Portuguese quickly jumped into their boats, pursuing the Moors vigorously and causing significant casualties. Albuquerque then focused on a large wooden jetty that was defended by numerous cannons and archers, whose accurately shot arrows injured several Portuguese, including the general himself, who nonetheless pressed on to land and set fire to the town’s suburbs. Realizing that further resistance would soon be futile and that their capital was at risk of destruction, the Moors raised a flag of truce and signed a treaty in which Seif-Ed-din declared himself a vassal of King Emmanuel, promised to pay an annual tribute of 15,000 seraphins or xarafins, and granted the conquerors land for a fortress, which, despite the reluctance and objections of the Portuguese captains, was hastily prepared for defense. Unfortunately, some deserters quickly informed Kodja-Atar of these disagreements, and he exploited them to delay the implementation of the treaty. A few days later, Joao da Nova and two other captains, envious of Albuquerque's successes and disregarding any sense of honor, discipline, or patriotism, abandoned him to go to the Indies. This cowardly desertion forced Albuquerque to withdraw without being able to protect the fortress he had worked so hard to build. He traveled to Socotra, where the garrison needed assistance, and then returned to patrol off Ormuz, but considering himself too weak to take any action, he retreated for a while to Goa, arriving there by the end of 1508.
What had been occurring on the Malabar coast during this long and adventurous campaign? The answer may be summed up in a few lines. It will be remembered that Almeida had set out from Belem in 1505 with a fleet of twenty-two sail, carrying soldiers to the number of 1500 men. First he seized Quiloa and then Mombaz, of which the "cavaliers, as the inhabitants loved to repeat, did not yield as easily as the chicken hearts of Quiloa." Out of the enormous booty, which by the fall of this town fell into the hands of the Portuguese, Almeida only took one arrow as his share of the spoil, thus giving a rare example of disinterestedness. After having stopped at Melinda he went on to Cochin, where he delivered to the Rajah the golden crown sent to him by Emmanuel, whilst he himself, with the presumptuous vanity of which he gave so many proofs, assumed the title of viceroy. Then, after commencing a fortress at Sofala, destined to overawe the Mussulmen of that coast, Almeida and his son, Lorenzo, scoured the Indian Seas, destroying the Malabar fleets, capturing some trading vessels, and causing great injury to the enemy, whose accustomed commercial roads were thus intercepted. But for this cruising warfare a numerous fleet of light vessels was needed, for there was scarcely any other harbour of refuge except Cochin upon the Asiatic coast. How preferable was Albuquerque's system of establishing himself in the country in a permanent manner, by constructing fortresses in all directions, by seizing upon the most powerful cities, whence it was easy to branch off into the interior of the country, by rendering himself master of the keys of the straits, and thus ensuring with much less risk, and more solidity, the monopoly of the Indian commerce.
What had been happening on the Malabar coast during this long and adventurous campaign? The answer can be summarized in a few lines. Almeida had set sail from Belem in 1505 with a fleet of twenty-two ships and 1,500 soldiers. First, he captured Quiloa and then Mombaz, which the locals liked to say did not give up as easily as the chicken hearts of Quiloa. From the massive loot gained after the fall of this town, Almeida only took one arrow as his share, showcasing a rare act of selflessness. After stopping at Melinda, he moved on to Cochin, where he presented the Rajah with the golden crown sent by Emmanuel, while he himself, showing the arrogant vanity he often displayed, claimed the title of viceroy. Then, after starting to build a fortress at Sofala to intimidate the Muslims on that coast, Almeida and his son, Lorenzo, patrolled the Indian Seas, destroying Malabar fleets, capturing some trading ships, and causing significant damage to the enemy by disrupting their usual trade routes. However, this kind of naval warfare required a large fleet of light vessels, as there were hardly any other safe harbors on the Asian coast except Cochin. Albuquerque's strategy of establishing a permanent presence in the region by building fortresses everywhere and capturing the most powerful cities, from which he could easily penetrate the interior, and controlling the key straits, was clearly preferable. This method ensured the monopoly of Indian trade with much less risk and greater stability.
Meantime the victories of Almeida, and the conquests of Albuquerque had much disquieted the Sultan of Egypt. The abandonment of the Alexandrian route caused a great diminution in the amount of imposts and dues of customs, anchorage, and transit, which were laid upon the merchandise of Asia as it passed through his states. Therefore, with the help of the Venetians, who furnished him with the wood for ship-building as well as with skilful sailors, he fitted out a squadron of twelve large ships, which came as far as Cochin, seeking the fleet of Lorenzo d'Almeida, and defeating it in a bloody combat in which Lorenzo was killed. If the sorrow of the viceroy were great at this sad news, at least he did not let it appear outwardly, but set to work to make all preparations for taking prompt vengeance upon the Roumis,—an appellation which shows the lasting terror attaching to the name of the Romans, and commonly used at this time upon the Malabar coast, for all Mussulman soldiers coming from Byzantium. With nineteen sail Almeida appeared before the fort where his son had been killed, and gained a great victory, but one sullied, it must be confessed, by most frightful cruelties, so much so that it soon became a common saying: "May the anger of the Franks fall upon thee as it fell upon Daboul." Not content with this first success, Almeida, some weeks later, annihilated the combined forces of the Sultan of Egypt, and the Rajah of Calicut, before Diu. This victory made a profound impression in India, and put an end to the power of the Mahumetists of Egypt.
Meanwhile, the victories of Almeida and the conquests of Albuquerque unsettled the Sultan of Egypt. The closure of the Alexandria route led to a significant drop in the customs duties and fees imposed on Asian goods passing through his territories. As a result, with the assistance of the Venetians, who provided the wood for shipbuilding and skilled sailors, he prepared a squadron of twelve large ships that reached Cochin, where they ambushed Lorenzo d'Almeida's fleet and defeated it in a brutal battle that resulted in Lorenzo’s death. Though the viceroy was deeply troubled by this tragic news, he didn't show it outwardly and immediately began organizing to take swift revenge on the Roumis—a term reflecting the lasting fear associated with the Romans, commonly used at that time along the Malabar coast to refer to all Muslim soldiers from Byzantium. With nineteen ships, Almeida appeared before the fort where his son had been killed and achieved a significant victory, though it was tainted by terrible atrocities, leading to the saying: "May the wrath of the Franks strike you as it did Daboul." Not satisfied with this initial success, Almeida went on to completely destroy the combined forces of the Sultan of Egypt and the Rajah of Calicut near Diu a few weeks later. This victory left a lasting impact in India and effectively ended the power of the Mahumetists of Egypt.
Joao da Nova and the other captains, who had abandoned Albuquerque before Ormuz, had decided to rejoin Almeida; they had excused their disobedience by calumnies, in consequence of which a judicial process was about to be instituted against Albuquerque, when the viceroy received the news of his being replaced in his office by Albuquerque. At first Almeida declared that obedience must be rendered to this sovereign decree, but afterwards influenced by the traitors, who feared that they would be severely punished when the power had passed into the hands of Albuquerque, he repaired to Cochin in the month of March, 1509, with the fixed determination not to give up the command to his successor. There were disagreeable and painful disputes between these two great men, in which all the wrong done was on the side of Almeida. Albuquerque was about to be sent to Lisbon with chains on his feet, when a fleet of fifteen sail entered the harbour, under the command of the grand Marshal of Portugal, Ferdinand Coutinho. The latter took the part of the prisoner, whom he immediately released, notifying again to Almeida the powers held by Albuquerque from the king, and threatening him with the great anger of Emmanuel if he refused to obey. Almeida could do nothing but yield, and he then did it nobly. As for Joao da Nova, the author of these sad misunderstandings, he died some time afterwards, forsaken by everybody, and had scarcely any one to follow him to the grave except the new viceroy, who thus generously forgot the injuries done to Alfonzo Albuquerque.
Joao da Nova and the other captains, who had abandoned Albuquerque before Ormuz, decided to rejoin Almeida. They justified their disobedience with false accusations, leading to a legal action being prepared against Albuquerque when the viceroy received news that he was being replaced by Albuquerque. Initially, Almeida insisted that everyone must obey this royal order, but later, swayed by the traitors who feared severe punishment once Albuquerque was in power, he went to Cochin in March 1509, determined not to hand over command to his successor. There were unpleasant and painful conflicts between these two prominent figures, with Almeida being entirely in the wrong. Albuquerque was about to be sent to Lisbon in chains when a fleet of fifteen ships arrived in the harbor, commanded by Portugal's grand Marshal, Ferdinand Coutinho. Coutinho supported the prisoner, immediately freeing him and reminding Almeida of the powers granted to Albuquerque by the king, threatening him with severe consequences from Emmanuel if he refused to comply. Almeida had no choice but to submit, and he did so with dignity. As for Joao da Nova, the source of these unfortunate conflicts, he died some time later, abandoned by everyone, with hardly anyone attending his funeral except the new viceroy, who generously overlooked the wrongs done to Alfonzo Albuquerque.
Immediately after the departure of Almeida, the grand Marshal Coutinho declared that, having come to India with the intention of destroying Calicut, he intended to turn to account the absence of the Zamorin from his capital. In vain the new viceroy endeavoured to modify his zeal and induce him to take the wise measures recommended by experience. Coutinho would listen to nothing, and Albuquerque was obliged to follow him. Calicut, taken by surprise, was easily set on fire; but the Portuguese, having lingered to pillage the Zamorin's palace, were fiercely attacked in rear by the Nairs, who had succeeded in rallying their troops. Coutinho, whose impetuous valour led him into the greatest danger, was killed, and it required all the skill and coolness of the viceroy to effect a re-embarkation of the troops under the enemy's fire, and to preserve the soldiers of the King of Portugal from total destruction.
Immediately after Almeida left, the grand Marshal Coutinho announced that, having come to India with the goal of destroying Calicut, he planned to take advantage of the Zamorin's absence from his capital. The new viceroy tried in vain to calm his enthusiasm and persuade him to adopt the wise strategies suggested by experience. Coutinho refused to listen, and Albuquerque had no choice but to follow him. Calicut was caught off guard and quickly set on fire; however, the Portuguese, having slowed down to loot the Zamorin's palace, were fiercely attacked from behind by the Nairs, who had managed to regroup their forces. Coutinho, whose reckless bravery put him in the greatest danger, was killed, and it took all of the viceroy's skill and composure to evacuate the troops under enemy fire and save the soldiers of the King of Portugal from complete destruction.
On his return to Cintagara, a sea-port which was a dependency of the King of Narsingue, with whom the Portuguese had been able to form an alliance, Albuquerque learnt that Goa, the capital of a powerful kingdom, was a prey to political and religious anarchy. Several chiefs were contending there for power. One of them, Melek Çufergugi, was just on the point of seizing the throne, and it was important to profit by the circumstances of the moment, and attack the town before he should have been able to gather a force capable of resisting the Portuguese. The viceroy perceived all the importance of this counsel. The situation of Goa, giving access as it did to the kingdom of Narsingue and to the Deccan, had already struck him forcibly. He did not delay, and soon the Portuguese reckoned one conquest more. Goa the Golden, a cosmopolitan town, where were mingled with all the various sects of Islam Parsees, the worshippers of Fire, and even some Christians, submitted to Albuquerque, and soon became, under a wise and strict government which understood how to conciliate the sympathies of opposing sects, the capital, the chief fortress, and the principal seat of trade of the Portuguese empire of the Indies.
On his return to Cintagara, a seaport that was under the control of the King of Narsingue, with whom the Portuguese had formed an alliance, Albuquerque learned that Goa, the capital of a powerful kingdom, was in the midst of political and religious chaos. Several leaders were fighting for power there. One of them, Melek Çufergugi, was on the verge of seizing the throne, and it was crucial to take advantage of the moment and attack the city before he could assemble a force strong enough to oppose the Portuguese. The viceroy recognized the significance of this advice. The location of Goa, which provided access to the kingdom of Narsingue and the Deccan, had already made a strong impression on him. He took immediate action, and soon the Portuguese celebrated yet another conquest. Goa the Golden, a diverse city where various sects of Islam, Parsees, fire worshippers, and even some Christians coexisted, fell under Albuquerque's control and quickly became, under a wise and strict government that adeptly balanced the interests of different sects, the capital, main fortress, and primary trading center of the Portuguese empire in the Indies.
By degrees and with the course of years the knowledge of these rich countries had increased. Much information had been gathered together by all those who had ploughed these sunny seas in their gallant vessels, and it was now known what was the centre of production of those spices which people went so far to seek, and for whose acquisition they encountered so many perils. It was already several years since Almeida had founded the first Portuguese factories in Ceylon, the ancient Taprobane. The Islands of Sunda, and the Peninsula of Malacca, were now exciting the desires of King Emmanuel, who had already been surnamed "the fortunate." He resolved to send a fleet to explore them, for Albuquerque had enough to do in India to restrain the trembling Rajahs, and the Mussulmen—Moors as they were then called—who were always ready to shake off the yoke. This new expedition was under the command of Diego Lopez Sequeira, and according to the traditional policy of the Moors, was at first amicably received at Malacca; but when the suspicions of Lopez Sequeira had been lulled to sleep by reiterated protestations of alliance, the whole population suddenly rose against him, and he was forced to return on board, but not without leaving thirty of his companions in the hands of the Malays. These events had already happened some time when the news of the taking of Goa arrived at Malacca. The bendarra, or Minister of Justice, who exercised regal power in the name of his nephew who was still a child, fearing the vengeance which the Portuguese would doubtless exact for his treachery, resolved to pacify them. He went to visit his prisoners, excused himself to them by swearing that all had been done unknown to him and against his will, for he desired nothing so much as to see the Portuguese establish themselves in Malacca; also he was about to order the authors of the treason to be sought out and punished. The prisoners naturally gave no credence to these lying declarations, but profiting by the comparative liberty which was henceforth granted to them, they cleverly succeeded in conveying to Albuquerque some valuable information upon the position and strength of the town.
Gradually, over the years, knowledge of these rich lands grew. A lot of information had been collected by those who navigated these sunny seas in their brave ships, and it became clear where the main source of those spices, which people went to great lengths to find and for which they faced numerous dangers, was located. It had been several years since Almeida established the first Portuguese trading posts in Ceylon, the ancient Taprobane. The Sunda Islands and the Malacca Peninsula were now capturing the interest of King Emmanuel, who had already earned the nickname "the fortunate." He decided to send a fleet to explore these areas, as Albuquerque had his hands full in India managing the anxious Rajahs and the Muslims—then called Moors—who were always looking to break free from control. This new expedition was led by Diego Lopez Sequeira, and in line with the Moors' usual approach, it was initially welcomed in Malacca. However, when Lopez Sequeira's suspicions were eased by repeated promises of alliance, the entire population suddenly turned against him. He was forced to retreat aboard his ship, but not before leaving thirty of his crew in the hands of the Malays. These events had already taken place some time ago when news of Goa's capture reached Malacca. The bendarra, or Minister of Justice, who wielded royal power on behalf of his young nephew, fearing revenge from the Portuguese for his betrayal, decided to appease them. He visited his captives, claimed that everything had been done without his knowledge and against his wishes, as he truly wanted to see the Portuguese settle in Malacca. He also intended to have those responsible for the betrayal found and punished. The prisoners naturally didn’t believe his false claims, but taking advantage of the relative freedom they were now granted, they cleverly managed to send some valuable information to Albuquerque about the town’s position and strength.
Albuquerque with much trouble collected a fleet of nineteen men of war, carrying fourteen hundred men, amongst whom there were only eight hundred Portuguese. This being the case, ought he to venture in obedience to the wish of King Emmanuel to steer for Aden, the key of the Red Sea, which it was important to master in preparation for opposing the passage of a new squadron, which the Sultan of Egypt was intending to send to India? Albuquerque hesitated, when a change in the trade-winds occurred which put an end to his irresolution. In fact, it was impossible to reach Aden in the teeth of the prevailing wind, while it was favourable for a descent upon Malacca. This town, at that time in its full splendour, did not contain less than 100,000 inhabitants. If many of the houses were built of wood, and roofed with the leaves of the palm-tree, yet they were equalled in number by the more important buildings, such as mosques and towers built of stone, which stretched out in a long panorama for the distance of three miles. The ships of India, China, and of the Malay kingdoms of the Sunda Islands, met in its harbour, where numerous vessels coming from the Malabar coast, the Persian Gulf, the Red Sea, and the coast of Africa traded in merchandise of all kinds and of every country.
Albuquerque had a tough time gathering a fleet of nineteen warships, carrying fourteen hundred men, among whom there were only eight hundred Portuguese. Given this situation, should he follow King Emmanuel's wish to head for Aden, the key to the Red Sea, which was crucial to control in preparation for countering a new squadron that the Sultan of Egypt planned to send to India? Albuquerque hesitated until a shift in the trade winds resolved his uncertainty. In reality, it was impossible to reach Aden against the prevailing wind, while the conditions were favorable for a move on Malacca. This town, at that time at its peak, had at least 100,000 residents. Although many houses were made of wood and roofed with palm leaves, they were matched in number by the more significant structures like mosques and stone towers, which extended for three miles. Ships from India, China, and the Malay kingdoms of the Sunda Islands gathered in its harbor, where numerous vessels coming from the Malabar coast, the Persian Gulf, the Red Sea, and the African coast traded all kinds of goods from every corner of the world.
When the Rajah of Malacca saw the Portuguese fleet arrive in his waters, he felt that it was necessary to appear to give satisfaction to the foreigners by sacrificing the minister who had excited their anger and caused their arrival. His ambassador therefore came to the viceroy to announce the death of the bendarra, and to find out what were the intentions of the Portuguese. Albuquerque answered by demanding the prisoners who had remained in the hands of the Rajah, but the latter, desirous of gaining time to allow for the expected change in the trade-wind,—a change which would force the Portuguese to regain the Malabar coast, or else would oblige them to remain at Malacca, where he hoped to be able to exterminate them,—invented a thousand pretexts for delay, and in the meantime according to the old narratives, he prepared a battery of 8000 cannon, and collected troops to the number of 20,000. At length Albuquerque lost his patience, and ordered some houses and several Gujerat vessels to be set on fire, a beginning of execution which speedily brought about the restoration of the prisoners; he then claimed 20,000 crusades as indemnity for the damage caused to the fleet of Lopez Sequeira, and finally he demanded to be allowed to build a fortress within the town itself, which should also serve as a counting-house for the merchants. This demand could not be complied with as Albuquerque well knew; but upon the refusal he resolved to seize the town, fixing upon St. James' day for the attack. The town was taken quarter by quarter, house by house, after a truly heroic struggle and a most vigorous defence, which lasted for nine whole days, notwithstanding the employment of extraordinary devices, such as elephants of war, poisoned sabres and arrows, barricades, and skilfully concealed troops. An enormous booty was divided amongst the soldiers, Albuquerque only reserving to himself six lions, of gold according to some accounts, of iron according to others, which he intended for the adornment of his tomb, to perpetuate the memory of his victory.
When the Rajah of Malacca saw the Portuguese fleet arrive in his waters, he felt it was necessary to show the foreigners that he was willing to satisfy them by sacrificing the minister who had angered them and caused their arrival. His ambassador went to the viceroy to announce the minister's death and to find out what the Portuguese intended to do. Albuquerque responded by demanding the prisoners that remained in the Rajah's hands, but the Rajah, wanting to buy time for the expected change in the trade wind—which would either force the Portuguese to return to the Malabar coast or leave them stuck at Malacca, where he hoped to wipe them out—came up with countless excuses to delay. In the meantime, according to old accounts, he prepared a battery of 8,000 cannons and gathered 20,000 troops. Eventually, Albuquerque lost his patience and ordered some houses and several Gujerat vessels to be set on fire, which quickly led to the return of the prisoners. He then claimed 20,000 crusades as compensation for the damage done to Lopez Sequeira's fleet, and finally, he requested permission to build a fortress in the town itself, which would also work as a trading post for merchants. He knew this request wouldn’t be granted, but upon its refusal, he decided to seize the town, choosing St. James' day for the attack. The town was taken quarter by quarter, house by house, after an incredibly heroic struggle and a vigorous defense that lasted nine whole days, despite the use of extraordinary tactics like war elephants, poisoned swords and arrows, barricades, and cleverly hidden troops. A massive amount of loot was shared among the soldiers, while Albuquerque kept only six lions for himself—some say they were made of gold, while others claim they were iron—as decorations for his tomb to commemorate his victory.
The door which gave access to Oceania, and to Upper Asia, was henceforth open. Many nations unknown till this time would now have intercourse with Europeans. The strange manners and fabulous history of many people were about to be disclosed to the astonished West. A new era had commenced, and these great results were due to the unbridled audacity, and indomitable courage of a nation whose country was scarcely discernible upon the map of the world!
The door that opened access to Oceania and Upper Asia was now wide open. Many nations previously unknown would soon interact with Europeans. The unusual customs and incredible stories of these people were about to be revealed to the amazed West. A new era had begun, and these significant changes were thanks to the fearless boldness and unwavering bravery of a nation hardly visible on the world map!
It was in part owing to the religious toleration which Albuquerque displayed, a toleration which contrasts strangely with the cruel fanaticism of the Spaniards, and in part to the skilful measures which he took, that the prosperity of Malacca resisted the rude shock which it had received. In the course of a few months no trace remained of the trials which the town had experienced, except the sight of the Portuguese banner floating proudly over this great city, which had now become the head and vanguard of the colonial empire of this people, small in numbers, but rendered great by their courage and their spirit of enterprise.
It was partly due to the religious tolerance that Albuquerque showed—a tolerance that stands in stark contrast to the cruel fanaticism of the Spaniards—and partly because of the smart strategies he implemented, that the prosperity of Malacca withstood the harsh impact it faced. Within a few months, there was no sign left of the hardships the town had endured, except for the sight of the Portuguese flag waving proudly over this great city, which had now become the leader and front line of this people’s colonial empire, small in numbers but made great by their bravery and entrepreneurial spirit.
Great and wonderful as this new conquest might be, it had not made Albuquerque forget his former projects. If he had appeared to have renounced them, it was only because circumstances had not hitherto seemed favourable for their execution. With that tenacity of determination which formed the basis of his character, while still at the southern extremity of the empire which he was founding, his thoughts were fixed upon the northern part of it, upon Ormuz, which the jealousy and treachery of his subordinates had obliged him to abandon at the beginning of his career, at the very moment when success was about to crown his persevering efforts; it was Ormuz which tempted him still.
Great and amazing as this new conquest might be, it hadn't made Albuquerque forget his previous plans. If he seemed to have given up on them, it was just because the circumstances hadn't been right for carrying them out. With his strong determination, which was the foundation of his character, even while he was at the southern end of the empire he was building, his thoughts were focused on the northern part of it, specifically Ormuz. The jealousy and betrayal of his subordinates had forced him to leave it behind at the start of his career, just when success was about to reward his hard work; it was Ormuz that still tempted him.
![]() |
The fame of his exploits and the terror inspired by his name had decided Kodja-Atar to make some advances to Albuquerque, to ask for a treaty, and to send the arrears of the tribute which had been formerly imposed. Although the viceroy placed no belief on these repeated declarations of friendship—on that Moorish faith which deserves to be as notorious as Punic faith,—he nevertheless welcomed them, whilst waiting for the power to establish his dominion after a permanent manner in these countries. In 1513 or 1514—the exact date is not ascertained—when his fleet and soldiers were set at liberty by the conquest of Malacca and the tranquillity of his other possessions, Albuquerque set sail for the Persian Gulf. Immediately upon his arrival, although a series of revolutions had changed the government of Ormuz and the power was then in the hands of a usurper named Rais-Nordim or Noureddin, Albuquerque demanded that the fortress, which had been formerly begun, should be immediately placed in his hands. After having had it repaired and finished, he took part against the pretender Rais Named, in the quarrel which was then dividing the town of Ormuz and preparing it to fall under the dominion of Persia. He seized upon the town and bestowed it upon the aspirant who had accepted his conditions beforehand, and who appeared to Albuquerque to present the most solid guarantees of submission and fidelity. Besides, it would not be difficult in the future to make this certain, for Albuquerque left in the new fortress a garrison perfectly able to bring Rais-Nordim to repentance for the slightest attempt at revolt, or the least desire of independence.
The reputation of his adventures and the fear his name evoked prompted Kodja-Atar to reach out to Albuquerque, seeking a treaty and sending the overdue tribute that had previously been imposed. Although the viceroy did not trust these repeated gestures of goodwill—considering the Moorish faith as unreliable as Punic faith—he still welcomed them while waiting for the opportunity to establish his control over these regions in a lasting way. In 1513 or 1514—the exact date is unclear—after the conquest of Malacca and the stability of his other territories freed up his fleet and soldiers, Albuquerque set sail for the Persian Gulf. Upon his arrival, even though a series of revolutions had reshaped the government of Ormuz and power was held by a usurper named Rais-Nordim or Noureddin, Albuquerque demanded that the fortress, which had been partially constructed, be immediately handed over to him. After repairing and completing it, he took action against the pretender Rais Named in the conflict that was then splitting Ormuz, preparing it to fall under Persian control. He took over the town and granted it to the claimant who had agreed to his terms beforehand and who seemed to Albuquerque to provide the strongest guarantees of submission and loyalty. Furthermore, it would not be hard to ensure this in the future, as Albuquerque left a well-trained garrison in the new fortress capable of reminding Rais-Nordim not to attempt revolt or seek independence.
A well-known anecdote is related of this expedition to Ormuz, but one which, even from its notoriety, we should be blamed for omitting. When the King of Persia sent to Noureddin to demand the tribute which the sovereigns of Ormuz had been in the habit of paying to him, Albuquerque gave orders that a quantity of bullets, cannon-balls and shells, should be brought from his ships, and showing them to the ambassadors he told them that such was the coin in which the King of Portugal was accustomed to pay tribute. It does not appear that the Persian ambassadors repeated their demand.
A well-known story is associated with this expedition to Ormuz, but one that we would be criticized for leaving out. When the King of Persia sent a message to Noureddin asking for the tribute that the rulers of Ormuz were used to paying him, Albuquerque ordered that a bunch of bullets, cannonballs, and shells be brought from his ships. After showing these to the ambassadors, he told them that this was the currency in which the King of Portugal preferred to pay tribute. It seems that the Persian ambassadors did not repeat their request.
![]() |
Albuquerque had a quantity of bullets brought from his vessels. |
With his usual wisdom, the viceroy did not wound the feelings of the inhabitants, who speedily returned to the town. Far from squeezing all he could from them, as his successors were destined soon to do, he established an upright system of government which caused the Portuguese name to be loved and respected.
With his usual wisdom, the viceroy did not hurt the feelings of the inhabitants, who quickly returned to the town. Instead of exploiting them like his successors would soon do, he set up a fair system of government that made people love and respect the Portuguese name.
At the same time that he was himself accomplishing these marvellous labours, Albuquerque had desired some of his lieutenants to explore the unknown regions to which access had been given by the taking of Malacca. For this purpose he gave to Antonio and Francisco d'Abreu the command of a small squadron carrying 220 men, with which they explored the whole of the Sunda Archipelago, Sumatra, Java, Anjoam, Simbala, Jolor, Galam, &c.; then being not far from the coast of Australia they sailed back again to the north and arrived at the Islands of Buro and Amboyna, which form part of the Molucca group. After having made a voyage of more than 1500 miles amongst dangerous archipelagos strewn with rocks and coral reefs, and amidst populations often hostile, and after loading their ships there with cloves, nutmegs, sandal-wood, mace, and pearls, they set sail for Malacca in 1512. This time the veritable land of spices had been reached, it now only remained to found establishments there and to take possession of it definitely, which was not likely to be long postponed.
At the same time he was achieving these amazing feats, Albuquerque had asked some of his lieutenants to explore the unknown areas made accessible by the capture of Malacca. For this task, he assigned Antonio and Francisco d'Abreu to lead a small squadron of 220 men to explore the entire Sunda Archipelago, including Sumatra, Java, Anjoam, Simbala, Jolor, Galam, etc. After getting close to the coast of Australia, they sailed back north and reached the islands of Buro and Amboyna, which are part of the Molucca group. After a voyage of over 1500 miles through dangerous archipelagos filled with rocks and coral reefs, and among often hostile populations, they loaded their ships with cloves, nutmegs, sandalwood, mace, and pearls and set sail for Malacca in 1512. This time they had truly reached the land of spices; now they just needed to establish settlements there and officially claim it, which was unlikely to be delayed for long.
It has been often remarked that the Tarpeian rock is not far from the Capitol; of this Albuquerque was destined to make experience, and his last days were to be saddened by unmerited disgrace, the result of calumnies and lies, and of a skilfully woven plot, which, although it succeeded in temporarily clouding his reputation with King Emmanuel, has not availed to obscure the glory of this great man in the eyes of posterity. Already there had been an effort made to persuade the king that the taking possession of Goa had been a grave error; its unhealthy climate must, it was said, decimate the European population in a short time, but the king, with perfect confidence in the experience and prudence of his lieutenant, had refused to listen to his enemies, for which Albuquerque had publicly thanked him, saying,—"I think more is owing to King Emmanuel for having defended Goa against the Portuguese, than to myself for having twice conquered it." But in 1514 Albuquerque had asked the king to bestow upon him as a reward for his services the title of Duke of Goa, and it was this imprudent step which gave an advantage to his adversaries.
It has often been noted that the Tarpeian rock is not far from the Capitol; this was something Albuquerque was destined to experience, and his final days were to be overshadowed by undeserved disgrace, due to slander and lies, and a cleverly devised plot that, although it temporarily tarnished his reputation with King Emmanuel, has not diminished the legacy of this great man in the eyes of future generations. There had already been an attempt to convince the king that taking possession of Goa was a serious mistake; it was claimed that its unhealthy climate would soon reduce the European population drastically, but the king, with complete trust in the experience and judgment of his lieutenant, refused to heed his enemies. Albuquerque publicly expressed his gratitude to the king, stating, "I owe more to King Emmanuel for defending Goa against the Portuguese than to myself for conquering it twice." However, in 1514, Albuquerque had requested that the king reward him with the title of Duke of Goa, and this unwise move gave his opponents an advantage.
Soarez d'Albergavia and Diogo Mendez, whom Albuquerque had sent as prisoners to Portugal after they had publicly declared themselves his enemies, had succeeded not only in clearing themselves from the accusation brought against them by the viceroy, but in persuading Emmanuel that he wished to constitute an independent duchy of which Goa should be the capital, and they ended by obtaining his disgrace. The news of the appointment of Albergavia to the post of Captain-General of Cochin, reached Albuquerque as he was issuing from the Strait of Ormuz on his return to the Malabar coast, and at a time when he was suffering much from disease. "He raised his hands towards heaven," says M. F. Denis, in his excellent History of Portugal, "and pronounced these few words: Behold I am in disgrace with the king on account of my love to men, and with men on account of my love to the king. Turn thee, old man, to the Church, and prepare to die, for it behoves thine honour that thou shouldest die, and never hast thou neglected to do aught which thine honour demands." Whereupon, being arrived in the roadstead of Goa, Alfonzo Albuquerque set in order the affairs of his conscience with the Church, caused himself to be clad in the dress of the Order of St. Iago of which he was a commander, and then "on Sunday the 16th of December, an hour before daybreak, he rendered up his soul to God. Thus ended all his labours, without their having ever brought him any satisfaction."
Soarez d'Albergavia and Diogo Mendez, whom Albuquerque had sent as prisoners to Portugal after they openly declared themselves his enemies, managed not only to clear their names from the accusations made against them by the viceroy, but also to convince Emmanuel that he wanted to create an independent duchy with Goa as its capital, ultimately leading to Albuquerque’s downfall. The news about Albergavia being appointed as Captain-General of Cochin reached Albuquerque while he was coming out of the Strait of Ormuz on his way back to the Malabar coast and at a time when he was suffering greatly from illness. "He raised his hands towards heaven," says M. F. Denis in his excellent History of Portugal, "and spoke these few words: Behold, I am in disgrace with the king for my love for men, and with men for my love for the king. Turn, old man, to the Church, and prepare to die, for your honor demands your death, and you have never neglected to do what your honor requires." Upon arriving in the roadstead of Goa, Alfonzo Albuquerque arranged his affairs with the Church, had himself dressed in the garb of the Order of St. Iago of which he was a commander, and then "on Sunday the 16th of December, an hour before daybreak, he surrendered his soul to God. Thus, all his efforts came to an end, without ever bringing him any satisfaction."
Albuquerque was buried with great pomp. The soldiers who had been the faithful companions of his wonderful adventures, and the witnesses of his manifold tribulations, disputed amidst their tears for the honour of carrying his remains to their last resting-place, which their commander had himself chosen. The Hindoos in their grief refused to believe that he was dead, declaring that he was gone to command the armies of the sky. A letter of King Emmanuel has been comparatively lately discovered which proves that, although he were deceived for a time by the false reports of the enemies of Albuquerque, he soon discovered his mistake, and rendered him full and entire justice. Unfortunately this letter of reparation never reached the unfortunate second Viceroy of the Indies; it would have sweetened his last moments, whereas he had the pain of dying in the belief that the sovereign for whose glory and the increase of whose power he had consecrated his life, had in the end proved ungrateful towards him. "With Albuquerque," says Michelet, "all humanity and all justice disappeared from amongst the conquerors. Long years after his death the Indians would repair to the tomb of the great Albuquerque, to demand justice of him against the oppressions of his successors."
Albuquerque was buried with great honors. The soldiers who had been his loyal companions through his incredible adventures and who had witnessed his many hardships fought through their tears for the privilege of carrying his body to the final resting place he had chosen himself. The Hindoos, in their sorrow, refused to accept that he was dead, insisting that he had gone to lead the armies of the sky. A letter from King Emmanuel was recently discovered, which shows that although he was initially misled by false reports from Albuquerque's enemies, he soon realized his mistake and gave him full credit. Unfortunately, this letter of acknowledgment never reached the unfortunate second Viceroy of the Indies; it would have comforted him in his final moments, while he suffered the pain of dying believing that the sovereign for whom he dedicated his life had ultimately been ungrateful to him. "With Albuquerque," says Michelet, "all humanity and all justice disappeared from among the conquerors. Many years after his death, the Indians would visit the tomb of the great Albuquerque to seek justice for the wrongs inflicted by his successors."
Many causes may be adduced as bringing about the rapid decay and dismemberment of that great colonial empire with which Albuquerque had enriched his country, and which even amidst its ruins has left ineffaceable traces upon India. With Michelet we may cite the distance and dispersion of the various factories, the smallness of the population of Portugal, but little suited to the wide extension of her establishments, the love of brigandage, and the exactions of a bad government, but beyond all, that indomitable national pride which forbade any mingling of the victors with the vanquished.
Many reasons can be given for the rapid decline and breakup of the great colonial empire that Albuquerque enriched his country with, which has left lasting marks on India even amidst its ruins. Following Michelet, we can mention the distances and separation of the various factories, the small size of Portugal's population, which was not well-suited to the vast reach of its settlements, the tendency towards banditry, and the burdens imposed by poor governance. But above all, it was that unyielding national pride that prevented any mixing of the victors with the defeated.
The fall of the colonial empire was hindered for a time by the influence of two heroic men, the first was Juan de Castro, who after having had the control of untold riches, remained so poor that he had not even the wherewithal to buy a fowl in his last illness; and the second, Ataïde, who once again gave the corrupt eastern populations an example of the most manly virtues, and of the most upright administration. But after their time the empire began to drop to pieces, and fell by degrees into the hands of the Spaniards and the Dutch, who in their turn were unable to preserve it intact. All passes away, all is changed. What can be said but to repeat the Spanish saw, in applying it to the case of empires, "Life is but a dream"?
The decline of the colonial empire was temporarily slowed by the impact of two heroic figures. The first was Juan de Castro, who, despite having controlled immense wealth, ended up so poor that he couldn't even afford a chicken during his final illness. The second, Ataïde, once again showed the corrupt eastern populations an example of manly virtues and honest leadership. However, after their time, the empire started to crumble and gradually fell into the hands of the Spaniards and the Dutch, who were also unable to keep it intact. Everything fades away, everything changes. What can we say but to echo the Spanish saying, applying it to empires: "Life is but a dream"?
PART II.
CHAPTER I.
I.
Hojeda—Americus Vespucius—The New World named after him—Juan de la Cosa—Vincent Yañez Pinzon—Bastidas—Diego de Lepe—Diaz de Solis—Ponce de Leon and Florida—Balboa discovers the Pacific Ocean—Grijalva explores the coast of Mexico.
Hojeda—Americus Vespucius—The New World named after him—Juan de la Cosa—Vincent Yañez Pinzon—Bastidas—Diego de Lepe—Diaz de Solis—Ponce de Leon and Florida—Balboa discovers the Pacific Ocean—Grijalva explores the coast of Mexico.
The letters and narratives of Columbus and his companions, especially those dwelling upon the large quantity of gold and pearls found in the recently discovered countries, had inflamed the imagination of eager traders, and of numbers of gentlemen who loved adventure. On the 10th of April, 1495, the Spanish government had issued an order allowing any one who might wish to do so, to go and discover new countries; but this privilege was so much abused, and Columbus complained so bitterly of its trenching upon established rights, that the permission was withdrawn on the 2nd of June, 1497, and four years later it became necessary to repeat the prohibition with more severe penalties attached to its infringement. The effect of the royal decree was at once to produce a kind of general rush to the Indies, and this was favoured by Bishop Fonseca of Badajoz, through whose hands passed all business connected with the Indies, and of whom Columbus had had so much reason to complain.
The letters and stories from Columbus and his crew, especially those highlighting the vast amounts of gold and pearls found in the newly discovered lands, sparked the imaginations of eager traders and a number of gentlemen who were drawn to adventure. On April 10, 1495, the Spanish government issued an order allowing anyone interested to explore and discover new lands; however, this privilege was misused so much, and Columbus complained so intensely about it violating established rights, that the permission was revoked on June 2, 1497. Four years later, it became necessary to repeat the ban with stricter penalties for any violations. As a result of the royal decree, there was an immediate surge of interest in the Indies, which was encouraged by Bishop Fonseca of Badajoz, who oversaw all matters related to the Indies and about whom Columbus had many grievances.
The admiral had but just left San-Lucar on his third voyage, when four expeditions of discovery were fitted out almost at the same moment, at the cost of some rich ship-owners, foremost among whom we find the Pinzons and Americus Vespucius. The first of these expeditions, which left the port of Santa-Maria on the 20th of May, 1499, consisted of four vessels, and was commanded by Alonzo Hojeda. Juan de la Cosa sailed with him as pilot; Americus Vespucius was also on board, without any very clearly defined duties, but he would seem to have been astronomer to the fleet.
The admiral had just left San-Lucar on his third voyage when four exploration expeditions were launched almost simultaneously, funded by several wealthy shipowners, including the Pinzons and Americus Vespucius. The first of these expeditions set sail from the port of Santa-Maria on May 20, 1499, consisting of four ships and commanded by Alonzo Hojeda. Juan de la Cosa accompanied him as the pilot; Americus Vespucius was also on board, though his specific role wasn't well-defined, but he appears to have served as the fleet's astronomer.
![]() |
Americus Vespucius. Fac-simile of an old print. |
Before entering on a brief account of this voyage, we will glance for a few moments at the three men whom we have just named; the last of the three especially, plays a most important part in the discovery of the New World, which received its name from him.
Before providing a short summary of this voyage, let's take a moment to look at the three men we've just mentioned; particularly the last one, who plays a crucial role in the discovery of the New World, which was named after him.
Hojeda, born at Cuença about 1465, and brought up in the household of the Duke of Medina-Celi, had gained his first experience in arms in the wars against the Moors. Columbus enrolled him amongst the adventurers whom he recruited for his second voyage, when Hojeda distinguished himself alike by his cool courage and his readiness in surmounting all difficulties. What caused his complete rupture with Columbus remains a mystery; it appears still more inexplicable when we think of the distinguished services that Hojeda had rendered, especially in 1495, at the battle of La Vega, when the Caribbean Confederation was annihilated. All we know is, that on Hojeda's return to Spain he found shelter and protection with Bishop Fonseca. It is said even that the Indian minister supplied him with the journal of the admiral's last voyage, and the map of the countries which Columbus had discovered.
Hojeda, born in Cuenca around 1465 and raised in the Duke of Medina-Celi's household, gained his first military experience in the wars against the Moors. Columbus included him among the adventurers he recruited for his second voyage, where Hojeda stood out for his calm bravery and his ability to overcome obstacles. The reason for his complete break with Columbus is still a mystery; it seems even more baffling considering the significant contributions Hojeda made, especially in 1495 during the battle of La Vega, when the Caribbean Confederation was defeated. All we know is that when Hojeda returned to Spain, he found refuge and support from Bishop Fonseca. It's even said that the Indian minister provided him with the journal from the admiral's last voyage and the map of the territories Columbus had discovered.
The first pilot employed by Hojeda was Juan de la Cosa, born probably at Santona, in the Biscayan country. He had often sailed along the coast of Africa before accompanying Columbus on his first voyage, while in the second expedition he filled the post of hydrographer (maestro de hacer cartas).
The first pilot hired by Hojeda was Juan de la Cosa, who was probably born in Santona, in the Biscayan region. He had frequently sailed along the coast of Africa before joining Columbus on his first voyage, and in the second expedition, he served as the hydrographer (maestro de hacer cartas).
As specimens of La Cosa's talent in drawing maps may be mentioned two very curious ones still extant; one showing all the territory that had been acquired in Africa in 1500, the other on vellum, and enriched with colour like the first, giving the discoveries made by Columbus and his successors. The second pilot was Bartholomew Roldan, who had likewise sailed with Columbus on his voyage to Paria.
As examples of La Cosa's talent in mapmaking, there are two fascinating maps that still exist: one that displays all the territory acquired in Africa in 1500, and the other on vellum, beautifully colored like the first, showing the discoveries made by Columbus and his followers. The second pilot was Bartholomew Roldan, who also sailed with Columbus on his journey to Paria.
As to Americus Vespucius, his duties were not, as we have said, very clearly defined, he was there to aid in making discoveries (per ajutare a discoprire, says the Italian text of his letter to Soderini). Born at Florence on the 9th of March, 1451, Amerigo Vespucci belonged to a family of distinction and wealth. He had made mathematics, natural philosophy, and astrology (as it was then called) his special studies. His knowledge of history and literature, judging from his letters, appears to have been somewhat vague and ill-digested. He left Florence in 1492 without any special aim in view, and went to Spain, where he occupied himself at first in commercial pursuits. We hear of him in Seville acting as factor in the powerful trading house of his fellow countryman, Juanoto Berardi. As this house had advanced money to Columbus for his second voyage, it is not unlikely that Vespucius had become acquainted with the admiral at this period of his career. On Juanoto's death in 1495, Vespucius was placed by his heirs at the head of the financial department of the house. Whether he may have been tired of a situation that he thought below his powers, or been seized in his turn with the fever for making new discoveries, or whether he hoped to make his fortune rapidly in the new countries reputed to be so rich; whatever in short may have been the motive that actuated him, at least this we know, that he joined Hojeda's expedition in 1499, this fact being so stated in Hojeda's deposition in the law-suit instituted by the Treasury with the heirs of Columbus.
As for Americus Vespucius, his responsibilities weren't very clearly defined; he was there to help with discoveries (per ajutare a discoprire, according to the Italian text of his letter to Soderini). Born in Florence on March 9, 1451, Amerigo Vespucci came from a distinguished and wealthy family. He focused his studies on mathematics, natural philosophy, and astrology (as it was then called). His understanding of history and literature, based on his letters, seems somewhat vague and poorly organized. He left Florence in 1492 without a specific goal and went to Spain, where he initially engaged in commercial activities. We hear of him in Seville working as an agent for the powerful trading company of his fellow countryman, Juanoto Berardi. Since this company had loaned money to Columbus for his second voyage, it’s likely that Vespucius met the admiral during this time in his career. After Juanoto died in 1495, Vespucius was appointed by his heirs to lead the financial department of the company. Whether he was bored with a position he felt was beneath him, caught up in the excitement of making new discoveries, or aimed to quickly make his fortune in the rich new lands, whatever his motivation was, we know that he joined Hojeda's expedition in 1499, as stated in Hojeda's deposition during the lawsuit filed by the Treasury against Columbus's heirs.
The flotilla, consisting of four vessels, set sail on the 20th of May from Santa-Maria, taking a south-westerly course, and in twenty-seven days the American continent was sighted at the place which was named Venezuela, because the houses being built upon piles reminded the beholders of Venice. Hojeda, after some ineffectual attempts to hold intercourse with the natives, with whom he had several skirmishes, next saw the Island of Margarita; after sailing about 250 miles to the east of the river Orinoco he reached the Gulf of Paria, and entered a bay called the Bay of Las Perlas, from the natives of that part being employed in the pearl fisheries.
The flotilla, made up of four ships, set off on May 20th from Santa Maria, heading southwest. After twenty-seven days, they spotted the American continent at a place later called Venezuela, because the houses built on stilts reminded people of Venice. Hojeda, after some unsuccessful attempts to communicate with the locals and several skirmishes, then saw the Island of Margarita. After sailing about 250 miles east of the Orinoco River, he reached the Gulf of Paria and entered a bay known as the Bay of Las Perlas, named for the locals who were involved in the pearl fishing industry.
Guided by the maps of Columbus, Hojeda passed by the Dragon's-Mouth, which separates Trinidad from the continent, and returned westward to Cape La Vela. Then, after touching at the Caribbee Islands, where he made a number of prisoners, whom he hoped to sell for slaves in Spain, he was obliged to cast anchor at Yaquimo, in Hispaniola, on the 5th of September, 1499.
Guided by Columbus's maps, Hojeda sailed past the Dragon's Mouth, which separates Trinidad from the mainland, and headed back west to Cape La Vela. After stopping at the Caribbee Islands, where he captured several people he planned to sell as slaves in Spain, he had to anchor at Yaquimo in Hispaniola on September 5, 1499.
Columbus, knowing Hojeda's courage and his restless spirit only too well, feared that he would introduce a new element of discord into the colony. He therefore despatched Francesco Roldan with two caravels to inquire into his motives in coming to the island, and if necessary to prevent his landing. The admiral's fears were but too well grounded; Hojeda had scarcely landed before he had an interview with some of the malcontents, inciting them to a rising at Xaragua, and to a determination to expel Columbus. After some skirmishes, which had not ended to Hojeda's advantage, a meeting was arranged for him with Roldan, Diego d'Escobar, and Juan de la Cosa, when they prevailed upon him to leave the island. "He took with him," says Las Casas, "a prodigious cargo of slaves, whom he sold in the market at Cadiz for enormous sums of money." He returned to Spain in February, 1500, where he had been preceded by Americus Vespucius and B. Roldan on the 18th of October, 1499.
Columbus, well aware of Hojeda's bravery and restless nature, was concerned that he would bring chaos to the colony. He therefore sent Francesco Roldan with two ships to investigate Hojeda's reasons for coming to the island and, if necessary, stop him from landing. The admiral's concerns were justified; Hojeda had barely set foot on land before he met with some of the discontented colonists, encouraging them to rise up in Xaragua and push Columbus out. After some conflicts that didn’t go well for Hojeda, a meeting was arranged with Roldan, Diego d'Escobar, and Juan de la Cosa, who convinced him to leave the island. "He took with him," says Las Casas, "a huge load of slaves, whom he sold in the market in Cadiz for large sums of money." He returned to Spain in February 1500, having been preceded by Americus Vespucius and B. Roldan on October 18, 1499.
The most southerly point that Hojeda had reached in this voyage was 4° north latitude, and he had only spent fourteen weeks on the voyage of discovery, properly so called. If we appear to have dwelt at some length upon this voyage, it is because it was the first one made by Vespucius. Some authors, Varnhagen for instance, and quite recently, Mr. H. Major, in his history of Prince Henry the Navigator, assert that Vespucius' first voyage was in 1497, and consequently that he must have seen the American continent before Columbus, but we prefer to follow Humboldt, who spent so many years in studying the history of the discovery of America, in his opinion that 1499 was the right date, also M. Ed. Charton and M. Jules Codine, the latter of whom discussed this question in the Report of the Geographical Society for 1873, apropos of Mr. Major's book.
The furthest south Hojeda got during this journey was 4° north latitude, and he spent only fourteen weeks on what we can properly call a voyage of discovery. If we seem to have focused a lot on this voyage, it's because it was Vespucius' first one. Some authors, like Varnhagen and more recently Mr. H. Major in his history of Prince Henry the Navigator, claim that Vespucius' first voyage was in 1497, suggesting he must have seen the American continent before Columbus. However, we prefer to follow Humboldt, who spent many years studying the history of America's discovery, and he believes 1499 is the accurate date. This view is also supported by M. Ed. Charton and M. Jules Codine, the latter of whom discussed this issue in the Report of the Geographical Society for 1873, apropos of Mr. Major's book.
"If it were true," says Voltaire, "that Vespucius had discovered the American Continent, yet the glory would not be his; it belongs undoubtedly to the man who had the genius and courage to undertake the first voyage, to Columbus." As Newton says in his argument with Leibnitz, "the glory is due only to the inventor." But we agree with M. Codine when he says, "How can we allow that there was an expedition in 1497 which resulted in the discovery of above 2500 miles of the coast-line of the mainland, when there is no trace of it left either among the great historians of that time, or in the legal depositions in connexion with the claims made by the heir of Columbus against the Spanish Government, in which the priority of the discoveries of each leader of an expedition is carefully mentioned, with the part of the coast explored by each?" Finally, the authentic documents extracted from the archives of the Casa de contratacion make it evident that Vespucius was entrusted with the preparation of the vessels destined for the third voyage of Columbus at Seville and at San Lucar from the middle of August, 1497, till the departure of Columbus on the 30th of May, 1498. The narratives of the voyages of Vespucius are very diffuse and wanting in precision and order; the information they give upon the places he visited is so vague, that it might apply to one part of the coast as well as to another; as to the localities treated of, as well as of the companions of Vespucius, there are no indications given of a nature to aid the historian. Not a single name is given of any well-known person, and the dates are contradictory in those famous letters which have given endless work to commentators. Humboldt says of them "There is an element of discord in the most authentic documents relating to the Florentine navigator." We have given an account of Hojeda's first voyage, which coincides with that of Vespucius according to Humboldt, who has compared the principal incidents of the two narratives. Varnhagen asserts that Vespucius, having started on the 10th of May, 1497, entered the Gulf of Honduras on the 10th of June, coasted by Yucatan and Mexico, sailed up the Mississippi, and at the end of February, 1498, doubled the Cape of Florida. After anchoring for thirty-seven days at the mouth of the St. Lawrence, he returned to Cadiz in October, 1498.
"If it were true," says Voltaire, "that Vespucius had discovered the American continent, the glory wouldn't belong to him; it's undoubtedly due to the man who had the genius and courage to make the first voyage, Columbus." As Newton points out in his argument with Leibnitz, "the glory goes only to the inventor." But we agree with M. Codine when he states, "How can we say there was an expedition in 1497 that led to the discovery of over 2500 miles of coastline when there’s no record of it from the great historians of that time or in the legal documents related to the claims made by Columbus's heir against the Spanish Government, where the order of discoveries by each expedition leader is carefully noted along with the sections of coastline explored by each?" Finally, the official documents taken from the archives of the Casa de contratacion clearly show that Vespucius was responsible for preparing the ships for Columbus's third voyage in Seville and San Lucar from mid-August 1497 until Columbus's departure on May 30, 1498. The accounts of Vespucius's voyages are very lengthy and lack precision and organization; the information they provide about the places he visited is so vague it could refer to one part of the coast as easily as another; regarding the locations discussed, as well as Vespucius's companions, there are no useful details for historians. Not a single name of a well-known individual is mentioned, and the dates contradict each other in those famous letters that have kept commentators busy for ages. Humboldt remarks, "There is an element of discord in the most authentic documents relating to the Florentine navigator." We have provided an account of Hojeda's first voyage, which aligns with Vespucius's according to Humboldt, who compared the major incidents of both narratives. Varnhagen claims that Vespucius set sail on May 10, 1497, entered the Gulf of Honduras on June 10, coasted along Yucatan and Mexico, sailed up the Mississippi, and by the end of February 1498, rounded Cape Florida. After anchoring for thirty-seven days at the mouth of the St. Lawrence, he returned to Cadiz in October 1498.
If Vespucius had really made this marvellous voyage, he would have far outstripped all the navigators of his time, and would have fully deserved that his name should be given to the newly-discovered continent, whose coast-line he had explored for so great a distance. But nothing is less certain, and Humboldt's opinion has hitherto appeared to the best writers to offer the largest amount of probability.
If Vespucius actually made this incredible journey, he would have surpassed all the navigators of his time and would have absolutely deserved for his name to be given to the newly discovered continent, whose coastline he had explored for such a long distance. But nothing is less certain, and Humboldt's view has so far seemed to the best writers to offer the most likelihood.
Americus Vespucius made three other voyages. Humboldt identifies the first with that of Vincent Yañez Pinzon, and M. d'Avezac with that of Diego de Lepe (1499-1500). At the close of this latter year, Giuliano Bartholomeo di Giocondo induced Vespucius to enter the service of Emmanuel, King of Portugal, and he accomplished two more voyages at the expense of his new master. On the first of these two voyages, he was no higher in command than he had been in his earlier ones, and only accompanied the expedition as one whose intimate acquaintance with all nautical matters might prove of service under certain circumstances. During this voyage the ships coasted along the American shores from Cape St. Augustine to 52° of south latitude. The fourth voyage of Vespucius was marked by the wreck of the flag-ship off the Island of Fernando de Noronha, which prevented the other vessels from continuing their voyage towards Malacca by way of the Cape of Good Hope, and obliged the crews to land at All Saints' Bay, in Brazil.
Americus Vespucius took three more trips. Humboldt links the first to Vincent Yañez Pinzon, while M. d'Avezac connects it to Diego de Lepe (1499-1500). At the end of that year, Giuliano Bartholomeo di Giocondo convinced Vespucius to work for Emmanuel, King of Portugal, leading him to undertake two additional voyages funded by his new employer. On the first of these trips, he held the same rank as before and joined the expedition primarily because of his deep knowledge of nautical matters, which could be useful in specific situations. During this journey, the ships sailed along the American coast from Cape St. Augustine to 52° south latitude. Vespucius's fourth voyage was notable for the flagship's wreck near the Island of Fernando de Noronha, which hindered the other vessels from proceeding to Malacca via the Cape of Good Hope and forced the crews to land at All Saints' Bay in Brazil.
This fourth voyage was unquestionably made with Gonzalo Coelho, but we are quite ignorant as to who was in command on the third voyage. These various expeditions had not tended to enrich Vespucius, while his position at the Portuguese court was so far from satisfactory that he determined to re-enter the service of the King of Spain. By him he was made Piloto Mayor on the 22nd of March, 1508. There were some valuable emoluments attached for his advantage to this appointment, which enabled him to end his days, if not as a rich man, at least as one far removed from want. He died at Seville on the 22nd of February, 1512, with the same conviction as Columbus, that he had reached the shores of Asia. Americus Vespucius is especially famous from the New World having been named after him, instead of being called Columbia, as in all justice it should have been, but with this Vespucius had nothing to do. He was for a long time charged, though most unjustly, with impudence, falsehood, and deceit, it being alleged that he wished to veil the glory of Columbus and to arrogate to himself the honour of a discovery which did not belong to him. This was an utterly unfounded accusation, for Vespucius was both loved and esteemed by Columbus and his contemporaries, and there is nothing in his writings to justify this calumnious assertion. Seven printed documents exist which are attributed to Vespucius; they are—the abridged accounts of his four voyages, two narratives of his third and fourth voyages, in the form of letters, addressed to Lorenzo de Pier Francesco de Medici, and a letter addressed to the same nobleman, relative to the Portuguese discoveries in the Indies. These documents, printed and bound up as small thin volumes, were soon translated into various languages and distributed throughout Europe.
This fourth voyage was definitely made with Gonzalo Coelho, but we don't know who was in charge during the third voyage. These different expeditions didn’t really make Vespucius wealthy, and his position at the Portuguese court was unsatisfactory enough that he decided to return to the service of the King of Spain. He was appointed Piloto Mayor on March 22, 1508. This role came with some valuable benefits that allowed him to live out his days comfortably, if not as a rich man. He died in Seville on February 22, 1512, firmly believing, like Columbus, that he had reached the shores of Asia. Americus Vespucius is especially well-known because the New World was named after him instead of being called Columbia, which would have been more appropriate, but Vespucius had nothing to do with that. He was long unjustly accused of being arrogant, dishonest, and deceitful, with claims that he tried to overshadow Columbus's achievements and take credit for a discovery that wasn't his. This accusation was completely baseless, as Vespucius was both liked and respected by Columbus and his contemporaries, and there’s nothing in his writings to support this slanderous claim. Seven printed documents are attributed to Vespucius; they include summarized accounts of his four voyages, two narratives of his third and fourth voyages in the form of letters to Lorenzo de Pier Francesco de Medici, and a letter to the same nobleman about the Portuguese discoveries in the Indies. These documents, printed and bound as small thin volumes, were quickly translated into various languages and spread throughout Europe.
It was in the year 1507 that a certain Hylacolymus, whose real name was Martin Waldtzemuller, first proposed to give the name of America to the new part of the world. He did so in a book printed at Saint Dié and called Cosmographia introductio. In 1509 a small geographical treatise appeared at Strasburg adopting the proposal of Hylacolymus; and in 1520 an edition of Pomponius Mela was printed at Basle, giving a map of the New World with the name of America. From this time the number of works employing the denomination proposed by Waldtzemuller increased perpetually.
It was in the year 1507 that a certain Hylacolymus, whose real name was Martin Waldtzemuller, first suggested calling the new part of the world "America." He did this in a book printed at Saint Dié called Cosmographia introductio. In 1509, a small geographical treatise came out in Strasburg that adopted Hylacolymus's proposal, and in 1520, an edition of Pomponius Mela was printed in Basle that included a map of the New World with the name America. From that point on, the number of works using the name proposed by Waldtzemuller continuously increased.
Some years later, when Waldtzemuller was better informed as to the real discoverer of America and of the value to be placed upon the voyages of Vespucius, he eliminated from his book all that related to the latter, and substituted everywhere the name of Columbus for that of Vespucius, but it was too late, the same error has prevailed ever since.
Some years later, when Waldtzemuller had a clearer understanding of who really discovered America and the significance of Vespucius’s voyages, he removed everything about Vespucius from his book and replaced his name with Columbus everywhere. However, it was too late; the same mistake has persisted ever since.
As to Vespucius himself, it seems very unlikely that he was at all aware of the excitement which prevailed in Europe, nor of what was passing at St. Dié. The testimony that has been unanimously borne to his honourable and upright conduct should surely clear him from the unmerited accusations which have for too long a time clouded his memory.
As for Vespucius himself, it seems very unlikely that he was aware of the excitement going on in Europe or what was happening at St. Dié. The praise that has been consistently given for his honorable and honest behavior should definitely clear him of the unfair accusations that have long tarnished his memory.
Three other expeditions left Spain almost at the same time as that of Hojeda. The first of these, consisting of but one vessel, sailed from Barra Saltez in June 1499. Pier Alonzo Nino, who had served under Columbus in his two last voyages, was its commander, and he was accompanied by Christoval Guerra, a merchant of Seville, who probably defrayed the expenses of the expedition. This voyage to the coast of Paria seems to have been dictated more by the hope of lucrative commerce than by the interests of science. No new discoveries were made, but the two voyagers returned to Spain in April, 1500, bringing with them so large a quantity of valuable pearls as to excite the cupidity of their countrymen, who became anxious to try their own fortunes in the same direction.
Three other expeditions left Spain almost at the same time as Hojeda's. The first one, which had only one ship, set sail from Barra Saltez in June 1499. Pier Alonzo Nino, who had been part of Columbus's last two voyages, was in charge, and he was joined by Christoval Guerra, a merchant from Seville, who likely funded the trip. This journey to the coast of Paria seemed to be driven more by the hope of profitable trade than by scientific goals. No new discoveries were made, but the two explorers returned to Spain in April 1500, bringing back such a large amount of valuable pearls that it sparked the greed of their fellow countrymen, who then wanted to try their own luck in the same area.
The second expedition was commanded by Vincent Yañez Pinzon, the younger brother of Alonzo Pinzon who had been captain of the Pinta and had shown so much jealousy of Columbus, even adopting the following mendacious device:—
The second expedition was led by Vincent Yañez Pinzon, the younger brother of Alonzo Pinzon, who had been the captain of the Pinta and had been quite envious of Columbus, even resorting to the following dishonest tactic:—
A Castilla, y a Leon Nuevo Mundo dio Pinzon. |
Yañez Pinzon, whose devotion to the admiral equalled his brother's jealousy, had advanced an eighth part of the funds required for the expedition of 1492, and had on that occasion been in command of the Nina.
Yañez Pinzon, whose loyalty to the admiral matched his brother's jealousy, had contributed one-eighth of the funds needed for the 1492 expedition and had been in charge of the Nina at that time.
He set out in December, 1499, with four vessels, of which only two returned to Palos at the end of September, 1500. He touched the coast of the newly discovered continent at a point near the shore visited by Hojeda some months before, and explored the coast for some 2400 miles, discovering Cape St. Augustine at 8° 20' south latitude, following the coast-line in a north-westerly direction to Rio Grande, which he named Santa-Maria de la Mar dulce, and continuing in the same direction as far as Cape St. Vincent. Diego de Lepe explored the same coasts with two caravels from January to June, 1500; there is nothing particular to record of this voyage beyond the very important observation that was made on the direction of the coast-line of the continent starting from Cape St. Augustine. Lepe had but just returned to Spain when two vessels left Cadiz, equipped by Rodrigo M. Bastidas, a wealthy and highly respectable man, with the view of making some fresh discoveries, but above all with the object of collecting as large a quantity of gold and pearls as possible, for which were to be bartered glass beads and other worthless trifles. Juan de la Cosa, whose talents as a navigator were proverbial, and who knew these coasts well from having explored them, was really at the head of this expedition. The sailors went on shore and saw the Rio Sinu, the Gulf of Urabia, and reached the Puerto del Retrete or de los Escribanos, in the Isthmus of Panama. This harbour was not visited by Columbus till the 26th of November, 1502; it is situated about seventeen miles from the once celebrated, but now destroyed town of Nombre de Dios. In fact this expedition, which had been organized by a merchant, became, thanks to Juan de la Cosa, one of the voyages the most fertile in discoveries; but alas! it came to a sad termination; the vessels were lost in the Gulf of Xaragua, and Bastidas and La Cosa were obliged to make their way by land to St. Domingo. When they arrived there, Bovadilla, the upright man and model governor, whose infamous conduct to Columbus we have already mentioned, had them arrested, on the plea that they had bought some gold from the Indians of Xaragua; he sent them off to Spain, which was only reached after a fearfully stormy voyage, some of the vessels being lost on the way.
He set out in December 1499 with four ships, of which only two made it back to Palos at the end of September 1500. He reached the coast of the newly discovered continent at a spot near where Hojeda had landed a few months earlier and explored the coastline for about 2,400 miles, discovering Cape St. Augustine at 8° 20' south latitude, then following the coast north-west to Rio Grande, which he named Santa-Maria de la Mar dulce, and continuing in the same direction up to Cape St. Vincent. Diego de Lepe explored the same coasts with two caravels from January to June 1500; there’s not much to note about this voyage except for the very important observation made about the direction of the continent's coastline starting from Cape St. Augustine. Lepe had just returned to Spain when two ships left Cadiz, outfitted by Rodrigo M. Bastidas, a wealthy and highly respected man, aiming to make new discoveries and, more importantly, to gather as much gold and pearls as possible, trading them for glass beads and other useless items. Juan de la Cosa, known for his exceptional navigation skills and familiarity with these coasts from previous explorations, was actually leading this expedition. The sailors went ashore and saw the Rio Sinu, the Gulf of Urabia, and reached the Puerto del Retrete or de los Escribanos in the Isthmus of Panama. Columbus did not visit this harbor until November 26, 1502; it’s located about seventeen miles from the once-famous, but now destroyed town of Nombre de Dios. In fact, this expedition, which was organized by a merchant, became one of the most fruitful in discoveries thanks to Juan de la Cosa, but sadly, it ended poorly; the ships were lost in the Gulf of Xaragua, forcing Bastidas and La Cosa to travel by land to St. Domingo. When they arrived, Bovadilla, the honest and exemplary governor, whose disgraceful treatment of Columbus we have already noted, had them arrested, claiming that they had bought gold from the Indians of Xaragua; he sent them back to Spain, which they reached only after a treacherously stormy voyage, with some of the ships being lost along the way.
After this expedition, so fruitful in results, voyages of discovery became rather less frequent for some years; the Spaniards being occupied in asserting their supremacy in the countries in which they had already founded colonies.
After this successful expedition, voyages of discovery became less common for a few years, as the Spaniards focused on establishing their dominance in the territories where they had already set up colonies.
![]() |
Indians devoured by Dogs. From an old print. |
The colonization of Hispaniola had commenced in 1493, when the town of Isabella was built. Two years afterwards Christopher Columbus had travelled over the island and had subjugated the poor savages, by means of those terrible dogs which had been trained to hunt Indians, and unaccustomed as the natives were to any hard work, he had forced them to toil in the mines. Both Bovadilla and Ovando treating the Indians as a herd of cattle, had divided them among the colonists as slaves. The cruelty with which this unfortunate people was treated became more and more unbearable. By means of a despicable ambush, Ovando seized the Queen of Xaragua and 300 of her principal subjects, and at a given signal they were all put to the sword without there being any crime adduced against them. "For some years," says Robertson, "the gold brought into the royal treasury of Spain amounted to about 460,000 pesos (2,400,000 livres of the currency of Tours) an enormous sum if we take into consideration the great increase in the value of money since the beginning of the sixteenth century." In 1511 Diego Velasquez conquered Cuba with 300 men, and here again were enacted the terrible scenes of bloodshed and pillage which have rendered the Spanish name so sadly notorious. They cut off the thumbs of the natives, put out their eyes, and poured boiling oil or melted lead into their wounds, even when they did not torture them by burning them over a slow fire to extract from them the secret of the treasures of which they were believed to be the possessors. It was only natural under these circumstances that the population rapidly decreased, and the day was not far off when it would be wholly exterminated. To understand fully the sufferings of this race thus odiously persecuted, the touching and horrible narrative of Las Casas must be read, himself the indefatigable defender of the Indians.
The colonization of Hispaniola began in 1493 with the establishment of the town of Isabella. Two years later, Christopher Columbus explored the island and subdued the Indigenous people using vicious dogs trained to hunt them. Since the natives were unaccustomed to hard labor, he forced them to work in the mines. Both Bovadilla and Ovando treated the Indigenous people like livestock, dividing them among the colonists as slaves. The cruelty inflicted on this unfortunate group became increasingly unbearable. Through a despicable ambush, Ovando captured the Queen of Xaragua and 300 of her top subjects; upon a signal, they were all killed without any charges against them. "For some years," says Robertson, "the gold brought into the royal treasury of Spain amounted to about 460,000 pesos (2,400,000 livres of the currency of Tours), an enormous sum when considering the significant increase in the value of money since the early sixteenth century." In 1511, Diego Velasquez conquered Cuba with 300 men, and once again, horrific scenes of bloodshed and pillage unfolded, making the Spanish name sadly notorious. They mutilated the natives by cutting off their thumbs, blinding them, and pouring boiling oil or melted lead into their wounds, even torturing them by burning them alive to extract information about supposed treasures they possessed. Given these circumstances, it’s no surprise that the population rapidly decreased, and the day was approaching when it would be completely exterminated. To fully grasp the suffering of this horrifically persecuted group, one must read the poignant and dreadful account by Las Casas, the tireless defender of the Indigenous people.
![]() |
Indians burnt alive. From an old print. |
In Cuba, the Cacique Hattuey was made prisoner and condemned to be burnt. When he was tied to the stake, a Franciscan monk tried to convert him, promising him that if he would only embrace the Christian faith, he would be at once admitted to all the joys of Paradise. "Are there any Spaniards in that land of happiness and joy of which you speak?" asked Hattuey. "Yes," replied the monk, "but only those who have been just and good in their lives." "The very best among them can have neither justice nor mercy!" said the poor cacique, "I do not wish to go to any place where I should meet a single man of that accursed race."
In Cuba, Chief Hattuey was captured and sentenced to be burned. As he was tied to the stake, a Franciscan monk tried to convert him, promising that if he embraced Christianity, he would immediately enter all the joys of Paradise. "Are there any Spaniards in that land of happiness and joy you talk about?" Hattuey asked. "Yes," the monk replied, "but only those who lived justly and kindly." "The very best among them can have neither justice nor mercy!" said the poor chief, "I don’t want to go to any place where I’d encounter even one of that cursed race."
Does not this fact suffice to paint the degree of exasperation to which these unfortunate people had been driven? And these horrors were repeated wherever the Spaniards set foot! We will throw a veil over these atrocities practised by men who thought themselves civilized, and who pretended that they wished to convert to Christianity, the religion pre-eminently of love and mercy, a race who were in reality less savage than themselves.
Doesn’t this fact show just how frustrated these unfortunate people had become? And these horrors happened everywhere the Spaniards went! We will cover up these atrocities committed by men who considered themselves civilized, and who claimed they wanted to convert to Christianity, a religion that is fundamentally about love and mercy, a group of people who were actually less brutal than they were.
In 1504 and 1505 four vessels explored the Gulf of Urabia. This was the first voyage in which Juan de la Cosa had the supreme command. This seems, too, to have been about the date of Hojeda's third voyage, when he went to the territory of Coquibacoa, a voyage that certainly was made, as Humboldt says, but of which we have no clear account.
In 1504 and 1505, four ships explored the Gulf of Urabia. This was the first journey where Juan de la Cosa was in charge. This also appears to be around the time of Hojeda's third voyage, when he traveled to the region of Coquibacoa, a trip that definitely happened, as Humboldt states, but we don’t have a clear record of.
In 1509 Juan Diaz de Solis, in concert with Vincent Yañez Pinzon, discovered a vast province, since known by the name of Yucatan.
In 1509, Juan Diaz de Solis, along with Vincent Yañez Pinzon, discovered a huge region, now called Yucatan.
"Though this expedition was not a very remarkable one in itself," says Robertson, "it deserves to be noticed as it led to discoveries of the utmost importance." For the same reason we must mention the voyage of Diego d'Ocampo, who being charged to sail round Cuba, was the first to ascertain the fact that it was a large island, Columbus having always regarded it as part of the continent. Two years later Juan Diaz de Solis and Vincent Pinzon sailing southwards towards the equinoctial line, advanced as far as the 40° of south latitude, and found, to their surprise, that the continent extended on their right hand even to this immense distance. They landed several times, and took formal possession of the country, but could not found any colonies there, on account of the small resources they had at their command. The principal result of this voyage was the more exact knowledge which it gave of the extent of this part of the globe.
"Although this expedition wasn't particularly remarkable," says Robertson, "it’s worth mentioning because it led to discoveries of great significance." For the same reason, we should highlight the voyage of Diego d'Ocampo, who was tasked with sailing around Cuba and became the first to confirm that it was a large island, since Columbus had always thought it was part of the mainland. Two years later, Juan Diaz de Solis and Vincent Pinzon sailed southward toward the equator, reaching as far as 40° south latitude, and discovered, to their surprise, that the continent extended to their right across such a vast distance. They landed several times and took formal possession of the territory, but they couldn't establish any colonies due to their limited resources. The main outcome of this voyage was the clearer understanding it provided of the extent of this part of the world.
Alonzo de Hojeda, whose adventures we have narrated above, was the first to think of founding a colony on the mainland; although he had no means of his own, his courage and enterprising spirit soon gained him associates, who furnished him with the funds needed for carrying out his plans.
Alonzo de Hojeda, whose adventures we've shared above, was the first to consider establishing a colony on the mainland; even though he had no resources of his own, his bravery and ambitious nature quickly attracted partners, who provided him with the funding necessary to pursue his plans.
With the same object Diego de Nicuessa, a rich colonist of Hispaniola, organized an expedition in 1509.
With the same goal, Diego de Nicuessa, a wealthy colonist from Hispaniola, organized an expedition in 1509.
King Ferdinand, who was always lavish of encouragements which cost little, gave both Hojeda and Nicuessa honourable titles and patents of nobility, but not a single maravédis (a Spanish coin). He also divided the newly-discovered continent into two governments, of which one was to extend from Cape La Vela to the Gulf of Darien, and the other from the Gulf of Darien to Cape Gracias a Dios. The first was given to Hojeda, the second to Nicuessa. These two "conquistadores" had to deal with a population far less easy to manage than that of the Antilles. Determined to resist to the utmost the invasion of their country, they adopted means of resistance hitherto unknown to the Spaniards. Thus the strife became deadly. In a single engagement seventy of Hojeda's companions fell under the arrows of the savages, fearful weapons steeped in "curare," so fatal a poison that the slightest wound was followed by death. Nicuessa on his side, had much difficulty in defending himself, and in spite of two considerable reinforcements from Cuba, the greater number of his followers perished during the year from wounds, fatigue, privations, or sickness. The survivors founded the small colony of Santa-Maria el Antigua upon the Gulf of Darien, and placed it under the command of Balboa.
King Ferdinand, who was always generous with encouragements that didn't cost much, granted both Hojeda and Nicuessa honorable titles and noble patents, but not a single maravédis (a Spanish coin). He also divided the newly discovered continent into two regions: one extending from Cape La Vela to the Gulf of Darien, and the other from the Gulf of Darien to Cape Gracias a Dios. The first was given to Hojeda, and the second to Nicuessa. These two "conquistadores" had to handle a population that was much harder to control than that of the Antilles. Determined to resist the invasion of their land, they used methods of resistance that were unknown to the Spaniards. Thus, the conflict became deadly. In a single battle, seventy of Hojeda's companions fell to the arrows of the natives, fearsome weapons dipped in "curare," a deadly poison that led to death from even the slightest wound. Nicuessa, meanwhile, struggled to defend himself, and despite two significant reinforcements from Cuba, most of his followers died over the year due to wounds, exhaustion, hardship, or illness. The survivors established a small colony called Santa-Maria el Antigua on the Gulf of Darien and put it under the leadership of Balboa.
Before we speak of Balboa's wonderful expedition, we must notice the discovery of a country that forms the most northerly side of that arc, cut so deeply into the continent, and which bears the name of the Gulf of Mexico. In 1502 Juan Ponce de Leon, a member of one of the oldest families in Spain, had arrived in Hispaniola with Ovando. He had assisted in its subjugation, and in 1508 had conquered the island of San Juan de Porto Rico. Having learnt from the Indians that there existed a fountain in the island of Bimini which possessed the miraculous power of restoring youth to all who drank of its waters, Ponce de Leon resolved to go in search of it. Infirmities must have been already creeping on him at fifty years of age, or he would scarcely have felt the need of trying this fountain. Ponce de Leon equipped three vessels at his own expense, and set out from St. Germain in Porto Rico on the 1st of March, 1512. He went first to the Lucayan Islands, which he searched in vain, and then to the Bahamas. If he did not succeed in finding the fountain of youth which he sought so credulously, at least he had the satisfaction of discovering an apparently fertile tract of country, which he named Florida, either from his landing there on Palm Sunday, (Pâques-Fleuries), or perhaps from its delightful aspect. Such a discovery would have contented many a traveller, but Ponce de Leon went from one island to another, tasting the water of every stream that he met with, without the satisfaction of seeing his white hair again becoming black or his wrinkles disappearing. After spending six months in this fruitless search, he was tired of playing the dupe, so giving up the business he returned to Porto Rico on the 5th of October, leaving Perez de Ortubia and the pilot Antonio de Alaminos to continue the search. Père Charlevoix says, "He was the object of great ridicule when he returned in much suffering, and looking older than when he set out."
Before we talk about Balboa's amazing expedition, we need to mention the discovery of a country that makes up the northern part of that deep cut into the continent known as the Gulf of Mexico. In 1502, Juan Ponce de Leon, a member of one of Spain's oldest families, arrived in Hispaniola with Ovando. He had helped conquer it, and in 1508, he conquered the island of San Juan de Puerto Rico. After learning from the Indigenous people about a fountain on the island of Bimini that could magically restore youth to anyone who drank from it, Ponce de Leon decided to search for it. At fifty years old, he must have already been feeling the effects of aging, or he wouldn’t have been motivated to find this fountain. Ponce de Leon funded three ships himself and set sail from St. Germain in Puerto Rico on March 1, 1512. He first went to the Lucayan Islands, where he searched in vain, and then to the Bahamas. Although he didn't find the fountain of youth he believed in, he did find a seemingly fertile area, which he named Florida, either because he landed there on Palm Sunday (Pâques-Fleuries) or maybe because of its beautiful scenery. Many travelers would have been satisfied with such a discovery, but Ponce de Leon continued hopping from one island to another, tasting the water in every stream he came across, without seeing his white hair turn black or his wrinkles fade. After six months of this fruitless quest, he grew tired of being fooled and returned to Puerto Rico on October 5, leaving Perez de Ortubia and pilot Antonio de Alaminos to keep looking. Père Charlevoix remarks, "He was the subject of much ridicule when he returned in pain, looking older than when he set out."
This voyage, so absurd in its motive but so fertile in its results, might well be considered to be simply imaginary, were it not vouched for by historians of such high repute as Peter Martyr, Oviedo, Herrera, and Garcilasso de la Vega.
This journey, ridiculous in its purpose but incredibly fruitful in its outcomes, could easily be seen as purely fictional, if it weren't for the endorsement of esteemed historians like Peter Martyr, Oviedo, Herrera, and Garcilasso de la Vega.
Vasco Nuñez de Balboa, who was fifteen years younger than Ponce de Leon, had come to America with Bastidas and had settled in Hispaniola. He was only anxious for a safe refuge from his numerous creditors, being, as were so many of his fellow-countrymen, deeply in debt, in spite of the repartimiento of Indians which had been allotted to him. Unfortunately for Balboa a law had been passed forbidding any vessels bound for the mainland taking insolvent debtors on board, but his ingenuity was equal to this emergency, for he had himself rolled in an empty barrel to the vessel which was to carry Encisco to Darien. The chief of the expedition had no choice but to receive the brave adventurer who had joined him in this singular manner, and who never fled except from duns, as he soon proved on landing. The Spaniards, accustomed to find but little resistance from the natives of the Antilles, could not subjugate the fierce inhabitants of the mainland. On account of the dissensions that had arisen among themselves, they were obliged to take refuge at Santa-Maria el Antigua, a settlement which Balboa, now elected commandant in place of Encisco, founded in Darien.
Vasco Nuñez de Balboa, who was fifteen years younger than Ponce de Leon, had come to America with Bastidas and had settled in Hispaniola. He was mainly looking for a safe place to escape his many creditors, being, like many of his fellow countrymen, deeply in debt despite the repartimiento of Indians that had been assigned to him. Unfortunately for Balboa, a law had been passed that forbade any ships heading to the mainland from taking insolvent debtors on board. However, he cleverly managed to hide himself in an empty barrel to get onto the ship that was taking Encisco to Darien. The leader of the expedition had no choice but to accept the brave adventurer who had joined him in this unusual way, and who only fled from bill collectors, as he soon showed after landing. The Spaniards, used to facing little resistance from the native people of the Antilles, struggled to conquer the fierce inhabitants of the mainland. Due to the conflicts that arose among themselves, they were forced to take refuge at Santa-Maria el Antigua, a settlement that Balboa, now elected commander instead of Encisco, established in Darien.
If the personal bravery of Balboa, or the ferocity of Leoncillo his blood-hound—who was more dreaded than twenty armed men and received the same pay as a soldier,—could have awed the Indians, Balboa would have also won their respect by his justice and comparative moderation, for he allowed no unnecessary cruelty. In the course of some years he collected a great mass of most useful information with regard to that El Dorado, that land of gold, which he was destined never to reach himself, but the acquisition of which he did much to facilitate for his successors.
If Balboa's personal bravery or the fierce loyalty of his bloodhound Leoncillo—who was more feared than twenty armed men and earned the same pay as a soldier—could have intimidated the Indigenous people, Balboa would have also earned their respect through his fairness and relative restraint, as he allowed no unnecessary cruelty. Over the years, he gathered a vast amount of valuable information about El Dorado, the land of gold, which he was fated never to reach, but he did a lot to make it easier for those who followed him.
It was in this way that he learnt the existence six suns away (six days' journey), of another sea, the Pacific Ocean, which washed the shores of Peru, a country where gold was found in large quantities. Balboa's character, which was as grand as those of Cortès and Pizarro, but who had not, as they, the time or opportunity to show the extraordinary qualities which he possessed, felt convinced that this information was most valuable, and that if he could carry out such a discovery, it would shed great lustre on his name.
It was like this that he learned about the existence of another sea, six suns away (a six-day journey), the Pacific Ocean, which bordered Peru, a country rich in gold. Balboa's character was as impressive as those of Cortés and Pizarro, but unlike them, he hadn’t had the time or opportunity to showcase the extraordinary qualities he had. He was convinced that this information was incredibly valuable and that if he could make such a discovery, it would bring great glory to his name.
He assembled a body of 190 volunteers, all valiant soldiers, and like himself, accustomed to all the chances of war, as well as acclimatised to the unhealthy effluvia of a marshy country, where fever, dysentery, and complaints of the liver were constantly present.
He gathered a group of 190 volunteers, all brave soldiers, and like him, used to the uncertainties of war, as well as adapted to the unhealthy conditions of a swampy area, where fever, dysentery, and liver problems were always a risk.
Though the Isthmus of Darien is only sixty miles in width, it is divided into two parts by a chain of high mountains; at the foot of these the alluvial soil is marvellously fertile, and the vegetation far more luxuriant than any European can imagine. It consists of an inextricable mass of tropical plants, creepers, and ferns, among trees of gigantic size which completely hide the sun, a truly virgin forest, interspersed here and there with patches of stagnant water, where live multitudes of birds, insects, and animals, never disturbed by the foot of man. A warm, moist atmosphere exists here which exhausts the strength and speedily saps the energy of any man, even the most robust.
Though the Isthmus of Darien is only sixty miles wide, it is split into two parts by a mountain range; at the base of these mountains, the soil is incredibly fertile, and the vegetation is far more lush than any European can imagine. It’s a dense tangle of tropical plants, vines, and ferns, mixed in with gigantic trees that completely block out the sun, creating a truly untouched forest, dotted here and there with pools of stagnant water, where countless birds, insects, and animals thrive, never disturbed by human beings. A warm, humid atmosphere hangs here that drains the strength and quickly tires out anyone, even the strongest person.
With all these obstacles which Nature seemed to have rejoiced in placing in Balboa's path, there was yet another no less formidable, and this was the resistance which the savage inhabitants of this inhospitable shore would offer to his progress. Balboa set out without caring for the risk he ran in the event of the guides and native auxiliaries proving faithless; he was escorted by a thousand Indians as porters, and accompanied by a troop of those terrible bloodhounds which had acquired the taste for human flesh in Hispaniola.
With all these obstacles that Nature seemed to take pleasure in putting in Balboa's way, there was yet another equally daunting one: the resistance from the savage inhabitants of this harsh shore. Balboa set out without worrying about the danger he faced if the guides and local helpers turned against him; he was accompanied by a thousand Indians acting as porters and a pack of those fierce bloodhounds that had developed a taste for human flesh in Hispaniola.
Of the tribes that he met with on his route, some fled into the mountains carrying their provisions with them, and others, taking advantage of the difficulties the land presented, tried to fight. Balboa marching in the midst of his men, never sparing himself, sharing in their privations and rousing their courage, which would have failed more than once, was able to inspire them with so much enthusiasm for the object that was before them, that after twenty-five days of marching and fighting, they could see from the top of a mountain that vast Pacific Ocean, of which, four days later, Balboa, his drawn sword in one hand and the banner of Castille in the other, took possession in the name of the King of Spain. The part of the Pacific Ocean which he had reached is situated to the east of Panama, and still bears the name of the Gulf of San Miguel, given to it by Balboa. The information he obtained from the neighbouring caciques, whom he subjugated by force of arms, and from whom he obtained a considerable booty, agreed in every particular with what he had heard before he set out.
Of the tribes he encountered on his journey, some ran into the mountains with their supplies, while others tried to fight, taking advantage of the tough terrain. Balboa, marching with his men, didn't hold back, sharing in their hardships and boosting their spirits, which would have faltered several times. He managed to inspire them with such passion for their goal that after twenty-five days of marching and battling, they saw from the top of a mountain the vast Pacific Ocean. Four days later, Balboa, with his sword drawn in one hand and the Castilian flag in the other, claimed it in the name of the King of Spain. The area of the Pacific Ocean he reached lies to the east of Panama and still bears the name Gulf of San Miguel, which Balboa named. The information he gathered from the local caciques, whom he subdued by force, and from whom he secured a significant amount of treasure, matched perfectly with what he had learned before setting out.
A vast empire lay to the south, they said, "so rich in gold, that even the commonest instruments were made of it," where the domestic animals were llamas that had been tamed and trained to carry heavy burdens, and whose appearance in the native drawings resembled that of the camel. These interesting details, and the great quantity of pearls offered to Balboa, confirmed him in his idea, that he must have reached the Asiatic countries described by Marco Polo, and that he could not be far from the empire of Cipango or Japan, of which the Venetian traveller had described the marvellous riches which were perpetually dazzling the eyes of these avaricious adventurers.
A vast empire lay to the south, they said, "so rich in gold that even the simplest tools were made of it," where the domesticated animals were llamas, trained to carry heavy loads, and which looked like camels in native drawings. These fascinating details, along with the large number of pearls offered to Balboa, strengthened his belief that he had arrived at the Asian countries mentioned by Marco Polo and that he was not far from the empire of Cipango or Japan, of which the Venetian traveler had detailed the incredible wealth that constantly dazzled the eyes of these greedy adventurers.
![]() |
Balboa discovering the Pacific Ocean. |
Balboa several times crossed the Isthmus of Darien, and always in some fresh direction. Humboldt might well say that this country was better known in the beginning of the sixteenth century than in his own day. Beyond this Balboa had launched some vessels built under his orders on the newly-discovered ocean, and he was preparing a formidable armament, with which he hoped to conquer Peru, when he was odiously and judicially murdered by the orders of Pedrarias Davila, the governor of Darien, who was jealous of the reputation Balboa had already gained, and of the glory which would doubtless recompense his bravery if he carried out the expedition which he had arranged. Thus the conquest of Peru was retarded by at least twenty-five years, owing to the culpable jealousy of a man whose name has acquired, by Balboa's assassination, almost as wretched a celebrity as that of Erostratus.
Balboa crossed the Isthmus of Darien several times, always heading in a new direction. Humboldt could rightly say that this region was better known at the beginning of the sixteenth century than in his own time. Additionally, Balboa had launched some ships he ordered on the newly discovered ocean, and he was preparing a strong fleet, hoping to conquer Peru when he was shamefully and unjustly executed on the orders of Pedrarias Davila, the governor of Darien, who was envious of the reputation Balboa had already earned and the glory he would likely receive for his bravery in carrying out the planned expedition. As a result, the conquest of Peru was delayed by at least twenty-five years due to the malicious jealousy of a man whose name, because of Balboa's assassination, became almost as infamous as that of Erostratus.
If we owe to Balboa the first authentic documents regarding Peru, another explorer was destined to furnish some not less important touching that vast Mexican Empire, which had extended its sway over almost the whole of Central America. In 1518, Juan de Grijalva had been placed in command of a flotilla, consisting of four vessels, armed by Diego Velasquez, the conqueror of Cuba, which were destined to collect information upon Yucatan, sighted the year before by Hernandez de Cordova. Grijalva, accompanied by the pilot Alaminos, who had made the voyage to Florida with Ponce de Leon, had two hundred men under his command; amongst the volunteers was Bernal Diaz del Castillo, the clever author of a very interesting history of the conquest of Mexico, from which we shall borrow freely.
If we owe the first real documents about Peru to Balboa, another explorer was set to provide equally important details about the vast Mexican Empire, which had extended its influence over almost all of Central America. In 1518, Juan de Grijalva was put in charge of a flotilla made up of four ships, equipped by Diego Velasquez, the conqueror of Cuba, which were meant to gather information on Yucatan, spotted the previous year by Hernandez de Cordova. Grijalva, along with the pilot Alaminos, who had traveled to Florida with Ponce de Leon, commanded two hundred men; among the volunteers was Bernal Diaz del Castillo, the talented author of a very interesting history of the conquest of Mexico, from which we will draw extensively.
After thirteen days' sailing, Grijalva reached the Island of Cozumel on the coast of Yucatan, doubled the Cape of Cotoche, and entered the Bay of Campeachy. He disembarked on the 10th of May at Potonchan, of which the inhabitants defended the town and citadel vigorously, in spite of their astonishment at the vessels, which they took for some kind of marine monsters, and their fear of the pale-faced men who hurled thunderbolts. Fifty-seven Spaniards were killed in the engagement, and many were wounded. This warm reception did not encourage Grijalva to make any long stay amongst this warlike people. He set sail again after anchoring for four days, took a westerly course along the coast of Mexico, and on the 19th of May entered a river named by the natives the Tabasco, where he soon found himself surrounded by a fleet of fifty native boats filled with warriors ready for the conflict, but thanks to Grijalva's prudence and the amicable demonstrations which he made, peace was not disturbed.
After thirteen days of sailing, Grijalva reached the Island of Cozumel on the coast of Yucatan, rounded the Cape of Cotoche, and entered the Bay of Campeachy. He landed on May 10th at Potonchan, where the locals fiercely defended their town and citadel, despite being astonished by the ships, which they thought were some kind of sea monsters, and frightened by the pale-faced men who threw thunderbolts. Fifty-seven Spaniards were killed in the battle, and many others were wounded. This warm welcome didn’t motivate Grijalva to linger among this fierce people. He set sail again after anchoring for four days, took a westward route along the coast of Mexico, and on May 19th, entered a river called Tabasco by the natives, where he soon found himself surrounded by a fleet of fifty native boats filled with warriors ready for conflict. However, thanks to Grijalva's caution and the friendly gestures he made, peace was maintained.
"We made them understand," writes Bernal Diaz, "that we were the subjects of a powerful emperor called Don Carlos, and that it would be greatly to their advantage if they also would acknowledge him as their master. They replied that they had a sovereign already, and were at a loss to understand why we, who had only just arrived, and who knew so little of them, should offer them another king." This reply was scarcely that of a savage!
"We made them understand," writes Bernal Diaz, "that we were the subjects of a powerful emperor named Don Carlos, and it would really benefit them if they also recognized him as their master. They responded that they already had a ruler and were confused as to why we, who had just arrived and knew so little about them, would offer them another king." This response was hardly that of a savage!
In exchange for some worthless European trinkets, the Spaniards obtained some Yucca bread, copal gum, pieces of gold worked into the shape of fishes or birds, and garments made of cotton, which had been woven in the country. As the natives who had been taken on board at Cape Cotoche did not perfectly understand the language spoken by the inhabitants of Tabasco, the stay here was but of short duration, and the ships again put to sea. They passed the mouth of the Rio Guatzacoalco, the snowy peaks of the San Martin mountains being seen in the distance, and they anchored at the mouth of a river which was called Rio de las Banderas, from the number of white banners displayed by the natives to show their friendly feeling towards the new comers.
In exchange for some useless European trinkets, the Spaniards got some Yucca bread, copal gum, pieces of gold shaped like fish or birds, and cotton garments that had been woven locally. Since the natives who had been taken aboard at Cape Cotoche didn't fully understand the language spoken by the people of Tabasco, their stay there was brief, and the ships set sail again. They passed the mouth of the Rio Guatzacoalco, with the snowy peaks of the San Martin mountains visible in the distance, and they anchored at the mouth of a river called Rio de las Banderas, named for the many white banners displayed by the locals to show their friendliness toward the newcomers.
When Grijalva landed, he was received with the same honour as the Indians paid to their gods; they burnt copal incense before him, and laid at his feet more than 1500 piastres' worth of small gold jewels, as well as green pearls and copper hatchets. After taking formal possession of the country, the Spaniards landed on an island called Los Sacrificios Island, from a sort of altar which they found there placed at the top of several steps, upon which lay the bodies of five Indians sacrificed since the preceding evening; their bodies were cut open, their hearts torn out, and both legs and arms cut off. Leaving this revolting spectacle, they went to another small island, which received the name of San Juan, being discovered on St. John's Day; to this they added the word Culua, which they heard used by the natives of these shores. But Culua was the ancient name for Mexico, and this Island of San-Juan de Culua is now known as St. John d'Ulloa.
When Grijalva landed, he was welcomed with the same reverence that the Indians showed their gods; they burned copal incense in his honor and laid over 1500 piastres' worth of small gold jewels, along with green pearls and copper hatchets, at his feet. After formally claiming the land, the Spaniards went to an island called Los Sacrificios, where they found an altar at the top of several steps, on which lay the bodies of five Indians who had been sacrificed since the previous evening; their bodies were opened, their hearts removed, and their arms and legs severed. Leaving this gruesome sight, they moved to another small island, which they named San Juan, after the day of St. John when it was discovered; they also added the word Culua, which they heard the local people using. However, Culua was the ancient name for Mexico, and this island of San-Juan de Culua is now known as St. John d'Ulloa.
Grijalva put all the gold which he had collected on board one of the ships and despatched it to Cuba, while he continued his exploration of the coast, discovered the Sierras of Tusta and Tuspa, and collected a large amount of useful information regarding this populous country; on arriving at the Rio Panuco, he was attacked by a flotilla of native vessels, and had much difficulty in defending himself against their attacks.
Grijalva loaded all the gold he had gathered onto one of the ships and sent it to Cuba while he kept exploring the coast. He discovered the Sierras of Tusta and Tuspa and gathered a lot of valuable information about this densely populated area. When he reached the Rio Panuco, he was attacked by a fleet of native boats and had a tough time defending himself against their assaults.
This expedition was nearly over, for provisions were running short, and the vessels were in a very bad state, the volunteers were many of them sick and wounded, and even had they been in good health their numbers were too small to make it safe to leave them among these warlike people, even under the shelter of fortifications. Besides, the leaders of the expedition no longer acted in concert, so after repairing the largest of the vessels in the Rio Tonala, where Bernal Diaz boasts of having sown the first orange-pips which were ever brought to Mexico, the Spaniards set out for Santiago in Cuba, where they arrived on the 15th of November, after a cruise of seven months, not forty-five days, as M. Ferdinand Denis asserts in the Biographie Didot, and as M. Ed. Charton repeats in his Voyageurs Anciens et Modernes.
This expedition was coming to an end, as supplies were running low, and the ships were in very poor condition. Many of the volunteers were sick or injured, and even if they had been healthy, there were too few of them to safely stay among these hostile people, even with fortifications. Additionally, the leaders of the expedition were no longer working together. After repairing the largest of the ships in the Rio Tonala, where Bernal Diaz claims to have planted the first orange seeds ever brought to Mexico, the Spaniards headed for Santiago in Cuba. They arrived on November 15, after a seven-month journey, not 45 days, as M. Ferdinand Denis claims in the Biographie Didot, and as M. Ed. Charton repeats in his Voyageurs Anciens et Modernes.
The results obtained from this voyage were considerable. For the first time the long line of coast which forms the peninsula of Yucatan, the Bay of Campeachy, and the base of the Gulf of Mexico, had been explored continuously from cape to cape. Not only had it been proved beyond doubt that Yucatan was not an island as they had believed, but much and reliable information had been collected with regard to the existence of the rich and powerful empire of Mexico. The explorers had been much struck with the marks of a more advanced civilization than that existing in the Antilles, with the superiority of the architecture, the skilful cultivation of the land, the fine texture of the cotton garments, and the delicacy of finish of the golden ornaments worn by the Indians. All this combined to increase the thirst for riches among the Spaniards of Cuba, and to urge them on like modern Argonauts to the conquest of this new golden fleece. Grijalva was not destined to reap the fruits of his perilous and at the same time intelligent voyage, which threw so new a light on Indian civilization. The sic vos, non vobis of the poet was once again to find an exemplification in this circumstance.
The results from this journey were significant. For the first time, the entire stretch of coastline that makes up the Yucatan Peninsula, the Bay of Campeachy, and the base of the Gulf of Mexico had been explored continuously from one cape to the other. It was clearly established that Yucatan was not an island as previously thought, and a wealth of reliable information was gathered regarding the existence of the rich and powerful empire of Mexico. The explorers were impressed by the signs of a more advanced civilization than that found in the Antilles, noting the superior architecture, skilled farming practices, the fine quality of cotton clothing, and the exquisite craftsmanship of the gold ornaments worn by the natives. All of this fueled the Spaniards in Cuba with a desire for wealth, driving them forward like modern Argonauts in pursuit of this new golden treasure. However, Grijalva was not meant to enjoy the rewards of his daring yet insightful voyage, which shed new light on Indian civilization. The sic vos, non vobis of the poet found yet another example in this situation.
THE CONQUERORS OF CENTRAL AMERICA.
Ferdinand Cortès—His character—His appointment—Preparations for the expedition, and attempts of Velasquez to stop it—Landing at Vera-Cruz—Mexico and the Emperor Montezuma—The republic of Tlascala—March upon Mexico—The Emperor is made prisoner—Narvaez defeated—The Noche Triste—Battle of Otumba—The second siege and taking of Mexico—Expedition to Honduras—Voyage to Spain—Expeditions on the Pacific Ocean—Second Voyage of Cortès to Spain—His death.
Ferdinand Cortès—His character—His appointment—Preparations for the expedition and Velasquez's attempts to stop it—Landing at Vera-Cruz—Mexico and Emperor Montezuma—The republic of Tlascala—March toward Mexico—The Emperor is captured—Narvaez is defeated—The Noche Triste—Battle of Otumba—The second siege and capture of Mexico—Expedition to Honduras—Voyage to Spain—Expeditions in the Pacific Ocean—Cortès's second voyage to Spain—His death.
Velasquez had not waited for Grijalva's return before sending off to Spain the rich products of the countries discovered by the latter, and at the same time soliciting from the council of the Indies, as well as from the Bishop of Burgos, an addition to his authority, that he might attempt the conquest of these countries. At the same time he fitted out a new armament proportioned to the dangers and importance of the undertaking that he proposed. But though it was comparatively easy for Velasquez to collect the necessary material and men, it was far more difficult for him—whom an old writer describes as niggardly, credulous, and suspicious in disposition—to choose a fit leader. He wished indeed, to find one who should combine qualities nearly always incompatible, high courage and great talent, without which there was no chance of success, with at the same time sufficient docility and submissiveness, to do nothing without orders, and to leave to him who incurred no risk, any glory and success which might attend the enterprise. Some who were brave and enterprising would not be treated as mere machines; others who were more docile or more cunning lacked the qualities required to insure the success of so vast an enterprise; among the former were some of Grijalva's companions who wished that he should be made commander, while the latter preferred Augustin Bermudez or Bernardino Velasquez. While this was pending, the governor's secretary, Andrès de Duero, and Amador de Larez, the Controller of Cuba, both favourites of Velasquez, made an arrangement with a Spanish nobleman named Ferdinand Cortès, that if they could obtain the appointment for him, they should be allowed a share in his gains.
Velasquez didn't wait for Grijalva to come back before he sent the valuable resources from the lands discovered by Grijalva to Spain. At the same time, he asked the Council of the Indies and the Bishop of Burgos for more authority to attempt conquering these areas. He also prepared a new expedition that matched the risks and importance of the mission he was planning. However, although it was relatively easy for Velasquez to gather the necessary supplies and personnel, it was much harder for him—described by an old writer as stingy, gullible, and distrustful—to find a suitable leader. He wanted someone who could combine traits that are often not found together: great bravery and exceptional skill, without which success was unlikely, along with enough obedience and compliance to follow orders and allow him, who took no risks, to enjoy any glory and success from the venture. Some brave and adventurous candidates would not settle for being treated like mere tools; others who were more obedient or clever lacked the essential qualities needed for such a significant undertaking. Among those who were brave were some of Grijalva's associates who believed he should take command, while others preferred Augustin Bermudez or Bernardino Velasquez. While this was being decided, the governor's secretary, Andrès de Duero, and Amador de Larez, the Controller of Cuba, both favorites of Velasquez, struck a deal with a Spanish noble named Ferdinand Cortès that if they could secure the position for him, they would receive a portion of his profits.
Bernal Diaz says, "They praised Cortès so highly, and pointed him out in such flattering terms as the very man fitted to fill the vacant post, adding that he was brave and certainly very faithful to Velasquez (to whom he was son-in-law), that he allowed himself to be persuaded, and Cortès was nominated captain-general. As Andrès de Duero was the governor's secretary, he hastened to formulate the powers in a deed, making them very ample, as Cortès desired, and brought it to him duly signed." Had Velasquez been gifted with the power of looking into the future, Cortès was certainly not the man he would have chosen.
Bernal Diaz says, "They praised Cortès extremely and described him with such flattering words as the perfect person to take the vacant position, adding that he was brave and undoubtedly loyal to Velasquez (to whom he was related by marriage), which led him to be convinced, and Cortès was appointed captain-general. Since Andrès de Duero was the governor's secretary, he quickly drafted the powers in a document, making them very broad, as Cortès wanted, and delivered it to him with the proper signatures." If Velasquez had the ability to see the future, Cortès would definitely not have been the man he chose.
![]() |
Ferdinand Cortès. From an old print. |
Cortès was born at Medellin in Estramadura in 1485, of an ancient, but slenderly-endowed family; after studying at Salamanca for some time, he returned to his native town, but the quiet monotonous life there was little suited to his restless and capricious temper, and he soon started for America, reckoning upon the protection of his relation Ovando, the Governor of Hispaniola.
Cortés was born in Medellín, Estramadura, in 1485, into an old but not well-off family. After studying in Salamanca for a while, he went back to his hometown, but the dull, repetitive life there didn't fit his restless and unpredictable nature. He quickly set out for America, counting on the support of his relative Ovando, the Governor of Hispaniola.
His expectations were fully realized, and he held several honourable and lucrative posts, without counting that between times he joined in several expeditions against the natives. If he became in this manner initiated into the Indian system of tactics, so also, unfortunately, did he grow familiar with those acts of cruelty which have too often stained the Castilian name. He accompanied Diego de Velasquez in his Cuban expedition in 1511, and here he distinguished himself so highly, that notwithstanding certain disagreements with his chief, a large grant of land as well as of Indians was made to him as a recognition of his services.
His expectations were fully met, and he held several respected and well-paying positions, not to mention that in between, he took part in various expeditions against the local people. While he became familiar with the Indian tactics, he also unfortunately got accustomed to the acts of cruelty that have often tarnished the Castilian name. He joined Diego de Velasquez on his Cuban expedition in 1511, where he distinguished himself so much that despite some disagreements with his leader, he was awarded a large grant of land and a number of Indians as recognition for his services.
Cortès amassed the sum of 3000 castellanos in the course of a few years by his industry and frugality, a large sum for one in his position, but his chief recommendations in the eyes of Andrès de Duero and Amador de Sarès his two patrons, were his activity, his well-known prudence, his decision of character, and the power of gaining the confidence of all with whom he was brought into contact. In addition to all this, he was of imposing stature and appearance, very athletic, and possessed powers of endurance, remarkable even among the hardy adventurers who were accustomed to brave all kinds of hardships.
Cortès accumulated 3,000 castellanos over a few years through hard work and being budget-conscious, which was a significant amount for someone in his position. However, what really stood out to his two patrons, Andrès de Duero and Amador de Sarès, were his energy, known wisdom, strong character, and ability to earn the trust of everyone he interacted with. On top of all that, he had a commanding presence and physique, was very fit, and had exceptional endurance, even compared to the tough adventurers used to facing all sorts of challenges.
As soon as Cortès had received his commission, which he did with every mark of respectful gratitude, he set up a banner at the door of his house, made of black velvet embroidered in gold, bearing the device of a red cross in the midst of blue and white flames, and below, this motto in Latin, "Friends, let us follow the Cross, and if we have faith, we shall overcome by this sign." He concentrated the whole force of his powerful mind upon the means to make the enterprise a success; even his most intimate friends were astonished at his enthusiasm in preparing for it. He not only gave the whole of the money which he possessed towards arming the fleet, but he charged part on his estate, and borrowed considerable sums from his friends to purchase vessels, provisions, munitions of war, and horses. In a few days 300 volunteers had enrolled themselves, attracted by the fame of the general, the daring nature of the enterprise, and the profit that would probably accrue from it. Velasquez, always suspicious, and doubtless instigated by some who were jealous of Cortès, tried to put a stop to the expedition at its outset. Cortès being warned by his two patrons that Velasquez would probably try to take the command from him, acted with his customary decision; he collected his men and, in spite of the vessels not being completed and of an insufficient armament, he weighed anchor and sailed during the night. When Velasquez discovered that his plans had been check-mated he concealed his indignation, but at the same time, he made every arrangement to stop the man who could thus throw off all dependence upon him with such consummate coolness. Cortès anchored at Macaca, to complete his stores, and found many of those who had accompanied Grijalva now hasten to serve under his banner: Pedro de Alvarado and his brothers, Christoval de Olid, Alonzo de Avila, Hernandez de Puerto-Carrero, Gonzalo de Sandoval, and Bernal Diaz del Castillo, who was to write a valuable account of these events "quorum pars magna fuit." Trinity Harbour, on the south coast of Cuba was the next resting-place, and here a further supply of provisions was taken on board, but while Cortès lay at anchor for this purpose, Verdugo the governor, received letters from Velasquez, desiring him to arrest the captain-general, the command of the fleet having been just taken from him. This bold step would have endangered the safety of the town, so Verdugo refrained from executing the order. Cortès sailed away to Havana in order to enlist some new adherents, while his lieutenant Alvarado went over land to the port where the last preparations were made. Although Velasquez was unsuccessful in his first attempt, he again sent an order to arrest Cortès, but Pedro Barba the governor, felt the impossibility of executing the order in the midst of soldiers who, as Bernal Diaz says, "would willingly have given their lives to save Cortès."
As soon as Cortès received his commission, which he accepted with deep gratitude, he set up a banner at the entrance of his house made of black velvet embroidered with gold. It featured a red cross surrounded by blue and white flames, with the motto below in Latin: "Friends, let us follow the Cross, and if we have faith, we shall overcome by this sign." He focused all his mental efforts on making the mission successful; even his closest friends were amazed by his enthusiasm in preparing for it. He contributed all his money to arm the fleet, took loans against his estate, and borrowed significant amounts from his friends to buy ships, supplies, weapons, and horses. Within a few days, 300 volunteers signed up, drawn by the reputation of the general, the boldness of the mission, and the expected profits. Velasquez, always suspicious and likely influenced by those envious of Cortès, attempted to halt the expedition from the start. Cortès was warned by his two sponsors that Velasquez might try to take command from him, so he acted decisively; he gathered his men and, despite the ships not being fully ready and lacking sufficient armament, he set sail at night. When Velasquez discovered that his plans had been thwarted, he hid his anger but also made every effort to stop the man who could so calmly assert his independence. Cortès landed at Macaca to finish gathering supplies, where he found many who had previously traveled with Grijalva rushing to join his cause: Pedro de Alvarado and his brothers, Christoval de Olid, Alonzo de Avila, Hernandez de Puerto-Carrero, Gonzalo de Sandoval, and Bernal Diaz del Castillo, who would later write an important account of these events "quorum pars magna fuit." Trinity Harbour on the south coast of Cuba was the next stop, where more provisions were loaded on. However, while Cortès was at anchor for this, Verdugo the governor received letters from Velasquez, instructing him to arrest the captain-general since command of the fleet had just been taken from him. This bold move could have jeopardized the town's safety, so Verdugo chose not to carry out the order. Cortès then sailed to Havana to recruit new followers while his lieutenant Alvarado traveled overland to the port for final preparations. Although Velasquez failed in his first attempt, he sent another order to arrest Cortès, but Governor Pedro Barba realized it was impossible to enforce the order amid soldiers who, as Bernal Diaz noted, "would willingly have given their lives to save Cortès."
At length, having recalled the volunteers by beat of drum, and taken on board all that appeared necessary, Cortès set sail on the 18th February, 1519, with eleven ships (the largest being of 100 tons), 110 sailors, 553 soldiers,—13 of whom were arquebusiers,—200 Indians from the island, and some women for domestic work. The real strength of the armament lay in the ten pieces of artillery, the four falconets provided with an ample supply of ammunition, and the sixteen horses which had been obtained at great expense. It was with these almost miserable means, which, however, had given Cortès much trouble to collect, that he prepared to wage war with a sovereign whose dominions were of greater extent than those appertaining to the King of Spain—an enterprise from which he would have turned back if he had foreseen half its difficulties. But long ago a poet said, "Fortune smiles on those who dare."
Finally, after recalling the volunteers with a drumroll and gathering everything they deemed necessary, Cortés set sail on February 18, 1519, with eleven ships (the largest was 100 tons), 110 sailors, 553 soldiers—13 of whom were armed with arquebuses—200 Indians from the island, and some women for domestic duties. The real strength of the expedition lay in the ten pieces of artillery, four falconets with plenty of ammo, and the sixteen horses they had acquired at great cost. With these rather limited resources, which took Cortés a lot of effort to assemble, he prepared to go to war against a ruler whose territories were larger than those of the King of Spain—an undertaking he would have turned away from had he known even half of its challenges. But as a poet said long ago, "Fortune favors the bold."
After encountering a very severe storm, the fleet touched at the island of Cozumel, where they found that the inhabitants had embraced Christianity, either from fear of the Spaniards, or from finding the inability of their gods to help them. Just as the fleet was about to leave the island, Cortès had the good fortune to meet with a Spaniard named Jeronimo d'Aguilar, who had been kept a prisoner by the Indians for eight years. During that time he had learnt the Indian language perfectly; he was as prudent as he was clever, and when he joined the expedition he was of the greatest use as an interpreter.
After facing a terrible storm, the fleet stopped at the island of Cozumel, where they discovered that the local people had converted to Christianity, either out of fear of the Spaniards or because they realized their gods could not help them. Just as the fleet was about to leave the island, Cortès had the good fortune of meeting a Spaniard named Jeronimo d'Aguilar, who had been held captive by the Indians for eight years. During that time, he had learned the Indian language perfectly; he was as wise as he was skilled, and when he joined the expedition, he was incredibly helpful as an interpreter.
After doubling Cape Catoche, Cortès sailed down the Bay of Campeachy, passed Potonchan, and entered the Rio Tabasco, hoping to meet with as friendly a reception there as Grijalva had done, and also to collect an equally large quantity of gold; but he found a great change had taken place in the feelings of the natives, and he was obliged to employ force. In spite of the bravery and numerical superiority of the Indians, the Spaniards overcame them in several engagements, thanks to the terror caused by the reports of their fire-arms and the sight of the cavalry, whom the Indians took for supernatural beings. The Indians lost a large number of men in these engagements, while among the Spaniards two were killed, and fourteen men and several horses wounded; the wounds of the latter were dressed with fat taken from the dead bodies of the Indians. At last peace was made, and the natives gave Cortès provisions, some cotton clothing, a small quantity of gold, and twenty female slaves, among whom was the celebrated Marina, who rendered such signal services to the Spaniards as an interpreter, and who is mentioned by all the historians of the conquest of the New World.
After rounding Cape Catoche, Cortès sailed down the Bay of Campeachy, passed Potonchan, and entered the Rio Tabasco, hoping to receive a warm welcome like Grijalva had and to gather a large amount of gold; however, he discovered a significant shift in the natives' attitudes, forcing him to use military force. Despite the bravery and larger numbers of the Indians, the Spaniards defeated them in several battles, aided by the fear instilled by their gunfire and the sight of cavalry, which the Indians viewed as otherworldly beings. The Indians suffered heavy losses in these confrontations, while the Spaniards had two killed and fourteen men and several horses wounded; the horses' injuries were treated with fat from the dead Indians. Eventually, a peace agreement was reached, and the natives provided Cortès with food, some cotton clothing, a small amount of gold, and twenty female slaves, including the famous Marina, who played a crucial role as an interpreter for the Spaniards and is mentioned by all historians of the conquest of the New World.
![]() |
Cortès receives provisions, clothing, a little gold, and twenty female slaves. |
Cortès continued on a westerly course, seeking a suitable place for landing, but he could find none until he reached St. John d'Ulloa. The fleet had scarcely cast anchor before a canoe made its way fearlessly to the admiral's vessel, and here Marina (who was of Aztec origin) was of the greatest use, in telling Cortès that the Indians of this part of the country were the subjects of a great empire, and that their province was one recently added to it by conquest. Their monarch, named Moctheuzoma, better known under the name of Montezuma, lived in Tenochtitlan, or Mexico, nearly 210 miles away in the interior. Cortès offered the Indians some presents, assuring them of his pacific intentions, and then disembarked upon the torrid and unhealthy shore of Vera-Cruz. Provisions flowed in immediately, but the day after the landing, Teutile, governor of the province, and ambassador of Montezuma to the Spaniards, had much difficulty in answering Cortès when he asked him to conduct him to his master without delay, knowing as he did all the anxiety and fears which had haunted the mind of the Emperor since the arrival of the Spaniards. However, he caused some cotton stuffs, feather cloaks, and some articles made of gold to be laid at the feet of the general, a sight which simply excited the cupidity of the Europeans. To give these poor Indians an adequate idea of his power, Cortès called out his soldiers, and put them through their drill, he also ordered the discharge of some pieces of artillery, the noise of which froze the hearts of the savages with terror. During the whole time of the interview, some painters had been employed in sketching upon pieces of white cotton, the ships, the troops, and everything which had struck their fancy. These drawings very cleverly executed, were to be sent to Montezuma.
Cortés continued west, looking for a good place to land, but he couldn't find one until he reached St. John d'Ulloa. The fleet had barely anchored when a canoe bravely approached the admiral's ship. Marina, who was of Aztec descent, was extremely helpful in informing Cortés that the locals were subjects of a powerful empire and that their region had recently been added to it through conquest. Their ruler, Moctheuzoma, more commonly known as Montezuma, lived in Tenochtitlan, or Mexico, about 210 miles inland. Cortés presented the locals with gifts, assuring them of his peaceful intentions, and then stepped onto the hot and unhealthy shore of Vera-Cruz. Supplies began to flow in right away, but the day after landing, Teutile, the governor of the province and Montezuma's ambassador to the Spaniards, had a hard time responding to Cortés when he asked to be taken to his master immediately, aware of the anxiety and fear that had been troubling the Emperor since the Spaniards arrived. Nevertheless, he had some cotton textiles, feather cloaks, and gold items laid at the general's feet, which only fueled the Europeans' greed. To impress these poor locals with his power, Cortés called his soldiers and put them through drills, and he also ordered the firing of some cannons, the noise of which terrified the natives. During their meeting, some artists were busy sketching on pieces of white cotton, capturing images of the ships, the troops, and everything that caught their interest. These well-executed drawings were meant to be sent to Montezuma.
Before beginning the history of the heroic struggles which shortly commenced, it will be useful to give some details as to that Mexican empire which, powerful as it appeared, nevertheless contained within itself numerous elements of decay and dissolution, which fact explains the cause of its conquest by a mere handful of adventurers. That part of America which was under the dominion of Montezuma was called Anahuac and lay between 14° and 20° north latitude. This region presents great varieties of climate on account of its difference of altitude; towards the centre, and rather nearer to the Pacific than to the Atlantic, there is a huge basin at an elevation of 7500 feet above the sea, and about 200 miles in circumference, in the hollow of which there were at that time several lakes; this depression is called the valley of Mexico, taking its name from the capital of the empire. As may be easily supposed, we possess very few authentic details about a people whose written annals were burnt by the ignorant "conquistadores" and by fanatical monks, who jealously suppressed everything which might remind the conquered race of their ancient religious and political traditions.
Before starting the story of the heroic battles that were about to begin, it's helpful to share some details about the Mexican empire, which, despite its impressive power, had many elements of decay and collapse within it. This explains why it was conquered by just a small group of adventurers. The part of America controlled by Montezuma was known as Anahuac and was located between 14° and 20° north latitude. This area has a wide variety of climates due to its different altitudes; in the center, closer to the Pacific than the Atlantic, there’s a large basin that sits 7,500 feet above sea level and has a circumference of about 200 miles. In this basin, there were several lakes at that time, and it’s called the valley of Mexico, named after the capital of the empire. As you might expect, we have very few reliable details about a people whose written records were burned by the ignorant "conquistadores" and fanatical monks, who carefully suppressed anything that might remind the conquered people of their ancient religious and political traditions.
Arriving from the north in the seventh century the Toltecs had overspread the plateau of Anahuac. They were an intelligent race of people, addicted to agriculture and the mechanical arts, understanding the working in metals, and to whom is due the construction of the greater part of the sumptuous and gigantic edifices of which the ruins are found in every direction in New Spain. After four centuries of power, the Toltecs disappeared from the country as mysteriously as they had come. A century later they were replaced by a savage tribe from the north-west, who were soon followed by more civilized races, speaking apparently the Toltec language. The most celebrated of these tribes were the Aztecs, and the Alcolhuès or Tezcucans, who assimilated themselves easily with the tincture of civilization which remained in the country with the last of the Toltecs. The Aztecs, after a series of migrations and wars, settled themselves in 1326 in the valley of Mexico, where they built their capital Tenochtitlan. A treaty of alliance both offensive and defensive was entered into between the states of Mexico, Tezcuco, and Tlacopan, and was rigorously observed for a whole century; in consequence of this the Aztec civilization, which had been at first bounded by the extent of the valley, spread on all sides, and soon was limited only by the Pacific and Atlantic Oceans. In a short time these people had reached a higher degree of civilization than any other tribe in the New World. The rights of property were recognized in Mexico, commerce flourished there, and three kinds of coin in circulation provided the ordinary mechanism of exchange. There was a well-organized police, and a system of relays which worked with perfect regularity, and enabled the sovereign to transmit his orders with rapidity from one end of the empire to the other. The number and beauty of the towns, the great size of the palaces, temples, and fortresses indicated an advanced civilization, which presented a singular contrast to the ferocious manners of the Aztecs. Their polytheistic religion was in the highest degree barbarous and sanguinary; the priests formed a very numerous body, and exercised great influence even over political affairs. Side by side with rites similar to those of Christians, such as baptism and confession, the religion presented a tissue of the most absurd and bloody superstitions. The offering up of human sacrifices, adopted at the beginning of the 14th century, and used at first very sparingly, had soon become so frequent, that the number of victims immolated each year, and drawn chiefly from the conquered nations, amounted to 20,000, while under certain circumstances the number was much larger. Thus in 1486, at the inauguration of the temple of Huitzilopchit, 70,000 captives perished in a single day.
Arriving from the north in the seventh century, the Toltecs spread across the Anahuac plateau. They were an intelligent group of people, focused on agriculture and skilled in mechanical arts, including metalworking. They are credited with building most of the impressive and large structures found in ruins throughout New Spain. After four centuries of dominance, the Toltecs disappeared from the region as mysteriously as they had arrived. A century later, a savage tribe from the northwest replaced them, soon followed by more civilized peoples who seemingly spoke the Toltec language. The most notable of these tribes were the Aztecs and the Alcolhuès, or Tezcucans, who easily adapted to the remnants of civilization left by the last Toltecs. After a series of migrations and battles, the Aztecs settled in the Valley of Mexico in 1326, where they founded their capital, Tenochtitlan. They formed a mutual defense and offense alliance with the states of Mexico, Tezcuco, and Tlacopan, which was strictly upheld for a century. As a result, the Aztec civilization, initially confined to the valley, expanded in all directions, eventually reaching the Pacific and Atlantic Oceans. In a short time, these people achieved a higher level of civilization than any other tribe in the New World. Property rights were recognized, commerce thrived, and three types of currency facilitated trade. There was an organized police force and a reliable relay system that allowed the ruler to send commands swiftly throughout the empire. The number and elegance of the towns, along with the grand size of the palaces, temples, and fortresses, reflected a developed civilization, contrasting sharply with the brutal practices of the Aztecs. Their polytheistic religion was extremely barbaric and bloody; the priests were numerous and held significant sway over political matters. Alongside rites similar to those in Christianity, like baptism and confession, their religion was filled with bizarre and violent superstitions. The practice of human sacrifice began in the early 14th century and initially occurred sparingly, but soon became so common that the number of victims, primarily from conquered nations, reached 20,000 each year, with even larger numbers during certain events. For instance, in 1486, at the inauguration of the temple of Huitzilopchit, 70,000 prisoners died in a single day.
The Government of Mexico was monarchical; at first the imperial power had been carefully limited, but it had increased with the various conquests, and had become despotic. The sovereign was always chosen out of the same family, and his accession was marked by the offering up of numerous human sacrifices. The Emperor Montezuma belonged to the sacerdotal caste, and in consequence his power received some unwonted development. The result of his numerous wars had been the extension of his frontiers, and the subjugation of various nations; these latter welcomed the Spaniards with eagerness, thinking that their dominion must surely be less oppressive and less cruel than that of the Aztecs.
The government of Mexico was a monarchy; initially, imperial power was carefully restricted, but it grew with various conquests and became tyrannical. The sovereign was always selected from the same family, and their rise to power was marked by numerous human sacrifices. Emperor Montezuma was from the priestly class, which significantly increased his authority. His many wars resulted in expanded borders and the conquering of various nations; these nations eagerly welcomed the Spaniards, believing their rule would be less oppressive and cruel than that of the Aztecs.
It is certain that if Montezuma, with the large force which he had at his disposal, had fallen upon the Spaniards when they were occupying the hot and unhealthy shore of Vera-Cruz, they would have been unable, in spite of the superiority of their arms and discipline, to resist such a shock; they must all have perished, or been obliged to re-embark, and the fate of the New World would have been completely changed. But the decision which formed the most salient point in the character of Cortès, was completely wanting in that of Montezuma, a prince who never could at any time adopt a resolute policy.
It’s clear that if Montezuma, with the large army he had, had attacked the Spaniards while they were on the hot and unhealthy shores of Vera Cruz, they wouldn’t have been able to withstand such an assault despite their superior weapons and training; they would have likely perished or had to flee back to their ships, completely altering the fate of the New World. However, the decisive quality that defined Cortés was entirely absent in Montezuma, a ruler who could never commit to a firm course of action.
Fresh ambassadors from the emperor had arrived at the Spanish camp, bringing to Cortès an order to quit the country, and upon his refusal all intercourse between the natives and the invaders had immediately ceased. The situation was becoming critical, and this Cortès felt. After having overcome some hesitation which had been shown by the troops, he laid the foundations of Vera-Cruz, a fortress designed to serve as a basis of operations, and a shelter in case of a possible re-embarkation. He next organized a kind of civil government, a junta, as it would be called in the present day, to which he resigned the commission which had been revoked by Velasquez, and then he made the junta give him one with new provisions and more extended powers. After this he received the envoys from the town of Zempoalla, who were come to solicit his alliance, and his protection against Montezuma, whose dominion they bore with impatience. Cortès was indeed fortunate in meeting with such allies so soon after landing, and not wishing to allow so golden an opportunity to slip, he welcomed the Totonacs kindly, went with them to their capital, and after having caused a fortress to be constructed at Quiabislan on the sea-shore, he persuaded his new friends to refuse the payment of tribute to Montezuma. He took advantage of his stay at Zempoalla to exhort these people to embrace Christianity, and he threw down their idols, as he had already done at Cozumel, to prove to them the powerlessness of their gods.
Fresh ambassadors from the emperor had arrived at the Spanish camp, delivering an order to Cortès to leave the country. When he refused, all communication between the natives and the invaders immediately stopped. The situation was becoming critical, and Cortès could feel it. After overcoming some initial hesitation from the troops, he laid the foundations of Vera-Cruz, a fortress meant to serve as a base of operations and a refuge in case he needed to retreat. He then set up a sort of civil government, a junta, as we would call it today, to which he transferred the power that had been revoked by Velasquez. He then arranged for the junta to grant him a new commission with expanded powers. After this, he received envoys from the town of Zempoalla, who had come to seek his alliance and protection against Montezuma, whose rule they could no longer tolerate. Cortès was fortunate to find such allies so soon after landing, and not wanting to miss this golden opportunity, he welcomed the Totonacs warmly, went to their capital, and after having a fortress built at Quiabislan by the seaside, he convinced his new friends to stop paying tribute to Montezuma. During his stay in Zempoalla, he encouraged the people to adopt Christianity and destroyed their idols, as he had already done at Cozumel, to demonstrate the powerlessness of their gods.
Meanwhile a plot had been forming in his own camp, and Cortès, feeling convinced that as long as there remained any way of returning to Cuba, there would be constant lukewarmness and discontent among his soldiers, caused all his ships to be run aground, under the pretext of their being in too shattered a condition to be of any further use. This was an unheard-of act of audacity, and one which forced his companions either to conquer or to die. Having no longer anything to fear from the want of discipline of his troops, Cortès set out for Zempoalla on the 16th of August, with five hundred soldiers, fifteen horses, and six field cannon, and also two hundred Indian porters, who were intended to perform all menial offices. The little army soon reached the frontiers of the small republic of Tlascala, of which the fierce inhabitants, impatient of servitude, had long been engaged in strife with Montezuma. Cortès flattered himself that his oft-proclaimed intention of delivering the Indians from the Mexican yoke would induce the Tlascalans to become his allies and at once to make common cause with him. He therefore asked for leave to cross their territory on his way to Mexico; but his ambassadors were detained, and as he advanced into the interior of the country, he was harassed for fourteen consecutive days and nights by continual attacks from several bodies of Tlascalans, amounting in all to 30,000 men, who displayed a bravery and determination such as the Spaniards had never yet seen equalled in the New World. But the arms possessed by these brave men were very primitive. What could they effect with only arrows and lances tipped with obsidian or fish-bones, stakes hardened in the fire, wooden swords, and above all with an inferior system of tactics? When they found that each encounter cost them the lives of many of their bravest warriors, while not a single Spaniard had been killed, they imagined that these strangers must be of a superior order of beings, while they could not tell what opinion to form of men who sent back to them the spies taken in their camp, with their hands cut off, and who yet after each victory not only did not devour their prisoners, as the Aztecs would have done, but released them, loading them with presents and proposing peace.
Meanwhile, a plot was brewing in his own camp, and Cortès, convinced that as long as there was any possibility of returning to Cuba, his soldiers would remain indifferent and discontented, ordered all his ships to be run aground, claiming they were too damaged to be useful anymore. This was an unprecedented act of boldness, forcing his companions to either conquer or perish. With nothing left to fear from the disarray of his troops, Cortès set out for Zempoalla on August 16, with five hundred soldiers, fifteen horses, six field cannons, and two hundred Indian porters to handle the menial tasks. The small army soon reached the borders of the small republic of Tlascala, where the fierce locals, tired of servitude, had long been fighting against Montezuma. Cortès hoped that his well-publicized intention to free the Indians from Mexican rule would lead the Tlascalans to ally with him. He therefore requested permission to cross their territory on his way to Mexico; however, his envoys were detained, and as he moved deeper into the country, he faced relentless attacks for fourteen straight days and nights from various groups of Tlascalans, totaling around 30,000 men, who displayed a bravery and determination unlike anything the Spaniards had seen in the New World. However, the weapons these brave men carried were very primitive. What could they achieve with only arrows and lances tipped with obsidian or fish bones, stakes hardened in fire, wooden swords, and a significantly inferior tactic system? Realizing that each clash cost them many of their bravest warriors while not a single Spaniard had fallen, they assumed these strangers must be a superior kind of beings. They were perplexed by men who returned their captured spies with their hands cut off and yet, after each victory, not only refrained from devouring their prisoners as the Aztecs would have done, but also released them, showering them with gifts and proposing peace.
Upon this the Tlascalans declared themselves vassals of the Spanish crown, and swore to assist Cortès in all his expeditions, while he on his side promised to protect them against their enemies. It was time that peace should be made, for many of the Spaniards were wounded or ill, and all were worn out with fatigue, but the entry in triumph into Tlascala, where they were welcomed as supernatural beings, quickly made them forget their sufferings.
Upon this, the Tlaxcalans declared themselves loyal subjects of the Spanish crown and vowed to support Cortés in all his missions, while he promised to protect them from their enemies. It was time for peace, as many of the Spaniards were injured or sick, and all were exhausted from fatigue. However, their triumphant entry into Tlaxcala, where they were greeted as supernatural beings, quickly made them forget their struggles.
After twenty days of repose in this town, Cortès resumed his march towards Mexico, having with him an auxiliary army of six thousand Tlascalans. He went first to Cholula, a town regarded as sacred by the Indians, and as the sanctuary and favoured residence of their deities. Montezuma felt much satisfaction in the advance of the Spaniards to this town, either from the hope that the gods would themselves avenge the desecration of their temples, or that he thought a rising, and massacre of the Spaniards might be more easily organized in this populous and fanatical town. Cortès had been warned by the Tlascalans that he must place no trust in the protestations of friendship and devotion made by the Cholulans. However, he took up his quarters in the town, considering that he would lose his prestige if he showed any signs of fear, but upon being informed by the Tlascalans that the women and children were being sent away, and by Marina that a considerable body of troops was massed at the gates of the city, that pitfalls and trenches were dug in the streets, whilst the roofs of the houses were loaded with stones and missiles, Cortès anticipated the designs of his enemies, gave orders to make prisoners of all the principal men of the town, and then organized a general massacre of the population, thus taken by surprise and deprived of their leaders. For two whole days the unhappy Cholulans were subject to all the horrors which could be invented by the rage of the Spaniards, and the vengeance of their allies the Tlascalans. A terrible example was made, six thousand people being put to the sword, temples burned to the ground, and the town half destroyed, a work of destruction well calculated to strike terror into the hearts of Montezuma and his subjects.
After twenty days of rest in this town, Cortès continued his journey towards Mexico, bringing along an auxiliary army of six thousand Tlascalans. He first went to Cholula, a town considered sacred by the Indians and seen as the home of their deities. Montezuma was quite pleased with the Spaniards advancing to this town, either from the hope that the gods would take revenge for the desecration of their temples, or because he thought it would be easier to organize a revolt and massacre of the Spaniards in this crowded and fanatical town. The Tlascalans had warned Cortès that he should not trust the Cholulans' claims of friendship and loyalty. However, he decided to stay in the town, believing it would damage his reputation if he showed any fear. But when the Tlascalans informed him that women and children were being sent away, and Marina told him that a large number of troops were gathered at the city gates, and that traps and trenches were dug in the streets while the roofs of the houses were piled with stones and missiles, Cortès anticipated his enemies' plans. He ordered the capture of all the town's main leaders and then coordinated a general massacre of the population, who were caught by surprise and left without their leaders. For two full days, the unfortunate Cholulans suffered every horror the Spaniards and their Tlascalan allies could devise. A terrible example was set, with six thousand people slaughtered, temples burned to the ground, and the town partially destroyed—a devastating act aimed to instill fear in the hearts of Montezuma and his subjects.
![]() |
Lake of Mexico. |
Sixty miles now separated Cortès from the capital, and everywhere as he passed along he was received as a liberator. There was not a cacique who had not some cause of complaint against the imperial despotism, and Cortès felt confirmed in the hope that so divided an empire would prove an easy prey. As the Spaniards descended from the mountains of Chalco, they beheld with astonishment the valley of Mexico, with its enormous lake, deeply sunk and surrounded by large towns, the capital city built upon piles, and the well-cultivated fields of this fertile region.
Sixty miles now separated Cortès from the capital, and everywhere he went, he was welcomed as a liberator. There wasn't a single cacique who didn't have some complaint against the imperial tyranny, and Cortès felt reassured in his belief that such a divided empire would be an easy target. As the Spaniards came down from the mountains of Chalco, they were amazed to see the valley of Mexico, with its massive lake, deeply set and surrounded by large towns, the capital city built on stilts, and the well-tended fields of this fertile area.
Cortès did not trouble himself about the continued tergiversations of Montezuma, who could not make up his mind to the last moment whether he would receive the Spaniards as friends or enemies. The Spanish general advanced along the causeway which leads to Mexico across the lake, and was already within a mile of the town, when some Indians, who, from their magnificent costume were evidently of high rank, came to greet him and to announce to him the approach of the emperor. Montezuma soon appeared, borne upon the shoulders of his favourites in a kind of litter adorned with gold and feathers, while a magnificent canopy protected him from the rays of the sun. As he advanced the Indians prostrated themselves before him, with their heads downwards, as though unworthy even to look at their monarch. This first interview was cordial, and Montezuma himself conducted his guests to the abode which he had prepared for them. It was a vast palace, surrounded by a stone wall, and defended by high towers. Cortès immediately took measures of defence, and ordered the cannon to be pointed upon the roads leading to the palace. At the second interview, magnificent presents were offered both to the general and soldiers. Montezuma related that according to an old tradition, the ancestors of the Aztecs had arrived in the country under the leadership of a man of white complexion, and bearded like the Spaniards. After laying the foundations of their power, he had embarked upon the ocean, promising them that one day his descendants would come to visit them and to reform their laws—and if, as Montezuma said, he now received the Spaniards rather as fathers than as foreigners, it was because he felt convinced that in them he beheld the descendants of his people's ancient chief, and he begged them to regard themselves as the masters of his country.
Cortés didn’t worry about Montezuma’s ongoing uncertainties, as he couldn’t decide until the very last moment whether he would welcome the Spaniards as friends or foes. The Spanish general moved along the causeway that leads to Mexico across the lake and was already within a mile of the city when some Indians, clearly of high rank from their impressive costumes, came to greet him and announce the emperor’s arrival. Montezuma soon appeared, carried on the shoulders of his favorites in a kind of litter adorned with gold and feathers, while a magnificent canopy sheltered him from the sun. As he approached, the Indians prostrated themselves before him, heads down, feeling unworthy even to look at their king. This first meeting was friendly, and Montezuma personally guided his guests to the residence he had prepared for them. It was a large palace, surrounded by a stone wall and protected by tall towers. Cortés quickly took defensive measures and ordered the cannons to be aimed at the roads leading to the palace. During the second meeting, lavish gifts were presented to both the general and his soldiers. Montezuma shared that according to an old tradition, the Aztec ancestors had arrived in the land under the guidance of a white, bearded man, like the Spaniards. After establishing their power, he had set sail for the ocean, promising them that one day his descendants would come to visit and reform their laws—and if, as Montezuma said, he now welcomed the Spaniards more as fathers than strangers, it was because he was convinced he saw in them the descendants of his people's ancient leader, and he asked them to consider themselves the masters of his land.
The following days were employed in visiting the town, which appeared to the Spaniards as larger, more populous, and more beautiful than any city which they had hitherto seen in America. Its distinguishing peculiarity consisted in the causeways which formed a means of communication with the land, and which were cut through in various places to allow a free passage to vessels sailing on the waters of the lake. Across these openings were thrown bridges which could be easily destroyed. On the eastern side of the town there was no causeway and no means of communication with the land except by canoes. This arrangement of the town of Mexico caused some anxiety to Cortès, who saw that he might be at any moment blockaded in the town, without being able to find means of egress. He determined, therefore, to prevent any seditious attempt by securing the person of the emperor, and using him as a hostage. The following news which he had just received furnished him with an excellent pretext: Qualpopoca, a Mexican general, had attacked the provinces which had submitted to the Spaniards, and Escalante and seven of his soldiers had been mortally wounded; besides this, a prisoner had been beheaded and the head carried from town to town, thus proving that the invaders could be conquered, and were nothing more than ordinary mortals.
The next few days were spent exploring the town, which seemed to the Spaniards larger, more populated, and more beautiful than any city they had seen in America so far. Its unique feature was the causeways that connected it to the mainland, with cuts in various places to allow boats to pass through the lake. Bridges were built over these openings, which could be easily destroyed. On the eastern side of the town, there was no causeway or way to reach the land except by canoe. This layout of Mexico City made Cortès uneasy, as he realized he could be trapped in the town at any time without a way to escape. He decided to prevent any rebellious actions by capturing the emperor and using him as a hostage. Recent news provided him with a solid justification: Qualpopoca, a Mexican general, had attacked the provinces that had submitted to the Spaniards, and Escalante along with seven of his soldiers had been seriously injured; moreover, a prisoner had been executed, and his head was carried from town to town, proving that the invaders could be defeated and were just ordinary people.
Cortès profited by these events to accuse the emperor of perfidy. He declared that although Montezuma appeared friendly to him and to his soldiers, it was only that he might wait for some favourable opportunity to treat them in the same manner as Escalante, a proceeding quite unworthy of a monarch, and very different from the confidence which Cortès had shown in coming, as he had done, to visit him. He went on to say that if the suspicions of the Spaniards were not justified, the emperor could easily exonerate himself by having Qualpopoca punished, and finally, to prevent the recurrence of aggressions which could but destroy the existing harmony, and to prove to the Mexicans that he harboured no ill-design against the Spaniards, Montezuma could not do otherwise than come to reside amongst them. It may be easily imagined that the emperor was not very ready to decide upon this course, but was at last obliged to give in to the violence and threats of the Spaniards. Upon announcing his resolution to his subjects, he was made to assure them several times over that he put himself into the hands of the Spaniards of his own free will; these words were needed to calm the Mexicans, who threatened to make an attack upon the foreigners.
Cortés took advantage of these events to accuse the emperor of betrayal. He stated that even though Montezuma seemed friendly to him and his soldiers, it was only so he could wait for a good chance to treat them the same way he did Escalante, which was unworthy of a king and very different from the trust Cortés had shown by coming to visit him. He continued by saying that if the Spaniards’ suspicions were unfounded, the emperor could easily clear his name by punishing Qualpopoca. Finally, to prevent further attacks that could ruin the current peace and to show the Mexicans that he meant no harm to the Spaniards, Montezuma had no choice but to come live among them. It’s easy to imagine that the emperor was reluctant to make this decision, but he ultimately had to give in to the force and threats of the Spaniards. When he informed his subjects of his decision, he had to assure them multiple times that he was putting himself in the hands of the Spaniards willingly; these reassurances were necessary to calm the Mexicans, who were threatening to attack the foreigners.
The success of Cortès in this bold scheme was quite beyond his expectations. Qualpopoca, with his son and five of the chief ringleaders in the revolt, were seized by the Mexicans, and brought before a Spanish tribunal, which was at the same time judge and prosecutor; the Indians were condemned and burnt alive. Not content with having punished men who had committed no crime but that of executing the orders of their emperor, and of opposing an armed resistance to the invasion of their country, Cortès imposed a new humiliation upon Montezuma, in placing fetters upon his feet, under the pretext that the culprits in their last moments had made accusations against him. For six months the "Conquistador" exercised the supreme government in the name of the emperor, now reduced to a puppet-show of authority. Cortès changed the governors who displeased him, collected the taxes, presided over all the details of the administration, and sent Spaniards into the various provinces of the empire with orders to examine their productions, and to take particular notice of the mining districts and the processes in use for collecting gold.
The success of Cortès in this daring plan exceeded his expectations. Qualpopoca, along with his son and five of the main leaders of the rebellion, were captured by the Mexicans and brought before a Spanish court, which served as both judge and prosecutor; the Indians were sentenced and burned alive. Not satisfied with punishing men who had done nothing but follow their emperor's orders and resist the invasion of their land, Cortès further humiliated Montezuma by shackling his feet, claiming that the condemned had accused him in their final moments. For six months, the "Conquistador" held absolute power in the name of the emperor, who had been reduced to a mere puppet. Cortès replaced any governors he didn’t like, collected taxes, oversaw all aspects of governance, and dispatched Spaniards to different provinces of the empire to assess their resources and pay special attention to the mining regions and gold extraction methods.
Cortès also turned to account the curiosity evinced by Montezuma to see European ships, to have rigging and other appurtenances brought from Vera-Cruz, and to order the construction of two brigantines destined to ensure his communications with terra-firma by the waters of the lake.
Cortès also took advantage of Montezuma's curiosity about European ships by having rigging and other supplies brought from Vera-Cruz, and he ordered the construction of two brigantines to secure communications with the mainland via the lake.
Emboldened by receiving so many proofs of submission and humility, Cortès took another step in advance, and required that Montezuma should declare himself the vassal and tributary of Spain. The act of fidelity and homage was accompanied, as may be easily imagined, with presents both rich and numerous, as well as by a heavy tax which was levied without much difficulty. The opportunity was now taken to gather together everything in gold and silver, which had been extorted from the Indians, and to melt them down, except certain pieces which were kept as they were, on account of the beauty of the workmanship. The whole did not amount to more than 600,000 pesos, or 100,000l. Thus, although the Spaniards had made use of all their power, and Montezuma had exhausted his treasures to satisfy them, the whole product amounted to an absurdly small sum, very little in accordance with the idea which the conquerors had formed of the riches of the country. After reserving one-fifth of the treasure for the king, and one-fifth for Cortès and subtracting enough to reimburse the sums which had been advanced for the expenses of the expedition, the share of each soldier did not amount to 100 pesos, and they considered that it would have been more worth their while to have remained in Hispaniola, than to have experienced such fatigues, encountered such great dangers, and suffered so many privations, all for the reward of 100 pesos! If the promises of Cortès ended in this beggarly result, and if the partition had been made with fairness, of which they did not feel certain, they argued that it was absurd to remain longer in so poor a country, while under a chief less prodigal in promises, but more generous, they might go to countries rich in gold and precious stones, where brave warriors would find an adequate compensation for their toils. So murmured these greedy adventurers; some accepting what fell to their share while fuming over its small amount, others disdainfully refusing it.
Emboldened by so many signs of submission and humility, Cortès took another step forward and demanded that Montezuma declare himself a vassal and tributary of Spain. This act of loyalty and tribute was naturally accompanied by valuable gifts and a heavy tax that was collected relatively easily. It was also a chance to gather up everything in gold and silver that had been taken from the Indians and to melt it down, except for certain pieces kept intact because of their beautiful craftsmanship. The total only amounted to about 600,000 pesos, or 100,000 l. Even though the Spaniards had used all their power and Montezuma had exhausted his treasures to appease them, the entire sum was absurdly small and not at all in line with what the conquerors had expected from the country’s wealth. After setting aside one-fifth of the treasure for the king and one-fifth for Cortès, and deducting enough to cover the costs of the expedition, each soldier ended up with less than 100 pesos. They felt it would have been better to stay in Hispaniola than to endure such hardships, face great dangers, and suffer numerous privations for just 100 pesos! Given that Cortès's promises led to such a meager outcome and that they weren't sure if the distribution had been fair, they believed it was ridiculous to stay in such a poor country. They argued that under a chief who made fewer grand promises but was more generous, they could go to wealthier lands filled with gold and precious stones, where brave warriors would be properly compensated for their efforts. So grumbled these greedy adventurers, some reluctantly accepting their shares while complaining about the little amount, and others disdainfully rejecting it.
Cortès had succeeded in persuading Montezuma to conform to his will in everything which concerned politics, but it was otherwise in regard to religion. He could not persuade him to change his creed, and when Cortès wished to throw down the idols, as he had done at Zempoalla, a tumult arose which would have become very serious, had he not immediately abandoned his project. From that time the Mexicans, who had offered scarcely any resistance to the subjugation and imprisonment of their monarch, resolved to avenge their outraged deities, and they prepared a simultaneous rising against the invaders. It was at this juncture, when the affairs in the interior seemed to be taking a less favourable turn, that Cortès received news from Vera-Cruz, that several ships were cruising off the harbour. At first he thought this must be a fleet sent to his aid by Charles V., in answer to a letter which he had sent to him on the 16th of July, 1519, by Puerto Carrero and Montejo. But he was soon undeceived, and learnt that this expedition was organized by Diego Velasquez, who knew by experience how lightly his lieutenant could shake off all dependence upon him; he had sent this armament with the object of deposing Cortès from his command, of making him a prisoner, and of carrying him off to Cuba, where he would be speedily placed upon his trial. The fleet thus sent was under the command of Pamphilo de Narvaez; it consisted of eighteen vessels, and carried eighty horse-soldiers, and 100 infantry (of whom eighty were musketeers), 120 cross-bowmen, and twelve cannons.
Cortès had managed to convince Montezuma to follow his orders in everything related to politics, but the same couldn't be said for religion. He couldn't get Montezuma to change his beliefs, and when Cortès tried to destroy the idols, like he had done at Zempoalla, a riot broke out that could have escalated seriously if he hadn't quickly given up on his plan. From that point on, the Mexicans, who had barely resisted the capture and imprisonment of their king, decided to take revenge on their offended gods and began preparing a coordinated uprising against the invaders. It was at this critical moment, when things in the interior were looking less promising for Cortès, that he learned from Vera-Cruz about several ships cruising off the harbor. At first, he thought this was a fleet sent by Charles V. to assist him in response to a letter he had sent on July 16, 1519, through Puerto Carrero and Montejo. But he was soon set straight and discovered that this expedition had been organized by Diego Velasquez, who knew from experience how easily his lieutenant could break away from his authority; he had dispatched this fleet with the intent of removing Cortès from command, capturing him, and taking him to Cuba, where he would be quickly put on trial. The fleet was led by Pamphilo de Narvaez, comprised of eighteen ships, and carried eighty cavalry soldiers, 100 infantry (of which eighty were musketeers), 120 crossbowmen, and twelve cannons.
Narvaez disembarked without opposition, near to the fort of San Juan d'Ulloa, but upon summoning the Governor of Vera-Cruz, Sandoval, to give up the town to him, Sandoval seized the men who were charged with the insolent message, and sent them off to Mexico, where Cortès at once released them, and then gained from them circumstantial information as to the forces, and the projects of Narvaez. The personal danger of Cortès at this moment was great; the troops sent by Velasquez were more numerous and better furnished with arms and ammunition than were his own, but his deepest cause of anxiety was not the possibility of his own condemnation and death, it was the fear lest all fruit of his efforts might be lost, and the knowledge of the hurtfulness of these dissensions to his country's cause. The situation was a critical one, but after mature reflection and the careful weighing of arguments for and against the course he meditated, Cortès determined to fight, even at a disadvantage, rather than to sacrifice his conquests and the interests of Spain. Before proceeding to this last extremity, he sent his chaplain Olmedo to Narvaez, but he was very ill-received, and saw all his proposals for an accommodation disdainfully rejected. Olmedo met with more success amongst the soldiers, who most of them knew him, and to whom he distributed a number of chains, gold rings, and other jewels, which were well calculated to give them a high idea of the riches of the conqueror. But when Narvaez heard of what was going on, he determined not to leave his troops any longer exposed to temptation; he set a price upon the heads of Cortès and his principal officers, and advanced to the encounter.
Narvaez landed without any resistance, close to the fort of San Juan d'Ulloa, but when he called on the Governor of Vera-Cruz, Sandoval, to surrender the town to him, Sandoval captured the men who delivered the arrogant message and sent them to Mexico. There, Cortès quickly released them and got detailed information about Narvaez's forces and plans. Cortès was in serious danger at this time; the troops sent by Velasquez were larger in number and better equipped with weapons and supplies than his own. However, his biggest worry wasn’t about facing condemnation and death but rather the fear that all his efforts might be wasted, and he understood how damaging these divisions were to his country’s cause. The situation was critical, but after careful consideration of the pros and cons of his options, Cortès decided to fight, even if it meant being at a disadvantage, rather than sacrifice his conquests and Spain's interests. Before taking such a drastic step, he sent his chaplain Olmedo to Narvaez, but he was received poorly, and all his suggestions for a peaceful settlement were scornfully dismissed. Olmedo had better luck with the soldiers, many of whom knew him, and he gave out chains, gold rings, and other jewels that were sure to impress them with the riches of the conqueror. But when Narvaez found out what was happening, he decided not to let his troops be tempted any longer; he put a bounty on the heads of Cortès and his top officers and moved to confront them.
Cortès, however, was too skilful to be enticed into giving battle under unfavourable circumstances. He temporized and succeeded in tiring out Narvaez and his troops, who retired to Zempoalla. Then Cortès, having taken his measures with consummate prudence, and the surprise and terror of a nocturnal attack which he organized compensating for the inferiority of his troops, he made prisoners of his enemy and all his soldiers, his own loss amounting to but two men. The conqueror treated the vanquished well, and gave them the choice between returning to Cuba, or remaining to share his fortune. This latter proposal, backed up as it was by gifts and promises, appeared so seductive to the new arrivals, that Cortès found himself at the head of 1000 soldiers, the day after he had been in danger of falling into the hands of Narvaez. This rapid change of fortune was turned to the greatest advantage by the skilful diplomacy of Cortès, who hastened to return to Mexico. The troops whom he had left there under the command of Alvarado, to guard the emperor and the treasure, were reduced to the last extremity by the natives, who had killed or wounded a great number of soldiers, and who kept the rest in a state of close blockade, while threatening them constantly with a general assault. It must be confessed that the imprudent and criminal conduct of the Spaniards, and notably the massacre of the most distinguished citizens of the empire during a fête, had brought about the rising which they dreaded, and which they had hoped to prevent. After having been joined by 2000 Tlascalans, Cortès pressed forward by forced marches towards the capital, where he arrived in safety, and found that the Indians had not destroyed the bridges belonging to the causeways and dikes which joined Mexico to the land. In spite of the arrival of this reinforcement, the situation did not improve. Each day it was necessary to engage in new combats, and to make sorties to clear the avenues leading to the palace occupied by the Spaniards.
Cortès, however, was too skilled to be lured into battle under unfavorable circumstances. He bided his time and managed to wear out Narvaez and his troops, who retreated to Zempoalla. Then, after taking careful measures and using the element of surprise with a nighttime attack he organized—making up for the smaller size of his forces—he captured his enemy and all his soldiers, suffering only two casualties himself. The conqueror treated the defeated well and offered them a choice between returning to Cuba or staying to share in his fortune. This latter option, supported by gifts and promises, seemed so appealing to the newcomers that Cortès found himself leading 1,000 soldiers the day after he had been in danger of falling into Narvaez’s hands. This swift change in fortune was skillfully managed by Cortès, who quickly returned to Mexico. The troops he had left behind under Alvarado to protect the emperor and the treasure were at their breaking point, as the natives had killed or injured many soldiers and kept the rest under siege, constantly threatening a full-scale attack. It must be acknowledged that the reckless and criminal actions of the Spaniards, particularly the massacre of prominent citizens during a celebration, had caused the uprising they feared and had hoped to avoid. After being joined by 2,000 Tlascalans, Cortès pressed onward with forced marches toward the capital, reaching it safely and discovering that the Indians had not destroyed the bridges along the causeways and dikes connecting Mexico to the mainland. Despite this reinforcements' arrival, the situation did not improve. Every day brought new battles, and sorties were necessary to clear the paths to the palace occupied by the Spaniards.
Cortès now saw but too plainly the mistake which he had made in shutting himself up in a town where his position might be stormed at any moment, and from which it was so difficult to extricate himself. In this difficulty he had recourse to Montezuma, who, by virtue of his authority and of the prestige which still clung to him, could appease the tumult, give the Spaniards some respite, and enable them to prepare for their retreat. But when the unfortunate emperor, now become a mere toy in the hands of the Spaniards, appeared upon the walls decked out with regal ornaments, and implored his subjects to cease from hostilities, murmurs of discontent arose, and threats were freely uttered. Hostilities began afresh, and before the soldiers had time to protect him with their shields, Montezuma was pierced with arrows, and hit upon the head by a stone which knocked him down. At this sight the Indians, horrified at the crime which they had just committed, at once ceased fighting, and fled in all directions, while the emperor, understanding but too late all the baseness of the part which Cortès had forced him to play, tore off the bandages which had been applied to his wounds, and refusing all nourishment, he died cursing the Spaniards.
Cortès now clearly realized the mistake he had made by locking himself in a town that could be attacked at any moment and was so hard to escape from. In this trouble, he turned to Montezuma, who, because of his authority and the respect he still had, could calm the chaos, give the Spaniards some time to breathe, and help them prepare to retreat. But when the unfortunate emperor, now just a pawn in the hands of the Spaniards, appeared on the walls wearing royal attire and begged his people to stop fighting, murmurs of discontent arose, and threats were thrown around. Hostilities resumed, and before the soldiers could shield him, Montezuma was shot by arrows and struck on the head by a stone, which knocked him down. At this sight, the Indians, horrified by the crime they had just committed, immediately stopped fighting and fled in every direction. Meanwhile, the emperor, realizing too late all the treachery in the role Cortès had forced him to play, ripped off the bandages from his wounds and, refusing all food, died cursing the Spaniards.
![]() |
Death of Montezuma. |
After so fatal an event, there was no more room to hope for peace with the Mexicans, and it became necessary to retire in haste, and at whatever cost, from a town in which the Spaniards were threatened with blockade and starvation. For this retreat Cortès was preparing in secret. He saw his troops each day more and more closely hemmed in, whilst several times he was forced himself to take his sword in his hand and to fight like a common soldier. Solis even relates, but upon what authority is not known, that during an assault which was made upon one of the edifices commanding the Spanish quarter, two young Mexicans, recognizing Cortès, who was cheering on his soldiers, resolved to sacrifice themselves in the hope of killing the man who had been the author of their country's calamities. They approached him in a suppliant attitude, as though they would ask for quarter, then seizing him round the waist they dragged him towards the battlements, over which they threw themselves, hoping to drag him over with them. But thanks to his exceptional strength and agility Cortès managed to escape from their embrace, and these two brave Mexicans perished in their generous but vain attempt to save their country.
After such a deadly event, there was no longer any hope for peace with the Mexicans, and it became necessary to retreat quickly, at any cost, from a town where the Spaniards faced the threat of blockade and starvation. Cortès was secretly preparing for this retreat. He noticed his troops getting more and more surrounded each day, and several times he had to take up his sword and fight like an ordinary soldier. Solis even mentions, although it's unclear on what basis, that during an attack on one of the buildings overlooking the Spanish quarter, two young Mexicans recognized Cortès, who was encouraging his soldiers, and decided to sacrifice themselves in hopes of killing the man who had caused their country's suffering. They approached him in a pleading manner, as if asking for mercy, then seized him around the waist and dragged him toward the battlements, over which they jumped, hoping to take him with them. But thanks to his incredible strength and agility, Cortès managed to break free from their grip, and these two courageous Mexicans lost their lives in their noble but futile attempt to save their country.
The retreat being determined upon, it was necessary to decide upon whether it should be carried out by night or by day. If in the daytime the enemy would be more easily resisted, any ambuscades which might be prepared would be more easily avoided, while they could better take precautions to repair any bridges broken by the Mexicans. On the other hand, it was known that the Indians will seldom attack an enemy after sunset, but what really decided Cortès in favour of a nocturnal retreat was, that a soldier who dabbled in astrology had declared to his comrades that success was certain if they acted in the night.
The decision to retreat was made, and it was necessary to choose whether to do it at night or during the day. If they retreated during the day, the enemy would be easier to fight off, they could avoid any ambushes that might be set, and they could better make repairs to any bridges that the Mexicans had damaged. On the other hand, it was known that the Indians rarely attacked after dark, but what really convinced Cortès to go for a nighttime retreat was that a soldier who was into astrology told his comrades that they would definitely succeed if they acted at night.
They therefore began their march at midnight. Besides the Spanish troops, Cortès had under his orders detachments from Tlascala, Zempoalla, and Cholula, which, notwithstanding the serious losses which had been sustained, still numbered 7000 men. Sandoval commanded the vanguard, and Cortès the centre, where were the cannon, baggage, and prisoners, amongst whom were a son and two daughters of Montezuma; Alvarado and Velasquez de Léon led the rearguard. With the army was carried a flying bridge, which had been constructed to throw over any gaps there might be in the causeway. Scarcely had the Spaniards debouched upon the dike leading to Tacuba, which was the shortest of all, when they were attacked in front, flank, and rear by solid masses of the enemy, whilst from a fleet of numberless canoes, a perfect hailstorm of stones and missiles fell upon them. Blinded and amazed, the allies knew not against whom to defend themselves first. The wooden bridge sank under the weight of the artillery and fighting men. Crowded together upon a narrow causeway where they could not use their fire-arms, deprived of their cavalry who had not room to act, mingled with the Indians in a hand-to-hand combat, not having strength to kill, and surrounded on all sides, the Spaniards and their allies gave way under the ever renewed numbers of the assailants. Officers and soldiers, infantry and cavalry, Spaniards and Tlascalans were confounded together, each defended himself to the best of his ability, without caring about discipline or the common safety.
They started their march at midnight. In addition to the Spanish troops, Cortès had detachments from Tlascala, Zempoalla, and Cholula, which, despite the serious losses they had suffered, still numbered 7,000 men. Sandoval led the vanguard, with Cortès in the center, where the cannons, baggage, and prisoners were, including a son and two daughters of Montezuma. Alvarado and Velasquez de Léon commanded the rearguard. The army was equipped with a portable bridge that had been built to cross any gaps in the causeway. As soon as the Spaniards emerged onto the dike leading to Tacuba, the shortest route, they were attacked from the front, sides, and rear by large groups of the enemy, while a fleet of countless canoes bombarded them with a storm of stones and projectiles. Dazed and confused, the allies didn't know whom to defend against first. The wooden bridge couldn't hold the weight of the artillery and soldiers. Packed together on a narrow causeway where they couldn’t use their firearms, deprived of their cavalry which had no space to maneuver, and caught in close combat with the Indians, they lacked the strength to fight back. Surrounded on all sides, the Spaniards and their allies began to give way under the relentless waves of attackers. Officers and soldiers, infantry and cavalry, Spaniards and Tlascalans were mixed up together, each defending themselves as best they could, ignoring discipline or the safety of the group.
All seemed lost, when Cortès with one hundred men succeeded in crossing the breach in the dike upon the mass of corpses which filled it up. He drew up his soldiers in order as they arrived, and putting himself at the head of those least severely wounded, plunged wedge-fashion into the mêlée, and succeeded in disengaging from it a portion of his men. Before day dawned all those who had succeeded in escaping from the massacre of the noche triste, as this terrible night was called, found themselves reunited at Tacuba. It was with eyes full of tears that Cortès passed in review his remaining soldiers, all covered with wounds, and took account of the losses which he had sustained; 4000 Indians, Tlascalans, and Cholulans, and nearly all the horses were killed, all the artillery and ammunition, as well as the greatest part of the baggage, were lost, and amongst the dead were several officers of distinction—Velasquez de Léon, Salcedo, Morla, Larès, and many others; one of those most dangerously hurt was Alvarado, but not one man, whether officer or soldier, was without a wound.
All seemed lost when Cortés, with a hundred men, managed to cross the breach in the dike over the pile of corpses filling it. He organized his soldiers as they arrived and, placing himself at the front with those who were least injured, charged into the fight and managed to pull out some of his men. By dawn, all those who had escaped the massacre of the noche triste, as this dreadful night was called, found themselves regrouped at Tacuba. With tears in his eyes, Cortés reviewed his remaining soldiers, all battered and covered in wounds, and assessed the losses he had suffered: 4,000 Indians, Tlaxcalans, and Cholulans were dead, nearly all the horses were killed, all the artillery and ammunition were lost, and most of the baggage was gone. Among the dead were several notable officers—Velasquez de León, Salcedo, Morla, Larès, and many others. One of the most severely injured was Alvarado, but not a single man, whether officer or soldier, was without a wound.
The fugitives did not delay at Tacuba, and by accident they took the road to Tlascala, where they did not know what reception might await them. Ever harassed by the Mexicans, the Spaniards were again obliged to give battle upon the plains of Otumba to a number of warriors, whom some historians reckon at two hundred thousand. Thanks to the presence of some cavalry soldiers who still remained to him, Cortès was able to overthrow all who were in front of him, and to reach a troop of persons whose high rank was easily discerned by their gilded plumes and luxurious costumes, amongst whom was the general bearing the standard. Accompanied by some horsemen, Cortès threw himself upon this group and was fortunate enough, or skilful enough, to overturn by a lance-thrust the Mexican general, who was then despatched by the sword by a soldier named Juan de Salamanca. From the moment when the standard disappeared the battle was gained, and the Mexicans, panic-stricken, fled hastily from the field of battle. "Never had the Spaniards incurred greater danger," says Prescott, "and had it not been for the lucky star of Cortès, not one would have survived to transmit to posterity the history of the sanguinary battle of Otumba." The booty was considerable, and sufficed in part, to indemnify the Spaniards for the loss they had sustained in leaving Mexico, for this army which they had just defeated was composed of the principal warriors of the nation, who, having been quite confident of success, had adorned themselves with their richest ornaments.
The fugitives didn’t stop in Tacuba and accidentally took the road to Tlascala, unsure of what kind of welcome they might receive. Constantly pursued by the Mexicans, the Spaniards had to fight again on the plains of Otumba against countless warriors, some historians estimating their number at two hundred thousand. Thanks to the few cavalry soldiers still with him, Cortès managed to defeat everyone in front of him and reached a group of people distinguished by their golden plumes and luxurious clothes, among whom was the general carrying the standard. Joined by some horsemen, Cortès charged at this group and was either lucky or skilled enough to strike down the Mexican general with a lance, after which a soldier named Juan de Salamanca finished him off with a sword. Once the standard was lost, the battle was won, and the Mexicans, filled with panic, quickly fled the battlefield. "The Spaniards had never faced greater danger," says Prescott, "and if it weren't for Cortès's fortunate star, none would have survived to tell the tale of the bloody battle of Otumba." The spoils were significant, helping to partly compensate the Spaniards for their losses in leaving Mexico, as this defeated army had been made up of the nation's top warriors who, feeling confident of victory, had adorned themselves in their finest gear.
![]() |
Cortès at the Battle of Otumba. |
The day after the battle the Spaniards entered the territory of Tlascala. Bernal Diaz says, "I shall now call the attention of curious readers to the fact that when we returned to Mexico to the relief of Alvarado, we were in all 1300 men, including in that number ninety-seven horsemen, eighty cross-bowmen, and the same number armed with carbines; besides, we had more than 2000 Tlascalans, and much artillery. Our second entry into Mexico took place on St. John's Day, 1520; our flight from the city was on the 10th day of the month of July following, and we fought the memorable battle of Otumba on the 14th day of this same month of July. And now I would draw attention to the number of men who were killed at Mexico during the passage of the causeways and bridges, in the battle of Otumba, and in the other encounters upon the route. I declare that in the space of five days 860 of our men were massacred, including ten of our soldiers and five Castilian women, who were killed in the village of Rustepèque; we lost besides 1200 Tlascalans during the same time. It is to be noticed also that if the number of dead in the troop of Narvaez were greater than in the troop of Cortès, it was because the former soldiers set out on the march laden with a quantity of gold, the weight of which hindered them from swimming, and from getting out of the trenches."
The day after the battle, the Spaniards entered the territory of Tlascala. Bernal Diaz states, "I want to point out to curious readers that when we returned to Mexico to support Alvarado, we numbered 1300 men in total, which included ninety-seven cavalry, eighty crossbowmen, and the same number armed with rifles; additionally, we had over 2000 Tlascalans and a lot of artillery. Our second entry into Mexico happened on St. John's Day, 1520; we fled the city on July 10 of the following month, and we fought the notable battle of Otumba on July 14 of that same month. I want to highlight the number of men who were killed during our crossing of the causeways and bridges, in the battle of Otumba, and in the other skirmishes along the way. I declare that within five days, 860 of our men were killed, including ten of our soldiers and five Castilian women who were murdered in the village of Rustepèque; we also lost 1200 Tlascalans during that time. It should be noted that if the number of dead in Narvaez's group was higher than in Cortès's group, it was because the former soldiers embarked on the march burdened with a lot of gold, the weight of which prevented them from swimming and escaping from the trenches."
The troops with Cortès were reduced to four hundred and forty men, with twenty horses, twelve cross-bowmen, and seven carabineers; they had not a single charge of gunpowder, they were all wounded, lame, or maimed in the arms. It was the same number of men that had followed Cortès when he first entered Mexico, but how great a difference was there between that conquering troop, and the vanquished soldiers who now quitted the capital.
The troops with Cortès were down to four hundred and forty men, with twenty horses, twelve crossbowmen, and seven carabineers; they didn't have a single charge of gunpowder, and they were all wounded, limping, or injured in the arms. It was the same number of men that had followed Cortès when he first entered Mexico, but what a huge difference there was between that conquering group and the defeated soldiers who were now leaving the capital.
As they entered the Tlascalan territory Cortès recommended his men, and especially those of Narvaez, not to do anything which could vex the natives, the common safety depending upon not irritating the only allies which remained to them. Happily the fears which had arisen as to the fidelity of the Tlascalans proved groundless. They gave the Spaniards a most sympathizing welcome, and their thoughts seemed to be wholly bent upon avenging the death of their brothers massacred by the Mexicans. While in their capital Cortès heard of the loss of two more detachments, but these reverses, grave as they were, did not discourage him; he had under his orders troops inured to war and faithful allies, Vera-Cruz was intact, he might once more reckon upon his good fortune. But before undertaking a new campaign or entering upon another siege, help must be sought and preparations made, and with these objects in view the general set to work. He sent four ships to Hispaniola to enrol volunteers and purchase powder and ammunition, and meanwhile he caused trees to be cut down in the mountains of Tlascala, and with the wood thus obtained twelve brigantines were constructed, which were to be carried in pieces to the Lake of Mexico, to be launched there at the moment when needed.
As they entered the Tlascalan territory, Cortés advised his men, especially those under Narvaez, not to do anything that might upset the locals, since their safety depended on not irritating their remaining allies. Fortunately, the concerns about the loyalty of the Tlascalans turned out to be unfounded. They welcomed the Spaniards warmly, focused entirely on avenging the deaths of their brothers who had been massacred by the Mexicans. While in their capital, Cortés learned about the loss of two more detachments, but these setbacks, as serious as they were, did not discourage him; he had troops seasoned in battle and loyal allies, Vera-Cruz was still secure, and he could rely once again on his good fortune. However, before launching a new campaign or starting another siege, he needed to seek assistance and make preparations, so the general got to work. He sent four ships to Hispaniola to recruit volunteers and buy gunpowder and ammunition while arranging for trees to be cut down in the Tlaxcala mountains. With the wood gathered, they constructed twelve brigantines, which were to be taken in pieces to the Lake of Mexico and launched at the right moment.
After suppressing some attempts at mutiny amongst the soldiers, in which those who had come with Narvaez were the most to blame, Cortès again marched forwards, and, with the help of the Tlascalans, first attacked the people of Tepeaca and of other neighbouring provinces, a measure which had the advantage of exercising anew his own troops in war, and of training his allies. While this was going on, two brigantines bringing ammunition and reinforcements fell into the hands of Cortès; these ships had been sent to Narvaez by Velasquez, in ignorance of his misadventures; at this time also some Spaniards sent by Francis de Garay, governor of Jamaica, joined the army. In consequence of these reinforcements the troops with Cortès, after he had rid himself of several partisans of Narvaez with whom he was dissatisfied, amounted to five hundred infantry, of whom eighty carried muskets, and forty horse-soldiers. With this small army, and with one thousand Tlascalans, Cortès set out once more for Mexico on the 28th of December, 1520, six months after he had been forced to abandon the city. This campaign had for its theatre countries already described, and must therefore be passed over somewhat rapidly here, notwithstanding the interest attaching to it; to enter fully into the history of the conquest of Mexico would not be in accordance with the primary object of this work.
After quelling some mutiny attempts among the soldiers, particularly those who had joined Narvaez, Cortès moved forward again. With the help of the Tlascalans, he first attacked the people of Tepeaca and other nearby provinces. This strategy not only re-trained his troops in warfare but also prepared his allies. During this time, Cortès seized two brigantines carrying ammunition and reinforcements. These ships had been sent to Narvaez by Velasquez, who was unaware of Narvaez's troubles. Additionally, some Spaniards sent by Francis de Garay, the governor of Jamaica, joined the army. Thanks to these reinforcements and after removing several of Narvaez's supporters he was unhappy with, Cortès's forces grew to five hundred infantry—eighty of whom had muskets—and forty cavalry. With this small army and one thousand Tlascalans, Cortès set out for Mexico again on December 28, 1520, six months after he had been forced to leave the city. This campaign took place in areas already described and will be summarized quickly here, despite its significance; a detailed account of the conquest of Mexico wouldn't align with the main purpose of this work.
After the death of Montezuma his brother Quetlavaca was raised to the throne, and he adopted all the measures of precaution compatible with Aztec strategic science. But he died of the smallpox, the sad gift of the Spaniards to the New World, at the very moment when his brilliant qualities of foresight and bravery were the most needed by his country. His successor was Guatimozin, the nephew of Montezuma, a man distinguished by his talents and courage.
After Montezuma's death, his brother Quetlavaca took the throne and implemented all the precautionary measures aligned with Aztec military strategy. However, he died from smallpox, the tragic consequence of the Spaniards' arrival in the New World, just when his exceptional foresight and bravery were desperately needed by his people. His successor was Guatimozin, Montezuma's nephew, a man known for his skills and bravery.
Cortès had no sooner entered the Mexican territory than fighting began. He speedily captured the town of Tezcuco, which was situated at twenty miles' distance, upon the edge of the great central lake, that lake upon whose waters the Spaniards were to see an imposing flotilla floating three months later. At this time a fresh conspiracy, which had for its object the assassination of Cortès and his principal officers, was discovered, and the chief culprit executed. At this moment fate seemed in every way to smile upon Cortès; he had just received the news of the arrival of fresh reinforcements at Vera-Cruz, and the greater part of the towns under the dominion of Guatimozin had submitted to the force of his arms. The actual siege of Mexico began in the month of May, 1521, and continued with alternate success and reverse until the day when the brigantines were launched upon the water of the lake. The Mexicans did not hesitate to attack them; from four to five thousand canoes, each bearing two men, covered the lake and advanced to the assault of the Spanish vessels, which carried in all nearly three hundred men. These nine brigantines were provided with cannon, and soon dispersed or sunk the enemy's fleet, who thenceforth left them in undisputed possession of the water. But this success and certain other advantages gained by Cortès had no very marked consequences, and the siege dragged slowly on, until the general made up his mind to capture the town by force. Unfortunately the officer who was charged with protecting the line of retreat by the causeways while the Spaniards were making their way into the town, abandoned his post, thinking it unworthy of his valour, and went to join in the combat. Guatimozin was informed of the fault which had been committed, and at once took advantage of it. His troops attacked the Spaniards on all sides with such fury that numbers of them were killed in a short time, while sixty-two of the soldiers fell alive into the hands of the Mexicans, a fate which Cortès, who was severely wounded in the thigh, narrowly escaped sharing. During the night following, the great temple of the war-god was illuminated in sign of triumph, and the Spaniards listened in profound sadness to the beating of the great drum. From the position they occupied they could witness the end of the prisoners, their unfortunate countrymen, whose breasts were opened and their hearts torn out, and whose dead bodies were hurled down the steps; they were then torn in pieces by the Aztecs, who quarrelled over the pieces with the object of using them for a horrible festival.
Cortès had barely entered Mexican territory when fighting began. He quickly took over the town of Tezcuco, located twenty miles away, right at the edge of the great central lake, where the Spaniards would see an impressive flotilla three months later. At this time, a new conspiracy aimed at assassinating Cortès and his key officers was uncovered, leading to the execution of the main culprit. Fate seemed to favor Cortès; he had just heard news of fresh reinforcements arriving at Vera-Cruz, and most of the towns under Guatimozin's control had surrendered to his forces. The actual siege of Mexico started in May 1521 and continued with mixed successes and setbacks until the day the brigantines were launched onto the lake. The Mexicans didn't hesitate to attack them; four to five thousand canoes, each carrying two men, covered the lake and advanced against the Spanish ships, which had nearly three hundred men onboard. These nine brigantines were armed with cannons, and soon scattered or sank the enemy's fleet, which then left them in control of the water. However, this victory and some other advantages gained by Cortès didn’t produce significant results, and the siege dragged on until the general decided to take the town by force. Unfortunately, the officer tasked with securing the retreat line along the causeways abandoned his post, thinking it was beneath his courage, and joined the battle. Guatimozin learned of this mistake and immediately exploited it. His troops attacked the Spaniards from all sides with such intensity that many were killed quickly, and sixty-two soldiers were captured alive by the Mexicans, a fate that Cortès, who was severely wounded in the thigh, narrowly avoided. The night after, the great temple of the war-god was lit up in a sign of triumph, and the Spaniards listened in deep sadness to the sound of the large drum. From their position, they watched the fate of the prisoners, their unfortunate countrymen, whose chests were opened and hearts ripped out, with their dead bodies thrown down the steps; these were then torn apart by the Aztecs, who fought over the pieces for a gruesome festival.
This terrible defeat caused the siege to go on slowly, until the day came when three parts of the city having been taken or destroyed, Guatimozin was obliged by his councillors to quit Mexico and to set out for the mainland, where he reckoned upon organizing his resistance, but the boat which carried him being seized he was made prisoner. In his captivity he was destined to display much greater dignity and strength of character than his uncle Montezuma had done. From this time all resistance ceased, and Cortès might take possession of the half-destroyed capital. After a heroic resistance, in which 120,000 Mexicans according to some accounts, but 240,000 according to others, had perished, after a siege which had lasted not less than seventy days, Mexico, and with the city all the rest of the empire, succumbed, less indeed to the blows dealt against it by the Spaniards than to the long-standing hatred and the revolts of the subjugated people, and to the jealousy of the neighbouring states, fated soon to regret the yoke which they had so deliberately shaken off.
This disastrous defeat caused the siege to drag on until the day came when three-quarters of the city had been taken or destroyed. Guatimozin was pressured by his advisors to leave Mexico and head for the mainland, where he planned to regroup and organize his resistance. However, the boat that was carrying him was captured, and he was made a prisoner. During his captivity, he showed much more dignity and strength of character than his uncle Montezuma had. From that point on, all resistance ended, and Cortès was able to take control of the half-destroyed capital. After a heroic struggle in which some accounts say 120,000 Mexicans perished, while others claim the number was 240,000, and after a siege that lasted at least seventy days, Mexico, along with the rest of the empire, fell. It succumbed not only to the assaults from the Spaniards but also due to the long-standing animosity and revolts of the oppressed people, along with the jealousy of neighboring states, who would soon regret the oppression they had willingly thrown off.
Contempt and rage soon succeeded amongst the Spaniards to the intoxication of success; the immense riches upon which they had reckoned either had no existence, or they had been thrown into the lake. Cortès found it impossible to calm the malcontents, and was obliged to allow the emperor and his principal minister to be put to the torture. Some historians, and notably Gomara, report that whilst the Spaniards were stirring the fire which burnt below the gridiron upon which the two victims were extended, the minister turned his head towards his master and apparently begged him to speak, in order to put an end to their tortures; but that Guatimozin reproved this single moment of weakness by these words, "And I, am I assisting at some pleasure, or am I in the bath?" an answer which has been poetically changed into, "And I, do I lie upon roses?"
Contempt and anger quickly replaced the excitement of victory among the Spaniards; the vast wealth they had expected was either non-existent or had been tossed into the lake. Cortès found it impossible to calm the dissenters, and he was forced to allow the emperor and his chief minister to be tortured. Some historians, particularly Gomara, report that as the Spaniards stoked the fire beneath the grill on which the two victims lay, the minister turned his head toward his master and seemingly pleaded with him to speak, hoping to end their suffering; but Guatimozin chastised this moment of weakness with the words, "Am I here for pleasure, or am I in a bath?"—a response that has been poetically transformed into, "Am I lying on roses?"
![]() |
The Spaniards stir the fire burning below the gridiron. |
The historians of the conquest of Mexico have usually stopped short at the taking of Mexico, but it remains for us to speak of some other expeditions undertaken by Cortès with different aims, but which resulted in casting quite a new light upon some portions of Central America; besides we could not leave this hero, who played so large a part in the history of the New World and in the development of its civilization, without giving some details of the end of his life.
The historians of the conquest of Mexico have typically focused on the fall of Mexico City, but we need to discuss some other expeditions led by Cortés with different goals that shed new light on parts of Central America. Additionally, we can't overlook this hero, who played such a significant role in the history of the New World and the development of its civilization, without sharing some details about the end of his life.
With the fall of the capital was involved, properly speaking, that of the Mexican empire; if there were still some resistance, as notably there was in the province of Oaxaca, it was of an isolated character, and a few detachments of troops sufficed to reduce to submission the last remaining opponents of the Spaniards, terrified as the Mexicans were by the punishments which had been dealt out to the people of Panuco, who had revolted. At the same time ambassadors were sent by the people of the distant countries of the empire, to convince themselves of the reality of that wonderful event, the taking of Mexico, to behold the ruins of the abhorred town, and to tender their submission to the conquerors.
With the fall of the capital came the end of the Mexican empire. Although there was still some resistance, particularly in the province of Oaxaca, it was isolated, and a few military detachments were enough to bring the last remaining opponents of the Spaniards to their knees. The Mexicans were terrified by the punishments previously inflicted on the people of Panuco, who had revolted. At the same time, ambassadors from distant parts of the empire were sent to verify the reality of the astonishing event—the capture of Mexico. They came to see the ruins of the hated city and to offer their submission to the conquerors.
Cortès was at length confirmed in the position he held after incidents which would take too long to relate, and which caused him to say, "It has been harder for me to fight against my countrymen than against the Aztecs." It now remained to him to organize the conquered country, and he began by establishing the seat of government at Mexico, which he rebuilt. He attracted Spaniards to the city by granting them concessions of lands, and the Indians, by allowing them at first to remain under the authority of their native chiefs, although he speedily reduced them all, except the Tlascalans, to the condition of slaves, by the vicious system of repartimientos, in vogue in the Spanish colonies. But if it is justifiable to reproach Cortès with having held cheaply the political rights of the Indians, it must be conceded that he manifested the most laudable solicitude for their spiritual well-being. To further this object he brought over some Franciscans, who by their zeal and charity in a short time gained the veneration of the natives, and in a space of twenty years brought about the conversion of the whole population.
Cortès was finally confirmed in his position after incidents that would take too long to explain, leading him to say, "It’s been harder for me to fight against my fellow countrymen than against the Aztecs." Now, he needed to organize the conquered territory, starting by establishing the government seat in Mexico, which he rebuilt. He drew Spaniards to the city by granting them land concessions and allowed the Indians to initially remain under their native chiefs’ authority, although he quickly reduced all of them, except for the Tlascalans, to a state of slavery through the abusive system of repartimientos that was common in the Spanish colonies. While it’s fair to criticize Cortès for disregarding the political rights of the Indians, it's also true that he showed great concern for their spiritual welfare. To support this goal, he brought over some Franciscans, who, through their dedication and kindness, quickly earned the respect of the natives and helped convert the entire population within twenty years.
At the same time Cortès sent some troops into the state of Mechoacan, who penetrated as far as the Pacific Ocean, and as they returned visited some of the rich provinces situated in the north. Cortès founded settlements in all the parts of the country which appeared to him advantageous: at Zacatula upon the shores of the Pacific, at Coliman in Mechoacan, at Santesteban near Tampico, at Medellin near Vera-Cruz, &c.
At the same time, Cortès sent some troops into the state of Michoacán, who traveled all the way to the Pacific Ocean, and on their way back, they explored some of the wealthy provinces located in the north. Cortès established settlements in all the areas of the country that seemed beneficial to him: in Zacatula on the Pacific coast, in Colima in Michoacán, in Santesteban near Tampico, in Medellín near Veracruz, etc.
Immediately after the pacification of the country, Cortès entrusted Christoval de Olid with the command of a considerable force, in order to establish a colony in Honduras, and at the same time Olid was to explore the southern coast of that province, and to seek for a strait which should form a communication between the Atlantic and Pacific Oceans. But, carried away by the pride of command, Olid had no sooner reached his destination than he declared himself independent, whereupon Cortès immediately despatched one of his relations to arrest the culprit, and set out himself, accompanied by Guatimozin, at the head of one hundred horsemen and fifty foot-soldiers, on the 12th of October, 1524. After crossing the provinces of Goatzacoalco, Tabasco, and Yucatan, and enduring all kinds of privations in the course of a most trying march over marshy and shifting ground, and across a perfect ocean of undulating forests, the detachment was approaching the province of Aculan, when Cortès was told of the existence of a plot, formed, as was said, by Guatimozin and the principal Indian chiefs. Its aim was to seize the first opportunity to massacre both officers and soldiers, after which the march to Honduras was to be continued, the settlements were to be destroyed, and then there was to be a return to Mexico, where during a general rising there would doubtless be small difficulty experienced in getting rid of the invaders. Guatimozin in vain protested his innocence, in which there is every reason to believe; he was hung, as well as several of the Aztec nobles, upon the branches of a Ceyba tree, which shaded the road. Bernal Diaz del Castillo says, "The execution of Guatimozin was very unjust, and we were all agreed in condemning it." But Prescott says, "If Cortès had consulted but his own interest and his renown, he should have spared him, for he was the living trophy of his victory, as a man keeps gold in the lining of his coat."
Immediately after bringing the country under control, Cortès appointed Christoval de Olid to lead a significant force to establish a colony in Honduras. At the same time, Olid was supposed to explore the southern coast of that region and search for a strait that would connect the Atlantic and Pacific Oceans. However, caught up in the pride of his position, Olid quickly declared himself independent upon reaching his destination. In response, Cortès sent one of his relatives to arrest him and set out himself, along with Guatimozin, leading a group of one hundred horsemen and fifty foot soldiers on October 12, 1524. After crossing the provinces of Goatzacoalco, Tabasco, and Yucatan, and enduring various hardships during a difficult march through marshy and shifting ground and a vast expanse of rolling forests, the detachment approached the province of Aculan when Cortès learned of a plot allegedly devised by Guatimozin and the main Indian chiefs. The plan was to seize the first opportunity to massacre both the officers and soldiers, continuing the march to Honduras, destroying the settlements, and then returning to Mexico, where a general uprising would likely make it easy to eliminate the invaders. Guatimozin fervently denied his involvement, and there’s good reason to believe he was innocent; he was hanged, along with several Aztec nobles, from the branches of a Ceyba tree that shaded the road. Bernal Diaz del Castillo stated, "The execution of Guatimozin was very unjust, and we all condemned it." However, Prescott remarked, "If Cortès had considered only his own interest and reputation, he should have spared him, as he was the living trophy of his victory, like a man keeping gold in the lining of his coat."
At length the Spaniards reached Aculan, a flourishing town, where they refreshed themselves after their journey in excellent quarters; when they set out again, it was in the direction of the Lake of Peten, a part of the country where the population was easily converted to Christianity. We shall not dwell upon the sufferings and misery which tried the expedition in these sparsely-peopled countries, until it arrived at San Gil de Buena-Vista, upon the Golfo Dolce, where Cortès, after receiving the news of the execution of Olid and the re-establishment of the central authority, embarked upon his return to Mexico. At this time he entrusted to Alvarado the command of three hundred infantry, one hundred and sixty cavalry, and four cannon, with a body of Indian auxiliaries, with which he set out for the south of Mexico, to conquer Guatemala. He reduced to submission the provinces of Zacatulan, Tehuantepec, Soconusco, Utlatlan, and laid the foundations of the town of Guatemala la Vieja; when, some time afterwards he made a voyage to Spain, he was named by Charles V. governor of the countries which he had conquered.
Finally, the Spaniards arrived at Aculan, a thriving town, where they rested after their journey in comfortable accommodations. When they resumed their journey, they headed toward Lake Peten, a region where the locals were easily converted to Christianity. We won’t dwell on the hardships and suffering faced during the expedition in these sparsely populated areas until they reached San Gil de Buena-Vista, by the Golfo Dolce. There, Cortès, after learning about Olid’s execution and the re-establishment of central authority, prepared to return to Mexico. At this time, he entrusted Alvarado with the command of three hundred infantry, one hundred and sixty cavalry, and four cannons, along with a group of Indian auxiliaries, to head south into Mexico and conquer Guatemala. He subdued the provinces of Zacatulan, Tehuantepec, Soconusco, and Utlatlan, and he laid the groundwork for the town of Guatemala la Vieja. Later, when he traveled to Spain, he was appointed by Charles V as governor of the territories he had conquered.
Three years had not expired after the conquest, before a territory 1200 miles in length upon the sea-board of the Atlantic, and 1500 miles upon that of the Pacific, had submitted to the Castilian crown, and with but few exceptions, was in a state of perfect tranquillity.
Three years had passed since the conquest, and already a territory 1200 miles long along the Atlantic coast and 1500 miles along the Pacific coast had submitted to the Castilian crown, and with only a few exceptions, was in a state of complete peace.
The return of Cortès to Mexico from the useless expedition to Honduras—which had wasted so much time and caused almost as great sufferings to the Spaniards as the conquest of Mexico—had taken place but a few days, when he received the news that he was temporarily replaced by another commander, and was invited to repair to Spain to exculpate himself from certain charges. He was not in any haste to comply with this order, hoping that it might be revoked, but his indefatigable calumniators and his implacable enemies, both in Spain and Mexico, preferred accusations against him after such a manner, that he found himself obliged to go and make his defence, to state his wrongs, and boldly to claim the approval of his conduct. Cortès therefore started accompanied by his friend Sandoval, as well as by Tapia und several Aztec chiefs, amongst whom was a son of Montezuma. He disembarked at Palos, in May, 1528, at the same place where Columbus had landed thirty-five years before, and he was welcomed with the same enthusiasm and rejoicings as the discoverer of America had been; here Cortès met with Pizarro, then at the outset of his career, who was come to solicit the support of the Spanish government. Cortès afterwards set out for Toledo, where the court then was. The mere announcement of his return had produced a complete change in public opinion. His unexpected arrival at once contradicted the idea that he harboured any projects of revolt and independence. Charles V. saw that public feeling would be outraged at the thought of punishing a man who had added its greatest gem to the crown of Castille, and so the journey of Cortès became one continual triumph in the midst of crowds of people greater than had been ever known before. "The houses and streets of the large towns and of the villages," says Prescott, "were filled with spectators impatient to contemplate the hero whose single arm might be said, in some sort, to have conquered an empire for Spain, and who, to borrow the language of an old historian, marched in all the pomp and glory, not of a great vassal, but of an independent monarch."
The return of Cortès to Mexico from the pointless expedition to Honduras—which had wasted so much time and caused almost as much suffering to the Spaniards as the conquest of Mexico—had just happened a few days earlier when he received the news that he was temporarily replaced by another commander and was invited to go to Spain to clear himself of certain charges. He wasn't in a rush to comply with this order, hoping it might be revoked, but his tireless accusers and relentless enemies in both Spain and Mexico made accusations against him in such a way that he felt compelled to go defend himself, explain his wrongs, and confidently claim approval for his actions. Cortès then set out with his friend Sandoval, along with Tapia and several Aztec chiefs, including a son of Montezuma. He landed at Palos in May 1528, the same place where Columbus had arrived thirty-five years earlier, and he was greeted with the same enthusiasm and celebration as the discoverer of America. Here, Cortès met Pizarro, who was just starting his career and had come to seek the support of the Spanish government. Cortès then headed for Toledo, where the court was at the time. The very announcement of his return had completely changed public opinion. His unexpected arrival immediately dispelled any notion that he harbored plans for revolt and independence. Charles V realized that public sentiment would be outraged at the thought of punishing a man who had added such a significant treasure to the crown of Castile, leading to Cortès’s journey becoming a continuous triumph amid larger crowds than had ever been seen before. "The houses and streets of the large towns and villages," says Prescott, "were filled with spectators eager to see the hero whose single efforts might be said, in a way, to have conquered an empire for Spain, and who, to borrow the language of an old historian, marched in all the pomp and glory, not as a great vassal, but as an independent monarch."
Charles V., after having granted several audiences to Cortès, and bestowed upon him those particular marks of favour which are termed important by courtiers, deigned to accept from him the empire which he had conquered for him, and the magnificent presents which he brought. But he considered that he had fully recompensed him when he had given Cortès the title of Marquis della Valle de Oajaca, and the post of captain-general of New Spain, without, however, restoring to him the civil government, a power which had been formerly delegated to him by the junta of Vera-Cruz. Cortès, after his marriage with the niece of the Duke de Béjar, who belonged to one of the first families in Spain, accompanied the emperor, who was on his way to Italy, to the port of embarkation; but the general, soon becoming tired of the frivolities of a court, so little in accordance with the active habits of his past life, set out again for Mexico in 1530, and landed at Villa-Rica. After his arrival he underwent some annoyance caused by the Audienza, which had exercised the power in his absence, and which had instituted law-suits against him, and he also found himself in conflict with the new civil junta on the subject of military affairs. The Marquis della Valle withdrew himself to Cuernavaca, where he had immense estates, and busied himself with agriculture. He was the means of introducing the sugar-cane and the mulberry into Mexico, he also encouraged the cultivation of hemp and flax, and the breeding, on a large scale, of merino sheep.
Charles V, after giving Cortés several meetings and showing him the special favors that courtiers consider important, agreed to accept from him the empire he had conquered for him, along with the impressive gifts he brought. However, he believed he had fully rewarded Cortés by giving him the title of Marquis della Valle de Oajaca and the position of captain-general of New Spain, but he did not restore to him the civil government, a power that had previously been entrusted to him by the junta of Vera-Cruz. After marrying the niece of the Duke de Béjar, who came from one of Spain's leading families, Cortés accompanied the emperor on his journey to Italy to the port of departure. However, the general quickly grew tired of the monarchy's frivolities, which were not in line with his previously active lifestyle, so he set off again for Mexico in 1530 and arrived at Villa-Rica. Upon his arrival, he experienced some trouble from the Audiencia, which had been exercising power in his absence and had filed lawsuits against him, and he also faced conflicts with the new civil junta regarding military matters. The Marquis della Valle retreated to Cuernavaca, where he owned large estates and focused on agriculture. He introduced sugarcane and mulberry to Mexico and promoted the cultivation of hemp and flax, as well as the large-scale breeding of merino sheep.
But this peaceable life without adventures could not long satisfy the enterprising spirit of Cortès. In 1532 and 1533, he equipped two squadrons destined to make voyages of discovery in the north-west of the Pacific. The latter expedition reached the southern extremity of the peninsula of California without attaining the object sought, namely the discovery of a strait uniting the Pacific with the Atlantic. Cortès himself met with no better success in 1536 in the Vermilion Sea (Gulf of California). Three years later a concluding expedition, of which Cortès gave the command to Ulloa, penetrated to the farthest extremity of the gulf, and then, sailing along the exterior side of the peninsula, reached the 29° of north latitude. From thence the chief of the expedition sent back one of his ships to Cortès, while the rest proceeded northwards, but from that time nothing more is heard of them. Such was the unhappy result of the expeditions of Cortès, which, while they did not bring him in a single ducat, cost him not less than 300,000 gold castellanos. But they at least had the result of making known the coast of the Pacific Ocean, from the Bay of Panama as far as Colorado. The tour of the Californian Peninsula was made, and it was thus discovered that what had been imagined to be an island, was in reality a part of the continent. The whole of the Vermilion Sea, or Sea of Cortès, as the Spaniards justly named it, was carefully explored, and it was ascertained that, instead of having an outlet as was supposed to the north, it was in reality only a gulf deeply hollowed into the continent.
But this peaceful life without any adventures couldn’t keep Cortès engaged for long. In 1532 and 1533, he sent out two fleets aimed at exploring the northwestern Pacific. The second expedition reached the southern tip of California but failed to find the strait that was supposed to connect the Pacific to the Atlantic. Cortès himself had no better luck in 1536 in the Vermilion Sea (Gulf of California). Three years later, a final expedition, which Cortès put under Ulloa’s command, made it to the farthest point of the gulf and then sailed along the outer side of the peninsula, reaching 29° north latitude. From there, the leader of the expedition sent one of his ships back to Cortès, while the others continued north, but after that, they were never heard from again. This was the unfortunate outcome of Cortès’s expeditions, which not only didn’t earn him a single ducat but also cost him about 300,000 gold castellanos. At least they revealed the coast of the Pacific Ocean, from the Bay of Panama up to Colorado. The trip around the Californian Peninsula was completed, proving that what had been thought to be an island was actually part of the continent. The entire Vermilion Sea, or Sea of Cortès, as the Spaniards rightly called it, was thoroughly explored, and it was determined that, instead of having an outlet to the north as previously believed, it was actually just a gulf deeply carved into the continent.
Cortès had not been able to fit out these expeditions without coming into antagonism with the viceroy Don Antonio de Mendoza, whom the emperor had sent to Mexico, an appointment which had wounded the feelings of the Marquis della Valle. Wearied with these continual, annoyances, and indignant at finding his prerogative as captain-general, if not absolutely ignored, at least perpetually questioned, Cortès left Mexico, and once more set out for Spain. But this journey was not destined at all to resemble the first. Grown old, disgusted with life, and betrayed by fortune, the "conquistador" had no longer anything to expect from government. He had not to wait long before receiving proof of this; one day he pressed through the crowd which surrounded the emperor's coach, and mounted upon the step of the door. Charles V. pretended not to recognize him, and asked who this man was. Cortès answered proudly, "It is the man who has given you more States than your father left you Towns." By this time public interest was diverted from Mexico, which had not yielded as much as had been expected from it, and was centred upon the marvellous riches of Peru. Cortès was, however, received with honour by the supreme council of the Indies, and permitted to state his complaints before it, but the debates upon the subject were endlessly drawn out, and he could obtain no redress. In 1541, during the disastrous expedition of Charles V. against Algiers, Cortès, who was serving in it as a volunteer, but whose counsels had not been listened to, had the misfortune to lose three great carved emeralds, jewels which would have sufficed for the ransom of an empire. Upon his return he renewed his solicitations, but with the same want of success. His grief over this injustice and these repeated disappointments was so deep, that his health suffered severely; he died far from the scene of his exploits, on the 10th of November, 1547, at Castilleja de la Cuesta, at the very moment when he was making preparations to return to America.
Cortès couldn't organize these expeditions without clashing with the viceroy Don Antonio de Mendoza, whom the emperor had sent to Mexico, a move that upset the Marquis della Valle. Tired of these ongoing frustrations and furious at having his authority as captain-general either ignored or constantly challenged, Cortès left Mexico and set out for Spain again. However, this journey was nothing like the first. Now older, disillusioned with life, and betrayed by fate, the "conquistador" had lost all hope for support from the government. It didn't take long for him to see this reality; one day, he pushed through the crowd around the emperor's coach and stepped up to the door. Charles V. pretended not to recognize him and asked who he was. Cortès replied proudly, "I am the man who has given you more States than your father left you Towns." By this time, public attention had shifted from Mexico, which hadn’t provided as much as expected, to the incredible riches of Peru. Nonetheless, Cortès was honorably received by the supreme council of the Indies, where he was allowed to voice his complaints, but the discussions dragged on endlessly, and he could not get any resolution. In 1541, during Charles V’s disastrous expedition against Algiers, Cortès, who was serving as a volunteer but whose advice went unheeded, unfortunately lost three large carved emeralds, jewels that could have paid the ransom for an empire. After returning, he renewed his requests but with the same lack of success. His sorrow over this injustice and repeated disappointments affected his health greatly; he died far from the scene of his achievements on November 10, 1547, in Castilleja de la Cuesta, just as he was preparing to return to America.
"He was a true knight errant," says Prescott; "of all that glorious troop of adventurers which the Spain of the sixteenth century sent forth to a career of discovery and conquest, there was not one more deeply imbued with the spirit of romantic enterprise than Fernando Cortès. Strife was his delight, and he loved to attempt an enterprise by its most difficult side."...
"He was a true knight-errant," Prescott says; "of all the glorious adventurers that Spain sent out in the sixteenth century for discovery and conquest, none embodied the spirit of romantic adventure more than Fernando Cortès. He thrived on conflict and enjoyed tackling challenges from their most difficult angles."
This passion for the romantic might have reduced the conqueror of Mexico to the part of a common adventurer, but Cortès was certainly a profound politician and a great captain, if one is justified in giving this name to a man who accomplished great actions by his own unassisted genius. There is no other example in history of so great an enterprise having been carried to a successful end with such inadequate means. It may be said with truth that Cortès conquered Mexico with his own resources alone. His influence over the minds of his soldiers was the natural result of their confidence in his ability, but it must be attributed also to his popular manners, which rendered him eminently fit to lead a band of adventurers. When he had attained to a higher rank, if Cortès displayed more of pomp, his veterans at least continued on the same terms of intimacy with him as before. In finishing this portrait of the "conquistador," we shall quote the upright and veracious Bernal Diaz, with whose sentiments we fully agree. "He preferred his name of Cortès to all the titles by which he might be addressed, and he had good reasons for it, for the name of Cortès is as famous in our days as that of Cesar amongst the Romans, or Hannibal amongst the Carthaginians." The old chronicler ends by a touch which vividly depicts the religious spirit of the sixteenth century: "Perhaps he was destined to receive his reward only in a better world, and I fully believe it to be so; for he was an honest knight, very sincere in his devotions to the Virgin, to the Apostle St. Peter, and to all the saints."
This passion for romance might have turned the conqueror of Mexico into just another adventurer, but Cortès was definitely a skilled politician and a great leader, if we can call a man who achieved remarkable feats on his own genius that. There's no other example in history of such a massive undertaking being successfully completed with such limited resources. It's true to say that Cortès conquered Mexico utilizing only his own resources. His influence over his soldiers came from their confidence in his abilities, but it was also due to his approachable nature, which made him particularly suited to lead a group of adventurers. Even after he rose to a higher rank, if Cortès acted more ceremoniously, his veterans still maintained an intimate relationship with him just like before. To finish this portrayal of the "conquistador," we will quote the honest and truthful Bernal Diaz, whose views we wholeheartedly share. "He preferred the name Cortès above all titles by which he could be addressed, and he had good reason for it, as the name Cortès is as well-known today as that of Caesar among the Romans, or Hannibal among the Carthaginians." The old chronicler concludes with a sentiment that vividly captures the religious spirit of the sixteenth century: "Perhaps he was meant to receive his reward only in a better world, and I truly believe that to be the case; for he was an honorable knight, very sincere in his devotions to the Virgin, to the Apostle St. Peter, and to all the saints."
THE CONQUERORS OF CENTRAL AMERICA.
The triple alliance—Francisco Pizarro and his brothers—Don Diego d'Almagro—First attempts—Peru, its extent, people, and kings—Capture of Atahualpa, his ransom and death—Pedro d'Alvarado—Almagro in Chili—Strife among the conquerors—Trial and execution of Almagro—Expeditions of Gonzalo Pizarro and Orellana—Assassination of Francisco Pizarro—Rebellion and execution of his brother Gonzalo.
The triple alliance—Francisco Pizarro and his brothers—Don Diego d'Almagro—Initial attempts—Peru, its size, people, and rulers—Capture of Atahualpa, his ransom, and execution—Pedro d'Alvarado—Almagro in Chile—Conflicts among the conquerors—Trial and execution of Almagro—Expeditions by Gonzalo Pizarro and Orellana—Assassination of Francisco Pizarro—Rebellion and execution of his brother Gonzalo.
The information which had been gained by Balboa as to the riches of the countries situated to the south of Panama had scarcely become known to the Spaniards before several expeditions were organized to attempt the conquest of them. But all had failed, either from the means used being insufficient, or from the commanders not being equal to the greatness of the undertaking. It must be confessed also that the localities explored by these first adventurers—these pioneers, as they would be called now-a-days—did not at all come up to what Spanish greed had expected from them, and for this reason, that all the attempts had been hitherto made upon what was then called "Terra Firma," a country pre-eminently unhealthy, mountainous, marshy, and covered with forests; the inhabitants were few, but of so warlike a disposition that they had added another obstacle to all those which nature had strewn with so prodigal a hand in the path of the invaders. Little by little, therefore, the enthusiasm had cooled, and the wonderful narratives of Balboa were mentioned only to be turned into ridicule.
The information Balboa had gathered about the wealth of the lands south of Panama had barely reached the Spaniards before several expeditions were launched to conquer them. However, all these attempts failed, either because the resources used were insufficient or the leaders weren't capable of handling such a massive challenge. It must be acknowledged that the areas explored by these early adventurers—what we would call pioneers today—didn’t live up to the Spanish expectations of riches. This was largely because all the efforts so far had been directed at what was then called "Terra Firma," a place that was extremely unhealthy, mountainous, swampy, and heavily forested. The local people were few in number but fiercely warlike, adding another hurdle to the many challenges that nature had already placed in front of the invaders. Gradually, the excitement began to fade, and Balboa's incredible stories were only brought up to be mocked.
![]() |
Francisco Pizarro. From an old print. |
There lived, however, in Panama a man well able to weigh the truth of the reports which had been circulated concerning the richness of the countries bathed by the Pacific; this man was Francisco Pizarro, who had accompanied Muñez de Balboa to the southern sea, and who now associated with himself two other adventurers, Diego de Almagro and Ferdinand de Luque. A few words must be said about the chiefs of the enterprise. Francisco Pizarro, born near Truxillo between the years 1471 and 1478, was the natural son of a certain Captain Gonzalo Pizarro, who had taught the boy nothing but to take care of pigs; he was soon tired of this occupation, and took advantage of his having allowed one of the animals who were in his charge to stray, not to return to the paternal roof, where he was accustomed to be cruelly beaten for the smallest peccadillo. The young Pizarro enlisted, and after passing some years amidst the Italian wars, he followed Christopher Columbus to Hispaniola in 1510. He served there with distinction, and also in Cuba; afterwards he accompanied Hojeda to Darien, discovered, as has been already mentioned, the Pacific, with Balboa, and after the execution of the latter, he assisted Pedrarias Davila, whose favourite he had become, in the conquest of all the country known as Castille d'Or.
There was a man in Panama who was well-equipped to assess the truth of the rumors about the wealth of the lands along the Pacific. This man was Francisco Pizarro, who had traveled with Muñez de Balboa to the southern sea, and he teamed up with two other adventurers, Diego de Almagro and Ferdinand de Luque. A few words should be said about the leaders of this venture. Francisco Pizarro, born near Truxillo between 1471 and 1478, was the illegitimate son of Captain Gonzalo Pizarro, who only taught him how to tend pigs. He soon grew tired of this job and, after letting one of the pigs under his care wander off, decided not to go back home, where he would often be harshly punished for the smallest mistakes. Young Pizarro enlisted in the military and, after spending several years in the Italian wars, he followed Christopher Columbus to Hispaniola in 1510. He served there with distinction and also in Cuba; later, he joined Hojeda in Darien, discovered the Pacific with Balboa, and after Balboa's execution, he aided Pedrarias Davila, of whom he had become a favorite, in conquering the region known as Castille d'Or.
While Pizarro was an illegitimate child, Diego de Almagro was a foundling, picked up according to some in 1475 at Aldea del Rey, but according to others at Almagro, from which circumstance, as they maintain, he derived his name. He was educated in the midst of soldiers, and while still young went to America, where he had succeeded in amassing a small fortune.
While Pizarro was an illegitimate child, Diego de Almagro was a foundling, supposedly found in 1475 at Aldea del Rey according to some, but according to others at Almagro, which is said to be the source of his name. He grew up among soldiers and, while still young, went to America, where he managed to accumulate a small fortune.
Ferdinand de Luque was a rich ecclesiastic of Tobago, who exercised the calling of a schoolmaster at Panama. The youngest of these adventurers was by this time more than fifty years of age, and Garcilasso de la Vega relates that upon their project being known, they became the objects of general derision; Ferdinand de Luque was the most laughed at, and was called by no other name than Hernando el Loco, Ferdinand the Fool. The terms of partnership were soon agreed upon between these three men, of whom two at least were without fear, if they were not all three without reproach. Luque furnished money needed for the armament of the vessels and the pay of the soldiers, and Almagro bore an equal part in the expense, but Pizarro, who possessed nothing but his sword, was to pay his contribution in another manner. It was he who took the command of the first attempt, upon which we shall dwell in some detail, because it was then that the perseverance and inflexible obstinacy of the "conquistador" first came fully into sight.
Ferdinand de Luque was a wealthy church official from Tobago who worked as a schoolteacher in Panama. At this point, the youngest of these adventurers was over fifty years old, and Garcilasso de la Vega notes that when their plans became known, they were met with widespread mockery; Ferdinand de Luque was the most ridiculed and was referred to only as Hernando el Loco, or Ferdinand the Fool. The three men quickly agreed on the terms of their partnership, with at least two of them being fearless, if not all three being above reproach. Luque provided the necessary funds for equipping the ships and paying the soldiers, while Almagro shared equally in the expenses. However, Pizarro, who had nothing but his sword, would contribute in a different way. He was the one who took command of the first attempt, which we will discuss in detail because it was during this time that the determination and unyielding stubbornness of the "conquistador" first became evident.
One of the historians of the conquest of Peru, Augustin de Zarate, relates as follows:—"Having then asked and obtained the permission of Pedro Arias d'Avila, Francisco Pizarro after much trouble equipped a vessel upon which he embarked with 140 men. At the distance of 150 miles from Panama he discovered a small and poor province named Peru, which caused the same name to be henceforward improperly bestowed upon all the country which was discovered along that coast for the space of more than 3600 miles in length. Passing onwards he discovered another country, which the Spaniards called the burnt people. The Indians slew so many of his men that he was constrained to retire in great disorder to the country of Chinchama, which is not far distant from the place whence he had started. Almagro, however, who had remained at Panama, fitted out a ship there, upon which he embarked with seventy Spaniards, and descended the coast as far as the River San Juan, 300 miles from Panama. Not having met with Pizarro, he went back northwards as far as the burnt people, where, having ascertained by certain indications that Pizarro had been there, he landed his men. But the Indians, puffed up by the victory which they had gained over Pizarro, resisted bravely, forced the entrenchments with which Almagro had covered his position, and obliged him to re-embark. He returned therefore, still following the coast-line until he arrived at Chinchama, where he found Francisco Pizarro. They were much rejoiced at meeting again, and having added to their followers some fresh soldiers whom they had levied, they found their troops amounted to 200 Spaniards, and once more they descended the coast. They suffered so much from scarcity of provisions and from the attacks of the Indians, that Don Diego returned to Panama to collect more recruits and to obtain provisions. He took back with him eighty men, with whom and with those who remained to them, they went as far as the country called Catamez, a country moderately peopled and where they found abundance of provisions. They noticed that the Indians of these parts who attacked them and made war against them, had their faces studded with nails of gold inserted in holes which they had made expressly for receiving these ornaments. Diego de Almagro returned once again to Panama, whilst his companion waited for him and for the reinforcements which he was to bring with him, in a small island called Cock Island, where he suffered much from the scarcity of all the necessaries of life."
One of the historians of the conquest of Peru, Augustin de Zarate, describes it this way: "After asking for and receiving permission from Pedro Arias d'Avila, Francisco Pizarro, with a lot of effort, fitted out a ship and set sail with 140 men. About 150 miles from Panama, he found a small and impoverished province called Peru, which led to that name being wrongly applied to all the land discovered along that coast, stretching over 3600 miles. Continuing his journey, he discovered another area that the Spaniards referred to as the burnt people. The Indians killed so many of his men that he had to retreat in disorder to the region of Chinchama, not far from where he had started. However, Almagro, who stayed behind in Panama, outfitted a ship and sailed with seventy Spaniards down the coast to the River San Juan, 300 miles from Panama. When he couldn't find Pizarro, he returned north to the burnt people, where he figured out from certain signs that Pizarro had been there, so he landed his men. But the Indians, emboldened by their victory over Pizarro, fiercely resisted, breached the defenses Almagro had set up, and forced him to re-embark. He continued along the coast until he reached Chinchama, where he found Francisco Pizarro. They were very happy to see each other again, and after adding some new soldiers they had recruited, their forces totaled 200 Spaniards, and they moved down the coast once more. They faced severe shortages of food and attacks from the Indians, which made Don Diego go back to Panama to gather more recruits and supplies. He returned with eighty men, and along with those who stayed with him, they reached a place called Catamez, a moderately populated area with plenty of provisions. They observed that the Indians there, who attacked and waged war against them, had faces decorated with gold nails inserted into holes they had made specifically for these ornaments. Diego de Almagro went back to Panama again, while his companion waited for him and the reinforcements he was supposed to bring on a small island called Cock Island, where he suffered greatly from the lack of essential supplies."
![]() |
The Indians kill many of the Spaniards. |
Upon his arrival in Panama, Almagro could not obtain permission from Los Rios, the successor of Avila, to make new levies, for he had no right, Los Rios said, to allow a greater number of people to go and perish uselessly in a rash enterprise; he even sent a boat to Cock Island to bring away Pizarro and his companions. But such a decision could not be pleasing to Almagro and De Luque. It meant expense thrown away; and it meant the annihilation of the hopes which the sight of the ornaments of gold and silver of the inhabitants of Catamez had caused them to entertain. They sent therefore a trusty person to Pizarro, to recommend him to persevere in his resolution, and to refuse to obey the orders of the Governor of Panama. But Pizarro in vain held out the most seductive promises; the remembrance of the fatigues which had been endured was too recent, and all his companions except twelve abandoned him.
Upon his arrival in Panama, Almagro couldn't get permission from Los Rios, Avila's successor, to recruit more people, because Los Rios said he had no right to let more people go and potentially perish in a reckless venture; he even sent a boat to Cock Island to bring back Pizarro and his crew. But this decision was not well received by Almagro and De Luque. It meant wasting resources and crushed the hopes sparked by the gold and silver ornaments seen among the people of Catamez. So, they sent a trusted person to Pizarro to encourage him to stick to his plan and to ignore the Governor of Panama's orders. However, Pizarro’s tempting promises failed to hold any weight; the memory of their recent hardships was too fresh, and all but twelve of his companions deserted him.
With these intrepid men, whose names have been preserved, and amongst whom was Garcia de Xerès, one of the historians of the expedition, Pizarro retired to an uninhabited island at a greater distance from the coast, to which he gave the name of Gorgona. There the Spaniards lived miserably on mangles, fish, and shell-fish, and awaited for five months the succour that Almagro and De Luque were to send them. At length, vanquished by the unanimous protestations of the whole colony,—who were indignant that people whose only crime was that they had not despaired of success, should be left to perish miserably and as though they were malefactors,—Los Rios sent to Pizarro a small vessel to bring him back. With the object of presenting no temptation to Pizarro to make use of this ship to renew his expedition, not a single soldier was placed on board of her. At the sight of the help which had arrived, and oblivious of all their privations, the thirteen adventurers thought of nothing but persuading the sailors who came to seek them to participate in their own hopes. Whereupon, instead of starting again on the route to Panama, they sailed all together, towards the south-east, in spite of contrary winds and currents, until, after having discovered the Island of St. Clara, they arrived at the port of Tumbez, situated beyond the 3° of south latitude, where they saw a magnificent temple and a palace belonging to the Incas, the sovereigns of the country.
With these brave men, whose names have been recorded, including Garcia de Xerès, one of the expedition's historians, Pizarro retreated to an uninhabited island further from the coast, which he named Gorgona. There, the Spaniards lived poorly on mangroves, fish, and shellfish, waiting for five months for help from Almagro and De Luque. Finally, overwhelmed by the strong objections of the entire colony—who were outraged that those who had only tried to remain hopeful should be left to suffer as if they were criminals—Los Rios sent a small vessel to bring Pizarro back. To avoid tempting Pizarro to use this ship to continue his expedition, no soldiers were placed onboard. When they saw the help that had arrived, forgetting their hardships, the thirteen adventurers only thought about convincing the sailors who came to get them to share in their hopes. Instead of heading back to Panama, they all sailed southeast together, despite facing opposing winds and currents, until, after discovering the Island of St. Clara, they reached the port of Tumbez, located beyond 3° south latitude, where they saw a magnificent temple and a palace belonging to the Incas, the rulers of the land.
The country was populous and fairly well-cultivated, but what proved beyond all else seductive to the Spaniards, and made them think that they had reached the marvellous countries of which so much had been said, was the sight of so great an abundance of gold and silver, that these metals were employed not only as finery and ornament by the inhabitants, but also for making vases and common utensils.
The country was densely populated and quite well-farmed, but what really captivated the Spaniards, leading them to believe they had arrived in the amazing lands they had heard so much about, was the incredible amount of gold and silver on display. These metals were used not just for decoration and jewelry by the locals, but also for creating vases and everyday items.
Pizarro caused the interior of the country to be explored by Pietro de Candia and Alonzo de Molina, who brought back an enthusiastic description of it, and he caused some gold vases to be given up to him, as well as some llamas, a quadruped domesticated by the Peruvians. He took two natives on board his vessel, to whom he proposed to teach the Spanish language, and to use them as interpreters when he should return to the country. He anchored successively at Payta, Saugarata, and in the Bay of Santa-Cruz, of which the sovereign, Capillana, received the strangers with such friendly demonstrations, that several of them were unwilling to re-embark. After having sailed down the coast as far as Porto Santo, Pizarro set out on his return to Panama, where he arrived after three whole years spent in dangerous explorations, which had completely ruined De Luque and Almagro.
Pizarro had Pietro de Candia and Alonzo de Molina explore the interior of the country, and they returned with an enthusiastic description of it. He also received some gold vases and llamas, a domesticated animal kept by the Peruvians. He brought two natives onto his ship, intending to teach them Spanish and use them as interpreters when he returned to the region. He anchored at Payta, Saugarata, and in the Bay of Santa Cruz, where the local leader, Capillana, welcomed the strangers so warmly that several of them were reluctant to leave. After sailing down the coast as far as Porto Santo, Pizarro headed back to Panama, where he arrived after three years of dangerous explorations that had completely ruined De Luque and Almagro.
![]() |
Pizarro received by Charles V. |
Pizarro resolved to apply to Charles V. before undertaking the conquest of the country which he had discovered, for he could not obtain leave from Los Rios to engage fresh adventurers; so he borrowed the sum required for the voyage, and in 1528 he went to Spain to inform the emperor of the work which he had undertaken. He painted the picture of the countries that were to be conquered in the most pleasing light, and as a reward for his labours the titles of governor, captain-general, and alguazil-major of Peru were bestowed upon him and his heirs in perpetuity. At the same time he was ennobled, and a pension of 1000 crowns was bestowed upon him. His jurisdiction, independent of the governor of Panama, was to extend over a tract of 600 miles along the coast to the south of the Santiago river; it was to be called New Castille, and he was to be the governor; concessions that cost nothing to Spain, for Pizarro had yet to conquer the country. On his side he undertook to raise a body of 250 men, and to provide himself with the necessary ships, arms, and ammunition. Pizarro then repaired to Truxillo, where he persuaded his three brothers Ferdinand, Juan, and Gonzalo to accompany him, as well as one of his half-brothers Martin d'Alcantara. He took advantage of his stay in his native town, and at Caceres, to try to raise recruits, both there and throughout Estramadura; they did not, however, come forward in large numbers, in spite of the title of Caballeros de la Espado dorada which he promised to bestow upon all who would serve under him. Then he returned to Panama, where affairs were not going so smoothly as he had hoped. He had succeeded in getting De Luque named Bishop protector de los Indios; but for Almagro, whose talents he knew, and whose ambition he feared, he had only asked that he should be ennobled and a gratuity of 500 ducats bestowed upon him, with the government of a fortress which was to be built at Tumbez. Almagro refused to take part in this new expedition; he was not pleased with the meagre portion given to him after spending all his money on the earlier expeditions; he wished now to organize one on his own account. It required all Pizarro's address, aided by the promise to give up to Almagro the office of adelantado, to appease him and make him consent to renew the old partnership.
Pizarro decided to approach Charles V. before starting the conquest of the land he had discovered, since he couldn’t get permission from Los Rios to recruit new adventurers. He borrowed the amount needed for the voyage, and in 1528, he traveled to Spain to inform the emperor about his undertakings. He depicted the countries that were to be conquered in the most favorable light, and as a reward for his efforts, he was granted the titles of governor, captain-general, and chief authority of Peru for himself and his heirs forever. At the same time, he was granted nobility and awarded a pension of 1000 crowns. His jurisdiction, independent of the governor of Panama, would extend over a 600-mile stretch along the coast south of the Santiago River; it was to be named New Castille, with him as the governor—benefits that cost Spain nothing, since Pizarro still had to conquer the territory. He committed to raising a group of 250 men and providing himself with the necessary ships, weapons, and ammunition. Pizarro then went to Truxillo, where he convinced his three brothers Ferdinand, Juan, and Gonzalo, along with one of his half-brothers, Martin d'Alcantara, to join him. During his visit to his hometown and Caceres, he tried to recruit more men, both there and throughout Estramadura; however, not many came forward, despite his promise of the title Caballeros de la Espado dorada to anyone who would serve under him. He then returned to Panama, where things weren’t going as smoothly as he had hoped. He had managed to get De Luque appointed as Bishop protector de los Indios; but for Almagro, whose abilities he recognized and whose ambition he feared, he only requested that he be ennobled and receive a grant of 500 ducats, along with the governorship of a fortress to be built at Tumbez. Almagro refused to participate in this new expedition; he was dissatisfied with the small share offered after having spent all his money on previous expeditions and wanted to organize one on his own. It took all of Pizarro's skill, along with the promise to give Almagro the title of adelantado, to placate him and convince him to renew their old partnership.
![]() |
Map of Peru. |
The resources of the three partners were so limited at this time, that they could only get together three small ships and 124 soldiers, of whom thirty-six were horse-soldiers; the expedition set out in February, 1531, under the command of Pizarro and his four brothers, whilst Almagro remained at Panama to organize an expedition of supplies. At the end of thirteen days' sailing, and after having been carried by a storm 300 miles more to the south than he had intended, Pizarro was forced to disembark both men and horses on the shores of the Bay of San Mateo, and to follow the line of the coast on land. This march was a difficult one in a very mountainous country, thinly-peopled, and intersected by rivers which had to be crossed at their mouths. At last a place called Coaqui was reached, where was found a great booty, which decided Pizarro to send back two of his ships. They carried to Panama and Nicaragua spoils to the amount of 30,000 castellanos, as well as a great number of emeralds, a rich booty, which would, according to Pizarro, determine many adventurers to come and join him.
The three partners had such limited resources at this time that they could only gather three small ships and 124 soldiers, of whom thirty-six were cavalry. The expedition set sail in February 1531, led by Pizarro and his four brothers, while Almagro stayed in Panama to organize a supply mission. After thirteen days of sailing, and being blown 300 miles further south by a storm than he had planned, Pizarro had to land both the men and the horses on the shores of the Bay of San Mateo and follow the coast on foot. This journey was challenging through a mountainous region that was sparsely populated and crossed by rivers that needed to be navigated at their mouths. Eventually, they reached a place called Coaqui, where they found a significant amount of treasure, prompting Pizarro to send two of his ships back. They brought spoils worth 30,000 castellanos to Panama and Nicaragua, along with many emeralds, a valuable haul that would, according to Pizarro, attract many adventurers to join him.
Then the conqueror continued his march southwards as far as Porto-Viejo, where he was joined by Sebastian Benalcazar and Juan Fernandez, who brought him twelve horsemen and thirty foot-soldiers. The effect which had been produced in Mexico by the sight of the horses and the reports of the fire-arms was repeated in Peru, and Pizarro was able to reach the Island of Puna in the Gulf of Guayaquil without encountering any resistance. But the islanders were more numerous and more warlike than their brothers of the mainland, and for six months they valiantly resisted all the attacks of the Spaniards. Although Pizarro had received some aid from Nicaragua, brought by Ferdinand de Soto, and although he had beheaded the cacique Tonalla and sixteen of the principal chiefs, he could not overcome their resistance. He was, therefore, obliged to regain the continent, where the maladies peculiar to the country tried his companions so cruelly, that he was forced to stay three months at Tumbez, exposed to the perpetual attacks of the natives. From Tumbez he went next to the Rio Puira, discovered the harbour of Payta, the best on this coast, and founded the colony of San-Miguel, at the mouth of the Chilo, in order that vessels coming from Panama might find a safe shelter. It was here that Pizarro received some envoys from Huascar, who informed him of the revolt of Atahualpa, the brother of Huascar, and asked his aid.
Then the conqueror continued his march south to Porto-Viejo, where he was joined by Sebastian Benalcazar and Juan Fernandez, who brought him twelve horsemen and thirty foot soldiers. The impact that had been seen in Mexico from the sight of horses and the reports of firearms happened again in Peru, and Pizarro was able to reach the Island of Puna in the Gulf of Guayaquil without facing any resistance. However, the islanders were more numerous and more warlike than their mainland counterparts, and for six months they fiercely resisted all the attacks from the Spaniards. Even though Pizarro had received some support from Nicaragua, delivered by Ferdinand de Soto, and had executed the cacique Tonalla along with sixteen other principal chiefs, he could not break their resistance. Consequently, he had to return to the continent, where the local diseases plagued his companions so severely that he was forced to stay three months at Tumbez, enduring constant attacks from the natives. From Tumbez, he next went to the Rio Puira, discovered the harbor of Payta, the best on this coast, and founded the colony of San-Miguel at the mouth of the Chilo so that ships coming from Panama could find safe shelter. It was here that Pizarro received some envoys from Huascar, who told him about the revolt of Atahualpa, Huascar's brother, and asked for his help.
At the period when the Spaniards landed to conquer Peru, it extended along the shore of the Pacific Ocean for 1500 miles, and stretched into the interior as far as the imposing chain of the Andes. Originally the population was divided into savage and barbarous tribes, having no idea of civilization, and living in a perpetual state of warfare with one another. For many centuries affairs had continued in the same state, and there appeared no presage of the coming of a better era, when, on the shores of Lake Titicaca, there appeared to the Indians a man and woman, who pretended that they were the Children of the Sun. They called themselves Manco-Capac and Mama-Oello, and were of majestic appearance; according to Garcilasso de la Vega, towards the middle of the twelfth century they united together a number of wandering tribes, and laid the foundations of the town of Cuzco. Manco-Capac had taught the men agriculture and mechanical arts, whilst Mama-Oello instructed the women in spinning and weaving. When Manco-Capac had satisfied these first needs of all societies, he framed laws for his subjects, and constituted a regular political state. It was thus that the dominion of the Incas or Lords of Peru was established. At first their empire was limited to the neighbourhood of Cuzco, but under their successors it rapidly increased, and extended from the Tropic of Capricorn to the Pearl Islands, a length of thirty degrees. The power of the incas was as absolute as that of the ancient Asiatic sovereigns. "Also," says Zarate, "there was perhaps no other country in the world where the obedience and submission of the subjects was carried further. The incas were to them quasi-divinities; they had but to place a thread drawn from the royal head-fillet in the hands of any one, and the man so distinguished, was certain to be everywhere respected and obeyed, and to find such absolute deference paid to the king's order which he carried, that he could alone exterminate a whole province without any assistance from soldiers, and cause to be put to death all the inhabitants, both male and female, because at the mere sight of this thread, taken from the royal crown, the people voluntarily and without any resistance, offered themselves up to die." However, the old chroniclers all agree in saying that this unlimited power was always used by the incas for the well-being of their subjects. Out of a series of twelve kings, who in succession sat on the throne of Peru, there was not one who did not leave behind him the memory of a just prince adored by his subjects. Should we not search in vain through the annals of any other country in the world for facts analogous to these? Must it not be regretted that the Spaniards should have brought war with all its attendant horrors, and the maladies and vices of a different climate, along with what they in their pride called civilization, amongst a rich and happy people, whose descendants, impoverished and debased as they are, have not even the recollection of their ancient prosperity to console them in their irremediable decay?
At the time when the Spaniards arrived to conquer Peru, the region extended along the Pacific Ocean for 1,500 miles and reached into the interior as far as the impressive Andes mountain range. The original population was split into savage and barbaric tribes, entirely unaware of civilization, and constantly waging war with one another. For centuries, things remained unchanged, with no sign of a better future, until a man and a woman appeared to the Indians on the shores of Lake Titicaca, claiming to be the Children of the Sun. They identified themselves as Manco-Capac and Mama-Oello, and had an imposing presence; according to Garcilasso de la Vega, they united several wandering tribes and established the town of Cuzco in the mid-12th century. Manco-Capac taught men agriculture and practical skills, while Mama-Oello instructed women in spinning and weaving. Once Manco-Capac addressed these essential needs of society, he created laws for his people and formed a structured political state. This is how the rule of the Incas, or Lords of Peru, began. Initially, their empire was limited to the area around Cuzco, but under their successors, it rapidly grew and spanned from the Tropic of Capricorn to the Pearl Islands, covering thirty degrees in length. The Incas wielded absolute power similar to that of ancient Asian monarchs. "Additionally," says Zarate, "there was likely no other country in the world where the obedience and submission of the subjects went further. The Incas were seen as almost divine; all it took was for someone to hold a thread pulled from the royal headband, and that person would be respected and obeyed everywhere. With this thread, they could execute orders that would lead to the extermination of an entire province without any soldiers, and cause the deaths of all inhabitants—male and female—because the mere sight of this thread from the royal crown would make people surrender themselves without resistance." However, all the old chroniclers agree that this absolute power was consistently used by the Incas for the benefit of their subjects. Among the twelve kings who ruled Peru in succession, not one failed to leave a legacy as a just prince beloved by the people. Shouldn't we search in vain through the history of any other nation for similar accounts? Isn't it tragic that the Spaniards brought war and all its horrors, along with the diseases and vices of a different climate, along with what they arrogantly called civilization, to a rich and happy people, whose descendants, now impoverished and degraded, don't even have the memory of their former prosperity to comfort them in their irreversible decline?
"The Peruvians," says Michelet in his admirable Précis d'Histoire Moderne, "handed down the principal facts to posterity by knots, which they made in ropes. They had obelisks and exact gnomons to mark the equinoxes and solstices. Their year consisted of 365 days. They had erected prodigies of architecture, and they carved statues with amazing art. They formed the most polished and industrious nation of the New World."
"The Peruvians," Michelet says in his admirable Précis d'Histoire Moderne, "passed down important facts to future generations using knots tied in ropes. They had obelisks and precise gnomons to mark the equinoxes and solstices. Their year was made up of 365 days. They built incredible architectural feats and carved statues with remarkable skill. They were the most refined and industrious nation in the New World."
The inca Huayna-Capac, father of Atahualpa, under whom this vast empire was destroyed, had done much to increase and embellish it. This inca, who conquered all the country of Quito, had made, by the hands of his soldiers and of the vanquished people, a great road 1500 miles in length from Cuzco to Quito, across precipices which had been filled up and mountains which had been levelled. Relays of men, stationed at intervals of a mile and a half from each other, carried the emperor's orders throughout the empire. Such was their police, and if we wish to judge of Peruvian magnificence, we need only instance the fact that the king when he travelled was carried on a throne of gold which weighed 25,000 ducats, and the golden litter upon which the throne rested was borne by the highest personages of the realm.
The Inca Huayna Capac, the father of Atahualpa, under whom this vast empire was destroyed, did a lot to expand and beautify it. This Inca, who conquered all of Quito, oversaw the construction of a massive road 1,500 miles long from Cuzco to Quito, made by his soldiers and the defeated people, spanning filled-in cliffs and leveled mountains. Groups of men, stationed every mile and a half, delivered the emperor's orders throughout the empire. That was their system, and if we want to understand Peruvian grandeur, we only need to note that when the king traveled, he was carried on a throne of gold that weighed 25,000 ducats, and the golden litter beneath the throne was carried by the highest-ranking nobles of the realm.
In 1526, when the Spaniards appeared on the coast for the first time, the twelfth inca had lately married—in defiance of the ancient law of the kingdom—the daughter of the vanquished king of Quito, and had had a son of this marriage named Atahualpa, to whom he left this kingdom on his death, which happened about 1529. His eldest son Huascar, whose mother was descended from the incas, had the remainder of his states. But this partition, so contrary to the customs established from time immemorial, caused such great discontent at Cuzco, that Huascar, encouraged by his subjects, determined to march against his brother, who would not acknowledge him for his lord and master. Atahualpa, in his turn, had too lately tasted power to be willing to abandon it. He managed by bribes to attach to himself the greater part of the warriors who had accompanied his father during the conquest of Quito, and when the two armies met, fortune favoured the usurper.
In 1526, when the Spaniards first arrived on the coast, the twelfth Inca had recently married—against the ancient laws of the kingdom—the daughter of the defeated king of Quito, and they had a son named Atahualpa. He inherited this kingdom after his father's death around 1529. His eldest son Huascar, whose mother was from the Inca lineage, received the rest of the states. However, this division, which went against the long-established customs, created significant discontent in Cuzco. Huascar, backed by his supporters, decided to march against his brother, who refused to recognize him as his lord. Atahualpa, having just gained power, was not willing to give it up. He used bribes to win over most of the warriors who had fought alongside his father during the conquest of Quito, and when the two armies faced each other, luck was on the side of the usurper.
Is it not curious to remark how both in Peru and Mexico the Spaniards were aided by entirely exceptional circumstances? In Mexico some of the people who had recently submitted to the Aztec race, being mercilessly trampled upon by their conquerors, welcome the Spaniards as deliverers; in Peru the strife between two brothers, furious against each other, hinders the Indians from turning all their forces against the invaders whom they might easily have crushed.
Isn't it interesting to note how in both Peru and Mexico, the Spaniards had totally unique circumstances working in their favor? In Mexico, some of the people who had recently been conquered by the Aztecs, being ruthlessly oppressed by their conquerors, welcomed the Spaniards as saviors; in Peru, the conflict between two brothers, fiercely battling one another, prevents the Indigenous people from uniting their efforts against the invaders, whom they could have easily defeated.
Pizarro upon receiving the envoys sent by Huascar, to ask his aid against his brother Atahualpa, whom he represented as a rebel and usurper, saw at once all the advantages that might accrue to him from these circumstances. He saw that by espousing the cause of one of the brothers, he could more easily crush them both, therefore he advanced at once into the interior of the country, at the head of a very inconsiderable force, consisting of sixty-two cavalry and one hundred and twenty foot-soldiers, of whom only twenty were armed with arquebuses and muskets; he was obliged to leave part of his troops to guard San-Miguel, in which Pizarro reckoned upon finding a refuge in case of his being unsuccessful, and where in any case all supplies which might arrive could be landed.
Pizarro, after getting the envoys sent by Huascar to ask for his help against his brother Atahualpa, whom he described as a rebel and usurper, immediately recognized all the potential benefits from the situation. He realized that by supporting one of the brothers, he could more easily defeat both of them. So, he moved quickly into the interior of the country, leading a small force of sixty-two cavalry and one hundred and twenty infantry, of which only twenty were armed with arquebuses and muskets. He had to leave some of his troops to guard San Miguel, where Pizarro hoped to find shelter if things went badly, and where any supplies that might come could be unloaded.
Pizarro first made for Caxamalca, a small town situated at about twenty days' march from the coast. To reach it he had to cross a desert of burning sand, without vegetation and without water, which extended for sixty miles in length as far as the province of Motupé, and where the slightest attack of the enemy, joined to the sufferings endured by the little army, would have been sufficient to crush the whole expedition at one blow. Next the troops plunged into the mountains and became entangled in narrow defiles where a small force might have annihilated them. During this march Pizarro received an envoy from Atahualpa bringing him some painted shoes and gold bracelets, which he was requested to wear at his approaching interview with the inca. Naturally Pizarro was lavish in his promises of friendship and devotion, and assured the Indian ambassador that he should be only following the orders given him by the king his master in respecting the lives and property of the inhabitants. From the moment of his arrival at Caxamalca Pizarro prudently lodged his soldiers in a temple and a palace belonging to the inca, where they were sheltered from any surprise. Then he sent one of his brothers with De Soto and twenty horse-soldiers to the camp of Atahualpa, which was distant only three miles, to announce to him his arrival. The envoys of the governor were received with magnificence, and were astonished at the multiplicity of the ornaments and vases made of gold and silver which they saw throughout the Indian camp. They returned, bringing a promise from Atahualpa that he would come on the next day to visit Pizarro, to bid him welcome to his kingdom. At the same time the envoys gave an account of the wonderful riches they had seen, which confirmed Pizarro in the project which he had formed of seizing the unfortunate Atahualpa and his treasures by treachery.
Pizarro first headed to Caxamalca, a small town about twenty days' march from the coast. To get there, he had to cross a desert of scorching sand, devoid of vegetation and water, which stretched for sixty miles to the province of Motupé, where even the slightest enemy attack, combined with the hardships faced by his small army, could have easily crushed the entire expedition. Next, the troops moved into the mountains and got caught in narrow paths where a small force could have wiped them out. During this march, Pizarro received a messenger from Atahualpa who brought him some decorated shoes and gold bracelets, which he was asked to wear at his upcoming meeting with the Inca. Naturally, Pizarro promised friendship and loyalty, assuring the Indian ambassador that he would be following the orders given to him by his king to respect the lives and property of the locals. As soon as he arrived in Caxamalca, Pizarro wisely settled his soldiers in a temple and a palace belonging to the Inca, where they would be safe from any surprise attacks. He then sent one of his brothers with De Soto and twenty cavalry to Atahualpa's camp, which was only three miles away, to announce his arrival. The governor's envoys were welcomed with great ceremony and were amazed by the abundance of gold and silver ornaments and vessels they saw throughout the Indian camp. They returned with a promise from Atahualpa that he would come the next day to welcome Pizarro to his kingdom. At the same time, the envoys reported on the incredible riches they had observed, which reinforced Pizarro’s plan to capture the unfortunate Atahualpa and his treasures through deceit.
Several Spanish authors, and notably Zarate, disguise these facts, which no doubt appeared to them too odious, and altogether deny the treachery towards Atahualpa. But at the present day there are extant many documents which force the historian to believe, with Robertson and Prescott, in the perfidy of Pizarro. It was very important for him to have the inca in his own hands, and to employ him as a tool, just as Cortès had done with Montezuma. He therefore took advantage of the honesty and simplicity of Atahualpa, who placed entire confidence in Pizarro's protestations of friendship and so was thrown off his guard, to arrange an ambuscade into which Atahualpa was certain to fall. There was not a scruple in the disloyal soul of the conqueror; he was as cool as though he were about to offer battle to enemies who had been forewarned of his approach; this infamous treason must be an eternal dishonour to his memory. Pizarro divided his cavalry into three small squadrons, left all his infantry in one body, hid his arquebusiers on the road by which the inca must pass, and kept twenty of his most determined companions near himself. Atahualpa, wishing to give the Spaniards a great idea of his power, advanced with the whole of his army. He himself was borne upon a kind of bed, decorated with feathers, covered with plates of gold and silver, and ornamented with precious stones. He was accompanied by his principal nobles, carried like himself on the shoulders of their servants, and he was surrounded by dancers and jesters. Such a march was more that of a procession than of an army.
Several Spanish writers, especially Zarate, downplay these events, which likely seemed too shameful to them, and completely deny the betrayal of Atahualpa. However, today we have many documents that compel historians to side with Robertson and Prescott regarding Pizarro’s deceit. It was crucial for him to capture the Inca and use him as a pawn, just like Cortés had with Montezuma. He took advantage of Atahualpa's honesty and naivety, who fully trusted Pizarro’s claims of friendship and thus let his guard down, leading to an ambush that Atahualpa was bound to fall into. There was no guilt in the treacherous heart of the conqueror; he was as composed as if he were preparing to battle enemies who had been warned of his approach; this infamous betrayal will forever tarnish his legacy. Pizarro split his cavalry into three small groups, kept all his infantry together, concealed his arquebusiers along the route the Inca would take, and had twenty of his most loyal companions close by. Atahualpa, wanting to impress the Spaniards with his power, advanced with his entire army. He was carried on a sort of bed, adorned with feathers, covered in gold and silver plates, and decorated with jewels. He was accompanied by his top nobles, who were also carried on their servants’ shoulders, and he was surrounded by dancers and jesters. This display felt more like a procession than an army.
As soon as the inca had nearly reached the Spanish quarters (according to Robertson), Father Vincent Valverde, the chaplain of the expedition, who was afterwards made a bishop as a reward for his conduct, advanced with the crucifix in one hand and his breviary in the other. In an interminable discourse he set forth to the monarch the doctrine of the creation, the fall of the first man, the Incarnation, Passion, and Resurrection of our Lord Jesus Christ, the choice made by God of St. Peter to be His vicar upon earth, the power transmitted through him to the Popes, and the gift made by Pope Alexander to the King of Castille of all the regions of the New World. When he had expounded all these doctrines, he called upon Atahualpa to embrace the Christian religion, to recognize the supreme authority of the Pope, and to submit to the King of Castille as his legitimate sovereign. If he submitted immediately, Valverde undertook to promise that the king his master would take Peru under his protection, and allow him to continue to reign there; but he declared war against him and threatened him with fearful vengeance if he refused to obey, and persevered in his impiety.
As the Inca was almost at the Spanish camp (according to Robertson), Father Vincent Valverde, the expedition's chaplain who later became a bishop as a reward for his actions, stepped forward with a crucifix in one hand and a breviary in the other. In a long speech, he explained to the monarch the teachings about creation, the fall of the first man, the Incarnation, Passion, and Resurrection of our Lord Jesus Christ, the choice of St. Peter as God’s representative on Earth, the power passed down to the Popes, and the gift made by Pope Alexander to the King of Castile of all the lands in the New World. After laying out these beliefs, he urged Atahualpa to accept Christianity, recognize the Pope's supreme authority, and acknowledge the King of Castile as his rightful ruler. If he complied right away, Valverde promised that the king would protect Peru and allow him to continue reigning there; however, he threatened war and severe punishment if Atahualpa refused to obey and persisted in his disbelief.
To say the least of it, this was a singular scene and a very strange harangue, alluding to facts which were utterly unknown to the Peruvians, and of the truth of which a more skilful orator than Valverde would not have succeeded in persuading them. If we add that the interpreter knew so little of the Spanish language that it was almost an impossibility for him to translate what he scarcely understood himself, and that the Peruvian language lacked words to express ideas so foreign to its genius, we shall not be much surprised to learn that Atahualpa understood almost nothing of the Spanish monk's discourse. Some sentences, however, which attacked his own power, filled him with surprise and indignation. But he was none the less moderate in his reply. He said that, as master of his own kingdom by right of succession, he could not see how any one had the power to dispose of it without his consent; he added that he was not at all willing to renounce the religion of his fathers to adopt one of which he had only heard that day for the first time; with regard to the other points touched upon in the discourse he understood nothing, it was a thing entirely new to him, and he would much like to know where Valverde had learnt so many wonderful things. "In this book," replied Valverde, handing him his breviary. Atahualpa received it with eagerness and turned over some of the leaves with much curiosity, then, putting it to his ear, he exclaimed, "What you show me there does not speak to me, and tells me nothing." With this he flung the book upon the ground.
To say the least, this was an unusual scene and a very strange speech, referring to facts that were completely unknown to the Peruvians, and that even a more skilled speaker than Valverde wouldn't have been able to convince them of. If we consider that the interpreter knew so little Spanish that it was nearly impossible for him to translate anything he barely understood, and that the Peruvian language didn't have words for such foreign ideas, we won't be surprised to find out that Atahualpa understood almost nothing of the Spanish monk's speech. However, some sentences that challenged his authority filled him with surprise and anger. Still, he responded calmly. He stated that, as the rightful heir to his kingdom, he couldn't see how anyone could take it without his permission; he added that he wasn’t willing to abandon the religion of his ancestors to adopt one he had just heard about that day; concerning the other topics mentioned in the speech, he understood nothing, as it was completely new to him, and he was very interested to know where Valverde had learned so many amazing things. "In this book," Valverde replied, handing him his breviary. Atahualpa took it eagerly and flipped through some of the pages with great curiosity, then, putting it to his ear, exclaimed, "What you show me there doesn’t speak to me and tells me nothing." With that, he threw the book on the ground.
This served as a signal for the combat, or rather for the massacre. Cannon and muskets came into play, the cavalry sprang forward, and the infantry fell sword in hand upon the stupefied Peruvians. In a few moments the confusion was at its height. The Indians fled on all sides, without attempting to defend themselves. As to Atahualpa, although his principal officers tried to make a rampart of their own bodies, while they carried him off, Pizarro sprang upon him, dispersed or overthrew his guards, and seizing him by his long hair, threw him down from the litter in which he was carried. Only the darkness could arrest the carnage. Four thousand Indians were killed, a greater number wounded, and 3000 were taken prisoners. An incontestable proof that there was no real battle is, that of all the Spaniards Pizarro alone was hit, and he received his wound from one of his own soldiers who was too precipitately endeavouring to seize upon the inca.
This was the signal for the fighting, or rather the massacre. Cannons and muskets were fired, the cavalry charged in, and the infantry attacked the stunned Peruvians. Within moments, chaos reigned. The Indians ran in every direction, making no attempt to defend themselves. As for Atahualpa, even though his main officers tried to protect him with their bodies as they carried him away, Pizarro leaped at him, scattered or knocked down his guards, and grabbing him by his long hair, pulled him off the litter he was on. Only darkness could stop the slaughter. Four thousand Indians were killed, even more were injured, and 3,000 were captured. A clear indication that there was no real battle is that of all the Spaniards, only Pizarro was injured, and he got his wound from one of his own soldiers who was too hasty in trying to grab the Inca.
![]() |
Atahualpa is made prisoner. From an old print. |
The booty collected in the camp and from the dead exceeded anything the Spaniards could have imagined, and their enthusiasm was proportioned to the conquest of such riches.
The loot gathered at the camp and from the dead was beyond anything the Spaniards could have imagined, and their excitement matched the achievement of such wealth.
At first Atahualpa bore his captivity with resignation, which may have been partly due to Pizarro's doing all he could to soothe him, at least by words. But the inca, soon understanding the unbridled covetousness of his jailors, made a proposal to Pizarro to pay him ransom, and to have a room of twenty-two feet in length by sixteen in width filled as high as the hand could reach with vases, utensils, and ornaments of gold. Pizarro eagerly agreed to this, and the captive inca despatched the necessary orders at once to all the provinces; these were carried out promptly and unmurmuringly. Beyond this, the Indian troops were disbanded, and Pizarro was able to send Soto and five Spaniards to Cuzco, a town situated more than 600 miles from Caxamalca, while he himself subjugated all the country within a circuit of 300 miles.
At first, Atahualpa accepted his captivity with patience, which might have been partly because Pizarro did all he could to calm him, at least with his words. But the Inca soon realized the unchecked greed of his captors and proposed to Pizarro that he pay a ransom, filling a room that was twenty-two feet long and sixteen feet wide with gold vases, utensils, and ornaments stacked as high as a hand could reach. Pizarro eagerly agreed to this, and the captive Inca immediately sent orders to all the provinces; these were carried out quickly and without complaint. Furthermore, the Indian troops were disbanded, allowing Pizarro to send Soto and five Spaniards to Cuzco, a town located more than 600 miles from Caxamalca, while he himself subjugated the entire area within a 300-mile radius.
In the meantime Almagro landed with 200 soldiers. There had been set aside for him and his men—with what regrets may easily be imagined—100,000 pesos (a Spanish coin); a fifth was reserved for the king, and this left 1,528,500 pesos to be divided between Pizarro and his companions. This product of pillage and massacre was solemnly divided between those entitled to it on the Festival of St. James, the patron saint of Spain, after fervent prayer to God. A deplorable mixture this of religion and profanity, too common unfortunately, in these times of mingled superstition and avarice.
In the meantime, Almagro arrived with 200 soldiers. There had been set aside for him and his men—along with the regrets that can easily be imagined—100,000 pesos (a Spanish coin); a fifth was kept for the king, leaving 1,528,500 pesos to be split between Pizarro and his companions. This result of looting and slaughter was formally divided among those entitled to it on the Festival of St. James, the patron saint of Spain, after earnest prayer to God. A tragic mix of religion and greed, unfortunately all too common in these times of combined superstition and desire for wealth.
Each horse-soldier received 8000 pesos as his share, and each foot-soldier 4000, which would be equivalent to about 1600l. and 800l. sterling. This was enough to satisfy the most exacting soldier, after a campaign which had been neither long nor difficult. Many of the adventurers wished to enjoy this unexpected good fortune in a peaceable manner in their own country, and eagerly asked for their dismissal. This Pizarro granted without hesitation, for he felt sure that the news of their rapidly-acquired wealth would soon bring him new recruits. With his brother Ferdinand, who went to Spain to give the emperor an account of Pizarro's triumph and some splendid presents, went sixty Spaniards, laden heavily indeed with money, but lightly with remorse.
Each horse-soldier got 8,000 pesos as their share, and each foot-soldier received 4,000, which is about £1,600 and £800 sterling. This was enough to satisfy even the most demanding soldier after a campaign that wasn’t long or hard. Many of the adventurers wanted to enjoy this unexpected fortune peacefully back in their own country and eagerly asked for their discharge. Pizarro granted this without hesitation, as he was sure that the news of their quickly earned wealth would soon attract new recruits. Accompanied by his brother Ferdinand, who went to Spain to report to the emperor about Pizarro's success and bring some impressive gifts, were sixty Spaniards, heavily loaded with money but feeling little guilt.
As soon as Atahualpa's ransom was paid, he claimed his freedom; but Pizarro, who had only saved his life that he might make all the treasures of Peru his own, and shelter himself under the prestige and authority which the inca still exercised over his subjects, was soon wearied by his entreaties. He suspected him also of having for some time secretly given orders to levy troops in the distant provinces of the empire. Besides, Atahualpa having soon discovered that Pizarro was no better educated than one of the lowest of his soldiers, felt in consequence a contempt for the governor which, unfortunately, he could not conceal. Such were the reasons, all trivial as they were, which determined Pizarro to prepare for the trial of the inca.
As soon as Atahualpa's ransom was paid, he wanted his freedom; however, Pizarro, who had only spared his life to claim all of Peru's treasures for himself and to use the Inca's status and authority over his people, quickly grew tired of his pleas. He also suspected that Atahualpa had been secretly ordering troops to be raised in the far provinces of the empire for some time. Additionally, Atahualpa soon realized that Pizarro was no better educated than the lowest of his soldiers, which led him to feel a disdain for the governor that he unfortunately couldn't hide. These were the reasons, however petty, that drove Pizarro to prepare for the trial of the Inca.
Nothing could have been more hateful than this trial, in which Almagro and Pizarro were at the same time both suitors and judges. The heads of the accusation were so ridiculous and absurd, that one is in doubt whether to be most surprised by the effrontery or the wickedness of Pizarro, in subjecting the head of a powerful empire, over which he had no jurisdiction, to such an inquiry. Atahualpa, being found guilty, was condemned to be burnt alive; but as he had at length asked to be baptized, that he might rid himself of the importunities of Valverde, his enemies contented themselves with strangling him. A worthy counterpart this, of Guatimozin's execution! These were amongst the most atrocious and odious deeds committed by the Spaniards in America, where, however, they have sullied themselves with every imaginable crime.
Nothing could have been more terrible than this trial, where Almagro and Pizarro were both claimants and judges at the same time. The charges were so ridiculous and absurd that one is left wondering whether to be more shocked by Pizarro's boldness or his malice in subjecting the leader of a powerful empire, over which he had no authority, to such an inquiry. Atahualpa, found guilty, was sentenced to be burned alive; however, since he finally requested to be baptized to escape Valverde's relentless pressure, his enemies settled for strangling him. This was a fitting parallel to Guatimozin's execution! These were among the most heinous and despicable actions committed by the Spaniards in America, where they stained themselves with every conceivable crime.
Among this herd of adventurers there were still some men who had retained sentiments of honour and self-respect. They protested loudly against this perversion of justice, but their generous pleadings were stifled by the selfish declamations of Pizarro and his worthy assistants.
Among this group of adventurers, there were still some men who held onto their sense of honor and self-respect. They strongly protested against this twisted justice, but their passionate arguments were drowned out by the self-serving speeches of Pizarro and his loyal followers.
The governor now raised one of Atahualpa's sons to the throne, under the name of Paul Inca; but the civil war between the two brothers, and the events which had occurred since the arrival of the Spaniards, had done much to loosen the ties which bound the Peruvians to their kings, and this young man, destined soon to die an ignominious death, had scarcely more authority than Manco-Capac, the son of Huascar, who was acknowledged by the inhabitants of Cuzco. Soon after this, some of the principal people in the country even tried to carve for themselves kingdoms out of the empire of Peru. Such was Ruminagui, the commandant of Quito, who caused the brother and the children of Atahualpa to be massacred, and declared himself independent. Discord reigned in the Peruvian camp, and the Spaniards resolved to take advantage of it. Pizarro advanced rapidly upon Cuzco, the small number of his forces having been the only reason which had prevented him from doing so sooner. Now that a crowd of adventurers, attracted by the treasures which had been brought back to Panama, vied with each other in hastening to Peru, now that he could assemble 500 men—after leaving an important garrison at San-Miguel under Benalcazar's command,—Pizarro had no further reason for delay. On the way some skirmishes took place with large bodies of troops, but they ended as always, with severe loss to the natives, and a very insignificant one to the Spaniards. When they entered Cuzco, and took possession of the town, the invaders showed surprise at the small quantity of gold and precious stones which they found there, although it far exceeded Atahualpa's ransom. Was this because they were becoming accustomed to the riches of the country, or because there was a larger number to share in them?
The governor now placed one of Atahualpa's sons on the throne, under the name Paul Inca; however, the civil war between the two brothers and the events that occurred since the Spaniards arrived had greatly weakened the loyalty of the Peruvians to their kings. This young man, who was soon to meet a shameful death, had hardly more power than Manco-Capac, the son of Huascar, who was recognized by the people of Cuzco. Shortly after this, some of the prominent figures in the country even attempted to carve out their own kingdoms from the empire of Peru. One such figure was Ruminagui, the commander of Quito, who ordered the massacre of Atahualpa's brother and children, declaring himself independent. Discord reigned in the Peruvian camp, and the Spaniards decided to take advantage of the situation. Pizarro quickly moved toward Cuzco, having previously delayed due to the small size of his forces. But now, with a crowd of adventurers drawn by the wealth brought back to Panama competing to get to Peru, and with 500 men gathered—after leaving a significant garrison at San Miguel under Benalcazar's command—Pizarro had no reason to wait any longer. En route, some skirmishes occurred with large forces, but as always, they resulted in heavy losses for the natives and very few for the Spaniards. When they entered Cuzco and took control of the town, the invaders were surprised by the relatively small amount of gold and precious stones they found there, even though it far exceeded Atahualpa’s ransom. Was this because they were getting used to the country's wealth, or was it because there were more people to share it?
Meanwhile, Benalcazar, being weary of inaction, took advantage of the arrival of a reinforcement from Nicaragua and Panama, to set out for Quito, where according to the Peruvians, Atahualpa had left the greater part of his treasure. He placed himself at the head of eighty horse-soldiers and 120 infantry, defeated on several occasions Ruminagui, who disputed his passage, and thanks to his prudence and cleverness, he entered Quito victorious; but he did not find there what he sought, that is to say, the treasures of Atahualpa.
Meanwhile, Benalcazar, tired of doing nothing, took advantage of the reinforcements arriving from Nicaragua and Panama to head out for Quito, where the Peruvians said Atahualpa had left most of his treasure. He led a group of eighty cavalry and 120 infantry, defeating Ruminagui multiple times as he tried to block his way. Thanks to his caution and strategy, he entered Quito triumphantly; however, he did not find what he was looking for—Atahualpa's treasures.
At the same time, Peter d'Alvarado, who had so signally distinguished himself under Cortès, and who had been made governor of Guatemala, as a reward for his services, pretended to believe that the province of Quito was not included in Pizarro's command, and organized an expedition consisting of 500 men, 200 of whom were cavalry. Landing at Porto-Viejo, he wished to reach Quito without a guide, by going up the Guayaquil River and crossing the Andes. This road has always been one of the worst and most trying that it is possible to choose. Before they had reached the plain of Quito, after horrible sufferings from hunger and thirst, without speaking of the burning cinders hurled from the crater of Chimborazo, a volcano near Quito, and the snow-storms which assailed them, the fifth part of the band of adventurers, and half the horses, had perished; the remainder were completely discouraged and quite unfit for fighting. It was therefore with the greatest surprise, and some uneasiness, that they found themselves face to face, not with a body of Indians as they had expected, but with a party of Spaniards, under the command of Almagro. The latter were preparing to charge, when some of the more moderate among the officers caused an arrangement to be entered into, by virtue of which Alvarado was to withdraw to his own province after receiving 100,000 pesos to defray the expenses of the armament.
At the same time, Peter d'Alvarado, who had greatly distinguished himself under Cortés and had been appointed governor of Guatemala as a reward for his services, pretended to believe that the province of Quito was not part of Pizarro's authority. He organized an expedition of 500 men, 200 of whom were cavalry. Landing at Porto-Viejo, he attempted to reach Quito without a guide by traveling up the Guayaquil River and crossing the Andes. This route has always been one of the worst and most challenging choices possible. Before they reached the plain of Quito, after enduring terrible suffering from hunger and thirst, not to mention the burning cinders thrown from the crater of Chimborazo, a volcano near Quito, and the snowstorms that hit them, a fifth of the group of adventurers and half the horses had died; the rest were completely demoralized and unfit for battle. Therefore, it was with great surprise and some anxiety that they found themselves face to face, not with a group of Indians as they had expected, but with a party of Spaniards led by Almagro. The latter were getting ready to charge when some of the more moderate officers proposed a deal, allowing Alvarado to retreat to his own province after receiving 100,000 pesos to cover the costs of the expedition.
Ferdinand Pizarro had set sail for Spain, while these events were happening in Peru, feeling sure that the immense quantity of gold, silver, and precious stones which he took with him, would secure him a warm welcome. He obtained for his brother Francisco the confirmation of his appointment as governor, with more extended powers; he himself was made a knight of the order of St. Iago; as for Almagro, he was confirmed in his title of adelantado, and his jurisdiction was extended 600 miles, without, however, its limits being very strictly defined, which left the door open for many contests and all kinds of arbitrary interpretations.
Ferdinand Pizarro had set sail for Spain while these events were unfolding in Peru, confident that the massive amounts of gold, silver, and precious stones he took with him would secure him a warm welcome. He obtained confirmation for his brother Francisco's appointment as governor, with expanded powers; he himself was made a knight of the order of St. Iago. As for Almagro, he was confirmed in his title of adelantado, and his jurisdiction was extended by 600 miles, although its boundaries were not very clearly defined, leaving room for many disputes and all kinds of arbitrary interpretations.
Ferdinand Pizarro had not reached Peru again, when Almagro, having learnt that a special government had been assigned to him, pretended that Cuzco formed part of it, and made preparations for its conquest. But Juan and Gonzalo Pizarro had no intention of allowing themselves to be robbed, and the parties were on the point of coming to blows when Francisco Pizarro, who is often called the Marquis or the great Marquis, arrived at the capital.
Ferdinand Pizarro hadn't made it back to Peru yet when Almagro, having found out that he was given a special government position, claimed that Cuzco was included and started getting ready to take control of it. But Juan and Gonzalo Pizarro weren't going to let that happen, and the two sides were about to clash when Francisco Pizarro, often referred to as the Marquis or the great Marquis, arrived in the capital.
Almagro had never forgiven Francisco Pizarro the duplicity which he had displayed in his negotiations with Charles V., nor the coolness with which he had claimed for himself, at the expense of his two friends, the principal share of authority, and the most extended government. But as Almagro met with great opposition to his designs, and as he was not the stronger, he concealed his vexation, put a good face on the matter, and seemed delighted at a reconciliation. "They renewed their partnership, therefore," says Zarate, "on condition that Don Diego d'Almagro should go and discover the country on the south side, and if he found any that was really good, they should ask his Majesty to make him the governor of it; but that if he found nothing to suit him, they should share Don Francisco's government between them." This arrangement was made very solemnly, and they took their oath upon the consecrated wafer, that for the future they would undertake nothing against one another. Some say that Almagro swore that he would never encroach either upon Cuzco or on the surrounding country within 390 miles, even if his Majesty should give him the government of it. They add that turning towards the holy sacrament, he pronounced these words, "Lord, if I violate the oath that I now take, I pray that Thou wilt confound me, and punish me both in my body and my soul!"
Almagro had never forgiven Francisco Pizarro for the deceit he showed in his dealings with Charles V, nor for the way he coolly claimed the majority of power and the most extensive governance at the expense of his two friends. However, since Almagro faced significant opposition to his plans and wasn't the stronger party, he hid his frustration, put on a brave face, and acted pleased about the reconciliation. "They renewed their partnership, therefore," says Zarate, "on the condition that Don Diego d'Almagro would go explore the territory to the south, and if he found any that was truly good, they would ask His Majesty to make him the governor of it; but if he found nothing suitable, they would share Don Francisco's territory between them." This agreement was made very formally, and they swore an oath on the consecrated wafer that they would not act against each other in the future. Some say Almagro swore he would never encroach on Cuzco or the surrounding area within 390 miles, even if His Majesty granted him control over it. They add that, turning towards the holy sacrament, he said, "Lord, if I break the oath I now take, I ask that You confound me and punish me in both body and soul!"
![]() |
Pizarro and Almagro take an oath upon the Host. |
After this solemn agreement, which was destined to be observed with as little fidelity as the first, Almagro made his preparations for departure. Thanks to his well-known liberality, as much as to his reputation for courage, he gathered together 570 men, of about equal numbers of cavalry and infantry, with which he set out by land for Chili. The journey was an extremely trying one, and the adventurers suffered severely from intense cold whilst crossing the Andes; they had also to deal with very warlike tribes, unsoftened by any civilization, who assailed them with a furia of which nothing they had seen in Peru had given them any idea. Almagro could make no settlement, for he had scarcely been two months in the country when he heard that the Indians in Peru had revolted, and massacred the greater part of the Spaniards, whereupon he immediately retraced his steps.
After this serious agreement, which was likely to be followed as poorly as the first, Almagro got ready to leave. Thanks to his well-known generosity and his reputation for bravery, he gathered 570 men, with about equal numbers of cavalry and infantry, and set out overland for Chile. The journey was incredibly tough, and the adventurers suffered greatly from extreme cold while crossing the Andes. They also had to face very warlike tribes, untouched by civilization, who attacked them with a fury unlike anything they had encountered in Peru. Almagro couldn't establish any settlements because he had barely been in the country for two months when he heard that the Indians in Peru had revolted and killed most of the Spaniards, prompting him to turn back immediately.
After the new partnership had been signed between the conquerors (1534), Pizarro had returned to the provinces bordering on the sea, in which he could establish a regular government, there being no longer anything to dread from resistance. For a man who had never studied legislation, he had drawn up some very wise rules for the administration of justice, for the collection of taxes, the apportionment of the Indians, and the working of the mines. Some parts of the "conquistador's" character were doubtless very open to criticism, but it is only just to recognize that he was not wanting in enlarged ideas, and that he was conscientious in playing his part as the founder of a great empire. This it was which made him hesitate long before choosing the future capital of the Spanish possessions. Cuzco had the recommendation of having been the residence of the incas; but this town, situated more than 400 miles from the sea, was very distant from Quito, of which the importance seemed to Pizarro to be extreme. Before long he was struck with the beauty and fertility of a great valley, watered by a stream called the Rimac, and there in 1536, he established the seat of his dominion. Soon, the City of Kings (de Los Reyes), or Lima, as it is called by a corruption of the name of the river which flows at its feet, assumed the aspect of a great city, owing to the magnificent palace and the sumptuous residences for officers, which Pizarro caused to be built there. While these cares kept Pizarro far from his capital, small bodies of troops, sent in different directions, penetrated into the most distant provinces of the empire, with the object of extinguishing the last smouldering embers of resistance; so many of the soldiers were employed in this way, that there remained in Cuzco itself but a very small body of troops. The inca, who had remained in the hands of the Spaniards, thought this an opportune moment for fomenting a general rising, in which he earnestly hoped that the foreign government might be overthrown. Although closely guarded, he contrived to take his measures with so much skill that he did not arouse the suspicions of his oppressors. He obtained permission even to be present at a grand fête, which was to be held at several miles' distance from Cuzco, and for which the most distinguished persons in the empire had met together. As soon as the inca appeared, the standard of revolt was raised. The country was soon in arms from the confines of the province of Quito as far as Chili, and a number of small detachments of Spaniards were surprised and destroyed. Cuzco, defended by the three brothers Pizarro with but 170 Spaniards, was exposed for eight consecutive months to the incessant attacks of the Peruvians, who had now become expert in the use of the arms which they had taken from their enemies. The conquerors made a most valiant resistance, but experienced some severe losses, especially that of Juan Pizarro. Almagro left Chili in the greatest haste, crossed the stony and sandy desert of Atacama, where he suffered as severely from heat and drought as he had done in the Andes from cold and snow, penetrated into the Peruvian territory, defeated Manco-Capac in a great battle, and succeeded in approaching the town of Cuzco, after having driven away the Indians. He then tried to get the town given up to him, on the pretext that it was not included in Pizarro's government, and violating a truce, during which the followers of the marquis were taking a short rest, he entered Cuzco, seized both Ferdinand and Gonzalo Pizarro, and had himself acknowledged as governor.
After the new partnership was signed between the conquerors (1534), Pizarro returned to the coastal provinces where he could establish a proper government, no longer fearing resistance. For someone who had never studied law, he created some very wise rules for administering justice, collecting taxes, distributing the Indians, and managing the mines. Some aspects of the "conquistador's" character were certainly open to criticism, but it’s fair to acknowledge that he had broad ideas and was dedicated to his role as the founder of a great empire. This was what made him take a long time to choose the future capital of the Spanish possessions. Cuzco was appealing as it had been the residence of the Incas, but being over 400 miles from the sea, it was far from Quito, which Pizarro deemed extremely important. Before long, he was struck by the beauty and fertility of a large valley, watered by a stream called the Rimac, and there in 1536, he established his seat of power. Soon, the City of Kings (de Los Reyes), or Lima, as it became known from a corruption of the river's name, took on the appearance of a great city due to the magnificent palace and luxurious residences for officials that Pizarro had built there. While these projects kept Pizarro away from his capital, small groups of troops sent in different directions advanced into the most distant provinces of the empire to extinguish the last sparks of resistance; so many soldiers were occupied this way that only a small contingent remained in Cuzco. The Inca, who was in Spanish custody, saw this as a perfect opportunity to incite a general uprising, genuinely hoping to overthrow the foreign government. Although closely guarded, he managed to plan so skillfully that he did not raise the suspicions of his captors. He even got permission to attend a grand celebration taking place several miles from Cuzco, where the most prominent figures of the empire had gathered. As soon as the Inca appeared, the flag of revolt was raised. The country quickly armed itself from the outskirts of the province of Quito all the way to Chile, and several small detachments of Spaniards were caught off guard and destroyed. Cuzco, defended by the three Pizarro brothers with just 170 Spaniards, faced relentless attacks from the Peruvians, who had now become skilled with the weapons taken from their enemies, for eight straight months. The conquerors put up a valiant fight but suffered severe losses, particularly the death of Juan Pizarro. Almagro hurriedly left Chile, crossed the rocky and sandy Atacama Desert, suffering as much from heat and drought as he had from cold and snow in the Andes, and entered Peruvian territory, defeating Manco-Capac in a major battle and advancing toward Cuzco after driving away the Indians. He then attempted to have the town surrendered to him, claiming it was not part of Pizarro's territory, and violated a truce while Pizarro's followers were resting, entering Cuzco, capturing Ferdinand and Gonzalo Pizarro, and declaring himself governor.
While this was going on, a considerable body of Indians invested Lima, intercepted all communications, and annihilated the various small bodies of troops which Pizarro sent at intervals to the aid of the Spaniards at Cuzco. At this time he sent away all his vessels to Panama to compel his companions to make a desperate resistance; he recalled from Truxillo the forces under the command of Alonzo d'Alvarado, and entrusted to the latter a column of 500 men, which advanced to within several miles of the capital without having the slightest suspicion that the town was now in the hands of fellow-countrymen, who were fully determined to bar their passage. But Almagro desired much rather to attract these new adversaries to himself than to destroy them; he arranged therefore, to surprise them and make them prisoners. He had now a fine opportunity in his hands of ending the war, and making himself master of the two governments by a single blow. Several of his officers had observed this to him, and especially Orgoños, who proposed that the two brothers of the "conquistador" should be put to death, and that Almagro should advance by forced marches with his victorious troops against Lima, where Pizarro, taken by surprise, would not be able to resist him. But as a Latin poet says, "Jupiter makes dotards of those whom he means to ruin." Almagro, who in so many other instances had thrown aside all scruples, did not wish to put himself in the wrong by invading Pizarro's dominions as a rebel, and he quietly took the road back to Cuzco.
While this was happening, a large group of Indians surrounded Lima, cut off all communications, and destroyed the various small units of troops that Pizarro sent intermittently to support the Spaniards at Cuzco. At that time, he sent all his ships back to Panama to force his companions to make a desperate stand; he recalled the forces under Alonzo d'Alvarado from Truxillo and tasked him with a column of 500 men, which moved within a few miles of the capital without the slightest suspicion that the town was now under the control of fellow countrymen who were fully determined to block their way. However, Almagro preferred to attract these new adversaries to himself rather than eliminate them; he planned to surprise them and capture them. He now had a great opportunity to end the war and take control of both governments in one fell swoop. Several of his officers pointed this out to him, especially Orgoños, who suggested that the two brothers of the "conquistador" should be killed, and that Almagro should march quickly with his victorious troops towards Lima, where Pizarro, caught off guard, would not be able to defend himself. But as a Latin poet says, "Jupiter makes fools of those he intends to ruin." Almagro, who had often cast aside his scruples in the past, didn't want to wrongfully invade Pizarro's territory as a rebel, so he quietly headed back to Cuzco.
Looking at it only from the side of Almagro's own interests, he evidently committed in this a gross blunder, of which he was soon to repent; but if we consider, what we should never lose sight of, the interest of the country, he had already committed a capital crime in the acts of aggression of which he had been guilty, and in kindling civil war in face of an enemy quite ready to take advantage of it. His adversaries did not delay to remind him of it. Whereas prompt decision would have been necessary for Almagro to make him master of the situation, Pizarro had everything to expect from time and opportunity. While waiting for the promised reinforcements from Darien, he commenced negotiations with his adversary, lasting for several months, during which time one of his brothers, as well as Alvarado, found means to escape with more than seventy men. Although Almagro had been so often duped, he consented again to receive the licentiate Espinosa, who was ordered to represent to him, that if the emperor knew what was taking place between the two competitors, and learnt the condition to which their contests had reduced affairs, no doubt he would recall them both, and put some one else in their place. At last, after the death of Espinosa, it was decided by the friar Francisco de Bovadilla, to whom Pizarro and Almagro had referred their differences, that Ferdinand Pizarro should be immediately set free, that Cuzco should be given back to the marquis, and that they should send several officers on both sides to Spain, charged with representing the respective rights of the two parties and submitting them to the emperor's decision.
Looking at it solely from Almagro's point of view, he clearly made a major mistake that he would soon regret; however, if we consider, which we should never forget, the interest of the country, he had already committed a serious crime with the aggressive acts he undertook, and by sparking civil war when there was an enemy ready to take advantage of the situation. His opponents wasted no time reminding him of this. While Almagro needed to act quickly to take control of the situation, Pizarro had everything to gain from waiting for time and opportunity. While awaiting the promised reinforcements from Darien, Pizarro began negotiations with his rival, which lasted for several months, during which one of his brothers, as well as Alvarado, managed to escape with more than seventy men. Even though Almagro had been deceived many times before, he agreed once again to meet with Licentiate Espinosa, who was sent to inform him that if the emperor knew about the situation between the two contenders and learned how their conflicts had affected things, he would likely recall both of them and appoint someone else instead. Eventually, after Espinosa's death, it was decided by Friar Francisco de Bovadilla, to whom Pizarro and Almagro had referred their disagreements, that Ferdinand Pizarro should be released immediately, that Cuzco should be returned to the marquis, and that they should send several officers from both sides to Spain to represent the respective rights of both parties and submit them to the emperor’s decision.
Scarcely had the last of his brothers been set at liberty than Pizarro, rejecting all idea of peace and amicable arrangement, declared that arms alone should decide whether he or Almagro was to be lord of Peru. In a short time he had assembled a body of 700 men, of which he entrusted the command to his two brothers. Finding it impossible to cross the mountains which would have been the most direct road to Cuzco, they followed the line of the sea-coast as far as Nasca, and then penetrated into a branch of the Andes, by which they could reach the capital in a short time. Possibly Almagro ought to have defended the mountain defiles, but he had only 500 men, and he reckoned much on his splendid cavalry, whom he could not deploy in a confined space; he therefore waited for the enemy in the plain of Cuzco. The two parties encountered each other on the 26th of April, 1538, with equal animosity; but the victory was decided by two companies of musketeers which the emperor had sent to Pizarro when he heard of the revolt of the Indians. One hundred and forty soldiers perished in this engagement, which received the name of las salinas. Orgoños and several officers of distinction were killed in cold blood after the battle, and Almagro himself, aged and ill, could not escape from Pizarro.
Scarcely had the last of his brothers been released when Pizarro, dismissing any notion of peace or agreements, declared that only weapons would determine whether he or Almagro would be the rightful ruler of Peru. Soon, he gathered an army of 700 men and put his two brothers in charge. Unable to cross the mountains, which would have been the most direct route to Cuzco, they took the coastal path down to Nasca and then moved into a branch of the Andes that would lead them to the capital quickly. Almagro should have defended the mountain passes, but he only had 500 men and relied heavily on his impressive cavalry, which he couldn't use in tight spaces; thus, he opted to wait for the enemy on the plains of Cuzco. The two sides met on April 26, 1538, filled with equal hostility, but the outcome was influenced by two companies of musketeers the emperor had sent to Pizarro upon hearing about the Indian revolt. One hundred and forty soldiers died in the battle, known as las salinas. Orgoños and several notable officers were executed in cold blood after the fight, and Almagro, aged and unwell, could not escape from Pizarro.
The Indians who, assembled in arms on the surrounding mountains, had reckoned upon falling on the conqueror, had need instead to fly in all haste. "Nothing," says Robertson, "more entirely proves the ascendancy gained by the Spaniards over the Americans, than seeing that the latter, witnesses of the defeat and dispersion of one of the parties, had not the courage to attack the other, even weakened and fatigued as they were by their victory, and dared not fall upon their oppressors when fortune offered them so favourable an opportunity for attacking them with advantage."
The Native Americans, gathered with weapons on the nearby mountains, had planned to ambush the conqueror but instead had to retreat in panic. "Nothing," says Robertson, "more completely demonstrates the dominance the Spaniards held over the Indigenous people than the fact that the latter, having witnessed the defeat and scattering of one group, lacked the courage to strike at the other, even though they were weakened and exhausted from their victory, and didn’t dare to attack their oppressors when fortune presented them with such a good opportunity to do so."
At this period a victory not followed by pillage was incomplete, so the town of Cuzco was sacked, and all the riches that Pizarro's companions found there did not suffice to content them. They had such exalted ideas of their merits and of the services which they had rendered, that each would have desired an appointment as governor. Ferdinand Pizarro therefore dispersed them, and sent them to conquer fresh territories with some of the partisans of Almagro who had rallied, and whom it was important to send to a distance.
During this time, a victory that wasn’t followed by looting felt incomplete, so the town of Cuzco was plundered, and all the wealth that Pizarro's men found there still wasn't enough to satisfy them. They held such high opinions of their own worth and the contributions they had made that each one wished to be appointed as governor. Ferdinand Pizarro, therefore, sent them off in different directions to conquer new lands alongside some of Almagro's supporters who had gathered, and it was crucial to send them far away.
As for Almagro himself, Ferdinand Pizarro, feeling convinced that his name constituted a focus of permanent agitation, resolved to get rid of him. He caused him therefore to be put upon his trial, which ended, as it was easy to foresee, in a sentence of death. When Almagro received this news, after giving way for a few moments to a very natural grief, pleading his great age and the different way in which he had behaved with regard to Ferdinand and Gonzalo Pizarro when they were his prisoners, he recovered his calmness and awaited his death with a soldier's courage. He was strangled in his prison, and afterwards publicly beheaded (1538).
As for Almagro himself, Ferdinand Pizarro, convinced that his name was a constant source of unrest, decided to eliminate him. He had him put on trial, which, as expected, resulted in a death sentence. When Almagro heard this news, he initially succumbed to natural grief, arguing his old age and how differently he had treated Ferdinand and Gonzalo Pizarro when they were his prisoners. However, he soon regained his composure and faced his death with the courage of a soldier. He was strangled in his cell and then publicly beheaded (1538).
After several successful expeditions, Ferdinand Pizarro set out for Spain, to give the Emperor an account of what had taken place. He found most minds there strangely prejudiced against him and his brothers. Their cruelty, their violence, and their disregard of the most sacred engagements had been laid bare without reserve, by some friends of Almagro's. Ferdinand Pizarro needed the utmost cleverness to win the Emperor round. Charles V. had no means of judging fairly on which side the justice of the case lay, for he had only heard of it from the interested parties; he could only discern the deplorable consequences to his own government of the civil war. He decided, therefore, to send a commissioner to the country, to whom he gave most extensive powers, and who, after having inquired into all that had taken place, should establish whatever form of government he thought most advisable. This delicate mission was confided to Christoval de Vaca, a judge of audience at Valladolid, who proved not unequal to his task. One fact is worthy of notice; he was recommended to show the greatest respect towards Francisco Pizarro, at the very time when his brother Ferdinand was arrested and thrown into a prison, where he was destined to remain forgotten for twenty years.
After several successful expeditions, Ferdinand Pizarro headed back to Spain to report to the Emperor about what had happened. He found that most people there had a negative opinion of him and his brothers. Their cruelty, violence, and disregard for sacred agreements had been openly criticized by some supporters of Almagro. Ferdinand Pizarro needed to be very clever to win the Emperor over. Charles V had no way of fairly judging where the justice in the situation lay, as he had only heard from those with vested interests; he could only see the disastrous effects of the civil war on his own government. Consequently, he decided to send a commissioner to the region with broad authority. This commissioner would investigate all that had occurred and establish whatever form of government he believed was best. This sensitive mission was entrusted to Christoval de Vaca, a judge from Valladolid, who proved capable of handling the task. One notable aspect is that he was instructed to show great respect towards Francisco Pizarro, even while his brother Ferdinand was arrested and thrown into a prison, where he would remain forgotten for twenty years.
While these events were taking place in Spain, the Marquis portioned out the conquered country, keeping for himself and his trustworthy friends the most fertile and best situated districts, and giving to Almagro's companions, the men of Chili as they were called, only the more sterile and distant territories. Next he confided to Pedro de Valdivia, one of his aides-de-camp the execution of the project which Almagro had only been able to sketch out, the conquest of Chili. Valdivia set out on the 28th of January, 1540, with 150 Spaniards, amongst whom Pedro Gomez, Pedro de Miranda, and Alonzo de Monroy were destined especially to distinguish themselves; he crossed first the desert of Atacama, which even at the present day is considered a most troublesome enterprise, and reached Copiapo, standing in the midst of a beautiful valley. Received at first with great cordiality, he had to sustain, as soon as harvest was over, several combats with the Araucanians, a race of brave, indefatigable warriors, very different from the Indians of Peru. In spite of this, he laid the foundations of the town of Santiago on the 12th of February, 1541. Valdivia spent eight years in Chili, presiding over the conquest and organization of the country. Less greedy than the other "conquistadores" his contemporaries, he only sought for the mineral riches of the country that he might ensure the development of the prosperity of his colony, in which he had taken care first of all to encourage agriculture. "The best mine that I know of, is one of corn and wine with nourishment for livestock. Who has this, has money. As for mines, we do not depend upon them for subsistence. And often that which looks well outwardly is not really worth much." These wise words of Lescarbot, in his Histoire de la Nouvelle France, might have been used by Valdivia, so exactly do they correspond with and express his sentiments. His valour, prudence, and humanity, more especially the latter quality, which shines forth strangely in contrast with the cruelty of Pizarro, ensures for him a distinction all his own among the "conquistadores" of the sixteenth century.
While these events were happening in Spain, the Marquis divided the conquered land, keeping the most fertile and well-located areas for himself and his trusted friends, and giving Almagro's companions, known as the men of Chili, only the less productive and more remote regions. He then entrusted Pedro de Valdivia, one of his aides-de-camp, with the task that Almagro had only vaguely planned: the conquest of Chili. Valdivia set out on January 28, 1540, with 150 Spaniards, including Pedro Gomez, Pedro de Miranda, and Alonzo de Monroy, who were especially destined to make a mark. He first crossed the Atacama Desert, which is still considered quite a challenging endeavor today, and reached Copiapo, located in a beautiful valley. Initially welcomed warmly, he soon had to engage in several battles with the Araucanians, a courageous and tireless warrior group very different from the Indians of Peru. Despite this, he laid the foundations of the town of Santiago on February 12, 1541. Valdivia spent eight years in Chili, overseeing the conquest and organization of the area. Less greedy than his fellow conquistadors, he only sought the country’s mineral wealth to promote the prosperity of his colony, where he first prioritized agriculture. “The best mine I know of is one of corn and wine with nourishment for livestock. Whoever has this has money. As for mines, we do not rely on them for survival. And often what looks good on the outside isn't worth much.” These wise words from Lescarbot’s Histoire de la Nouvelle France could easily have been spoken by Valdivia, as they perfectly reflect his thoughts. His bravery, prudence, and especially his humanity—an aspect that stands out in stark contrast to Pizarro's brutality—give him a unique distinction among the conquistadors of the sixteenth century.
![]() |
The shores of Rio Napo. |
At the time that Valdivia set out for Chili, Gonzalo Pizarro crossed the Andes at the head of 340 Spaniards, half of whom were mounted, and 4000 Indians, of whom the greater part of the Indians perished from cold; then he penetrated eastwards into the interior, seeking for a country where spices and cinnamon were said to abound. In these vast Savannahs, intersected by marshes and virgin forests, the Spaniards encountered torrents of rain, which lasted quite two months; they found only a scattered population, who were not industrious and also hostile; in consequence, the invaders often suffered from hunger in a country where there were then neither horses nor oxen, where the largest quadrupeds were tapirs and llamas, and even the latter were seldom met with on this slope of the Andes. In spite of these difficulties, which would have discouraged any less energetic explorers than the descubridores of the sixteenth century, they persevered in their attempt and descended the Rio Napo or Coca, an affluent on the left of the Marañon, as far as its confluence. There, with great difficulty they built a brigantine, which was manned by fifty soldiers under the command of Francisco Orellana. But either the strength of the current carried him away, or else being no longer under the eyes of his chief, he wished in his turn to be the leader of an expedition of discovery; he did not wait for Gonzalo Pizarro at the appointed rendezvous, but continued to descend the river until he reached the ocean. Such a voyage is simply marvellous, through nearly 6000 miles of an unknown region, without guide, without compass, without provisions, with a crew who murmured more than once against the foolish attempt of their leader, and in the midst of populations almost invariably hostile. From the mouth of the river, which he had just descended in his badly built and dilapidated vessel, Orellana succeeded in reaching the Island of Cubagua, whence he set sail for Spain. If the proverb "He who comes from a distance tells many lies" were not of much earlier date, one might have thought it had been coined for Orellana. He invented the most preposterous fables as to the wealth of the countries he had traversed; the inhabitants were so rich that the roofs of the temples were formed of plates of gold; an assertion which gave rise to the legend of El Dorado. Orellana had heard of the existence of a Republic of female warriors who had founded a vast empire, which caused the river Marañon to be called the River of the Amazons. If, however, we strip this narrative of all that is ridiculous and grotesque, and calculated to please the imaginations of his contemporaries, it remains certain that Orellana's expedition is one of the most remarkable of this epoch, so fertile in gigantic enterprises; and it furnishes the first information upon the immense zone of country lying between the Andes and the Atlantic.
At the time Valdivia was preparing to head for Chile, Gonzalo Pizarro crossed the Andes with 340 Spaniards, half of whom rode on horseback, and 4,000 Indians, most of whom died from the cold. He pushed east into the interior, searching for a land rumored to be rich in spices and cinnamon. In these vast savannahs, cut through by swamps and untouched forests, the Spaniards encountered heavy rains that lasted for two months. They found only a scattered population that was neither industrious nor friendly, leading the invaders to often suffer from hunger in a land that had no horses or oxen; the largest animals there were tapirs and llamas, and even llamas were rarely seen on this side of the Andes. Despite these challenges, which would have discouraged any less determined explorers than the descubridores of the sixteenth century, they continued their journey and navigated down the Rio Napo, or Coca, a tributary of the Marañon, down to where it meets the main river. With great difficulty, they built a small ship manned by fifty soldiers under Francisco Orellana's command. Either the current swept him away, or he decided to take charge of a discovery mission after being out of his leader's sight; he did not wait for Gonzalo Pizarro at their meeting point but continued down the river until he reached the ocean. This journey is truly incredible—covering nearly 6,000 miles through an unknown area, without guides, compasses, or supplies, with a crew that often complained about their leader's reckless quest, and amidst mostly hostile populations. From the river's mouth, Orellana made his way to the Island of Cubagua, from which he set sail for Spain. If the saying "He who comes from afar tells many tales" hadn’t existed long before, one might think it was made for Orellana. He spun the most outrageous stories about the wealth of the lands he had crossed, claiming that the roofs of temples were made of gold, which led to the legend of El Dorado. Orellana talked about a republic of female warriors who had built a vast empire, which made the Marañon River known as the River of the Amazons. However, if we remove the ridiculous and exaggerated elements aimed at fascinating his contemporaries, it remains clear that Orellana's expedition is one of the most remarkable of this era, known for its grand adventures, and it provides the first insights into the vast region lying between the Andes and the Atlantic.
But we must return to Gonzalo Pizarro. His embarrassment and consternation had been great, when on arriving at the confluence of the Napo and Marañon, he had not found Orellana, who was to have been awaiting him. Fearing that some accident might have befallen his lieutenant, he had descended the course of the river for 150 miles, until he met with an unfortunate officer, who had been left behind for having addressed some remonstrances to his chief upon his perfidy. The bravest among Pizarro's men were discouraged at the news of the cowardly way in which they had been abandoned, and at the destitute condition in which they were left. Pizarro was obliged to yield to their entreaties and to return to Quito, from which they were more than 1200 miles away. To give an idea of their sufferings on this return journey, it suffices to say that, after having eaten horses, dogs, and reptiles, roots, and wild beasts, and after having devoured every article made of leather in their accoutrements, the unfortunate survivors who reached Quito, lacerated by brambles, emaciated and utterly impoverished, numbered only twenty-four. Four thousand Indians and two hundred and ten Spaniards had perished in this expedition, which had lasted less than two years.
But we need to go back to Gonzalo Pizarro. He felt a strong sense of embarrassment and shock when he arrived at the meeting point of the Napo and Marañon rivers and didn’t find Orellana, who was supposed to be waiting for him. Worried that something might have happened to his lieutenant, he traveled down the river for 150 miles until he encountered a disgraced officer who had been left behind for voicing objections to his leader about his betrayal. The bravest among Pizarro’s men were demoralized by the news of how cowardly they had been abandoned and the desperate situation they were in. Pizarro had no choice but to give in to their pleas and head back to Quito, which was over 1200 miles away. To illustrate their suffering during this return trip, it’s enough to mention that after having eaten horses, dogs, reptiles, roots, wild animals, and having consumed every piece of leather from their gear, the unfortunate survivors who reached Quito—bruised by thorns, emaciated, and completely broke—only numbered twenty-four. Four thousand Indigenous people and two hundred and ten Spaniards had lost their lives in this expedition, which lasted less than two years.
While Gonzalo Pizarro was conducting the unfortunate expedition just related, the old partisans of Almagro, who had never frankly joined Pizarro, gathered round the son of their old leader, and formed a plot for murdering the Marquis. In vain was Francisco Pizarro several times warned of what was threatening him, he would pay no heed to the report. He said "Keep quiet, I shall be safe as long as there is no one in Peru who does not know that I can in a moment take the life of any one who should dare to form the project of attempting mine."
While Gonzalo Pizarro was leading the unfortunate expedition just mentioned, the old supporters of Almagro, who had never fully aligned with Pizarro, rallied around the son of their former leader and plotted to kill the Marquis. Despite several warnings to Francisco Pizarro about the threat he faced, he ignored the reports. He said, "Stay quiet; I’ll be safe as long as everyone in Peru knows that I can easily take the life of anyone who dares to try to harm me."
On Sunday, the 26th of June, 1541, at the hour of siesta, Juan de Herrada and eighteen conspirators left the house of Almagro's son with drawn swords in their hands and armed from top to toe. They ran towards the house of Pizarro, crying out, "Death to the tyrant! death to the infamous wretch!" They entered the palace, killed Francisco de Chaves, who had appeared in haste on hearing the noise, and gained the hall, where was Francisco Pizarro, with his brother Francisco-Martin, the doctor Juan Velasquez, and a dozen servants. These jumped out of the windows, with the exception of Martin Pizarro, two other gentlemen, and two tall pages, who were killed while defending the door of the governor's apartment. He himself had not had time to put on his cuirass, but he seized his sword and buckler and defended himself valiantly, killing four of his adversaries and wounding several others. One of his assailants, in a spirit of self-devotion, attracted to himself the blows of Pizarro. Meanwhile the other conspirators made their way in and attacked him with such fury that he could not parry all the blows, being so exhausted that he could scarcely wield his sword. "Thus," says Zarate, "they made an end, and succeeded in killing him by a thrust in the throat. Falling to the ground, he asked in a loud voice that he might be allowed to confess, and then not being able any longer to speak, he made the sign of the cross on the ground, which he kissed, and then yielded up his soul to God." Some negroes carried his body to the church, where Juan Barbazan, his old servant, alone ventured to come and claim it. This faithful servant secretly rendered to it funeral honours, for the conspirators had pillaged the house of Pizarro, not leaving enough even to pay for wax tapers.
On Sunday, June 26, 1541, during siesta time, Juan de Herrada and eighteen conspirators left the house of Almagro's son with their swords drawn and fully armed. They ran toward Pizarro's house, shouting, "Death to the tyrant! Death to the infamous wretch!" They entered the palace, where they killed Francisco de Chaves, who rushed out upon hearing the commotion, and made their way to the hall, where Francisco Pizarro was with his brother Francisco-Martin, doctor Juan Velasquez, and a dozen servants. The servants jumped out of the windows, except for Martin Pizarro, two other gentlemen, and two tall pages, who were killed while trying to defend the door to the governor's apartment. Pizarro hadn’t had time to put on his armor but grabbed his sword and shield, fighting bravely, killing four of his attackers and injuring several others. One of his attackers, showing self-sacrifice, drew Pizarro's blows to himself. Meanwhile, the other conspirators rushed in and attacked him with such ferocity that he couldn’t block all the strikes and was exhausted to the point of barely being able to hold his sword. "Thus," says Zarate, "they brought an end to him, succeeding in killing him with a stab to the throat. As he fell to the ground, he loudly asked to be allowed to confess, and when he could no longer speak, he made the sign of the cross on the ground, kissed it, and then surrendered his soul to God." Some Black servants carried his body to the church, where Juan Barbazan, his old servant, was the only one brave enough to come and claim it. This loyal servant secretly gave him a proper burial since the conspirators had looted Pizarro's house, leaving nothing even to pay for wax candles.
![]() |
Death of Pizarro. From an old print. |
Thus did Francisco Pizarro come to his end, assassinated even in the capital of the vast empire which Spain owed to his valour and indefatigable perseverance, but which he bestowed upon his country, it must be admitted, ravaged, decimated, and drowned in a deluge of blood. Pizarro is often compared with Cortès; the one had as much ambition, courage, and military capacity as the other; but the cruelty and avarice of the Marquis della Valle were carried to an extreme in Pizarro, and united in him to perfidy and duplicity. If we are inclined to excuse certain parts of Cortès' character which are not estimable, by the times in which he lived, we are at least charmed by that grace and nobility of manners, and by that way of a gentleman above prejudices, which made him so much beloved by the soldier. In Pizarro, on the contrary, we find roughness, and a harsh, unsympathizing way of feeling, while his chivalrous qualities disappear entirely behind the rapacity and perfidy which are the salient features of his character.
Thus did Francisco Pizarro meet his end, assassinated even in the capital of the vast empire that Spain owed to his bravery and relentless perseverance, but which he, it must be said, left his country ravaged, decimated, and drenched in a flood of blood. Pizarro is often compared to Cortès; both had equal ambition, courage, and military skill; however, the cruelty and greed of the Marquis della Valle were taken to an extreme in Pizarro, who also combined them with treachery and deceit. If we’re inclined to excuse certain less admirable aspects of Cortès' character due to the times he lived in, we at least admire his grace, nobility, and gentlemanly demeanor that made him so well-liked by his soldiers. In Pizarro, on the other hand, we find a roughness and a harsh, unsympathetic disposition, while his chivalrous qualities completely vanish behind his greed and treachery, which are the most prominent aspects of his character.
If Cortès found brave and resolute adversaries among the Mexicans, who opposed almost insurmountable difficulties to his progress, Pizarro had no trouble in vanquishing the Peruvians, who were timid and enervated, and who never made any serious resistance to his arms. Of the conquests of Peru and Mexico, the less difficult produced the greater metallurgic advantage to Spain, and thus it was the more appreciated.
If Cortès encountered courageous and determined opponents among the Mexicans, who posed nearly impossible challenges to his advancement, Pizarro had an easy time defeating the Peruvians, who were fearful and weakened, and who never mounted any substantial resistance to his forces. Of the conquests of Peru and Mexico, the less challenging one provided greater metal resources to Spain, making it more valued.
The civil war was on the point of breaking out again after Pizarro's death when the governor arrived, who was delegated by the metropolitan government. As soon as he had collected the needful troops, he marched towards Cuzco. He seized young Almagro without trouble, had him beheaded with forty of his confederates and governed the country with firmness, until the viceroy Blasco Nuñez Vela, arrived. It is not our intention to enter into the detail of the disputes which took place between the latter and Gonzalo Pizarro, who, profiting by the general discontent, caused by the new regulations as to the "repartimientos," revolted against the Emperor's representative. After many changes of fortune, for which we have not space, the struggle ended by the defeat and execution of Gonzalo Pizarro, which took place in 1548. His body was taken to Cuzco and buried fully dressed; "No one," says Garcilasso de la Vega, "being willing to give even a winding-sheet for it." Thus ended the judicial assassin of Almagro. Is not the text appropriate in this case: "They that take the sword shall perish with the sword"?
The civil war was about to break out again after Pizarro's death when the governor, sent by the central government, arrived. As soon as he gathered the necessary troops, he marched towards Cuzco. He captured young Almagro easily, had him beheaded along with forty of his allies, and ruled the country firmly until viceroy Blasco Nuñez Vela arrived. We won't go into detail about the disputes between him and Gonzalo Pizarro, who, taking advantage of the widespread discontent caused by the new regulations on "repartimientos," revolted against the Emperor's representative. After many ups and downs, which we don’t have the space to cover, the struggle ended with the defeat and execution of Gonzalo Pizarro in 1548. His body was taken to Cuzco and buried dressed; "No one," says Garcilasso de la Vega, "was willing to give even a shroud for it." Thus ended the judicial assassin of Almagro. Is not the text fitting here: "Those who take the sword will die by the sword"?
CHAPTER II.
Magellan—His early history—His disappointment—His change of nationality—Preparations for the expedition—Rio de Janeiro—St. Julian's Bay—Revolt of a part of the squadron—Terrible punishment of the guilty—Magellan's Strait—Patagonia—The Pacific—The Ladrone Islands—Zebu and the Philippine Islands—Death of Magellan—Borneo—The Moluccas and their Productions—Separation of the Trinidad and Victoria—Return to Europe by the Cape of Good Hope—Last misadventures.
Magellan—His early life—His disappointments—His switch in nationality—Preparations for the expedition—Rio de Janeiro—St. Julian's Bay—Revolt by part of the squadron—Severe punishment for the guilty—Magellan's Strait—Patagonia—The Pacific—The Ladrone Islands—Cebu and the Philippine Islands—Magellan's death—Borneo—The Moluccas and their products—Separation of the Trinidad and Victoria—Return to Europe via the Cape of Good Hope—Final misadventures.
No one as yet was aware of the immense size of the continent discovered by Christopher Columbus. Still was sought perseveringly on the coast of America—which was thought to be a collection of several islands—the famous strait which should lead at once to the Pacific Ocean and to those Spice Islands the possession of which would have made the fortune of Spain. While Cortereal and Cabot were seeking for it in the Atlantic Ocean, and Cortès in the furthest part of the Gulf of California, while Pizarro was coasting along Peru, and Valdivia was conquering Chili, the solution of this problem was found by a Portuguese in the service of Spain, Ferdinand de Magellan.
No one knew yet how big the continent discovered by Christopher Columbus really was. They were still searching hard along the coast of America—which was thought to be just a group of islands—for the famous strait that would directly connect to the Pacific Ocean and the Spice Islands, the ownership of which would have made Spain rich. While Cortereal and Cabot were looking for it in the Atlantic Ocean, and Cortès was exploring the far end of the Gulf of California, while Pizarro was sailing along Peru, and Valdivia was conquering Chile, a Portuguese in the service of Spain, Ferdinand de Magellan, found the solution to this puzzle.
The son of a gentleman of Cota e Armas, Ferdinand de Magellan was born either at Oporto, at Lisbon, at Villa de Sabrossa, or at Villa de Figueiro, it is not actually known which; the date of his birth is unknown, but it took place towards the end of the fifteenth century. He had been brought up in the house of King John II., where he received as complete an education as could then be given him. After having made mathematics and navigation his special study—for at this time in Portugal there was an irresistible current which drew the whole country towards maritime expeditions and discoveries—Magellan early embraced a maritime career, and embarked in 1505 with Almeida, who was on his way to the Indies. He took part in the sacking of Quiloa, and in all the events of that campaign. The following year he accompanied Vaz Pereira to Sofala; then, on returning to the Malabar coast, we find him assisting Albuquerque at the taking of Malacca, and bearing himself on that occasion with equal prudence and bravery. He took part in the expedition sent by Albuquerque about 1510, to seek for the famous Spice Islands, under the command of Antonio de Abreu and of Francisco Serrão, which discovered Banda, Amboyna, Ternate, and Tidor. During this time Magellan had landed at the Malaysian Islands, distant 1800 miles from Malacca, and in the Archipelago of the Moluccas he had obtained the circumstantial information which gave birth in his mind to the idea of the voyage which he was destined to accomplish later on.
The son of a gentleman from Cota e Armas, Ferdinand de Magellan was born either in Oporto, Lisbon, Villa de Sabrossa, or Villa de Figueiro; it's not really known which. His birth date is also a mystery, but it happened towards the end of the fifteenth century. He was raised in the house of King John II., where he received as thorough an education as possible at that time. After focusing on mathematics and navigation—since Portugal was swept up in a wave of maritime exploration and discoveries—Magellan decided to pursue a career at sea and joined Almeida's expedition to the Indies in 1505. He participated in the sacking of Quiloa and all the events of that campaign. The following year, he went with Vaz Pereira to Sofala; then, upon returning to the Malabar coast, he assisted Albuquerque in capturing Malacca, showing both caution and courage. He took part in the expedition sent by Albuquerque around 1510 to search for the famous Spice Islands, led by Antonio de Abreu and Francisco Serrão, which discovered Banda, Amboyna, Ternate, and Tidor. During this time, Magellan landed in the Malaysian Islands, about 1,800 miles from Malacca, where in the Moluccas Archipelago, he gathered the detailed information that sparked the idea for the voyage he was meant to undertake later on.
![]() |
Magellan on board his caravel. From an old print. |
On his return to Portugal, Magellan obtained leave, though not without difficulty, to search through the royal archives. He soon became certain that the Moluccas were situated in the hemisphere which the bull of demarcation adopted at Tordesillas by the kings of Spain and Portugal, and confirmed in 1494 by Pope Alexander VI., had given to Spain.
On his return to Portugal, Magellan managed to get permission, though not easily, to search through the royal archives. He quickly became convinced that the Moluccas were located in the hemisphere assigned to Spain by the demarcation decree established at Tordesillas by the kings of Spain and Portugal, which was confirmed in 1494 by Pope Alexander VI.
In virtue of this line of demarcation, which was destined to give rise to so many impassioned debates, all the countries situated at 360 miles west of the meridian of the Cape de Verd Islands were to belong to Spain, and all those lying to the east of the same meridian to Portugal. Magellan was of too active a nature to remain long without again taking service; he went next to fight in Africa at Azamor, a town in Morocco, where he received a slight wound in his knee, but one which by injuring a nerve made him lame for the remainder of his life, and obliged him to return to Portugal. Conscious of the superiority which his theoretical and practical knowledge and his services had earned for him above the herd of courtiers, Magellan naturally felt more keenly than another would have done the unjust treatment he received from Emmanuel with regard to certain complaints laid by the people of Azamor against the Portuguese officers. King Emmanuel's prejudices soon changed to a real dislike. It showed itself by the outrageous imputation that Magellan was pretending to suffer from a wound which was really of no consequence and was completely cured, that he might escape from accusations which he could not refute. Such an assertion was a serious matter for the honour of Magellan, so susceptible and suspicious; he thereupon came to a desperate determination which corresponded moreover with the greatness of the insult which he had received. That no one might be ignorant of it, he caused it to be legally set forth that he renounced his rights as a Portuguese citizen, and changed his nationality, and he then took out letters of naturalization in Spain. This was to proclaim, as solemnly as could possibly be done, that he intended to be looked upon as a subject of the crown of Castille, to which henceforward he would consecrate his services and his whole life. This was a serious determination, as we can see, which no one blamed, and which even the most severe historians, such as Barros and Faria y Sousa, have excused.
Due to this line of division, which sparked many heated debates, all countries located 360 miles west of the Cape Verde Islands' meridian would belong to Spain, and those to the east would belong to Portugal. Magellan was too driven to stay inactive for long, so he went on to fight in Africa at Azamor, a town in Morocco, where he sustained a minor wound to his knee. However, this injury damaged a nerve, leaving him lame for the rest of his life and forcing him to return to Portugal. Aware of the advantage his theoretical and practical knowledge, along with his service, had given him over many courtiers, Magellan felt the unfair treatment he received from Emmanuel regarding the complaints made by the people of Azamor against the Portuguese officers much more acutely than others might have. King Emmanuel's biases quickly turned into outright dislike. This was evident when he made the outrageous claim that Magellan was feigning a wound that was actually minor and fully healed to avoid accusations he couldn't counter. Such a claim was a serious blow to Magellan's reputation, which was highly sensitive and suspicious; he then made a drastic decision that matched the gravity of the insult he had endured. To ensure everyone knew, he had it legally stated that he renounced his rights as a Portuguese citizen and changed his nationality, subsequently obtaining letters of naturalization in Spain. This was a formal declaration that he intended to be recognized as a subject of the crown of Castille, to which he would henceforth dedicate his services and entire life. This was a momentous decision, as we can see, which no one condemned, and even the most critical historians, like Barros and Faria y Sousa, have excused.
At the same time as Magellan, the licentiate Rey Faleiro left Lisbon with his brother Francisco and a merchant named Christovam de Haro; the former was a man deeply versed in cosmographical knowledge, and had equally with Magellan fallen under Emmanuel's displeasure. Faleiro had entered into a treaty of partnership with Magellan to reach the Moluccas by a new way, but one which was not otherwise specified, and which remained Magellan's secret. As soon as they arrived in Spain, (1517), the two partners submitted their project to Charles V., who accepted it in principle; but there remained the always delicate question touching the means for putting it into execution. Happily, Magellan found in Juan de Aranda, the factor of the Chamber of Commerce, an enthusiastic partisan of his theories, and one who promised to exert all his influence to make the enterprise a success. He had an interview accordingly with the high Chancellor, the Cardinal and Bishop of Burgos, Fonseca. He set forth with such skill the great advantage that Spain would derive from the discovery of a route leading to the very centre of the spice production, and the great prejudice which it would cause to the trade of Portugal, that an agreement was signed on the 22nd of March, 1518. The Emperor undertook to pay all the expenses of the expedition on condition that the greater part of the profits should belong to him.
At the same time as Magellan, Rey Faleiro, a licensed navigator, left Lisbon with his brother Francisco and a merchant named Christovam de Haro. Faleiro was well-versed in navigation and had also fallen out of favor with Emmanuel, just like Magellan. Faleiro had made a partnership agreement with Magellan to find a new route to the Moluccas, though the specifics of this route remained a secret known only to Magellan. When they arrived in Spain in 1517, the two partners presented their plan to Charles V, who approved it in principle. However, the tricky issue of how to carry it out still needed to be addressed. Fortunately, Magellan found a strong ally in Juan de Aranda, the Chamber of Commerce factor, who was enthusiastic about his ideas and promised to use his influence to ensure the project's success. He then met with the high Chancellor, Cardinal and Bishop of Burgos, Fonseca. Aranda skillfully outlined the significant benefits Spain would gain from discovering a route to the heart of spice production, as well as the harm it would cause to Portugal's trade. This led to an agreement being signed on March 22, 1518. The Emperor agreed to cover all expedition expenses on the condition that he would receive the majority of the profits.
But Magellan had still many obstacles to surmount before taking to the sea. In the first place there were the remonstrances of the Portuguese ambassador, Alvaro de Costa, who, seeing that his endeavours were in vain, even tried to compass the assassination of Magellan, so says Faria y Sousa. Then he encountered the ill-will of the employés of the Casa de contratacion at Seville, who were jealous of a stranger being entrusted with the command of such an important expedition, and envious of the least token of favour which had been accorded to Magellan and Rey Faleiro, who had been named commanders of the order of St. James. But Charles V. had given his consent by a public act, which seemed to be irrevocable. They tried, however, to make the Emperor alter his decision by organizing, on the 22nd of October, 1518, a disturbance paid for with Portuguese gold. It broke out on the pretext that Magellan, who had just had one of his ships drawn on shore for repairs and painting, had decorated it with the Portuguese arms. This last attempt failed miserably, and three statutes of the 30th of March, and 6th and 30th of April, fixed the composition of the crews and named the staff; while a final official document dated from Barcelona the 26th of July, 1519, confided the sole command of the expedition to Magellan.
But Magellan still had many challenges to overcome before setting sail. First, there were the objections from the Portuguese ambassador, Alvaro de Costa, who, realizing his efforts were futile, even tried to orchestrate Magellan's assassination, according to Faria y Sousa. Then he faced the resentment of the employees at the Casa de Contratacion in Seville, who were jealous of a foreigner being given command of such an important expedition and envious of any favor shown to Magellan and Rey Faleiro, who had been named commanders of the Order of St. James. However, Charles V. had given his approval through an official act, which seemed binding. Nevertheless, they attempted to persuade the Emperor to change his mind by staging a disturbance on October 22, 1518, funded by Portuguese gold. This erupted under the pretext that Magellan, who had recently brought one of his ships ashore for repairs and painting, had adorned it with Portuguese arms. This last effort failed miserably, and three decrees from March 30, and April 6 and 30 established the crew structure and named the staff; while a final official document from Barcelona dated July 26, 1519, granted Magellan sole command of the expedition.
What had meanwhile been happening to Rey Faleiro? We cannot exactly say. But this man, who had up to this time been treated on the same footing as Magellan, and who had perhaps first conceived the project, now found himself quite excluded from the command of the expedition, after some dissensions of which the cause is unknown. His health, already shaken, received a last shock from this affront, and poor Rey Faleiro, who had become almost childish, having returned to Portugal to see his family, was arrested there, and only released upon the intercession of Charles V. At last, after having sworn fidelity and homage to the crown of Castille, Magellan received in his turn the oath of his officers and sailors, and left the port of San Lucar de Barrameda on the morning of the 10th of August, 1519.
What had been happening to Rey Faleiro in the meantime? We can't say for sure. But this man, who had been treated as an equal to Magellan until now and who may have originally come up with the idea, found himself completely excluded from leading the expedition after some disagreements of which the reasons are unclear. His already weakened health took a final hit from this insult, and poor Rey Faleiro, who had become almost childlike, returned to Portugal to see his family, where he was arrested and only set free after Charles V intervened. Finally, after swearing loyalty and allegiance to the crown of Castile, Magellan received the oaths of his officers and sailors and left the port of San Lucar de Barrameda on the morning of August 10, 1519.
But before entering on the narrative of this memorable campaign, we must give a few particulars of the man who has left us the most complete account of it, Francesco Antonio Pigafetta or Jerome Pigaphète as he is often called in France. Born at Venice about 1491, of a noble family, Pigafetta formed part of the suite of the Ambassador Francesco Chiericalco, sent by Leo X. to Charles V., who was then at Barcelona. His attention was no doubt aroused by the noise which the preparations for the expedition made at that time in Spain, and he obtained permission to take part in the voyage. This volunteer proved an excellent recruit, for he showed himself in every respect as faithful and intelligent an observer as he was a brave and courageous companion. He was wounded at the battle of Zebu, fighting beside Magellan, which prevented him from being present at the banquet during which so many of his companions were destined to lose their lives. As to his narrative, with the exception of some exaggerations of detail according to the taste of that time, it is exact, and the greater part of the descriptions which we owe to him have been verified by modern travellers and learned men, especially by M. Alcide d'Orbigny.
But before diving into the story of this memorable campaign, we need to share a few details about the man who left us the most thorough account of it, Francesco Antonio Pigafetta, or Jerome Pigaphète as he’s often called in France. Born in Venice around 1491 into a noble family, Pigafetta was part of the entourage of Ambassador Francesco Chiericalco, who was sent by Leo X to Charles V, then in Barcelona. His interest was likely piqued by the buzz surrounding the expedition preparations in Spain, and he got permission to join the voyage. This volunteer turned out to be an excellent addition, as he was a faithful and insightful observer as well as a brave and courageous companion. He was wounded in the battle of Zebu while fighting alongside Magellan, which kept him from attending the banquet where many of his companions would meet their end. As for his account, aside from some embellishments typical of that era, it is accurate, and most of the descriptions we attribute to him have been confirmed by modern travelers and scholars, especially by M. Alcide d'Orbigny.
Upon his return to San Lucar on the 6th of September, 1522, after having fulfilled the vow which he had made to go bare-foot to return thanks to Nuesta Señora de la Victoria, the Lombard (as they called him on board the Victoria,) presented to Charles V., then at Valladolid, a complete journal of the voyage. When he returned to Italy, by means of the original as well as of some supplementary notes, he wrote a longer narrative of the expedition, at the request of Pope Clement VII. and of Villiers de l'Isle Adam, grand-master of the Knights of Malta. He sent copies of this work to several distinguished personages, and notably to Louisa of Savoy, mother of Francis I. But she not understanding, so thinks Harrisse, the very learned author of the Bibliotheca Americana Vetustissima, the kind of patois used by Pigafetta, and which resembles a mixture of Italian, Venetian, and Spanish, employed a certain Jacques Antoine Fabre to translate it into French. Instead of giving a faithful translation, Fabre made a kind of abridgment of it. Some critics, however, suppose that this narrative must have been written originally in French; they found their opinion upon the existence of three French manuscripts of the sixteenth century, which give very different readings, and of which two are deposited in the Bibliothèque Nationale at Paris.
Upon his return to San Lucar on September 6, 1522, after fulfilling his vow to walk barefoot in gratitude to Nuesta Señora de la Victoria, the Lombard (as he was called on board the Victoria) presented a complete journal of the voyage to Charles V., who was then in Valladolid. After returning to Italy, using both the original journal and some additional notes, he wrote a longer account of the expedition at the request of Pope Clement VII. and Villiers de l'Isle Adam, grand master of the Knights of Malta. He sent copies of this work to several notable figures, including Louisa of Savoy, mother of Francis I. However, since she did not understand the kind of patois used by Pigafetta, which resembles a mix of Italian, Venetian, and Spanish, she hired a certain Jacques Antoine Fabre to translate it into French. Instead of providing an accurate translation, Fabre produced a sort of abridgment. Some critics believe this narrative may have originally been written in French, based on the existence of three French manuscripts from the sixteenth century that have significantly different readings, two of which are held in the Bibliothèque Nationale in Paris.
Pigafetta died at Venice about 1534, in a house in the Rue de la Lune, which in 1800 was still to be seen, and which bore the well-known device, "No rose without a thorn."
Pigafetta died in Venice around 1534, in a house on Rue de la Lune, which was still standing in 1800 and had the famous saying, "No rose without a thorn."
At the same time, not wishing to confine ourselves to Pigafetta's narrative entirely, we have compared and completed it with that of Maximilian Transylvain, secretary to Charles V., of which there is an Italian translation in Ramusio's valuable collection.
At the same time, not wanting to limit ourselves to Pigafetta's story entirely, we have compared and supplemented it with that of Maximilian Transylvain, secretary to Charles V., which has an Italian translation in Ramusio's valuable collection.
The fleet of Magellan consisted of the Trinidad, of 120 tons' burden, which carried the flag of the commander of the expedition; the Sant'-Antonio, also of 120 tons, commanded by Juan de Carthagena, the second in rank, the person joined with Magellan, says the official document; the Concepcion, of 90 tons, commanded by Gaspar de Quesada; the famous Victoria, of 85 tons, commanded by Luis de Mendoza; and lastly the Santiago, of 75 tons, commanded by Joao Serrâo, called by the Spaniards Serrano.
The fleet of Magellan included the Trinidad, weighing 120 tons and serving as the flagship of the expedition leader; the Sant'-Antonio, also 120 tons, commanded by Juan de Carthagena, the second-in-command, as stated in the official document; the Concepcion, which weighed 90 tons and was led by Gaspar de Quesada; the well-known Victoria, at 85 tons, commanded by Luis de Mendoza; and finally, the Santiago, at 75 tons, led by Joao Serrâo, referred to by the Spaniards as Serrano.
Four of these captains and nearly all the pilots were Portuguese. Barbosa and Gomez on board the Trinidad, Luis Alfonso de Goez and Vasco Gallego on the Victoria, Serrâo, Joao Lopez de Carvalho on the Concepcion, Joao Rodriguez de Moefrapil on the Sant'-Antonio, and Joao Serrâo on the Santiago, with 25 sailors, formed a total of 33 Portuguese out of the whole body of 237 individuals whose names have all been handed down to us, and amongst whom are found a considerable number of Frenchmen.
Four of these captains and almost all the pilots were Portuguese. Barbosa and Gomez were on the Trinidad; Luis Alfonso de Goez and Vasco Gallego were on the Victoria; Serrâo and Joao Lopez de Carvalho were on the Concepcion; Joao Rodriguez de Moefrapil was on the Sant'-Antonio; and Joao Serrâo was on the Santiago. With 25 sailors, there were a total of 33 Portuguese among the 237 individuals whose names have been recorded, which also includes a fair number of Frenchmen.
Of the officers whose names have been mentioned, it is to be remembered that Duarte Barbosa was brother-in-law to Magellan and that Estavam Gomez, who, by returning to Seville on the 6th of May, 1521, did not participate in the conclusion of this memorable voyage, was afterwards sent by Charles V. to seek for the north-west passage, and in 1524 sailed along the coast of America from Florida to Rhode Island, and perhaps as far as Cape Cod.
Of the officers mentioned, it’s important to note that Duarte Barbosa was Magellan’s brother-in-law. Estavam Gomez, who returned to Seville on May 6, 1521, and didn’t take part in the conclusion of this remarkable voyage, was later sent by Charles V to search for the northwest passage. In 1524, he traveled along the American coast from Florida to Rhode Island, and possibly as far as Cape Cod.
Nothing could have been better arranged than this expedition, for the equipment of which the whole resources of the nautical science of that epoch had been taxed. At the moment of departure Magellan gave his last orders to his pilots and captains, and the code of signals which were to ensure unanimity in manoeuvres, and prevent a possible separation.
Nothing could have been better organized than this expedition, for which the entire knowledge of maritime science at that time had been utilized. At the moment of departure, Magellan gave his final instructions to his pilots and captains, along with the signal code designed to ensure coordinated movements and prevent any possible separation.
On Monday morning, the 10th of August, 1519, the fleet weighed anchor and sailed down the Guadalquiver as far as San Lucar de Barrameda, which forms the port of Seville, where the victualling of the ships was completed, and it was the 20th of September before they were really off. Six days afterwards the fleet anchored at Teneriffe in the Canary Archipelago, where both wood and water were taken on board. It was on leaving this island that the first symptoms appeared of the misunderstanding between Magellan and Juan de Carthagena which was to prove so fatal to the expedition. The latter claimed to be informed by the commander-in-chief of the route which he intended to take, a claim which was at once rejected by Magellan, who declared that he was not called upon to give any explanation to his subordinate.
On Monday morning, August 10, 1519, the fleet lifted anchor and sailed down the Guadalquivir River to San Lucar de Barrameda, the port of Seville, where the ships were fully stocked. It wasn’t until September 20 that they actually set off. Six days later, the fleet anchored at Tenerife in the Canary Islands, where they gathered wood and water. As they were leaving this island, the first signs of conflict arose between Magellan and Juan de Carthagena, which would ultimately be disastrous for the expedition. Carthagena insisted that the commander-in-chief should inform him of the route he planned to take, a request that Magellan immediately dismissed, stating that he didn’t need to provide any explanations to his subordinate.
After having passed between the Cape de Verd Islands and Africa, the ships reached the shores of Sierra Leone, where contrary winds and dead calms detained the fleet for twenty days.
After passing between the Cape Verde Islands and Africa, the ships arrived at the shores of Sierra Leone, where conflicting winds and stillness kept the fleet stuck for twenty days.
![]() |
Juan de Carthagena placed in the stocks. |
A painful incident now occurred. During a council which was held on board the flag-ship, a sharp dispute arose, and Juan de Carthagena, who affected to treat the Captain-general with contempt, having answered him with pride and insolence, Magellan felt obliged to arrest him with his own hand, and to have him put in the stocks, an instrument made of two pieces of wood placed one upon the other and pierced with holes, in which were placed the legs of the sailor who was to be punished. The other captains remonstrated loudly with Magellan against a punishment which was too degrading for a superior officer, and Carthagena in consequence was simply put under arrest, and guarded by one of the captains. To the calms now succeeded rain, tempests, and heavy squalls, which obliged the vessels to lie-to. During these storms the navigators several times witnessed an electric phenomenon of which the cause was not then known, but which they considered an undoubted sign of the protection of heaven, and which even at the present day is known by the name of St. Elmo's fire. Once past the equinoctial line—a passage which does not at that time seem to have been celebrated by the grotesque ceremony of baptism which is in vogue at the present day—they steered for Brazil, where, on the 13th of December, 1519, the fleet cast anchor in the magnificent port of Santa Lucia, now known under the name of Rio Janeiro. This was not, however, the first time that this bay had been seen by Europeans, as was long believed. Since the year 1511 it had been known under the name of Bahia do Cabo Frio. It had been visited also, four years before Magellan's arrival, by Pero Lopez, and seems to have been frequented since the commencement of the sixteenth century by mariners from Dieppe who, inheritors of the passion for adventurous navigation of their ancestors the North-men, roamed over the world, and founded small establishments or factories in all directions. Here the Spanish expedition procured cheaply, in exchange for looking-glasses, pieces of ribbon, scissors, hawks' bells or fish-hooks, a quantity of provisions, amongst which Pigafetta mentions pine-apples, sugar-canes, sweet potatoes, fowls, and the flesh of the Anta, which is thought to be the tapir.
A painful incident took place. During a meeting on the flagship, a heated argument erupted, and Juan de Carthagena, who acted as if he looked down on the Captain-general, responded with arrogance and disrespect. As a result, Magellan felt compelled to physically restrain him and put him in the stocks, a device made of two pieces of wood stacked on top of each other with holes in them for the legs of the sailor being punished. The other captains strongly objected to Magellan's punishment, saying it was too demeaning for a senior officer, so Carthagena was instead placed under arrest and guarded by one of the captains. Following the calm, they faced rain, storms, and heavy squalls that forced the ships to wait. During these storms, the navigators observed an electrical phenomenon, the cause of which was unknown at the time, but they believed it was a clear sign of divine protection, now known today as St. Elmo's fire. After crossing the equatorial line—a journey that wasn't celebrated by the odd baptism ceremony that we have today—they headed for Brazil, where on December 13, 1519, the fleet anchored in the stunning harbor of Santa Lucia, which is now known as Rio de Janeiro. However, this wasn't the first time this bay had been seen by Europeans, as was long assumed. Since 1511, it had been referred to as Bahia do Cabo Frio. It had also been visited four years before Magellan's arrival by Pero Lopez and seems to have been frequented since the early sixteenth century by sailors from Dieppe, who, inheriting their ancestors' love for adventurous navigation, roamed the world and established small settlements or trading posts everywhere. Here, the Spanish expedition managed to obtain a variety of provisions at a low price, trading items like mirrors, ribbons, scissors, hawks' bells, and fish-hooks, which included pineapples, sugarcane, sweet potatoes, chickens, and the flesh of the Anta, thought to be the tapir.
The account given in the same narrative of the manners of the inhabitants is sufficiently curious to be repeated. "The Brazilians are not Christians," he says, "but no more are they idolaters, for they worship nothing; natural instinct is their only law." This is an interesting fact, and a singular avowal for an Italian of the sixteenth century, deeply imbued with superstition; it offers one more proof that the idea of the Divinity is not innate, as some theologians have imagined. "These natives live to a great age, they go entirely naked, and sleep in cotton nets called hammocks, suspended by the two ends to beams. As to their boats, called canoes, each is hollowed out of the single trunk of a tree and can hold as many as forty men. They are anthropophagi (cannibals), but only on special occasions, and scarcely ever eat any but their enemies taken in battle. Their dress of ceremony is a kind of vest made of paroquets' feathers, woven together, and so arranged that the large wing and tail-feathers form a sort of girdle round their loins, which gives them a whimsical and ridiculous appearance."
The account shared in the same narrative about the behavior of the inhabitants is interesting enough to be repeated. "The Brazilians are not Christians," he says, "but they aren't idolaters either, because they worship nothing; their only law is natural instinct." This is a fascinating detail and a unique admission for a superstitious Italian from the sixteenth century; it provides further evidence that the concept of the Divine is not inherent, as some theologians have thought. "These natives live to a great age, they go completely naked, and sleep in cotton nets called hammocks, which are hung by both ends from beams. Their boats, known as canoes, are each carved from a single tree trunk and can hold up to forty men. They are cannibals, but only on special occasions, and they rarely eat anyone except their enemies captured in battle. Their ceremonial dress consists of a kind of vest made from parrot feathers, woven together so that the large wing and tail feathers create a sort of belt around their waists, which gives them a quirky and ridiculous look."
We have already said that the feather cloak was in use on the shores of the Pacific, among the Peruvians; it is curious to ascertain that it was worn equally by the Brazilians. Some specimens of this singular garment may be seen at the exhibition of the Ethnographical Museum. This was not however the only ornament of these savages; they suspended little stone cylinders from three holes pierced in the lower lip, a custom which is common among many of the Oceanic people, and which may be compared with our fashion of ear-rings. These people were extremely credulous and of good disposition and thus, as Pigafetta says, they could easily have been converted to Christianity, for they assisted in silence, and with gravity, at the mass which was said on shore, a remark that Alvarez Cabral had already made.
We’ve already mentioned that the feather cloak was worn on the shores of the Pacific by the Peruvians; it’s interesting to note that it was also worn by the Brazilians. Some examples of this unique garment can be seen at the Ethnographical Museum exhibition. However, this wasn’t the only adornment these people had; they hung small stone cylinders from three holes pierced in their lower lip, a custom common among many Oceanic cultures, similar to our practice of wearing earrings. These individuals were very gullible and had a good nature, so, as Pigafetta noted, they could have easily been converted to Christianity. They watched the mass held on the shore in silence and with seriousness, a point that Alvarez Cabral had already observed.
![]() |
The Coast of Brazil. |
After remaining thirteen days in this place, the squadron continued its route to the south, coasting along the shore, and arrived at 34° 40' of south latitude in a country where flowed a large river of fresh water. It was the La Plata. The natives, called Charruas, were so frightened at the sight of the vessels that they hastily took refuge in the interior of the country, carrying with them all their valuables, and it was impossible to overtake any of them. It was in this country that four years previously, Juan Diaz de Solis had been massacred by a tribe of Charruas, armed with that terrible engine which is still in use at the present day among the gauchos of the Argentine Republic, the bolas, which are metal balls fastened to the two ends of a long leather thong, called a lasso.
After staying in this place for thirteen days, the squadron continued south along the coast and reached 34° 40' south latitude, where a large freshwater river flowed. It was the La Plata. The locals, known as the Charruas, were so scared when they saw the ships that they quickly retreated deep into the land, taking all their valuables with them, and it was impossible to catch up with any of them. It was in this area that four years earlier, Juan Diaz de Solis had been killed by a Charruas tribe, armed with a dangerous weapon still used today by the gauchos of the Argentine Republic, the bolas, which are metal balls attached to the ends of a long leather thong called a lasso.
A little below the estuary of the La Plata, once thought to be an arm of the sea opening into the Pacific, the flotilla anchored at Port Desire. Here they obtained an ample supply of penguins for the crews of the five vessels—a bird which did not make a very delicious meal. Then they anchored in 49° 30' in a beautiful harbour, where Magellan resolved to winter, and which received the name of St. Julian's Bay. The Spaniards had been two months there, when one day they perceived a man who seemed to them to be of gigantic stature. At sight of them he began dancing and singing and throwing dust upon his head. This was a Patagonian, who allowed himself without resistance to be taken on board the vessels. He showed the greatest surprise at all he saw around him, but nothing astonished him so much as a large steel mirror which was presented to him. "The giant, who had not the least idea of the use of this piece of furniture, and who, no doubt, now saw his own face for the first time, drew back in such terror, that he threw to the ground four of our people who were behind him." He was taken back on shore loaded with presents, and the kind welcome which he had received induced eighteen of his companions, thirteen women and five men, to come on board. They were tall, and had broad faces, painted red except the eyes, which were encircled with yellow; their hair was whitened with lime, they were wrapped in enormous fur cloaks, and wore those large leather boots from which was given to them the name of Large-feet or Patagonians. Their stature was not, however, so gigantic as it appeared to our simple narrator, for it varies from 5ft. 10in. to 5ft. 8in., being somewhat above the middle height among Europeans. For arms they had a short massive bow, and arrows made of reed, of which the point was formed of a sharp pebble.
A little downstream from the La Plata estuary, which was once thought to be a sea inlet leading to the Pacific, the fleet anchored at Port Desire. Here, they managed to gather a good supply of penguins for the crews of the five ships—a bird that wasn't exactly a tasty meal. Next, they anchored at 49° 30' in a beautiful harbor, where Magellan decided to spend the winter, naming it St. Julian's Bay. The Spaniards had been there for two months when one day they spotted a man who seemed to be gigantic. Upon seeing them, he started dancing, singing, and throwing dust on his head. This was a Patagonian, who willingly allowed himself to be taken aboard the ships. He was extremely surprised by everything around him, but nothing shocked him more than a large steel mirror that was shown to him. "The giant, who had no idea what this object was and likely saw his own face for the first time, recoiled in such fear that he knocked down four of our crew members who were behind him." He was taken back to shore with gifts, and the warm welcome he received encouraged eighteen of his companions, thirteen women and five men, to come aboard. They were tall with broad faces painted red except for their eyes, which were outlined in yellow; their hair was dusted with lime, they were wrapped in huge fur cloaks, and they wore large leather boots, which earned them the name of Large-feet or Patagonians. However, their height was not as gigantic as our simple narrator believed, ranging from 5ft. 10in. to 5ft. 8in., which is somewhat above average for Europeans. For weapons, they had short, sturdy bows and arrows made of reeds with sharp pebble tips.
The captain, to retain two of these savages whom he wished to take to Europe, used a stratagem, which we should characterize as hateful in the present day, but which had nothing revolting about it for the sixteenth century, when Indians and negroes were universally considered to be a kind of brute beasts. Magellan loaded these Indians with presents, and when he saw them embarrassed with the quantity, he offered to each of them one of those iron rings used for chaining captives. They would have desired to carry them away, for they valued iron above everything, but their hands were full. It was then proposed to fasten the rings to their legs, to which they agreed without suspicion. The sailors then closed the rings, so that the savages found themselves in fetters. Nothing can give an idea of their fury when they discovered this stratagem, worthy rather of savages than of civilized men. The capture of others was attempted, but in vain, and in the chase one of the Spaniards was wounded by a poisoned arrow, which caused his death almost instantaneously. Intrepid hunters, these people wander about perpetually in pursuit of guanaquis and other game; they are endowed with such wonderful voracity "that what would suffice for the nourishment of twenty sailors, can scarcely satisfy seven or eight of them." Magellan, foreseeing that the stay here was likely to be prolonged, and perceiving that the country only presented meagre resources, gave orders to economize the provisions, and to put the men on fixed rations, that they might not experience too great privations before the spring, when they might reach a country where there was more game. But the Spaniards, discontented at the sterility of the place, and at the length and rigour of the winter, began to murmur. This land seemed to stretch southwards as far as the Antarctic pole, they said; there did not seem to be any strait; already several had died from the privations they had endured; lastly it was time to return to Spain, if the commander did not wish to see all his men perish in this place.
The captain, wanting to keep two of these natives he intended to take to Europe, used a trick that we would probably call cruel today, but which wasn't shocking in the sixteenth century when Indigenous people and Black people were typically seen as less than human. Magellan loaded these natives with gifts, and when they struggled with the weight, he offered to each of them one of those iron rings used for chaining captives. They would have liked to take them, since they valued iron above everything, but their hands were full. It was then suggested to attach the rings to their legs, and they agreed without hesitation. The sailors then closed the rings, trapping the natives in shackles. You can't imagine their rage when they realized this trick, which seemed more fitting for savages than civilized people. They tried to capture others, but it didn't work, and during the chase, one of the Spaniards was hit with a poisoned arrow that killed him almost instantly. These people are fearless hunters, always on the lookout for guanaquis and other game; their appetite is so incredible that what would feed twenty sailors hardly fills seven or eight of them. Anticipating that their stay might be extended and noticing the scarcity of resources in the area, Magellan ordered the rationing of supplies so that the men wouldn’t suffer too much before spring, when they could reach a place with more game. But the Spaniards, unhappy with the barren land and the harshness of winter, started to complain. They said this land seemed to stretch southward all the way to the Antarctic pole; there appeared to be no strait; several men had already died from the hardships; and it was high time to head back to Spain if the commander didn’t want to see all his men perish here.
Magellan, fully resolved to die, or else to bring the enterprise he commanded to a successful issue, replied that the Emperor had assigned him the course which the voyage was to take, and he neither could nor would depart from it under any pretext, and that in consequence, he should go straight forward to the end of this land, or until he met with some strait. As to provisions, if they found them insufficient, his men might add to their rations the produce of their fishing or hunting. Magellan thought that so firm a declaration would impose silence on the malcontents, and that he would hear no more of privations, from which he suffered equally with his crews. He deceived himself completely. Certain of the captains, and Juan de Carthagena in particular, were interested in causing a revolt to break out. These rebels therefore began by reminding the Spaniards of their old animosity against the Portuguese. The captain-general being one of the latter nation, had never, according to them, tendered a whole-hearted allegiance to the Spanish flag. In order to be able to return to his own country and to gain pardon for what he had done wrong, he wished to commit some heinous crime, and nothing could be more advantageous to Portugal than the destruction of this fine fleet. Instead of leading them to the Archipelago of the Moluccas, of the riches of which he had boasted to them, he wished to take them into frozen regions, the dwelling-place of eternal snow, where he could easily manage that they should all perish; then with the help of the Portuguese on board the squadron, he would take back to his own country the vessels which he had seized.
Magellan, determined to either die or successfully complete his mission, stated that the Emperor had given him the route for the voyage, and he could not and would not deviate from it for any reason. He planned to continue straight to the end of the land or until he found a strait. As for supplies, if they ran low, his men could supplement their rations with whatever they could catch while fishing or hunting. Magellan believed that such a firm statement would silence the dissenters and that he would no longer hear complaints about shortages, which he also faced alongside his crew. He was completely mistaken. Certain captains, particularly Juan de Carthagena, had a vested interest in inciting a rebellion. These dissenters began by reminding the Spaniards of their long-standing hostility towards the Portuguese. They claimed that since the captain-general was from Portugal, he had never truly pledged loyalty to the Spanish flag. They suggested that to return home and seek forgiveness for his past mistakes, he intended to commit a terrible act, and nothing would benefit Portugal more than the destruction of this impressive fleet. Instead of guiding them to the rich Moluccas, as he had promised, he aimed to lead them into icy regions, a place of eternal snow, where it would be easy for him to ensure their demise; then, with the help of the Portuguese on board, he would take back the seized vessels to his homeland.
Such were the reports and accusations that the partisans of Juan de Carthagena, Luis de Mendoza, and Gaspar de Quesada had disseminated among the sailors, when on Palm Sunday, the 1st of April, 1520, Magellan summoned the captains, officers, and pilots, to hear mass on board his vessel and to dine with him afterwards. Alvaro de la Mesquita, a cousin of the captain-general, accepted this invitation with Antonio de Coca and his officers, but neither Mendoza nor Quesada, nor Juan de Carthagena, who was Quesada's prisoner, appeared. The next night the malcontents boarded the Sant'-Antonio with thirty of the men of the Concepcion, and desired to have La Mesquita given up to them. The pilot, Juan de Eliorraga, while defending his captain, received four stabs from a poniard in the arm. Quesada cried out at the same time, "You will see that this fool will make our business fail." The three vessels, the Concepcion, Sant'-Antonio, and Santiago, fell without difficulty into the hands of the rebels, who reckoned more than one accomplice among the crews. In spite of this success, the three captains did not dare openly to attack the commander-in-chief, and sent to him some proposals for a reconciliation. Magellan ordered them to come on board the Trinidad to confer with him; but this they stoutly refused to do, whereupon Magellan, having no further need of caution, had the boat seized which had brought him this answer, and choosing six strong and brave men from amongst his crew, he sent them on board the Victoria under the command of the alguazil Espinosa. He carried a letter from Magellan to Mendoza enjoining him to come on board the Trinidad, and when Mendoza smiled in a scornful manner, Espinosa stabbed him in the throat with a poniard, while a sailor struck him on the head with a cutlass. While these events were taking place, another boat, laden with fifteen armed men, came alongside the Victoria, and took possession of her without any resistance from the sailors, surprised by the rapidity of the action. On the next day, the 3rd of April, the two other rebel vessels were taken, not however without bloodshed. Mendoza's body was divided into quarters, while a clerk read in a loud voice the sentence that blasted his memory. Three days afterwards, Quesada was beheaded and cut in pieces by his own servant, who undertook this sad task to save his own life. As to Carthagena, the high rank which the royal edict had conferred upon him in the expedition saved him from death, but with Gomez de la Reina, the chaplain, he was left behind on the shore, where some months afterwards he was found by Estevam Gomez. Forty sailors convicted of rebellion were pardoned because their services were considered indispensable. After this severe lesson Magellan might well hope that the mutinous spirit was really subdued.
Such were the reports and accusations that the supporters of Juan de Carthagena, Luis de Mendoza, and Gaspar de Quesada had spread among the sailors when, on Palm Sunday, April 1, 1520, Magellan called the captains, officers, and pilots to hear mass on his ship and have dinner with him afterward. Alvaro de la Mesquita, a cousin of the captain-general, accepted the invitation along with Antonio de Coca and his crew, but neither Mendoza nor Quesada, nor Juan de Carthagena, who was Quesada's prisoner, showed up. That night, the discontented boarded the Sant'-Antonio with thirty men from the Concepcion and demanded that La Mesquita be handed over to them. The pilot, Juan de Eliorraga, while defending his captain, was stabbed four times in the arm with a dagger. Quesada shouted at the same time, "You’ll see that this fool will ruin our plans." The three ships, the Concepcion, Sant'-Antonio, and Santiago, easily fell into the hands of the rebels, who had more than one accomplice among the crews. Despite this success, the three captains did not dare to openly attack the commander-in-chief and sent him some proposals for reconciliation. Magellan ordered them to come aboard the Trinidad to discuss it with him, but they stubbornly refused. Consequently, Magellan, having no need for restraint, seized the boat that had brought him this response and selected six strong and brave men from his crew to send them to the Victoria under the command of the alguazil Espinosa. He carried a letter from Magellan to Mendoza, ordering him to come aboard the Trinidad, and when Mendoza smirked scornfully, Espinosa stabbed him in the throat with a dagger, while a sailor hit him on the head with a cutlass. While all this was happening, another boat, loaded with fifteen armed men, pulled alongside the Victoria and took control of it without any resistance from the sailors, who were caught off guard by the swift action. The following day, April 3, the two other rebel ships were captured, but not without bloodshed. Mendoza's body was divided into quarters while a clerk loudly read the sentence that condemned his memory. Three days later, Quesada was beheaded and dismembered by his own servant, who performed this tragic act to save his life. As for Carthagena, the high rank granted to him by the royal decree in the expedition saved him from death, but along with Gomez de la Reina, the chaplain, he was left on the shore, where he was later found by Estevam Gomez a few months later. Forty sailors convicted of rebellion were pardoned because their services were deemed essential. After this harsh lesson, Magellan could be hopeful that the rebellious spirit was truly subdued.
When the temperature became milder the anchors were weighed; the squadron put to sea on the 24th of August, following the coast, and carefully exploring all the gulfs to find that strait which had been so persistently sought. At the level of Cape St. Croix, one of the vessels, the Santiago, was lost on the rocks during a violent gale from the east. Happily both the men and merchandise on board were saved, and they succeeded also in taking from the wrecked vessel the rigging and appurtenances of the ship, which they divided among the four remaining vessels.
When the weather got warmer, they weighed anchor; the squadron set sail on August 24th, following the coast and carefully exploring all the bays to find the strait that had been sought after for so long. Near Cape St. Croix, one of the ships, the Santiago, was lost on the rocks during a severe eastward storm. Fortunately, both the crew and the cargo on board were rescued, and they also managed to salvage the rigging and other gear from the wrecked ship, which they shared among the four remaining vessels.
At last on the 21st of October, according to Pigafetta, the 27th of November according to Maximilian Transylvain, the flotilla penetrated by a narrow entrance into a gulf, at the bottom of which a strait opened, which as they soon saw passed into the sea to the south. First they called this the Strait of the Eleven Thousand Virgins, because this was the day dedicated to them. On each side of the strait rose high land covered with snow, on which they saw numerous fires, especially to the left, but they were unable to obtain any communication with the natives. The details which Pigafetta and Martin Transylvain have given with regard to the topographical and hydrographical dispositions of this strait are rather vague, and as we shall have to mention it again when we speak of De Bougainville's expedition, we shall not dilate upon it now. After sailing for twenty-two days across this succession of narrow inlets and arms of the sea, in some places three miles wide, in some twelve, which extends for a distance of 440 miles and has received the name of Magellan's Strait, the flotilla emerged upon a sea of immense extent and great depth.
Finally, on October 21st, according to Pigafetta, and November 27th according to Maximilian Transylvain, the flotilla passed through a narrow entrance into a gulf, at the end of which a strait opened up that soon revealed a passage into the sea to the south. They initially called this the Strait of the Eleven Thousand Virgins, as it was dedicated to them. High land covered in snow rose on either side of the strait, and they saw numerous fires, particularly on the left, but they could not make any contact with the locals. The descriptions that Pigafetta and Martin Transylvain provided regarding the topography and hydrography of this strait are pretty vague, and since we'll mention it again when discussing De Bougainville's expedition, we won’t elaborate on it now. After 22 days of sailing through this series of narrow inlets and sea arms, some three miles wide and others twelve, which stretches for 440 miles and is known as Magellan's Strait, the flotilla finally reached an expanse of ocean that was vast and deep.
The rejoicings were general when at last the sailors found themselves at the long-wished-for end of their efforts. Henceforward the route was open and Magellan's clever conjectures were realized.
The celebrations were widespread when the sailors finally reached the long-awaited endpoint of their journey. From then on, the path was clear, and Magellan's brilliant predictions came to fruition.
Nothing is more extraordinary than the navigation of Magellan upon this ocean, which he called Pacific, because for four months no storm assailed him upon it. The privations endured by the crews during this long space of time were excessive. The biscuit was nothing more than dust mixed with worms, while the water had become bad and gave out an unbearable smell. The sailors were obliged to eat mice and sawdust to prevent themselves from dying of hunger, and to gnaw all the leather that it was possible to find. As it was easy to foresee under these circumstances, the crews were decimated by scurvy. Nineteen men died, and thirty were seized with violent pains in their arms and legs, which caused prolonged sufferings. At last, after having sailed over more than 12,000 miles without meeting with a single island, in a sea where so many and such populous archipelagos were destined to be discovered, the fleet came upon two desert and sterile islands, called for that reason the Unfortunate Islands, but of which the position is indicated in much too contradictory a manner, for it to be possible to recognize them.
Nothing is more remarkable than Magellan's journey across this ocean, which he named the Pacific, since he faced no storms for four whole months. The hardships endured by the crews during this lengthy period were extreme. The biscuits were nothing but dust mixed with worms, and the water had gone bad, giving off an unbearable smell. The sailors had to resort to eating mice and sawdust to avoid starving, gnawing on any leather they could find. As could be easily expected in these circumstances, the crews were devastated by scurvy. Nineteen men died, and thirty suffered from severe pain in their arms and legs, causing long-lasting suffering. Finally, after sailing over more than 12,000 miles without encountering a single island, in a sea where so many populous archipelagos would later be discovered, the fleet found two barren and lifeless islands, which were named the Unfortunate Islands. However, their location is described in such a contradictory way that it’s impossible to identify them.
In 12° north latitude and 146° longitude, on Wednesday the 6th of March, the navigators discovered successively three islands, at which they greatly desired to stop to recruit, and take in fresh provisions; but the islanders who came on board stole so many things, without the possibility of preventing them, that the sailors were obliged to give up the idea of remaining there. The natives contrived even to carry off a long boat. Magellan, indignant at such daring, made a descent with forty armed men, burned some houses and boats, and killed seven men. These islanders had neither chief, king, nor religion. Their heads were covered with palm-leaf hats, they wore beards, and their hair descended to their waists. Generally of an olive tint, they thought they embellished themselves by colouring their teeth black and red, while their bodies were anointed with cocoa-nut oil, no doubt in order to protect themselves from the heat of the sun. Their canoes of curious construction, carried a very large matting sail, which might have easily capsized the boat if the precaution had not been taken of giving a more stable trim by means of a long piece of wood kept at a certain distance by two poles; this is what is called the "balance." These islanders were very industrious, but had a singular aptitude for stealing, which has gained for their country the name of the Islands of Thieves (Ladrone Islands).
At 12° north latitude and 146° longitude, on Wednesday, March 6th, the navigators discovered three islands in succession, where they really wanted to stop to rest and gather fresh supplies. However, the islanders who came on board stole so many items that the sailors had no choice but to abandon the idea of staying there. The natives even managed to take away a longboat. Magellan, furious at such audacity, landed with forty armed men, burned some houses and boats, and killed seven men. These islanders had no chief, king, or religion. They wore palm-leaf hats, had beards, and their hair reached down to their waists. Generally olive-skinned, they thought they enhanced their appearance by dyeing their teeth black and red, while their bodies were coated in coconut oil, likely to protect themselves from the sun's heat. Their uniquely constructed canoes had large matting sails, which could have easily capsized the boat if not for a stability measure involving a long piece of wood held at a distance by two poles, known as the "balance." These islanders were very hardworking but had a peculiar knack for stealing, which led to their country being called the Islands of Thieves (Ladrone Islands).
![]() |
The Ladrone Islands. From an old print. |
On the 16th of March was seen, at about 900 miles from the Ladrones, some high ground; this was soon discovered to be an island which now goes by the name of Samar Island. There Magellan, resolving to give his exhausted crews some rest, caused two tents to be pitched on land for the use of the sick. The natives quickly brought bananas, palm wine, cocoa-nuts, and fish; for which mirrors, combs, bells, and other similar trifles were offered in exchange. The cocoa-nut, a tree which is valuable beyond all others, supplied these natives with their bread, wine, oil, and vinegar, and besides they obtained from it their clothing and the necessary wood for building and roofing in their huts.
On March 16, about 900 miles from the Ladrones, some high ground was spotted; this turned out to be an island now known as Samar Island. Magellan, wanting to give his tired crews a break, had two tents set up on land for the sick. The locals quickly brought bananas, palm wine, coconuts, and fish, for which they were offered mirrors, combs, bells, and other small items in return. The coconut tree, which is incredibly valuable, provided these locals with their bread, wine, oil, and vinegar, and they also used it for clothing and the wood needed to build and roof their huts.
The natives soon became familiar with the Spaniards, and told them that their archipelago produced cloves, cinnamon, pepper, nutmegs, ginger, maize or Indian-corn, and that even gold was found there. Magellan gave this archipelago the name of the St. Lazarus Islands, afterwards changed to that of the Philippines from the name of Philip of Austria, son of Charles V.
The locals quickly got to know the Spaniards and informed them that their islands had cloves, cinnamon, pepper, nutmeg, ginger, corn, and even gold. Magellan named this group of islands the St. Lazarus Islands, which was later changed to the Philippines, named after Philip of Austria, the son of Charles V.
This archipelago is formed of a great number of islands which extend in Malaysia, between 5° 32' and 19° 38' north latitude, and 114° 56' and 123° 43' longitude east of the meridian of Paris. The most important are Luzon, Mindoro, Leyte, the Ceylon of Pigafetta, Samar, Panay, Negros, Zebu, Bohol, Palawan, and Mindanao.
This group of islands consists of many islands located in Malaysia, between 5° 32' and 19° 38' north latitude, and 114° 56' and 123° 43' longitude east of the Paris meridian. The most significant ones are Luzon, Mindoro, Leyte, the Ceylon of Pigafetta, Samar, Panay, Negros, Cebu, Bohol, Palawan, and Mindanao.
When they were a little restored, the Spaniards put to sea again, in order to explore the archipelago. They saw in succession the islands of Cenalo, Huinaugan, Ibusson, and Abarien, as well as another island called Massava, of which the king Colambu could make himself understood by a slave a native of Sumatra, whom Magellan had taken to Europe from India, and who by his knowledge of Malay rendered signal service in several instances. The king came on board with six or eight of his principal subjects. He brought with him presents for the captain-general, and in exchange he received a vest of red and yellow cloth, made in Turkish fashion, and a cap of fine scarlet, while mirrors and knives were given to the members of his suite. The Spaniards showed him all their fire-arms and fired some shots from the cannon in his presence, at which he was much terrified. "Then Magellan caused one of our number to be fully armed," says Pigafetta, "and ordered three men to give him blows with the sword and stiletto, to show the king that nothing could wound a man armed in this manner, which surprised him greatly, and turning to the interpreter he said to the captain through him, 'that a man thus armed, could fight against a hundred.' 'Yes,' replied the interpreter, in the name of the commandant, 'and each of the three vessels carries 200 men armed in this manner.'" The king, astonished by all that he had seen, took leave of the captain, begging him to send two of his men with him, to let them see something of the island. Pigafetta was chosen, and was much satisfied with the welcome that he received. The king told him "that in this island they found pieces of gold as large as nuts, and even eggs, mixed with the earth which they passed through a sieve to find them; all his vessels and even some of the ornaments of his house were of this metal. He was very neatly dressed, according to the custom of the country, and was the finest man that I have seen among these people. His black hair fell upon his shoulders; a silk veil covered his head, and he wore two rings in his ears. From his waist to his knees, he was covered with a cotten cloth embroidered in silk. On each of his teeth there were three spots of gold, arranged in such a manner that one would have said all his teeth were fastened together with this metal. He was perfumed with storax and benzoin. His skin was painted, but its natural tint was olive."
When they had recovered a bit, the Spaniards set sail again to explore the islands. They successively saw the islands of Cenalo, Huinaugan, Ibusson, and Abarien, as well as another island called Massava. The king, Colambu, was able to communicate through a slave from Sumatra, whom Magellan had brought to Europe from India, and who, with his knowledge of Malay, helped out in many situations. The king boarded their ship with six or eight of his chief subjects. He brought gifts for the captain-general, and in return, he received a vest made of red and yellow cloth in a Turkish style, and a fine scarlet cap, while mirrors and knives were given to his group. The Spaniards showed him all their firearms and fired some cannon shots in front of him, which terrified him. "Then Magellan had one of our men fully armed," says Pigafetta, "and ordered three men to hit him with a sword and stiletto, to demonstrate to the king that nothing could hurt a man dressed this way. This greatly surprised him, and turning to the interpreter, he told the captain through him that a man armed like that could fight against a hundred." "Yes," the interpreter replied on behalf of the commander, "and each of the three ships carries 200 men armed like this." The king, amazed by everything he had witnessed, took his leave from the captain, asking him to send two of his men with him to explore the island. Pigafetta was chosen and was pleased with the warm welcome he received. The king told him that "on this island, they found pieces of gold as large as nuts and even eggs, which they mixed with the soil and sifted to find. All his vessels and even some of his household decorations were made of this metal. He was dressed very neatly, according to local customs, and was the most impressive person I had seen among these people. His black hair fell to his shoulders; a silk veil covered his head, and he wore two rings in his ears. From his waist to his knees, he was draped in a cotton cloth embroidered in silk. Each of his teeth had three spots of gold, arranged so that it looked like all his teeth were lined with this metal. He smelled of storax and benzoin. His skin was painted, but its natural color was olive."
On Easter Day, the Europeans went on shore to celebrate mass in a kind of little church which they had constructed on the sea-shore with sails and branches of trees. An altar had been set up, and during the whole time that the religious ceremony lasted, the king with a large concourse of people, listened in silence and imitated all the motions of the Spaniards. Then a cross having been planted on a hill with great solemnity, they weighed anchor and made for the port of Zebu, as being the best for revictualling the vessels and trading. They arrived there on Sunday, the 7th of April. Magellan sent one of his officers on shore at once with the interpreter, as ambassador to the king of Zebu. The envoy explained that the chief of the squadron was under the orders of the greatest king in the world. The object of the voyage, he added, was the wish to pay him a visit, and at the same time to take in some fresh provisions in exchange for merchandise, and then to go to the Molucca Islands. Such were the motives which caused them to tarry in a country where they came as friends.
On Easter Sunday, the Europeans went ashore to hold a mass in a makeshift little church they built by the seaside using sails and tree branches. An altar was set up, and throughout the entire ceremony, the king and a large crowd of people watched in silence, mimicking the actions of the Spaniards. After a cross was solemnly planted on a hill, they weighed anchor and headed for the port of Zebu, which was the best spot for restocking their ships and trading. They arrived there on Sunday, April 7th. Magellan immediately sent one of his officers ashore with an interpreter as an ambassador to the king of Zebu. The envoy explained that the leader of the squadron was working under the orders of the greatest king in the world. He added that the purpose of their visit was to pay a visit and simultaneously replenish their supplies in exchange for merchandise, before heading to the Molucca Islands. These were the reasons that led them to stay in a land where they came as friends.
"They are welcome," replied the king; "but if they intend to trade they should pay a duty to which all vessels are subject that enter my port, as did, not four days since, a junk from Siam, which came to seek for slaves and gold, to which a Moorish merchant who has remained in this country can testify."
"They are welcome," replied the king; "but if they plan to trade, they need to pay a fee that all ships must pay when they enter my port, just like a junk from Siam did, not four days ago, which came looking for slaves and gold, as a Moorish merchant who has stayed in this country can confirm."
The Spaniard replied that his master was too great a king to submit to such an unreasonable demand. They had come with pacific intentions; but if war were declared, it would be seen with whom they had to deal.
The Spaniard replied that his master was too important a king to agree to such an unreasonable demand. They had come with peaceful intentions; but if war were declared, it would be clear who they were dealing with.
The king of Zebu, warned by the Moorish merchant, of the power of those who stood before him, and whom he took for Portuguese, at length consented to forego his claims. Moreover the king of Massava, who had continued to serve as pilot to the Spaniards, so altered the inclinations of his brother sovereign, that the Spaniards obtained the exclusive privilege of trading in the island, and a loyal friendship was sealed between the king of Zebu and Magellan by an exchange of blood which each drew from his right arm.
The king of Zebu, alerted by the Moorish merchant about the power of those standing before him, whom he thought were Portuguese, eventually agreed to give up his claims. Additionally, the king of Massava, who had been serving as a pilot for the Spaniards, changed his brother king's mind so that the Spaniards secured exclusive trading rights on the island. A strong friendship was established between the king of Zebu and Magellan through a blood pact, where each drew blood from his right arm.
From this moment, provisions were brought and cordial relations established. The nephew of the king came with a numerous suite to visit Magellan on board his ship, and the latter took this opportunity to relate to his visitors the wonderful history of the creation of the world, and of the redemption of the human race, and to invite him and his people to become converts to Christianity. They showed no repugnance to being baptized, and on the 14th of April the kings of Zebu and Massava, and the Moorish merchant, with 500 men and as many women received baptism. But what was only a fashion at first, for it cannot be said that the natives knew the religion which they embraced or were persuaded of its truth, became a real frenzy, after a wonderful cure had been effected by Magellan. Having learnt that the father of the king had been ill for two years and was on the point of death, the captain-general promised, that if he consented to be baptized and the natives would burn their idols, he would find himself cured. "He added that he was so convinced of what he said," relates Pigafetta—for it is as well to quote the author verbatim in such a matter—"that he agreed to lose his head if what he promised did not happen immediately. We then made a procession, with all possible pomp, from the place where we were to the sick man's house, whom we found really in a very sad state in that he could neither speak nor move. We baptized him with two of his wives and ten daughters. The captain asked him directly after his baptism how he found himself, and he suddenly replied that thanks to our Lord he was well. We were all witnesses of this miracle. The captain above all rendered thanks to God for it. He gave the prince a refreshing drink, and continued to send him some of it every day till he was quite restored. On the fifth day the invalid found himself quite cured and got up. His first care was to have burned, in the presence of the king and all the people, an idol for which he had great veneration, and which some old women guarded carefully in his house. He also caused some temples which stood on the sea-shore, and in which the people assembled to eat the meat consecrated to their old divinities, to be thrown down. All the inhabitants applauded these acts, and proposed themselves to go and destroy all the idols, even those which were in use in the king's house, crying at the same time 'Vive la Castille!' in honour of the king of Spain."
From this point on, supplies were brought in and friendly relations were established. The king's nephew came with a large group to visit Magellan on his ship, and Magellan took this chance to share the incredible story of the world's creation and humanity's redemption, inviting him and his people to convert to Christianity. They showed no resistance to being baptized, and on April 14th, the kings of Zebu and Massava, along with a Moorish merchant, baptized 500 men and as many women. What initially started as a trend, since the natives didn’t fully understand the religion they were adopting or were convinced of its truth, turned into a genuine fervor after Magellan performed a miraculous healing. Learning that the king's father had been ill for two years and was near death, the captain-general promised that if he agreed to be baptized and the natives would burn their idols, he would be cured. "He even said he was so sure of what he claimed," Pigafetta writes—it's best to quote the author directly in such matters—"that he agreed to lose his head if what he promised didn't happen right away." We then made a grand procession from our location to the sick man's house, where we found him in very poor condition, unable to speak or move. We baptized him along with two of his wives and ten daughters. The captain immediately asked him how he felt after his baptism, and he suddenly responded that thanks to our Lord he was feeling well. We all witnessed this miracle. The captain, above all, gave thanks to God for it. He provided the prince with a revitalizing drink and continued to send him some every day until he was fully recovered. On the fifth day, the sick man felt completely healed and got up. His first action was to burn an idol he deeply respected, which some old women had kept carefully in his house, in front of the king and all the people. He also ordered the destruction of temples along the shore where people gathered to eat the meat dedicated to their old deities. All the inhabitants praised these actions and expressed their intention to destroy all the idols, even those in the king's house, shouting 'Vive la Castille!' in honor of the king of Spain.
Near to the Island of Zebu is another island called Matan which had two chiefs, one of whom had recognized the authority of Spain, while the other having energetically resisted it, Magellan resolved to impose it upon him by force. On Friday, the 26th of April, three long boats left for the Island of Matan containing sixty men wearing cuirasses and helmets, and armed with muskets; and thirty balangais bearing the king of Zebu, his son-in-law, and a number of warriors.
Near the Island of Zebu is another island called Matan, which had two chiefs. One chief had accepted Spain's authority, while the other had strongly resisted it. Magellan decided to enforce it by force. On Friday, April 26th, three long boats departed for the Island of Matan, carrying sixty men in armor and helmets, armed with muskets; and thirty balangais with the king of Zebu, his son-in-law, and several warriors.
The Spaniards waited for day and then to the number of forty-nine leapt into the water, for the boats could not approach the land on account of the rocks and shallow water. More than 1500 natives awaited them, and at once threw themselves upon them, and attacked them in three troops, both in front and flank. The musketeers and the crossbow-men fired on the multitude of warriors from a distance, without doing them much harm, they being protected by their bucklers. The Spaniards, assailed by stones, arrows, javelins, and lances, and overwhelmed by numbers, set fire to some huts to disperse and intimidate the natives. But these, made more furious by the sight of the fire, redoubled their efforts, and pressed the Spaniards on all sides, who had the greatest difficulty in resisting them, when a sad event took place which compromised the issue of the combat. The natives were not slow in remarking that all the blows which they directed towards those parts of their enemies' bodies which were protected by armour, caused no wounds; they set themselves therefore to hurl their arrows and javelins against the lower part of the body, which was undefended. Magellan, wounded in the leg by a poisoned arrow, gave the order for retreat, which, begun in good order, soon changed into such a flight, that seven or eight Spaniards alone remained at his side. With much difficulty they kept moving backwards, fighting as they went, in order to reach the boats. They were already knee-deep in the water when several islanders rushed all together upon Magellan, who, wounded in the arm, was unable to draw his sword; they gave him such a sabre-cut upon his leg that he immediately fell down in the water, where he was speedily despatched. His remaining companions, and among them Pigafetta, every one of whom had been hit, hastily regained the boats. Thus perished the illustrious Magellan on the 27th of April, 1521. "He was adorned with every virtue," says Pigafetta, "and ever exhibited an unshaken constancy in the midst of the greatest adversity. At sea he always condemned himself to greater privations than the rest of his crew. Better versed than any one else in the knowledge of nautical charts, he was perfect in the art of navigation, as he proved by making the tour of the world, which none before him had ventured to do." Pigafetta's funeral eulogy, though a little hyperbolical, is not untrue in the main. Magellan had need of singular constancy and perseverance to penetrate, despite the fears of his companions, into regions peopled by the superstitious spirit of the time with fantastic dangers. Peculiar nautical science was also necessary to achieve the discovery at the extremity of that long coast of the strait which so justly bears his name. He was obliged to give unceasing attention to avoid all untoward accidents while exploring those unknown parts without any exact instruments. That one of the vessels was lost must be imputed to pride and a spirit of revolt in her own captain, more than to any incapacity or want of caution in the captain-general. Let us add with our enthusiastic narrator, "The glory of Magellan will survive his death."
The Spaniards waited for daylight, then a group of forty-nine jumped into the water, as the boats couldn’t get close to the shore because of the rocks and shallow water. Over 1,500 natives were waiting for them and immediately attacked in three groups from the front and sides. The musketeers and crossbowmen shot at the mass of warriors from a distance, but didn’t inflict much damage since the natives were shielded by their bucklers. The Spaniards, bombarded by stones, arrows, javelins, and lances, and overwhelmed by numbers, set fire to some huts to scatter and intimidate the natives. Instead, the sight of the fire enraged the natives even more, and they intensified their assaults, pressing in on the Spaniards from all sides, who struggled to defend themselves. A tragic event occurred that jeopardized the outcome of the battle. The natives quickly noticed that their attacks on the armored parts of the Spaniards resulted in no injuries, so they aimed their arrows and javelins at the unprotected lower bodies. When Magellan was struck in the leg by a poisoned arrow, he ordered a retreat. It started off organized, but turned into a chaotic flight, leaving only seven or eight Spaniards at his side. They struggled to move backward, fighting as they retreated, trying to reach the boats. They were already knee-deep in the water when several islanders rushed at Magellan, who, wounded in the arm, couldn’t draw his sword; they inflicted a severe cut on his leg, causing him to collapse in the water, where he was quickly killed. His remaining companions, including Pigafetta, each of whom had been injured, scrambled back to the boats. Thus, the famous Magellan died on April 27, 1521. "He had every virtue," says Pigafetta, "and always showed unshakeable resolve amid the greatest challenges. At sea, he willingly endured more hardships than the rest of his crew. He was more knowledgeable than anyone else about nautical charts and excelled in navigation, evidenced by his journey around the world, something no one had attempted before him." While Pigafetta’s eulogy might be a bit exaggerated, it largely holds true. Magellan needed extraordinary courage and determination to venture into areas filled with the fantastical dangers believed in by his superstitious crew. Unique nautical skills were essential for the discovery at the far end of that long stretch of the strait that rightly bears his name. He had to constantly pay attention to avoid accidents while exploring unknown territories without precise instruments. The loss of one of the ships should be attributed more to the pride and rebellious nature of its captain than to any incompetence or carelessness on the part of the captain-general. Let’s add with our enthusiastic narrator, "The glory of Magellan will endure beyond his death."
![]() |
Death of Magellan. |
Duarte Barbosa, Magellan's brother-in-law, and Juan Serrano were elected commanders by the Spaniards, who were destined to meet with further catastrophes. The slave who had acted as interpreter up to this time had been slightly wounded during the battle. From the time of his master's death he had kept aloof, not rendering any further service to the Spaniards, and remaining extended upon his mat. After some rather sharp reproofs from Barbosa, who told him that his master's death did not make him a free man, he disappeared all at once. He was gone to the newly-baptized king, to whom he declared that if he could allure the Spaniards into some trap and then kill them, he would make himself master of all their provisions and merchandise. Serrano, Barbosa, and twenty-seven Spaniards were accordingly invited to a solemn assembly to receive the presents destined by the king of Zebu for the Emperor; during the banquet they were attacked unexpectedly, and were all massacred except Serrano, who was led bound to the sea-shore, where he besought his companions to ransom him, for if they did not he would be murdered. But Juan de Carvalho and the others, fearing that the insurrection would become general, and that they might be attacked during the negotiations by a numerous fleet which they would not be able to resist, turned a deaf ear to the unfortunate Serrano's supplications. The ships set sail and reached the Island of Bohol, which was not far distant.
Duarte Barbosa, Magellan's brother-in-law, and Juan Serrano were chosen as commanders by the Spaniards, who were set to face more disasters. The slave who had been acting as an interpreter until this point had been slightly injured during the battle. Following his master’s death, he kept to himself, no longer helping the Spaniards and lying on his mat. After some harsh words from Barbosa, who told him that his master’s death didn’t make him a free man, he suddenly disappeared. He had gone to the newly-baptized king, where he told him that if he could lure the Spaniards into a trap and then kill them, he would take control of all their supplies and goods. Serrano, Barbosa, and twenty-seven Spaniards were then invited to a formal meeting to receive gifts meant for the Emperor from the king of Cebu; during the banquet, they were ambushed and all were killed except for Serrano, who was captured and taken to the shore, where he begged his companions to pay for his release, saying that if they didn’t, he would be killed. But Juan de Carvalho and the others, worried that the uprising would spread and that they might be attacked during the negotiations by a large fleet they couldn't fight off, ignored the desperate pleas of Serrano. The ships then set sail and reached the nearby Island of Bohol.
When there, thinking that their numbers were too much reduced to navigate three vessels, they burnt the Concepcion, after having transshipped all that was most precious on board the other vessels. Then, after having coasted along the Island of Panilongon they stopped at Butuan, which forms part of Mindanao, a magnificent island, with numerous ports, and rivers abounding in fish, to the north-west of which lies the Island of Luzon, the most considerable of the Archipelago. The ships touched also at Paloan, where they found pigs, goats, fowls, different kinds of bananas, cocoa-nuts, sugar-canes, and rice, with which they provisioned the ships. This was for them, as Pigafetta expresses it, "a promised land." Among the things which he thought worthy of notice, the Italian traveller mentions the cocks kept by the natives for fighting; a passion which after so many years is still deeply-rooted amongst the population of the whole Philippine Archipelago. From Paloan, the Spaniards next went to the Island of Borneo, the centre of Malay civilization. From that time they had no longer to deal with poverty-stricken people, but with a rich population, who received them with magnificence. Their reception by the rajah is sufficiently curious to warrant a few words being devoted to it. At the landing-place they found two elephants with silk trappings, who bore the strangers to the house of the governor of the town, while twelve men carried the presents which were to be offered to the rajah. From the governor's house where they slept, to the palace of the king, the streets were kept by armed men. Upon descending from their elephants the Spaniards were admitted to a room filled with courtiers. At the end of this room opened another smaller room, hung with cloth of gold, in which were 300 men of the king's guard armed with poniards. Through a door they could then see the rajah, sitting by a table with a little child, chewing betel-nut. Behind him there were only some women.
When they arrived, thinking their numbers were too small to manage three ships, they burned the Concepcion, after transferring everything valuable from it to the other vessels. Then, after sailing along the Island of Panilongon, they stopped at Butuan, part of Mindanao, a beautiful island with many ports and rivers full of fish. To the northwest lies Luzon, the largest island in the Archipelago. The ships also visited Paloan, where they found pigs, goats, chickens, various types of bananas, coconuts, sugarcane, and rice, which they used to stock up the ships. This place was, as Pigafetta described it, "a promised land." Among the noteworthy things he mentioned were the roosters that the locals kept for fighting; a tradition that, after many years, is still very much alive among the people of the entire Philippine Archipelago. From Paloan, the Spaniards proceeded to Borneo, the hub of Malay civilization. From that point on, they no longer encountered impoverished people but a wealthy population that welcomed them lavishly. Their reception by the rajah is interesting enough to deserve a few words. At the landing area, they found two elephants adorned with silk who transported the newcomers to the governor's residence, while twelve men carried gifts meant for the rajah. From the governor's house, where they stayed, to the king's palace, the streets were patrolled by armed guards. After getting down from their elephants, the Spaniards were taken into a room filled with courtiers. At the end of that room was another smaller room draped in cloth of gold, where 300 men of the king's guard were armed with daggers. Through a door, they could see the rajah sitting at a table with a small child, chewing betel-nut. Behind him were just a few women.
Etiquette required that the petition to be made must pass in succession through the mouths of three nobles, each of higher rank than the last, before being transmitted, by means of a hollow cane placed in a hole in the wall, to one of the principal officers, who submitted it to the king. Then there was an exchange of presents, after which the Spanish Ambassadors were conducted back to their vessels with the same ceremony as on their arrival. The capital is built on piles in the sea; so that when the tide rises, the women who sell provisions go about the town in boats. On the 29th of July more than 100 canoes surrounded the two vessels, whilst at the same time some junks weighed anchor to approach them more nearly. The Spaniards, fearing to be treacherously attacked, took the initiative and fired off their artillery, which killed a number of people in the canoes, upon which the king excused himself, saying that his fleet had not been directed against them, but against the Gentiles with whom the Mussulmen had daily combats. This island produces arrack (the alcohol of rice), camphor, cinnamon, ginger, oranges, citrons, sugar-canes, melons, radishes, onions, &c. The articles of exchange are copper, quicksilver, cinnabar, glass, woollen cloths, and canvas, and above all iron and spectacles, without mentioning porcelain, and diamonds, some of which were of extraordinary size and value. The fauna comprises elephants, horses, buffaloes, pigs, goats, and domestic poultry. The money in use is of bronze, it is called sapèque and consists of small coins which are perforated with holes, that they may be strung together.
Etiquette required that the petition must be passed through the mouths of three nobles, each of a higher rank than the last, before being sent, via a hollow cane placed in a hole in the wall, to one of the main officers, who would then present it to the king. After this, there was an exchange of gifts, and the Spanish ambassadors were escorted back to their ships with the same ceremony as when they arrived. The capital is built on stilts in the sea; so when the tide comes in, the women selling provisions move around the town in boats. On July 29th, over 100 canoes surrounded the two vessels, while some junks weighed anchor to get closer. The Spaniards, fearing a surprise attack, took the initiative and fired their artillery, which killed several people in the canoes. The king later explained that his fleet was not directed at them, but at the Gentiles with whom the Muslims were in constant conflict. This island produces arrack (rice alcohol), camphor, cinnamon, ginger, oranges, citrons, sugarcane, melons, radishes, onions, etc. The goods exchanged include copper, mercury, cinnabar, glass, woolen cloths, and canvas, especially iron and spectacles, not to mention porcelain and diamonds, some of which were exceptionally large and valuable. The fauna includes elephants, horses, buffaloes, pigs, goats, and domestic poultry. The currency used is made of bronze, called sapèque, consisting of small coins that are perforated with holes so they can be strung together.
On leaving Borneo the travellers sought for a suitable spot in which to repair their vessels, which were in such great need of it that the men were not less than forty-two days over the work. "The oddest things which I have found in this island," says Pigafetta, "are the trees of which all the leaves are animated. These leaves resemble those of the mulberry, but are not so long; the stalk is short and pointed, and near the stalk on both sides there are two feet. If you touch the leaves, they escape; but when crushed no blood comes from them. I have kept one of them in a box for nine days; when I opened the box, the leaf was walking about in it; I believe they must live upon air." These very curious animals are well known at the present day, and are commonly called leaf-flies (mouches-feuille); they are of a grey-brown, which makes them more easily mistaken for dead leaves, which they exactly resemble in appearance.
On their way out of Borneo, the travelers looked for a good place to fix their boats, which needed so much work that it took the men forty-two days to complete it. "The strangest things I've discovered on this island," Pigafetta says, "are the trees with all animated leaves. These leaves look like mulberry leaves, but they're shorter; the stem is short and pointy, and there are two little legs on either side near the stem. If you touch the leaves, they flee; but when crushed, they don't bleed. I kept one in a box for nine days; when I opened the box, the leaf was moving around inside it. I think they must survive on air." These peculiar creatures are well known today and are commonly called leaf-flies (mouches-feuille); they are a grey-brown color, making them easily mistaken for dead leaves, which they perfectly mimic in appearance.
It was while in these parts that the Spanish expedition, which, during Magellan's life had preserved its scientific character, began perceptibly to become piratical. Thus, on several occasions, junks were seized upon, and their crews forced by their Spanish captors to pay large ransoms.
It was in this area that the Spanish expedition, which had maintained its scientific purpose during Magellan's lifetime, started to shift noticeably towards piracy. Therefore, on multiple occasions, junk boats were captured, and their crews were coerced by their Spanish captors into paying hefty ransoms.
The ships next passed by the Archipelago of the Sooloo Islands, the haunt of Malay pirates, who have even now only lately submitted to the Spanish arms; then by Mindanao, which had been already visited, for it was known that the eagerly sought-for Moluccas must be in its neighbourhood, whether more or less remote. At last, after having seen a number of islands, of which the names would not convey much idea to us, on Wednesday, the 6th of November the Spaniards discovered the Archipelago, about which the Portuguese had related such terrifying fables, and two days later they landed at Tidor. Thus the object of the voyage was attained.
The ships then sailed past the Sooloo Islands, a hotspot for Malay pirates, who had only recently surrendered to the Spanish forces. They continued by Mindanao, which they had already explored, as it was known that the sought-after Moluccas had to be nearby, whether close or far. Finally, after seeing several islands, most of which wouldn’t mean much to us, on Wednesday, November 6th, the Spaniards discovered the Archipelago, about which the Portuguese had shared many terrifying stories, and two days later they landed at Tidor. Thus, the goal of the voyage was achieved.
The king came to meet the Spaniards, and invited them to go on board his canoe. "He was seated under a silk parasol which covered him entirely. In front of him were placed one of his sons who carried the royal sceptre, two men who had each a golden vase full of water for washing the king's hands, and two others holding small gilt boxes filled with betel." Then the Spaniards made the king come on board the vessels, where they showed him much respect, at the same time loading him and those who accompanied him with presents, which seemed to them very precious. "This king is a Moor, that is to say, an Arab," Pigafetta affirms; "he is nearly forty-five years of age, tolerably well made, and with a fine physiognomy. His clothing consisted of a very fine shirt, the cuffs of which were embroidered in gold; drapery descended from his waist to his feet; a silk veil (no doubt a turban) covered his head, and upon this veil there was a garland of flowers. His name is Rajah-sultan Manzor."
The king came to meet the Spaniards and invited them to board his canoe. "He was sitting under a silk parasol that covered him completely. In front of him was one of his sons holding the royal scepter, two men each carrying a golden vase full of water for washing the king's hands, and two others with small gilt boxes filled with betel." Then the Spaniards invited the king on board their vessels, where they showed him great respect, while also showering him and his companions with gifts, which they thought were very valuable. "This king is a Moor, or in other words, an Arab," Pigafetta states; "he is about forty-five years old, fairly well built, and has a striking appearance. His outfit included a very fine shirt with gold-embroidered cuffs; drapery flowing from his waist to his feet; a silk veil (probably a turban) covering his head, and a garland of flowers on top of it. His name is Rajah-sultan Manzor."
The next day, in a long interview which he had with the Spaniards, Manzor declared his intention of placing himself with the Islands of Ternate and Tidor under the protection of the king of Spain.
The next day, in a lengthy interview he had with the Spaniards, Manzor stated his intention to align himself and the Islands of Ternate and Tidor under the protection of the king of Spain.
![]() |
The Sultan Manzor. |
This is the place to give some details about the Archipelago of the Moluccas, drawn from Pigafetta's narrative, which we are following step by step in the version that M. Ed. Charton has given, and to which he has added such valuable notes.
This is the place to provide some details about the Moluccas Archipelago, taken from Pigafetta's narrative, which we are following closely in the version provided by M. Ed. Charton, along with the valuable notes he has added.
This Archipelago properly speaking, comprises the Islands of Gilolo, Ternate, Tidor, Mornay, Batchian, and Misal; but the Banda and Amboyna groups are also often comprehended under the general name of Molucca. Formerly convulsed by repeated volcanic commotions, this Archipelago contains a great number of craters almost all extinct, or in repose during a long succession of years. The air there is burning, and would be almost unfit to breathe, if frequent rains did not fall and refresh the atmosphere. The natural productions are extremely valuable. In the first rank must be placed the sago-tree, of which the pith called sago takes, with yams, the place of cereals throughout Malacca. As soon as the tree is cut down, the pith is extracted, which is then grated, passed through a sieve, and afterwards cut up in the form of small rolls, which are dried in the shade. There are also the mulberry, the clove, the nutmeg, the camphor, and pepper-trees; in fact all the spice-trees and all the tropical fruits. The forests contain some valuable kinds of wood, ebony, iron-wood, teak, famous for its strength and employed from the most ancient times in costly buildings, and the Calilaban laurel, which yields an aromatic essential oil that is highly prized. At this period domestic animals were not numerous in the Moluccas, but among the wild animals the most curious were the babiroussa, an enormous wild boar with long tusks bent backwards; the opossum, a kind of didelphis a little larger than our squirrel; the phalanger, a marsupial which lives in thick, dark forests, where it feeds upon leaves and fruit; and the tarsier, a kind of jerboa, a very harmless, inoffensive little animal with reddish-coloured hair, about the size of a rat, but whose body bears some resemblance to that of an ape. Among the birds, the most remarkable were the parroquets and cockatoos, the birds of Paradise of which so many fabulous accounts were given, and which until then had been believed to be without legs, the king-fishers, and the cassowaries, great wading-birds almost as large as ostriches.
This archipelago, strictly speaking, consists of the islands of Gilolo, Ternate, Tidor, Mornay, Batchian, and Misal; however, the Banda and Amboyna groups are often included under the general name of Molucca. Once shaken by repeated volcanic eruptions, this archipelago now has numerous craters, most of which are extinct or have been dormant for many years. The air is scorching and would almost be unbearable to breathe if it weren't for the frequent rains that cool the atmosphere. The natural resources here are incredibly valuable. At the top of the list is the sago palm, whose pith, called sago, alongside yams, substitutes for grains throughout Malacca. Once the tree is cut down, the pith is removed, grated, strained, and then shaped into small rolls that are dried in the shade. There are also mulberry trees, clove, nutmeg, camphor, and pepper trees; in fact, all the spice-producing plants and tropical fruits. The forests contain valuable types of wood, such as ebony, ironwood, and teak, well-known for its strength and used since ancient times for expensive constructions, along with the Calilaban laurel, which produces a highly prized aromatic essential oil. At this time, domestic animals were not numerous in the Moluccas, but among the wild ones, the most interesting included the babiroussa, a massive wild boar with long tusks that curve backward; the opossum, a type of didelphis slightly larger than a squirrel; the phalanger, a marsupial that inhabits dense, dark forests, feeding on leaves and fruits; and the tarsier, a type of jerboa, a small, harmless animal with reddish fur, about the size of a rat, but with a body that resembles that of an ape. Among the birds, the most notable were the parrots and cockatoos, the birds of paradise that had been subject to many fantastical tales, which were believed until then to be legless, along with the kingfishers and the cassowaries, large wading birds nearly as big as ostriches.
A Portuguese named Lorosa had been long settled in the Moluccas, and to him the Spaniards forwarded a letter, in the hope that he would betray his country and attach himself to Spain. They obtained the most curious information from him with regard to the expeditions which the king of Portugal had despatched to the Cape of Good Hope, to the Rio de la Plata and to the Moluccas; but from various circumstances these latter expeditions had not been able to take place. He himself had been sixteen years in this Archipelago; the Portuguese had been installed there for ten years, but upon this fact they preserved the most complete silence. When Lorosa saw the Spaniards making their preparations for departure, he came on board with his wife and his goods to return to Europe. On the 12th of November all the merchandise destined for barter was landed, it being chiefly derived from the four junks which had been seized in Borneo. Certainly the Spaniards traded to great advantage, but nevertheless not to so great an extent as they might have done, for they were in haste to return to Spain. Some vessels from Gilolo and Batchian came also to trade with them, and a few days later they received a considerable stock of cloves from the king of Tidor. This king invited them to a great banquet which he said it was his custom to give when a vessel or junk was loaded with the first cloves. But the Spaniards, remembering what had happened to them in the Philippines, refused the invitation while presenting compliments and excuses to the king. When their cargo was completed, they set sail. Scarcely had the Trinidad put to sea before it was perceived that she had a serious leak, and the return to Tidor as fast as possible was unavoidable. The skilful divers whom the king placed at the disposal of the Spaniards, were unable to discover the hole, and it became necessary to partly unload the ship to make the necessary repairs. The sailors who were on board the Victoria would not wait for their companions, and the ship's officers seeing clearly that the Trinidad would not be fit for the voyage to Spain, decided that she should go to Darien, where her valuable cargo would be discharged and transported across the Isthmus to the Atlantic, where a vessel would be sent to fetch it. But neither the unfortunate vessel nor her crew was destined ever to return to Spain.
A Portuguese named Lorosa had been living in the Moluccas for a long time, and the Spaniards sent him a letter, hoping he would betray his country and join Spain. He provided them with intriguing information about the expeditions the king of Portugal had sent to the Cape of Good Hope, the Rio de la Plata, and the Moluccas; however, due to various issues, these expeditions had not taken place. Lorosa had spent sixteen years in this Archipelago; the Portuguese had been established there for ten years, but they kept this information completely to themselves. When Lorosa saw the Spaniards preparing to leave, he boarded with his wife and belongings to return to Europe. On November 12th, all the merchandise meant for trade was unloaded, primarily from the four junks seized in Borneo. The Spaniards certainly made a good profit from trade, but still not as much as they could have, as they were eager to get back to Spain. Some ships from Gilolo and Batchian also came to trade with them, and a few days later, they received a substantial amount of cloves from the king of Tidor. This king invited them to a big banquet that he said he usually held when a vessel or junk was loaded with the first cloves. However, the Spaniards, recalling their previous experiences in the Philippines, declined the invitation while offering compliments and apologies to the king. Once their cargo was loaded, they set sail. Hardly had the Trinidad hit the water when it became clear that it had a serious leak, making a return to Tidor necessary as fast as possible. The skilled divers the king provided couldn’t find the hole, and they had to partially unload the ship to make the necessary repairs. The sailors on board the Victoria wouldn’t wait for their crew mates, and the ship's officers, seeing that the Trinidad wouldn’t be seaworthy for the trip to Spain, decided it should head to Darien, where its valuable cargo would be unloaded and transported across the Isthmus to the Atlantic, from where a ship would be sent to retrieve it. But neither the unfortunate vessel nor its crew was ever meant to return to Spain.
The Trinidad, commanded by the alguazil Gonzalo Gomez de Espinosa, who had Juan de Carvalho as pilot, was in so bad a state that after leaving Tidor, she was obliged to anchor at Ternate, in the port of Talangomi, where her crew consisting of seventeen men was immediately imprisoned by the Portuguese. The only reply given to Espinosa's remonstrances was a threat to hang him to the yard of a vessel; and the unfortunate alguazil, after having been transferred to Cochin, was sent to Lisbon, where for seven months he remained shut up in the prison of the Limoeiro with two Spaniards, the sole survivors of the crew of the Trinidad.
The Trinidad, led by the sheriff Gonzalo Gomez de Espinosa, with Juan de Carvalho as the pilot, was in such bad shape that after leaving Tidor, it had to anchor at Ternate, in the port of Talangomi, where its crew of seventeen men was promptly imprisoned by the Portuguese. The only response to Espinosa's protests was a threat to hang him from the yard of a ship; and the unfortunate sheriff, after being taken to Cochin, was sent to Lisbon, where he spent seven months locked up in the Limoeiro prison with two Spaniards, the only survivors from the crew of the Trinidad.
As to the Victoria, she left Tidor richly laden under the command of Juan Sebastian del Cano, who, after having been simply a pilot on board one of Magellan's ships, had taken the command of the Concepcion on the 27th of April, 1521, and who succeeded to Juan Lopez de Carvalho, when the latter was superseded in his command for incapacity. The crew of the Victoria was composed of only fifty-three Europeans and thirteen Indians. Fifty-four Europeans remained at Tidor on board the Trinidad.
As for the Victoria, she set sail from Tidor fully loaded under the command of Juan Sebastian del Cano, who, after starting as just a pilot on one of Magellan's ships, took over the command of the Concepcion on April 27, 1521, and succeeded Juan Lopez de Carvalho when he was removed from his position for incompetence. The crew of the Victoria consisted of only fifty-three Europeans and thirteen Indians. Fifty-four Europeans stayed at Tidor on board the Trinidad.
After passing amidst the islands of Caioan, Laigoma, Sico, Giofi, Cafi, Laboan, Toliman, Batchian, Mata, and Batu, the Victoria left this latter island to the west, and steering west-south-west, stopped during the night at the island of Xulla or Zulla. At thirty miles from thence the Spaniards anchored at Booro, (the Boero of Bougainville), where the ship was revictualled. They stopped 105 miles further on, at Banda, where mace and nutmegs are found, then at Solor, where a great trade in white sandal-wood is carried on. They spent a fortnight there to repair their ship, which had suffered much, and there they laid in an ample provision of wax and pepper; then they anchored at Timor, where they could only obtain provisions by retaining by stratagem the chief of the village and his son, who had come on board the ship. This island was frequented by junks from Luzon, and by the "praos," from Malacca and Java, which traded largely there in sandal-wood and pepper. A little further on the Spaniards touched at Java, where, as it appears, suttee was practised at this time, as it has been in India until quite recently.
After passing through the islands of Caioan, Laigoma, Sico, Giofi, Cafi, Laboan, Toliman, Batchian, Mata, and Batu, the Victoria left Batu to the west and, steering west-south-west, stopped for the night at the island of Xulla or Zulla. Thirty miles from there, the Spaniards anchored at Booro (the Boero of Bougainville), where the ship was restocked with supplies. They stopped 105 miles further at Banda, where mace and nutmeg are found, then at Solor, where there is a significant trade in white sandalwood. They spent two weeks there to repair their ship, which had taken considerable damage, and stocked up on wax and pepper; then they anchored at Timor, where they could only get provisions by cleverly keeping the village chief and his son, who had come on board the ship, as hostages. This island was frequented by junks from Luzon and by "praos" from Malacca and Java, which traded extensively in sandalwood and pepper. A bit further on, the Spaniards stopped at Java, where, it seems, suttee was practiced at that time, as it had been in India until quite recently.
Among the stories which Pigafetta relates, without entirely believing them, is one which is most curious. It concerns a gigantic bird the Epyornis, of which the bones and the enormous eggs were discovered in Madagascar about the year 1850. It is an instance proving the caution needed before rejecting as fictitious many apparently fabulous legends, but which on examination may prove to possess a substratum of truth. "To the north of Greater Java," says Pigafetta, "in the gulf of China, there is a very large tree called campanganghi inhabited by certain birds called garula, which are so large and strong that they can bear away a buffalo and even an elephant, and carry it as they fly to the place where the tree puzathaer is." This legend has been current ever since the ninth century, among the Persians and Arabs, and this bird plays a wonderful part in Arabian tales under the name of the roc. It is not surprising, therefore, that Pigafetta found an analogous tradition among the Malays.
Among the stories that Pigafetta shares, without fully believing them, is one that is quite fascinating. It talks about a gigantic bird called the Epyornis, whose bones and enormous eggs were found in Madagascar around 1850. This example demonstrates the caution needed before dismissing many seemingly fictional legends, which, upon closer inspection, might actually have a basis in truth. "To the north of Greater Java," Pigafetta says, "in the Gulf of China, there's a very large tree called campanganghi inhabited by certain birds called garula, which are so big and strong that they can carry off a buffalo and even an elephant, transporting it as they fly to where the tree puzathaer is." This legend has been known since the ninth century among Persians and Arabs, and this bird plays a remarkable role in Arabian tales under the name roc. It's not surprising, then, that Pigafetta found a similar tradition among the Malays.
After leaving greater Java, the Victoria rounded the peninsula of Malacca, which had been subjugated to Portugal by the great Albuquerque ten years before. In the immediate neighbourhood are Siam and Cambodia, and Tchiampa, where rhubarb grows. This substance is discovered in the following manner. "A company of from twenty to five-and-twenty men go into the wood, where they pass the night in the trees, to protect themselves from lions (note here, that there are no lions in this country), and other ferocious beasts, and also that they may better perceive the odour of the rhubarb, which the wind wafts towards them. In the morning they go towards the place whence came the odour, and search there for the rhubarb until they find it. Rhubarb is the putrefied wood of a great tree, and acquires its odour even from its putrefaction, the best part of the tree is the root, nevertheless the trunk, which they call calama, has the same medicinal virtue."
After leaving greater Java, the Victoria sailed around the Malacca Peninsula, which had been taken over by Portugal under the great Albuquerque ten years earlier. Nearby are Siam and Cambodia, as well as Tchiampa, where rhubarb grows. This substance is found in the following way. "A group of twenty to twenty-five men enters the woods, where they spend the night in the trees to protect themselves from lions (note that there are no lions in this country) and other fierce animals, and also to better catch the scent of the rhubarb, which the wind carries to them. In the morning, they head towards the source of the scent and search for the rhubarb until they find it. Rhubarb is the decayed wood of a large tree, and it gets its scent from its decay; the best part of the tree is the root, but the trunk, which they call calama, has the same medicinal properties."
Decidedly it is not from Pigafetta that we should seek to acquire botanical knowledge; we should run a great risk of deceiving ourselves if we took in earnest the nonsense that the Moor told him from whom he drew his information. The Lombard traveller gives us also fantastic details about China with the greatest seriousness, and falls into the grave errors, which his contemporary Duarte Barbosa had avoided. It is to the latter we owe the information that the trade in anfiam or opium has existed from this period. When once the Victoria had left the shores of Malacca, Sebastian del Cano took great care to avoid the coast of Zanguebar, where the Portuguese had been established since the beginning of the century. He kept to the open sea as far as 42° south latitude, and for nine weeks he was obliged to keep the sails furled, on account of the constant west and north-west winds, which ended in a fearful storm. To keep to this course required great perseverance on the part of the captain, with a settled desire on his part to carry his enterprise to a successful issue. The vessel had several leaks, and a number of the sailors demanded an anchorage at Mozambique, for the provisions which were not salted having become bad, the crew had only rice and water for food and drink. At last on the 6th of May, the Cape of Tempests was doubled and a favourable issue to the voyage might be hoped for. Nevertheless, many vexatious accidents still awaited the navigator. In two months, twenty-one men, Europeans and Indians, died from privations, and if on the 9th July they had not landed at Santiago, one of the Cape de Verd Islands, the whole crew would have died of hunger. As this archipelago belonged to Portugal, the sailors took care to say that they came from America, and carefully concealed the route which they had discovered. But one of the sailors having had the imprudence to say that the Victoria was the only vessel of Magellan's squadron which had returned to Europe, the Portuguese immediately seized the crew of a long-boat, and prepared to attack the Spanish vessel. However, Del Cano on board his vessel was watching all the movements of the Portuguese, and suspecting, by the preparations which he saw, that there was an intention of seizing the Victoria, he set sail, leaving thirteen men of his crew in the hands of the Portuguese. Maximilian Transylvain assigns a different motive from the one given by Pigafetta, for the anchorage at the Cape de Verd Islands. He asserts that the fatigued state of the crew, who were reduced by privations, and who in spite of everything had not ceased to work the pumps, had decided the captain to stop and buy some slaves to aid them in this work. Having no money the Spaniards would have paid with some of their spices, which would have opened the eyes of the Portuguese.
Clearly, we shouldn’t look to Pigafetta for botanical knowledge; we’d be at risk of misleading ourselves if we took seriously the nonsense that the Moor fed him for information. The Lombard traveler also presents outrageous details about China with utmost seriousness and makes significant mistakes that his contemporary Duarte Barbosa managed to avoid. We owe it to the latter for the knowledge that the trade in anfiam or opium has been around since this time. Once the Victoria left the shores of Malacca, Sebastian del Cano took great care to steer clear of the coast of Zanguebar, where the Portuguese had established themselves since the start of the century. He kept to the open sea, reaching 42° south latitude, and endured nine weeks with the sails furled due to constant westerly and northwesterly winds that culminated in a terrifying storm. Sticking to this route required significant determination from the captain, who was committed to seeing his mission through successfully. The ship had several leaks, and a number of sailors wanted to anchor at Mozambique, as their non-salted provisions had spoiled, leaving the crew with only rice and water for sustenance. Finally, on May 6, they rounded the Cape of Tempests, and there was hope for a positive outcome for the voyage. However, many frustrating incidents still lay ahead for the navigator. In two months, twenty-one men, Europeans and Indians alike, died from deprivation, and if they hadn’t landed at Santiago, one of the Cape Verde Islands, on July 9, the entire crew would have starved. Since this archipelago belonged to Portugal, the sailors claimed they came from America and carefully hid the route they had discovered. But one sailor recklessly mentioned that the Victoria was the only ship of Magellan's squadron to return to Europe, which led the Portuguese to immediately seize a crew member from a longboat and prepare to attack the Spanish ship. However, Del Cano was monitoring the actions of the Portuguese closely and, suspecting their intention to capture the Victoria, he set sail, leaving thirteen of his crew in the hands of the Portuguese. Maximilian Transylvain offers a different reason from Pigafetta for anchoring at the Cape Verde Islands. He argues that the crew’s exhaustion, after enduring hardships and continuing to work the pumps despite it all, led the captain to stop and buy some slaves to assist with this labor. With no money, the Spaniards planned to pay with some of their spices, which would have alerted the Portuguese.
"To see if our journals were correctly kept," says Pigafetta, "we inquired on shore what day of the week it was. They replied that it was Thursday, which surprised us, because according to our journals it was as yet only Wednesday. We could not be persuaded that we had made the mistake of a day; I was more astonished myself than the others were, because having always been sufficiently well to keep my journal, I had uninterruptedly marked the days of the week, and the course of the months. We learnt afterwards, that there was no error in our calculation, for having always travelled towards the west, following the course of the sun, and having returned to the same point, we must have gained twenty-four hours upon those who had remained stationary; one has only need of reflection to be convinced of this fact."
"To check if we had kept our journals correctly," says Pigafetta, "we asked on shore what day of the week it was. They said it was Thursday, which surprised us because according to our journals, it was still only Wednesday. We couldn’t believe we had made a mistake with the day; I was more shocked than the others because I had always been well enough to keep my journal and had consistently marked the days of the week and the progression of the months. We later learned that there was no error in our calculations, as we had always traveled west, following the sun, and had returned to the same point, meaning we must have gained twenty-four hours on those who stayed put; one only needs to think about it to realize this."
Sebastian del Cano rapidly made the coast of Africa, and on the 6th of September entered the Bay of San Lucar de Barrameda, with a crew of seventeen men, almost all of whom were ill. Two days later he anchored before the mole at Seville, after having accomplished a complete circuit of the world.
Sebastian del Cano quickly reached the coast of Africa, and on September 6th, he entered the Bay of San Lucar de Barrameda with a crew of seventeen men, most of whom were sick. Two days later, he anchored in front of the mole at Seville, having completed a full trip around the world.
As soon as he arrived, Sebastian del Cano went to Valladolid, where the court was, and received from Charles V. the welcome which was merited after so many difficulties had been courageously overcome. The bold mariner received permission to take as his armorial bearings, a globe with this motto, Primus circumdedisti me, and he also received a pension of 500 ducats.
As soon as he arrived, Sebastian del Cano went to Valladolid, where the court was, and received from Charles V the welcome he deserved after overcoming so many challenges. The brave sailor was granted permission to use a globe as his coat of arms with the motto, Primus circumdedisti me, and he also received a pension of 500 ducats.
The rich freight of the Victoria, decided the Emperor to send a second fleet to the Moluccas. The supreme command of it was not, however, given to Sebastian del Cano; it was reserved for the commander Garcia de Loaisa, whose only claim to it was his grand name. However, after the death of the chief of the expedition, which happened as soon as the fleet had passed the Strait of Magellan, Del Cano found himself invested with the command, but he did not hold it long, for he died six days afterwards. As for the ship Victoria, she was long preserved in the port of Seville, but in spite of all the care that was taken of her, she at length fell to pieces from old age.
The valuable cargo of the Victoria led the Emperor to decide to send a second fleet to the Moluccas. However, the supreme command wasn't given to Sebastian del Cano; it was instead entrusted to Commander Garcia de Loaisa, whose only claim to the position was his impressive name. After the death of the expedition's leader, which occurred shortly after the fleet passed through the Strait of Magellan, del Cano found himself in command, but he didn't keep it long, as he died six days later. As for the ship Victoria, she was kept for a long time in the port of Seville, but despite all the care taken to maintain her, she eventually fell apart due to old age.
CHAPTER III.
I.
The Northmen—Eric the Red—The Zenos—John Cabot—Cortereal—Sebastian Cabot—Willoughby—Chancellor.
The Northmen—Eric the Red—The Zenos—John Cabot—Cortereal—Sebastian Cabot—Willoughby—Chancellor.
Pytheas had opened up the road to the north to the Scandinavians by discovering Iceland (the famous Thule) and the Cronian Ocean, of which the mud, the shallow-water, and the ice render the navigation dangerous, and where the nights are as light as twilight. The traditions of the voyages undertaken by the ancients to the Orkneys, the Faröe Islands, and even to Iceland, were treasured up among the Irish monks, who were learned men, and themselves bold mariners, as their successive establishments in these archipelagos clearly prove. They were also the pilots of the Northmen, a name given generally to the Scandinavian pirates, both Danish and Norwegian, who rendered themselves so formidable to the whole of Europe during the Middle Ages. But if all the information that we owe to the ancients, both Greeks and Romans, with regard to these hyperborean countries be extremely vague and so to speak fabulous, it is not so with that which concerns the adventurous enterprises of the "Men of the North." The Sagas, as the Icelandic and Danish songs are called, are extremely precise, and the numerous data which we owe to them are daily confirmed by the archæological discoveries made in America, Greenland, Iceland, Norway, and Denmark. This is a source of valuable information which was long unknown and unexplored, and of which we owe the revelation to the learned Dane, C. C. Rafn, who has furnished us with authentic facts of the greatest interest bearing on the pre-Columbian discovery of America.
Pytheas opened up the northern route to the Scandinavians by discovering Iceland (the famous Thule) and the Cronian Ocean, where the mud, shallow waters, and ice make navigation dangerous, and where nights are as bright as twilight. The Irish monks, who were educated men and daring sailors as shown by their subsequent settlements in these archipelagos, preserved the traditions of ancient voyages to the Orkneys, the Faroe Islands, and even to Iceland. They were also the navigators for the Northmen, a term generally applied to the Scandinavian pirates, both Danish and Norwegian, who became a major threat to all of Europe during the Middle Ages. While the information we have from the ancients, both Greeks and Romans, about these hyperborean lands is quite vague and almost mythical, that isn’t the case with the adventurous exploits of the "Men of the North." The Sagas, which are the Icelandic and Danish songs, are very detailed, and the many insights we gain from them are continually validated by archaeological discoveries in America, Greenland, Iceland, Norway, and Denmark. This is a rich source of valuable information that was long overlooked, and we owe its revelation to the learned Dane, C. C. Rafn, who provided us with authentic facts of great interest regarding the pre-Columbian discovery of America.
Norway was poor and encumbered with population. Hence arose the necessity for a permanent emigration, which should allow a considerable portion of the inhabitants to seek in more favoured regions the nourishment which a frozen soil denied them. When they had found some country rich enough to yield them an abundant spoil, they then returned to their own land, and set out the following spring accompanied by all those who could be enticed either by the love of lucre, the desire for an easy life, or by the thirst for strife. Intrepid hunters and fishermen, accustomed to a dangerous navigation between the continent and the mass of islands which border it and appear to defend it against the assaults of the ocean, and across the narrow, deep fiords, which seem as though they were cut into the soil itself by some gigantic sword, they set out in those oak vessels, the sight of which made the people tremble who lived on the shores of the North Sea and British Channel. Sometimes decked, these vessels, long or short, large or small, were usually terminated in front by a spur of enormous size, above which the prow sometimes rose to a great height, taking the form of an S. The hällristningar, for so they call the graphic representations so often met with on the rocks of Sweden and Norway, enable us to picture to ourselves these swift vessels, which could carry a considerable crew. Such was the Long-serpent of Olaf Tryggvason, which had thirty-two benches of rowers and held ninety men, Canute's vessel, which carried sixty, and the two vessels of Olaf the Saint, which carried sometimes 200 men. The Sea-kings, as they often called these adventurers, lived on the ocean, never settling on shore, passing from the pillage of a castle to the burning of an abbey, devastating the coasts of France, ascending rivers, especially the Seine, as far as Paris, sailing over the Mediterranean as far as Constantinople, establishing themselves later in Sicily, and leaving traces of their incursions or their sojourn in all the regions of the known world.
Norway was poor and had a large population. This created the need for permanent emigration, allowing many people to seek sustenance in more favorable areas that a frozen land denied them. When they found a place rich enough to provide them with plenty, they would return home and set out the next spring with anyone who could be tempted by the lure of money, the desire for an easy life, or the thirst for adventure. Fearless hunters and fishermen, used to navigating the dangerous waters between the continent and the islands that seem to protect it from the ocean's fury, and across the narrow, deep fiords that appear as if carved into the land by some gigantic sword, they embarked in their oak ships, which frightened those living along the North Sea and the English Channel. Sometimes equipped with decks, these vessels—long or short, big or small—typically had a massive spur at the front, with the prow sometimes rising high, shaped like an S. The hällristningar, as they call the graphic representations often found on the rocks of Sweden and Norway, help us imagine these swift ships, which could carry a significant crew. Such was the Long-serpent of Olaf Tryggvason, which had thirty-two rows of oars and held ninety men, Canute's ship, which carried sixty, and the two ships of Olaf the Saint, which sometimes held 200 men. The Sea-kings, as these adventurers were often called, lived at sea, never settling on land, moving from robbing castles to burning abbeys, ravaging the coasts of France, sailing up rivers, especially the Seine, all the way to Paris, and crossing the Mediterranean as far as Constantinople, eventually establishing themselves in Sicily and leaving traces of their raids or stays in all the known regions of the world.
![]() |
Norman Ships. |
Piracy, far from being, as at the present day, an act falling under the ban of the law, was not only encouraged in that barbarous or half-civilized society, but was celebrated in the songs of the Skalds, who reserved their most enthusiastic eulogies for celebrating chivalrous struggles, adventurous privateering, and all exhibitions of strength. From the eighth century, these formidable sea-rovers frequented the groups of the Orkney, the Hebrides, the Shetland, and Faröe Islands, where they met with the Irish monks, who had settled themselves there nearly a century earlier, to instruct the idolatrous population.
Piracy, rather than being the illegal act it is today, was not only accepted but celebrated in that brutal or partially civilized society. It was praised in the songs of the Skalds, who dedicated their most passionate praises to heroic battles, daring privateering, and any displays of strength. Since the eighth century, these powerful sea raiders often visited the groups of the Orkney, the Hebrides, the Shetland, and Faröe Islands, where they encountered the Irish monks who had settled there nearly a century earlier to educate the idol-worshipping locals.
In 861 a Norwegian pirate, named Naddod, was carried by a storm towards an island covered with snow, which he named Snoland (land of snow), a name changed later to that of Iceland (land of ice). There again the Northmen found the Irish monks under the name of Papis, in the cantons of Papeya and Papili.
In 861, a Norwegian pirate named Naddod was caught in a storm and drifted toward a snowy island, which he called Snoland (land of snow), a name that was later changed to Iceland (land of ice). There, the Norse found Irish monks known as the Papis, in the regions of Papeya and Papili.
Ingolf installed himself some years afterwards in the country, and founded Reijkiavik. In 885 the triumph of Harold Haarfager, who had just subjugated the whole of Norway by force of arms, brought a considerable number of malcontents to Iceland. They established there the republican form of government, which had just been overthrown in their own country, and which subsisted till 1261, the epoch when Iceland passed under the dominion of the kings of Norway.
Ingolf settled in the countryside a few years later and founded Reykjavik. In 885, the victory of Harold Haarfager, who had just conquered all of Norway by force, drove many discontented people to Iceland. They established a republican form of government there, which had just been overthrown in their own country, and this system lasted until 1261, the time when Iceland came under the rule of the kings of Norway.
When established in Iceland, these bold fellows, lovers of adventure and of long hunts in pursuit of seals and walrus, retained their wandering habits and pursued their bold plans in the west, where only three years after the arrival of Ingolf, Guunbjorn discovered the snowy peaks of the mountains of Greenland. Five years later, Eric the Red, banished from Iceland for murder, rediscovered the land in latitude 64° north, of which Guunbjorn had caught a glimpse. The sterility of this ice-bound coast made him decide to seek a milder climate with a more open country, and one producing more game, in the south. So he rounded Cape Farewell at the extremity of Greenland, established himself on the west coast, and built some vast dwellings for himself and his companions, of which M. Jorgensen has discovered the ruins. This country was worthy at that period of the name of Green-Land (Groenland) which the Northmen gave to it, but the annual and great increase of the glaciers, has rendered it since that epoch a land of desolation.
When they settled in Iceland, these adventurous guys, who loved long hunts for seals and walrus, kept their wandering ways and started their daring journeys to the west. Just three years after Ingolf arrived, Guunbjorn spotted the snowy mountains of Greenland. Five years later, Eric the Red, exiled from Iceland for murder, rediscovered the land at latitude 64° north that Guunbjorn had seen. The barren ice-covered coast led him to look for a milder climate with more open land and more game in the south. He rounded Cape Farewell at the southern tip of Greenland, set up on the west coast, and built large homes for himself and his friends, the ruins of which M. Jorgensen has found. At that time, the place truly deserved the name Greenland (Groenland) that the Norse gave it, but the ever-growing glaciers have turned it into a desolate land since then.
Eric returned to Iceland to seek his friends, and in the same year that he returned to Brattahalida (for so he called his settlement), fourteen vessels laden with emigrants came to join him. It was a veritable exodus. These events took place in the year 1000. As quickly as the resources of the country allowed of it, the population of Greenland increased, and in 1121, Gardar, the capital of the country, became the seat of a bishopric, which existed until after the discovery of the Antilles by Christopher Columbus.
Eric went back to Iceland to find his friends, and in the same year that he returned to Brattahalida (the name he gave his settlement), fourteen ships loaded with emigrants came to join him. It was a massive migration. These events happened in the year 1000. As quickly as the country could support it, the population of Greenland grew, and in 1121, Gardar, the capital of the country, became the center of a bishopric, which lasted until after Christopher Columbus discovered the Antilles.
In 986 Bjarn Heriulfson, who had come from Norway to Iceland to spend the winter with his father, learnt that the latter had joined Eric the Red in Greenland. Without hesitation, the young man again put to sea, seeking at haphazard for a country of which he did not even know the exact situation, and was cast by currents on coasts which we think must have been those of New Scotland, Newfoundland, and Maine. He ended, however, by reaching Greenland, where Eric, the powerful Norwegian jarl, reproached him for not having examined with more care countries of which he owed his knowledge to a happy accident of the sea.
In 986, Bjarn Heriulfson, who had traveled from Norway to Iceland to spend the winter with his father, found out that his father had gone to join Eric the Red in Greenland. Without thinking twice, the young man set sail again, searching randomly for a land he wasn’t even sure about, and was swept by currents onto coastlines that we believe were parts of New Scotland, Newfoundland, and Maine. However, he eventually made it to Greenland, where Eric, the powerful Norwegian jarl, scolded him for not exploring the lands he only knew about by a lucky chance encounter at sea.
Eric had sent his son Leif to the Norwegian court, so close at this time was the connexion between the metropolis and the colonies. The king, who had been converted to Christianity, had just despatched a mission to Iceland charged to overthrow the worship of Odin. He committed to Leif's care some priests who were to instruct the Greenlanders; but scarcely had the young adventurer returned to his own country, when he left the holy men to work out the accomplishment of their difficult task and hearing of the discovery made by Bjarn, he fitted out his vessels and went to seek for the lands which had been only imperfectly seen. He landed first on a desolate and stony plain, to which he gave the name of Helluland, and which we have no hesitation in recognizing as Newfoundland, and afterwards on a flat sandy shore behind which rose an immense screen of dark forests, cheered by the songs of innumerable birds. A third time he put to sea and steering towards the south he arrived at the Bay of Rhode Island, where the mild climate and the river teeming with salmon induced him to settle, and where he constructed vast buildings of planks, which he called Leifsbudir (Leif's house). Then he sent some of his companions to explore the country, and they returned with the good news that the wild vine grows in the country, to which it owes the name of Vinland. In the spring of the year 1001, Leif, having laded his ship with skins, grapes, wood, and other productions of the country, set out for Greenland; he had made the valuable observation that the shortest day in Vinland lasted nine hours, which places the site of Leifsbudir at 41° 24' 10". This fortunate voyage and the salvage of a Norwegian vessel carrying fifteen men, gained for Leif the surname of the Fortunate.
Eric had sent his son Leif to the Norwegian court, reflecting how close the connection was between the capital and the colonies at that time. The king, who had converted to Christianity, had just dispatched a mission to Iceland tasked with ending the worship of Odin. He entrusted Leif with some priests who were supposed to teach the Greenlanders; however, shortly after the young adventurer returned home, he left the holy men to tackle their challenging mission and, upon hearing about the discovery made by Bjarn, he gathered his ships and went to search for the lands that had only been partially seen. He first landed on a barren, rocky plain, which he named Helluland, and which we can confidently identify as Newfoundland. Next, he landed on a flat, sandy shore with a massive backdrop of dark forests, filled with the songs of countless birds. On a third journey, he set sail again, heading south, and arrived at the Bay of Rhode Island, where the mild climate and salmon-rich river tempted him to settle. There, he built large wooden structures, which he called Leifsbudir (Leif's house). He then sent some of his companions to explore the area, and they returned with great news that wild grapes grew there, earning the region the name Vinland. In the spring of 1001, Leif loaded his ship with skins, grapes, wood, and other resources from the land and set out for Greenland. He made a valuable observation that the shortest day in Vinland lasted nine hours, placing the location of Leifsbudir at 41° 24' 10". This successful voyage and the rescue of a Norwegian ship carrying fifteen men earned Leif the nickname "the Fortunate."
This expedition made a great stir, and the account of the wonders of the country in which Leif had settled, induced his brother Thorvald, to set out with thirty men. After passing the winter at Leifsbudir, Thorvald explored the coasts to the south, returning in the autumn to Vinland, and in the following year 1004, he sailed along the coast to the north of Leifsbudir. During this return voyage, the Northmen met with the Esquimaux for the first time, and without any provocation, slaughtered them without mercy. The following night they found themselves all at once surrounded by a numerous flotilla of Kayacs, from which came a cloud of arrows. Thorvald alone, the chief of the expedition, was mortally wounded; he was buried by his companions on a promontory, to which they gave the name of the promontory of the Cross.
This expedition created quite a buzz, and the stories about the amazing land where Leif had settled inspired his brother Thorvald to head out with thirty men. After spending the winter at Leifsbudir, Thorvald explored the southern coasts and returned to Vinland in the autumn. The next year, 1004, he sailed along the northern coast of Leifsbudir. During this return journey, the Northmen encountered the Esquimaux for the first time and, without any provocation, brutally attacked them. That night, they suddenly found themselves surrounded by a large fleet of Kayacs, which unleashed a barrage of arrows. Thorvald, the leader of the expedition, was mortally wounded; his companions buried him on a promontory, which they named the Promontory of the Cross.
Now, in the Gulf of Boston in the eighteenth century, a tomb of masonry was discovered, in which, with the bones, was found a sword-hilt of iron. The Indians not being acquainted with this metal, it could not be one of their skeletons; it was not either, the remains of one of the Europeans who had landed after the fifteenth century, for their swords had not this very characteristic form. This tomb has been thought to be that of a Scandinavian, and we venture to say, that of Thorvald, son of Eric the Red.
Now, in the Gulf of Boston during the eighteen hundreds, a stone tomb was discovered that contained bones and an iron sword hilt. Since the Native Americans weren't familiar with this metal, it couldn't belong to one of them; it also wasn't the remains of any Europeans who arrived after the fifteenth century, because their swords didn't have this specific shape. This tomb is believed to be that of a Scandinavian, and we dare to suggest it could belong to Thorvald, the son of Eric the Red.
In the spring of 1007, three vessels carrying 160 men and some cattle, left Eriksfjord; the object in view was the foundation of a permanent colony. The emigrants after sighting Helluland, Markland, and Vinland, landed in an island, upon which they constructed some barracks and began the work of cultivation. But they must either have laid their plans badly, or have been wanting in foresight, for the winter found them without provisions, and they suffered cruelly from hunger. They had, however, the good sense to regain the continent, where in comparative ease, they could await the end of the winter.
In the spring of 1007, three ships carrying 160 men and some cattle left Eriksfjord with the goal of establishing a permanent colony. After spotting Helluland, Markland, and Vinland, the emigrants landed on an island, where they built some barracks and started cultivating the land. However, they must have poorly planned or lacked foresight, as winter arrived and they found themselves without food, suffering greatly from hunger. Fortunately, they wisely chose to return to the mainland, where they could wait out the winter more comfortably.
At the beginning of 1008, they set out to seek for Leifsbudir, and settled themselves at Mount-Hope Bay, on the opposite shore to the old settlement of Leif. There, for the first time, some intercourse was held with the natives, called Skrellings in the sagas, and whom, from the manner in which they are portrayed, it is easy to recognize as Esquimaux. The first meeting was peaceable, and barter was carried on with them until the day when the desire of the Esquimaux to acquire iron hatchets, always prudently refused them by the Northmen, drove them to acts of aggression, which decided the new-comers, after three years of residence, to return to their own country, which they did without leaving behind them any lasting trace of their stay in the country.
At the beginning of 1008, they set out to search for Leifsbudir and settled at Mount-Hope Bay, across from the old settlement of Leif. For the first time, they interacted with the natives, referred to as Skrellings in the sagas, who resemble the Eskimos based on their portrayal. The first encounter was friendly, and they traded with the natives until the day when the natives' desire for iron hatchets, which the Norsemen always wisely refused to give them, led to aggressive actions. This prompted the newcomers, after three years of living there, to return to their homeland, leaving no lasting evidence of their presence in the area.
It will be easily understood that we cannot give any detailed account of all the expeditions, which set out from Greenland, and succeeded each other on the coasts of Labrador and the United States. Those of our readers who wish for circumstantial details, should refer to M. Gabriel Gravier's interesting publication, the most complete work on the subject, and from which we have borrowed all that relates to the Norman expeditions.
It’s easy to see that we can’t provide a detailed account of all the expeditions that left from Greenland and followed one after another along the coasts of Labrador and the United States. Readers who want more specific details should check out M. Gabriel Gravier's interesting publication, the most comprehensive work on the topic, from which we have taken everything related to the Norman expeditions.
The same year as Erik the Red landed in Greenland (983), a certain Hari Marson, being driven out of the ordinary course by storms, was cast upon the shores of a country known by the name of "White man's land," which extended according to Rafn from Chesapeake Bay to Florida.
The same year Erik the Red arrived in Greenland (983), a man named Hari Marson, pushed off course by storms, ended up on the shores of a place called "White man's land," which, according to Rafn, stretched from Chesapeake Bay to Florida.
What is the meaning of this name "White man's land"? Had some compatriots of Marson's already settled there? There is some reason to suppose so even from the words used in the chronicle. We can understand how interesting it would be, to be able to determine the nationality of these first colonists. However, the Sagas have not as yet revealed all their secrets. There are probably, some of them still unknown, and as those which have been successively discovered, have confirmed facts already admitted, there is every reason to hope that our knowledge of Icelandic navigation may become more precise.
What does the name "White man's land" mean? Did some of Marson's fellow countrymen already settle there? There's some evidence to suggest that, even from the words used in the chronicle. It would be really interesting to figure out the nationality of these first colonists. However, the Sagas haven't revealed all their secrets yet. There are probably still some unknowns, and since the ones that have been discovered so far have confirmed previously accepted facts, we have every reason to believe that our understanding of Icelandic navigation may become clearer.
Another legend, of which great part is mere romance, but which nevertheless, contains a foundation of truth, relates that a certain Bjorn, who was obliged to quit Iceland in consequence of an unfortunate passion, took refuge in the countries beyond Vinland, where in 1027, he was found by some of his countrymen.
Another legend, much of which is just a story, but still has some truth to it, talks about a man named Bjorn, who had to leave Iceland because of a bad romance. He ended up finding shelter in the lands beyond Vinland, where in 1027, he was discovered by some fellow countrymen.
In 1051, during another expedition, an Icelandic woman was killed by some Skrellings, and in 1867, a tomb was exhumed, bearing a runic inscription, and containing bones, and some articles of the toilet, which are now preserved in the museum at Washington. This discovery was made at the exact spot indicated in the Saga which related these events, and which was not itself discovered until 1863.
In 1051, during another expedition, an Icelandic woman was killed by some Skrellings. In 1867, a tomb was dug up that had a runic inscription and contained bones, along with some personal items, which are now kept in the museum in Washington. This discovery happened at the precise location mentioned in the Saga that told these events, which itself wasn't found until 1863.
But the Northmen, established in Iceland and Greenland, were not the only people who frequented the coast of America about the year 1000, which is proved by the name of "Great Ireland," which was given to White man's land. As the history of Madoc-op-Owen proves, the Irish and Welsh founded colonies there, regarding which we have but little information, but vague and uncertain as it is, MM. d'Avezac and Gaffarel agree in recognizing its probability.
But the Norse, who settled in Iceland and Greenland, weren't the only ones visiting the coast of America around the year 1000. This is demonstrated by the name "Great Ireland," which was given to the land of the white man. The history of Madoc-op-Owen shows that the Irish and Welsh established colonies there. We have very little information about these colonies, but despite how vague and uncertain it is, both MM. d'Avezac and Gaffarel agree that it's likely true.
Having now said a few words upon the travels and settlements of the Northmen in Labrador, Vinland, and the more southern countries, we must return to the north. The colonies first founded in the neighbourhood of Cape Farewell, had not been slow in stretching along the western coast, which at this period was infinitely less desolate than it is at the present day, as far as northern latitudes, which were not again reached until our own day. Thus at this time they caught seals, walrus, and whales in the bay of Disco; there were 190 towns counted then in Westerbygd and eighty-six in Esterbygd, while at the present day, there are far fewer Danish settlements on these icy shores. These towns were probably only inconsiderable groups of those houses in stone and wood, of which so many ruins have been found from Cape Farewell, as far as Upernavik in about 72° 50'. At the same time numerous runic inscriptions, which have now been deciphered, have given a degree of absolute certainty to facts so long unknown. But how many of these vestiges of the past still remain to be discovered! how many of these valuable evidences of the bravery and spirit of enterprise of the Scandinavian race are for ever buried under the glaciers!
Having shared some insights about the travels and settlements of the Northmen in Labrador, Vinland, and the southern regions, we now need to shift our focus back to the north. The colonies that were initially established near Cape Farewell began to extend along the western coast, which at that time was far less desolate than it is today, reaching northern latitudes that aren't seen again until modern times. During this time, they hunted seals, walrus, and whales in the bay of Disco; there were 190 towns counted in Westerbygd and eighty-six in Esterbygd, whereas today, there are many fewer Danish settlements on these icy shores. These towns were likely just small clusters of stone and wooden houses, many of which have left ruins from Cape Farewell all the way to Upernavik at around 72° 50'. Meanwhile, numerous runic inscriptions that have now been deciphered have provided a level of certainty to facts that were previously unknown. But how many of these remnants from the past are still waiting to be found! How many valuable pieces of evidence showcasing the courage and adventurous spirit of the Scandinavian people remain forever hidden beneath the glaciers!
![]() |
The Glaciers of Greenland. |
We have also obtained evidence that Christianity had been brought into America, and especially into Greenland. To this country, according to the instructions of Pope Gregory IV., there were pastoral visits made to strengthen the newly-converted Northmen in the faith, and to evangelize the Esquimaux and the Indian tribes. Besides this, M. Riant in 1865, has proved incontrovertibly that the Crusades were preached in Greenland in the bishopric of Gardar, as well as in the islands and neighbouring lands, and that up to 1418, Greenland paid to the Holy See tithes and St. Peter's pence, which for that year consisted of 2600 lbs. of walrus tusks.
We have also found evidence that Christianity was introduced to America, particularly in Greenland. According to Pope Gregory IV's directives, there were pastoral visits made to support the newly converted Northmen in their faith and to spread the gospel to the Eskimos and Indian tribes. Additionally, in 1865, M. Riant definitively proved that the Crusades were promoted in Greenland, specifically in the bishopric of Gardar, as well as in the islands and neighboring lands. Up until 1418, Greenland paid tithes and St. Peter's pence to the Holy See, which for that year amounted to 2,600 lbs. of walrus tusks.
The Norwegian colonies owe their downfall and ruin to various causes: to the very rapid extension of the glaciers,—Hayes has proved that the glacier of Friar John moves at the rate of about thirty-three yards annually;—to the bad policy of the mother country, which prevented the recruiting of the colonies; to the black plague, which decimated the population of Greenland from 1347 to 1351; lastly, to the depredations of the pirates, who ravaged these already enfeebled countries in 1418, and in whom some have thought they recognized certain inhabitants of the Orkney and Faröe Islands, of which we are now about to speak.
The downfall and destruction of the Norwegian colonies can be attributed to several factors: the rapid expansion of the glaciers—Hayes has shown that the glacier of Friar John moves about thirty-three yards each year; the poor policies of the mother country, which hindered the recruitment of the colonies; the black plague, which wiped out a large portion of Greenland's population between 1347 and 1351; and finally, the attacks by pirates who devastated these already weakened regions in 1418, some of whom are believed to have been from the Orkney and Faröe Islands, which we are now going to discuss.
One of the companions of William the Conqueror, named Saint-Clair or Sinclair, not thinking that the portion of the conquered country allotted to him was proportioned to his merits, went to try his luck in Scotland, where he was not long in rising to fortune and honours. In the latter half of the fourteenth century, the Orkney Islands passed into the hands of his descendants.
One of William the Conqueror's companions, named Saint-Clair or Sinclair, felt that the piece of land given to him in the conquered territory didn’t match his worth, so he decided to try his luck in Scotland, where he quickly found success and recognition. In the later part of the fourteenth century, his descendants acquired the Orkney Islands.
About 1390, a certain Nicolo Zeno, a member of one of the most ancient and noble Venetian families, who had fitted out a vessel at his own expense, to visit England and Flanders as a matter of curiosity, was wrecked in the archipelago of the Orkneys whither he had been driven by a storm. He was about to be massacred by the inhabitants, when the Earl, Henry Sinclair took him under his protection. The history of this wreck, and the adventures and discoveries which followed it, published in the collection of Ramusio had been written by Antonio Zeno, says Clements Markham, the learned geographer, in his "Threshold of the Unknown Region." Unfortunately one of his descendants named Nicolo Zeno, born in 1515, when a boy, not knowing the value of these papers, tore them up, "but some of the letters surviving, he was able from them subsequently to compile the narrative as we now have it, and which was printed in Venice in 1558. There was also found in the palace an old map, rotten with age, illustrative of his voyages. Of this he made a copy, unluckily supplying from his own reading of the narrative what he thought was requisite for its illustration. By doing this in a blundering way, unaided by the geographical knowledge which enables us to see where he goes astray, he threw the whole of the geography which he derived from the narrative into the most lamentable confusion, while those parts of the map which are not thus sophisticated, and which are consequently original, present an accuracy far in advance by many generations of the geography even of Nicolo Zeno's time, and confirm in a notable manner the site of the old Greenland colony. In these facts we have not only the solution of all the discussions which have arisen on the subject, but the most indisputable proof of the authenticity of the narrative; for it is clear that Nicolo Zeno, junior, could not himself have been the ingenious concocter of a story the straightforward truth of which he could thus ignorantly distort upon the face of the map."
Around 1390, a man named Nicolo Zeno, from one of the oldest and most distinguished Venetian families, outfitted a ship on his own to explore England and Flanders out of curiosity. He was shipwrecked in the Orkney Islands after being caught in a storm. Just as he was about to be killed by the locals, the Earl, Henry Sinclair, stepped in to protect him. The story of this shipwreck, along with the adventures and discoveries that followed, was written by Antonio Zeno and published in Ramusio's collection, according to the scholar Clements Markham in his "Threshold of the Unknown Region." Unfortunately, one of his descendants, also named Nicolo Zeno, who was born in 1515, unknowingly destroyed the valuable documents when he was a child. However, some letters survived, allowing him to compile the narrative we have today, which was printed in Venice in 1558. An old, decayed map illustrating the voyages was also found in the palace. He made a copy of this map but mistakenly added details from his own understanding of the narrative, which led to significant inaccuracies. Lacking the geographical knowledge needed to spot his errors, he turned the geography from the narrative into a confusing mess. However, the parts of the map that remain unaltered are original and show a level of accuracy far ahead of Nicolo Zeno’s time, notably confirming the location of the old Greenland colony. These facts not only clarify all discussions on the subject but also provide undeniable proof of the narrative's authenticity. It's clear that Nicolo Zeno, Junior, could not have cleverly fabricated a story that he would then distort so carelessly on the map.
The name of Zichmni, in which writers of the present day, and chief among them Mr. H. Major, who has rescued these facts from the domain of fable, recognize the name of Sinclair—appears to be in fact only applicable to this earl of the Orkneys.
The name Zichmni, which modern writers, especially Mr. H. Major, have brought back from myth into reality, is believed to refer to Sinclair, but it seems to truly apply only to this earl of the Orkneys.
At this time the seas of the north of Europe were infected by Scandinavian pirates. Sinclair, who had recognized in Zeno a clever mariner, attached him to himself, and with him conquered the country of Frisland, the haunt of pirates, who ravaged all the north of Scotland. In the maps at the end of the fifteenth and beginning of the sixteenth century this name is applied to the archipelago of the Faröe Islands, a reasonable indication, for Buache has recognized in the present names of the harbours and islands of this archipelago a considerable number of those given by Zeno; finally the facts which we owe to the Venetian navigator about the waters,—abounding in fish and dangerous from shallows,—which divide this archipelago, are still true at the present day.
At this time, the northern seas of Europe were plagued by Scandinavian pirates. Sinclair, who saw that Zeno was a skilled sailor, made him part of his crew, and together they conquered the region of Frisland, a pirate stronghold that terrorized the northern coast of Scotland. On maps from the late 15th and early 16th centuries, this name refers to the archipelago of the Faröe Islands, which makes sense, as Buache identified many of the names of the harbors and islands in this archipelago that were originally given by Zeno. Ultimately, the information we have from the Venetian navigator about the waters—rich in fish and perilous due to shallow areas—that separate this archipelago is still accurate today.
Satisfied with his position, Zeno wrote to his brother Antonio to come and join him. While Sinclair was conquering the Faröe Islands, the Norwegian pirates desolated the Shetland Islands, then called Eastland. Nicolo set sail to give them battle, but was himself obliged to fly before their fleet, much more numerous than his own, and to take refuge on a small island on the coast of Iceland.
Satisfied with his situation, Zeno wrote to his brother Antonio inviting him to join him. While Sinclair was conquering the Faröe Islands, the Norwegian pirates were ravaging the Shetland Islands, then known as Eastland. Nicolo set out to confront them, but he was forced to retreat in front of their fleet, which was much larger than his own, and he sought safety on a small island off the coast of Iceland.
After wintering in this place Zeno must have landed the following year on the eastern coast of Greenland at 69° north latitude, in a place "where was a monastery of the order of preaching friars, and a church dedicated to St. Thomas. The cells were warmed by a natural spring of hot water, which the monks used to prepare their food and to bake their bread. The monks had also gardens covered over in the winter season, and warmed by the same means, so that they were able to produce flowers, fruits, and herbs as well as if they had lived in a mild climate." There would seem to be some confirmation of these narratives in the fact that between the years 1828-1830 a captain of the Danish navy met with a population of 600 individuals at 69° north latitude, of a purely European type.
After spending the winter here, Zeno likely landed the next year on the eastern coast of Greenland at 69° north latitude, in a place "where there was a monastery of the preaching friars, and a church dedicated to St. Thomas. The cells were heated by a natural hot spring, which the monks used to cook their meals and bake their bread. The monks also had gardens that were covered during the winter and heated in the same way, allowing them to grow flowers, fruits, and herbs as well as if they lived in a milder climate." This account seems to be supported by the fact that between 1828-1830, a captain of the Danish navy encountered a population of 600 people at 69° north latitude, who were purely of European descent.
But these adventurous travels in countries of which the climate was so different from that of Venice, proved fatal to Zeno, who died a short time after his return to Frisland.
But these adventurous travels in places with a climate so different from that of Venice ended up being deadly for Zeno, who died shortly after returning to Frisland.
An old sailor, who had returned with the Venetian, and who said he had been for many long years a prisoner in the countries of the extreme west, gave to Sinclair such precise and tempting details of the fertility and extent of these regions, that the latter resolved to attempt their conquest with Antonio Zeno who had rejoined his brother. But the inhabitants showed themselves everywhere so hostile, and opposed such resistance to the strangers landing, that Sinclair after a long and dangerous voyage was obliged to return to Frisland.
An old sailor, who had come back with the Venetian and claimed he had been a prisoner for many years in the far western lands, provided Sinclair with such detailed and alluring descriptions of the richness and vastness of these areas that Sinclair decided to try to conquer them with Antonio Zeno, who had rejoined his brother. However, the locals were incredibly hostile and put up strong resistance against the newcomers’ attempts to land, forcing Sinclair to turn back to Frisland after a long and perilous journey.
These are all the details that have been left to us, and they make us deeply regret the loss of those that Antonio should have furnished in his letters to his father Carlo, on the subject of the countries which Forster and Malto-Brun have thought may be identified with Newfoundland.
These are all the details we have, and they make us really regret the loss of the information that Antonio should have provided in his letters to his father Carlo about the countries that Forster and Malto-Brun believe might be linked to Newfoundland.
Who knows, if in his voyage to England and during his wanderings as far as Thule, Christopher Columbus may not have heard mentioned the ancient expeditions of the Northmen and the Zeni, and if this information may not have appeared to him a strange confirmation of the theories which he held, and of the ideas for whose realization he came to claim the protection of the King of England?
Who knows, during his journey to England and his travels as far as Thule, maybe Christopher Columbus heard about the ancient expeditions of the Norse and the Zeni. Perhaps this information seemed to him like a peculiar confirmation of the theories he believed in and the ideas he presented to seek the support of the King of England.
From the collection of facts which have been here briefly given, it follows that America was known to Europeans and had been colonized before the time of Columbus. But in consequence of various circumstances, and foremost among these must be placed the rarity of communication between the people in the north of Europe and those in the south, the discoveries made by the Northmen were only vaguely known in Spain and Portugal. Judging by appearances, we of the present day know much more on this subject than did the fellow-countrymen and contemporaries of Columbus. If the Genoese mariner had been informed of the existence of some rumours, he classed them with the information he had collected in the Cape de Verd Islands and with his classical recollections of the famous Island of Antilia and the Atlantides of Plato. From this information, which came from so many different sides, the certainty awoke within him that the east could be reached by the western route. However it may be, his glory remains whole and entire; he is really the discoverer of America, and not those who were carried thither in spite of themselves by chances of wind and storm, without their having any intention of reaching the shores of Asia, which Christopher Columbus would have done, had not the way been barred by America.
From the collection of facts presented here, it follows that America was known to Europeans and had been colonized before Columbus's time. However, due to various factors, primarily the limited communication between the people in northern Europe and those in southern Europe, the discoveries made by the Northmen were only vaguely known in Spain and Portugal. It seems that we today know much more about this topic than Columbus's contemporaries did. If the Genoese sailor had been aware of certain rumors, he would have combined them with the information he gathered in the Cape Verde Islands and his classical knowledge of the legendary Island of Antilia and Plato’s Atlantides. From this diverse information, he became convinced that the East could be reached via a western route. Regardless, his fame remains intact; he is truly the discoverer of America, unlike those who ended up there by chance due to winds and storms, without actually intending to reach the shores of Asia, which Columbus would have done if America hadn’t been in the way.
The information that we are about to give on the family of Cortereal, although it may be much more complete than that which can be met with in biographical Dictionaries, is still extremely vague. Nevertheless we must content ourselves with it, for up to this time history has not collected further details concerning this race of intrepid navigators.
The information we’re about to share about the Cortereal family, while likely more detailed than what you’d find in biographical dictionaries, is still quite vague. However, we have to make do with it since, so far, history hasn’t gathered more details about this brave group of navigators.
Joao Vaz Cortereal was the natural son of a gentleman named Vasco Annes da Costa, who had received the soubriquet of Cortereal from the King of Portugal, on account of the magnificence of his house and followers. Devoted like so many other gentlemen of this period to sea-faring adventure, Joao Vaz had carried off in Gallicia a young girl named Maria de Abarca, who became his wife. After having been gentleman-usher to the Infante don Fernando, he was sent by the king to the North Atlantic, with Alvaro Martins Homem. The two navigators saw an island known from this time by the name of Terra dos Bacalhaos—the land of cod-fish—which must really have been Newfoundland. The date of this discovery is approximately fixed by the fact that on their return, they landed at Terceira and finding the captainship vacant by the death of Jacome de Bruges, they went to ask for it from the Infanta Doña Brites, the widow of the Infante Don Fernando; she bestowed it upon them on condition that they would divide it between them, a fact which is confirmed by a deed of gift dated from Evora the 2nd of April, 1464. Though one cannot guarantee the authenticity of this discovery of America, it is nevertheless an ascertained fact that Cortereal's voyage must have been signalized by some extraordinary event; donations of such importance as this were only made to those who had rendered some great service to the crown.
Joao Vaz Cortereal was the illegitimate son of a gentleman named Vasco Annes da Costa, who was given the nickname Cortereal by the King of Portugal because of the grandeur of his household and followers. Like many gentlemen of his time, Joao Vaz was drawn to maritime adventures and he took a young girl named Maria de Abarca from Galicia to be his wife. After serving as a gentleman usher to the Infante Don Fernando, he was sent by the king to the North Atlantic with Alvaro Martins Homem. The two navigators discovered an island that became known as Terra dos Bacalhaos—the land of cod-fish—which was likely Newfoundland. The timing of this discovery is roughly indicated by the fact that upon their return, they landed at Terceira and found the captainship open due to the death of Jacome de Bruges. They sought the position from Infanta Doña Brites, the widow of Infante Don Fernando; she granted it to them on the condition that they would share it, which is supported by a deed of gift dated April 2, 1464, in Evora. While the authenticity of this discovery of America cannot be guaranteed, it is a confirmed fact that Cortereal's voyage was marked by some significant event; such important donations were only given to those who had provided great service to the crown.
When Vaz Cortereal was settled at Terceira from 1490 to 1497, he caused a fine palace to be built in the town of Angra, where he lived with his three children. His third son, Gaspard, after having been in the service of King Emmanuel, when the latter was only Duke de Beja had felt himself attracted while still young to the enterprises of discovery which had rendered his father illustrious. By an act dated from Cintra the 12th of March, 1500, King Emmanuel made a gift to Gaspard Cortereal of any islands or terra firma which he might discover, and the king added this valuable information, that "already and at other times he had sought for them on his own account and at his own expense."
When Vaz Cortereal settled in Terceira from 1490 to 1497, he had a beautiful palace built in the town of Angra, where he lived with his three children. His youngest son, Gaspard, who had served King Emmanuel when he was still the Duke of Beja, found himself drawn to the exploration ventures that had made his father famous from a young age. In a document dated March 12, 1500, in Cintra, King Emmanuel granted Gaspard Cortereal the rights to any islands or land he might discover, and the king noted that "he had already sought them out on his own initiative and at his own expense."
For Gaspard Cortereal this was not his first essay. Probably, his researches may have been directed to the parts where his father had discovered the Island of Cod. At his own expense, although with the assistance of the king, Gaspard Cortereal fitted out two vessels at the commencement of the summer of 1500, and after having touched at Terceira, he sailed towards the north-west. His first discovery was of a land of which the fertile and verdant aspect seems to have charmed him. This was Canada. He saw there a great river bearing ice along with it on its course—the St. Lawrence—which some of his companions mistook for an arm of the sea, and to which he gave the name of Rio Nevado. "Its volume is so considerable that it is not probable that this country is an island, besides, it must be completely covered with a very thick coating of snow to produce such a stream of water."
For Gaspard Cortereal, this wasn’t his first attempt. Likely, his explorations were aimed at the areas where his father had found the Island of Cod. At his own expense, though with the king's support, Gaspard Cortereal equipped two ships at the start of summer 1500, and after stopping at Terceira, he sailed northwest. His first discovery was a land with such a fertile and lush appearance that it seemed to captivate him. This was Canada. He saw a large river carrying ice along with it—the St. Lawrence—which some of his crew mistook for an arm of the sea, and he named it Rio Nevado. "Its size is so significant that it seems unlikely this region is an island; plus, it must be completely blanketed with a thick layer of snow to create such a powerful current."
The houses in this country were of wood and covered with skins and furs. The inhabitants were unacquainted with iron, but used swords made of sharpened stones, and their arrows were tipped with fish-bones or stones. Tall and well-made, their faces and bodies were painted in different colours according to taste, they wore golden and copper bracelets, and dressed themselves in garments of fur. Cortereal pursued his voyage and arrived at the Cape of Bacalhaos, "fishes which are found in such great quantities upon this coast that they hinder the advance of the caravels." Then he followed the shore for a stretch of 600 miles, from 56° to 60°, or even more, naming the islands, the rivers, and the gulfs that he met with, as is proved by Terra do Labrador, Bahia de Conceiçao, &c., and landing and holding intercourse with the natives. Severe cold, and a veritable river of gigantic blocks of ice prevented the expedition from going farther north, and it returned to Portugal bringing back with it fifty-seven natives. The very year of his return, on the 15th of May, 1501, Gaspard Cortereal, in pursuance of an order of the 15th of April, received provisions, and left Lisbon in the hope of extending the field of his discoveries. But from this time he is never again mentioned. Michael Cortereal, his brother, who was the first gentleman-usher to the king, then requested and obtained permission to go and seek his brother, and to pursue his enterprise. By an act of the 15th of January, 1502, a deed of gift conveyed to him the half of the terra firma and islands which his brother might have discovered. Setting out on the 10th of May of this year with three vessels, Michael Cortereal reached Newfoundland, where he divided his little squadron, so that each of the vessels might explore the coasts separately, while he fixed the place of rendezvous. But at the time fixed, he did not reappear, and the two other vessels, after waiting for him till the 20th of August, set out on their return to Portugal.
The houses in this country were made of wood and covered with skins and furs. The people didn’t know about iron, but they used swords made from sharpened stones, and their arrows were tipped with fish bones or stones. Tall and well-built, they painted their faces and bodies in different colors according to their taste, wore golden and copper bracelets, and dressed in fur garments. Cortereal continued his voyage and arrived at the Cape of Bacalhaos, where there are so many fish that they obstruct the progress of the caravels. He then followed the shoreline for about 600 miles, from 56° to 60°, or maybe even further, naming the islands, rivers, and gulfs he encountered, as shown by Terra do Labrador, Bahia de Conceiçao, etc., and landing to interact with the locals. Harsh cold and a massive river of giant ice blocks prevented the expedition from going further north, and it returned to Portugal with fifty-seven natives. The same year he returned, on May 15, 1501, Gaspard Cortereal, following an order from April 15, received supplies and left Lisbon hoping to expand his discoveries. However, he was never mentioned again after this. His brother, Michael Cortereal, who was the king’s first gentleman-usher, then asked for and received permission to search for his brother and continue his mission. By an act on January 15, 1502, he received a deed granting him half of the mainland and islands that his brother might have discovered. Setting out on May 10 of that year with three ships, Michael Cortereal reached Newfoundland, where he divided his small fleet so that each ship could explore the coast separately while he established a meeting point. But at the designated time, he didn't return, and the other two ships, after waiting for him until August 20, headed back to Portugal.
In 1503, the king sent two caravels to try to obtain news of the two brothers, but the search was in vain, and they returned without having acquired any information. When Vasco Annes, the last of the brothers Cortereal, who was captain and governor of the Islands of St. George and Terceira, and alcaide mõr of the town of Tavilla, became acquainted with these sad events, he resolved to fit out a vessel at his own cost, and to go and search for his brothers. The king, however, would not allow him to go, fearing to lose the last of this race of good servants.
In 1503, the king sent two ships to try to find out what happened to the two brothers, but their search was unsuccessful, and they returned empty-handed. When Vasco Annes, the last of the Cortereal brothers, who was captain and governor of the Islands of St. George and Terceira, and alcaide mõr of the town of Tavilla, learned about these unfortunate events, he decided to fund a ship himself and search for his brothers. However, the king would not permit him to go, worried about losing the last of this family of loyal servants.
Upon the maps of this period, Canada is often indicated by the name of Terra dos Cortereales, a name which is sometimes extended much further south, embracing a great part of North America.
Upon the maps of this time, Canada is often labeled as Terra dos Cortereales, a name that is sometimes used much further south, covering a large portion of North America.
All that concerns John and Sebastian Cabot has been until recently shrouded by a mist which is not even now completely dissipated, notwithstanding the conscientious labours of Biddle the American in 1831, and of our compatriot M. d'Avezac; as also those of Mr. Nicholls the Englishman, who taking advantage of the discoveries made among the English, Spanish, and Venetian archives, has built up an imposing monument, of which some parts, however, are open to discussion. It is from the two last-named works that we shall draw the materials for this rapid sketch, but principally from Mr. Nicholls' book, which has this advantage over the smaller volume of M. d'Avezac, that it relates the whole life of Sebastian Cabot.
All that concerns John and Sebastian Cabot has until recently been surrounded by a fog that still isn't completely clear, despite the diligent efforts of Biddle the American in 1831, as well as our fellow countryman M. d'Avezac; and also those of Mr. Nicholls the Englishman, who, taking advantage of the discoveries made in English, Spanish, and Venetian archives, has constructed an impressive account, although some parts are still open to debate. It is from the last two mentioned works that we will gather the materials for this brief overview, but mainly from Mr. Nicholls' book, which has the advantage over M. d'Avezac's smaller volume, as it covers the entire life of Sebastian Cabot.
![]() |
Sebastian Cabot. From an old print. |
It has been found impossible to determine with certainty either the name or the nationality of John Cabot, and still less to settle the period of his birth. John Cabota, Caboto or Cabot must have been born, if not in Genoa itself, as M. d'Avezac asserts, at least in the neighbourhood of that town, possibly at Castiglione, about the first quarter of the fifteenth century. Some historians have considered that he was an Englishman, and perhaps Mr. Nicholls from national considerations is inclined to adopt this opinion; at least this seems to be the meaning of the expressions used by him. What we do know without room for doubt, is that John Cabot came to London to occupy himself with commerce, and that he soon settled at Bristol, then the second town in the kingdom, in one of the suburbs which had received the name of Cathay, probably from the number of Venetians who resided there, and the trade carried on by them with the countries of the extreme East. It was at Bristol that Cabot's two youngest children were born, Sebastian and Sancho, if we may rely upon the following account given by the old chronicler Eden. "Sebastian Cabot told me that he was born at Bristol, and that at four years of age he went with his father to Venice, returning with him to England some years later; this made people imagine that he was born at Venice." In 1476, John Cabot was at Venice, and there on the 29th of March, he received letters of naturalization, which prove that he was not a native of this city, and that he must have merited the honour by some service rendered to the Republic. M. d'Avezac is inclined to think that he devoted himself to the study of cosmography and navigation, perhaps even in company with the celebrated Florentine, Paul Toscanelli, with whose theories upon the distribution of land and sea on the surface of the globe, he would certainly be acquainted at this time. He may also have heard mention made of the islands situated in the Atlantic, and known by the names of Antilia, the Land of the Seven Cities, or Brazil. What seems more certain is, that his business affairs took him to the Levant, and, it is said, to Mecca, and that while there he would learn from what country came the spices, which then constituted the most important branch of Venetian commerce.
It’s been impossible to definitively identify John Cabot’s name or nationality, and even harder to pinpoint his birth year. John Cabota, Caboto, or Cabot must have been born, if not right in Genoa as M. d'Avezac claims, at least nearby, possibly in Castiglione, around the early 15th century. Some historians believe he was English, and perhaps Mr. Nicholls leans toward this view, which seems to be what he implies. What we do know for sure is that John Cabot moved to London for business and soon settled in Bristol, which was the second-largest city in the kingdom, in a suburb called Cathay, likely named for the many Venetians living there and their trade with the Far East. It was in Bristol that Cabot's two youngest children, Sebastian and Sancho, were born, according to the old chronicler Eden. "Sebastian Cabot told me he was born in Bristol and that he went with his father to Venice at the age of four, returning to England a few years later; this led people to believe he was born in Venice." In 1476, John Cabot was in Venice, where on March 29th, he received letters of naturalization, proving that he wasn't a native of the city and that he must have earned this honor by serving the Republic. M. d'Avezac thinks he may have studied cosmography and navigation, possibly alongside the famous Florentine, Paul Toscanelli, whose theories on the layout of land and sea he would certainly be aware of at that time. He might have also heard about the islands in the Atlantic, known as Antilia, the Land of the Seven Cities, or Brazil. What’s more certain is that his business dealings took him to the Levant and, reportedly, to Mecca, where he would learn about the origins of the spices that made up the most significant part of Venetian trade.
Whatever value we may attach to these speculative theories, it is at least certain that John Cabot founded an important mercantile house at Bristol. His son Sebastian, who in these first voyages had acquired an inclination for the sea, studied navigation, as far as it was then known, and made some excursions on the sea, to render himself as familiar with the practice of this art, as he already was with its theory. "For seven years past," says the Spanish Ambassador in a despatch of the 25th of July, 1498, speaking of an expedition commanded by Cabot, "the people of Bristol have fitted out two, three, or four caravels every year, to go in search of the Island of Brazil, and of the Seven Cities, according to the ideas of the Genoese." At this time the whole of Europe resounded with the fame of the discoveries of Columbus. "It awoke in me," says Sebastian Cabot, in a narrative preserved by Ramusio, "a great desire and a kind of ardour in my heart to do myself also something famous, and knowing by examining the globe, that if I sailed by the west wind I should reach India more rapidly, I at once made my project known to His Majesty, who was much satisfied with it." The king to whom Cabot addressed himself was the same Henry VII. who some years before had refused all support to Christopher Columbus. It is evident that he received with favour the project which John and Sebastian Cabot had just submitted to him; and though Sebastian, in the fragment which we have just quoted, attributes to himself alone all the honour of the project, it is not less true that his father was the promoter of the enterprise, as the following charter shows, which we translate in an abridged form.
Whatever value we may give to these speculative theories, it’s clear that John Cabot established an important trading company in Bristol. His son Sebastian, who during these early voyages developed a passion for the sea, studied navigation as it was known at the time and took some trips to gain practical experience in this field, just as he was already well-versed in its theory. "For the past seven years," says the Spanish Ambassador in a message dated July 25, 1498, referring to an expedition led by Cabot, "the people of Bristol have outfitted two, three, or four caravels every year to search for the Island of Brazil and the Seven Cities, based on the ideas of the Genoese." At that time, all of Europe was buzzing with the news of Columbus's discoveries. "It stirred in me," Sebastian Cabot recounts in a narrative preserved by Ramusio, "a great desire and a kind of eagerness in my heart to achieve something famous myself, and knowing from examining the globe that if I sailed with the west wind, I could reach India more quickly, I immediately made my plan known to His Majesty, who was very pleased with it." The king Cabot approached was the same Henry VII who had previously denied any support to Christopher Columbus. Clearly, he received favorably the plan that John and Sebastian Cabot had just presented to him; and while Sebastian, in the excerpt we just quoted, claims all the credit for the project, it is equally true that his father was the driving force behind the endeavor, as the following charter illustrates, which we will summarize.
"We Henry ... permit our well-beloved Jehan Cabot, citizen of Venice, and Louis, Sebastian, and Sancho, his sons, under our flag and with five vessels of the tonnage and crew which they shall judge suitable, to discover at their own expense and charge ... we grant to them as well as to their heirs and assigns, licence to occupy, possess ... at the charge of, by them, upon the profits, benefits, and advantages, accruing from this navigation, to pay us in merchandise or in money the fifth part of the profit thus obtained, for each of their voyages, every time that they shall return to the port of Bristol (at which port they shall be compelled to land).... We promise and guarantee to them, their heirs and assigns, that they shall be exempt from all custom-house duties on the merchandise which they shall bring from the countries thus discovered.... We command and direct all our subjects, as well on land as on the sea, to render assistance to the said Jehan, and to his sons.... Given at ... the 5th day of March, 1495."
"We, Henry, allow our dear Jehan Cabot, a citizen of Venice, along with his sons Louis, Sebastian, and Sancho, to explore under our flag with five ships of their choosing, in terms of size and crew. They will do this at their own expense... We grant them, as well as their heirs and assigns, the right to occupy and possess... and in return for the profits and benefits gained from this expedition, they will pay us one-fifth of the profits in goods or money for each journey every time they return to the port of Bristol (where they are required to dock).... We guarantee that they, their heirs, and assigns will be free from all customs duties on goods they bring back from these newly discovered lands.... We instruct all our subjects, both on land and at sea, to assist Jehan and his sons.... Issued on the 5th day of March, 1495."
Such was the charter that was granted to John Cabot and his sons upon their return from the American continent, and not as certain authors have pretended, anterior to this voyage. From the time that the news of the discovery made by Columbus had reached England, that is to say, probably in 1493, John and Sebastian Cabot prepared the expedition at their own expense, and set out at the beginning of the year 1494, with the idea of reaching Cathay, and finally the Indies. There can be no doubt upon this point, for in the Bibliothèque Nationale in Paris is preserved an unique copy of the map engraved in 1544, that is to say, in the lifetime of Sebastian Cabot, which mentions this voyage, and the precise and exact date of the discovery of Cape Breton.
Such was the charter granted to John Cabot and his sons when they returned from the American continent, not as some writers have claimed, before this voyage. After the news of Columbus's discovery reached England, likely in 1493, John and Sebastian Cabot organized the expedition at their own expense and set off at the beginning of 1494 with the goal of reaching Cathay and eventually the Indies. There’s no doubt about this, as there is a unique copy of the map preserved in the Bibliothèque Nationale in Paris, engraved in 1544, during Sebastian Cabot's lifetime, which mentions this voyage and the specific date of the discovery of Cape Breton.
It is probable that we must attribute to the intrigues of the Spanish Ambassador, the delay which occurred in Cabot's expedition, for the whole of the year 1496 passed without the voyage being accomplished.
It’s likely that we have to credit the Spanish Ambassador’s scheming for the hold-up in Cabot’s expedition, as the entire year of 1496 went by without the voyage happening.
The following year he set out at the beginning of summer. After having again sighted the Terra Bona-vista, he followed the coast, and was not long in perceiving to his great disappointment that it trended towards the north. "Then, sailing along it to make sure if I could not find some passage, I could not perceive any, and having advanced as far as 56°, and seeing that at this point the land turned towards the east, I despaired of finding any passage, and I put about to examine the coast in this direction towards the equinoctial line, always with the same object of finding a passage to the Indies, and in the end, I reached the country now called Florida, where as provisions were beginning to run short, I resolved to return to England." This narrative, of which we have given the commencement above, was related by Cabot to Fracastor, forty or fifty years after the event. Also, is it not astonishing that Cabot mixes up in it two perfectly distinct voyages, that of 1494, and that of 1497? Let us add some reflections on this narrative. The first land seen was, without doubt, the North Cape, the northern extremity of the island of Cape Breton, and the island which is opposite to it is that of Prince Edward, long known by the name of St. John's Island. Cabot, probably penetrated into the estuary of the St. Lawrence, which he took for an arm of the sea, near to the place where Quebec now stands, and coasted along the northern shore of the gulf, so that he did not see the coast of Labrador stretching away in the east. He took Newfoundland for an archipelago, and continued his course to the south, not doubtless, as far as Florida as he states himself, the time occupied by the voyage making it impossible that he can have descended so low, but as far as Chesapeake Bay. These were the countries which the Spaniards afterwards called "Terra de Estevam Gomez."
The following year, he set out at the beginning of summer. After spotting the Terra Bona-vista again, he followed the coast and quickly realized, to his great disappointment, that it turned north. "Then, sailing along it to see if I could find a passage, I couldn’t find any. Having traveled as far as 56° and noticing that the land turned east, I lost hope of finding any passage and decided to check the coast in the direction of the equator, still with the goal of finding a route to the Indies. Eventually, I reached what is now known as Florida, where I decided to return to England as supplies were running low." This account, which we've partially reproduced above, was told by Cabot to Fracastor about forty or fifty years after the event. Isn't it surprising that Cabot confuses two completely different voyages, one from 1494 and another from 1497? Let’s add some thoughts about this narrative. The first land seen was undoubtedly the North Cape, the northern tip of Cape Breton Island, and the island facing it is Prince Edward Island, long known as St. John's Island. Cabot likely navigated into the St. Lawrence estuary, which he mistook for an arm of the sea near where Quebec is now located, and he coasted along the northern shore of the gulf, so he did not see the Labrador coast stretching east. He took Newfoundland for an archipelago and continued south, not, as he claims, all the way to Florida, as the time taken for the voyage makes it impossible, but rather as far as Chesapeake Bay. These were the regions that the Spaniards later referred to as "Terra de Estevam Gomez."
On the 3rd of February, 1498, King Henry VII. signed at Westminster some new letters patent. He empowered John Cabot or his representative,—being duly authorized—to take in English ports six vessels of 200 tons' burden, and to procure all that should be required for their equipment, at the same price as if it were for the crown. He was allowed to take on board such master-mariners, pages, and other subjects as might of their own accord wish to go, and pass with him to the recently discovered land and islands. John Cabot bore the expense of the equipment of two vessels, and three others were fitted out at the cost of the merchants of Bristol.
On February 3, 1498, King Henry VII signed some new letters patent at Westminster. He authorized John Cabot or his representative—who would be officially recognized—to take six vessels of 200 tons each from English ports and to gather everything needed for their outfitting, at the same cost as if it were for the crown. He could bring aboard any skilled sailors, apprentices, and other people who wanted to join him voluntarily on his journey to the newly discovered land and islands. John Cabot covered the expenses for outfitting two vessels, while three others were equipped at the expense of the merchants from Bristol.
In all probability it was death—a sudden and unexpected death—which prevented John Cabot from taking the command of this expedition. His son Sebastian then assumed the direction of the fleet, which carried 300 men and provisions for a year. After having sighted land at 45°, Sebastian Cabot followed the coast as far as 58°, perhaps even higher, but then it became so cold, and although it was the month of July, there was so much floating ice about, that, it would have been impossible to go further northwards. The days were very long, and the nights excessively light, an interesting detail by which to fix the latitude reached, for we know that below the 60th parallel of latitude the longest days are eighteen hours. These various reasons made Sebastian Cabot decide to put about, and he touched at the Bacalhaos Islands, of which the inhabitants, who were clothed in the skins of animals, were armed with bow and arrows, lance, javelin, and wooden sword. The navigators here caught a great number of cod-fish; they were even so numerous, says an old narrative, that they hindered ships from advancing. After having sailed along the coast of America as far as 38°, Cabot set out for England, where he arrived at the beginning of autumn. This voyage had indeed a threefold object, that of discovery, commerce, and colonization, as is shown by the number of vessels which took part in it and the strength of the crews. Nevertheless it does not appear that Cabot landed any one, or that he made any attempts at forming a settlement, either in Labrador, or in Hudson's Bay—which he was destined to explore more completely in 1517, in the reign of Henry VIII.—or even to the south of the Bacalhaos, known by the general name of Newfoundland. At the close of this expedition, which was almost entirely unproductive, we lose sight of Sebastian Cabot, if not completely, at least so as to be insufficiently informed about his deeds and voyages until 1517. The traveller Hojeda, whose various enterprises we have related above, had left Spain in the month of May, 1499. We know that in this voyage he met with an Englishman at Caquibaco, on the coast of America. Can this have been Cabot? Nothing has come to light to enable us to settle this point; but we may believe that Cabot did not remain idle, and that he would be likely to undertake some fresh expedition: what we do know is, that in spite of the solemn engagements that he had made with Cabot, the King of England granted certain privileges of trading in the countries which he had discovered, to the Portuguese and to the merchants of Bristol. This ungenerous manner of recognizing his services wounded the navigator, and decided him to accept the offers which had been made to him on different occasions, to enter the Spanish service. From the death of Vespucius, which happened in 1512, Cabot was the navigator held in most renown. To attach him to himself, Ferdinand wrote on the 13th of September, 1512, to Lord Willoughby, commander in chief of the troops which had been transported to Italy, to treat with the Venetian navigator.
In all likelihood, it was a sudden and unexpected death that prevented John Cabot from leading this expedition. His son, Sebastian, then took charge of the fleet, which carried 300 men and enough supplies for a year. After spotting land at 45°, Sebastian Cabot followed the coast up to 58°, maybe even further, but it got so cold that, despite it being July, there was so much floating ice that continuing north became impossible. The days were very long and the nights incredibly bright, which is an interesting detail to note for determining the latitude reached, as we know that below the 60th parallel, the longest days are eighteen hours. These various reasons led Sebastian Cabot to turn back, and he stopped at the Bacalhaos Islands, where the locals, dressed in animal skins, were armed with bows and arrows, lances, javelins, and wooden swords. The sailors here caught a huge number of codfish; they were so plentiful, says an old narrative, that they hindered ships from moving forward. After sailing along the coast of America as far as 38°, Cabot headed for England, arriving at the start of autumn. This voyage had indeed three main goals: discovery, commerce, and colonization, as shown by the number of ships involved and the strength of the crews. However, it doesn’t appear that Cabot landed anyone or made any attempts to establish a settlement, either in Labrador, or in Hudson's Bay—which he was meant to explore in greater detail in 1517, during the reign of Henry VIII—or even south of the Bacalhaos, collectively known as Newfoundland. At the end of this expedition, which was nearly completely unproductive, we lose track of Sebastian Cabot, if not entirely, at least in terms of being insufficiently informed about his deeds and voyages until 1517. The traveler Hojeda, whose various ventures we've mentioned above, left Spain in May 1499. We know that during this trip he encountered an Englishman at Caquibaco, on the American coast. Could this have been Cabot? There’s nothing that has emerged to confirm this, but it’s reasonable to think that Cabot was not idle and might have undertaken a new expedition: what we do know is that despite the formal commitments he made with Cabot, the King of England granted trading privileges in the territories he had discovered to the Portuguese and the merchants of Bristol. This ungracious acknowledgment of his services hurt the navigator and pushed him to accept various offers he received to join the Spanish service. Since the death of Vespucius in 1512, Cabot was the most renowned navigator. To keep him tied to himself, Ferdinand wrote on September 13, 1512, to Lord Willoughby, the commander of the troops sent to Italy, to negotiate with the Venetian navigator.
![]() |
Discoveries of John and Sebastian Cabot. |
As soon as he arrived in Castille, Cabot received the rank of captain, by an edict dated the 20th of October, 1512, with a salary of 5000 maravédis. Seville was fixed upon for his residence, until an opportunity might arise of turning his talents and experience to account. There was a plan on foot for his taking the command of a very important expedition, when Ferdinand the Catholic died, on the 23rd of January, 1516. Cabot returned at once to England, having probably obtained leave of absence. Eden tells us that the following year Cabot was appointed with Sir Thomas Pert to the command of a fleet which was to reach China by the north-west. On the 11th of June, he was in Hudson's Bay at 67½° of latitude; the sea free from ice spread itself out before him so far that he reckoned upon success in his enterprise, when the faintheartedness of his companion, together with the cowardice and mutinous spirit of the crews, who refused to go any further, obliged him to return to England. In his Theatrum orbis terrarum, Ortelius traces the shape of Hudson's Bay as it really is; he even indicates at its northern extremity a strait leading northwards. How can the geographer have attained to such exactness? "Who," says Mr. Nicholls, "can have given him the information set forth in his map, if not Cabot?"
As soon as he got to Castille, Cabot was given the rank of captain by a decree dated October 20, 1512, with a salary of 5,000 maravédis. Seville was chosen as his home base until he had the chance to make use of his skills and experience. There was a plan for him to lead a very important expedition when Ferdinand the Catholic passed away on January 23, 1516. Cabot immediately returned to England, likely having obtained leave. Eden tells us that the following year, Cabot was appointed, along with Sir Thomas Pert, to command a fleet aiming to reach China via the northwest. On June 11, he was in Hudson's Bay at 67½° latitude; the sea was clear of ice and stretched out before him, making him hopeful for success in his mission. However, the cowardice of his companion and the mutinous spirit of the crew, who refused to go any further, forced him to return to England. In his Theatrum orbis terrarum, Ortelius accurately depicts Hudson's Bay and even marks a strait at its northern edge leading northward. How did the geographer achieve such accuracy? "Who," asks Mr. Nicholls, "could have provided him with the information shown on his map, if not Cabot?"
On his return to England, Cabot found the country ravaged by a horrible plague, which put a stop even to commercial transactions. Soon, either because the time of his leave had expired, or that he wished to escape from the pestilence, or that he was recalled to Spain, the Venetian navigator returned to that country. In 1518, on the 5th of February, Cabot was made pilot-major, with a salary which, added to that which he already had, made a total of 125,000 maravédis, say, 300 ducats. He did not actually exercise the functions of his office till Charles V. returned from England. His principal duty consisted in examining pilots, who were not allowed to go to the Indies until after having passed this examination.
On his return to England, Cabot found the country devastated by a terrible plague, which even halted commerce. Soon, either because his leave had ended, he wanted to escape the disease, or he was ordered back to Spain, the Venetian navigator returned to that country. In 1518, on February 5th, Cabot was appointed pilot-major, with a salary that, when combined with his previous earnings, totaled 125,000 maravédis, or about 300 ducats. He didn’t take on the responsibilities of his position until Charles V. came back from England. His main role was to evaluate pilots, who weren’t allowed to go to the Indies until they passed this examination.
This epoch was by no means favourable to great maritime expeditions. The struggle between France and Spain absorbed all the resources both in men and money, of these two countries—Cabot too, who seems to have adopted science for his fatherland, much more than any particular country, made some overtures to Contarini, the Ambassador of Venice, to take service on board the fleets of the Republic; but when the favourable answer of the Council of Ten arrived, he had other projects in his head, and did not carry his attempt any further.
This period was definitely not conducive to major sea explorations. The conflict between France and Spain consumed all the resources—both manpower and funds—of these two nations. Cabot, who seems to have embraced science for his homeland rather than a specific country, even reached out to Contarini, the Ambassador of Venice, to join the Republic's fleets. However, by the time he received a positive response from the Council of Ten, he had other plans in mind and didn't pursue his idea any further.
![]() |
Cabot presides over a Conference of Cosmographers. |
In the month of April, 1524, Cabot presided at a conference of mariners and cosmographers, which met at Badajoz, to discuss the question whether the Moluccas belonged, according to the celebrated treaty of Tordesillas, to Spain or Portugal. On the 31st of May, it was decided that the Moluccas were within the Spanish waters, by 20°. Perhaps this resolution of the junta of which Cabot was president, and which again placed in the hands of Spain a great part of the spice trade, was not without its influence upon the resolutions of the council of the Indies. However this may be, in the month of September of the same year Cabot was authorized to take the command of three vessels of 100 tons, and a small caravel, carrying together 150 men, with the title of captain-general.
In April 1524, Cabot led a meeting of sailors and mapmakers in Badajoz to debate whether the Moluccas, according to the famous treaty of Tordesillas, belonged to Spain or Portugal. On May 31st, they decided that the Moluccas were within Spanish waters, at 20°. This decision by the assembly, which Cabot chaired, likely had an impact on the decisions made by the Council of the Indies, leading Spain to regain a significant portion of the spice trade. Regardless, in September of the same year, Cabot was given the authority to command three ships of 100 tons and a small caravel, carrying a total of 150 men, with the title of captain-general.
The declared aim of this voyage was to pass through the Strait of Magellan, carefully to explore the western coast of America, and to reach the Moluccas, where they would take in on their return a cargo of spices. The month of August, 1525, had been fixed upon as the date of departure, but the intrigues of Portugal succeeded in delaying it until April, 1526.
The stated goal of this journey was to navigate through the Strait of Magellan, thoroughly explore the western coast of America, and reach the Moluccas, where they would load up on spices for their return trip. August 1525 was originally set as the departure date, but political maneuvering from Portugal caused delays, pushing it back to April 1526.
Different circumstances seem from this moment to have augured ill for the voyage. Cabot had only a nominal authority, and the association of merchants who had defrayed the expenses of the equipment not accepting him willingly as chief, had found means to oppose all the plans of the Venetian sailor. Thus it was that in place of the man whom he had appointed as second in command, another was imposed upon him, and that instructions destined to be unsealed when at sea were delivered to each captain. They contained this absurd arrangement, that in case of the death of the captain-general, eleven individuals were to succeed him each in his turn. Was not this an encouragement given to assassination?
Different circumstances now seemed to predict bad things for the voyage. Cabot had only nominal authority, and the group of merchants who had covered the costs of the equipment weren't keen on accepting him as their leader, finding ways to oppose all of the Venetian sailor's plans. As a result, instead of the person he had chosen as his second-in-command, another was forced upon him, and instructions meant to be opened at sea were given to each captain. These instructions included the ridiculous plan that if the captain-general died, eleven individuals would take over in turn. Wasn't this just an invitation to assassination?
Scarcely was the fleet out of sight of land, when discontent appeared. The rumour spread that the captain-general was not equal to his task; then as they saw that these calumnies did not affect him, they pretended that the flotilla was already short of provisions. The mutiny broke out as soon as land was reached, but Cabot was not the man to allow himself to be annihilated by it; he had suffered too much from Sir Thomas Pert's cowardice to bear such an insult. In order to nip the evil in the bud, he had the mutinous captains seized, and notwithstanding their reputation and the brilliancy of their past services, he made them get into a boat, and abandoned them on the shore. Four months afterwards they had the good luck to be picked up by a Portuguese expedition, which seems to have had orders to thwart the plans of Cabot.
Scarcely had the fleet disappeared from view of land when discontent began to surface. Rumors spread that the captain-general wasn't up to the task; when they saw that these slanders didn't seem to bother him, they pretended that the flotilla was already running low on supplies. The mutiny erupted as soon as they reached land, but Cabot wasn't the kind of person to let himself be defeated by it; he had endured too much from Sir Thomas Pert's cowardice to tolerate such an insult. To tackle the issue early on, he had the rebellious captains arrested, and despite their status and their impressive past achievements, he forced them into a boat and left them on the shore. Four months later, they were fortunate to be rescued by a Portuguese expedition, which seemed to be ordered to disrupt Cabot's plans.
The Venetian navigator then penetrated into the Rio de la Plata, the exploration of which had been commenced by his predecessor the Pilot-major de Solis. The expedition was not then composed of more than two vessels, one having been lost during the voyage. Cabot sailed up the Argent River, and discovered an island which he called Francis Gabriel, and upon which he built the fort of San Salvador, entrusting the command of it to Antonio de Grajeda. Cabot had the keel removed from one of his caravels, and with it, being towed by his small boats, entered the Parana, built a new fort at the confluence of the Carcarama and Terceiro, and after having thus secured his line of retreat he pursued the course of these rivers farther into the interior. Arriving at the confluence of the Parana and Paraguay, he followed the second, the direction of which agreed best with his project of reaching the region of the west where silver was to be obtained. But it was not long before the aspect of the country changed, and the attitude of the inhabitants altered also. Until now, they had collected in crowds, astonished at the sight of the vessels; but upon the cultivated shores of the Paraguay they courageously opposed the strangers' landing, and three Spaniards having tried to knock down the fruit from a palm-tree, a struggle took place, in which 300 natives lost their lives. This victory had disabled twenty-five Spaniards. It was too much for Cabot, who rapidly removed his wounded to the fort San Spirito and retired, still presenting a bold front to the enemy.
The Venetian navigator then entered the Rio de la Plata, which had been started by his predecessor, the Pilot-major de Solis. The expedition only had two ships at that point, as one had been lost during the journey. Cabot sailed up the Argent River and discovered an island that he named Francis Gabriel, where he built the fort of San Salvador and placed Antonio de Grajeda in charge of it. Cabot removed the keel from one of his caravels and, using small boats to tow it, entered the Parana River, where he built a new fort at the meeting point of the Carcarama and Terceiro Rivers. After securing his retreat, he continued up these rivers deeper into the interior. When he reached the confluence of the Parana and Paraguay Rivers, he chose to follow the Paraguay, as it aligned best with his plan to reach the western region where silver could be found. However, it wasn't long before the landscape changed and the locals' behavior shifted as well. Previously, they had gathered in crowds, amazed by the ships; but along the cultivated banks of the Paraguay, they bravely resisted the strangers' landing. When three Spaniards attempted to knock down fruit from a palm tree, a conflict broke out, resulting in the deaths of 300 natives. This victory came at the cost of twenty-five Spaniards. It was too much for Cabot, who quickly moved his wounded to Fort San Spirito and retreated while still facing the enemy bravely.
Cabot had already sent two of his companions to the Emperor, to acquaint him with the attempt at revolt of the captains, to explain to him the motives which obliged him to modify the course marked out for his voyage, and to request aid from him, both in men and provisions. The answer arrived at last. The Emperor approved of what Cabot had done, and ordered him to colonize the country in which he had just made a settlement, but did not send him either one man or a single maravédi. Cabot tried to procure the resources which he needed in the country, and caused some attempts at cultivation to be commenced. At the same time, to keep his troops in exercise, he reduced the neighbouring nations to obedience, had some forts built, and again sailing up the Paraguay he reached Potosi, and the water-courses of the Andes which feed the basin of the Atlantic. At last he prepared to enter Peru, from whence came the gold and silver which he had seen in the possession of the natives; but it needed more troops than he could muster, to attempt the conquest of this vast region. The Emperor, however, was quite unable to send him any. His European wars absorbed all his resources, the Cortez refused to vote new subsidies and the Moluccas had just been pledged to Portugal. In this state of affairs, after having occupied the country for five years, and waited all this time for the assistance which never came, Cabot decided to evacuate a part of his settlements, and he returned with some of his people to Spain. The rest, amounting to 120, men who were left to guard the fort of San Spirito, after many vicissitudes which cannot be related here, perished by the hands of the Indians, or were obliged to take refuge in the Portuguese settlements on the coast of Brazil. It is to the horses imported by Cabot that is due the wonderful race of wild horses which may be seen in large troops on the pampas of La Plata at the present day; this was the only result of the expedition.
Cabot had already sent two of his companions to the Emperor to inform him about the attempted revolt of the captains, explain the reasons that forced him to change his planned route for the voyage, and request support in the form of manpower and supplies. Eventually, he received a response. The Emperor approved of Cabot's actions and instructed him to colonize the area where he had recently established a settlement, but he didn’t send any soldiers or resources. Cabot attempted to gather the necessary supplies locally and began some farming initiatives. At the same time, to keep his troops engaged, he subdued neighboring nations, built a few forts, and sailed up the Paraguay River to reach Potosi and the waterways of the Andes that flow into the Atlantic basin. He finally prepared to enter Peru, where the gold and silver he had seen in the hands of the natives originated, but he needed more soldiers than he had to conquer this vast territory. Unfortunately, the Emperor was unable to send him any reinforcements. His European wars consumed all his resources, Cortez refused to authorize new funding, and the Moluccas had just been committed to Portugal. Faced with this situation, after occupying the land for five years and waiting in vain for assistance, Cabot decided to abandon part of his settlements and returned to Spain with some of his crew. The remaining 120 men, who were left to defend Fort San Spirito, after many challenges that can't be detailed here, either died at the hands of the Indigenous people or had to take refuge in the Portuguese settlements along the Brazilian coast. The wild horse population currently seen roaming in large groups on the pampas of La Plata can be traced back to the horses brought in by Cabot; this was the only outcome of the expedition.
Some time after his return to Spain, Cabot resigned his office, and went to Bristol, where he settled about 1548, that is to say at the beginning of the reign of Edward VI. What were the motives of this fresh change? Was Cabot discontented at having been left to his own resources during his expedition? Was he hurt at the manner in which his services were recompensed? It is impossible to say. But Charles V. took advantage of Cabot's departure to deprive him of his pension, which Edward VI. hastened to replace, causing him to receive 250 marks annually, about 116l. and a fraction, which was a considerable sum for that period.
Some time after he returned to Spain, Cabot quit his position and moved to Bristol, where he settled around 1548, which was right at the start of Edward VI's reign. What prompted this new change? Was Cabot unhappy about having to rely on himself during his expedition? Was he upset about how his services were rewarded? It's hard to say. However, Charles V took advantage of Cabot's departure to cut off his pension, which Edward VI quickly reinstated, granting him 250 marks a year, roughly 116l. and some change, a substantial amount for that time.
The post which Cabot occupied in England seems to be best expressed by the name of Intendant of the Navy; under the authority of the king and council, he appears to have superintended all maritime affairs. He issues licences, he examines pilots, he frames instructions, he draws maps, a varied and complicated function for which he possessed the rare gift of both practical and theoretical knowledge. At the same time he instructed the young king in cosmography, explained to him the variation of the compass, and was successful in interesting him in nautical matters, and in the glory resulting from maritime discoveries. It was a high and almost unique situation. Cabot used it to put into execution a project which he had long cherished.
The position Cabot held in England can best be described as the Intendant of the Navy; acting under the authority of the king and council, he seemed to oversee all maritime activities. He issued licenses, evaluated pilots, created instructions, drafted maps, and handled a variety of complex tasks for which he had the rare combination of both practical and theoretical expertise. At the same time, he taught the young king about cosmography, explained compass variations, and managed to spark his interest in nautical subjects and the glory that came from maritime discoveries. It was a prestigious and nearly unparalleled role. Cabot used this opportunity to pursue a project he had long dreamed of.
At this period, we may almost say there was no trade in England. All commerce was in the hands of the Hanseatic towns, Antwerp, Hamburg, Bremen, &c. These companies of merchants had, on various occasions, obtained considerable reductions in import duties, and had ended by monopolizing the English trade. Cabot held that Englishmen possessed as good qualifications as these merchants for becoming manufacturers, and that the already powerful navy which England possessed might assist marvellously in the export of the products of the soil and of the manufactures. What was the use of having recourse to strangers when people could do their own business? If they had been unable up to this time to reach Cathay and India by the north-west, might they not endeavour to reach it by the north-east. And if they did not succeed, would they not find in this direction more commercial, and more civilized people than the miserable Esquimaux on the coast of Labrador and Newfoundland?
During this time, we can almost say there was no trade in England. All commerce was controlled by the Hanseatic towns, Antwerp, Hamburg, Bremen, etc. These merchant groups had, on several occasions, secured significant cuts in import duties and ended up monopolizing English trade. Cabot believed that Englishmen had just as much potential as these merchants to become manufacturers and that the already strong navy England had could greatly aid in exporting agricultural products and manufactured goods. Why rely on outsiders when people could handle their own business? If they hadn't been able to reach Cathay and India via the northwest so far, couldn't they try to get there through the northeast? And if they didn’t succeed, wouldn’t they encounter more commercially advanced and civilized people in that direction than the miserable Eskimos on the coast of Labrador and Newfoundland?
Cabot assembled some leading London merchants, laid his projects before them, and formed them into an association, of which on the 14th of December, 1551, he was named president for life. At the same time he exerted himself most vigorously with the king, and having made him understand the wrong which the monopoly enjoyed by strangers did to his own subjects, he obtained its abolition on the 23rd of February, 1551, and inaugurated the practice of free trade.
Cabot gathered some top London merchants, presented his plans to them, and formed them into a group, of which he was appointed president for life on December 14, 1551. At the same time, he worked hard with the king, and after making him realize how the monopoly held by outsiders harmed his own people, he got it abolished on February 23, 1551, and started the practice of free trade.
The Association of English Merchants, under the name of "Merchant Adventurers," hastened to have some vessels built, adapted to the difficulties to be encountered in the navigation of the Arctic regions. The first improvement which the English marine owed to Cabot was the sheathing of the keels, which he had seen done in Spain, but which had not hitherto been practised in England.
The Association of English Merchants, known as the "Merchant Adventurers," quickly commissioned the construction of ships designed to handle the challenges of navigating the Arctic regions. The first enhancement that the English navy gained from Cabot was the sheathing of the keels, a practice he had observed in Spain but that had not previously been used in England.
A flotilla of three vessels was assembled at Deptford. They were the Buona-Speranza, of which the command was given to Sir Hugh Willoughby, a brave gentleman who had earned a high reputation in war; the Buona-Confidencia, Captain Cornil Durforth; and the Bonaventure, Captain Richard Chancellor, a clever sailor, and a particular friend of Cabot's; he received the title of pilot-major. The sailing-master of the Bonaventure was Stephen Burrough, an accomplished mariner, who was destined to make numerous voyages in the North seas, and later to become pilot in chief for England.
A fleet of three ships was gathered at Deptford. They were the Buona-Speranza, commanded by Sir Hugh Willoughby, a brave man with a strong reputation in battle; the Buona-Confidencia, captained by Cornil Durforth; and the Bonaventure, led by Captain Richard Chancellor, a skilled sailor and a close friend of Cabot, who was appointed as the main pilot. The sailing master of the Bonaventure was Stephen Burrough, a talented sailor who would go on to make many journeys in the Northern seas and eventually become the chief pilot for England.
Although age and his important duties prevented Cabot from placing himself at the head of the expedition, he wished at least, to preside over all the details of the equipment. He himself wrote out the instructions, which have been preserved, and which prove the prudence and skill of this distinguished navigator. He there recommends the use of the log-line, an instrument intended to measure the speed of the vessel, and he desires that the journal of the events happening at sea may be kept with regularity, and that all information as to the character, manners, habits, and resources of the people visited, and the productions of the country, may be recorded in writing. The sailors were to offer no violence to the natives, but to act towards them with courtesy. All blasphemy and swearing was to be punished with severity, and also drunkenness. The religious exercises are prescribed, prayers are to be said morning and evening, and the Holy Scriptures are to be read once in the day. Cabot ends by recommending union and concord above all, and reminds the captains of the greatness of their enterprise, and the honour which they might hope to gain; finally he promises them to add his prayers to theirs for the success of their common work.
Although age and his important duties kept Cabot from leading the expedition, he still wanted to oversee all the details of the equipment. He personally wrote the instructions, which have been preserved and show the prudence and skill of this notable navigator. In these instructions, he recommends using the log-line, an instrument designed to measure the vessel's speed, and he insists that a journal of events at sea be kept regularly. He also requests that all information about the character, manners, habits, resources of the people visited, and the products of the country be documented in writing. The sailors were instructed to be courteous to the natives and to avoid any form of violence. Any blasphemy, swearing, or drunkenness was to be strictly punished. The guidelines included religious practices, with prayers to be said morning and evening, and the Holy Scriptures to be read once a day. Cabot concluded by emphasizing the importance of unity and harmony above all, reminding the captains of the significance of their mission and the honor they could achieve, and finally, he promised to add his prayers for the success of their shared efforts.
The squadron set sail on the 20th of May, 1558, in presence of the court assembled at Greenwich, amid an immense concourse of people, after fêtes and rejoicings, at which the king, who was ill, could not be present. Near the Loffoden Islands, on the coast of Norway at the bearing of Wardhous, the squadron was separated from the Bonaventure. Carried away by the storm, Willoughby's two vessels touched, without doubt, at Nova Zembla, and were forced by the ice to return southwards. On the 18th of September, they entered the port formed by the mouth of the River Arzina in East Lapland. Some time afterwards, the Buona-Confidencia, separated from Willoughby by a fresh tempest, returned to England. As to the latter, some Russian fishermen found his vessel the following year, in the midst of the ice. The whole crew had died of cold. This, at least, is what we are led to suppose from the journal kept by the unfortunate Willoughby up to the month of January, 1554.
The squadron set off on May 20, 1558, in front of the court gathered at Greenwich, with a huge crowd of people present, after celebrations that the king, who was unwell, couldn't attend. Close to the Loffoden Islands on the coast of Norway, near Wardhous, the squadron got separated from the Bonaventure. Caught in a storm, Willoughby's two ships likely stopped at Nova Zembla and were forced to head back south due to the ice. On September 18, they arrived at the port created by the mouth of the River Arzina in East Lapland. Later, the Buona-Confidencia, which had separated from Willoughby during another storm, returned to England. As for Willoughby, some Russian fishermen discovered his ship the following year, trapped in the ice. All of the crew had died from the cold. This is what we can infer from the journal kept by the unfortunate Willoughby until January 1554.
Chancellor, after having waited in vain for his two consorts at the rendezvous which had been agreed upon in case of separation, thought they must have outsailed him, and rounding the North Cape, he entered a vast gulf which was none other than the White Sea; he then landed at the mouth of the Dwina, near the monastery of St. Nicholas, on the spot upon which the town of Archangel was soon to stand. The inhabitants of these desolate places told him that the country was under the dominion of the Grand Duke of Russia. Chancellor resolved at once to go to Moscow, in spite of the enormous distance which separated him from it. The Czar then on the throne was Ivan IV. Wassiliewitch, called the Terrible. For some time before this, the Russians had shaken off the Tartar yoke, and Ivan had united all the petty rival principalities in one body politic, of which the power was already becoming considerable. The situation of Russia, exclusively continental, far from any frequented sea, isolated from the rest of Europe, of which it did not yet form part, so much were its habits and manners still Asiatic, promised success to Chancellor.
Chancellor, after waiting in vain for his two associates at the meeting point they agreed upon in case they got separated, figured they must have sailed past him. He rounded the North Cape and entered a vast gulf, which was actually the White Sea. He then landed at the mouth of the Dwina, near the St. Nicholas monastery, on the site where the town of Archangel would soon be established. The locals in these desolate areas informed him that the land was under the rule of the Grand Duke of Russia. Chancellor immediately decided to make his way to Moscow, despite the immense distance between them. At that time, the Czar on the throne was Ivan IV. Wassiliewitch, known as the Terrible. Some time before, the Russians had shaken off the Tartar yoke, and Ivan had unified all the small rival principalities into a single political entity, which was already gaining considerable power. Russia's situation, being entirely continental, away from any busy sea and isolated from the rest of Europe—of which it hadn't yet become part, given that its customs and lifestyles were still quite Asiatic—gave Chancellor hope for success.
![]() |
Chancellor received by the Czar. |
The Czar, who up to this time, had not been able to procure European merchandise, except by way of Poland, and who wished to gain access to the German seas, saw with pleasure the attempts of the English to establish a trade which would be beneficial to both parties. He not only received Chancellor courteously, but he made him most advantageous offers, granted him great privileges and encouraged him, by the kindness of his reception, to repeat his voyage. Chancellor sold his merchandise to great advantage, and after taking on board another cargo of furs, of seal and whale oils, copper, and other products, returned to England, carrying a letter from the Czar. The advantages which the Company of Merchant Adventurers had derived from this first voyage, encouraged them to attempt a second. So Chancellor the following year, made a fresh voyage to Archangel, and took two of the Company's agents to Russia, who concluded an advantageous treaty with the Czar. Then he set out again for England with an ambassador and his suite, sent by Ivan to Great Britain. Of the four vessels which composed the flotilla, one was lost on the coast of Norway, another as it left Drontheim, and the Bonaventure, on board of which were Chancellor and the ambassador, foundered in the Bay of Pitsligo, on the east coast of Scotland on the 10th of November, 1556. Chancellor was drowned in the wreck, being less fortunate than the Muscovite ambassador, who had the good luck to escape; but the presents and merchandise which he was carrying to England were lost.
The Czar, who until now had only been able to get European goods through Poland and wanted access to the German seas, was pleased with the English efforts to establish a mutually beneficial trade. He not only welcomed the Chancellor warmly but also made him very favorable offers, granted him significant privileges, and encouraged him, through the kindness of his reception, to return for another voyage. Chancellor sold his goods at a great profit, and after loading up with another shipment of furs, seal and whale oils, copper, and other products, he returned to England with a letter from the Czar. The benefits that the Company of Merchant Adventurers gained from this first trip motivated them to plan a second mission. So, the following year, Chancellor made another voyage to Archangel and took two of the Company’s agents to Russia, who finalized a beneficial treaty with the Czar. He then set off again for England with an ambassador and his entourage, sent by Ivan to Great Britain. Of the four ships in the fleet, one was lost off the coast of Norway, another went down as it left Drontheim, and the Bonaventure, which carried Chancellor and the ambassador, sank in the Bay of Pitsligo, on the east coast of Scotland on November 10, 1556. Chancellor drowned in the wreck, being less fortunate than the Muscovite ambassador, who managed to escape; however, the gifts and goods he was bringing to England were lost.
![]() |
Wreck of the Bonaventure. |
Such was the commencement of the Anglo-Russian Company. A goodly number of expeditions succeeded each other in those parts, but it would be beside our purpose to give an account of them. Let us now return to Cabot.
Such was the start of the Anglo-Russian Company. Many expeditions followed in those regions, but it’s not our aim to recount them. Let’s now go back to Cabot.
It was in 1554 that Queen Mary of England was married to Philip II., King of Spain. When the latter came to England he showed himself very ill-disposed towards Cabot, who had abandoned the service of Spain, and who, at this very moment was procuring for England a commerce which would soon immensely increase the maritime power of an already formidable country. Thus we are not surprised to learn that eight days after the landing of the King of Spain, Cabot was forced to resign his office and his pension, both of which had been bestowed upon him for life by Edward VI. Worthington was nominated in his place. Mr. Nicholls thinks that this dishonourable man, who had had some quarrels with the law, had a secret mission to seize among Cabot's plans, maps, instructions, and projects, those which could be of use to Spain. The fact is that all these documents are now lost, at least unless they may yet be discovered among the archives of Simancas.
It was in 1554 that Queen Mary of England married Philip II, King of Spain. When he arrived in England, he showed a strong dislike for Cabot, who had left Spain's service and was currently securing a trade for England that would soon greatly enhance the maritime power of an already powerful nation. Therefore, it’s not surprising to learn that eight days after the King of Spain's arrival, Cabot was forced to resign his position and his pension, both of which had been granted to him for life by Edward VI. Worthington was appointed in his place. Mr. Nicholls believes that this dishonorable man, who had some legal troubles, had a secret mission to seize Cabot's plans, maps, instructions, and projects that could be useful to Spain. The fact is that all these documents are now lost, unless they might still be found among the archives of Simancas.
At the end of this period, history completely loses sight of the old mariner. The same mystery which hangs over his birth, also envelopes the place and date of his death. His immense discoveries, his cosmographical works, his study of the variations of the magnetic needle, his wisdom, his humane disposition, and his honourable conduct, place Sebastian Cabot in the foremost rank among discoverers. A figure lost in the shadow and vagueness of legends until our own day, Cabot owes it to his biographers, to Biddle, D'Avezac, and Nicholls, that he is now better known, more highly appreciated, and for the first time really placed in the light.
At the end of this time period, history completely loses track of the old sailor. The same mystery surrounding his birth also shrouds the place and date of his death. His vast discoveries, his work in cosmography, his research on the magnetic needle's variations, his wisdom, his kindness, and his honorable behavior place Sebastian Cabot among the top explorers. A figure long lost in the shadows and uncertainty of legends until now, Cabot owes his current recognition and appreciation to his biographers, Biddle, D'Avezac, and Nicholls, who have finally brought him into the light.
POLAR EXPEDITIONS.
John Verrazzano—Jacques Cartier and his three voyages to Canada—The town of Hochelaga—Tobacco—The scurvy—Voyage of Roberval—Martin Frobisher and his voyages—John Davis—Barentz and Heemskerke—Spitzbergen—Winter season at Nova Zembla—Return to Europe—Relics of the Expedition.
John Verrazzano—Jacques Cartier and his three trips to Canada—The town of Hochelaga—Tobacco—Scurvy—Roberval's voyage—Martin Frobisher and his journeys—John Davis—Barentz and Heemskerke—Spitzbergen—Winter in Nova Zembla—Return to Europe—Remnants of the Expedition.
From 1492 to 1524, France had stood aloof, officially at least, from enterprises of discovery and colonization. But Francis I. could not look on quietly while the power of his rival Charles V. received a large addition by the conquest of Mexico. He therefore ordered John Verrazzano, a Venetian who was in his service, to make a voyage of exploration. We will pause here for a short time, although the various places may have already been visited on several occasions, because for the first time the banner of France floats over the shores of the New World. This exploration besides, was to prepare the way for those of Jacques Cartier and of Champlain in Canada, as well as for the unlucky experiments in colonization of Jean Ribaut, and of Laudonnière, the sanguinary voyage of reprisals of Gourgues, and Villegagnon's attempt at a settlement in Brazil.
From 1492 to 1524, France had remained detached, at least officially, from exploration and colonization efforts. However, Francis I couldn’t just sit back and watch while his rival Charles V gained significant power through the conquest of Mexico. So, he instructed John Verrazzano, a Venetian working for him, to undertake an exploration voyage. We will pause here for a moment, even though these areas may have been visited before, because this marks the first time the French flag flies over the shores of the New World. This exploration was also meant to pave the way for Jacques Cartier and Champlain in Canada, along with the unfortunate colonization attempts by Jean Ribaut and Laudonnière, Gourgues’ violent revenge expedition, and Villegagnon's settlement attempt in Brazil.
We possess no biographical details with regard to Verrazzano. Under what circumstances did he enter the service of France? What was his title to the command of such an expedition? Nothing is known of the Venetian traveller, for all we possess of his writings is the Italian translation of his report to Francis I. published in the collection of Ramusio. The French translation of this Italian translation exists in an abridged form in Lescarbot's work on New France and in the Histoire des Voyages. For our very rapid epitome we shall make use of the Italian text of Ramusio, except in some passages where Lescarbot's translation has appeared to give an idea of the rich, original, and marvellously modulated language of the sixteenth century.
We don't have any biographical details about Verrazzano. Under what circumstances did he start working for France? What gave him the authority to lead such an expedition? We know nothing about the Venetian traveler because all we have of his writings is the Italian translation of his report to Francis I, published in Ramusio's collection. The French translation of this Italian version exists in a condensed form in Lescarbot's work on New France and in the Histoire des Voyages. For our very brief summary, we'll use the Italian text from Ramusio, except in some sections where Lescarbot's translation provides a sense of the rich, original, and beautifully crafted language of the sixteenth century.
![]() |
Having set out with four vessels to make discoveries in the ocean, says Verrazzano in a letter written from Dieppe to Francis I. on the 8th July, 1524, he was forced by a storm to take refuge in Brittany with two of his vessels, the Dauphine and the Normande, there to repair damages. Thence he set sail for the coast of Spain, where he seems to have given chase to some Spanish vessels. We see him leave with the Dauphine alone on the 17th of January, 1524, a small inhabited island in the neighbourhood of Madeira, and launch himself upon the ocean with a crew of fifty men, well furnished with provisions and ammunition for an eight months' voyage.
Having set out with four ships to explore the ocean, Verrazzano mentions in a letter from Dieppe to Francis I on July 8, 1524, that he was forced by a storm to take shelter in Brittany with two of his ships, the Dauphine and the Normande, to repair damage. From there, he sailed to the coast of Spain, where he seems to have pursued some Spanish ships. We see him depart with just the Dauphine on January 17, 1524, from a small inhabited island near Madeira, and venture out into the ocean with a crew of fifty men, fully stocked with supplies and ammunition for an eight-month journey.
Twenty-five days later he has made 1500 miles to the west, when he is assailed by a fearful storm; and twenty-five days afterwards, that is to say on the 8th or 9th of March, having made about 1200 miles, he discovers land at 30° north latitude, which he thought had never been previously explored. "When we arrived, it seemed to us to be very low, but on approaching within a quarter of a league we saw by the great fires which were lighted along the harbours and borders of the sea, that it was inhabited, and in taking trouble to find a harbour in which to land and make acquaintance with the country, we sailed more than 150 miles in vain, so that seeing the coast trended ever southwards, we decided to turn back again." The Frenchmen finding a favourable landing-place, perceived a number of natives who came towards them, but who fled away when they saw them land. Soon recalled by the friendly signs and demonstrations of the French, they showed great surprise at their clothes, their faces, and the whiteness of their skin. The natives were entirely naked, except that the middle of the body was covered with sable-skins, hung from a narrow girdle of prettily woven grasses, and ornamented with tails of other animals, which fell to their knees. Some wore crowns of birds' feathers. "They have brown skins," says the narrative, "and are exactly like the Saracens; their hair is black, not very long, and tied at the back of the head in the form of a small tail. Their limbs are well proportioned, they are of middle height, although a little taller than ourselves, and have no other defect beyond their faces being rather broad; they are not strong, but they are agile, and some of the greatest and quickest runners in the world." It was impossible for Verrazzano to collect any details about the manners and mode of life of these people, on account of the short time that he remained among them. The shore at this place was composed of fine sand interspersed here and there with little sandy hillocks, behind which were scattered "groves and very thick forests which were wonderfully pleasant to look upon." There were in this country, as far as we could judge, abundance of stags, fallow deer and hares, numerous lakes, and streams of sparkling water, as well as a quantity of birds.
Twenty-five days later, he had traveled 1,500 miles to the west when he was hit by a fierce storm; and twenty-five days after that, around March 8th or 9th, having covered about 1,200 miles, he spotted land at 30° north latitude, which he believed had never been explored before. "When we arrived, it looked very low, but as we got within a quarter of a league, we saw by the large fires lit along the harbors and the shoreline that it was inhabited. In our search for a harbor to land and get to know the area, we sailed over 150 miles in vain; so, seeing that the coast continued to trend southward, we decided to turn back." The French found a suitable landing spot and noticed several natives approaching them, but the natives fled when they saw them land. Soon reassured by the friendly gestures of the French, they were visibly surprised by their clothes, faces, and the whiteness of their skin. The natives were completely naked, except for their midsection, which was covered with sable-skins hanging from a narrow belt made of beautifully woven grasses, adorned with tails of other animals that reached their knees. Some wore crowns made of bird feathers. "They have brown skin," the narrative states, "and they are much like the Saracens; their hair is black, not very long, and tied at the back of their heads in a small tail. Their limbs are well-proportioned; they are of average height, though slightly taller than us, and have no other flaw except that their faces are somewhat broad. They are not strong, but they are agile and among the fastest runners in the world." It was impossible for Verrazzano to gather any details about the customs and way of life of these people due to his short stay among them. The shore in this area was made up of fine sand, sprinkled here and there with small sandy hills, behind which were "groves and very dense forests that were lovely to behold." In this country, as far as we could see, there were plenty of stags, fallow deer, and hares, numerous lakes, sparkling streams, and a variety of birds.
This land lies at 34°. It is therefore the part of the United States which now goes by the name of Carolina. The air there is pure and salubrious, the climate temperate, the sea is entirely without rocks, and in spite of the want of harbours it is not unfavourable for navigators.
This land is located at 34°. It is now known as Carolina, part of the United States. The air here is clean and healthy, the climate is mild, the sea is completely free of rocks, and even though there are no harbors, it’s still not bad for sailors.
During the whole month of March the French sailed along the coast, which seemed to them to be inhabited by a numerous population. The want of water forced them to land several times, and they perceived that the savages were most pleased with mirrors, bells, knives, and sheets of paper. One day they sent a long-boat ashore with twenty-five men in it. A young sailor jumped into the water "because he could not land on account of the waves and currents, in order to give some small articles to these people, and having thrown them to them from a distance because he was distrustful of the natives, he was cast violently on shore by the waves. The Indians seeing him in this condition, take him and carry him far away from the sea, to the great dismay of the poor sailor, who expected they were about to sacrifice him. Having placed him at the foot of a little hill, in the full blaze of the sun, they stripped him quite naked and wondered at the whiteness of his skin; then lighting a large fire they made him come to it and recover his strength, and it was then that the poor young man as well as those who were in the boat, thought that the Indians were about to massacre and immolate him, roasting his flesh in this large brazier and then eating their victim, as do the cannibals. But it happened quite differently; for having shown a desire to return to the boat they reconducted him to the edge of the sea, and having kissed him very lovingly, they retired to a hill to see him re-enter the boat."
During the whole month of March, the French sailed along the coast, which seemed to be inhabited by many people. The lack of water forced them to land several times, and they noticed that the locals were particularly interested in mirrors, bells, knives, and sheets of paper. One day, they sent a longboat ashore with twenty-five men. A young sailor jumped into the water because he couldn’t land due to the waves and currents, wanting to give some small items to the locals. He threw the items to them from a distance because he was wary of the natives, and then the waves threw him violently onto the shore. The Indians, seeing him in this state, took him and carried him far away from the sea, which greatly alarmed the poor sailor, who feared they were going to sacrifice him. They placed him at the foot of a small hill, in the full sun, stripped him completely, and marveled at the whiteness of his skin. Then, they built a large fire and made him come closer to recover his strength. At that moment, both the poor young man and those in the boat thought the Indians were going to massacre him, roasting his flesh over the fire to eat him, like cannibals do. However, it turned out very differently; after expressing a desire to return to the boat, they took him back to the shore, kissed him affectionately, and then went to a hill to watch him re-enter the boat.
Continuing to follow the shore northwards for more than 150 miles, the Frenchmen reached a land which seemed to them more beautiful, being covered with thick woods. Into these forests, twenty men penetrated for more than six miles and only returned to the shore from the fear of losing themselves. In this walk, having met two women, one young and the other old, with some children, they seized one of the latter who might be about eight years old, with the idea of taking him away to France; but they could not do the same with the young woman, who began to cry with all her might, calling for aid from her compatriots, who were hidden in the wood. In this place the savages were whiter than any of those hitherto met with; they snared birds and used a bow of very hard wood, and arrows tipped with fish-bones. Their canoes, twenty feet long and four feet wide, were hollowed by fire out of a trunk of a tree. Wild vines abounded and climbed over the trees in long festoons as they do in Lombardy. With a little cultivation they would no doubt produce excellent wine—"for the fruit is sweet and pleasant like ours, and we thought that the natives were not insensible to it, for in all directions where these vines grew, they had taken care to cut away the branches of the surrounding trees so that the fruit might ripen." Wild roses, lilies, violets, and all kinds of odoriferous plants and flowers, new to the Europeans, carpeted the ground everywhere, and filled the air with sweet perfumes.
Continuing to follow the shore north for more than 150 miles, the Frenchmen reached a land they found beautiful, covered in thick woods. Twenty of them ventured into the forests for over six miles and only returned to the shore out of fear of getting lost. During their exploration, they encountered two women, one young and one old, along with some children. They captured one of the children, who was about eight years old, intending to take him back to France; however, they couldn't do the same with the young woman, who began to cry out loudly for help from her people hidden in the woods. In this area, the locals were fairer than any they had encountered before; they caught birds using a bow made of very hard wood and arrows tipped with fish bones. Their canoes, measuring twenty feet long and four feet wide, were hollowed out of tree trunks by fire. Wild vines were plentiful, climbing over the trees in long strands, much like they do in Lombardy. With some cultivation, they would surely produce excellent wine— "for the fruit is sweet and pleasant like ours, and we thought the natives appreciated it, as they went to the trouble of cutting away the branches of nearby trees to let the fruit ripen." Wild roses, lilies, violets, and all kinds of fragrant plants and flowers, new to the Europeans, covered the ground everywhere and filled the air with sweet scents.
![]() |
Canadian Landscape. |
After remaining for three days in this enchanting place, the Frenchmen continued to follow the coast northwards, sailing by day and casting anchor at night. As the land trended towards the east, they went 150 miles further in that direction, and discovered an island of triangular shape about thirty miles distant from the continent, similar in size to the Island of Rhodes, and upon which they bestowed the name of the mother of Francis I., Louisa of Savoy. Then they reached another island forty-five miles off, which possessed a magnificent harbour and of which the inhabitants came in crowds to visit the strange vessels. Two kings, especially, were of fine stature and great beauty. They were dressed in deer-skins, with the head bare, the hair carried back and tied in a tuft, and they wore on the neck a large chain ornamented with coloured stones. This was the most remarkable nation which they had until now met with. "The women are graceful," says the narrative published by Ramusio. "Some wore the skins of the lynx on their arms; their head was ornamented with their plaited hair and long plaits hung down on both sides of the chest; others had headdresses which recalled those of the Egyptian and Syrian women; only the elderly women, and those who were married, wore pendants in their ears of worked copper." This land is situated on the same parallel as Rome, in 41° 40', but its climate is much colder.
After staying in this amazing place for three days, the Frenchmen continued to sail north along the coast, traveling during the day and anchoring at night. As the land curved eastward, they ventured 150 miles further in that direction and discovered a triangular-shaped island about thirty miles from the mainland, roughly the size of Rhodes, which they named after Louisa of Savoy, the mother of Francis I. They then reached another island forty-five miles away, which had a magnificent harbor, and the locals came in large numbers to visit the strange ships. Two kings, in particular, were tall and strikingly handsome. They were dressed in deer-skin, with bare heads, their hair pulled back and tied in a tuft, and they wore large chains adorned with colored stones around their necks. This was the most remarkable tribe they had encountered so far. "The women are graceful," says the narrative published by Ramusio. "Some wore lynx skins on their arms; their hair was braided and long braids hung down on both sides of their chests; others had headdresses reminiscent of those worn by women in Egypt and Syria; only older and married women wore copper pendants in their ears." This land is located on the same latitude as Rome, at 41° 40', but its climate is much colder.
![]() |
Two Canadian Kings. |
On the 5th of May, Verrazzano left this port and sailed along the sea-shore for 450 miles. At last he reached a country of which the inhabitants resembled but little any of those whom he had hitherto met with. They were so wild that it was impossible to carry on any trade with them, or any sustained intercourse. What they appeared to esteem above everything else were fish-hooks, knives, and all articles in metal, attaching no value to all the trifling baubles which up to this time had served for barter. Twenty-five armed men landed and advanced from four to six miles into the interior of the country. They were received by the natives with flights of arrows, after which the latter retired into the immense forests which appeared to cover the whole country.
On May 5th, Verrazzano left this port and sailed along the coastline for 450 miles. Eventually, he arrived at a land where the people were very different from anyone he had encountered before. They were so wild that it was impossible to trade or have any meaningful interactions with them. What they seemed to value above all were fish-hooks, knives, and other metal items, showing no interest in the small trinkets that had worked for trade until then. Twenty-five armed men went ashore and ventured four to six miles into the interior. They were met by the locals with a shower of arrows, after which the natives retreated into the vast forests that seemed to cover the entire region.
One hundred and fifty miles further on spreads out a vast archipelago composed of thirty-two islands, all near the land, separated by narrow canals, which reminded the Venetian navigator of the archipelagos which in the Adriatic border the coasts of Sclavonia and Dalmatia. At length, 450 miles further on, in latitude 50°, the French came to lands which had been previously discovered by the Bretons. Finding themselves then short of provisions, and having reconnoitred the coast of America for a distance of 2100 miles, they returned to France, and disembarked safely at Dieppe in the month of July, 1524.
One hundred and fifty miles farther on lies a huge group of thirty-two islands, all close to the mainland, separated by narrow channels that reminded the Venetian navigator of the archipelagos along the Adriatic shores of Sclavonia and Dalmatia. Finally, 450 miles later, at latitude 50°, the French arrived at lands previously discovered by the Bretons. Running low on supplies and having explored the coast of America for 2,100 miles, they returned to France and safely landed in Dieppe in July 1524.
Some historians relate that Verrazzano was made prisoner by the savages who inhabit the coast of Labrador, and was eaten by them. A fact which is simply impossible, since he addressed from Dieppe to Francis I. the account of his voyage which we have just abridged. Besides, the Indians of these regions were not anthropophagi. Certain authors, but we have not been able to discover on the authority of what documents, nor under what circumstances this happened, relate that Verrazzano having fallen into the power of the Spaniards, had been taken to Spain and there hanged. It is wiser to admit that we know nothing certain about Verrazzano, and that we are totally ignorant what rewards his long voyage procured for him. Perhaps when some learned man shall have looked through our archives (of which the abstract and inventory are far from being finished), he may recover some new documents; but for the present we must confine ourselves to the narrative of Ramusio.
Some historians say that Verrazzano was captured by the locals along the coast of Labrador and was eaten by them. This claim is simply not true, as he wrote to Francis I from Dieppe recounting his voyage, which we have just summarized. Also, the Indigenous people in these areas were not cannibals. Some authors have mentioned, but we haven't found the sources or contexts for their claims, that Verrazzano was captured by the Spaniards, taken to Spain, and hanged there. It's wiser to acknowledge that we don't know anything certain about Verrazzano, and we have no idea what rewards he received for his long voyage. Maybe someday a scholar will go through our archives (which are still being summarized and organized) and uncover new documents; but for now, we must stick to Ramusio's narrative.
![]() |
Jacques Cartier. From an old print. |
Ten years later a captain of St. Malo, named Jacques Cartier, born on the 21st of December, 1484, conceived the project of establishing a colony in the northern part of America. Being favourably received by Admiral Philippe de Chabot, and by Francis I., who asked to see the clause in Adam's will which disinherited him of the New World in favour of the kings of Spain and Portugal, Cartier left St. Malo with two vessels on the 20th of April, 1534. The vessel which carried him weighed only sixty tons and carried a crew of sixty-one men. At the end of only twenty days, so favourable was the voyage, Cartier discovered Newfoundland at Cape Bonavista. He then went northwards as far as Bird Island, which he found surrounded by ice, all broken up and melting, but on which he was able, nevertheless, to lay in a stock of five or six tons of guillemots, puffins, and penguins, without reckoning those which were eaten fresh. He then explored all the coast of the island, which at this time bore a number of Breton names, thus proving the assiduous manner in which the French frequented these shores. Then penetrating into the Strait of Belle-Isle, which separates the continent from the Island of Newfoundland, Cartier arrived at the Gulf of St. Lawrence. Along the whole of this coast the harbours are excellent: "If the land only corresponded to the goodness of the harbours," says the St. Malo sailor, "it would be a great blessing; but one ought not to call it land; it is rather pebbles and savage rocks and places fit for wild beasts: as for all the land towards the north, I never saw as much earth there as would fill a tumbrel." After having coasted along the continent, Cartier was cast by a tempest upon the west coast of Newfoundland, where he explored Cape Royal and Cape Milk, the Columba Islands, Cape St. John, the Magdalen Islands, and the Bay of Miramichi on the continent. In this place he had some intercourse with the savages, who showed "a great and marvellous eagerness in the acquisition of iron tools and other things, always dancing and performing various ceremonies, among others throwing sea-water on their heads with their hands; so well did they receive us that they gave us all that they had, keeping back nothing." The next day the number of the savages was even greater, and our French sailors made an ample harvest of furs and skins of animals.
Ten years later, a captain from St. Malo named Jacques Cartier, born on December 21, 1484, came up with the idea of establishing a colony in the northern part of America. He got a positive response from Admiral Philippe de Chabot and Francis I., who wanted to see the clause in Adam's will that disinherited him of the New World in favor of the kings of Spain and Portugal. Cartier left St. Malo with two ships on April 20, 1534. The ship he was on was only sixty tons and had a crew of sixty-one men. After just twenty days, thanks to a favorable voyage, Cartier discovered Newfoundland at Cape Bonavista. He then headed north as far as Bird Island, which he found surrounded by melting ice, but he was still able to stock up on five or six tons of guillemots, puffins, and penguins, not counting those that were eaten fresh. He explored the entire coast of the island, which at that time had quite a few Breton names, demonstrating how frequently the French visited these shores. Then, pushing into the Strait of Belle Isle, which separates the mainland from the Island of Newfoundland, Cartier reached the Gulf of St. Lawrence. The harbors along this entire coast were excellent: "If the land only matched the quality of the harbors," says the St. Malo sailor, "it would be a great blessing; but one shouldn't call it land; it’s more like pebbles and wild rocks and areas fit for wild beasts: as for all the land to the north, I never saw as much earth there as would fill a cart." After sailing along the continent, Cartier was caught in a storm that threw him onto the west coast of Newfoundland, where he explored Cape Royal, Cape Milk, the Columba Islands, Cape St. John, the Magdalen Islands, and the Bay of Miramichi on the mainland. Here, he had some interaction with the natives, who showed "a great and remarkable eagerness for iron tools and other items, always dancing and performing various ceremonies, including throwing sea-water on their heads with their hands; they received us so well that they gave us everything they had, holding nothing back." The next day, there were even more natives, and our French sailors made a significant haul of furs and animal hides.
After having explored the Bay of Chaleurs, Cartier arrived at the entrance of the estuary of the St. Lawrence, where he saw some natives, who possessed neither the appearance nor the language of the first. "The latter may truly be called savages, for no poorer people can be found in the world, and I think that all put together, excepting their boats and their nets, they could not have had the value of two pence half-penny. They have the head entirely shaved, with the exception of a lock of hair on the very top, which they allow to grow as long as a horse's tail, and which they fasten upon the head with some small copper needles. Their only dwelling is underneath their boats, which they overturn and then stretch themselves on the ground beneath them without any covering."
After exploring the Bay of Chaleurs, Cartier reached the entrance of the St. Lawrence estuary, where he encountered some natives who looked and spoke differently from the first group he met. "These can truly be called savages, as you won't find poorer people anywhere in the world. All of them together, excluding their boats and nets, likely have less value than two and a half pence. They shave their heads completely, leaving only a lock of hair on the very top that they let grow as long as a horse's tail, which they secure to their heads with some small copper needles. Their only shelter is beneath their overturned boats, where they lie on the ground underneath with no covering."
After having planted a large cross in this place, Jacques Cartier obtained the chief's permission to take away with him two of his children, whom he was to bring back again on his next voyage. Then he set out again for France, and landed at St. Malo on the 5th of September, 1534.
After planting a large cross in this area, Jacques Cartier got the chief's permission to take two of his children with him, promising to bring them back on his next trip. He then headed back to France and arrived in St. Malo on September 5, 1534.
The following year, on the 19th of May, Cartier left St. Malo at the head of a fleet composed of three vessels called the Grande and the Petite Hermine and the Emerillon on board of which some gentlemen of high rank had taken passages, among whom may be named Charles de la Pommeraye, and Claude de Pont-Briant, son of the Sieur de Moncevelles and cup-bearer to the Dauphin.
The next year, on May 19th, Cartier set sail from St. Malo with a fleet of three ships named the Grande, the Petite Hermine, and the Emerillon, which had some distinguished gentlemen on board, including Charles de la Pommeraye and Claude de Pont-Briant, the son of Sieur de Moncevelles and cup-bearer to the Dauphin.
Very soon the squadron was dispersed by the storm, and could not be brought together again until it reached Newfoundland. After having landed at Bird Island, in Whitesand harbour, which is in Castle Bay, Cartier penetrated into the Bay of St. Lawrence. He discovered there the Island of Natiscotec which we call Anticosti, and entered a great river called Hochelaga, which leads to Canada. On the banks of this river lies the country called Saguenay, whence comes the red copper, to which the two savages whom he had taken on his first voyage gave the name of caquetdazé. But before entering the St. Lawrence, Cartier wished to explore the whole gulf, to see if no passage existed to the north. He afterwards returned to the Bay of the Seven Islands, went up the river, and soon reached the river Saguenay, which falls into the St. Lawrence on its northern bank. A little further on, after passing by fourteen islands, he entered the Canadian territories, which no traveller before him had ever visited.
Very soon, the squadron was scattered by the storm and couldn't regroup until it reached Newfoundland. After landing at Bird Island in Whitesand Harbour, which is in Castle Bay, Cartier made his way into the Bay of St. Lawrence. There, he discovered the Island of Natiscotec, which we now call Anticosti, and entered a large river called Hochelaga, which leads to Canada. Along the banks of this river is a region called Saguenay, known for its red copper, which the two Indigenous people he had taken on his first voyage referred to as caquetdazé. However, before entering the St. Lawrence, Cartier wanted to explore the entire gulf to see if there was a passage to the north. He later returned to the Bay of the Seven Islands, navigated up the river, and soon reached the Saguenay River, which flows into the St. Lawrence on its northern bank. A little further on, after passing fourteen islands, he entered Canadian territories that no traveler had ever been to before.
"The next day the lord of Canada, called Donnacona, with twelve boats and accompanied by sixteen men, approached the ships. When abreast of the smallest of our vessels he began to make a palaver or preachment in their fashion, while moving his body and limbs in a marvellous manner, which is a sign of joy and confidence, and when he arrived at the flag-ship where were the two Indians who had been brought back from France, the said chief spoke to them and they to him. And they began to relate to him what they had seen in France and the good treatment which they had received, at which the said chief was very joyful, and begged the captain to give him his arms that he might kiss and embrace them, which is their mode of welcome in this country. The country of Stadaconé, or St. Charles, is fertile and full of very fine trees of the same nature and kind as in France, such as oaks, elms, plum-trees, yews, cedars, vines, hawthorns—which bear fruit as large as damsons—and other trees; beneath them grows hemp as good as that of France." Cartier succeeded afterwards in reaching with his boats and his galleon a place which is the Richelieu of the present day, next, a great lake formed by the river—St. Peter's Lake—and at last he arrived at Hochelaga or Montreal, which is 630 miles from the mouth of the St. Lawrence. In this place are "ploughed lands and large and beautiful plains full of the corn of the country, which is like the millet of Brazil, as large or larger than peas, on which they live as we do on wheat. And among these plains is placed and seated the said town of Hochelaga near to and joining on to some high ground which is around the town; and which is well cultivated and quite small; from the top of it one can see very far. We named this mountain the Mount Royal."
"The next day, the chief of Canada, known as Donnacona, came with twelve boats and sixteen men to the ships. When he got to the smallest of our vessels, he started to speak in their style, moving his body and limbs in an impressive way, which shows joy and confidence. When he reached the flagship where the two Indians who had been brought back from France were, the chief talked to them, and they responded. They began to share what they had seen in France and the good treatment they received, which made the chief very happy. He asked the captain for his weapons so he could kiss and embrace them, which is their way of welcoming people in this country. The region of Stadaconé, or St. Charles, is fertile and filled with beautiful trees similar to those in France, such as oaks, elms, plum trees, yews, cedars, vines, and hawthorns—some of which bear fruit as large as damsons—and other trees; underneath them grows hemp as good as that of France." Cartier then managed to reach a place that is now known as Richelieu, and then a large lake created by the river—St. Peter's Lake—and finally he arrived at Hochelaga or Montreal, which is 630 miles from the mouth of the St. Lawrence. In this area, there are "plowed fields and large, beautiful plains filled with local corn, which is similar to Brazilian millet, as large or larger than peas, on which they survive as we do on wheat. Among these plains lies the town of Hochelaga, close to and adjoining some higher ground surrounding it, which is well cultivated and quite small; from the top of it, you can see very far. We named this mountain Mount Royal."
The welcome given to Jacques Cartier could not have been more cordial. The chief or Agouhanna, who was crippled in all his limbs, begged the captain to touch them, as if he had asked him for a cure. Then the blind, and those who were blind in one eye, the lame, and the impotent came and sat down near Jacques Cartier, that he might touch them, so thoroughly were they persuaded that he was a god descended to heal them. "The said captain, seeing the faith and piety of this people, recited the Gospel of St. John, namely: In principio, making the sign of the cross over the poor sick people, praying GOD that he would give them the knowledge of our holy faith and grace to accept Christianity and baptism. Then the said captain took a book of Hours and read aloud the Passion of our Saviour, so well that all those present could hear it, all the poor people being quite silent, looking up to heaven and using the same ceremonies as they saw us use." After making themselves acquainted with the country, which could be seen for ninety miles around from the top of Mount Royal, and having collected some information about the water-falls and rapids of the St. Lawrence, Jacques Cartier returned towards Canada, where he did not delay to rejoin his ships. We owe to him the first information on tobacco for smoking, which does not seem to have been in use throughout the whole extent of the New World. "They have a herb," he says, "of which they collect great quantities during the summer for the winter; they esteem it highly, and the men alone use it in the following manner: they dry it in the sun and carry it on their necks in a small skin of an animal in the shape of a bag, with a horn of stone or of wood, then constantly they make the said herb into powder, and put it into one of the ends of the said horn; they then place a live coal upon it and blow through the other end, and so fill their body with smoke that it issues from the mouth and nostrils, as if from the shaft of a chimney. We have tried the said smoke, but after having put it into our mouths, it seemed as if there were ground pepper in them, so hot is it." In the month of December the inhabitants of Stadaconé were attacked by an infectious disease which proved to be the scurvy. "This malady spread so rapidly in our vessels that by the middle of February out of our 110 men there were but ten in good health." Neither prayers, nor orisons, nor vows to our Lady of Roquamadour brought any relief. Twenty-five Frenchmen perished up to the 18th of April, and there were not four amongst them who were not attacked by the malady. But at this time a savage chief informed Jacques Cartier that a decoction of the leaves and sap of a certain tree, probably either the Canadian fir-tree or the barberry, was very salutary. As soon as two or three had experienced its beneficial effects "there was a crowding as if they would have killed each other to be the first to get the medicine; and one of the tallest and largest trees I ever saw was used in less than eight days, which had such an effect that if all the doctors of Louvain and Montpellier had been there with all the drugs of Alexandria, they had not done as much in a year as the said tree accomplished in eight days."
The welcome given to Jacques Cartier could not have been warmer. The chief, Agouhanna, who was disabled, pleaded with the captain to touch him, as if asking for a cure. Then the blind, those with vision in only one eye, the lame, and the infirm gathered around Jacques Cartier, convinced he was a god sent to heal them. "The captain, seeing the faith and devotion of these people, recited the Gospel of St. John, specifically: In principio, making the sign of the cross over the sick, praying GOD to grant them the understanding of our holy faith and the grace to embrace Christianity and baptism. Then the captain took a Book of Hours and read aloud the Passion of our Savior so clearly that everyone could hear it, all the sick people remaining silent, gazing up to heaven and mimicking the rituals they observed us perform." After familiarizing themselves with the land, which could be seen for ninety miles from the top of Mount Royal, and gathering information about the waterfalls and rapids of the St. Lawrence, Jacques Cartier returned toward Canada, where he quickly rejoined his ships. We owe him the first reports on smoking tobacco, which did not appear to be widespread across the New World. "They have a herb," he notes, "that they gather in large amounts during the summer for the winter; they highly value it, and only men use it in this way: they dry it in the sun and carry it around their necks in a small animal skin bag, along with a stone or wooden horn. They constantly grind the herb into powder and put it into one end of the horn; then they place a live coal on it and blow through the other end, filling their bodies with smoke that escapes from their mouths and nostrils, like a chimney. We tried the smoke, but after putting it in our mouths, it felt like we had ground pepper in them—it was that hot." In December, the inhabitants of Stadaconé were struck by a contagious disease that turned out to be scurvy. "This illness spread so quickly through our ships that by mid-February, only ten of our 110 men were healthy." Neither prayers, nor supplications, nor vows to our Lady of Roquamadour provided any relief. By April 18, twenty-five Frenchmen had died, and not four of them were free from the disease. At this point, a native chief told Jacques Cartier that a concoction made from the leaves and sap of a certain tree, probably either the Canadian fir or the barberry, was highly beneficial. Once two or three people experienced its positive effects, "there was such a rush that it seemed they would fight to be the first to get the medicine; and one of the largest trees I have ever seen was used up in less than eight days, achieving results that no doctors from Louvain and Montpellier, with all the remedies from Alexandria, could match in a year."
Some time after, Cartier, having noticed that Donnacona was trying to excite sedition against the French, caused him to be seized, as well as nine other savages, that he might take them to France, where they died. He set sail from the harbour of St. Croix on the 6th of May, descended the St. Lawrence, and after a voyage which was not marked by any incident, he landed at St. Malo on the 16th of July, 1536.
Some time later, Cartier noticed that Donnacona was trying to stir up trouble against the French, so he had him captured along with nine other natives to take them to France, where they ended up dying. He left the harbor of St. Croix on May 6th, traveled down the St. Lawrence, and after a routine voyage without any significant events, he arrived in St. Malo on July 16, 1536.
Francis I., in consequence of the report of this voyage which the St. Malo captain made to him, resolved to take effective possession of the country. After having appointed François de la Roque, Sieur de Roberval, viceroy of Canada, he caused five vessels to be fitted out, which being laden with provisions and ammunition for two years, were to transport Roberval and a certain number of soldiers, artizans, and gentlemen to the new colony, which they were about to establish. The five vessels set sail on the 23rd of May, 1541. They met with such contrary winds that it took them three months to reach Newfoundland. Cartier did not arrive at the harbour of St. Croix till the 23rd of August. As soon as he had landed his provisions, he sent back two of his vessels to France with letters for the king, telling him what had been done, also that the Sieur de Roberval had not yet appeared, and that they did not know what had happened to him. Then he had works commenced to clear the land, to build a fort, and to lay the first foundations of the town of Quebec. He next set out for Hochelaga, taking with him Martin de Paimpont and other gentlemen, and went to examine the three waterfalls of Sainte Marie, La Chine, and St. Louis; on his return to St. Croix, he found Roberval had just arrived. Cartier returned to St. Malo in the month of October, 1542, where, probably ten years later, he died. As to the new colony, Roberval having perished in a second voyage, it vegetated, and was nothing more than a factory until 1608, the date of the foundation of Quebec by M. de Champlain, of whom we shall relate the services and discoveries a little further on.
Francis I, after hearing about the voyage from the captain of St. Malo, decided to establish a formal presence in the area. He appointed François de la Roque, Sieur de Roberval, as viceroy of Canada and arranged for five ships to be equipped with supplies and ammunition for two years. These ships were to carry Roberval and several soldiers, artisans, and gentlemen to the new colony they were about to create. The five vessels set sail on May 23, 1541. They faced strong winds, which delayed their arrival in Newfoundland by three months. Cartier didn’t reach the harbor of St. Croix until August 23. Once he unloaded his supplies, he sent two of his ships back to France with letters for the king, informing him about their progress and that Sieur de Roberval had not yet arrived, with no news of his whereabouts. Cartier then began clearing land, building a fort, and laying the groundwork for the town of Quebec. He then headed to Hochelaga, bringing along Martin de Paimpont and other gentlemen to explore the three waterfalls of Sainte Marie, La Chine, and St. Louis. On returning to St. Croix, he found that Roberval had just arrived. Cartier went back to St. Malo in October 1542, where he likely died about ten years later. As for the new colony, Roberval perished on a second voyage, and it stagnated, becoming nothing more than a trading post until 1608, when M. de Champlain founded Quebec, whose contributions and discoveries we will discuss later.
We have just seen how Cartier, who had set out first to seek for the north-west passage, had been led to take possession of the country and to lay the foundations of the colony of Canada. In England a similar movement had begun, set on foot by the writings of Sir Humphrey Gilbert and of Richard Wills. They ended by carrying public opinion with them, and demonstrating that it was not more difficult to find this passage than it had been to discover the Strait of Magellan. One of the most ardent partizans of this search was a bold sailor, called Martin Frobisher, who after having many times applied to rich ship-owners, at last found in Ambrose Dudley, Earl of Warwick, the favourite of Queen Elizabeth, a patron, whose pecuniary help enabled him to equip a pinnace and two poor barks of from twenty to twenty-five tons' burden. It was with means thus feeble, that the intrepid navigator went to encounter the ice in localities which had never been visited since the time of the Northmen. Setting out from Deptford on the 8th of June, 1576, he sighted the south of Greenland, which he took for the Frisland of Zeno. Soon stopped by the ice, he was obliged to return to Labrador without being able to land there, and he entered Hudson's Straits. After having coasted along Savage and Resolution Islands, he entered a strait which has received his name, but which is also called by some geographers, Lunley's inlet. He landed at Cumberland, took possession of the country in the name of Queen Elizabeth, and entered into some relations with the natives. The cold increased rapidly, and he was obliged to return to England. Frobisher only brought back some rather vague scientific and geographical details about the countries which he had visited; he received, however, a most flattering welcome when he showed a heavy black stone in which a little gold was found. At once all imaginations were on fire. Several lords and the Queen herself contributed to the expense of a new armament, consisting of a vessel of 200 tons, with a crew of 100 men, and two smaller barks, which carried six months' provision both for war and for nourishment. Frobisher had some experienced sailors—Fenton, York, George Best, and C. Hall, under his command. On the 31st of May, 1577, the expedition set sail, and soon sighted Greenland, of which the mountains were covered with snow, and the shores defended by a rampart of ice. The weather was bad. Exceedingly dense fogs,—as thick as pease-soup, said the English sailors,—islands of ice a mile and a half in circumferance, floating mountains which were sunk seventy or eighty fathoms in the sea, such were the obstacles which prevented Frobisher from reaching before the 9th of August, the strait which he had discovered during his previous campaign. The English took possession of the country, and pursued both upon land and sea some poor Esquimaux, who, wounded "in this encounter, jumped in despair from the top of the rocks into the sea," says Forster in his Voyages in the North, "which would not have happened if they had shown themselves more submissive, or if we could have made them understand that we were not their enemies." A great quantity of stones similar to that which had been brought to England were soon discovered. They were of gold marcasite, and 200 tons of this substance was soon collected. In their delight, the English sailors set up a memorial column on a peak to which they gave the name of Warwick Mount, and performed solemn acts of thanksgiving. Frobisher afterwards went ninety miles further on in the same strait, as far as a small island, which received the name of Smith's Island. There the English found two women, of whom they took one with her child, but left the other on account of her extreme ugliness. Suspecting, so much did superstition and ignorance flourish at this time, that this woman had cloven feet, they made her take the coverings off her feet, to satisfy themselves that they really were made like their own. Frobisher, now perceiving that the cold was increasing, and wishing to place the treasures which he thought he had collected, in a place of safety, resolved to give up for the present any farther search for the north-west passage. He then set sail for England, where he arrived at the end of September, after weathering a storm which dispersed his fleet. The man, woman, and child who had been carried off were presented to the Queen. It is said with regard to them, that the man, seeing at Bristol Frobisher's trumpeter on horseback wished to imitate him, and mounted with his face turned towards the tail of the animal. These savages were the objects of much curiosity, and obtained permission from the Queen to shoot all kinds of birds, even swans, on the Thames, a thing which was forbidden to every one else under the most severe penalties. They did not long survive, and died before the child was fifteen months old.
We’ve just seen how Cartier, originally on a quest to find the northwest passage, ended up claiming the land and starting the colony of Canada. In England, a similar effort began, inspired by the writings of Sir Humphrey Gilbert and Richard Wills. They eventually swayed public opinion and showed that finding this passage wasn’t any harder than discovering the Strait of Magellan. One of the most enthusiastic supporters of this search was a daring sailor named Martin Frobisher. After reaching out to wealthy shipowners multiple times, he finally found a backer in Ambrose Dudley, the Earl of Warwick and a favorite of Queen Elizabeth, whose financial support allowed him to outfit a small ship and two modest vessels, each around twenty to twenty-five tons. With these limited resources, the fearless navigator braved icy waters in areas that had not been explored since the Northmen. Setting out from Deptford on June 8, 1576, he sighted the southern part of Greenland, mistaking it for the Frisland of Zeno. Stopped by ice, he had to turn back to Labrador without making landfall and entered Hudson's Straits. After cruising along Savage and Resolution Islands, he navigated into a strait that bears his name, though some geographers refer to it as Lunley's Inlet. He landed at Cumberland, claimed the land for Queen Elizabeth, and established some initial contact with the indigenous people. As the cold intensified rapidly, he had to head back to England. Frobisher returned with only vague scientific and geographical details about the places he had visited, but he received a warm welcome for bringing back a heavy black stone containing a bit of gold. Immediately, imaginations ran wild. Several lords and the Queen herself funded a new expedition, which included a 200-ton ship with a crew of 100 men and two smaller boats carrying six months’ worth of supplies for both war and sustenance. Frobisher commanded some experienced sailors—Fenton, York, George Best, and C. Hall. On May 31, 1577, the expedition set sail and soon spotted Greenland, where the mountains were snow-covered and the shores were protected by a wall of ice. The weather was harsh, with thick fogs—“as thick as pea soup,” as the English sailors put it—and ice islands that were a mile and a half around, floating mountains that sank seventy or eighty fathoms into the sea, all blocking Frobisher’s path. It wasn’t until August 9 that he reached the strait he had discovered earlier. The English claimed the land and pursued some unfortunate Eskimos both on land and at sea. “Wounded in this encounter, they jumped in despair from the top of the rocks into the sea,” noted Forster in his Voyages in the North. “This might not have happened if they had been more submissive or if we could have made them understand we weren’t their enemies.” A large quantity of stones similar to the one brought back to England was soon found. They were gold marcasite, and 200 tons of this material was quickly collected. Overjoyed, the English sailors erected a memorial column on a peak they named Warwick Mount and held formal thanksgiving ceremonies. Later, Frobisher ventured another ninety miles into the strait, reaching a small island that was named Smith’s Island. There, the English encountered two women—one had a child, and they took her but left the other due to her extreme unappealingness. Because of the superstition and ignorance prevalent at the time, they suspected the abandoned woman had cloven feet. They made her remove her footwear to confirm that they looked like their own. Realizing the cold was worsening and wanting to secure the treasures he believed he had discovered, Frobisher decided to halt his search for the northwest passage for the time being. He then sailed back to England, arriving at the end of September after braving a storm that scattered his fleet. The man, woman, and child taken from the island were presented to the Queen. It’s said that when the man saw Frobisher’s trumpeter on horseback in Bristol, he tried to imitate him but mounted facing the wrong way. These indigenous people were the center of much curiosity and received permission from the Queen to hunt all kinds of birds, even swans, on the Thames—something strictly forbidden to everyone else under severe penalties. However, they didn’t live long, passing away before the child turned fifteen months old.
People were not slow in discovering that the stones brought back by Frobisher really contained gold. The nation, but above all the higher classes, were immediately seized with a fever bordering on delirium. They had found a Peru, an Eldorado. Queen Elizabeth, in spite of her practical good sense, yielded to the current. She resolved to build a fort in the newly discovered country, to which she gave the name of Meta incognita, (unknown boundary) and to leave there, with 100 men as garrison, under the command of Captains Fenton, Best, and Philpot, three vessels which should take in a cargo of the auriferous stones. These 100 men were carefully chosen; there were bakers, carpenters, masons, gold-refiners, and others belonging to all the various handicrafts. The fleet was composed of fifteen vessels, which set sail from Harwich on the 31st of May, 1578. Twenty days later the western coasts of Frisland were discovered. Whales played round the vessels in innumerable troops. It is related even that one of the vessels propelled by a favourable wind, struck against a whale with such force that the violence of the shock stopped the ship at once, and that the whale after uttering a loud cry, made a spring out of the water and then was suddenly swallowed up. Two days later, the fleet met with a dead whale which they thought must be the one struck by the Salamander. When Frobisher came to the entrance of the strait which has received his name, he found it blocked up with floating ice. "The barque Dennis, 100 tons," says the old account of George Best, "received such a shock from an iceberg that she sank in sight of the whole fleet. Following upon this catastrophe, a sudden and horrible tempest arose from the south-east, the vessels were surrounded on all sides by the ice; they left much of it, between which they could pass, behind them, and found still more before them through which it was impossible for them to penetrate. Certain ships, either having found a place less blocked with ice, or one where it was possible to proceed, furled sails and drifted; of the others, several stopped and cast their anchors upon a great island of ice. The latter were so rapidly enclosed by an infinite number of islets of ice and fragments of icebergs, that the English were obliged to resign themselves and their ships to the mercy of the ice, and to protect the ships with cables, cushions, mats, boards, and all kinds of articles which were suspended to the sides, in order to defend them from the fearful shocks and blows of the ice." Frobisher himself was thrown out of his course. Finding the impossibility of rallying his squadron, he sailed along the west coast of Greenland, as far as the strait which was soon to be called Davis' Strait, and penetrated as far as the Countess of Warwick Bay. When he had repaired his vessels with the wood which was to have been used in the building of a dwelling, he loaded the ships with 500 tons of stones similar to those which he had already brought home. Judging the season to be then too far advanced, and considering also that the provisions had been either consumed, or lost in the Dennis, that the wood for building had been used for repairing the vessels, and having lost 40 men, he set out on his return to England on the 31st of August. Tempests and storms accompanied him to the shores of his own country. As to the results of his expedition they were almost none as to discoveries, and the stones, which he had put on board in the midst of so many dangers, were valueless.
People quickly realized that the stones brought back by Frobisher actually contained gold. The nation, especially the upper classes, was immediately consumed by a fever that was nearly delirious. They had discovered a new Peru, an Eldorado. Queen Elizabeth, despite her practical good sense, succumbed to the excitement. She decided to build a fort in the newly discovered land, which she named Meta incognita (unknown boundary), and to leave 100 men there as a garrison under the command of Captains Fenton, Best, and Philpot, along with three ships that would carry a cargo of gold-bearing stones. These 100 men were carefully selected; there were bakers, carpenters, masons, gold refiners, and others from various trades. The fleet consisted of fifteen ships that set sail from Harwich on May 31, 1578. Twenty days later, they discovered the western coasts of Frisland. Whales swam around the ships in huge numbers. It’s even said that one of the vessels, pushed by a favorable wind, collided with a whale so forcefully that it stopped the ship instantly, and the whale, after letting out a loud cry, leaped out of the water and then disappeared. Two days later, the fleet encountered a dead whale that they believed must have been the one hit by the Salamander. When Frobisher reached the entrance of the strait named after him, he found it blocked with floating ice. "The barque Dennis, 100 tons," says the old account by George Best, "was so violently struck by an iceberg that it sank in full view of the entire fleet. Following this disaster, a sudden and terrible storm arose from the southeast, surrounding the vessels on all sides with ice; they left much behind them that they could navigate through, only to find even more ahead that was impossible to pass. Some ships, either having found a less ice-choked area or a route they could navigate, furled their sails and drifted; others stopped and anchored on a large ice island. The latter were quickly surrounded by countless ice islets and chunks of icebergs, forcing the English to resign themselves and their ships to the mercy of the ice, using cables, cushions, mats, boards, and all sorts of items suspended over the sides to protect them from the terrifying shocks and blows of the ice." Frobisher himself was thrown off course. Realizing he couldn’t regroup his squadron, he sailed along the west coast of Greenland as far as the strait that would soon be called Davis' Strait and went as far as the Countess of Warwick Bay. After repairing his ships with the wood intended for building a dwelling, he loaded them with 500 tons of stones similar to those he had already brought back. Judging that the season was too advanced and considering that the provisions had either been consumed or lost on the Dennis, that the wood for building had been used for repairs, and having lost 40 men, he set out for England on August 31. Storms and tempests accompanied him to the shores of his homeland. As for the outcomes of his expedition, they were nearly nonexistent regarding discoveries, and the stones he had put on board amidst so many dangers turned out to be worthless.
This was the last Arctic voyage in which Frobisher took part. In 1585 we meet with him again as vice-admiral, under Drake; in 1588 he distinguished himself against the Invincible Armada; in 1590 he was with Sir Walter Raleigh's fleet on the coast of Spain; finally in a descent on the coast of France, he was so seriously wounded that he had only time to bring his squadron back to Portsmouth before he died. If Frobisher's voyages had only gain for their motive, we must put this down not to the navigator himself, but to the passions of the period, and it is not the less true that in difficult circumstances, and with means the insufficiency of which makes us smile, he gave proof of courage, talent, and perseverance. To Frobisher is due, in one word, the glory of having shown the route to his countrymen, and of having made the first discoveries in the localities where the English name was destined to render itself illustrious.
This was the last Arctic voyage that Frobisher participated in. In 1585, we see him again as vice-admiral under Drake; in 1588, he made a name for himself against the Invincible Armada; in 1590, he was with Sir Walter Raleigh's fleet off the coast of Spain; and finally, during an attack on the coast of France, he was seriously wounded, leaving him just enough time to bring his squadron back to Portsmouth before he died. If Frobisher’s voyages were driven solely by the desire for profit, we shouldn’t attribute this to the navigator himself but rather to the fervent passions of the time. Nonetheless, it’s true that in challenging situations, and with resources that might seem inadequate today, he demonstrated courage, skill, and determination. In short, Frobisher deserves credit for showing his countrymen the way and for making the first discoveries in places that would later bring fame to the English name.
If it became necessary to abandon the hope of finding in these circumpolar regions countries in which gold abounded as it did in Peru, this was no ground for not continuing to seek there for a passage to China; an opinion supported by very skilful sailors, and one which found many adherents among the merchants of London. By the aid of several high personages, two ships were equipped; the Sunshine, of fifty tons' burden and carrying a crew of twenty-three in number, and the Moonshine, of thirty-five tons. They quitted Portsmouth on the 7th of June, 1585, under the command of John Davis.
If it became necessary to give up the hope of finding in these circumpolar regions countries where gold was as plentiful as it was in Peru, that didn’t mean we should stop searching for a passage to China; this idea was backed by very skilled sailors and gained many supporters among the merchants of London. With the help of several important figures, two ships were prepared: the Sunshine, weighing fifty tons and carrying a crew of twenty-three, and the Moonshine, weighing thirty-five tons. They left Portsmouth on June 7, 1585, under the command of John Davis.
Davis discovered the entrance of the strait which received his name, and was obliged to cross immense fields of drifting ice, after having reassured his crew, who were frightened while in the midst of a dense fog, by the dash of the icebergs, and the splitting of the blocks of ice. On the 20th July, Davis discovered the Land of Desolation, but without being able to disembark upon it. Nine days later he entered Gilbert Bay, where he found a peaceable population, who gave him sealskins and furs in exchange for some trifling articles. These natives, some days afterwards, arrived in such numbers, that there were not less than thirty-seven canoes around Davis' vessels. In this place, the navigator perceived an enormous quantity of drift wood, amongst which he mentions an entire tree, which could not have been less than sixty feet in length. On the 6th of August, he cast anchor in a fine bay called Tottness; near a mountain of the colour of gold, which received the name of Raleigh, at the same time, he gave the names of Dyer and Walsingham to two capes of that land of Cumberland.
Davis found the entrance to the strait that was named after him and had to navigate through vast fields of drifting ice. He calmed his crew, who were scared by the crashing of icebergs and the cracking of ice blocks in the thick fog. On July 20th, Davis discovered the Land of Desolation but couldn't land there. Nine days later, he entered Gilbert Bay, where he encountered a friendly population who traded him sealskins and furs for some small items. A few days later, the natives came in such numbers that there were at least thirty-seven canoes around Davis's ships. In this area, the navigator noticed a huge amount of driftwood, including an entire tree that was at least sixty feet long. On August 6th, he anchored in a beautiful bay called Tottness, near a mountain that looked golden, which he named Raleigh. He also named two capes in that area of Cumberland Dyer and Walsingham.
During eleven days, Davis still sailed northwards on a very open sea, free from ice, and of which the water had the colour of the Ocean. Already he believed himself at the entrance of the sea, which communicated with the Pacific, when all at once the weather changed, and became so foggy, that he was forced to return to Yarmouth, where he landed on the 30th of September.
During eleven days, Davis continued to sail north on an open sea, free of ice, with water the color of the ocean. He thought he was nearing the entrance to the sea that connected with the Pacific when suddenly the weather shifted, turning so foggy that he had to head back to Yarmouth, where he landed on September 30th.
Davis had the skill to make the owners of his ships partake in the hope which he had conceived. Thus on the 7th of May (1586), he set out again with the two ships which had made the previous voyage. To them were added the Mermaid of 120 tons, and the pinnace North Star. When, on the 25th of June, he arrived at the southern point of Greenland, Davis despatched the Sunshine and the North Star towards the north, in order to search for a passage upon the eastern coast, whilst he pursued the same route as in the preceding year, and penetrated into the strait which bears his name as far as 69°. But there was a much greater quantity of ice this year, and on the 17th of July, the expedition fell in with an "icefield" of such extent that it took thirteen days to coast along it. The wind after passing over this icy plain was so cold, that the rigging and sails were frozen, and the sailors refused to go any further. It was needful, therefore, to descend again to the east-south-east. There Davis explored the land of Cumberland, without finding the strait he was seeking, and after a skirmish with the Esquimaux, in which three of his men were killed, and two wounded, he set out on the 19th of September, on his return to England.
Davis had a knack for getting the owners of his ships to share in the hopes he had. So, on May 7th, 1586, he set out again with the two ships from his last voyage. He added the Mermaid of 120 tons and the pinnace North Star. When he reached the southern tip of Greenland on June 25th, he sent the Sunshine and the North Star north to search for a passage along the eastern coast, while he followed the same course as the previous year, pushing into the strait that bears his name, all the way to 69°. However, there was much more ice this year, and on July 17th, the expedition encountered an "icefield" so vast that it took thirteen days to navigate along it. After crossing this icy expanse, the wind was so frigid that the rigging and sails froze, and the sailors refused to go any further. Therefore, it became necessary to head southeast again. There, Davis explored the land of Cumberland but couldn’t find the strait he was looking for. After a skirmish with the Esquimaux, where three of his men were killed and two others wounded, he set out on September 19th to return to England.
Although once more his researches had not been crowned with success, Davis still had good hope, as is witnessed by a letter, which he wrote to the Company, in which he said that he had reduced the existence of the passage to a species of certainty. Foreseeing, however, that he would have more trouble in obtaining the despatch of a new expedition, he added that the expenses of the enterprise would be fully covered by the profit arising from the fishery of walrus, seals, and whales, which were so numerous in those parts, that they appeared to have there established their head-quarters. On the 15th of May, 1587, he set sail with the Sunshine, the Elizabeth of Dartmouth, and the Helen of London. This time he went farther north than he had ever done before, and reached 72° 12', that is to say, nearly the latitude of Upernavik, and he descried Cape Henderson's Hope. Stopped by the ice, and forced to retrace his way, he sailed in Frobisher's Strait, and after having crossed a large gulf, he arrived, in 61° 10' latitude, in sight of a cape to which he gave the name of Chudleigh. This cape is a part of the Labrador coast, and forms the southern entrance to Hudson's Bay. After coasting along the American shores as far as 52°, Davis set out for England, which he reached on the 15th of September.
Although his research hadn't been successful again, Davis remained hopeful, as shown in a letter he wrote to the Company stating that he had nearly confirmed the existence of the passage. Anticipating more difficulty in getting a new expedition underway, he mentioned that the costs of the venture would be fully covered by the profits from the abundant walrus, seal, and whale fisheries in the area, which seemed to have set up camp there. On May 15, 1587, he set sail on the Sunshine, the Elizabeth of Dartmouth, and the Helen of London. This time, he ventured further north than ever before, reaching 72° 12', almost the latitude of Upernavik, and sighted Cape Henderson's Hope. Blocked by ice and forced to turn back, he sailed into Frobisher's Strait, and after crossing a large bay, he arrived at a cape at 61° 10' latitude, which he named Chudleigh. This cape is part of the Labrador coast and marks the southern entrance to Hudson's Bay. After following the American coastline down to 52°, Davis headed back to England, arriving on September 15.
Although the solution of the problem had not been found, yet nevertheless, precious results had been obtained, but results to which people at that period did not attach any great value. Nearly the half of Baffin's Bay had been explored, and clear ideas had been obtained of its shores, and of the people inhabiting them. These were considerable acquisitions, from a geographical point of view, but they were scarcely those which would greatly affect the merchants of the city. In consequence, the attempts at finding a north-west passage were abandoned by the English for a somewhat long period.
Although the problem still hadn't been solved, valuable results had been achieved, though people at the time didn't see their importance. Nearly half of Baffin's Bay had been explored, and clear ideas had been formed about its shores and the people living there. These were significant advancements in geography, but they didn't really impact the city's merchants. As a result, the search for a northwest passage was put on hold by the English for quite a while.
A new nation was just come into existence. The Dutch—while scarcely delivered from the Spanish yoke,—inaugurated that commercial policy, which was destined to make the greatness and prosperity of their country, by the successive despatch of several expeditions to seek for a way to China by the north-east; the same project formerly conceived by Sebastian Cabot, and which had given to England the Russian trade. With their practical instinct, the Dutch had acquainted themselves with English navigation. They had even established factories at Kola, and at Archangel, but they wished to proceed further in their search for new markets. The Sea of Kara appearing to them too difficult, they resolved, acting on the advice of the cosmographer Plancius, to try a new way by the north of Nova Zembla. The merchants of Amsterdam applied therefore, to an experienced sailor, William Barentz, born in the island of Terschelling, near the Texel. This navigator set out from the Texel in 1594, on board the Mercure, doubled the North Cape, saw the island of Waigatz, and found himself, on the 4th of July, in sight of the coast of Nova Zembla, in latitude 73° 25'. He sailed along the coast, doubled Cape Nassau on the 10th of July, and three days later he came in contact with the ice. Until the 3rd of August, he attempted to open a passage through the pack, testing the mass of ice on various sides, going up as far as the Orange Islands at the north-western extremity of Nova Zembla, sailing over 1700 miles of ground, and putting his ship about no less than eighty-one times. We do not imagine that any navigator had hitherto displayed such perseverance. Let us add that he turned this long cruise to account, to fix astronomically, and with remarkable accuracy, the latitude of various points. At last, wearied with the fruitless boxing about along the edge of the pack, the crew cried for mercy, and it became necessary to return to the Texel.
A new nation had just come into existence. The Dutch—barely freed from Spanish control—began a commercial strategy that would lead to their country's greatness and prosperity by sending out several expeditions to find a route to China via the northeast; this same idea had been proposed earlier by Sebastian Cabot, which had given England the Russian trade. With their practical instincts, the Dutch had learned about English navigation. They had even set up trading posts in Kola and Archangel, but they wanted to push further in their search for new markets. Finding the Sea of Kara too challenging, they decided, based on the advice of the cosmographer Plancius, to try a new route north of Nova Zembla. Therefore, the merchants of Amsterdam turned to an experienced sailor, William Barentz, who was born on the island of Terschelling near Texel. This navigator left Texel in 1594 aboard the Mercure, rounded the North Cape, viewed the island of Waigatz, and on July 4th, found himself near the coast of Nova Zembla at latitude 73° 25'. He sailed along the coast, rounded Cape Nassau on July 10th, and three days later encountered ice. Until August 3rd, he tried to find a passage through the ice pack, testing the ice from various angles, reaching as far as the Orange Islands at the northwestern tip of Nova Zembla, covering over 1700 miles, and turning his ship around no less than eighty-one times. We don’t believe any navigator had shown such determination before. Additionally, he used this long journey to accurately fix the latitude of various points. Finally, exhausted from the unproductive exploration along the ice's edge, the crew begged to return, and they had no choice but to head back to Texel.
The results obtained were judged so important, that the following year, the Dutch States-General entrusted to Jacob van Heemskerke, the command of a fleet of seven vessels, of which Barentz was named chief pilot. After touching at various points upon the coasts of Nova Zembla and of Asia, this squadron was forced by the pack to go back without having made any important discovery, and it returned to Holland on the 18th of September.
The results were considered so significant that the following year, the Dutch States-General appointed Jacob van Heemskerke to lead a fleet of seven ships, with Barentz named as the chief pilot. After stopping at several locations along the coasts of Nova Zembla and Asia, this squadron was forced to turn back due to the ice pack without making any notable discoveries, and it returned to Holland on September 18th.
As a general rule governments do not possess as much perseverance as do private individuals. The large fleet of the year 1595, had cost a great sum of money, and had produced no results; this was sufficient to discourage the States-General. The merchants of Amsterdam therefore, substituting private enterprise for the action of the government, which merely promised a reward to the man who should first discover the north-east passage—fitted out two vessels, of which the command was given to Heemskerke and to Jan Corneliszoon Rijp, while Barentz, who had only the title of pilot, was virtually the leader of the expedition. The historian of the voyage, Gerrit de Veer, was also on board as second mate.
As a general rule, governments aren’t as persistent as private individuals. The big fleet of 1595 had cost a lot of money and achieved nothing, which discouraged the States-General. So, the merchants of Amsterdam stepped in, taking on the role of private enterprise instead of relying on the government, which just promised a reward to whoever first discovered the northeast passage. They outfitted two ships, putting Heemskerke and Jan Corneliszoon Rijp in charge, while Barentz, who was only the pilot on paper, was essentially the leader of the expedition. The historian of the voyage, Gerrit de Veer, also joined as the second mate.
The Dutchmen sailed from Amsterdam on the 10th of May, 1596, passed by the Shetland and Faröe Islands, and on the 5th of June, saw the first masses of ice, "whereat we were much amazed, believing at first that they were white swans." They soon arrived to the south of Spitzbergen, at Bear Island, upon which they landed on the 11th of June. They collected there a great number of sea-gulls' eggs, and after much trouble killed at some distance inland a white bear, destined to give its name to the land which Barentz had just discovered. On the 19th of June, they disembarked upon some far-spreading land, which they took to be a part of Greenland, and to which on account of the sharp-pointed mountains, they gave the name of Spitzbergen; of this they explored a considerable portion of the western coast. Forced by the Polar pack to go southwards again to Bear Island, they separated there from Rijp, who was once more to endeavour to find a way by the north. On the 11th of July, Heemskerke and Barentz were in the parts of Cape Kanin, and five days later they had reached the western coast of Nova Zembla, which was called Willoughby's Land. They then altered their course, and again going northwards, they arrived on the 19th at the Island of Crosses, where the ice which was still attached to the shore, barred their passage. They remained in this place until the 4th of August, and two days later they doubled Cape Nassau. After several changes of course, which it would take too long to relate, they reached the Orange Islands at the northern extremity of Nova Zembla. They began to descend the eastern coast, but were soon obliged to enter a harbour, where they found themselves completely blocked in by the pack-ice, and in which "they were forced in great cold, poverty, misery, and grief, to stay all the winter." This was on the 26th of August. "On the 30th the masses of ice began to pile themselves one upon another against the ship, with snow falling. The ship was lifted up and surrounded in such a manner, that all that was about her and around her began to crack and split. It seemed as if the ship must break into a thousand pieces, a thing most terrible to see and to hear, and fit to make one's hair stand on end. The ship was afterwards in equal danger, when the ice formed beneath, raising her and bearing her up as though she had been lifted by some instrument." Soon the ship cracked to such a degree, that prudence dictated the debarkation of some of the provisions, sails, gunpowder, lead, the arquebuses as well as other arms, and the erection of a tent or hut, in which the men might be sheltered from the snow and from any attacks by bears. Some days later, some sailors who had advanced from four to six miles inland, found near a river of fresh water, a quantity of drift-wood; they discovered there also the traces of wild goats and of reindeer. On the 11th of September, seeing that the bay was filled with enormous blocks of ice piled one upon the other, and welded together, the Dutchmen perceived that they would be obliged to winter in this place, and resolved, "in order to be better defended against the cold, and armed against the wild beasts," to build a house there, which might be able to contain them all, while they would leave to itself the ship, which became each day less safe and comfortable. Fortunately, they found upon the shore whole trees, coming doubtless from Siberia, and driven here by the current, and in such quantity that they sufficed not only for the construction of their habitation, but also for firewood throughout the winter.
The Dutchmen set sail from Amsterdam on May 10, 1596, passed by the Shetland and Faroe Islands, and on June 5, they saw the first large masses of ice, "which amazed us greatly, as we initially thought they were white swans." They soon reached Bear Island, south of Spitzbergen, and landed there on June 11. They collected a large number of seagull eggs and, after a lot of effort, killed a white bear some distance inland, which would become the namesake of the land just discovered by Barentz. On June 19, they disembarked onto some vast land, which they believed was part of Greenland and named Spitzbergen due to its sharply pointed mountains; they explored a significant part of the western coast. Forced by the polar ice pack to head south again to Bear Island, they separated from Rijp, who was going to try once more to find a route north. On July 11, Heemskerke and Barentz were near Cape Kanin, and five days later, they reached the western coast of Nova Zembla, known as Willoughby's Land. They then changed course and headed north again, arriving on the 19th at the Island of Crosses, where the ice still attached to the shore blocked their way. They stayed in this spot until August 4, and two days later, they rounded Cape Nassau. After several changes in direction, which would take too long to recount, they reached the Orange Islands at the northern tip of Nova Zembla. They began to descend the eastern coast but were soon forced to enter a harbor where they found themselves completely trapped by the pack ice and had to endure "great cold, poverty, misery, and grief, staying there all winter." This was on August 26. "On the 30th, the ice began to pile up against the ship, with snow falling. The ship was lifted and surrounded in such a way that everything around her started to crack and split. It looked as if the ship would break into a thousand pieces, a sight and sound so terrifying that it would make anyone's hair stand on end. The ship faced equal danger when the ice formed beneath it, lifting and supporting it as if by some unseen force." Soon, the ship cracked to such an extent that they prudently decided to offload some provisions, sails, gunpowder, lead, arquebuses, and other weapons, and set up a tent or hut to shelter the men from the snow and potential bear attacks. A few days later, some sailors who’d ventured four to six miles inland discovered a river with fresh water, where they found driftwood, along with signs of wild goats and reindeer. On September 11, noticing that the bay was filled with enormous ice blocks piled on top of each other and fused together, the Dutchmen realized they had to winter in this location. They resolved to build a house there, to better protect themselves from the cold and defend against wild animals, allowing the ship to fend for itself as it became less safe and comfortable each day. Fortunately, they found whole trees on the shore, likely from Siberia and washed here by the current, in such quantity that they were enough for not just building their shelter but also for firewood throughout the winter.
![]() |
Barentz's Ship. From an old print. |
Never yet had any European wintered in these regions, in the midst of that slothful and immovable sea, which according to the very false expressions used by Tacitus, forms the girdle of the world, and in which is heard the uproar caused by the rising of the sun. The Dutchmen, therefore, were unable to picture to themselves the sufferings which threatened them. They bore them, however, with admirable patience, without a single murmur, and without the least want of discipline or attempt at mutiny. The conduct of these brave seamen, quite ignorant of what so apparently dark a future might have in reserve for them, but who with wonderful faith had "placed their affairs in the hands of God," may be always proposed as an example even to the sailors of the present day. It may well be said that they had really in their heart the æs triplex of which Horace speaks. It was owing to the skill, knowledge, and foresight of their leader Barentz, as much as to their own spirit of obedience, that the Dutch sailors ever came forth from Nova Zembla, which threatened to be their tomb, and again saw the shores of their own country.
Never before had any European spent a winter in these regions, surrounded by that sluggish and unyielding sea, which, according to the misleading words of Tacitus, wraps around the world, and where you can hear the chaos caused by the rising sun. The Dutchmen, therefore, struggled to imagine the suffering that awaited them. However, they endured it with remarkable patience, without a single complaint, and without any loss of discipline or attempts at rebellion. The actions of these brave sailors, completely unaware of the seemingly bleak future ahead but who had placed their trust in God with astonishing faith, should always be held up as an example even for modern sailors. It could be said that they truly embodied the æs triplex that Horace mentioned. Thanks to the skill, knowledge, and foresight of their leader Barentz, as much as their own spirit of obedience, the Dutch sailors managed to survive Nova Zembla, which threatened to be their grave, and returned to the shores of their homeland.
![]() |
Interior view of the house. From an old print. |
The bears, which were extremely numerous at that period of the year, made frequent visits to the crew. More than one was killed, but the Dutchmen contented themselves with skinning them for the sake of their fur, and did not eat them, probably because they believed the flesh to be unwholesome. It would have been, however, a considerable addition to their food, and would have saved them from using their salted meat, and thus they might longer have escaped the attacks of scurvy. But that we may not anticipate, let us continue to follow the journal of Gerrit de Veer.
The bears, which were very common at that time of year, often visited the crew. More than one was killed, but the Dutchmen only skinned them for their fur and didn’t eat them, probably because they thought the meat was unhealthy. However, it would have added a significant amount to their food supply and could have spared them from relying on their salted meat, helping them avoid scurvy for longer. But rather than jump ahead, let’s keep following Gerrit de Veer’s journal.
On the 23rd September, the carpenter died, and was interred the next day in the cleft of a mountain, it being impossible to put a spade into the ground, on account of the severity of the frost. The following days were devoted to the transport of driftwood and the building of the house. To cover it in, it was necessary to demolish the fore and aft cabins of the ship; the roof was put on, on the 2nd October, and a piece of frozen snow was set up like a May pole. On the 31st September, there was a strong wind from the north-west, and as far as the eye could reach, the sea was entirely open and without ice. "But we remained as though taken and arrested in the ice, and the ship was raised full two or three feet upon the ice, and we could imagine nothing else but that the water must be frozen quite to the bottom, although it was three fathoms and a half in depth."
On September 23rd, the carpenter passed away and was buried the next day in a mountain crevice since the ground was too frozen to dig a grave. The following days were spent gathering driftwood and building the house. To cover it, we had to tear down the front and back cabins of the ship; the roof was finished on October 2nd, and a block of frozen snow was set up like a Maypole. On September 31st, there was a strong wind from the northwest, and as far as we could see, the sea was completely open and ice-free. "But we felt as if we were trapped in ice, and the ship was lifted two or three feet above the ice, leading us to think that the water must be frozen solid to the bottom, even though it was three and a half fathoms deep."
On the 12th October, they began to sleep in the house, although it was not completed. On the 21st, the greater part of the provisions, furniture, and everything which might be wanted was withdrawn from the ship, for they felt certain that the sun was about to disappear. A chimney was fixed in the centre of the roof, inside a Dutch clock was hung up, bed-places were formed along the walls, and a wine-cask was converted into a bath, for the surgeon had wisely prescribed to the men frequent bathing as a preservative of health. The quantity of snow which fell during this winter, was really marvellous. The house disappeared entirely beneath this thick covering, which, however, sensibly raised the temperature within. Every time that they wished to go forth, the Dutchmen were obliged to hollow out a long corridor beneath the snow. Each night they first heard the bears, and then the foxes, which walked upon the top of the dwelling, and tried to tear off some planks from the roof, that they might get into the house. So the sailors were accustomed to climb into the chimney, whence, as from a watch-tower they could shoot the animals and drive them off. They had manufactured a great number of snares, into which fell numbers of blue foxes, the valuable fur of which served as a protection against cold, while their flesh enabled the sailors to economize their provisions. Always cheerful and good tempered, they bore equally well the ennui of the long polar night, and the severity of the cold, which was so extreme, that during two of three days, when they had not been able to keep so large a fire as usual, on account of the smoke being driven back again by the wind, it froze so hard in the house, that the walls and the floor were covered with ice to the depth of two fingers, even in the cots where these poor people were sleeping. It was necessary to thaw the sherry, when it was served out, as was done every two days, at the rate of half a pint.
On October 12th, they started sleeping in the house, even though it wasn't finished. By the 21st, most of the supplies, furniture, and everything else they might need were taken off the ship, as they were convinced that the sun was about to vanish. A chimney was installed in the center of the roof, a Dutch clock was hung up, beds were set up along the walls, and a wine barrel was turned into a bath, since the surgeon had wisely advised the men to bathe regularly to maintain their health. The amount of snow that fell that winter was truly remarkable. The house completely disappeared under this thick layer, which, however, notably raised the temperature inside. Every time they wanted to go outside, the Dutchmen had to dig out a long tunnel beneath the snow. Each night, they first heard the bears and then the foxes walking on top of the dwelling, trying to rip off some boards from the roof to get inside. So, the sailors got used to climbing into the chimney, where they could shoot the animals from their lookout and scare them away. They had made a lot of traps, which captured many blue foxes; their valuable pelts provided warmth against the cold, while their meat helped the sailors stretch their supplies. Always cheerful and good-natured, they coped well with the boredom of the long polar night and the harsh cold, which was so extreme that during two or three days when they couldn’t maintain a big fire because the wind kept pushing the smoke back, it froze so hard inside the house that ice covered the walls and floor up to two inches deep, even in the beds where these poor folks were sleeping. The sherry had to be thawed when it was served, as was done every two days, at the rate of half a pint.
"On the 7th of December, the rough weather continued, with a violent storm coming from the north-east, which produced horrible cold. We knew no means of guarding ourselves against it, and while we were consulting together, what we could do for the best, one of our men in this extreme necessity proposed to make use of the coal which we had brought from the ship into our house, and to make a fire of it, because it burns with great heat and lasts a long time. In the evening we lighted a large fire of this coal, which threw out a great heat, but we did not provide against what might happen, for as the heat revived us completely, we tried to retain it for a long time. To this end we thought it well to stop up all the doors and the chimney, to keep in the delightful warmth. And thus, each went to repose in his cot, and animated by the acquired warmth, we discoursed long together. But in the end, we were seized with a giddiness in the head, some however, more than others; this was first perceived to be the case with one of our men who was ill, and who for this reason, had less power of resistance. And we also ourselves were sensible of a great pain which attacked us, so that several of the bravest came out of their cots and began by unstopping the chimney, and afterwards opening the door. But the man who opened the door fainted, and fell senseless upon the snow, on perceiving which, I ran to him and found him lying on the ground in a fainting fit. I went in haste to seek for some vinegar, and with it I rubbed his face until he recovered from his swoon. Afterwards, when we were somewhat restored, the captain gave to each a little wine, in order to comfort our hearts...."
"On December 7th, the bad weather continued, with a fierce storm coming from the northeast that brought terrible cold. We had no way to protect ourselves from it, and while we were discussing what we could do to improve the situation, one of our men suggested using the coal we had brought from the ship to make a fire, since it burns hot and lasts a long time. In the evening, we lit a large fire with the coal, which generated a lot of heat, but we didn't prepare for what might happen. As the heat revived us, we tried to hold onto it for as long as possible. To do this, we thought it was a good idea to block all the doors and the chimney to keep in the lovely warmth. So, we each settled down in our cots and, encouraged by the warmth, we talked for a long time. Eventually, we started to feel dizzy, and some of us more than others; it was first noticed with one of our sick men who had less resistance because of his condition. We also felt a sharp pain, causing several of the braver ones to get out of their cots and first unblock the chimney, then open the door. But when the man opened the door, he fainted and collapsed into the snow. Seeing this, I rushed to him and found him lying on the ground, unconscious. I quickly went to look for some vinegar and rubbed it on his face until he came to. Once we were feeling a bit better, the captain gave everyone a little wine to lift our spirits...."
"On the 11th, the weather continued fine, but so extremely cold, that no one who had not felt it could imagine it; even our shoes, frozen to our feet, were as hard as horn, and inside they were covered with ice in such a manner that we could no longer use them. The garments which we wore were quite white with frost and ice."
"On the 11th, the weather remained nice, but it was so incredibly cold that no one who hadn't experienced it could understand. Our shoes, frozen to our feet, felt as hard as rock, and inside they were covered with ice to the point that we could no longer wear them. The clothes we had on were completely white with frost and ice."
On Christmas Day, the 25th December, the weather was as rough as on the preceding days. The foxes made havoc upon the house, which one of the sailors declared to be a bad omen, and upon being asked why he said so, answered, "Because we cannot put them in a pot, or on the spit, which would have been a good omen."
On Christmas Day, December 25th, the weather was just as harsh as it had been on the days before. The foxes were wreaking havoc around the house, and one of the sailors claimed this was a bad sign. When asked why he thought that, he replied, "Because we can’t put them in a pot or on a spit, which would have been a good sign."
If the year 1596, had closed with excessive cold, the commencement of 1597 was not more agreeable. Most violent storms of snow, and hard frost prevented the Dutchmen from leaving the house. They celebrated Twelfth Night with gaiety, as is related in the simple and touching narrative of Gerrit de Veer. "For this purpose, we besought the captain to allow us a little diversion in the midst of our sufferings, and to let us use a part of the wine which was destined to be served out to us every other day. Having two pounds of flour we made some pancakes with oil, and each one brought a white biscuit, which we soaked in the wine and eat. And it seemed to us that we were in our own country, and amongst our relations and friends; and we were as much diverted as if a banquet had been given in our honour, so much did we relish our entertainment. We also made a Twelfth-Night king, by means of paper, and our master gunner was king of Nova Zembla, which is a country enclosed between two seas, and of the great length of six hundred miles."
If the year 1596 ended with extreme cold, the start of 1597 wasn’t any better. Intense snowstorms and hard frost kept the Dutchmen stuck indoors. They celebrated Twelfth Night cheerfully, as recounted in the simple and moving story of Gerrit de Veer. "For this reason, we asked the captain to let us have a little fun in the midst of our hardships, and to allow us to use some of the wine that was meant to be given to us every other day. With two pounds of flour, we made some pancakes with oil, and everyone brought a white biscuit, which we soaked in the wine and ate. It felt to us like we were back in our own country, among our relatives and friends; and we enjoyed ourselves as if there had been a feast in our honor, that's how much we savored our little celebration. We also created a Twelfth Night king out of paper, and our master gunner became the king of Nova Zembla, a land bordered by two seas, stretching six hundred miles long."
After the 21st January, the foxes became less numerous, the bears reappeared, and daylight began to increase, which enabled the Dutchmen, who had been so long confined to the house, to go out a little. On the 24th, one of the sailors, who had been long ill, died, and was buried in the snow at some distance from the house. On the 28th, the weather being very fine, the men all went out, walking about, running for exercise, and playing at bowls, to take off the stiffness of their limbs, for they were extremely weak, and nearly all suffering from scurvy. They were so much enfeebled that they were obliged to go to work several times before they could carry to their house the wood which was needful. At length in the first days of March, after several tempests and driving snowstorms, they were able to verify the fact that there was no ice in the sea. Nevertheless, the weather was still rough and the cold glacial. It was not feasible as yet to put to sea again, the rather because the ship was still embedded in the ice. On the 15th of April, the sailors paid a visit to her and found her in fairly good condition.
After January 21st, the number of foxes decreased, the bears came back, and the days started getting longer, which allowed the Dutchmen, who had been stuck in the house for so long, to go outside a bit. On the 24th, one of the sailors, who had been ill for a long time, died and was buried in the snow a short distance from the house. On the 28th, with the weather being really nice, the men all went outside, walking around, running for exercise, and playing bowls to loosen up their stiff limbs, as they were extremely weak and almost all suffering from scurvy. They were so weak that they had to make multiple trips before they could bring enough wood back to the house. Finally, in the first days of March, after several storms and heavy snow, they confirmed that there was no ice in the sea. Still, the weather was rough and freezing cold. It wasn't possible to set sail again yet, especially since the ship was still trapped in the ice. On April 15th, the sailors visited her and found her in pretty good condition.
![]() |
Exterior view of the house. From an old print. |
At the beginning of May the men became somewhat impatient, and asked Barentz if he were not soon intending to make the necessary preparations for departure. But Barentz answered that he must wait until the end of the month, and then, if it should be impossible to set the ship free, he would take measures to prepare the long-boats and the launch, and to render them fit for a sea voyage. On the 20th of the month the preparations for departure commenced; with what joy and ardour it is easy to imagine. The launch was repaired, the sails were mended, and both boats were dragged to the sea, and provisions put on board. Then, seeing that the water was free, and that a strong wind was blowing, Heemskerke went to seek Barentz, who had been long ill, and declared to him "that it seemed good to him to set out from thence, and in God's name to commence the voyage and abandon Nova Zembla."
At the beginning of May, the men grew a bit impatient and asked Barentz if he planned to start getting ready for departure soon. Barentz replied that he needed to wait until the end of the month, and then, if it was impossible to free the ship, he would start preparing the longboats and the launch for a sea voyage. On the 20th of the month, preparations for departure began; it’s easy to imagine the joy and enthusiasm this brought. The launch was repaired, the sails were mended, and both boats were pulled to the sea, with supplies loaded on board. Seeing that the water was clear and a strong wind was blowing, Heemskerke went to find Barentz, who had been ill for a while, and told him, "I think it's time to leave this place and, with God's blessing, start the voyage and abandon Nova Zembla."
"William Barentz had before this written a paper setting forth how we had started from Holland to go towards the kingdom of China, and all that had happened, in order that, if by chance, some one should come after us, it might be known what had befallen us. This note he enclosed in the case of a musket which he hung up in the chimney."
"William Barentz had previously written a document explaining how we had left Holland to journey towards the kingdom of China, detailing everything that had happened. This was done so that if someone came after us, they would know what had occurred. He placed this note inside the case of a musket, which he hung up in the chimney."
On the 13th June, 1597, the Dutchmen abandoned the ship, which had not stirred from her icy prison, and commending themselves to the protection of God, the two open boats put to sea. They reached the Orange Islands, and again descended the western coast of Nova Zembla in the midst of ceaselessly recurring dangers.
On June 13, 1597, the Dutchmen left the ship, which had remained stuck in its icy trap, and, putting their faith in God's protection, the two open boats set out to sea. They arrived at the Orange Islands and continued navigating down the western coast of Nova Zembla, facing constant dangers along the way.
"On the 20th of June Nicholas Andrieu became very weak, and we saw clearly that he would soon expire. The lieutenant of the governor came on board our launch, and told us that Nicholas Andrieu was very much indisposed, and that it was very evident that his days would soon end. Upon which, William Barentz said, 'It appears to me that my life also will be very short.' We did not imagine that Barentz was so ill, for we were chatting together, and William Barentz was looking at the little chart which I had made of our voyage, and we had various discourses together. Finally, he laid down the chart, and said to me, 'Gerard, give me something to drink.' After he had drunk, such weakness supervened that his eyes turned in his head, and he died so suddenly that we had not time to call the captain, who was in the other boat. This death of William Barentz saddened us greatly, seeing that he was our principal leader, and our sole pilot, in whom we had placed our whole trust. But we could not oppose the will of God, and this thought quieted us a little." Thus died the illustrious Barentz, like his successors Franklin and Hall, in the midst of his discoveries. In the measured and sober words of the short funeral oration of Gerrit de Veer may be perceived the affection, sympathy, and confidence which this brave sailor had been able to inspire in his unfortunate companions. Barentz is one of the glories of Holland, so prolific in brave and skilful navigators. We shall mention presently what has been done to honour his memory.
"On June 20th, Nicholas Andrieu became very weak, and we could clearly see that he was nearing the end of his life. The lieutenant governor came aboard our launch and told us that Nicholas was quite ill, and it was obvious that he didn’t have much time left. At that point, William Barentz said, 'It seems to me that my life will also be very short.' We didn’t realize Barentz was so unwell, as we had been chatting together, and he was looking at the small chart I had made of our journey, and we were engaged in various conversations. Eventually, he put down the chart and said to me, 'Gerard, give me something to drink.' After he drank, he became so weak that his eyes rolled back, and he died so suddenly that we didn’t have time to call the captain, who was in the other boat. The death of William Barentz saddened us deeply since he was our main leader and our only pilot, in whom we had placed all our trust. But we couldn’t oppose God’s will, and this thought brought us some comfort." Thus died the illustrious Barentz, like his successors Franklin and Hall, in the midst of his discoveries. In the measured and sober words of Gerrit de Veer’s brief funeral speech, one can sense the affection, sympathy, and confidence that this brave sailor inspired in his unfortunate companions. Barentz is one of the glories of Holland, a nation rich in brave and skilled navigators. We will mention shortly what has been done to honor his memory.
![]() |
After having been forced several times to haul the boats out of the water when they were on the point of being crushed between the blocks of ice; after having seen on various occasions the sea open, and again close before them; after having suffered both from thirst and hunger, the Dutchmen reached Cape Nassau. One day, being obliged to draw up the long-boat, which was in danger of being stove in upon an iceberg, the sailors lost a part of their provisions and were all deluged with water, for the ice broke away under their feet. In the midst of so much misery they sometimes met with good windfalls. Thus, when they were upon the ice on the Island of Crosses they found there seventy eggs of the mountain-duck. "But they did not know what they should put them in to carry them. At length one man took off his breeches, tying them together by the ends, and having put the eggs into them, they carried them on a pike between two, while the third man carried the musket. The eggs were very welcome, and we eat them like lords." From the 19th July, the Dutchmen sailed over a sea, which, if not altogether free from ice, was at least clear of those great fields of ice which had given them so much trouble to avoid. On the 28th July, when entering the Gulf of St. Lawrence, they met with two Russian vessels, which at first they dared not approach. But when they saw the sailors come to them unarmed and with friendly demonstrations, they put aside all fear, the rather as they recognized in the Russians some people whom they had met with the year before in the neighbourhood of Waigatz. The Dutchmen received some assistance from them, and then continued their voyage, still keeping along the coast of Nova Zembla, and as close in shore as the ice would allow. Upon one occasion when they landed, they discovered the cochlearia (scurvy-grass), a plant of which the leaves and seeds form one of the most powerful of known anti-scorbutics. They eat them, therefore, by handfuls, and immediately experienced great relief. Their provisions were, however, nearly exhausted; they had only a little bread remaining and scarcely any meat. They decided therefore to take to the open sea, in order to shorten the distance which separated them from the coast of Russia, where they hoped to fall in with some fishermen's boats, from which they might obtain assistance. In this hope they were not deceived, although they had still many trials to undergo. The Russians were much touched by their misfortunes, and consented on several occasions to bestow provisions upon them, which prevented the Dutch sailors from dying of hunger. In consequence of a thick fog the two boats were separated from each other, and did not come together again until some distance beyond Cape Kanin on the further side of the White Sea, at Kildyn Island, where some fishermen informed the Dutchmen that at Kola there were three ships belonging to their nation, which were ready to put to sea on their return to their own country. They therefore despatched thither one of their men accompanied by a Laplander, who returned three days afterwards with a letter signed Jan Rijp. Great was the astonishment of the Dutch at the sight of this signature. It was only on comparing the letter just received with several others which Heemskerke had in his possession, that they were convinced that it really came from the captain who had accompanied them the preceding year. Some days later, on the 30th September, Rijp himself arrived with a boat laden with provisions, to seek them out and take them to the Kola River, in which his ship was at anchor.
After being forced multiple times to pull the boats out of the water when they were almost crushed between blocks of ice; after seeing the sea open and then close in front of them a bunch of times; after suffering from both thirst and hunger, the Dutchmen reached Cape Nassau. One day, while they had to pull the long-boat ashore because it was in danger of getting smashed against an iceberg, the sailors lost some of their supplies and got drenched in water, as the ice broke away beneath them. Amid all this suffering, they sometimes found lucky breaks. For instance, when they were on the ice at the Island of Crosses, they discovered seventy mountain-duck eggs. "But they didn't know what to use to carry them. Eventually, one man took off his pants, tied them together at the ends, and put the eggs inside. They carried them on a pike between two of them, while the third man carried the musket. The eggs were a welcome surprise, and we devoured them like kings." From July 19th, the Dutchmen sailed across a sea that, while not completely free of ice, was at least clear of those massive fields that had caused them so much trouble. On July 28th, as they entered the Gulf of St. Lawrence, they encountered two Russian vessels, which at first they were hesitant to approach. But when they saw the sailors come toward them unarmed and friendly, they let go of their fear, especially since they recognized some of the Russians from the previous year near Waigatz. The Dutchmen received some help from them and continued their journey, keeping as close to the shore of Nova Zembla as the ice allowed. Once, when they landed, they found cochlearia (scurvy-grass), a plant whose leaves and seeds are one of the most effective known remedies for scurvy. They ate it by the handful and immediately felt much better. However, their supplies were almost gone; they only had a little bread left and hardly any meat. So, they decided to head out to open sea to shorten the distance to the coast of Russia, hoping to meet up with some fishermen’s boats for assistance. Fortunately, their hope wasn’t in vain, even though they had to face many more challenges. The Russians were moved by their plight and agreed several times to share provisions with them, preventing the Dutch sailors from starving. Due to thick fog, the two boats got separated and didn’t reunite until they were quite a distance past Cape Kanin on the other side of the White Sea, at Kildyn Island, where some fishermen told the Dutchmen that there were three ships from their country ready to sail back home at Kola. They sent one of their men accompanied by a Laplander, who returned three days later with a letter signed Jan Rijp. The Dutchmen were amazed to see this signature. It was only after comparing the newly received letter with several others that Heemskerke had, that they were convinced it really was from the captain who had sailed with them the previous year. A few days later, on September 30th, Rijp himself arrived with a boat full of provisions to find them and take them to the Kola River, where his ship was anchored.
Rijp was greatly astonished at all that they related to him, and at the terrible voyage of nearly 1200 miles which they had made, and which had not taken less than 104 days—namely, from the 13th June to the 25th September. Some days of repose accompanied by wholesome and abundant food sufficed to clear off the last remains of scurvy, and to refresh the sailors after their fatigues. On the 17th September, Jan Rijp left the Kola River, and on the 1st November the Dutch crew arrived at Amsterdam. "We had on," says Gerrit de Veer, "the same garments which we wore in Nova Zembla, having on our heads caps of white fox-skin, and we repaired to the house of Peter Hasselaer, who had been one of the guardians of the town of Amsterdam charged with presiding over the fitting out of the two ships of Jan Rijp and of our own captain. Arrived at this house, in the midst of general astonishment, because that we had been long thought to be dead, and this report had been spread throughout the town, the news of our arrival reached the palace of the prince, where there were then at table the Chancellor, and the Ambassador of the high and mighty King of Denmark and Norway, of the Goths and the Vandals. We were then brought before them by M. l'Écoutets and two lords of the town, and we gave to the said lord Ambassador, and to their lordships the burgomasters, a narrative of our voyage. Afterwards each of us retired to his own house. Those who had not dwellings in the town, were lodged in an inn until such time as we had received our money, when each went his own way. These are the names of the men who returned from this voyage: Jacob Heemskerke, clerk and captain, Peter Peterson Vos, Gerrit de Veer, mate, Jan Vos, surgeon, Jacob Jansen Sterrenburg, Leonard Henry, Laurence William, Jan Hillebrants, Jacob Jansen Hoochwout, Peter Corneille, Jacob de Buisen, and Jacob Everts."
Rijp was really surprised by everything they told him, especially the awful journey of nearly 1200 miles that had taken them 104 days — from June 13th to September 25th. A few days of rest along with plenty of good food helped get rid of the last bits of scurvy and refreshed the sailors after their hardships. On September 17th, Jan Rijp left the Kola River, and on November 1st, the Dutch crew arrived in Amsterdam. "We wore," says Gerrit de Veer, "the same clothes we had on in Nova Zembla, with white fox-skin caps on our heads, and we went to Peter Hasselaer's house. He had been one of the town's guardians in Amsterdam responsible for overseeing the outfitting of Jan Rijp's two ships and our captain's ship. When we got to this house, people were amazed because they thought we were dead, and news of our arrival spread throughout the town, even reaching the prince's palace where the Chancellor and the Ambassador of the powerful King of Denmark and Norway, as well as the Goths and Vandals, were dining. We were then presented to them by M. l'Écoutets and two town lords, and we shared a recount of our journey with the Ambassador and the burgomasters. Afterward, each of us went home. Those who didn’t have homes in town stayed at an inn until we received our pay, then each went their own way. Here are the names of the men who returned from this voyage: Jacob Heemskerke, clerk and captain, Peter Peterson Vos, Gerrit de Veer, mate, Jan Vos, surgeon, Jacob Jansen Sterrenburg, Leonard Henry, Laurence William, Jan Hillebrants, Jacob Jansen Hoochwout, Peter Corneille, Jacob de Buisen, and Jacob Everts."
Of all these brave sailors we have nothing further to record except that De Veer published the following year the narrative of his voyage, and that Heemskerke after having made several cruises to India, received in 1607 the command of a fleet of twenty-six vessels, at the head of which, on the 25th of April, he had a severe battle with the Spaniards under the guns of Gibraltar, in which battle, although the Dutch were the conquerers, Heemskerke lost his life.
Of all these brave sailors, we have nothing more to report except that De Veer published the account of his voyage the following year, and that Heemskerke, after making several trips to India, took command of a fleet of twenty-six ships in 1607. On April 25th, he fought a fierce battle against the Spaniards near Gibraltar, and although the Dutch emerged victorious, Heemskerke lost his life.
The spot where the unfortunate Barentz and his companions had wintered was not revisited until 1871, nearly three hundred years after their time. The first to double the northern point of Nova Zembla, Barentz had remained alone in the achievement until this period. On the 7th September, 1871, the Norwegian Captain, Elling Carlsen, well known by his numerous voyages in the North Sea and the Frozen Ocean, arrived at the ice haven of Barentz, and on the 9th he discovered the house which had sheltered the Dutchmen. It was in such a wonderful state of preservation that it seemed to have been built but a day, and everything was found in the same position as at the departure of the shipwrecked crew. Bears, foxes, and other creatures inhabiting these inhospitable regions had alone visited the spot. Around the house were standing some large puncheons and there were heaps of seal, bear, and walrus bones. Inside, everything was in its place. It was the faithful reproduction of the curious engraving of Gerrit de Veer. The bed-places were arranged along the partition as they are shown in the drawing, as well as the clock, the muskets, and the halberd. Amongst the household utensils, the arms, and the various objects brought away by Captain Carlsen, we may mention two copper cooking-pans, some goblets, gun-barrels, augers and chisels, a pair of boots, nineteen cartridge-cases, of which some were still filled with powder, the clock, a flute, some locks and padlocks, twenty-six pewter candlesticks, some fragments of engravings, and three books in Dutch, one of which, the last edition of Mendoza's "History of China" shows the goal which Barentz sought in this expedition, and a "Manual of Navigation" proves the care taken by the pilot to keep himself well up in all professional matters.
The place where the unfortunate Barentz and his crew spent the winter wasn't revisited until 1871, nearly three hundred years later. Barentz was the first to sail around the northern tip of Nova Zembla, and he remained the only one to achieve this until then. On September 7, 1871, Norwegian Captain Elling Carlsen, known for his extensive journeys in the North Sea and the Arctic, arrived at Barentz's ice shelter, and on the 9th, he found the house that had sheltered the Dutchmen. It was so well preserved that it looked like it had just been built, and everything was exactly as it was when the shipwrecked crew left. Only bears, foxes, and other wildlife inhabiting this harsh area had visited the spot. Surrounding the house were some large barrels and piles of seal, bear, and walrus bones. Inside, everything was in place. It was a faithful reproduction of the interesting engraving by Gerrit de Veer. The sleeping areas were arranged along the wall as shown in the drawing, along with the clock, muskets, and the halberd. Among the household items, weapons, and various objects taken by Captain Carlsen, we can mention two copper cooking pots, some goblets, gun barrels, augers and chisels, a pair of boots, nineteen cartridge cases, some of which were still filled with powder, the clock, a flute, some locks and padlocks, twenty-six pewter candlesticks, some fragments of engravings, and three Dutch books, one of which, the latest edition of Mendoza's "History of China," illustrates the goal Barentz was pursuing on this expedition, while a "Manual of Navigation" shows the pilot's dedication to staying updated on all professional matters.
Upon his return to the port of Hammerfest, Captain Carlsen met with a Dutchman, Mr. Lister Kay, who purchased the Barentz relics, and forwarded them to the authorities of the Netherlands. These objects have been placed in the Naval Museum at the Hague, where a house, open in front, has been constructed precisely similar to the one represented in the drawing of Gerrit de Veer, and each object or instrument brought back has been placed in the very position which it occupied in the house in Nova Zembla. Surrounded by all the respect and affection which they merit, these precious witnesses of a maritime event so important as the first wintering in the Arctic regions, these touching reminiscences of Barentz, Heemskerke, and their rough companions, constitute one of the most interesting monuments in the Museum. Beside the clock is placed a copper dial, through the middle of which a meridian is drawn. This curious dial, invented by Plancius, which served without doubt to determine the variations of the compass, is now the only example extant of a nautical instrument which has never been in very general use. For this reason it is as precious as, from another point of view, are the flute used by Barentz, and the shoes of the poor sailor who died during the winter sojourn. It is impossible to behold this curious collection without experiencing poignant emotion.
Upon his return to the port of Hammerfest, Captain Carlsen met a Dutchman, Mr. Lister Kay, who bought the Barentz relics and sent them to the authorities in the Netherlands. These objects are now displayed in the Naval Museum in The Hague, where a front-open house has been constructed exactly like the one in Gerrit de Veer's drawing, and each item or tool brought back has been placed in the same position it occupied in the house in Nova Zembla. Surrounded by all the respect and admiration they deserve, these valuable witnesses of such an important maritime event as the first wintering in the Arctic, these touching reminders of Barentz, Heemskerke, and their rugged companions make up one of the most interesting monuments in the Museum. Next to the clock is a copper dial, marked with a meridian through the center. This interesting dial, invented by Plancius, which surely helped determine compass variations, is now the only existing example of a nautical instrument that was never widely used. For this reason, it is as valuable as, in another sense, the flute used by Barentz and the shoes of the poor sailor who died during the winter stay. It is impossible to look at this fascinating collection without feeling deep emotion.
CHAPTER IV.
Drake—Cavendish—De Noort—Walter Raleigh.
Drake, Cavendish, De Noort, Walter Raleigh.
A very poor cottage at Tavistock in Devonshire was the birthplace in 1540, of Francis Drake, who was destined to gain millions by his indomitable courage, which however, he lost with as much facility as he had obtained them. Edmund Drake his father, was one of those clergy who devote themselves to the education of the people. His poverty was only equalled by the respect which was felt for his character. Burdened with a family as he was, the father of Francis Drake found himself obliged from necessity to allow his son to embrace the maritime profession, for which he had an ardent longing, and to serve as cabin-boy on board a coasting vessel which traded with Holland. Industrious, active, self-reliant, and saving, the young Francis Drake had soon acquired all the theoretical knowledge needed for the direction of a vessel. When he had realized a small sum, which was increased by the sale of a vessel bequeathed to him by his first master, he made more extended voyages; he visited the Bay of Biscay and the Gulf of Guinea, and laid out all his capital in purchasing a cargo which he hoped to sell in the West Indies. But no sooner had he arrived at Rio de la Hacha, than both ship and cargo were confiscated, we know not under what frivolous pretext. All the remonstrances of Drake, who thus saw himself ruined, were useless. He vowed to avenge himself for such a piece of injustice, and he kept his word.
A very poor cottage in Tavistock, Devonshire, was the birthplace of Francis Drake in 1540. He was destined to earn millions through his incredible bravery, but he also lost them just as easily as he gained them. His father, Edmund Drake, was a clergyman dedicated to educating the people. His poverty was matched only by the respect others held for his character. Given the burden of a family, Francis Drake's father had no choice but to let his son pursue the maritime career he yearned for, and so he became a cabin boy on a coasting ship that traded with Holland. Young Francis, hardworking, active, independent, and frugal, quickly gained the theoretical knowledge needed to navigate a ship. After saving up a bit of money and selling a vessel he inherited from his first captain, he took on longer voyages, visiting the Bay of Biscay and the Gulf of Guinea. He invested all his savings in purchasing cargo he hoped to sell in the West Indies. However, as soon as he arrived in Rio de la Hacha, both the ship and cargo were seized, though the reason remains unclear. All of Drake's protests were in vain as he found himself ruined. He vowed to take revenge for this injustice, and he kept his promise.
In 1567, two years after this adventure, a small fleet of six vessels, of which the largest was of 700 tons' burden, left Plymouth with the sanction of the Queen, to make an expedition to the Coasts of Mexico. Drake was in command of a ship of fifty tons. At first starting they captured some negroes on the Cape de Verd Islands, a sort of rehearsal of what was destined to take place in Mexico. Then they besieged La Mina, where some more negroes were taken, which they sold at the Antilles. Hawkins, doubtless by the advice of Drake, captured the town of Rio de la Hacha; after which he reached St. Jean d'Ulloa, having encountered a fearful storm. But the harbour contained a numerous fleet, and was defended by formidable artillery. The English fleet was defeated, and Drake had much difficulty in regaining the English coast in January, 1568.
In 1567, two years after this adventure, a small fleet of six ships, the largest being 700 tons, set off from Plymouth with the Queen's approval to launch an expedition to the coasts of Mexico. Drake was in charge of a ship that weighed fifty tons. At the beginning, they captured some enslaved people on the Cape Verde Islands, which was a preview of what would happen in Mexico. Then they laid siege to La Mina, where they captured more enslaved people, who were sold in the Antilles. Hawkins, likely on Drake's advice, took over the town of Rio de la Hacha; after that, he made his way to St. Jean d'Ulloa, but faced a terrifying storm. However, the harbor had a large fleet and was protected by strong artillery. The English fleet was defeated, and Drake struggled to return to the English coast by January 1568.
Drake afterwards made two expeditions to the West Indies for the purpose of studying the country. When he considered himself to have acquired the necessary information, he fitted out two vessels at his own expense: the Swan, of twenty-five tons, commanded by his brother John, and the Pasha of Plymouth, of seventy tons. The two vessels had as crew seventy-three jack-tars, who could be thoroughly depended on. From July, 1572, to August, 1573, sometimes alone, sometimes in concert with a certain Captain Rawse, Drake made a lucrative cruise upon the coasts of the Gulf of Darien, attacked the towns of Vera Cruz and of Nombre de Dios, and obtained considerable spoil. Unfortunately these enterprises were not carried out without much cruelty and many acts of violence which would make men of the present day blush. But we will not dwell upon the scenes of piracy and barbarity which are only too frequently met with in the sixteenth century.
Drake later went on two trips to the West Indies to learn about the area. Once he felt he had enough information, he outfitted two ships at his own cost: the Swan, a twenty-five-ton vessel led by his brother John, and the Pasha of Plymouth, which weighed seventy tons. The two ships had a crew of seventy-three reliable sailors. From July 1572 to August 1573, sometimes alone and sometimes with a Captain Rawse, Drake undertook a profitable voyage along the coasts of the Gulf of Darien, attacked the towns of Vera Cruz and Nombre de Dios, and secured a good amount of treasure. Unfortunately, these missions involved a lot of cruelty and violence that would make people today uncomfortable. But we won't focus on the piracy and barbarity that were all too common in the sixteenth century.
After assisting in the suppression of the rebellion in Ireland, Drake, whose name was beginning to be well known, was presented to Queen Elizabeth. He laid before her his project of going to ravage the western coasts of South America, by passing through the Strait of Magellan, and he obtained, with the title of admiral, a fleet of six vessels, on board of which were 160 picked sailors.
After helping to put down the rebellion in Ireland, Drake, whose name was starting to gain recognition, was introduced to Queen Elizabeth. He presented his plan to invade the western coasts of South America by sailing through the Strait of Magellan, and he received the title of admiral along with a fleet of six ships, which carried 160 elite sailors.
Francis Drake started from Plymouth on the 15th November, 1577. He had some intercourse with the Moors of Mogador, of which he had no reason to boast, made some captures of small importance before arriving at the Cape de Verd Islands, where he took in fresh provisions, and then was fifty-six days in crossing the Atlantic and reaching the coast of Brazil, which he followed as far as the estuary of La Plata, where he laid in a supply of water. He afterwards arrived at Seal Bay in Patagonia, where he traded with the natives, and killed a great number of penguins and sea-wolves for the nourishment of his crew. "Some of the Patagonians who were seen on the 13th May a little below Seal Bay," says the original narrative, "wore on the head a kind of horn, and nearly all had many beautiful birds' feathers by way of hats. They also had the face painted and diversified by several kinds of colours, and they each held a bow in the hand, from which every-time they drew it, they discharged two arrows. They were very agile, and as far as we could see, well instructed in the art of making war, for they kept good order in marching and advancing, and for so few men as they were, they made themselves appear a large number." M. Charton, in his Voyageurs Anciens et Modernes, notices that Drake does not mention the extraordinary stature which Magellan had attributed to the Patagonians. For this there is more than one good reason. There exists in Patagonia more than one tribe, and the description here given by Drake of the savages whom he met, does not at all resemble that given by Pigafetta of the Patagonians of Port St. Julian. If there exist, as seems now to be proved, a race of men of great stature, their habitat appears fixed upon the shores of the Strait at the southern extremity of Patagonia, and not at fifteen days' sail from Port Desire, at which Drake arrived on the 2nd June. On the following day he reached the harbour of St. Julian, where he found a gibbet erected of yore by Magellan for the punishment of some rebellious members of his crew. Drake in his turn, chose this spot to rid himself of one of his captains, named Doughty, who had been long accused of treason and underhand dealing, and who on several occasions had separated himself from the fleet. Some sailors having confessed that he had solicited them to join with him in frustrating the voyage, Doughty was convicted of the crimes of rebellion, and of tampering with the sailors, and according to the laws of England, he was condemned by a court martial to be beheaded. This sentence was immediately executed, although Doughty until the last moment vehemently declared his innocence. Was his guilt thoroughly proved? If Drake were accused upon his return to England—in spite of the moderation which he always evinced towards his men,—of having taken advantage of the opportunity to get rid of a rival whom he dreaded, it is difficult to conceive that the forty judges who pronounced the sentence should have concerted together to further the secret designs of their admiral and condemn an innocent man.
Francis Drake set out from Plymouth on November 15, 1577. He had some interactions with the Moors of Mogador, which he had no reason to brag about, made a few minor captures before reaching the Cape Verde Islands, where he stocked up on fresh supplies, and then spent fifty-six days crossing the Atlantic to reach the coast of Brazil. He followed the coast as far as the estuary of La Plata, where he replenished his water supply. He later arrived at Seal Bay in Patagonia, where he traded with the locals and killed a large number of penguins and sea wolves to feed his crew. "Some of the Patagonians seen on May 13 just below Seal Bay," says the original narrative, "wore a type of horn on their heads, and nearly all had beautiful bird feathers as hats. They also painted their faces with various colors and each held a bow, from which they fired two arrows each time they drew it. They were very agile, and as far as we could see, well-trained in warfare, as they maintained good order while marching and advancing, and despite their small numbers, they made themselves appear much larger." M. Charton, in his Voyageurs Anciens et Modernes, notes that Drake does not mention the extraordinary height that Magellan had attributed to the Patagonians. There are several good reasons for this. Patagonia is home to more than one tribe, and the description given by Drake of the natives he encountered does not resemble the account by Pigafetta of the Patagonians at Port St. Julian. If there indeed exists a race of very tall people, they appear to be located on the shores of the Strait at the southern end of Patagonia, not a fifteen-day sail from Port Desire, where Drake arrived on June 2. The next day, he reached the harbor of St. Julian, where he found a gallows that Magellan had previously erected to punish some rebellious crew members. Drake, in turn, chose this location to execute one of his captains, named Doughty, who had long been accused of treason and subterfuge, and who had separated himself from the fleet on several occasions. Some sailors admitted that he had tried to persuade them to undermine the voyage. Doughty was found guilty of rebellion and of conspiring with the sailors, and according to English law, he was sentenced to death by beheading by a court martial. This sentence was carried out immediately, although Doughty fervently proclaimed his innocence until the very end. Was his guilt truly established? If Drake was accused upon his return to England—despite the restraint he generally showed toward his men—of taking the opportunity to eliminate a rival he feared, it's hard to imagine that the forty judges who delivered the sentence conspired to support their admiral's secret agenda and condemn an innocent man.
On the 20th of August, the fleet, now reduced to three vessels—two of the ships having been so much damaged that they were at once destroyed by the admiral—entered the strait, which had not been traversed since the time of Magellan. Although he met with fine harbours, Drake found that it was difficult to anchor in them, on account both of the depth of the water close to the shore, and of the violence of the wind, which, blowing as it did in sudden squalls, rendered navigation dangerous. During a storm which was encountered at the point where the strait opens into the Pacific, Drake beheld one of his ships founder, while his last companion was separated from him a few days afterwards, nor did he see her again until the end of the campaign. Driven by the currents to the south of the strait as far as 55° 40', Drake had now only his own vessel; but by the injury which he did to the Spaniards, he showed what ravages he would have committed if he had had still under his command the fleet with which he left England. During a descent upon the island of Mocha, the English had two men killed and several wounded, while Drake himself, hit by two arrows on the head, found himself utterly unable to punish the Indians for their perfidy. In the harbour of Valparaiso he captured a vessel richly laden with the wines of Chili, and with ingots of gold valued at 37,000 ducats; afterwards he pillaged the town, which had been precipitately abandoned by its inhabitants. At Coquimbo, the people were forewarned of his approach, so that he found there a strong force, which obliged him to re-embark. At Arica he plundered three small vessels, in one of which he found fifty-seven bars of silver valued at 2006l. In the harbour of Lima, where were moored twelve ships or barks, the booty was considerable. But what most rejoiced the heart of Drake was to learn that a galleon named the Cagafuego, very richly laden, was sailing towards Paraca. He immediately went in pursuit, capturing on the way a bark carrying 80 lbs. of gold, which would be worth 14,080 French crowns, and in the latitude of San Francisco he seized without any difficulty the Cagafuego, in which he found 80 lbs. weight of gold. This caused the Spanish pilot to say, laughing, "Captain, our ship ought no longer to be called Cagafuego (spit-fire), but rather Caga-Plata (spit money), it is yours which should be named Caga-Fuego." After making some other captures more or less valuable, upon the Peruvian coast, Drake, learning that a considerable fleet was being prepared to oppose him, thought it time to return to England. For this, there were three different routes open to him: he might again pass the Strait of Magellan, or he might cross the Southern Sea, and doubling the Cape of Good Hope might so return to the Atlantic Ocean, or he could sail up the coast of China and return by the Frozen Sea and the North Cape. It was this last alternative, as being the safest of the three, which was adopted by Drake. He therefore put out to sea, reached the 38° of north latitude, and landed on the shore of the Bay of San Francisco, which had been discovered three years previously by Bodega. It was now the month of June, the temperature was very low, and the ground covered with snow. The details given by Drake of his reception by the natives, are curious enough: "When we arrived, the savages manifested great admiration at the sight of us, and thinking that we were gods, they received us with great humanity and reverence."
On August 20th, the fleet, now reduced to three ships—two having been so badly damaged that the admiral immediately ordered their destruction—entered the strait, which hadn't been crossed since Magellan's time. While he found great harbors, Drake struggled to anchor in them due to the depth of the water near the shore and the fierce winds, which whipped up sudden squalls, making navigation risky. During a storm at the point where the strait opens into the Pacific, one of his ships sank, and a few days later, his last remaining ship was separated from him; he wouldn’t see it again until the end of the campaign. Driven by the currents south of the strait as far as 55° 40', Drake was left with only his own vessel. However, the damage he inflicted on the Spaniards demonstrated the destruction he could have caused if he had still commanded the fleet he left England with. During an attack on the island of Mocha, two Englishmen were killed and several others wounded, while Drake himself, struck by two arrows in the head, was unable to retaliate against the Indians for their treachery. In the harbor of Valparaiso, he captured a ship loaded with Chilean wines and gold ingots worth 37,000 ducats; afterwards, he looted the town that the inhabitants had hurriedly abandoned. In Coquimbo, the locals were warned of his approach, so he encountered a strong force that forced him to re-embark. At Arica, he plundered three small vessels, one of which contained fifty-seven bars of silver valued at 2006l. In the harbor of Lima, where twelve ships or barks were moored, he found significant loot. But what brought Drake the most joy was learning that a galleon named Cagafuego, heavily laden, was heading towards Paraca. He quickly pursued it, capturing a bark along the way carrying 80 lbs. of gold, worth 14,080 French crowns. In the latitude of San Francisco, he easily seized the Cagafuego, which also held 80 lbs. of gold. This prompted the Spanish pilot to joke, "Captain, our ship should no longer be called Cagafuego (spit-fire), but rather Caga-Plata (spit money); yours should be named Caga-Fuego." After capturing a few more more or less valuable items along the Peruvian coast, Drake, realizing a significant fleet was being prepared to confront him, decided it was time to return to England. He had three different routes to choose from: he could pass through the Strait of Magellan again, cross the Southern Sea and round the Cape of Good Hope to return to the Atlantic Ocean, or sail up the coast of China and come back via the Frozen Sea and the North Cape. Drake opted for the last alternative, as it was the safest option. He set out to sea, reached 38° north latitude, and landed on the shore of the Bay of San Francisco, which had been discovered three years earlier by Bodega. It was now June, the temperature was very low, and the ground was covered in snow. Drake’s account of his reception by the natives is quite interesting: "When we arrived, the savages showed great admiration at the sight of us, and thinking that we were gods, they welcomed us with great kindness and respect."
"As long as we remained, they continued to come and visit us, sometimes bringing us beautiful plumes made of feathers of divers colours, and sometimes petun (tobacco) which is a herb in general use among the Indians. But before presenting these things to us, they stopped at a little distance, in a spot where we had pitched our tents. Then they made a long discourse after the manner of a harangue, and when they had finished, they laid aside their bows and arrows in that place, and approached us to offer their presents."
"As long as we stayed, they kept coming to visit us, sometimes bringing us beautiful feather plumes in various colors, and sometimes petun (tobacco), which is a herb commonly used by the Indians. But before giving us these gifts, they paused a bit away from where we had set up our tents. Then they gave a lengthy speech like a formal address, and when they were done, they put down their bows and arrows in that spot and came over to present their offerings."
"The first time they came their women remained in the same place, and scratched and tore the skin and flesh of their cheeks, lamenting themselves in a wonderful manner, whereat we were much astonished. But we have since learnt that it was a kind of sacrifice which they offered to us."
"The first time they arrived, their women stayed in the same spot, scratching and tearing at the skin and flesh of their cheeks, lamenting in an incredible way, which left us quite astonished. But we've since learned that it was a form of sacrifice they offered to us."
The facts given by Drake with regard to the Indians of California are almost the only ones which he furnishes upon the manners and customs of the nations which he visited. We would draw the reader's attention here, to that custom of long harangues which the traveller especially remarks, just as Cartier had observed upon it forty years earlier, and which is so noticeable amongst the Canadian Indians at the present day. Drake did not advance farther north and gave up his project of returning by the Frozen Sea. When he again set sail, it was to descend towards the Line, to reach the Moluccas, and to return to England by the Cape of Good Hope. As this part of the voyage deals with countries already known, and as the observations made by Drake are neither numerous nor novel, our narrative here shall be brief.
The facts provided by Drake regarding the Native Americans of California are almost the only information he offers about the customs and traditions of the nations he visited. We’d like to highlight the custom of lengthy speeches that the traveler notes, just as Cartier had pointed out forty years earlier, which is still quite prominent among Canadian Indigenous peoples today. Drake did not venture further north and abandoned his plan to return via the Arctic Ocean. When he set sail again, it was to head south toward the Equator, to reach the Moluccas, and then return to England by way of the Cape of Good Hope. Since this part of the journey involves areas that are already known and Drake’s observations are neither plentiful nor groundbreaking, our account here will be brief.
On the 13th of October, 1579, Drake arrived in latitude 8° north, at a group of islands of which the inhabitants had their ears much lengthened by the weight of the ornaments suspended to them; their nails were allowed to grow, and appeared to serve as defensive weapons, while their teeth, "black as ship's pitch," contracted this colour from the use of the betel-nut. After resting for a time, Drake passed by the Philippines, and on the 14th of November arrived at Ternate. The king of this island came alongside, with four canoes bearing his principal officers dressed in their state costumes. After an interchange of civilities and presents, the English received some rice, sugar-canes, fowls, figo, cloves, and sago. On the morrow, some of the sailors who had landed, were present at a council. "When the king arrived, a rich umbrella or parasol all embroidered in gold was borne before him. He was dressed after the fashion of his country, but with extreme magnificence, for he was enveloped from the shoulders with a long cloak of cloth of gold reaching to the ground. He wore as an ornament upon the head, a kind of turban made of the same stuff, all worked in fine gold and enriched with jewels and tufts. On his neck there hung a fine gold chain many times doubled, and formed of broad links. On his fingers, he had six rings of very valuable stones, and his feet were encased in shoes of morocco leather."
On October 13, 1579, Drake reached latitude 8° north, arriving at a group of islands where the locals had very elongated earlobes due to the heavy ornaments they wore. Their nails were long and seemed to serve as defensive weapons, and their teeth were "black as ship's pitch," a result of chewing betel-nut. After resting for a while, Drake sailed past the Philippines and arrived at Ternate on November 14. The king of the island approached him with four canoes carrying his main officers, all dressed in their ceremonial attire. After exchanging pleasantries and gifts, the English were given rice, sugarcane, chickens, figs, cloves, and sago. The next day, some sailors who had gone ashore attended a council. "When the king arrived, a lavishly embroidered gold umbrella was carried before him. He was dressed in the traditional style of his country, but with incredible grandeur, draped in a long cloak made of gold cloth that reached the ground. He wore a turban-like headpiece made of the same material, intricately adorned with fine gold and decorated with jewels and tassels. Around his neck hung a fine gold chain made up of thick links, and on his fingers, he wore six rings set with very valuable stones, while his feet were clad in morocco leather shoes."
After remaining some time in the country to refresh his crew, Drake again put to sea, but his ship on the 9th of January, 1580, struck on a rock, and to float her off it was necessary to throw overboard eight pieces of ordnance and a large quantity of provisions. A month later, Drake arrived at Baratena Island where he repaired his ship. This island afforded much silver, gold, copper, sulphur, spices, lemons, cucumbers, cocoa-nuts, and other delicious fruits. "We loaded our vessels abundantly with these, being able to certify that since our departure from England we have not visited any place where we have found more comforts in the way of food and fresh provisions than in this island and that of Ternate."
After spending some time in the country to refresh his crew, Drake set sail again, but on January 9, 1580, his ship ran aground on a rock. To get it off the rock, they had to toss overboard eight cannons and a large amount of supplies. A month later, Drake arrived at Baratena Island, where he repaired his ship. This island had an abundance of silver, gold, copper, sulfur, spices, lemons, cucumbers, coconuts, and other delicious fruits. "We loaded our ships heavily with these, being able to confirm that since our departure from England, we have not visited any place where we have found more comfort in terms of food and fresh supplies than in this island and that of Ternate."
After quitting this richly endowed island, Drake landed at Greater Java, where he was very warmly welcomed by the five kings amongst whom the island was partitioned, and by the inhabitants. "These people are of a fine degree of corpulence, they are great connoisseurs in arms, with which they are well provided, such as swords, daggers, and bucklers, and all these arms are made with much art." Drake had been some little time at Java when he learnt that not far distant there was a powerful fleet at anchor, which he suspected must belong to Spain; to avoid it he put to sea in all haste. He doubled the Cape of Good Hope during the first days of June, and after stopping at Sierra Leone to take in water, he entered Plymouth harbour on the 3rd November, 1580, after an absence of three years all but a few days.
After leaving this wealthy island, Drake arrived at Greater Java, where he was warmly welcomed by the five kings who ruled the island and its people. "These folks are quite hefty, and they're experts when it comes to weapons; they have many like swords, daggers, and shields, all made with great craftsmanship." Drake had been in Java for a little while when he found out that not too far away, there was a powerful fleet anchored, which he suspected belonged to Spain; to avoid it, he quickly set sail. He rounded the Cape of Good Hope during the first days of June, and after stopping at Sierra Leone to replenish his water supply, he entered Plymouth harbor on November 3, 1580, returning after almost three years away.
The reception which awaited him in England was at first extremely cold. His having fallen by surprise both upon Spanish towns and ships, at a time when the two nations were at peace, rightly caused him to be regarded by a portion of society as a pirate, who tramples under foot the rights of nations. For five months the Queen herself, under the pressure of diplomatic proprieties, pretended to be ignorant of his return. But at the end of that time, either because circumstances had altered, or because she did not wish to show herself any longer severe towards the skilful sailor, she repaired to Deptford where Drake's ship was moored, went on board, and conferred the honour of knighthood upon the navigator.
The reception he got in England was initially very cold. His unexpected attacks on Spanish towns and ships, while the two nations were at peace, properly made some people view him as a pirate, disregarding the rights of nations. For five months, the Queen herself, due to diplomatic formalities, acted as if she didn’t know he had returned. But after that time, either because the situation had changed or because she didn’t want to appear harsh toward the skilled sailor any longer, she went to Deptford where Drake's ship was docked, boarded it, and knighted the navigator.
![]() |
Elizabeth knighting Drake. |
From this period Drake's part as a discoverer is ended, and his after-life as a warrior and as the implacable enemy of the Spaniards does not concern us. Loaded with honours, and invested with important commands, Drake died at sea on the 28th January, 1596, during an expedition against the Spaniards.
From this time on, Drake's role as an explorer came to an end, and his later life as a soldier and relentless foe of the Spaniards isn't relevant to us. Burdened with honors and given significant commands, Drake passed away at sea on January 28, 1596, while on an expedition against the Spaniards.
To him pertains the honour of having been the second to pass through the Strait of Magellan, and to have visited Tierra del Fuego as far as the parts about Cape Horn. He also ascended the coast of North America to a point higher than any his predecessors had attained, and he discovered several islands and archipelagos. Being a very clever navigator, he made the transit through the Strait of Magellan with great rapidity. If there are but very few discoveries due to him, this is probably either because he neglected to record them in his journal, or because he often mentions them in so inaccurate a manner that it is scarcely possible to recognize the places. It was he who inaugurated that privateering warfare by which the English, and later on the Dutch, were destined to inflict much injury upon the Spaniards. And the large profits accruing to him from it, encouraged his contemporaries, and gave birth in their minds to the love for long and hazardous voyages.
He has the honor of being the second person to navigate through the Strait of Magellan and to have explored Tierra del Fuego up to the area around Cape Horn. He also traveled up the North American coast farther than any of his predecessors and discovered several islands and archipelagos. As a skilled navigator, he crossed the Strait of Magellan quickly. Although there are only a few discoveries credited to him, this could be because he either didn't keep accurate records in his journal or because he often described them so vaguely that it's hard to identify the locations. He was the one who started the privateering war that the English, and later the Dutch, used to significantly harm the Spaniards. The considerable profits he made from this encouraged others of his time and sparked their interest in long and risky voyages.
Among all those who took example by Drake, the most illustrious was undoubtedly Thomas Cavendish or Candish. Cavendish joined the English marine service at a very early age; and passed a most stormy youth, during which he rapidly dissipated his modest fortune. That which play had robbed him of, he resolved to recover from the Spaniards. Having in 1585 obtained letters of mark, he made a cruise to the East Indies and returned with considerable booty. Encouraged by his easy success as a highwayman on the great maritime roads, he thought that if he could acquire some honour and glory while engaged in making his fortune, so much the better would it be for him. With this idea he bought three ships, the Desire, of twenty tons, the Content, of sixty tons, and the Hugh Gallant, of forty tons, upon which he embarked one hundred and twenty-three soldiers and sailors. Setting sail on the 22nd July, 1586, he passed by the Canaries, and landed at Sierra Leone, which town he attacked and plundered; then, sailing again, he crossed the Atlantic, sighted Cape Sebastian in Brazil, sailed along the coast of Patagonia, and arrived on the 27th November at Port Desire. He found there an immense quantity of dog-fish, very large, and so strong that four men could with difficulty kill them, and numbers of birds, which, having no wings, could not fly, and which fed upon fish. They are classed under the general names of auks and penguins. In this very secure harbour, the ships were drawn up on shore to be repaired. During his stay at this place Cavendish had some skirmishes with the Patagonians,—"men of gigantic size, and having feet eighteen inches long"—who wounded two of the sailors with arrows tipped with sharpened flints.
Among all those inspired by Drake, the most notable was definitely Thomas Cavendish, or Candish. Cavendish joined the English navy at a very young age and had a tumultuous youth, during which he quickly spent his modest wealth. What he had lost to gambling, he decided to regain from the Spaniards. After obtaining letters of marque in 1585, he set out on a voyage to the East Indies and returned with a significant haul. Motivated by his easy success as a pirate on the busy maritime routes, he figured that gaining some honor and glory while making his fortune would be even better for him. With this in mind, he purchased three ships: the Desire (twenty tons), the Content (sixty tons), and the Hugh Gallant (forty tons), on which he took one hundred and twenty-three soldiers and sailors. He set sail on July 22, 1586, passed by the Canaries, and landed at Sierra Leone, where he attacked and looted the town. After sailing again, he crossed the Atlantic, spotted Cape Sebastian in Brazil, traveled along the coast of Patagonia, and reached Port Desire on November 27. There, he encountered a massive number of dogfish, which were so large and powerful that four men could barely kill them, as well as many flightless birds that fed on fish, known generally as auks and penguins. In this very safe harbor, the ships were pulled ashore for repairs. During his time there, Cavendish had some skirmishes with the Patagonians—"men of gigantic size, with feet eighteen inches long"—who injured two of the sailors with arrows tipped with sharp flints.
On the 7th January, 1587, Cavendish entered the Strait of Magellan, and in the narrowest part of it received on board his ships one-and-twenty Spaniards and two women, the sole survivors of the colony founded three years previously, under the name of Philippeville, by Captain Sarmiento. This town, which had been built to bar the passage through the strait, had possessed no fewer than four forts as well as several churches. Cavendish could discern the fortress, then deserted and already falling into ruins. Its inhabitants, who had been completely prevented by the continual attacks of the savages from gathering in their harvests, had died of hunger, or had perished in endeavouring to reach the Spanish settlements in Chili. The Admiral, upon hearing this lamentable tale, changed the name of Philippeville into that of Port Famine, under which appellation the place is known at the present day. On the 21st the ships entered a beautiful bay, which received the name of Elizabeth, and in which was buried the carpenter of the Hugh Gallant. Not far from thence a fine river fell into the sea, on the banks of which dwelt the anthropophagi who had fought so fiercely with the Spaniards, and who endeavoured, but in vain, to entice the Englishmen into the interior of the country.
On January 7, 1587, Cavendish entered the Strait of Magellan and took on board his ships twenty-one Spaniards and two women, the only survivors of the colony founded three years earlier by Captain Sarmiento, known as Philippeville. This town was built to block the passage through the strait and had at least four forts along with several churches. Cavendish could see the fortress, which was now abandoned and already in ruins. The inhabitants had been completely unable to harvest their crops due to constant attacks from local tribes and had either died from starvation or perished trying to reach the Spanish settlements in Chile. After hearing this sad story, the Admiral changed the name of Philippeville to Port Famine, which is how the place is known today. On the 21st, the ships entered a beautiful bay, which was named Elizabeth, where the carpenter of the Hugh Gallant was buried. Not far from there, a nice river flowed into the sea, along its banks lived the cannibals who had fiercely fought with the Spaniards and who tried, unsuccessfully, to lure the Englishmen into the interior of the country.
On the 24th February, as the little squadron came forth from the strait, it encountered a violent storm, which dispersed it. The Hugh Gallant, left alone, and letting in water in all directions, was only kept afloat with the greatest trouble. Rejoined on the 15th by his consorts, Cavendish tried in vain to land on Mocha Island, where Drake had been so maltreated by the Araucanians. This country, rich in gold and silver, had hitherto successfully resisted all Spanish attempts to subjugate it, and its inhabitants, fully determined to maintain their liberty, repulsed by force of arms every attempt to land. It was necessary therefore to go to the island of St. Maria, where the Indians, who took the Englishmen for Spaniards, furnished them with abundance of maize, fowls, sweet potatoes, pigs, and other provisions.
On February 24th, as the small squadron emerged from the strait, it was hit by a severe storm that scattered them. The Hugh Gallant, left alone and taking on water from all sides, struggled to stay afloat. After reuniting with his companions on the 15th, Cavendish attempted unsuccessfully to land on Mocha Island, where Drake had been treated badly by the Araucanians. This region, rich in gold and silver, had successfully resisted all Spanish attempts to conquer it, and its people, determined to keep their freedom, forcefully turned back every effort to land. Therefore, it was necessary to head to the island of St. Maria, where the locals, thinking the Englishmen were Spaniards, provided them with plenty of corn, chickens, sweet potatoes, pigs, and other supplies.
On the 30th March, Cavendish dropped anchor in 32° 50' in the Bay of Quintero. A party of thirty musketeers advanced into the country and met with oxen, cows, wild horses, hares, and partridges in abundance. The little troop was attacked by the Spaniards, and Cavendish was obliged to return to his ships after losing twelve of his men. He afterwards ravaged, plundered, or burnt the towns of Paraca, Cincha, Pisca, and Païta, and devastated the island of Puna, where he obtained a booty in coined money of the value of 25,760l. After having scuttled the Hugh Gallant, which was totally unfit any longer to keep the water, Cavendish continued his profitable cruising, burnt, in the latitude of New Spain, a ship of 120 tons, plundered and burnt Aguatulio, and captured, after six hours of fighting, a vessel of 708 tons, laden with rich stuffs, and with 122,000 gold pesos. Then, "victorious and contented," Cavendish wished to secure the great spoils which he was conveying against any chance of danger. He touched at the Ladrones, the Philippines, and Greater Java, doubled the Cape of Good Hope, recruited himself at St. Helena, and on the 9th September, 1588, anchored at Plymouth, after two years of sailing, privateering, and fighting. At the end of two years after his return, of all the great fortune which he had brought back with him, there remained only a sum sufficient for the fitting out of a third, and as it proved, a last expedition.
On March 30th, Cavendish dropped anchor at 32° 50' in the Bay of Quintero. A group of thirty musketeers moved into the interior and encountered plenty of oxen, cows, wild horses, hares, and partridges. The small troop was attacked by the Spaniards, and Cavendish had to return to his ships after losing twelve of his men. He then raided, looted, or burned the towns of Paraca, Cincha, Pisca, and Païta, and devastated the island of Puna, where he seized a haul of 25,760l. in coins. After scuttling the Hugh Gallant, which was no longer seaworthy, Cavendish continued his lucrative raiding, burning a 120-ton ship off the coast of New Spain, plundering and destroying Aguatulio, and after six hours of battle, capturing a 708-ton vessel loaded with valuable goods and 122,000 gold pesos. Then, "victorious and satisfied," Cavendish wanted to protect his significant loot from any potential threats. He stopped at the Ladrones, the Philippines, and Greater Java, rounded the Cape of Good Hope, resupplied at St. Helena, and on September 9th, 1588, anchored in Plymouth, after two years of sailing, privateering, and fighting. Two years after his return, out of all the great fortune he had brought back, only enough remained to fund a third, and as it turned out, final expedition.
Cavendish started on the 6th August, 1591, with five vessels, but a storm on the coast of Patagonia scattered the flotilla, which could not be collected again until the arrival at Port Desire. Assailed by fearful hurricanes in the Strait of Magellan, Cavendish was obliged to go back, after having seen himself deserted by three of his ships. The want of fresh provisions, the cold, and the privations of all kinds which he underwent, and which had decimated his crew, forced him to return northwards along the coast of Brazil, where the Portuguese opposed every attempt at landing. He was therefore obliged to put to sea again without having been able to revictual. Cavendish died, from grief perhaps as much as from hardships, before he reached the English coast.
Cavendish set out on August 6, 1591, with five ships, but a storm off the coast of Patagonia scattered the fleet, which couldn't regroup until they reached Port Desire. Battling fierce hurricanes in the Strait of Magellan, Cavendish had to turn back after three of his ships deserted him. The lack of fresh supplies, the cold, and various hardships he faced, which severely reduced his crew, forced him to head north along the coast of Brazil, where the Portuguese resisted every attempt to land. As a result, he had to go back to sea without restocking. Cavendish died, possibly from grief as much as from the challenges he endured, before reaching the English coast.
One year after the return of the companions of Barentz, two ships, the Mauritius and the Hendrik Fredrik, with two yachts, the Eendracht and Espérance, having on board a crew of 248 men, quitted Amsterdam on the 2nd July, 1598. The commander-in-chief of this squadron was Oliver de Noort, a man at that time about thirty or thereabouts, and well known as having made several long cruising voyages. His second in command and vice-admiral was Jacob Claaz d'Ulpenda, and as pilot there was a certain Melis, a skilful sailor of English origin. This expedition, fitted out by the merchants of Amsterdam with the concurrence and aid of the States-General of Holland, had a double purpose; at once commercial and military. Formerly the Dutch had contented themselves with fetching from Portugal the merchandise which they distributed by means of their coasting vessels throughout Europe; but now they were reduced to the necessity of going to seek the commodities in the scene of their production. For this object, De Noort was to show his countrymen the route inaugurated by Magellan, and on the way to inflict as much injury as he could upon the Spaniards and Portuguese. At this period Philip II., whose yoke the Dutch had shaken off, and who had just added Portugal to his possessions, had forbidden his subjects to have any commercial intercourse with the rebels of the Low Countries. It was thus a necessity for Holland if she did not wish to be ruined, and as a consequence, to fall anew under Spanish rule, to open up for herself a road to the Spice Islands. The route which was the least frequented by the enemy's ships was that by the Strait of Magellan, and this was the one which De Noort was ordered to follow.
One year after the companions of Barentz returned, two ships, the Mauritius and the Hendrik Fredrik, along with two yachts, the Eendracht and Espérance, set sail from Amsterdam on July 2, 1598, carrying a crew of 248 men. The fleet was led by Oliver de Noort, a man around thirty years old, known for his long sea voyages. His second-in-command was Jacob Claaz d'Ulpenda, and the pilot was a skilled sailor named Melis, who was of English descent. This expedition was organized by the merchants of Amsterdam with the support of the States-General of Holland, and it had both commercial and military goals. Previously, the Dutch had imported goods from Portugal, distributing them throughout Europe with their coastal vessels, but now they had to go directly to the source of these goods. De Noort was to show his fellow countrymen the route first taken by Magellan while also trying to harm the Spaniards and Portuguese as much as possible along the way. At this time, Philip II, whose rule the Dutch had recently rejected, and who had just incorporated Portugal into his territories, had banned his subjects from trading with the rebels in the Low Countries. For Holland, it was crucial to avoid ruin and not fall back under Spanish control, so they needed to establish a route to the Spice Islands. The least traveled route by enemy ships was through the Strait of Magellan, which was the path that De Noort was instructed to take.
After touching at Goree, the Dutch anchored in the Gulf of Guinea, at the Island do Principe. Here the Portuguese pretended to give a friendly welcome to the men who went on shore, but they took advantage of a favourable opportunity, to fall upon and massacre them without mercy. Among the dead were Cornille de Noort, brother of the admiral, Melis, Daniel Goerrits, and John de Bremen—the captain, Peter Esias, being the only man who escaped. It was a sorrowful commencement for a campaign, a sad presage which was destined not to remain unfulfilled. De Noort, who was furious over this foul play, landed from his ships 120 men; but he found the Portuguese so well entrenched, that after a brisk skirmish in which seventeen more of his men were either killed or wounded, he was obliged to weigh anchor without having been able to avenge the wicked and cowardly perfidy to which his brother and twelve of his companions had fallen victims. On the 25th December, one of the pilots named Jan Volkers, was abandoned on the African coast as a punishment for his disloyal intrigues, for endeavouring to foment a spirit of despondency amongst the crews, and for his well-proved rebellion. On the 5th January, the island of Annobon, situated in the Gulf of Guinea, a little below the Line, was sighted, and the course of the ships was changed for crossing the Atlantic. De Noort had scarcely cast anchor in the Bay of Rio Janeiro before he sent some sailors on shore to obtain water and buy provisions from the natives; but the Portuguese opposed the landing, and killed eleven men. Afterwards, repulsed from the coast of Brazil by the Portuguese and the natives, driven back by contrary winds, having made vain efforts to reach the island of St. Helena, where they had hoped to obtain the provisions of which they were in the most pressing want, the Dutchmen, deprived of their pilot, toss at random upon the ocean. They land upon the desert islands of Martin Vaz, again reach the coast of Brazil at Rio Doce, which they mistake for Ascension Island, and are finally obliged to winter in the desert island of Santa Clara. The putting into port at this place was marked by several disagreeable events. The flag-ship struck upon a rock with so much violence that had the sea been a little rougher, she must have been lost. There were also some bloody and barbarous executions of mutinous sailors, notably that of a poor man, who having wounded a pilot with a knife thrust, was condemned to have his hand nailed to the mainmast. The invalids, of whom there were many on board the fleet, were brought on shore, and nearly all were cured by the end of a fortnight. From the 2nd to the 21st of June, De Noort remained in this island, which was not more than three miles from the mainland. But before putting to sea he was obliged to burn the Eendracht, as he had not sufficient men to work her. It was not until the 20th December, after having been tried by many storms, that he was able to cast anchor in Port Desire, where the crew killed in a few days a quantity of dog-fish and sea-lions, as well as more than five thousand penguins. "The general landed," says the French translation of De Noort's narrative, published by De Bry, "with a party of armed men, but they saw nobody, only some graves placed on high situations among the rocks, in which the people bury their dead, putting upon the grave a great quantity of stones, all painted red, having besides adorned the graves with darts, plumes of feathers, and other singular articles which they use as arms."
After stopping at Goree, the Dutch anchored in the Gulf of Guinea, at the island of do Principe. Here the Portuguese pretended to warmly welcome the men who went ashore, but they took the opportunity to attack and mercilessly massacre them. Among the dead were Cornille de Noort, brother of the admiral, Melis, Daniel Goerrits, and John de Bremen—only the captain, Peter Esias, managed to escape. It was a tragic start to a campaign, a grim omen that was destined to be fulfilled. De Noort, furious over this treachery, landed 120 men from his ships; however, he found the Portuguese well entrenched. After a fierce skirmish, where seventeen more of his men were either killed or injured, he had to leave without avenging the cowardly betrayal that had claimed his brother and twelve others. On December 25th, one of the pilots named Jan Volkers was left behind on the African coast as punishment for his disloyal schemes, for trying to spread despair among the crews, and for his proven rebellion. On January 5th, they spotted the island of Annobon, situated in the Gulf of Guinea just below the equator, and changed course to cross the Atlantic. De Noort had barely anchored in the Bay of Rio Janeiro before sending some sailors ashore to gather water and buy provisions from the locals; however, the Portuguese resisted the landing and killed eleven men. Later, after being pushed back from the coast of Brazil by the Portuguese and natives, and battling against unfavorable winds while trying unsuccessfully to reach St. Helena for desperately needed supplies, the Dutch found themselves adrift at sea without their pilot. They landed on the deserted Martin Vaz islands, then mistakenly returned to the coast of Brazil at Rio Doce, thinking it was Ascension Island, and were ultimately forced to spend the winter on the uninhabited Santa Clara island. Their arrival at this location was marked by several unpleasant incidents. The flagship crashed into a rock with such force that if the sea had been a little rougher, it would have been lost. There were also brutal and bloody executions of mutinous sailors, particularly that of a poor man who, after stabbing a pilot, was condemned to have his hand nailed to the mainmast. The sick, many in number on the fleet, were brought ashore and most were cured within two weeks. From June 2nd to 21st, De Noort stayed on this island, which was only about three miles from the mainland. But before setting sail, he had to burn the Eendracht, as he didn't have enough men to operate her. It wasn't until December 20th, after enduring many storms, that he was able to anchor in Port Desire, where the crew swiftly killed quantities of dogfish and sea lions, as well as more than five thousand penguins. "The general landed," states the French translation of De Noort's narrative published by De Bry, "with a group of armed men, but they found no one, only some graves placed on high locations among the rocks, where people bury their dead, piling a large number of stones on each grave, all painted red, and also decorating the graves with darts, feather plumes, and other unique items they use as weapons."
![]() |
A Sea-lion Hunt. From an old print. |
The Dutch saw also, but at too great a distance to shoot them, buffalos, stags, and ostriches, and from a single nest they obtained ten ostrich eggs. Captain Jacob Jansz Huy de Cooper, died during the stay at this place, and was interred at Port Desire. On the 23rd November, the fleet entered the Strait of Magellan. During a visit to the shore three Dutchmen were killed by some Patagonians, and their death was avenged by the massacre of a whole tribe of Enoos. The long navigation through the narrows and the lakes of the Strait of Magellan was signalized by the meeting with two Dutch ships, under the command of Sebald de Weerdt, who had wintered not far from the Bay of Mauritius, and by the abandoning of Vice-admiral Claaz, who, as it would appear, had been several times guilty of insubordination. Are not these acts, which we see so frequently committed by English, Dutch, and Spanish navigators, a true sign of the times? A deed which we should regard now-a-days as one of terrible barbarity seemed, doubtless, a relatively mild punishment in the eyes of men so accustomed to set but little value upon human life. Nevertheless, could anything be more cruel than to abandon a man in a desert country, without arms and without provisions, to put him on shore in a country peopled by ferocious cannibals, prepared to make a repast on his flesh; what was it but condemning him to a horrible death?
The Dutch also spotted buffalos, stags, and ostriches, but they were too far away to shoot them, and from a single nest, they collected ten ostrich eggs. Captain Jacob Jansz Huy de Cooper died during their stay at this location and was buried at Port Desire. On November 23rd, the fleet entered the Strait of Magellan. While visiting the shore, three Dutchmen were killed by some Patagonians, and their deaths were avenged by the massacre of an entire tribe of Enoos. The long journey through the narrow passages and lakes of the Strait of Magellan was marked by the encounter with two Dutch ships, commanded by Sebald de Weerdt, who had wintered not far from the Bay of Mauritius, and by the abandonment of Vice-admiral Claaz, who had apparently shown insubordination multiple times. Are these actions, so frequently carried out by English, Dutch, and Spanish navigators, not a true sign of the times? A deed that we now view as horrifying barbarity likely seemed like a relatively mild punishment to those who placed little value on human life. Still, could anything be more cruel than leaving a man in a desolate land, unarmed and without supplies, dropping him off in a territory inhabited by vicious cannibals ready to feast on him; wasn’t that just condemning him to a horrific death?
On the 29th of February, 1600, De Noort, after having been ninety-nine days in passing through the strait, came out on to the Pacific Ocean. A fortnight later, a storm separated him from the Hendrik Fredrik, which was never again heard of. As for De Noort, who had now with him only one yacht besides his own vessel, he cast anchor at the island of Mocha, and, unlike the experience of his predecessors, he was very well received by the natives. Afterwards he sailed along the coast of Chili, where he was able to obtain provisions in abundance in exchange for Nuremberg knives, hatchets, shirts, hats, and other articles of no great value. After ravaging, plundering, and burning several towns on the Peruvian coast, after sinking all the vessels that he met with, and amassing a considerable booty, De Noort, hearing that a squadron commanded by the brother of the viceroy, Don Luis de Velasco, had been sent in pursuit of him, judged it time to make for the Ladrone Islands, where he anchored on the 16th of September. "The inhabitants came around our ship with more than 200 canoes, there being three, four, or five men in each canoe, crying out all together: 'Hierro, hierro' (iron, iron), which is greatly in request amongst them. They are as much at home in the water as upon land, and are very clever divers, as we perceived when we threw five pieces of iron into the sea, which a single man went to search for." De Noort could testify unfortunately, that these islands well deserved their name. The islanders tried even to drag the nails out of the ship, and carried off everything upon which they could lay their hands. One of them, having succeeded in climbing along a part of the rigging, had the audacity to enter a cabin and seize upon a sword, with which he threw himself into the sea.
On February 29, 1600, De Noort, after spending ninety-nine days navigating the strait, finally emerged into the Pacific Ocean. Two weeks later, a storm separated him from the Hendrik Fredrik, which was never heard from again. As for De Noort, who was left with only one yacht besides his own ship, he anchored at Mocha Island, and unlike his predecessors, he was warmly welcomed by the locals. He then sailed along the coast of Chile, where he was able to get plenty of provisions in exchange for Nuremberg knives, hatchets, shirts, hats, and other items of little value. After plundering and burning several towns on the Peruvian coast, sinking all ships he encountered, and gathering a significant amount of loot, De Noort learned that a squadron led by Don Luis de Velasco, the viceroy's brother, was sent after him. Thinking it was time to head for the Ladrone Islands, he anchored there on September 16. "The locals surrounded our ship with more than 200 canoes, each manned by three, four, or five men, all shouting together: 'Hierro, hierro' (iron, iron), which they greatly desired. They are as comfortable in the water as they are on land and are very skilled divers, as we saw when we threw five pieces of iron into the sea, which one man dove down to retrieve." Unfortunately, De Noort had to confirm that these islands truly lived up to their name. The islanders even attempted to pull the nails out of the ship and took everything they could grab. One of them successfully climbed part of the rigging and audaciously entered a cabin to grab a sword, which he then jumped into the sea with.
On the 14th October following, De Noort traversed the Philippine Archipelago, where he made several descents, and burnt, plundered, or sunk a number of Spanish or Portuguese vessels, and some Chinese junks. While cruising in the Strait of Manilla he was attacked by two large Spanish vessels, and in the battle which followed the Dutch had five men killed, and twenty-five wounded and lost their brigantine, which was captured with her crew of twenty-five men. The Spaniards lost more than 200 men, for their flag-ship caught fire and sank. Far from picking up the wounded and the able-bodied men, who were trying to save themselves by swimming, the Dutch, "making way with sails set on the foremast, across the heads which were to be seen in the water, pierced some with lances, and also discharged their cannon over them." After this bloody and fruitless victory, De Noort went to recruit at Borneo, captured a rich cargo of spices at Java, and having doubled the Cape of Good Hope, landed at Rotterdam on the 26th of August, having only one ship and forty-eight men remaining. If the merchants who had defrayed the expenses of the expedition approved of the conduct of De Noort, who brought back a cargo which more than reimbursed them for their expenditure, and who had taught his countrymen the way to the Indies, it behoves us, while extolling his qualities as a sailor, to take great exception to the manner in which he exercised the command, and to mete out severe blame for the barbarity which has left a stain of blood upon the first Dutch voyage of circumnavigation.
On October 14th, De Noort traveled through the Philippine Archipelago, where he made several landings and burned, plundered, or sank a number of Spanish or Portuguese ships, as well as some Chinese junks. While cruising in the Strait of Manila, he was attacked by two large Spanish ships. In the battle that followed, the Dutch lost five men killed and twenty-five wounded, along with their brigantine, which was captured with its crew of twenty-five. The Spaniards suffered over 200 casualties, as their flagship caught fire and sank. Rather than rescuing the wounded and able-bodied men who were trying to swim to safety, the Dutch, "making way with sails set on the foremast, crossed over the heads visible in the water, stabbing some with lances and firing their cannons at them." After this bloody and pointless victory, De Noort went to recruit at Borneo, captured a valuable cargo of spices in Java, and after rounding the Cape of Good Hope, arrived in Rotterdam on August 26th with only one ship and forty-eight men left. While the merchants who funded the expedition may have approved of De Noort's actions, as he returned with a cargo that more than compensated for their expenses and showed his countrymen the route to the Indies, we must applaud his skills as a sailor while also strongly criticizing how he commanded the mission, as his brutality has left a dark mark on the first Dutch circumnavigation.
![]() |
Battle of Manilla. From an old print. |
We have now to speak of a man who, endowed with eminent qualities and with at least equal defects, carried on his life's work in divers, sometimes even in opposing directions, and who after having reached the highest summit of honour to which a gentleman could aspire, at last laid his head upon a scaffold, accused of treason and felony. This man is Sir Walter Raleigh. If he have any claim to a place in this portrait gallery of great sailors, it is neither as founder of any English colony nor as a sailor; it is as a discoverer, and what we have to say of him is not to his credit. Walter Raleigh passed five years in France fighting against the League, in the midst of all those Gascons who formed the basis of the armies of Henry of Navarre, and in such society he perfected the habits of boasting and falsehood which belonged to his character. In 1577, after a campaign in the Low Countries against the Spaniards, he returns to England and takes a deep interest in the questions so passionately debated among his three brothers by the mother's side, John, Humphrey, and Adrian Gilbert. At this period England was passing through a very grave economic crisis. The practice of agriculture was undergoing a transformation; in all directions grazing was being substituted for tillage, and the number of agricultural labourers was greatly reduced by the change. From thence arose general distress, and also such a surplussage of population as was fast becoming a matter of anxious concern. At the same time, to long wars succeeds a peace, destined to endure throughout the reign of Elizabeth, so that a great number of adventurers know not how to find indulgence for their love of violent emotions. At this moment, therefore, arises the necessity for such an emigration as may relieve the country of its population, may permit all the miserable people dying of hunger to provide for their own wants in a new country, and by that means may increase the influence and prosperity of the mother country. All the more thoughtful minds in England, who follow the course of public opinion—Hakluyt, Thomas Hariot, Carlyle, Peckham, and the brothers Gilbert—are struck with this need. But it is to the last named that belongs the credit of indicating the locality suitable for the establishing of colonies. Raleigh only joined with his brothers in the scheme, following their lead, but he neither conceived nor began the carrying into execution—as he has been too often credited with doing—of this fruitful project, the colonization of the American shores of the Atlantic. If Raleigh, all-powerful with Queen Elizabeth, fickle and nevertheless jealous in her affections as she was, encourage his brothers; if he expend himself 40,000l. sterling in his attempts at colonization, he still takes good care not to quit England, for the life of patience and self-devotion of the founder of a colony would have no attractions for him. He gives up and sells his patent as soon as he perceives the inutility of his efforts, while he does not forget to reserve for himself the fifth part of any profit arising eventually from the colony.
We now need to talk about a man who, despite having remarkable qualities and equally notable flaws, pursued his life's work in various, sometimes opposing directions. After reaching the highest peak of honor imaginable for a gentleman, he ultimately found himself on a scaffold, accused of treason and felony. This man is Sir Walter Raleigh. If he deserves a spot in this gallery of great sailors, it's not for founding any English colony or being a sailor; it's as a discoverer, and what we have to say about him isn't commendable. Walter Raleigh spent five years in France fighting against the League, surrounded by Gascons who were crucial to Henry of Navarre’s armies. In this environment, he honed the habits of boasting and falsehood that defined his character. In 1577, after a campaign against the Spaniards in the Low Countries, he returned to England and became deeply interested in the heated debates among his three maternal brothers, John, Humphrey, and Adrian Gilbert. At this time, England was experiencing a serious economic crisis. Agriculture was undergoing a transformation; grazing was replacing tillage all over, drastically reducing the number of agricultural laborers. This led to widespread distress and a surplus population that became a growing concern. Simultaneously, peace followed long wars, set to last throughout Elizabeth's reign, leaving many adventurers at a loss for how to satisfy their craving for excitement. Thus, the need for emigration arose to relieve the pressure of overpopulation, allowing hungry people to support themselves in a new land, which would also enhance the influence and prosperity of the home country. Many thoughtful individuals in England, observing public sentiment—like Hakluyt, Thomas Hariot, Carlyle, Peckham, and the Gilbert brothers—recognized this need. However, credit for identifying suitable locations for establishing colonies belongs to the Gilbert brothers. Raleigh joined the plan led by his brothers but did not conceive or initiate this fruitful project of colonizing the American shores of the Atlantic, despite being credited for it too often. Even though Raleigh held significant influence with Queen Elizabeth, who was fickle and jealous with her affections, he encouraged his brothers; he spent £40,000 on his colonization attempts but was careful not to leave England. A life of patience and dedication as a colony founder held no appeal for him. He gave up and sold his patent as soon as he realized the futility of his efforts, while ensuring he reserved a fifth of any potential profits from the colony for himself.
![]() |
Sir Walter Raleigh. From an old print. |
At the same time Raleigh fits out some vessels against the Spanish possessions; and himself soon takes part in the strife and the battles which saved England from the Invincible Armada, afterwards proceeding to support the claims of the Prior de Crato, to the throne of Portugal. It is a short time after his return to England that he falls into disgrace with his royal mistress, and after his release from prison, while he is confined to his princely mansion of Sherborne, he conceives the project of his voyage to Guiana. To his mind, this is a gigantic enterprise of which the marvellous results are destined to draw upon him the attention of the whole world, and to restore to him the favour of his sovereign. Would not the discovery and conquest of El Dorado, of the country in which according to Orellana, the temples are roofed with plates of gold, where all the tools, even those for the meanest purposes, are made of gold, where one walks upon precious stones, "procure for him greater glory," these are the very words which Raleigh employs in his account, "than Cortès had gained in Mexico, or Pizarro in Peru. He will have under him more golden towns and nations than the King of Spain, the Sultan of the Turks, and no matter what Emperor!" We have already spoken of the fables which Orellana had invented in 1539, and which had been the fruitful source of more than one legend. Humboldt discloses what had given them birth when he describes to us the nature of the soil and the rocks which surround Lake Parima, between the Essequibo and the Branco. "They are," says this great traveller, "rocks of micaceous slate, and of sparkling talc, which are resplendent in the midst of a sheet of water, which acts as a reflector beneath the burning tropical sun." So are explained those massive domes of gold, those obelisks of silver, and all those marvels of which the boastful and enthusiastic minds of the Spaniards afforded them a glimpse. Did Raleigh believe really in the existence of this city of gold, for the conquest of which he was about to sacrifice so many lives? Was he thoroughly convinced himself, or did he not yield to the illusions of a mind eager for glory? It is impossible to say, but this at least is indisputable, that, to borrow the just expressions of M. Philarète Chasles, "at the moment even of his embarkation men did not believe in his promises, they were suspicious of his exaggerations, and dreaded the results of an expedition directed by a man so fool-hardy, and of a morality so equivocal."
At the same time, Raleigh outfits some ships against the Spanish territories and soon becomes involved in the conflicts and battles that saved England from the Invincible Armada. He then goes on to support the claims of the Prior de Crato to the Portuguese throne. It’s shortly after he returns to England that he falls out of favor with his royal mistress. After his release from prison, while confined to his grand estate in Sherborne, he comes up with the idea for his voyage to Guiana. He sees this as a massive venture that will grab the world's attention and win back his sovereign's favor. Wouldn't discovering and conquering El Dorado—the land where, according to Orellana, temples are topped with gold plates, and all tools, even the simplest ones, are made of gold, where people walk on precious stones—"bring him greater glory," in his own words, "than Cortès gained in Mexico or Pizarro in Peru"? He would command more towns and nations made of gold than the King of Spain, the Sultan of the Turks, or any Emperor! We’ve already mentioned the myths that Orellana created in 1539, which became the basis for more than one legend. Humboldt reveals what inspired these tales by describing the soil and rocks around Lake Parima, between the Essequibo and the Branco. "They are," says this great traveler, "rocks of micaceous slate and sparkling talc that shine brightly under a sheet of water, acting like a reflector beneath the scorching tropical sun." This accounts for the massive domes of gold, the silver obelisks, and all those wonders that the boastful and excited Spaniards imagined. Did Raleigh really believe in the existence of this city of gold for which he was about to risk so many lives? Was he truly convinced, or did he fall for the illusions of a mind hungry for glory? It’s hard to say, but what is clear, to borrow the apt words of M. Philarète Chasles, is that "at the very moment of his departure, people didn’t believe his promises, were wary of his exaggerations, and feared the outcome of an expedition led by a man so reckless and of such questionable morality."
![]() |
Raleigh seizes Berreo. From an old print. |
Nevertheless, it seemed that Raleigh had foreseen everything needful for this undertaking, and that he had made the necessary studies. Not only did he speak of the nature of the soil of Guiana, of its productions, and its inhabitants with imperturbable assurance, but he had taken care to send, at his own expense, a ship commanded by Captain Whiddon, to prepare the way for the fleet which he intended to conduct in person to the banks of the Orinoco. What he took good care, however, not to confide to the public, was that all the information he received from his emissary was unfavourable to the enterprise. Raleigh himself started from Plymouth on the 9th February, 1595, with a small fleet of five vessels, and 100 soldiers, without reckoning marines, officers, and volunteers. After stopping four days at Fortaventura, one of the Canaries, to take in wood and water there, he reached Teneriffe, where Captain Brereton ought to have rejoined him. Having waited for him in vain for eighty days, Raleigh sailed for Trinidad, where he met Whiddon. The island of Trinidad was at that time governed by Don Antonio de Berreo, who, it is said, had obtained accurate information concerning Guiana. The arrival of the English did not please him, and he immediately despatched emissaries to Cumana and to Margarita, with orders to gather together the troops to attack the Englishmen, while at the same time he forbade any Indians or Spaniards to hold intercourse with them under pain of death. Raleigh, forewarned, determined to be beforehand with him. At nightfall he landed in secret with 100 men, captured the town of St. Joseph, to which the Indians set fire, without a blow, and carried off Berreo and the principal personages to the ships. At the same time arrived Captains Gifford and Knynin, from whom he had been separated upon the Spanish Coasts. Raleigh at once sailed for the Orinoco, entered Capuri Bay with a large galley and three boats carrying 100 sailors and soldiers, became entangled in the inextricable labyrinth of islands and canals which form the mouth of the river, and ascended the Orinoco for a distance of 330 miles. The account which Raleigh gives of his campaign is so fabulous, with the coolness of a Gascon transported to the banks of the Thames, he so heaps one falsehood upon the top of another, that one is almost tempted to class his narrative amongst the number of imaginary voyages. He says that some Spaniards who had seen the town of Manoa, called El Dorado, told him that this town exceeds in size and wealth all the towns in the world, and everything which the "conquistadores" had seen in America. "There is no winter there," he says; "a soil dry and fertile, with game, and birds of every species in great abundance, who filled the air with hitherto unknown notes; it was a real concert for us. My captain, sent to search for mines, perceived veins both of gold and silver; but as he had no tool but his sword, he was unable to detach these metals to examine them in detail; however, he carried away several bits of them which he reserved for future examination. A Spaniard of Caracas called this mine Madre del Oro (mother of gold)." Then, as Raleigh well knows that the public is on its guard against his exaggerations, he adds, "It will be thought perchance, that I am the sport of a false and cheating delusion, but why should I have undertaken a voyage thus laborious, if I had not entertained the conviction that there is not a country upon earth which is richer in gold than Guiana? Whiddon and Milechappe, our surgeon, brought back several stones which resembled sapphires. I showed these stones to several inhabitants of Orinoco, who have assured me that there exists an entire mountain of them." An old cacique of the age of 110, who nevertheless could still walk ten miles without fatigue, came to see Raleigh, boasted to him of the formidable power of the Emperor of Manoa, and proved to him that his forces were insufficient. He depicted these people as much civilized, as wearing clothes, and possessing great riches, especially in plates of gold; finally, he spoke to him of a mountain of pure gold. Raleigh relates that he wished to approach this mountain, but, sad mischance, it was at that moment half submerged. "It had the form of a tower, and appeared to me rather white than yellow. A torrent which precipitated itself from the mountain, swollen by the rains, made a tremendous noise, which could be heard at the distance of many miles, and which deafened our people. I recollected the description which Berreo had given of the brilliancy of the diamonds and of the other precious stones scattered over the various parts of the country. I had, however, some doubt as to the value of these stones; their extraordinary whiteness, nevertheless surprised me. After a short time of repose on the banks of the Vinicapara, and a visit to the village of the cacique, the latter promised to conduct me to the foot of the mountain by a circuitous route; but at the sight of the numerous difficulties which presented themselves, I preferred to return to the mouth of the Cumana, where the caciques of the neighbourhood came to bring various presents, consisting of the rare productions of the country." We will spare the reader the description of people three times taller than ordinary men, of cyclops, of natives who had their eyes upon the shoulders, their mouth in the chest, and the hair growing from the middle of the back—all affirmations seriously related, but which give to Raleigh's narrative a singular resemblance to a fairy tale. One fancies while reading it that it must be a page taken out of the Thousand and one Nights.
Nevertheless, it seemed that Raleigh had anticipated everything necessary for this venture and had conducted the required research. Not only did he confidently discuss the soil, resources, and inhabitants of Guiana, but he also took the initiative to send a ship commanded by Captain Whiddon at his own expense, to prepare for the fleet he intended to lead himself to the banks of the Orinoco. What he carefully chose not to share with the public was that all the information he received from his envoy was unfavorable to the mission. Raleigh himself departed from Plymouth on February 9, 1595, with a small fleet of five ships and 100 soldiers, not including marines, officers, and volunteers. After stopping for four days at Fortaventura, one of the Canary Islands, to gather wood and water, he reached Tenerife, where Captain Brereton was supposed to meet him. Having waited in vain for eighty days, Raleigh sailed for Trinidad, where he met Whiddon. At that time, Trinidad was ruled by Don Antonio de Berreo, who reportedly had reliable information about Guiana. The arrival of the English displeased him, and he quickly sent emissaries to Cumana and Margarita, commanding them to gather troops to attack the English while forbidding any Indians or Spaniards from interacting with them under penalty of death. Raleigh, forewarned, decided to take the initiative. At nightfall, he secretly landed with 100 men, seized the town of St. Joseph, which the Indians set on fire without a fight, and captured Berreo and the main figures, taking them to the ships. At the same time, Captains Gifford and Knynin, from whom he had been separated along the Spanish coast, arrived. Raleigh then sailed for the Orinoco, entered Capuri Bay with a large galley and three boats carrying 100 sailors and soldiers, became trapped in the complex network of islands and canals at the river's mouth, and traveled up the Orinoco for 330 miles. The narrative Raleigh gives about his campaign is so fantastic, with the swagger of someone boasting on the banks of the Thames, that it often feels more like a work of fiction than a real account. He claims that some Spaniards who had seen the town of Manoa, known as El Dorado, told him that this city surpasses all others in size and wealth, exceeding everything the "conquistadores" had encountered in America. "There is no winter there," he says; "a dry and fertile soil, with game and birds of every kind in abundance, filling the air with previously unknown melodies; it was a true concert for us. My captain, sent to search for mines, discovered veins of both gold and silver, but since he only had his sword as a tool, he couldn't extract these metals for further examination; however, he took several pieces of them for later analysis. A Spaniard from Caracas referred to this mine as Madre del Oro (mother of gold)." Then, knowing that the public might be skeptical of his exaggerations, he adds, "It may be thought that I am under the spell of a false and deceptive illusion, but why would I have undertaken such a laborious journey if I did not believe that no country on earth is richer in gold than Guiana? Whiddon and Milechappe, our surgeon, returned with several stones that looked like sapphires. I showed these stones to various people from Orinoco, who assured me there’s an entire mountain of them." An old cacique, who was 110 years old but could still walk ten miles without tiring, came to see Raleigh and boasted about the formidable power of the Emperor of Manoa, proving to him that his forces were inadequate. He described these people as quite civilized, wearing clothes and possessing great wealth, especially in gold plates; finally, he told him about a mountain made entirely of gold. Raleigh recounts that he wanted to approach this mountain, but unfortunately, it was currently half-submerged. "It had the shape of a tower and appeared rather white than yellow. A torrent rushing down the mountain, swollen by the rains, produced a deafening noise that could be heard from miles away, overwhelming our people. I remembered the description Berreo had given of the brilliance of diamonds and other precious stones scattered throughout the region. I had some doubts about the value of these stones; their extraordinary whiteness, however, surprised me. After resting for a while on the banks of the Vinicapara and visiting the cacique's village, he promised to guide me to the base of the mountain via a roundabout route; however, seeing the many challenges ahead, I preferred to return to the mouth of the Cumana, where the local caciques came to bring various gifts made from the rare products of the land." We will spare the reader the details about people three times taller than average, cyclops, natives with their eyes on their shoulders, mouths in their chests, and hair growing from the middle of their backs—all claims seriously made, yet they give Raleigh's narrative a striking resemblance to a fairy tale. One might think while reading it that it is a page taken from the Thousand and One Nights.
If we put on one side all these figments of an imagination run mad, what gain has been derived for geography? There was certainly no pains spared in announcing with much noise, and very great puffing, this fantastic expedition, and we may well say with the fable-writer,—
If we set aside all these wild flights of imagination, what benefit has geography actually gained? There was definitely no effort spared in making a big fuss and a lot of hype about this absurd expedition, and we could just as easily say, like the fable-writer,—
"In fancy free I an author see, Who says, 'The awful war I'll sing Of Titans with the Thunder-King:' Of this grand promise the result, we find, Is often wind." |
CHAPTER V.
I.
Distinguishing characteristics of the Seventeenth Century—The more thorough exploration of regions previously discovered—To the thirst for gold succeeds Apostolic zeal—Italian missionaries in Congo—Portuguese missionaries in Abyssinia—Brue in Senegal and Flacourt in Madagascar—The Apostles of India, of Indo-China, and of Japan.
Key features of the Seventeenth Century—An increased exploration of areas that had already been found—A passion for gold is replaced by a zeal for spreading faith—Italian missionaries in the Congo—Portuguese missionaries in Abyssinia—Brue in Senegal and Flacourt in Madagascar—Missionaries in India, Indo-China, and Japan.
The seventeenth century has a distinctive character of its own, differing from that of the preceding century in the fact that nearly all the great discoveries have been already made, and that the work of this whole period consists almost exclusively in perfecting the information already acquired. It contrasts equally with the century which is to succeed it, because scientific methods are not yet applied by astronomers and sailors, as they are to be 100 years later. It appears in fact, that the narratives of the first explorers—who were only able, so to speak, to obtain a glimpse of the regions which they traversed while waging their wars,—may have in some degree exercised a baneful influence upon the public mind. Curiosity, in the narrowest sense of the word, is carried to an extreme. Men travel over the world to gain an idea of the manners and customs of each nation, of the productions and manufactures of each country, but there is no real study. They do not seek to trace what they see to its source, and to reason scientifically upon the why and wherefore of facts. They behold, curiosity is satisfied, and they pass on. The observations made do not penetrate beneath the surface, and the great object appears to be to visit, as rapidly as may be, all the regions which the sixteenth century has brought to light.
The seventeenth century has its own unique character, different from the one before it, as almost all major discoveries have already been made, and this period largely focuses on refining the knowledge already gained. It also contrasts with the century that follows, since scientific methods aren't yet used by astronomers and sailors as they will be a hundred years later. In fact, the accounts of the early explorers—who could only get a fleeting glimpse of the areas they navigated while engaged in conflict—may have negatively influenced public perception to some extent. Curiosity, in the strictest sense, reaches an extreme. People travel the world to learn about the customs and practices of different nations, as well as the products and industries of each country, but there’s little genuine study involved. They don’t attempt to trace what they observe back to its origins or reason scientifically about the causes behind the facts. They see, their curiosity is satisfied, and then they move on. The observations don’t go beyond the surface, and the main goal seems to be to quickly visit all the regions revealed by the sixteenth century.
Besides, the abundance of the wealth diffused on a sudden over the whole of Europe has caused an economic crisis. Commerce, like industry, is transformed and altered. New ways are opened, new mediums arise, new wants are created, luxury increases, and the eagerness to make a fortune rapidly by speculation, turns the heads of many. If Venice from a commercial point of view be dead, the Dutch are about to constitute themselves, to use a happy expression of M. Leroy-Beaulieu, "the carriers and agents of Europe," and the English are preparing to lay the foundations of their vast colonial empire.
Besides, the sudden influx of wealth across Europe has led to an economic crisis. Commerce, like industry, is changing and evolving. New opportunities are emerging, new mediums are popping up, new desires are being created, luxury is increasing, and the rush to make quick money through speculation is dizzying many. If Venice is essentially finished as a commercial power, the Dutch are poised to become, as M. Leroy-Beaulieu famously put it, "the carriers and agents of Europe," while the English are getting ready to build the foundations of their expansive colonial empire.
To the merchants succeed the missionaries. They alight in large numbers upon the newly-discovered countries, preaching the Gospel, civilizing the barbarous nations, studying and describing the country. The development of Apostolic zeal is one of the dominant features of the seventeenth century, and it behoves us to recognize all that geography and historic science owe to these devoted, learned, and unassuming men. The traveller only passes through a country, the missionary dwells in it. The latter has evidently much greater facilities for acquiring an intimate knowledge of the history and civilization of the nations which he studies. It is therefore very natural that we should owe to them narratives of journeys, descriptions, and histories, which are still consulted with advantage, and which have served as a basis for later works.
To the merchants follow the missionaries. They arrive in large numbers in the newly discovered countries, spreading the Gospel, civilizing the uncivilized nations, studying and describing the land. The growth of Apostolic zeal is one of the key features of the seventeenth century, and we should acknowledge all that geography and historical science owe to these dedicated, knowledgeable, and humble individuals. The traveler merely passes through a country, while the missionary lives there. The missionary clearly has much better opportunities to gain a deep understanding of the history and culture of the nations they study. Therefore, it makes sense that we owe to them accounts of journeys, descriptions, and histories that are still valuable resources today and that have served as a foundation for later works.
If there be any country to which these reflections more particularly apply, it is to Africa, and especially to Abyssinia. How much of this vast triangular continent of Africa was known in the seventeenth century? Nothing but the coasts, it will be said. A mistake. From the earliest times the two branches of the Nile, the Astapus and the Bahr-el-Abiad, had been known to the ancients. They had even advanced—if the lists of countries and nations discovered at Karnak by M. Mariette may be believed—as far as the great Lakes of the interior. In the twelfth century, the Arab geographer Edrisi writes an excellent description of Africa for Roger II. of Sicily, and confirms these data. Later on, Cadamosto and Ibn Batuta travel over Africa, and the latter goes as far as Timbuctoo. Marco Polo affirms that Africa is only united to Asia by the Isthmus of Suez, and he visits Madagascar. Lastly, when the Portuguese, led by Vasco da Gama, have completed the circumnavigation of Africa, some of them remain in Abyssinia, and in a short time diplomatic relations are established between that country and Portugal. We have already said something of Francesco Alvarez; in his train several Portuguese missionaries settle in the country, amongst whom must be named Fathers Paez and Lobo.
If there’s a place where these thoughts especially apply, it’s Africa, and particularly Abyssinia. How much of this huge triangular continent was known in the seventeenth century? People might say just the coasts. That’s a mistake. From ancient times, the two branches of the Nile, the Astapus and the Bahr-el-Abiad, were known. They had even ventured—if we can trust the lists of countries and nations discovered at Karnak by M. Mariette—as far as the great Lakes in the interior. In the twelfth century, the Arab geographer Edrisi wrote an excellent description of Africa for Roger II. of Sicily, confirming this information. Later, Cadamosto and Ibn Batuta traveled through Africa, with Ibn Batuta reaching as far as Timbuktu. Marco Polo stated that Africa is only connected to Asia by the Isthmus of Suez, and he visited Madagascar. Finally, after the Portuguese, led by Vasco da Gama, circumnavigated Africa, some of them stayed in Abyssinia, leading to the establishment of diplomatic relations between that country and Portugal. We’ve already mentioned Francesco Alvarez; following him, several Portuguese missionaries, including Fathers Paez and Lobo, settled in the country.
Father Paez left Goa in 1588 to preach Christianity upon the eastern coast of North Africa. After long and sad mishaps, he landed at Massowah in Abyssinia, traversed the country, and in 1618 pushed on as far as the sources of the Blue Nile,—a discovery the authenticity of which Bruce was hereafter to dispute, but of which the narrative differs only in some unimportant particulars from that of the Scotch traveller. In 1604, Paez, arrived at the court of the king Za Denghel, had preached with such success that he had converted the king and all his court. He had even soon acquired so great an influence over the Abyssinian monarch, that the latter, in writing to the Pope and to the King of Spain to offer them his friendship, asked them to send him men fitted to teach his people.
Father Paez left Goa in 1588 to spread Christianity along the eastern coast of North Africa. After many difficult and unfortunate events, he arrived at Massowah in Abyssinia, traveled through the country, and in 1618 ventured as far as the sources of the Blue Nile—a discovery that Bruce would later dispute, but that differs only in minor details from the narrative of the Scottish traveler. In 1604, when Paez reached the court of King Za Denghel, he preached so effectively that he converted the king and his entire court. He quickly gained significant influence over the Abyssinian ruler, who, in his letters to the Pope and the King of Spain to offer friendship, asked them to send people qualified to educate his subjects.
Father Geronimo Lobo landed in Abyssinia with Alfonzo Meneses, patriarch of Ethiopia, in 1625. But times were greatly changed. The king converted by Paez had been murdered, and his successor, who had summoned the Portuguese missionaries, died after a short time. A violent revulsion of feeling ensued against the Christians, and the missionaries were driven away, imprisoned, or given up to the Turks. Lobo was charged with the mission of obtaining the sum necessary for the ransom of his companions. After many wanderings, which led him to Brazil, Carthagena, Cadiz, and Seville, to Lisbon and to Rome, where he gave the Pope and the King of Spain numerous and accurate details upon the Church of Ethiopia and the manners of the inhabitants, he made a last journey in India, and returned to Lisbon to die, in 1678.
Father Geronimo Lobo arrived in Abyssinia with Alfonzo Meneses, the patriarch of Ethiopia, in 1625. However, times had changed dramatically. The king who had been converted by Paez had been murdered, and his successor, who had summoned the Portuguese missionaries, died shortly after. A strong backlash against Christians followed, and the missionaries were either driven away, imprisoned, or handed over to the Turks. Lobo was tasked with raising the funds needed to ransom his companions. After many travels that took him to Brazil, Carthagena, Cadiz, Seville, Lisbon, and Rome, where he provided the Pope and the King of Spain with detailed information about the Church of Ethiopia and its people, he made one last trip to India and returned to Lisbon, where he died in 1678.
Christianity had been introduced into Congo, upon the Atlantic coast, in 1489, the year of its discovery by the Portuguese. At first Dominicans were sent; but as they made scarce any progress, the Pope, with the consent of the King of Portugal, despatched thither some Italian Capuchins. These were Carli de Placenza in 1667, Giovanni Antonio Cavazzi, from 1654 to 1668, afterwards Antonio Zucchelli and Gradisca, from 1696 to 1704. We shall mention these missionaries only, because they have published accounts of their journeys. Cavazzi explored in succession Angola, the country of Matumba, and the islands of Coanza and Loana. In the ardour of his apostolic zeal, he could devise no better means of converting the blacks than by burning their idols, rebuking the kings for the time-honoured custom of polygamy, and subjecting to torture, or to being torn with whips, those who relapsed into idolatry. Notwithstanding all this, he gained considerable ascendancy over the natives, which, if it had been well directed, might have produced very useful results in the development of civilization and the progress of religion. The same reproach is due also to Father Zucchelli and to the other Missionaries in Congo. The narrative of Cavazzi, published at Rome in 1687, asserted that Portuguese influence extended from 200 to 300 miles from the coast, and that in the interior there existed a very important town, known by the name of San Salvador, which possessed twelve churches, a Jesuit college, and a population of 50,000 souls.
Christianity was introduced in Congo, on the Atlantic coast, in 1489, the year it was discovered by the Portuguese. Initially, Dominicans were sent, but since they made little progress, the Pope, with the King of Portugal's approval, sent some Italian Capuchins. These included Carli de Placenza in 1667, Giovanni Antonio Cavazzi, who served from 1654 to 1668, and later Antonio Zucchelli and Gradisca, who were there from 1696 to 1704. We will mention only these missionaries because they published accounts of their journeys. Cavazzi explored Angola, the Matumba region, and the islands of Coanza and Loana. In his fervor for his mission, he thought the best way to convert the locals was by destroying their idols, scolding the kings about their long-standing practice of polygamy, and torturing or whipping those who returned to idol worship. Despite all this, he gained significant influence over the natives, which, if properly guided, could have led to meaningful advancements in civilization and the growth of religion. The same criticism applies to Father Zucchelli and the other missionaries in Congo. Cavazzi's account, published in Rome in 1687, claimed that Portuguese influence reached 200 to 300 miles inland and that there was a significant town called San Salvador, which had twelve churches, a Jesuit college, and a population of 50,000 people.
At the close of the fourteenth century Pigafetta published the account of the journey of Duarte Lopez, ambassador from the King of Congo to the Courts of Rome and Lisbon. A map which accompanies this narrative presents to us a Lake Zambré, in the very place occupied by Lake Tanganyika, and more to the west, Lake Acque Lunda, from whence issued the Congo River; south of the equator two lakes are indicated, one the Lake of the Nile, the other, more to the east, bears the name of Colué; they appear to be the Albert and the Victoria Nyanza. This most curious information was rejected by the geographers of the nineteenth century, who left blank the whole interior of Africa.
At the end of the fourteenth century, Pigafetta published an account of the journey of Duarte Lopez, the ambassador from the King of Congo to the courts of Rome and Lisbon. A map that goes along with this narrative shows a Lake Zambré, right where Lake Tanganyika is located today, and further west is Lake Acque Lunda, where the Congo River flows from. South of the equator, two lakes are marked: one is the Lake of the Nile, and the other, further east, is called Colué; these seem to correspond to the Albert and Victoria Nyanza lakes. This fascinating information was dismissed by the geographers of the nineteenth century, who left the entire interior of Africa blank.
Upon the West Coast of Africa at the mouth of the Senegal, the French had established settlements which, under the skilful administration of Andrew Brue, speedily received considerable extension. Brue, Commandant for the King and Director-general of the Royal French Company upon the Senegal Coast and in other parts of Africa—so ran his official title—although he may be little known, and the article which treats of him may be one of the most curtailed in the great collections of biography, deserves to occupy one of the most prominent positions among colonizers and explorers. Not content with extending the colony as far as its present limits, he explored countries which have been only lately revisited by Lieutenant Mage, or which have not been visited at all since Brue's time. He carried the French outposts eastwards above the junction of the Senegal and the Faleme, northwards as far as Arguin, which we have since abandoned, although reserving our rights, and southwards as far as the island of Bissao. He explored in the interior Galam and Bambouk, so rich in gold, and collected the earliest documents concerning the Pouls, Peuls or Fouls, the Yoloffs and the Mussulmen, who coming from the north, attempted the religious conquest of all the black nations of the country. The information thus collected by Brue about the history and migrations of these various people, is of the greatest value, affording clear light, even in the present day, to the geographer and the historian. Not only has Brue left us the narrative of deeds of which he was witness and the description of the places which he visited, but we also owe to him much information about the productions of the countries, the plants, the animals, and all the objects which would give occasion for commercial or industrial enterprise. These most curious documents, put together very maladroitly it must be confessed, by Father Labat, formed the subject, a few years ago, of a very interesting work by M. Berlioux.
At the mouth of the Senegal River on the West Coast of Africa, the French established settlements that quickly expanded under the skilled leadership of Andrew Brue. Brue, Commandant for the King and Director-general of the Royal French Company on the Senegal Coast and in other parts of Africa—as his official title stated—might not be well-known, and his entry in the major biography collections could be one of the briefest, but he deserves a prominent place among colonizers and explorers. Not satisfied with extending the colony to its current limits, he explored regions that have only recently been revisited by Lieutenant Mage or have not been visited at all since Brue's time. He pushed the French outposts eastward above the junction of the Senegal and the Faleme, north to Arguin, which we have since abandoned while retaining our rights, and south as far as the island of Bissao. He explored the interior regions of Galam and Bambouk, rich in gold, and gathered some of the earliest documents about the Pouls, Peuls or Fouls, the Yoloffs, and the Muslims, who came from the north attempting to convert all the black nations of the area. The information Brue collected about the history and migrations of these various groups is extremely valuable and provides insight, even today, to geographers and historians. Brue not only left us accounts of the events he witnessed and descriptions of the places he visited but also a wealth of information about the resources of the countries, including plants, animals, and other items that could inspire commercial or industrial ventures. These fascinating documents, although somewhat haphazardly compiled by Father Labat, were the subject of an interesting work by M. Berlioux a few years ago.
To the south-east of Africa, during the first half of the seventeenth century, the French founded some commercial settlements in Madagascar, an island long known under the name of St. Lawrence. They build Fort Dauphin under the administration of M. de Flacourt; several unknown districts of the island are explored as well as the neighbouring islands upon the coast; the Mascarene Islands are occupied in 1649. Although firm and moderate towards his countrymen, De Flacourt did not use the same self-control towards the natives; he even brought about a general revolt, as a consequence of which he was recalled. Expeditions into the interior of Madagascar were henceforth very rare, and it is not until the present day that we find a thorough exploration carried out.
To the southeast of Africa, during the early 1600s, the French established some commercial settlements in Madagascar, an island previously known as St. Lawrence. They built Fort Dauphin under the leadership of M. de Flacourt; several unexplored areas of the island and nearby islands along the coast were examined, and the Mascarene Islands were occupied in 1649. Although firm and reasonable with his own countrymen, De Flacourt lacked the same restraint with the locals; this led to a general uprising, resulting in his recall. After that, expeditions into the interior of Madagascar became quite rare, and it wasn't until now that we see a thorough exploration taking place.
Of Indo-China and Thibet the only information which reached Europe during the whole of the seventeenth century was due to the missionaries. Such names as Father Alexandre de Rhodes, Ant. d'Andrada, Avril, Benedict Goes, may not be passed over in silence. In their Annual Letters is to be found a quantity of information, which even in the present day retains a real interest, as concerning regions so long closed against Europeans. In Cochin China and Tonkin, Father Tachard devoted himself to astronomical observations, of which the result was to prove by the most conclusive evidence the great errors in the longitudes given by Ptolemy. This called the attention of the learned world to the necessity of a reform in the graphic representation of the countries of the extreme east, and for attaining this end, to the absolute need of close observations made by specially qualified scientific men, or by navigators familiar with astronomical calculations. The country which especially attracted the missionaries was China, that enormous and populous empire, which ever since the arrival of Europeans in India, had persevered with the greatest strictness in the absurd policy of abstention from any intercourse whatsoever with foreigners. It was not until the close of the sixteenth century that the missionaries obtained the permission, so often demanded before in vain, to penetrate into the Middle Empire. Their knowledge of mathematics and astronomy facilitated their settlement and enabled them to gather, as well from the ancient annals of the country, as during their journies, a prodigious quantity of most valuable information concerning the history, ethnography, and geography of the Celestial Empire. Fathers Mendoza, Ricci, Trigault, Visdelou, Lecomte, Verbiest, Navarrete, Schall, and Martini, deserve especial mention for having carried to China the arts and sciences of Europe, while they diffused in the west the first accurate and precise information upon the unprogressive civilization of the Flowery Land.
Of Indo-China and Tibet, the only information that reached Europe during the entire seventeenth century came from missionaries. Names like Father Alexandre de Rhodes, Ant. d'Andrada, Avril, and Benedict Goes shouldn't be overlooked. In their Annual Letters, there’s a wealth of information that remains relevant today, considering regions that were long closed off to Europeans. In Cochin China and Tonkin, Father Tachard focused on astronomical observations, providing clear evidence of significant inaccuracies in the longitudes proposed by Ptolemy. This drew the attention of scholars to the need for reform in how the extreme eastern countries were represented on maps, highlighting the crucial need for detailed observations by qualified scientists or navigators skilled in astronomical calculations. The country that particularly fascinated the missionaries was China, the vast and populated empire that had maintained a strict policy of refusing any interaction with foreigners since Europeans arrived in India. It wasn’t until the end of the sixteenth century that the missionaries finally received the long-sought permission to enter the Middle Empire. Their expertise in mathematics and astronomy helped them settle and allowed them to gather an enormous amount of valuable information about the history, ethnography, and geography of the Celestial Empire, both from the country's ancient records and during their travels. Fathers Mendoza, Ricci, Trigault, Visdelou, Lecomte, Verbiest, Navarrete, Schall, and Martini are particularly noteworthy for bringing European arts and sciences to China while also sharing the first accurate and precise information about the stagnant civilization of the Flowery Land back in the West.
MISSIONARIES AND SETTLERS. MERCHANTS AND TOURISTS.
The Dutch in the Spice Islands—Lemaire and Schouten—Tasman—Mendana—Queiros and Torrès—Pyrard de Laval—Pietro della Valle—Tavernier—Thévenot—Bernier—Robert Knox—Chardin—De Bruyn—Kæmpfer.
The Dutch in the Spice Islands—Lemaire and Schouten—Tasman—Mendana—Queiros and Torrès—Pyrard de Laval—Pietro della Valle—Tavernier—Thévenot—Bernier—Robert Knox—Chardin—De Bruyn—Kæmpfer.
The Dutch were not slow in perceiving the weakness and decadence of the Portuguese power in Asia. They felt with how much ease a clever and prudent nation might in a short time become possessed of the whole commerce of the extreme East. After a considerable number of private expeditions and voyages of reconnaissance they had founded in 1602 that celebrated Company of the Indies which was destined to raise to so high a pitch the wealth and prosperity of the metropolis. Equally in its strife with the Portuguese as in its dealing with the natives, the Company pursued a very skilful policy of moderation. Far from founding colonies, or repairing and occupying the fortresses which they took from the Portuguese, the Dutch bore themselves as simple traders, exclusively occupied with their commerce. They avoided building any fortified factory, except at the intersection of the great commercial roads. Thus they were able in a short time to seize all the carrying trade between India, China, Japan, and Oceania. The one fault committed by the all-powerful Company was the concentrating in its own hands a monopoly of the trade in spices. It drove away the foreigners who had settled in the Moluccas or in the Islands of Sunda, or who came thither to obtain a cargo of spices; it even went the length, in order to raise the price of this valuable commodity, of proscribing the cultivation of certain species in a large number of islands, and of forbidding, under pain of death, the exportation and sale of seeds and cuttings of the spice-producing trees. In a few years the Dutch were established in Java, Sumatra, Borneo, the Moluccas, and at the Cape of Good Hope, harbours the best placed for ships returning to Europe.
The Dutch quickly recognized the weakness and decline of Portuguese power in Asia. They understood how easily a smart and strategic nation could take over the entire trade of the Far East in a short time. After many private expeditions and explorations, they established the famous Company of the Indies in 1602, which would significantly boost the wealth and success of their home country. In their competition with the Portuguese and their dealings with the locals, the Company adopted a very skillful and moderate policy. Instead of creating colonies or repairing and occupying the forts they took from the Portuguese, the Dutch acted simply as traders focused solely on their commerce. They avoided building any fortified trading posts except at key intersections of major commercial routes. This allowed them to quickly dominate the trade route between India, China, Japan, and Oceania. The only mistake made by the powerful Company was monopolizing the spice trade. They pushed out foreigners who had settled in the Moluccas or the Sunda Islands or who came there to get a shipment of spices. They even went so far as to raise the prices of these valuable goods by banning the cultivation of certain types on many islands and forbidding, under penalty of death, the export and sale of seeds and cuttings from spice-producing trees. Within a few years, the Dutch were established in Java, Sumatra, Borneo, the Moluccas, and at the Cape of Good Hope, which were the best ports for ships returning to Europe.
It was at this time that a rich merchant of Amsterdam, Jacob Lemaire, in concert with a skilful mariner, named Wilhem Cornelis Schouten, conceived a project for reaching the Indies by a new route. The Dutch States-General had in fact forbidden any subject of the United Provinces, not in the pay of the Company of the Indies, from going to the Spice Islands by way of the Cape of Good Hope or of the Strait of Magellan. Schouten, according to some, Lemaire, according to others, had formed the idea of eluding this interdict by seeking a passage to the south of Magellan's Strait. This much is certain, that Lemaire bore one half of the expense of the expedition, while Schouten, by the aid of several merchants whose names have been handed down to us, and who filled the chief offices in the town of Hoorn, provided the other half. They fitted out the Concorde, a vessel of 360 tons, and a yacht, carrying together a crew of sixty-five men, and twenty-nine cannon. This was certainly an equipment but little in accordance with the magnitude of the enterprise. But Schouten was a skilful mariner, the crew had been carefully chosen, and the vessels were abundantly furnished with provisions and spare rigging. Lemaire was commissioner, and Schouten the captain of the ship. The destination was kept secret, and officers and crew entered into an unlimited engagement to go wherever they might be led. On the 25th June, 1615, eleven days after quitting the Texel, and when there was no longer anything to be feared from indiscretion, the crews were assembled to listen to the reading of an order which ran as follows: "The two vessels would seek another passage than that of Magellan, by which to enter the South Sea, and to discover there certain southern countries, in the hope of obtaining enormous profits from them, and if heaven should not favour this design, they would repair by means of the same sea to the East Indies." This declaration was received with enthusiasm by the whole crew, who were animated, like all Dutchmen of that period, with a love for great discoveries.
It was at this time that a wealthy merchant from Amsterdam, Jacob Lemaire, along with a skilled sailor named Wilhem Cornelis Schouten, came up with a plan to reach the Indies through a new route. The Dutch States-General had actually prohibited anyone from the United Provinces, who wasn’t working for the Company of the Indies, from traveling to the Spice Islands via the Cape of Good Hope or the Strait of Magellan. Some say Schouten, while others claim Lemaire, had the idea to bypass this ban by finding a passage south of Magellan's Strait. What is certain is that Lemaire covered half the cost of the expedition, while Schouten, with help from several merchants whose names have been recorded, and who held important positions in the town of Hoorn, managed the other half. They outfitted the Concorde, a ship of 360 tons, along with a yacht, collectively carrying a crew of sixty-five men and twenty-nine cannons. This was definitely not the kind of equipment you'd expect for such a major undertaking. However, Schouten was an experienced sailor, the crew had been carefully selected, and the ships were well stocked with provisions and spare rigging. Lemaire served as the commissioner, while Schouten took on the role of captain. The destination was kept secret, and both officers and crew committed to going wherever they were led. On June 25, 1615, eleven days after leaving the Texel, and with no more fear of being discovered, the crews gathered to hear an order that stated: "The two vessels will seek an alternative passage to enter the South Sea, to explore certain southern lands with the hope of gaining huge profits from them, and if fortune doesn't favor this plan, they will then proceed via the same sea to the East Indies." This announcement was met with enthusiasm from the entire crew, who, like many Dutchmen of that time, were filled with a passion for great discoveries.
The route then usually pursued for reaching South America—as may perhaps have been already observed—followed the African coasts as far as below the equator. The Concorde did not try to deviate from it; she reached the shores of Brazil, Patagonia, and Port Desire, at 300 miles to the north of the Strait of Magellan, but was for several days hindered by storms from entering the harbour. The yacht even remained for the space of one whole tide, aground and lying on her side, but high water set her afloat again; only for a short time however, for whilst some repairs were being done to her keel, her rigging took fire, and she was consumed in spite of the energetic efforts of the two crews. On the 13th January, 1616, Lemaire and Schouten arrived at the Sebaldine Islands, discovered by Sebald de Weerdt, and followed the coast of Tierra del Fuego at a short distance from land. The coast ran east-quarter-south-east, and was skirted by high mountains covered with snow. On the 24th of January at mid-day, they sighted its extreme point, but eastward stretched some more land, which also appeared to be of great elevation. The distance between these two islands, according to the general opinion, appeared to be about twenty-four miles, and Schouten entered the strait which divided them. It was so encumbered with whales that the ship was obliged to tack more than once to avoid them. The island to the east received the name of Staten Island, and that to the west the name of Maurice of Nassau.
The route typically taken to get to South America—as has probably already been mentioned—followed the African coast all the way down past the equator. The Concorde didn’t try to go off course; it reached the shores of Brazil, Patagonia, and Port Desire, which is 300 miles north of the Strait of Magellan, but was stuck for several days by storms and couldn’t enter the harbor. The yacht even got stuck for an entire tide, lying on its side, but high water eventually lifted it back up; however, it was only for a short while because while some repairs were being made to its keel, the rigging caught fire, and it was destroyed despite the crews’ desperate efforts. On January 13, 1616, Lemaire and Schouten arrived at the Sebaldine Islands, discovered by Sebald de Weerdt, and sailed along the coast of Tierra del Fuego close to land. The coast ran east-southeast and was lined with high snow-covered mountains. On January 24 at noon, they spotted its farthest point, but there was more land stretching to the east, which also seemed to be quite elevated. The distance between these two islands, according to general belief, was about twenty-four miles, and Schouten entered the strait that separated them. It was so filled with whales that the ship had to tack several times to avoid them. The island to the east was named Staten Island, and the one to the west was named Maurice of Nassau.
![]() |
The sea was so encumbered with whales. |
Twenty-four hours after entering this strait, which received the name of Lemaire, the ship emerged from it, and to an archipelago of small islands situated to starboard was given the name of Barneveldt, in honour of the Grand Pensionary of Holland. In 58° Lemaire doubled Cape Horn—so named in remembrance of the town where the expedition had been fitted out—and entered the South Sea. Lemaire afterwards went northwards as far as the parallel of the Juan Fernandez Islands, where he judged it wise to stop, in order to recruit his men who were suffering from scurvy. As Magellan had done, Lemaire and Schouten passed without perceiving them amongst the principal Polynesian archipelagos, and cast anchor on the 10th April, at the Island of Dogs, where it was only possible to procure a little fresh water and some herbs. They hoped to reach the Solomon Islands, but in the north the Dangerous Archipelago was entered, in which were discovered Waterland Island—so named on account of its containing a great lake—and Fly Island, because a cloud of these insects settled upon the vessel, and it was impossible to get rid of them until at the end of four days there was a change of wind. Afterwards Lemaire crossed the Friendly Archipelago, and entered that of the Navigators, or of Samoa, of which four small islands still retain the names which were then given to them: Goed Hoep, Cocoa, Horn, and Traitors' Islands. The inhabitants of these parts showed themselves extremely addicted to stealing; they tried to draw out the bolts from the ship and to break the chains. Scurvy continued to prevail among the crew, and it was therefore a great boon to receive from the king a present of a black boar and some fruits. The sovereign, who was named Latou, speedily arrived in a large canoe with sails, in shape like the Dutch sledges (trainaux), escorted by a flotilla of five and twenty boats. The king did not venture himself to go on board the Concorde, but his son was of a bolder spirit, and inquired the reason of everything he saw with the most lively curiosity. The next day the number of canoes was greatly augmented, and the Dutch perceived by certain indications that an attack was impending. Accordingly, a shower of stones falls on a sudden upon the ship, the canoes approach nearer, become annoying, and the Dutch to free themselves from them are forced to resort to a discharge of musketry. This island was rightly named Traitors' Island.
Twenty-four hours after entering this strait, which was called Lemaire, the ship came out of it and reached an archipelago of small islands on the right, named Barneveldt in honor of the Grand Pensionary of Holland. In 58° Lemaire rounded Cape Horn—named for the town where the expedition was organized—and entered the South Sea. Lemaire then traveled north until he reached the latitude of the Juan Fernandez Islands, where he decided it was wise to stop to help his men who were suffering from scurvy. Like Magellan before him, Lemaire and Schouten passed without noticing the main Polynesian archipelagos and dropped anchor on April 10 at the Island of Dogs, where they could only find a bit of fresh water and some herbs. They hoped to reach the Solomon Islands, but instead entered the Dangerous Archipelago, where they discovered Waterland Island—named for its large lake—and Fly Island, because a swarm of these insects settled on the vessel, and they couldn’t get rid of them until the wind changed after four days. Lemaire then crossed the Friendly Archipelago and entered the Navigators' Archipelago, or Samoa, where four small islands still bear the names given to them: Goed Hoep, Cocoa, Horn, and Traitors' Islands. The locals in these areas were very prone to stealing; they tried to pull the bolts from the ship and break the chains. Scurvy continued to plague the crew, so it was a relief to receive a gift of a black boar and some fruits from the king. The king, named Latou, quickly arrived in a large canoe with sails shaped like Dutch sledges, accompanied by a flotilla of twenty-five boats. The king did not dare to board the Concorde, but his son was more adventurous and asked about everything with great curiosity. The next day, the number of canoes increased significantly, and the Dutch noticed signs that an attack was likely. Suddenly, a shower of stones fell on the ship as the canoes came closer and became a nuisance, forcing the Dutch to respond with gunfire. This island was aptly named Traitors' Island.
It was now the 18th of May, and Lemaire ordered the course to be changed, that the Moluccas might be reached by the north of New Guinea. He probably passed within sight of the Solomon Archipelago, the Admiralty Islands, and the Thousand Islands (Mille Iles), coasting afterwards along New Guinea from 143° to Geelwink Bay. He frequently landed, and gave names to a number of points: the twenty-five islands which form a part of the Admiralty Archipelago, the High Corner, the High Mountain (Hoogberg)—which seems to correspond to a portion of the neighbouring coast of Kornelis-Kinerz Bay—Moa and Arimoa, two islands again seen later on by Tasman, the island to which was given the name of Schouten, but which is now called Mysore and which must not be confounded with some other Schouten Islands situated upon the Coast of Guinea but much farther to the west, and finally the Cape Goede-Hoep, which appears to be Cape Saavedra at the western extremity of Mysore. After sighting the country of Papua, Schouten and Lemaire reached Gilolo, one of the Moluccas, where they received an eager welcome from their compatriots.
It was now May 18th, and Lemaire ordered a change in course so they could reach the Moluccas by sailing north of New Guinea. He likely passed by the Solomon Archipelago, the Admiralty Islands, and the Thousand Islands, then coasted along New Guinea from 143° to Geelwink Bay. He often landed and named several locations: the twenty-five islands that are part of the Admiralty Archipelago, the High Corner, the High Mountain (Hoogberg)—which seems to correspond to part of the nearby Kornelis-Kinerz Bay coast—Moa and Arimoa, two islands that Tasman later saw, the island named Schouten, which is now called Mysore and should not be confused with other Schouten Islands located along the coast of Guinea but much farther to the west, and finally Cape Goede-Hoep, which appears to be Cape Saavedra at the western tip of Mysore. After seeing the land of Papua, Schouten and Lemaire arrived at Gilolo, one of the Moluccas, where they were warmly welcomed by their fellow countrymen.
When they were thoroughly rested from their fatigues and cured of scurvy, the Dutch went to Batavia, arriving there on the 23rd October, 1616, only thirteen months after quitting the Texel, and having lost only thirteen men during the long voyage. But the Company of the Indies did not at all understand their privileges being infringed upon, and a possibility discovered of reaching the colonies by a way not foreseen in the letters patent which had been granted to the Company at the time of its establishment. The Governor caused the Concorde to be seized, and arrested her officers and sailors, whom he sent off to Holland, there to be tried. Poor Lemaire, who had expected a totally different recompense for his toils and fatigues, and for the discoveries which he had made, could not bear up under the blow which had fallen so unexpectedly upon him; he fell ill of grief and died in the latitude of the island of Mauritius. As for Schouten, he appears not to have been molested upon his return to his own country, and to have made several voyages to the Indies, which were not distinguished by any fresh discovery. He was returning to Europe in 1625, when he was forced by bad weather to enter Antongil Bay, upon the east coast of Madagascar, where he died.
After they had fully recovered from their exhaustion and healed from scurvy, the Dutch arrived in Batavia on October 23, 1616, just thirteen months after leaving the Texel, with only thirteen men lost during the long journey. However, the Company of the Indies didn't realize that their privileges were being undermined, and a new route to the colonies had been uncovered that wasn’t included in the letters patent given to the Company when it was founded. The Governor ordered the seizure of the Concorde and arrested her crew, sending them back to Holland to be put on trial. Poor Lemaire, who had hoped for a completely different reward for his hard work and the discoveries he made, couldn't handle the shock of such an unexpected blow; he fell ill from grief and died near the island of Mauritius. As for Schouten, he seems to have faced no issues when he returned to his homeland and made several voyages to the Indies, none of which resulted in new discoveries. He was on his way back to Europe in 1625 when bad weather forced him to take shelter in Antongil Bay on the east coast of Madagascar, where he died.
Such was the history of this important expedition, which by means of Strait Lemaire opened up a shorter and less dangerous route than that by Magellan's Strait, an expedition signalized by several discoveries in Oceania, and by a more attentive exploration of points already seen by Spanish or Portuguese navigators. But it is often a matter of difficulty to settle with accuracy to which of these nations the discovery of certain islands, countries, or archipelagos in the neighbourhood of Australia, may be due.
Such was the history of this important expedition, which through Strait Lemaire created a shorter and safer route than Magellan's Strait. This expedition was marked by several discoveries in Oceania and by a more thorough exploration of areas already encountered by Spanish or Portuguese navigators. However, it is often challenging to determine exactly which of these nations can be credited with the discovery of certain islands, countries, or archipelagos near Australia.
Since we are speaking of the Dutch, we shall put the chronological order of discoveries a little on one side, that we may relate as well as those of Mendana and Quiros, the expeditions of Jan Abel Tasman.
Since we're discussing the Dutch, let's set aside the chronological order of discoveries for a moment, so we can also talk about the expeditions of Jan Abel Tasman, along with those of Mendana and Quiros.
What was the early history of Tasman, by what concurrence of circumstances did he embrace the profession of a sailor, by what means did he acquire the nautical skill and science of which he gave so many proofs, and which conducted him to his important discoveries? From ignorance we cannot answer these questions, all we know of his biography commences with his departure from Batavia on 2nd June, 1639. After passing the Philippines, he would seem during this first voyage to have visited in company with Matthew Quast the Bonin Islands, then known by the fantastic title of "the Gold and Silver Islands."
What was the early history of Tasman? What series of events led him to become a sailor? How did he gain the nautical skills and knowledge that he demonstrated so many times, which took him to his important discoveries? We can’t answer these questions due to a lack of information; all we know about his life begins with his departure from Batavia on June 2, 1639. After passing through the Philippines, it seems that on this first voyage he visited the Bonin Islands with Matthew Quast, which were then called the "Gold and Silver Islands."
In a second expedition, composed of two vessels of which he had the chief command, and which sailed from Batavia on the 14th of August, 1642, he reached the Mauritius on the 5th September, and afterwards sailed to the south-east, seeking for the Australian Continent. On the 24th November in latitude 42° 25' south, he discovered land, to which he gave the name of Van-Diemen, after the Governor of the Sunda Islands, but which is now with much greater justice called Tasmania. He anchored there in Fredrik Hendrik Bay, and ascertained that the country was inhabited, although he could not see a single native.
In a second expedition, consisting of two ships under his main command, which set sail from Batavia on August 14, 1642, he arrived at Mauritius on September 5. He then continued southeast, looking for the Australian continent. On November 24, at latitude 42° 25' south, he found land, which he named Van-Diemen after the Governor of the Sunda Islands, but is now more appropriately called Tasmania. He anchored in Fredrik Hendrik Bay and discovered that the area was populated, although he didn't see a single native.
After following this coast for a certain time, he sailed eastwards, with the intention of afterwards making once more for the north, to reach the Solomon Archipelago. On the 13th December, in latitude 42° 10', he came in sight of a mountainous country which he followed towards the north, until the 18th December, when he cast anchor in a bay; but even the boldest of the savages whom he met with there, did not approach the ship within a stone's throw. Their voices were rough, their stature tall, their colour brown inclining to yellow, and their black hair, which was nearly as long as that of the Japanese, was worn drawn up to the crown of the head. On the morrow they summoned courage to go on board one of the vessels and carry on traffic by means of barter. Tasman, upon seeing these pacific dispositions, despatched a boat for the purpose of obtaining a more accurate knowledge of the shore. Of the sailors who manned it, three were killed without provocation by the natives, while the others escaped by swimming, and were picked up by the ships' boats, but by the time they were in readiness to fire upon the assailants, these had disappeared. The spot where this sad event happened, received the name of Assassins' (Moordenaars) Bay. Tasman, who felt convinced that he could not carry on any intercourse with such fierce people, weighed anchor and sailed up the coast as far as its extreme point, which he named Cape Maria Van-Diemen, in honour of his "lady," for a legend states that having had the audacity to pretend to the hand of the daughter of the governor of the East Indies, the latter had sent him to sea with two dilapidated ships, the Heemskerke and the Zeechen.
After following the coast for a while, he sailed east, planning to head north again to reach the Solomon Archipelago. On December 13th, at latitude 42° 10', he spotted a mountainous region that he followed north until December 18th, when he dropped anchor in a bay. However, even the bravest of the locals he encountered there didn’t approach the ship closer than a stone's throw. They had rough voices, tall stature, brownish-yellow skin, and black hair that was almost as long as Japanese hair, which they styled up on their heads. The next day, they gathered the courage to board one of the vessels and trade through barter. Seeing their peaceful intentions, Tasman sent a boat to get a better understanding of the shore. Unfortunately, three of the sailors in that boat were killed without cause by the locals, while the others managed to swim to safety and were rescued by the ship's boats. By the time they were ready to fight back, the attackers had vanished. The location of this tragic event was named Assassins' (Moordenaars) Bay. Tasman, convinced that he couldn't establish any relations with such hostile people, weighed anchor and sailed up the coast to its farthest point, which he named Cape Maria Van-Diemen in honor of his “lady.” According to legend, he had the audacity to seek the hand of the daughter of the governor of the East Indies, who had sent him to sea with two rundown ships, the Heemskerke and the Zeechen.
![]() |
Three were killed by the natives without provocation. |
The land thus discovered received the name of Staaten Land, soon changed into that of New Zealand. On the 21st January, 1643, Tasman discovered the islands of Amsterdam and Rotterdam, upon which he found a great quantity of pigs, fowls, and fruit. On the 6th February, the ships entered an archipelago, consisting of a score of islands, which were called Prince William Islands, and after sighting Anthong-Java, Tasman followed the coast of New Guinea from Cape Santa Maria, passed by the various points previously discovered by Lemaire and Schouten, and anchored off Batavia on the 15th June following, after a ten months' voyage.
The land discovered was named Staaten Land, which was soon changed to New Zealand. On January 21, 1643, Tasman discovered the islands of Amsterdam and Rotterdam, where he found a large number of pigs, chickens, and fruit. On February 6, the ships entered an archipelago made up of about twenty islands, which were called the Prince William Islands. After spotting Anthong-Java, Tasman followed the coast of New Guinea from Cape Santa Maria, passed by various points previously discovered by Lemaire and Schouten, and anchored off Batavia on June 15, after a ten-month voyage.
In a second expedition, Tasman, in obedience to his orders dated 1664, was to visit Van Diemen's Land, and to make a careful examination of the western coast of New Guinea, as far as 17° south latitude, in order to ascertain whether that island belonged to the Australian Continent. It does not appear that Tasman carried out this programme, but the loss of his journals causes complete uncertainty as to the route which he followed, and the discoveries which he may have made. From this time there is no record of the events which marked the close of his career, nor of the place and date of his death.
In a second expedition, Tasman, following his orders from 1664, was supposed to visit Van Diemen's Land and carefully examine the western coast of New Guinea, reaching as far as 17° south latitude, to determine if that island was part of the Australian Continent. It seems that Tasman didn't complete this plan, but the loss of his journals leaves us completely unsure about the route he took and any discoveries he might have made. After this point, there are no records of the events that marked the end of his career, nor details about where and when he died.
From the period of the taking of Malacca by Albuquerque, the Portuguese conceived that a new world extended to the south of Asia. Their ideas were soon shared by the Spaniards, and henceforward a series of voyages were made on the Pacific Ocean, to search for a southern continent, of which the existence appeared geographically necessary to counterbalance the immense extent of the lands already known. Java the Great, designated later by the names of New Holland and Australia, had been seen by the French perhaps, or as is more probable by Saavedra, from 1530 to 1540, and it was sought for by a crowd of navigators, amongst whom we may mention the Portuguese, Serrao and Meneses, and the Spaniards, Saavedra, Hernando de Grijalva, Alvarado, and Inigo Ortiz de Retes, who explored the greater part of the islands to the north of New Guinea, as well as that great island itself. Afterwards come Mendana, Torrès, and Quiros, upon whose deeds we shall pause a little, on account of the importance and authenticity of the discoveries which we owe to them.
From the time Albuquerque captured Malacca, the Portuguese believed there was a new world to the south of Asia. Their thoughts were quickly shared by the Spaniards, leading to a series of voyages across the Pacific Ocean in search of a southern continent, which seemed necessary to balance the vast areas of land that were already known. Java the Great, later called New Holland and Australia, may have been sighted by the French, or more likely by Saavedra, from 1530 to 1540. A host of navigators sought it out, including the Portuguese Serrao and Meneses, and the Spaniards Saavedra, Hernando de Grijalva, Alvarado, and Inigo Ortiz de Retes, who explored much of the islands north of New Guinea, as well as New Guinea itself. Then came Mendana, Torrès, and Quiros, whose achievements we will focus on for a moment, due to the significance and authenticity of the discoveries attributed to them.
Alvaro Mendana de Neyra was nephew to the Governor of Lima, Don Pedro de Castro, who warmly advocated with the home government his nephew's project of searching for new countries in the Pacific Ocean. Mendana was one-and-twenty when he took the command of two ships and one hundred and twenty-five soldiers and sailors. He sailed from Callao, the port of Lima, on the 19th November, 1567. After sighting the small Island of Jesus, he discovered on the 7th February between 7° and 8° south latitude, the Island of Santa Isabella, where the Spaniards built a brigantine, with which they explored the archipelago of which this island was a part. "The inhabitants," says the narrative of a companion of Mendana, "are anthropophagi, they devour those whom they can make their prisoners in war, and even without being in open hostility, those whom they can succeed in taking by treachery." One of the chiefs in the island sent to Mendana as a delicacy, a quarter of a child, but the Spanish commander caused it to be buried in the presence of the natives, who appeared much hurt by an act which they could not understand. The Spaniards explored the Island las Palmas (Palm Island), los Ramos—so named because it was discovered on Palm Sunday—Galley Island, and Buena-Vista, of which the inhabitants, under the appearance of friendship concealed hostile intentions, which were not long in displaying themselves. The same reception awaited the Spaniards at the Island San Dimas, at Sesarga, and at Guadalcanar, upon which ginger was found for the first time. In the return voyage to Santa Isabella, the Spaniards pursued a course which enabled them to discover St. George Island, where they found bats as large as kites. Scarcely had the crew of the brigantine cast anchor in the harbour of Santa Isabella, than they were obliged again to weigh it, for the place was so unhealthy that five soldiers died and a great number of others were taken ill. Mendana stopped at the Island of Guadalcanar, where out of ten men who had landed to fetch water, one negro alone escaped from the attacks of the natives, who were extremely angry at one of their fellows having been carried off by the Spaniards. The punishment was terrible; twenty men were killed and a number of houses burnt. Mendana afterwards visited several islands of the Solomon archipelago, amongst others the Three Maries and San Juan. Upon the latter island, whilst the ships were being repaired and calked, several affrays with the natives occurred, in which some prisoners were made. After this checkered rest, Mendana again put to sea, and visited the islands of San Christoval, Santa Catalina, and Santa Anna. But as by this time the number of invalids was considerable, the provisions and ammunition nearly exhausted, and the rigging become rotten, the flotilla now set out to return to Peru. The separation of the flagship, the discovery of certain islands which it is difficult to identify, and probably of the Sandwich Islands; violent storms, during which the sails were carried away; the sickness caused by the insufficiency and putrefaction of the water and biscuit on board, were all incidents signalizing this long and trying return voyage, which was ended by the arrival of the ships at the port of Colima in California after five months of navigation.
Alvaro Mendana de Neyra was the nephew of Don Pedro de Castro, the Governor of Lima, who strongly supported his nephew's plan to find new lands in the Pacific Ocean. Mendana was just 21 when he took command of two ships and 125 soldiers and sailors. He left Callao, the port of Lima, on November 19, 1567. After spotting the small Island of Jesus, he discovered the Island of Santa Isabella on February 7, located between 7° and 8° south latitude, where the Spaniards built a brigantine to explore the surrounding archipelago. "The inhabitants," according to the account of one of Mendana's companions, "are cannibals; they eat those they can capture in war, and even those they can trick, without being in open conflict." One of the island's chiefs sent Mendana a delicacy—a quarter of a child—but the Spanish commander had it buried in front of the natives, who seemed very hurt by an act they couldn't comprehend. The Spaniards explored Palm Island, Ramos (named because it was discovered on Palm Sunday), Galley Island, and Buena-Vista, where the locals, pretending to be friendly, had hidden hostile intentions that soon became evident. The Spaniards faced the same kind of reception at San Dimas Island, Sesarga, and Guadalcanar, where they first found ginger. On the way back to Santa Isabella, the Spaniards found St. George Island, where they encountered bats as large as kites. As soon as the brigantine's crew anchored in Santa Isabella's harbor, they had to leave again, as the area was so unhealthy that five soldiers died and many others fell ill. Mendana stopped at Guadalcanar, where out of ten men who went ashore to fetch water, only one survived the attacks by angry natives retaliating for a fellow native taken by the Spaniards. The punishment was harsh; twenty men were killed and several houses burned. Mendana then visited several islands in the Solomon archipelago, including the Three Maries and San Juan. On the latter island, while the ships were being repaired, several encounters with the natives occurred, resulting in some prisoners being taken. After this tumultuous period, Mendana set out to sea again, visiting San Christoval, Santa Catalina, and Santa Anna. However, by this time, the number of sick was significant, supplies and ammunition were running low, and the ship's rigging was rotting, leading the fleet to head back to Peru. The flagship's separation, the discovery of possibly unidentifiable islands, and likely the Sandwich Islands; fierce storms that tore the sails; and sickness caused by spoiled food and water marked this long and difficult return voyage, which culminated in the ships arriving at the port of Colima in California after five months at sea.
The narrative of Mendana excited no enthusiasm, in spite of the name of Solomon which he gave to the archipelago discovered by him, to make it believed that from thence came the treasures of the Jewish King. Marvellous recitals had no longer any fascination for men glutted with the riches of Peru. Proofs were what they demanded; the smallest nugget of gold, or the least grain of silver would have been more satisfactory to them.
The story of Mendana didn't spark any excitement, even though he named the archipelago he found after Solomon to suggest that it was the source of the Jewish King's treasures. Incredible tales no longer captivated people who were already overwhelmed by the wealth of Peru. They wanted evidence; even the smallest nugget of gold or a tiny grain of silver would have been more fulfilling for them.
Mendana had twenty-seven years to wait before he was able to organize another expedition, but then his fleet was a large one, it being proposed to found a colony in the island of San Christoval which Alvaro de Mendana had seen during his first voyage. Thus four ships carrying nearly four hundred people sailed from the port of Lima on the 11th April, 1595. Amongst those on board may be named Doña Isabella, wife of Mendana, the three brothers-in-law of the general, and the pilot Pedro Fernandez Quiros, who later on distinguished himself as commander-in-chief of another expedition. The fleet did not finally leave the Peruvian coast, where its equipment had been completed, until the 16th April. At the end of a month's navigation, not distinguished by any remarkable incident, an island was discovered, which according to custom received the name of the saint whose day it was, and was called Magdalena. Immediately the fleet was surrounded by a crowd of canoes bearing more than four hundred Indians, of fine stature and nearly white, and who while presenting cocoa-nuts and other fruits to the sailors, appeared to entreat them to disembark. The natives no sooner came on board than they began to pilfer, and it was necessary to fire a cannon to get rid of them; a wound which one of the natives received in the fray soon changed their disposition, and a discharge of musketry was the reply to the shower of arrows which they let fly from their boats. Not far from this island three others were discovered, San Pedro, Dominica, and Santa Christina, and the name of las Marquezas de Mendoça was given to the group, in honour of the governor of Peru. So friendly had been the intercourse at the beginning, that an Indian woman upon seeing the beautiful fair hair of Doña Isabella de Mendana had begged her by signs to give her a curl of it; but by the fault of the Spaniards the mutual relations speedily became hostile, and so continued until the day when the natives, becoming conscious of the great inferiority of their arms, begged for peace.
Mendana had to wait twenty-seven years before he could organize another expedition, but when he did, his fleet was quite large, as they planned to establish a colony on the island of San Christoval, which Alvaro de Mendana had seen during his first voyage. So, four ships carrying nearly four hundred people set sail from the port of Lima on April 11, 1595. Among those on board were Doña Isabella, Mendana's wife, the three brothers-in-law of the general, and the pilot Pedro Fernandez Quiros, who later made a name for himself as the commander of another expedition. The fleet didn't finally depart from the Peruvian coast, where they finished their preparations, until April 16. After a month of unremarkable sailing, they discovered an island that was named after the saint for that day, calling it Magdalena. The fleet was soon surrounded by a crowd of canoes occupied by over four hundred Indians, who were tall, nearly white, and offered cocoa-nuts and other fruits to the sailors, seemingly urging them to come ashore. As soon as the natives boarded the ships, they began to steal, prompting the crew to fire a cannon to drive them away; one native was wounded during the scuffle, which changed their demeanor, and the natives responded to the crew's musket fire with a barrage of arrows from their boats. Close to this island, they discovered three others—San Pedro, Dominica, and Santa Christina—and named the group las Marquezas de Mendoça in honor of the governor of Peru. Initially, the interactions were so friendly that an Indian woman, upon seeing Doña Isabella de Mendana's beautiful fair hair, gestured to ask for a curl of it. However, due to the Spaniards' actions, relations quickly turned hostile and remained that way until the natives, realizing the significant disadvantage of their weapons, requested peace.
On the 5th August the Spanish flotilla again put to sea and made 1200 miles west-north-west. On the 20th August were discovered the St. Bernard, since called Dangerous Islands, and afterwards Queen Charlotte's Islands, upon which notwithstanding the scarcity of provisions, no landing was made. After Solitary Island—a name which explains its situation—the Santa Cruz archipelago was reached. But at this time, during a storm, the flagship became separated from the fleet, and although search was made several times, no tidings of her were obtained. Fifty canoes, carrying a crowd of natives of a tawny complexion, or of a lustrous black, immediately approached the ships. "All had frizzled hair, black, red, or some other colour (for it was dyed); their teeth also were dyed red; the head was half shaven, the body was naked, except a small veil of fine linen, the face and the arms painted black, glittering and striped with various colours; the neck and limbs loaded with several strings of small beads, of gold, or of black wood, of fishes' teeth, or of a species of medals made of mother of pearl, or of pearls." For arms they carried bows, poisoned arrows with sharp points hardened in the fire, or tipped with bone and steeped in the juice of a herb, great stones, heavy wooden swords made of stiff wood, with three harpoon points, each more than a handbreadth long. Slung over their shoulders they had haversacks exceedingly well made out of palm leaves, and filled with biscuits made from certain roots which serve them for food.
On August 5th, the Spanish fleet set sail again and traveled 1,200 miles west-northwest. On August 20th, they discovered the St. Bernard, now known as the Dangerous Islands, and later the Queen Charlotte's Islands, but despite the lack of supplies, they did not land there. After passing Solitary Island—a name that reflects its isolation—they reached the Santa Cruz archipelago. Unfortunately, during a storm, the flagship got separated from the fleet, and despite several attempts to find it, no news was received. Fifty canoes, filled with natives of either a tawny complexion or a shiny black skin, quickly approached the ships. "All had frizzy hair—black, red, or another color (as it was dyed); their teeth were also dyed red; their heads were partially shaved, their bodies naked except for a small veil made of fine linen, and their faces and arms painted black, shimmering, and striped with various colors. Their necks and limbs were adorned with several strings of small beads, made of gold, black wood, fish teeth, or a type of medals made from mother of pearl or pearls." As weapons, they carried bows, poisoned arrows with sharp tips hardened in the fire or tipped with bone soaked in the juice of an herb, large stones, and heavy wooden swords made from stiff wood, each with three harpoon points, more than a hand's breadth long. Slung over their shoulders were well-made haversacks made from palm leaves, filled with biscuits made from certain roots that served as their food.
![]() |
Doña Isabella consults the officers. |
At first Mendana thought he recognized in these natives the inhabitants of the islands he was seeking, but he was quickly undeceived. The vessels were received with a shower of arrows, which was the more vexatious because Mendana, seeing that he could not find the Solomon Islands, had determined to establish his colony in this archipelago. At this juncture, discord reigned among the Spaniards; a revolt fomented against the general was almost immediately suppressed, and the guilty were executed. But these sorrowful events and the fatigues of the voyage had so completely undermined the health of the head of the expedition, that he died on the 17th October, after having had time to indicate his wife as his successor in the conduct of the enterprise. After the death of Mendana the hostilities with the natives redoubled, and many of the Spaniards were so exhausted by sickness and hardships, that a score of thoroughly determined natives might easily have gained the mastery over them. To persist in the intention of founding a settlement under such conditions would have been folly; all agreed in this, and the anchor was raised on the 18th November. Doña Isabella de Mendana's project was to go to Manilla, and there to obtain recruits from amongst the colonists, with whom she would return to found a settlement. She consulted the officers, who all gave their approval in writing; and she found in Quiros a devotion and skill which were speedily to be put to a severe proof. They at once steered away from New Guinea, in order to avoid being entangled amongst the numerous archipelagos surrounding it, and also to enable them sooner to reach the Philippines, which the dilapidated state of the ships rendered necessary. After passing within sight of several islands surrounded by reefs of madrepore, upon which the crews wished to land, a permission which Quiros with great prudence always refused, after having been separated from one of the ships of the squadron, which could not or would not follow, the flotilla arrived at the Ladrone—soon to be called the Marianne—Islands. The Spaniards went on shore several times to buy some provisions; the natives did not desire either their silver or gold, but set the highest value upon iron and all tools made of that metal. The narrative contains here some details upon the veneration shown by the natives towards their ancestors, which are curious enough to warrant our reproducing them verbatim: "They take out the bones from the bodies of their relations, burn the flesh, and mixing the ashes with tuba, a wine made from the cocoa palm, swallow them. They weep for the dead every year for a whole week; there are a great number of female mourners, who are to be hired for the purpose. Besides that, all the neighbours come to weep in the house of the deceased; the compliment being returned to them when the turn comes for the feast to take place at their house. These anniversaries are much frequented, all those assisting at them being liberally regaled. They weep all day and drink to intoxication all night. They recite in the midst of tears, the life and deeds of the dead, beginning with the moment of his birth, and dealing with the whole course of his life, recounting his strength, his height, his beauty, in a word, all that can in any way do him honour. If some amusing action occur in the recital, the company begin to laugh as if they would split their sides; then on a sudden they drink and are again drowned in tears. There are sometimes two hundred persons present at these absurd anniversaries." When the Spanish crew arrived at the Philippines, it was scarcely more than a company of skeletons, emaciated and half dead with hunger. Doña Isabella landed at Manilla on the 11th February, 1596, under a salute from the guns, and was solemnly received in the midst of the troops drawn up under arms. The rest of the crew, fifty having died since the departure from Santa Cruz, were housed and fed at the public expense, and the women all found husbands in Manilla, except four or five who embraced the religious life. As for Doña Isabella, she was escorted back to Peru some time afterwards by Quiros, who lost no time in submitting to the viceroy a project for a fresh voyage. But Luis de Velasco, who had succeeded Mendoza, referred the navigator to the King of Spain and the Council of the Indies, under the pretext that such a decision would overstep the limits of his authority. Quiros therefore went to Spain and thence to Rome, where he received a kindly welcome from the Pope, who recommended him warmly to Philip III. At length in 1605, after numberless applications and solicitations, he was empowered to fit out at Lima the two vessels which he should judge the most suitable for the investigation of the Australian continent and for continuing the discoveries of Mendana. With two ships and one light vessel, Quiros set out from Callao on the 21st December, 1605. At 3000 miles from Peru he had as yet discovered no land. In latitude 25° south he observed a group of small islands belonging to the Dangerous archipelago. These were the Convercion de San Pablo, the Osnabrugh of Wallis, and Decena, so named because it was the tenth island seen. Although this island was defended by rocks, intercourse was carried on with the natives, whose dwellings were scattered about amongst palm-trees on the sea shore. The natives were strong and well proportioned, and their chief wore on his head a kind of crown made of small black feathers so fine and supple that they might have been taken for silk. His fair hair, which descended to the waist, excited the wonder of the Spaniards, who, not being able to understand how a man with so tawny coloured a face could have such light yellow hair, "chose to think that he was married, and that he wore his wife's hair." This singular colour was only due to the habitual use of powdered lime, which burns the hair and causes it to turn yellow.
At first, Mendana thought he recognized in these natives the inhabitants of the islands he was looking for, but he quickly realized he was wrong. The ships were met with a barrage of arrows, which was especially frustrating because Mendana, unable to find the Solomon Islands, had decided to establish his colony in this archipelago. At this point, conflict broke out among the Spaniards; a revolt against the general was quickly put down, and those responsible were executed. However, these unfortunate events and the stress of the journey had severely weakened the health of the expedition leader, who died on October 17th after naming his wife as his successor for the mission. Following Mendana's death, hostilities with the natives intensified, and many of the Spaniards were so worn down by sickness and hardship that they could have easily been overpowered by a determined group of natives. Continuing with plans to establish a settlement under such conditions would have been foolish; everyone agreed on this, and the anchor was lifted on November 18th. Doña Isabella de Mendana's plan was to go to Manila to recruit colonists, with whom she would return to establish a settlement. She consulted the officers, who all gave their written approval, and she found in Quiros a dedication and skill that would soon be put to the test. They set sail away from New Guinea to avoid getting caught up among the many archipelagos surrounding it and also to reach the Philippines more quickly, which was necessary given the poor condition of the ships. After passing several islands surrounded by coral reefs, where the crews wanted to land but Quiros prudently refused, the flotilla eventually reached the Ladrone Islands—soon to be known as the Marianne Islands. The Spaniards went ashore several times to buy provisions; the natives showed no interest in their silver or gold, but highly valued iron and any tools made from it. The narrative includes some details about the reverence the natives showed towards their ancestors, which are interesting enough to warrant our repeating them verbatim: "They take out the bones from the bodies of their relatives, burn the flesh, and mix the ashes with tuba, a wine made from the cocoa palm, and swallow them. They mourn for the dead every year for an entire week; there are many female mourners who can be hired for this purpose. In addition, all the neighbors come to weep in the house of the deceased, returning the favor when it’s their turn for a feast to be held at their house. These anniversaries are well attended, with everyone present being generously offered refreshments. They weep all day and drink to intoxication all night. They recount, amid tears, the life and deeds of the deceased, starting from their birth and covering the entirety of their life, highlighting their strength, height, beauty, and anything else that honors them. If something amusing happens during the recounting, the group laughs as if they would burst; then suddenly they drink and are again overcome with tears. Sometimes there are up to two hundred people present at these peculiar anniversaries." When the Spanish crew arrived in the Philippines, they were little more than a group of skeletons, emaciated and half-dead from hunger. Doña Isabella landed in Manila on February 11, 1596, to a salute from the guns and received a formal welcome amidst troops lined up with weapons. The rest of the crew, fifty of whom had died since leaving Santa Cruz, were housed and fed at public expense, and the women all found husbands in Manila, except for four or five who chose to embrace religious life. As for Doña Isabella, she was escorted back to Peru sometime later by Quiros, who wasted no time presenting a new voyage plan to the viceroy. But Luis de Velasco, who had succeeded Mendoza, referred the navigator to the King of Spain and the Council of the Indies, claiming that such a decision was beyond his authority. Quiros then traveled to Spain and later to Rome, where he received a warm welcome from the Pope, who strongly recommended him to Philip III. Finally, in 1605, after countless requests and appeals, he was authorized to outfit two ships in Lima that he deemed most suitable for exploring the Australian continent and continuing Mendana’s discoveries. With two ships and one lighter vessel, Quiros set sail from Callao on December 21, 1605. Three thousand miles from Peru, he had yet to discover any land. At latitude 25° south, he encountered a group of small islands belonging to the Dangerous Archipelago. These were the Conversion de San Pablo, the Osnabrugh of Wallis, and Decena, named because it was the tenth island seen. Although this island was protected by rocks, they managed to communicate with the natives, whose homes were scattered among palm trees along the shoreline. The natives were strong and well-built, and their chief wore a type of crown made of tiny black feathers that were so fine and soft they could be mistaken for silk. His fair hair, which fell to his waist, amazed the Spaniards, who couldn’t understand how someone with such a tanned face could have light, yellow hair, leading them to "think that he was married and wearing his wife’s hair." This unusual hair color was simply the result of regular use of powdered lime, which burned the hair and caused it to turn yellow.
This island to which Quiros gave the name of Sagittaria, is, according to Fleurieu, Tahiti, one of the principal of the group of Society Islands. On the succeeding days Quiros sighted several other islands, upon which he did not land, and to which he gave names taken from the Calendar, according to a practice which has changed all the native nomenclature of Oceania into a veritable litany. One island visited may be especially noticed; it was named the island of la Gente Hermosa on account of the beauty of its inhabitants, and of the fair colour and coquetry of its women, who, as the Spaniards declared, even bore away the palm for grace and attractiveness from their own fellow-countrywomen of Lima, whose beauty is proverbial. This island, according to Quiros, was situated upon the same parallel as Santa Cruz, to which he intended to go. He therefore sailed westward and reached an island called by the natives Taumaco, in 10° south latitude and 240 miles east of Santa Cruz. This must have been one of the Duff Islands, and here Quiros was told that if he directed his course southwards, he would discover a great land, of which the inhabitants were whiter than those whom he had hitherto seen. This information determined him to abandon his scheme of going to Santa Cruz. He steered in a south-westerly direction, and after having sighted several small islands, he arrived on the 1st May, 1606, in a bay more than twenty-four miles broad. He gave to this island the name which it still bears, of Espiritu Santo. It was one of the New Hebrides group. What events happened during the stay of the ships here? The narrative is silent upon this subject, but we know from other sources that the crew mutinied, made Quiros prisoner, and abandoning the second ship and the brigantine, set out on the 11th June to return to America, where they arrived on the 3rd October, 1606, after a nine months' voyage. M. Ed. Charton throws no light upon this incident. He is silent upon the mutiny of the crew, and even throws all the blame of the separation upon the commander of the second vessel, Luis Vaes de Torrès, who abandoned his chief in quitting Espiritu Santo. Now it is known by a letter from Torrès himself to the King of Spain—published by Lord Stanley at the end of his English edition of Antoine de Morga's History of the Philippines—that he remained "fifteen" days waiting for Quiros in the Bay of Saint Philip and Saint James. The officers met in council, resolved to weigh anchor on the 26th June, and to continue the search for the Australian continent. Hindered by bad weather, which prevents him from sailing round Espiritu Santo Island, assailed by the demands of a crew over whom prevails a slight breath of mutiny, Torrès decides to steer to the north-east to reach the Spanish Islands. In 11° 30' he discovers land, which he imagines must be the commencement of New Guinea. "All this land is part of New Guinea," says Torrès, "it is peopled by Indians who are not very white, and who go naked, although their middles are covered with the bark of trees.... They fight with javelins, bucklers, and certain clubs of stone, the whole adorned with beautiful feathers. All along this land there are other inhabited islands. Upon the whole of this coast there are numerous and vast harbours, with very broad rivers and great plains. Outside these islands stretch reefs and shallows; the islands are between these dangers and the mainland, and a channel runs between. We took possession of these harbours in your Majesty's name. Having pursued this coast for 900 miles, and seen our latitude decrease from 2½° until we found ourselves in 9°, at this point commenced a shoal of from three to nine fathoms deep, which stretched along the coast to 7½°. Not being able to proceed farther on account of the numerous shallows and powerful currents which we encountered, we decided to alter our course to the south-west, by the deep channel which has been mentioned, as far as about 11°. There is there, from one end to the other, an archipelago of innumerable islands, by which I passed. At the end of the eleventh degree the bottom became deeper. There were some very large islands there, and there appeared to be more of them towards the south; they were inhabited by a black population, very robust and quite naked, bearing for arms, strong and long spears, arrows, and stone clubs roughly fashioned."
This island that Quiros named Sagittaria is, according to Fleurieu, Tahiti, one of the main islands in the Society Islands group. In the following days, Quiros spotted several other islands but didn’t go ashore, giving them names from the calendar, a practice that transformed all the native names of Oceania into a kind of litany. One island he visited is notable; it was called the island of la Gente Hermosa because of the beauty of its residents and the fair skin and charm of its women, who, according to the Spaniards, were even more graceful and attractive than their own fellow countrywomen from Lima, known for their beauty. Quiros claimed this island was on the same parallel as Santa Cruz, which he intended to reach. He then sailed west and arrived at an island called Taumaco, located at 10° south latitude and 240 miles east of Santa Cruz. This was likely one of the Duff Islands, where Quiros learned that if he headed south, he would discover a large land inhabited by people who were whiter than those he had encountered so far. This information led him to abandon his plan to go to Santa Cruz. He changed course to the southwest and, after spotting several small islands, reached a bay over twenty-four miles wide on May 1, 1606. He named this island Espiritu Santo, which is part of the New Hebrides group. What happened during the ships' stay there? The story doesn’t say, but we know from other sources that the crew mutinied, took Quiros prisoner, and abandoned the second ship and the brigantine, setting sail back to America on June 11, where they arrived on October 3, 1606, after a nine-month journey. M. Ed. Charton doesn’t clarify this event, placing all the blame for the separation on the commander of the second vessel, Luis Vaes de Torrès, who left Quiros behind at Espiritu Santo. However, a letter from Torrès to the King of Spain—published by Lord Stanley at the end of his English edition of Antoine de Morga’s History of the Philippines—reveals that he waited for Quiros in the Bay of Saint Philip and Saint James for "fifteen" days. The officers convened and decided to set sail on June 26 to continue searching for the Australian continent. Struggling with bad weather that prevented him from navigating around Espiritu Santo Island, and a crew showing signs of mutiny, Torrès chose to head northeast toward the Spanish Islands. At 11° 30', he discovered land, which he thought was the start of New Guinea. "All this land is part of New Guinea," said Torrès, "it is inhabited by Indians who are not very white and go naked, though they cover their middles with tree bark... They fight with javelins, shields, and certain stone clubs, all decorated with beautiful feathers. Throughout this land, there are other inhabited islands. The coast has many large harbors, with wide rivers and expansive plains. Beyond these islands, there are reefs and shallows; the islands are situated between these dangers and the mainland, with a channel running between. We took possession of these harbors in your Majesty's name. After following this coast for 900 miles and observing our latitude drop from 2½° to 9°, we encountered a shoal of three to nine fathoms deep, which extended along the coast to 7½°. Unable to progress due to the shallows and strong currents, we decided to change our course southwest via the deep channel mentioned, reaching about 11°. There, from one end to the other, lay an archipelago of countless islands. At the end of the eleventh degree, the sea floor deepened. There were several large islands, and it appeared there were more to the south, inhabited by a very strong, fully naked black population, armed with long, sturdy spears, arrows, and roughly made stone clubs."
Modern geographers are agreed in recognizing in the localities thus described, that portion of the Australian Coast which ends in York Peninsula, and the extremity of New Guinea recently visited by Captain Moresby. It was known that Torrès had entered the strait which has been named after him, and which divides New Guinea from Cape York; but the very recent exploration of the south-eastern portion of New Guinea, of which the population has been discovered to be of a comparatively light colour and differing much from the Papous, has just furnished an unexpected confirmation of the discoveries of Quiros. It is for this reason that we have dwelt at some length upon them, referring for the purpose to a very learned work of M. E. T. Hamy, which appeared in the Bulletin de la Société de Géographie.
Modern geographers agree that the areas described include the part of the Australian coast that ends at York Peninsula and the tip of New Guinea recently explored by Captain Moresby. It was known that Torres had entered the strait named after him, which separates New Guinea from Cape York; however, the recent exploration of the southeastern part of New Guinea, where the population has been found to be of a relatively lighter skin tone and differs significantly from the Papuans, has unexpectedly confirmed the findings of Quiros. For this reason, we have spent some time discussing these discoveries, referring to the learned work of M. E. T. Hamy, which was published in the Bulletin de la Société de Géographie.
It behoves us now to say a few words about some travellers who explored some unfrequented countries, and furnished their contemporaries with more exact knowledge of a world until then almost unknown. The first of these travellers is François Pyrard, of Laval. Having embarked in 1601 on board a St. Malo ship to go to the Indies to trade, he was wrecked in the Maldive Archipelago. These islets or atolls (detached coral reefs,) to the number of at least 12,000, descend into the Indian Ocean from Cape Comorin as far as the equator. The worthy Pyrard relates his shipwreck, the flight of a portion of his companions in captivity in the archipelago, and his long sojourn of seven years upon the Maldive Islands, a stay rendered almost agreeable by the pains which he took to acquire the native language. He had plenty of time to learn the manners, customs, religion, and industries of the inhabitants, as well as to study the productions and climate of the country. Thus his narrative is filled with details of all kinds, and had retained its attractions until recent years, because travellers do not voluntarily frequent this unhealthy archipelago, the isolated situation of which had kept away foreigners and conquerors. Pyrard's narrative therefore, is still instructive and agreeable reading.
It’s important for us to mention a few travelers who ventured into less-traveled regions and provided their contemporaries with a clearer understanding of a world that was largely unknown at the time. The first of these travelers is François Pyrard from Laval. In 1601, he set sail on a ship from St. Malo to trade in the Indies but was shipwrecked in the Maldive Archipelago. These islets or atolls, which are detached coral reefs, number at least 12,000 and stretch from Cape Comorin down to the equator in the Indian Ocean. Pyrard recounts his shipwreck, the escape of some of his companions who were captured in the archipelago, and his lengthy seven-year stay on the Maldive Islands, a period that was made almost enjoyable by his efforts to learn the local language. He had ample time to study the customs, traditions, religion, and industries of the locals, as well as the natural resources and climate of the region. His account is filled with various details and has remained engaging until recent times because travelers tend to avoid this unhealthy archipelago, whose remote location kept foreigners and conquerors away. Thus, Pyrard's narrative is still an informative and enjoyable read.
In 1607, a fleet was sent to the Maldives by the King of Bengal, in order to carry off the 100 or 120 cannon which the Maldive sovereign owed to the wreck of numerous Portuguese vessels. Pyrard, notwithstanding all the liberty allowed him, and that he had become a landholder, was desirous to behold his beloved Brittany once more. He therefore eagerly embraced this opportunity of quitting the Archipelago with the three companions who out of the whole crew alone remained with him. But the eventful travels of Pyrard were not yet concluded. Taken first to Ceylon, he was carried afterwards to Bengal, and endeavoured to reach Cochin. Before reaching this town he was captured by the Portuguese and carried prisoner to Cochin; he afterwards fell ill and was nursed in the Hospital of Goa which he only quitted to serve for two years as a soldier, at the end of which time he was again thrown into prison, and it was not until 1611, that he was able to revisit the good town of Laval. After so many trials, Pyrard must doubtless have felt the need of repose, and we are justified in imagining, from the silence of history as to the close of his life, that he was privileged at length to find happiness.
In 1607, the King of Bengal sent a fleet to the Maldives to take back the 100 or 120 cannons that the Maldive ruler owed due to the wreckage of several Portuguese ships. Pyrard, despite enjoying a good amount of freedom and having become a landholder, longed to see his beloved Brittany again. So, he eagerly took the chance to leave the Archipelago with the three companions who were the only ones from the crew still with him. However, Pyrard's adventurous travels were not over yet. He was first taken to Ceylon, then brought to Bengal, and tried to make his way to Cochin. Before he could reach the town, he was captured by the Portuguese and taken prisoner to Cochin; later, he fell ill and was cared for in the Hospital of Goa, which he only left to serve two years as a soldier. After that, he was thrown back into prison, and it wasn't until 1611 that he was able to return to the good town of Laval. After such a series of challenges, Pyrard must have certainly felt the need for rest, and we can assume, given the lack of historical records about the end of his life, that he eventually found happiness.
While the honest burgess François Pyrard, was, so to speak, in spite of himself, and from having indulged the desire of making a fortune too rapidly, launched into adventures in which he had to pass much of his life, circumstances of a different and romantic kind caused Pietro della Valle to determine upon travelling. Descendant of an ancient and noble family, he is by turns a soldier of the Pope, and a sailor chasing Barbary corsairs. Upon his return to Rome he finds that a rival, profiting by his absence, has taken his place with a young girl whom he was to have married. So great a misfortune demands an heroic remedy, and Della Valle makes a vow of pilgrimage to the Holy Sepulchre. But if, as saith the proverb, there is no road which does not lead to Rome, so there is no circuit so long as not to lead to Jerusalem, and of this Della Valle was to make proof. He embarks at Venice in 1614, passes thirteen months at Constantinople, reaches Alexandria by sea, afterwards Cairo, and joins a caravan which at length brings him to Jerusalem. But while en route, Delia Valle had no doubt imbibed a taste for a traveller's life, for he visits in succession Baghdad, Damascus, Aleppo, and even pushes on as far as the ruins of Babylon. We must believe that Della Valle was marked out as an easy prey to love, for upon his return he becomes enamoured of a young Christian woman of Mardin, of wondrous beauty, whom he marries. One would imagine that here at length is fixed the destiny of this indefatigable traveller. Nothing of the kind. Della Valle contrives to accompany the Shah in his war against the Turks, and to traverse during four consecutive years the provinces of Iran. He quits Ispahan in 1621, loses his wife in the month of December of the same year, causes her to be embalmed, and has her coffin carried about in his train for four years longer, which he devotes to exploring Ormuz, the western coasts of India, the Persian Gulf, Aleppo, and Syria, landing at length at Naples in 1626.
While the honest citizen François Pyrard, was, in a way, caught up in adventures that took up much of his life because he couldn’t resist the desire to make a fortune too quickly, a different and more romantic set of circumstances led Pietro della Valle to embark on a journey. Coming from an ancient and noble family, he served as a soldier for the Pope and later became a sailor chasing Barbary pirates. When he returned to Rome, he discovered that a rival had taken his place with a young woman he was supposed to marry while he was away. This huge misfortune called for a bold response, prompting Della Valle to vow a pilgrimage to the Holy Sepulchre. The saying goes that all roads lead to Rome, but there’s no detour that doesn’t end up in Jerusalem, and Della Valle was about to experience this. He set sail from Venice in 1614, spent thirteen months in Constantinople, traveled by sea to Alexandria, then to Cairo, and joined a caravan that finally brought him to Jerusalem. On his journey, Della Valle surely developed a taste for a traveler’s life, as he went on to visit Baghdad, Damascus, Aleppo, and even ventured as far as the ruins of Babylon. It seems Della Valle was destined to fall in love, because upon his return he became infatuated with a stunning young Christian woman from Mardin and married her. You might think that this would finally settle the restless spirit of the traveler, but that wasn’t the case. Della Valle managed to accompany the Shah in his war against the Turks and traveled through the provinces of Iran for four consecutive years. He left Ispahan in 1621, lost his wife that December, had her embalmed, and carried her coffin with him for four more years, which he spent exploring Ormuz, the western coasts of India, the Persian Gulf, Aleppo, and Syria, finally arriving in Naples in 1626.
The countries which this singular character visited, urged on as he was by an extraordinary enthusiasm, are described by him in a shrewd, gay, and natural style, and even with some degree of fidelity. But he inaugurates the pleiad of amateur, curious, and commercial travellers. He is the first of that prolific race of tourists who each year encumber geographical literature with numerous volumes, from which the savant finds nothing to glean beyond meagre details.
The countries this unique person explored, driven by an intense passion, are described by him in a clever, cheerful, and straightforward way, and even with some accuracy. But he kicks off the trend of amateur, curious, and commercial travelers. He is the first of that prolific group of tourists who every year fill geographical literature with numerous books, from which experts find little more than sparse details.
Tavernier is a specimen of insatiable curiosity. At two-and-twenty he has traversed France, England, the Low Countries, Germany, Switzerland, Poland, Hungary, and Italy. Then when Europe no longer offers any food for his curiosity, he starts for Constantinople, where he remains for a year, and then arrives in Persia, where the opportunity and
Tavernier is a person with an unquenchable thirst for knowledge. At just 22, he has traveled through France, England, the Low Countries, Germany, Switzerland, Poland, Hungary, and Italy. When Europe no longer provides any new experiences for him, he sets off to Constantinople, where he stays for a year, and then he heads to Persia, where the opportunity and
he sets to work to purchase carpets, stuffs, precious stones, and those thousand trifles of which lovers of curiosities soon became passionately fond, and for which they were ready to pay fabulous sums. The profit which Tavernier realized from his cargo induced him to resume his travels. But like a wise and prudent man, before starting he learnt from a jeweller the art of knowing precious stones. During four successive journeys from 1638 to 1663, he travelled over Persia, the Mogul Empire, the Indies as far as the frontier of China, and the Islands of Sunda. Dazzled by the immense fortune which his traffic had obtained for him, Tavernier would play the lord, and soon saw himself on the verge of ruin, which he hoped to avert by sending one of his nephews to the east with a considerable venture, but instead, his ruin was consummated by this young man, who, judging it best to appropriate the goods which had been confided to him, settled down at Ispahan. Tavernier, who was a well-educated man, made a number of interesting observations upon the history, manners and customs, of the countries which he visited. His narrative certainly contributed to give his contemporaries a much more correct idea of the countries of the east than they previously possessed.
He got to work buying carpets, fabrics, precious stones, and all those little items that collectors quickly became obsessed with, for which they were willing to pay outrageous amounts. The profit Tavernier made from his shipments encouraged him to travel again. But being wise and cautious, he first learned from a jeweler how to identify precious stones. Over four trips from 1638 to 1663, he journeyed through Persia, the Mughal Empire, the Indies as far as the Chinese border, and the Sunda Islands. Blinded by the vast wealth his trade had brought him, Tavernier started to act like a wealthy gentleman, only to find himself on the brink of disaster. He tried to prevent this by sending one of his nephews to the east with a significant investment, but instead, this nephew decided to steal the goods entrusted to him and settled down in Isfahan. Tavernier, an educated man, made numerous intriguing observations about the history, customs, and culture of the places he visited. His writings certainly gave his contemporaries a much clearer understanding of the Eastern countries than they had before.
All travellers during the reign of Louis XIV. take the route to the East Indies, whatever may be the end they have in view. Africa is entirely deserted, and if America be the theatre of any real exploration, it is carried out without aid from government.
All travelers during the reign of Louis XIV take the route to the East Indies, regardless of their destination. Africa is completely uninhabited, and if America is the site of any genuine exploration, it happens without government support.
Whilst Tavernier was accomplishing his last and distant excursions, a distinguished archæologist, Jean de Thévenot, nephew of Melchisedec Thévenot—a learned man to whom we owe an interesting series of travels—journeyed through Europe, and visited Malta, Constantinople, Egypt, Tunis, and Italy. He brought back in 1661 an important collection of medals and monumental inscriptions, recognized nowadays as so important a help to the historian and the philologist. In 1664, he set out anew for the Levant, and visited Persia, Bassorah, Surat, and India, where he saw Masulipatam, Burhampur, Aurungabad, and Golconda. But the fatigues which he had experienced prevented his return to Europe, and he died in Armenia in 1667. The success of his narratives was considerable, and was well deserved by the care and exactitude of a traveller whose scientific attainments in history, geography, and mathematics, far surpassed the average level of his contemporaries.
While Tavernier was carrying out his last and distant travels, a notable archaeologist, Jean de Thévenot, who was the nephew of Melchisedec Thévenot—a knowledgeable man to whom we owe an interesting series of travels—traveled through Europe and visited Malta, Constantinople, Egypt, Tunis, and Italy. In 1661, he returned with an important collection of medals and monumental inscriptions, which are now recognized as a crucial resource for historians and philologists. In 1664, he set out again for the Levant and visited Persia, Basra, Surat, and India, where he saw Masulipatam, Burhampur, Aurangabad, and Golconda. However, the hardships he endured prevented him from returning to Europe, and he died in Armenia in 1667. The success of his writings was significant and well-deserved due to the care and precision of a traveler whose scholarly achievements in history, geography, and mathematics greatly surpassed the average level of his contemporaries.
We must now speak of the amiable Bernier, the "pretty philosopher," as he was entitled in his polite circle, in which were found Ninon and La Fontaine, Madame de la Sablière, St. Evremont, and Chapelle, without reckoning many other good and gay spirits, refractories from the stiff solemnity which then weighed upon the entourage of Louis XIV. Bernier could not escape from the fashion of travelling. After having taken a rapid survey of Syria and Egypt, he resided for twelve years in India, where his good knowledge of medicine conciliated the favour of Aurung-Zebe, and gave him the opportunity of beholding in detail, and with profit, an empire then in the full bloom of its prosperity.
We now need to talk about the charming Bernier, the "pretty philosopher," as he was known in his polite circle, which included Ninon, La Fontaine, Madame de la Sablière, St. Evremont, and Chapelle, along with many other good-natured and lively individuals who preferred a more relaxed atmosphere over the rigid seriousness that surrounded Louis XIV. Bernier wasn't able to resist the trend of traveling. After quickly touring Syria and Egypt, he spent twelve years in India, where his solid understanding of medicine won him the favor of Aurung-Zebe and allowed him to witness the details of an empire that was thriving at the time.
To the south of Hindostan, Ceylon had more than one surprise in reserve for its explorers. Robert Knox, taken prisoner by the natives, owed to this sad circumstance his long residence in the country and the collection of the first authentic documents relating to the forests and the savage natives of Ceylon, the Dutch, with a commercial jealousy which they were not singular in evincing, having until now kept secret all the information which had come to light concerning an island of which they were endeavouring to make a colony.
To the south of Hindostan, Ceylon had more than one surprise in store for its explorers. Robert Knox, who was captured by the locals, spent a long time in the country because of this unfortunate situation, and he gathered the first reliable records about the forests and the wild inhabitants of Ceylon. The Dutch, driven by a commercial rivalry that many shared, had kept all the information about the island hidden while trying to establish it as a colony.
![]() |
Jean Chardin. From an old print. |
Another merchant, Jean Chardin, the son of a rich Parisian jeweller, jealous of the successes of Tavernier, desired, like him, to make his fortune by trading in diamonds. The countries which attract these merchants are those of which the fame for wealth and prosperity is become proverbial; these are Persia and India, where rich costumes sparkle with jewels and gold, and where there are mines of diamonds of a fabulous size. The moment is well chosen for visiting these countries. Thanks to the Mogul Emperors, civilization and art have been developed; mosques, palaces, temples have been built, and towns have risen suddenly. Their taste—that curious taste, so distinctly characterized, so different from our own,—is displayed in the construction of gigantic edifices, quite as much as in jewellery and goldsmith's work, and in the manufacture of those costly trifles of which the east was beginning to be passionately fond. Like a wise man, Chardin takes a partner, as good a connoisseur as himself. At first Chardin only traversed Persia in order to reach Ormuz and to embark for the Indies. The following year he returns to Ispahan, and applies himself to learn the language of the country, in order to be able to transact business directly and without any intermediary agent. He has the good fortune to please the Shah, Abbas II. From that time his fortune is made, for it is at once genteel and also the part of a prudent courtier to employ the same purveyor as his sovereign. But Chardin had another merit besides that of making a fortune. He was able to collect so considerable a mass of information concerning the government, manners, creeds, customs, towns, and populations of Persia, that his narrative has remained to our own days the vade-mecum of the traveller. This guide is so much the more precious because Chardin took care to engage at Constantinople a clever draughtsman named Grelot, by whom were reproduced the monuments, cities, scenes, costumes, and ceremonies which so well portray what Chardin called, "the every day of a people."
Another merchant, Jean Chardin, the son of a wealthy Parisian jeweler, was envious of Tavernier’s successes and wanted to make his fortune by trading in diamonds, just like him. The countries that attracted these merchants were known for their wealth and prosperity, especially Persia and India, where bright costumes shimmer with jewels and gold, and where there are fabulously large diamond mines. It was a great time to visit these places. Thanks to the Mogul Emperors, civilization and art flourished; mosques, palaces, and temples were built, and towns sprang up quickly. Their unique taste—so distinctly different from ours—was evident in the construction of massive buildings, as well as in jewelry and goldsmithing, and in the creation of those luxurious items that the East was becoming increasingly fond of. Like a wise man, Chardin took on a partner who was just as knowledgeable as he was. Initially, Chardin only traveled through Persia to reach Ormuz and board a ship to the Indies. The following year, he returned to Ispahan to learn the local language, so he could do business directly without a middleman. He was fortunate to win over Shah Abbas II. From that point on, his fortune was secured, as it was both fashionable and smart for a respectable courtier to use the same supplier as the king. But Chardin had another important quality beyond just making money. He managed to gather a significant amount of information about the government, customs, beliefs, traditions, towns, and people of Persia, making his narrative a lasting vade-mecum for travelers even today. This guide is particularly valuable because Chardin hired a talented draftsman named Grelot in Constantinople, who illustrated the monuments, cities, landscapes, outfits, and ceremonies that vividly captured what Chardin referred to as "the everyday life of a people."
When Chardin returned to France in 1670, the Revocation of the Edict of Nantes, with the barbarous persecutions which resulted from it, had chased from their country great numbers of artisans, who, taking refuge in foreign countries enriched them with our arts and manufactures. Chardin, being a protestant, clearly perceived that his religion would hinder him from attaining "to what are termed honours and advancement." As, to use his own words, "one is not free to believe what one will," he resolved to return to the Indies "where, without being urged to a change of religion," he could not fail of attaining an honourable position. Thus liberty of conscience was at that period greater in Persia than in France. Such an assertion on the part of a man who had made the comparison, is but little flattering to the grandson of Henry IV.
When Chardin returned to France in 1670, the Revocation of the Edict of Nantes, along with the brutal persecutions that followed, had driven many artisans out of the country. These artisans took refuge in foreign lands, where they enriched those countries with our skills and crafts. As a Protestant, Chardin understood that his faith would prevent him from achieving "what are called honors and advancement." As he put it, "one is not free to believe what one will," so he decided to return to the Indies "where, without being pressured to change his religion," he was sure to attain a respectable position. At that time, the freedom of conscience was actually greater in Persia than in France. Such a statement from someone who had made that comparison is not very flattering to the grandson of Henry IV.
This time, however, Chardin did not follow the same route as before. He passed by Smyrna and Constantinople, and from thence, crossing the Black Sea, he landed in the Crimea, in the garb of a religious. Whilst passing through the region of the Caucasus he had the opportunity of studying the Abkasians and Circassians. He afterwards penetrated into Mingrelia, where he was robbed of his goods and papers, and of a portion of the jewels which he was taking back to Europe. He could not have escaped himself had it not been for the devotion to him of the theatines, from whom he had received hospitality, but he escaped only to fall into the hands of the Turks, who, in their turn, accepted a ransom for him. After further misadventures he arrived at Tiflis on the 17th of December, 1672, and as Georgia was then governed by a prince who was a tributary of the Shah of Persia, it was easy for Chardin to reach Erivan, Tauriz, and finally Ispahan.
This time, though, Chardin didn’t take the same route as before. He went by Smyrna and Constantinople, and then crossed the Black Sea to land in Crimea, dressed as a religious figure. While traveling through the Caucasus region, he had the chance to study the Abkasians and Circassians. He later ventured into Mingrelia, where he was robbed of his belongings and papers, as well as some jewels that he was bringing back to Europe. He might not have made it out if it weren’t for the kindness of the Theatines, who had offered him hospitality, but he only escaped to find himself in the hands of the Turks, who in turn accepted a ransom for him. After more misadventures, he reached Tiflis on December 17, 1672, and since Georgia was then ruled by a prince who was a vassal of the Shah of Persia, it was easy for Chardin to get to Erivan, Tauriz, and finally Ispahan.
After a stay of four years in Persia, and a concluding journey to India, during which he realized a considerable fortune, Chardin returned to Europe and settled in England, his own country on account of his religion, being forbidden ground to him.
After spending four years in Persia, and taking a final trip to India where he made a nice fortune, Chardin returned to Europe and settled in England, since his own country was off-limits to him because of his religion.
The journal of his travels forms a large work, in which everything that concerns Persia is especially developed. The long stay he made in the country and his intimate acquaintance with the highest personages of the state enabled him to collect numerous and authentic documents. It may fairly be said that in this way Persia was better known in the seventeenth century than it was 100 years later.
The journal of his travels is a substantial work that goes into detail about everything related to Persia. His extended time in the country and his close relationships with the top officials allowed him to gather many accurate and reliable documents. It's reasonable to say that, in this way, Persia was better understood in the seventeenth century than it was a century later.
The countries which Chardin had just explored were visited again some years later by a Dutch painter, Cornelius de Bruyn, or Le Brun. The great value of his work consists in the beauty and accuracy of the drawings which illustrate it, for as far as the text is concerned, it contains nothing which was not known before, except in what relates to the Samoyedes, whom he was the first to visit.
The countries that Chardin had recently explored were revisited a few years later by a Dutch painter, Cornelius de Bruyn, or Le Brun. The true worth of his work lies in the beauty and precision of the drawings that accompany it, since the text itself doesn’t offer any new information except for what pertains to the Samoyedes, whom he was the first to encounter.
![]() |
Japanese Warrior. From an old print. |
We must now speak of the Westphalian, Kæmpfer, almost a naturalized Swede in consequence of his long sojourn in Scandinavian countries. He refused the brilliant position which was there offered him in order to accompany as secretary, an ambassador who was going to Moscow. He was thus enabled to see the principal cities of Russia, a country which at that period had scarcely entered upon the path of western civilization; afterwards he went to Persia, where he quitted the Ambassador Fabricius, in order to enter the service of the Dutch Company of the Indies, and to continue his travels. He thus visited in the first place Persepolis, Shiraz, Ormuz upon the Persian Gulf, where he was extremely ill, and whence he embarked in 1688 for the East Indies. Arabia Felix, India, the Malabar Coast, Ceylon, Java, Sumatra, and Japan were afterwards all visited by him. The object of these journeys was exclusively scientific. Kæmpfer was a physician, but was more especially devoted to the various branches of Natural History, and collected, described, drew, or dried, a considerable number of plants then unknown in Europe, gave new information upon their use in medicine or manufactures, and collected an immense herbarium, which is now preserved with the greater part of his manuscripts in the British Museum in London. But the most interesting portion of his narrative, now-a-days indeed quite obsolete and very incomplete since the country has been opened up to our scientific men,—was for a long time that relating to Japan. He had contrived to procure books treating of the history, literature, and learning of the country, when he had failed in obtaining from certain personages to whom he had rendered himself very acceptable, information which was not usually imparted to foreigners.
We now need to talk about Kæmpfer, who was almost a naturalized Swede due to his long stay in Scandinavian countries. He turned down a prestigious position that was offered to him there so he could go as a secretary with an ambassador headed to Moscow. This allowed him to see the main cities of Russia, a country that at that time had barely begun to embrace western civilization. Afterward, he traveled to Persia, where he left Ambassador Fabricius to join the Dutch East India Company and continue his travels. His first stops included Persepolis, Shiraz, and Ormuz on the Persian Gulf, where he got very sick, and from there he set sail in 1688 for the East Indies. He later visited Arabia Felix, India, the Malabar Coast, Ceylon, Java, Sumatra, and Japan. The purpose of these journeys was purely scientific. Kæmpfer was a physician but was particularly interested in various fields of Natural History, collecting, describing, illustrating, or drying a significant number of plants that were unknown in Europe at the time. He provided new insights on their uses in medicine or manufacturing and gathered an extensive herbarium, which is now kept, along with most of his manuscripts, at the British Museum in London. The most intriguing part of his account, which today seems quite outdated and incomplete since the country has become accessible to our scientists, was for a long time his account of Japan. He managed to obtain books about the country's history, literature, and education when he had difficulty getting information from certain individuals who he had befriended, information that was not usually shared with foreigners.
To conclude, if all the travellers of whom we have just spoken are not strictly speaking discoverers, if they do not explore countries unknown before, they all have, in various degrees and according to their ability or their studies, the merit of having rendered the countries which they visited better known. Besides they were able to banish to the domain of fable, many of the tales which others less learned had naïvely accepted, and which had for long become so completely public property that nobody dreamed of disputing them.
To sum up, while the travelers we’ve just mentioned aren’t technically discoverers and didn’t explore completely unknown lands, they each played a role in making the places they visited more familiar. Plus, they were able to dismiss many myths that others, who were less knowledgeable, had naively accepted, and which had become so widely accepted that no one thought to challenge them.
Thanks to these travellers, something is known of the history of the east, the migrations of nations began to be dimly suspected, and accounts to be given of the changes in those great empires of which the very existence had been long problematical.
Thanks to these travelers, we now know something about the history of the east, the migrations of nations started to be vaguely understood, and reports began to emerge about the changes in those great empires whose very existence had long been uncertain.
CHAPTER VI.
THE GREAT CORSAIR.
William Dampier; or a Sea-King of the Seventeenth Century.
William Dampier; or a Sea King of the Seventeenth Century.
William Dampier was born in 1612 at East Coker, and by the death of his parents was from his childhood left to his own control. Not possessing any great taste for study, he preferred running wild in the woods, and fighting with his companions, to remaining in his place on the school benches. While still young he was sent to sea as cabin-boy on board merchant ships. After a voyage to Newfoundland and a campaign in the East Indies, he took service in the Naval Marine, and being wounded in a battle, returned to Greenwich to be nursed. Free from any prejudices, Dampier forgot his engagement when he left the Military Hospital, and started for Jamaica in the position of manager of a plantation. It did not require a long trial to discover that this occupation was not to his taste. So he abandoned his negroes at the end of six months, and went on board a ship bound for the Bay of Campeachy, where he worked for three years at gathering in woods for dyeing.
William Dampier was born in 1612 in East Coker, and after his parents passed away, he was left to fend for himself from a young age. Not really into studying, he preferred to roam the woods and get into fights with his friends rather than sit in a classroom. When he was still young, he was sent to sea as a cabin boy on merchant ships. After a trip to Newfoundland and a stint in the East Indies, he joined the Naval Marine, where he got wounded in battle and returned to Greenwich for recovery. Without any biases holding him back, Dampier forgot about his commitments when he left the Military Hospital and headed to Jamaica to manage a plantation. It didn't take long for him to realize this job wasn't for him. So, after six months, he left his workers behind and boarded a ship heading to the Bay of Campeachy, where he spent three years gathering wood for dyeing.
At the end of that period he is again found in London, but the laws and the officers charged with compelling their observance are too strict for his comfort. He goes back to Jamaica, where he speedily puts himself into communication with those famous buccaneers and corsairs, who at that time did so much harm to the Spaniards.
At the end of that time, he is once again in London, but the laws and the officials enforcing them are too strict for his liking. He returns to Jamaica, where he quickly connects with those well-known pirates and privateers who were causing a lot of trouble for the Spaniards at that time.
These English or French adventurers, established in the Island of Tortuga, off the coast of San Domingo, had sworn implacable hatred to Spain. Their ravages were not confined to the Gulf of Mexico: they crossed the Isthmus of Panama and devastated the coast of the Pacific Ocean from the Strait of Magellan to California. Terror exaggerated the exploits of these pirates, which however presented something of the marvellous.
These English and French adventurers, settled on the island of Tortuga off the coast of San Domingo, had vowed a deep hatred for Spain. Their destruction wasn’t limited to the Gulf of Mexico; they crossed the Isthmus of Panama and devastated the Pacific coast from the Strait of Magellan to California. Fear amplified the stories of these pirates, which were, nonetheless, quite remarkable.
It was amongst these adventurers, then commanded by Harris, Sawkins, and Shays, that Dampier enrolled himself. In 1680 we find him in Darien, where he pillages Santa Maria, endeavours in vain to surprise Panama, and with his companions, on board of some wretched canoes stolen from the Indians, captures eight vessels well armed, which were at anchor not far from the town. In this affair the losses of the corsairs are so great in the fight, and the spoil is so poor, that they separate from each other. Some go back to the Gulf of Mexico, while others establish themselves upon the island of Juan Fernandez, whence shortly after they attack Arica. But here again they were so roughly handled that a new secession takes place, and Dampier is sent to Virginia, where his captain hoped to make some recruits. There Captain Cook was fitting out a vessel, with the intention of reaching the Pacific by the Strait of Magellan, and Dampier joins the expedition. It begins by privateering upon the African coast, in the Cape de Verd Islands, at Sierra Leone, and in the River Scherborough, for this is the route habitually taken by the ships going to South America. In 36° south latitude, Dampier, who notes in his journal every interesting fact, remarks that the sea is become white or rather pale, but of this he cannot explain the reason, which he might easily have done had he made use of the microscope. The Sebaldine Islands are passed without incident, the Strait of Le Maire is traversed, Cape Horn is doubled on the 6th February, 1684, and as soon as he can escape from the storms which usually assail ships entering the Pacific, Captain Cook arrives at the island of Juan Fernandez, where he hopes to revictual. Dampier wondered if he would find a Nicaraguan Indian there, who had been left behind in 1680 by Captain Sharp. "This Indian had remained alone upon the island for more than three years. He had been in the woods hunting goats when the English captain had ordered his men to re-embark, and they had set sail without perceiving his absence. He had only his gun and his knife, with a small horn of powder and a little lead; when his powder and lead were exhausted he had contrived to saw the barrel of his gun into small pieces with his knife, and out of them to make harpoons, spears, fish hooks and a long knife. With these instruments he obtained all the supplies which the island afforded: goats and fish. At the distance of half a mile from the sea, he had a small hut covered with goat skins. He had no clothes left, but an animal's skin covered his loins." We have dwelt at some length upon this involuntary hermit because he served Daniel de Foe as the original of his "Robinson Crusoe," a romance which has formed the delight of every child.
It was among these adventurers, led by Harris, Sawkins, and Shays, that Dampier joined. In 1680, we find him in Darien, where he loots Santa Maria, tries unsuccessfully to ambush Panama, and along with his companions, captures eight well-armed vessels anchored near the town using some poorly made canoes stolen from the Indians. In this operation, the corsairs suffer heavy losses in the battle, and the loot is minimal, causing them to split up. Some head back to the Gulf of Mexico, while others settle on Juan Fernandez Island, from where they soon attack Arica. However, they are again dealt a harsh blow, leading to another split, and Dampier is sent to Virginia, where his captain hopes to recruit new members. There, Captain Cook is preparing a vessel to reach the Pacific through the Strait of Magellan, and Dampier joins the mission. They start by privateering along the African coast, in the Cape Verde Islands, Sierra Leone, and the Scherborough River, as this is the usual route for ships heading to South America. At 36° south latitude, Dampier, who records every interesting detail in his journal, notes that the sea has turned white, or rather pale, but he can't explain why, although he could have easily done so with a microscope. The Sebaldine Islands are passed without incident, the Strait of Le Maire is crossed, and Cape Horn is rounded on February 6, 1684. Once they escape the storms that typically hit ships entering the Pacific, Captain Cook reaches Juan Fernandez Island, hoping to resupply. Dampier wonders if he would find a Nicaraguan Indian there who had been left behind in 1680 by Captain Sharp. “This Indian had been alone on the island for over three years. He was hunting goats in the woods when the English captain ordered his men to re-embark, and they sailed away without noticing he was missing. All he had was his gun and knife, a small horn of powder, and a bit of lead; when his powder and lead ran out, he managed to saw his gun barrel into small pieces with his knife and made harpoons, spears, fish hooks, and a long knife. With these tools, he gathered all the supplies the island offered: goats and fish. Half a mile from the sea, he had a small hut covered with goat skins. He had no clothes left, just an animal's skin covering his waist.” We have spent some time discussing this involuntary hermit because he served as the inspiration for Daniel Defoe's "Robinson Crusoe," a tale that has captivated every child.
We shall not relate minutely all the expeditions in which Dampier participated. Suffice it to mention that in this campaign he visited the Gallapagos Islands. In 1686, Dampier was serving on board of Captain Swan's ship, who, seeing that the greater part of his enterprises failed, went to the East Indies, where the Spaniards were less upon their guard, and where the corsairs reckoned upon seizing the Manilla galleon. But when our adventurers arrived at Guaham, they had only three days' provisions, and the sailors had plotted if the voyage should be prolonged, to eat in turn all those who had declared themselves in favour of the voyage, and to begin with the captain who had proposed it. Dampier's turn would have come next. "Thus it came to pass," says he very humourously, "that after having cast anchor at Guaham, Swan embraced him and said: 'Ah Dampier, you would have made them but a sorry meal.' He was right," he adds, "for I was as thin and lean, as he was fat and plump." Mindanao, Manilla, certain parts of the Chinese coasts, the Moluccas, New Holland, and the Nicobar Islands, were the places visited and plundered by Dampier in this campaign. In the last-named archipelago he became separated from his companions, and was discovered half dead upon the coast of Sumatra.
We won't go into detail about all the expeditions Dampier took part in. It’s enough to mention that during this campaign he visited the Galapagos Islands. In 1686, Dampier was on Captain Swan's ship, who, seeing that most of his ventures failed, went to the East Indies, where the Spaniards were less cautious and where the pirates hoped to seize the Manila galleon. But when our adventurers reached Guam, they only had three days' worth of supplies, and the sailors had plotted that if the journey lasted too long, they would take turns eating those who supported the voyage, starting with the captain who suggested it. Dampier would have been next in line. "Thus it came to pass," he humorously notes, "that after anchoring at Guam, Swan embraced him and said, 'Ah Dampier, you would have made them a pretty sorry meal.' He was right," he adds, "because I was as thin and lean as he was fat and plump." Mindanao, Manila, parts of the Chinese coast, the Moluccas, New Holland, and the Nicobar Islands were the locations Dampier visited and pillaged during this campaign. In the last archipelago mentioned, he got separated from his crew and was found half-dead on the coast of Sumatra.
![]() |
"Ah! Dampier, you would have afforded them but a sorry meal." |
During this voyage, Dampier had discovered several hitherto unknown islands, and especially the Baschi group. Like the thorough adventurer he was, immediately he recovered his health he travelled over the south of Asia, Malacca, Tonkin, Madras, and Bencoolen, where he enrolled himself as an artilleryman in the English service. Five months afterwards he deserted and returned to London. The narrative of his adventures and his privateering obtained for him a certain amount of sympathy amongst the higher classes, and he was presented to the Earl of Oxford, Lord High Admiral. He speedily received the command of the ship Roebuck to attempt a voyage of discovery in the seas which he had already explored. He left England on the 14th January, 1699, with the intention of passing through the Strait of Magellan, or of making the tour of Tierra del Fuego, so as to commence his discoveries on the coasts of the Pacific, which had hitherto received the visits of a comparatively small number of travellers. After crossing the line on the 10th March, he sailed for Brazil, where the ship was revictualled. Far from being able again to descend the coast of Patagonia, he beheld himself driven by the wind to forty-eight miles south of the Cape of Good Hope, whence he steered east-south-east towards New Holland, a long passage which was not signalized by any adventure. On the 1st August, Dampier saw land, and at once sought for a harbour in which to land. Five days later he entered the Bay of Sea-Dogs upon the western coast of Australia; but he only found there a sterile soil, and met with neither water nor vegetation. Until the 31st August, he sailed along this coast without discovering what he sought. Once when he landed, he had a slight skirmish with some of the inhabitants, who seemed to be very thinly scattered over the country. Their chief was a young man of middle height, but quick and vigilant; his eyes were surrounded by a single ring of white paint, while a stripe of the same colour descended from the top of his forehead to the end of his nose; his chest and arms were likewise striped with white. His companions were black, fierce in aspect, their hair woolly, and in shape they were tall and slender.
During this journey, Dampier discovered several previously unknown islands, especially the Baschi group. True to his adventurous spirit, as soon as he regained his health, he traveled through southern Asia, Malacca, Tonkin, Madras, and Bencoolen, where he joined the English military as an artilleryman. Five months later, he deserted and returned to London. His stories of adventure and privateering garnered him some sympathy among the upper classes, and he was introduced to the Earl of Oxford, the Lord High Admiral. He quickly received command of the ship Roebuck to embark on a voyage of discovery in the seas he had already explored. He left England on January 14, 1699, intending to either pass through the Strait of Magellan or sail around Tierra del Fuego, so he could start his discoveries along the Pacific coasts, which had previously seen only a handful of visitors. After crossing the equator on March 10, he sailed to Brazil, where the ship was restocked. Instead of heading down the coast of Patagonia, he found himself pushed by the wind 48 miles south of the Cape of Good Hope, from where he headed east-southeast toward New Holland, a lengthy journey that was uneventful. On August 1, Dampier spotted land and immediately searched for a harbor to dock. Five days later, he entered the Bay of Sea-Dogs on the western coast of Australia, but found only barren land without water or vegetation. He sailed along this coast until August 31 without finding what he was looking for. Once, when he went ashore, he had a brief clash with some of the local inhabitants, who appeared very few in number. Their chief was a young man of average height but was quick and alert; his eyes were surrounded by a single ring of white paint, and a stripe of the same color ran from the top of his forehead to the tip of his nose; his chest and arms were also striped with white. His companions were tall and slender, with fierce looks and woolly hair.
For five weeks Dampier hovered near land, and found neither water nor provisions; however, he would not give in, and intended to continue to ascend the coast northwards, but the shallows which he incessantly encountered, and the monsoon from the north-west which was soon due, obliged him to give up the enterprise, after having discovered more than 900 miles of the Australian continent. He afterwards steered towards Timor, where he intended to repose and recruit his crew, exhausted by the long voyage. But he knew little of these parts, and his charts were quite insufficient. He was therefore obliged to make a reconnaissance of it, as if the Dutch had not already been long settled there. Thus he discovered a passage between Timor and Anamabao, in a locality in which his map only indicated a bay. The arrival of Dampier in a port known only to themselves, astonished and greatly displeased the Dutch. They imagined that the English could only have reached it by means of charts taken on board a ship of their own. However, in the end they recovered from their fright and received the strangers with kindness.
For five weeks, Dampier stayed close to shore, finding neither water nor supplies. Still, he refused to give up and planned to keep moving north along the coast. However, the shallow waters he continually faced and the approaching northwestern monsoon forced him to abandon his mission, after mapping more than 900 miles of the Australian coastline. He then headed towards Timor, intending to rest and replenish his crew, who were worn out from the long journey. But he didn't know much about the area, and his maps were inadequate. Therefore, he had to explore it as if the Dutch hadn’t already been established there for a long time. He discovered a passage between Timor and Anamabao, in a place where his map only showed a bay. The Dutch were shocked and very annoyed by Dampier's arrival in a port they thought was known only to them. They assumed the English could only have found it using charts from their own ship. However, they eventually calmed down and welcomed the newcomers with kindness.
Although the precursors of the monsoon were making themselves felt, Dampier again put to sea, and steered towards the western coast of New Guinea, where he arrived on the 4th February, 1700, near to Cape Maho of the Dutch. Amongst the things which struck him, Dampier notices the prodigious quantities of a species of pigeon, bats of extraordinary size, and scallops, a kind of shell fish, of which the empty shell weighed as much as 258 lbs. On the 7th of February he approaches King William's Island and runs to the east, where he soon sights the Cape of Good Hope of Schouten, and the island named after that navigator. On the 24th the crew witnessed a curious spectacle: "Two fish, which had accompanied the vessel for five or six days, perceived a great sea serpent, and began to pursue it. They were about the shape and size of mackerel, but yellow and green in colour. The serpent, who fled from them with great swiftness, carried his head out of the water, and one of them attempted to seize his tail. As soon as he turned round, the first fish remained in the rear, and the other took his place. They retained their wind for a long time, always heedful to defend themselves by flight, until they were lost to view."
Although the early signs of the monsoon were starting to show, Dampier set out to sea again and headed towards the western coast of New Guinea, arriving on February 4, 1700, near Cape Maho in Dutch territory. Among the things he noticed, Dampier highlighted the enormous numbers of a type of pigeon, bats that were extraordinarily large, and scallops, a type of shellfish, whose empty shells weighed as much as 258 lbs. On February 7, he approached King William's Island and went east, soon spotting Schouten's Cape of Good Hope and the island named after the explorer. On the 24th, the crew witnessed an intriguing sight: "Two fish, which had been following the vessel for five or six days, saw a large sea serpent and began to chase it. They were shaped and sized like mackerel but were yellow and green. The serpent, which fled from them quickly, raised its head out of the water, and one of the fish tried to grab its tail. As soon as it turned around, the first fish fell back, and the other took its place. They conserved their energy for a long time, always careful to escape, until they disappeared from sight."
On the 25th, Dampier gave the name of Saint Matthias to a mountainous island, thirty miles long, situated above and to the east of the Admiralty Islands. Further on at the distance of twenty-one or twenty-four miles, he discovered another island, which received the name of Squally Island, on account of violent whirlwinds which prevented him from landing upon it. Dampier believed himself to be on the coast of New Guinea, while he was in reality sailing along that of New Ireland. He endeavoured to land there, but he was surrounded by canoes carrying more than 200 natives, and the shore was covered by a large crowd. Seeing that it would be imprudent to send a boat on shore, Dampier ordered the ship to be put about. Scarcely was the order given, when the ship was assailed by showers of stones, which the natives hurled from a machine of which Dampier could not discover the shape, but which caused the name of Slingers' Bay to be given to this locality. A single discharge of cannon stupefied the natives, and put an end to hostilities. A little further on, at some distance from the coast of New Ireland, the English discover the Islands of Denis and St. John. Dampier is the first to pass through the strait which separates New Ireland from New Britain, and discovers Vulcan, Crown, G. Rook, Long Reach and Burning Islands.
On the 25th, Dampier named a mountainous island Saint Matthias; it was thirty miles long and located to the east of the Admiralty Islands. A bit farther on, about twenty-one to twenty-four miles away, he found another island that he called Squally Island because of the fierce winds that kept him from landing. Dampier thought he was along the coast of New Guinea, but he was actually sailing along New Ireland's coast. He tried to land there, but more than 200 natives surrounded his ship in canoes, and a large crowd gathered on the shore. Realizing it would be unwise to send a boat ashore, Dampier ordered the ship to turn around. Just after the order was given, the ship was bombarded with stones that the natives fired from a machine whose design Dampier couldn't figure out, leading to the area being named Slingers' Bay. A single cannon shot stunned the natives and ended the conflict. A little further along, away from the coast of New Ireland, the English discovered the Islands of Denis and St. John. Dampier was the first to navigate the strait separating New Ireland from New Britain and discovered the Vulcan, Crown, G. Rook, Long Reach, and Burning Islands.
![]() |
Battle in Slingers' Bay. |
After this long cruise, distinguished by important discoveries, Dampier again steered towards the west, reached Missory Island, and at length arrived at the Island of Ceram, one of the Moluccas, where he made a somewhat long stay. He went afterwards to Borneo, passed through the Strait of Macassar, and on the 23rd of June anchored at Batavia, in the Island of Java. He remained there until the 17th of October, when he set out for Europe. On arriving at the Island of Ascension on the 23rd of February, 1701, his vessel had so considerable a leak that it was impossible to stop it. It was necessary to run the ship aground and to put the crew and cargo on shore. Happily there was no want of water, turtles, goats, and land-crabs, which prevented any fear of dying of hunger before some ship should call at the island, and transport the shipwrecked sailors to their country. For this they had not long to wait, for on the 2nd of April an English vessel took them on board and carried them to England. We shall have occasion again to speak of Dampier with relation to the voyages of Wood Rodgers.
After this long journey filled with significant discoveries, Dampier headed west again, reached Missory Island, and finally arrived at the Island of Ceram, one of the Moluccas, where he stayed for a considerable time. He then moved on to Borneo, passed through the Strait of Macassar, and on June 23rd anchored at Batavia, on the Island of Java. He remained there until October 17th, when he set out for Europe. Upon reaching Ascension Island on February 23, 1701, his ship had such a severe leak that it couldn't be fixed. They had to run the ship aground and unload the crew and cargo. Fortunately, there was plenty of water, turtles, goats, and land crabs, which alleviated any fear of starving before another ship came to the island to take the shipwrecked sailors back home. They didn't have to wait long, as an English vessel picked them up on April 2nd and took them to England. We will have the opportunity to discuss Dampier again in relation to Wood Rodgers' voyages.
THE POLE AND AMERICA.
Hudson and Baffin—Champlain and La Sale—The English upon the coast of the Atlantic—The Spaniards in South America—Summary of the information acquired at the close of the 17th century—The measure of the terrestrial degree—Progress of cartography—Inauguration of Mathematical Geography.
Hudson and Baffin—Champlain and La Salle—The English on the Atlantic coast—The Spaniards in South America—Summary of the information gathered by the end of the 17th century—The measurement of the terrestrial degree—Advancements in cartography—The beginning of Mathematical Geography.
Although the attempts to find a passage by the north-west had been abandoned by the English for twenty years, they had not, however, given up the idea of seeking by that way, for a passage which was only to be discovered in our own days, and of which the absolute impracticability was then to be ascertained. A clever sailor, Henry Hudson, of whom Ellis says, "that never did any one better understand the seafaring profession, that his courage was equal to any emergency, and that his application was indefatigable," concluded an agreement with a company of merchants to search for the passage by the north-west. On the 1st of May, 1607, he sailed from Gravesend in the Hopewell, a craft about the size of one of the smallest of modern collier brigs, and having on board a crew of twelve men; and on the 13th of June, reached the eastern coast of Greenland at 73°, and gave it a name answering to the hopes he entertained, in calling it Cape Hold with Hope. The weather here was finer and less cold than it had been ten degrees southwards. By the 27th of June, Hudson had advanced 5° more to the north, but on the 2nd of July, by one of the sudden changes which so frequently occur in those countries, the cold became severe. The sea, however, remained free, the air was still, and drift wood floated about in large quantity. On the 14th of the same month, in 33° 23', the master's mate and the boatswain of the vessel landed upon a shore which formed the northern part of Spitzbergen. Traces of musk oxen, and foxes, great abundance of aquatic birds, two streams of fresh water, one of them being warm, proved to our navigators that it was possible to live in these extreme latitudes at this period of the year. Hudson, who had re-embarked without delay, found himself arrested at the height of 82°, by thick pack ice, which he endeavoured in vain to penetrate or sail round. He was compelled to return to England, where he arrived on September 15th, after having discovered an island, which is probably that of Jan Mayen. The route followed in this first voyage having had no result towards the north, Hudson would try another, and accordingly set sail on April 21st in the following year, and advanced between Spitzbergen and Nova Zembla; but he could only follow for a certain distance the coast of that vast land, without being able to attain as high an elevation as he had wished. The failure of this second attempt was more complete than that of the voyage of 1607. In consequence, the English Company, which had defrayed the expenses of both attempts, declined to proceed further. This was doubtless the reason which decided Hudson to take service in Holland.
Although the English had abandoned their efforts to find a northwest passage for twenty years, they hadn’t completely given up on the idea, especially since the passage would only be discovered in modern times, revealing its absolute impracticality. A skilled sailor, Henry Hudson, whom Ellis describes as "someone who truly understood the seafaring profession, whose courage matched any crisis, and whose diligence was tireless," made an agreement with a merchant company to search for this passage. On May 1, 1607, he set sail from Gravesend on the Hopewell, a vessel about the size of the smallest modern collier brigs, with a crew of twelve men. By June 13, he reached the eastern coast of Greenland at 73° and named it Cape Hold with Hope, reflecting his optimistic outlook. The weather was milder and less cold here than it had been ten degrees further south. By June 27, Hudson had progressed another 5° to the north, but on July 2, he experienced one of the sudden weather shifts typical of those regions, and the cold became intense. However, the sea remained clear, the air was calm, and there was a lot of driftwood floating around. On July 14, at 33° 23', the master’s mate and the boatswain landed on a shore in the northern part of Spitzbergen. They found signs of musk oxen and foxes, a large number of aquatic birds, and two streams of fresh water—one of which was warm—confirming to Hudson and his crew that it was possible to live in these extreme latitudes during this time of year. After quickly re-embarking, Hudson encountered thick pack ice at 82°, which he tried unsuccessfully to navigate through or around. He was forced to turn back to England, arriving on September 15, having discovered an island that is likely Jan Mayen. Since the first voyage did not yield any results toward the north, Hudson planned another attempt and set sail again on April 21 of the following year, progressing between Spitzbergen and Nova Zembla. However, he could only follow the coast of that vast land for a limited distance without reaching the desired latitude. The failure of this second attempt was more definitive than that of the 1607 voyage. As a result, the English Company that funded both expeditions chose not to continue. This was likely why Hudson decided to seek service in Holland.
The Company of Amsterdam gave him, in 1609, the command of a vessel, with which he set sail from the Texel at the beginning of the year. Having doubled the North Cape, he advanced along the coasts of Nova Zembla; but his crew, composed of English and Dutch, who had made voyages to the East Indies, were soon disheartened by the cold and ice. Hudson found himself forced to change his route, and to propose to his sailors, who were in open mutiny, to seek for a passage, either by Davis' Strait, or the coasts of Virginia, where, according to the information of Captain Smith, who had frequently visited them, an outlet must surely be found. The choice of this crew, little accustomed to discipline, could not be doubtful. In order not to render the outlay of the Company completely abortive, Hudson was obliged to make for the Faröe Islands, to descend southward as low as 44°, and to search on the coast of America for the strait, of the existence of which he had been assured. On July 18th, he disembarked on the continent, in order to replace his foremast, which had been broken in a storm; and he took the opportunity of bartering furs with the natives. But his undisciplined sailors, having by their exactions roused the indignation of the poor and peaceable natives, compelled him again to set sail. He continued to follow the coast until August 3rd, and then landed a second time. At 40° 30', he discovered a great bay which he explored in a canoe for more than 150 miles. In the meantime, his provisions began to run short, and it was impossible to procure supplies on land. The crew, which appears to have imposed its wishes on its captain during this whole voyage, assembled; some proposed to winter in Newfoundland, in order to resume the search for the passage in the following year; others wished to make for Ireland. This latter proposition was adopted; but when they approached the shores of Great Britain, the land proved so attractive to his men, that Hudson was obliged, on November 7th, to cast anchor at Dartmouth.
The Company of Amsterdam gave him command of a ship in 1609, and he set sail from the Texel at the start of the year. After rounding the North Cape, he moved along the shores of Nova Zembla; however, his crew, made up of English and Dutch sailors who had previously sailed to the East Indies, quickly lost their motivation due to the cold and ice. Hudson felt he had to change his course and suggested to his crew, who were openly mutinying, that they look for a passage either through Davis' Strait or along the coast of Virginia, where, according to Captain Smith, who had often visited there, a passage was sure to be found. The choice of this crew, who were not used to discipline, was obvious. To avoid making the Company's investment completely pointless, Hudson had to head for the Faröe Islands, go as far south as 44°, and search along the American coast for the strait he had been told existed. On July 18th, he landed on the continent to replace his foremast, which had broken in a storm; he also took the opportunity to trade for furs with the locals. However, his undisciplined sailors angered the poor and peaceful natives with their demands, forcing him to sail away again. He continued along the coast until August 3rd and then landed a second time. At 40° 30', he discovered a large bay that he explored in a canoe for more than 150 miles. Meanwhile, his supplies began to run low, and it was impossible to find more on land. The crew, which had seemed to have the captain under their influence throughout the trip, gathered; some suggested wintering in Newfoundland to resume the search for the passage the following year, while others wanted to head for Ireland. The latter suggestion was accepted; but as they approached the shores of Great Britain, the land looked so appealing to his men that Hudson had no choice but to anchor at Dartmouth on November 7th.
The following year, 1610, notwithstanding all the mortifications which he had experienced, Hudson tried to renew his engagement with the Dutch company. But the terms which they named as the price of their concurrence compelled him to renounce the project, and induced him to submit to the requirements of the English Company. This company imposed on Hudson as a condition, that he should carry on board, rather as an assistant than as a subordinate, a clever seaman, named Coleburne, in whom they had full confidence. It is easy to understand how mortifying this condition was to Hudson. Accordingly, he took the earliest opportunity of ridding himself of the superintendent who had been imposed upon him. He had not yet left the Thames when he sent Coleburne back to shore with a letter for the Company, in which he endeavoured to palliate and justify this certainly very strange proceeding.
The following year, 1610, despite all the humiliations he had faced, Hudson tried to reestablish his partnership with the Dutch company. However, the terms they proposed for their support forced him to abandon the project and led him to agree to the demands of the English Company. This company required Hudson to take on board a skilled sailor named Coleburne as more of a colleague than a subordinate, someone they fully trusted. It's easy to see how frustrating this condition was for Hudson. As a result, he quickly sought a way to get rid of the superintendent they had assigned to him. Before he had even left the Thames, he sent Coleburne back to shore with a letter for the Company, in which he tried to explain and justify this certainly unusual action.
Towards the end of May, when the ship had cast anchor in one of the ports of the island, the crew formed on the subject of Coleburne, its first conspiracy, which was repressed without difficulty, and when Hudson quitted the island on June 1st, he had re-established his authority. After having passed Frobisher's Strait, he sighted the land of Desolation of Davis, entered the strait which has received his name, and speedily penetrated into a wide bay, the entire western coast of which he examined until the beginning of September. At this epoch, one of the inferior officers, continuing to excite revolt against his chief, was superseded; but this act of justice only exasperated the sailors. In the early part of November, Hudson, having arrived at the extremity of the bay, sought for an appropriate spot to winter in, and having soon found one, drew up the ship on dry land. It is difficult to understand such a resolution. On the one hand, Hudson had left England with provisions for six months only, which had already been largely reduced, and he could scarcely reckon, considering the barrenness of the country, upon procuring a further supply of nourishment; on the other, the crew had exhibited such numerous signs of mutiny, that he could hardly rely upon its discipline and good will. Nevertheless, although the English were often obliged to content themselves with scanty rations, they did not, owing to the arrival of great numbers of birds, pass a very distressing winter. But, on the return of spring, as soon as the ship was prepared to resume her route to England, Hudson found that his fate was decided. He made his arrangements accordingly, distributed to each his share of biscuit, paid the wages due, and awaited the course of events. He had not long to wait. The conspirators seized their captain, his son, a volunteer, the carpenter, and five sailors, put them on board a boat, without arms, provisions, or instruments, and abandoned them to the mercy of the ocean. The culprits reached England again, but not all; two were killed in an encounter with the Indians, another died of sickness, while the others were sorely tried by famine. Eventually, no prosecution was commenced against them. Only, the Company, in 1674, procured employment, on board a vessel, for the son of Henry Hudson, "lost in the discovery of the North-west," the son being entirely destitute of resources.
Towards the end of May, when the ship anchored in one of the island's ports, the crew conspired against Coleburne. This first conspiracy was quickly suppressed, and when Hudson left the island on June 1st, he had restored his authority. After passing through Frobisher's Strait, he saw the land of Desolation of Davis, entered the strait that bears his name, and quickly explored a large bay, examining its entire western coast until the beginning of September. At this point, one of the junior officers, who continued to stir up rebellion against his captain, was replaced; however, this act of justice only angered the sailors further. In early November, Hudson arrived at the end of the bay and looked for a suitable spot to spend the winter. After finding one, he pulled the ship onto dry land. It's hard to understand such a decision. On one hand, Hudson had left England with provisions meant to last six months, which were already running low, and considering the country's barrenness, he could hardly expect to find more food. On the other hand, the crew had shown so many signs of mutiny that he could hardly depend on their discipline and willingness. Nevertheless, even though the English often had to make do with meager rations, they didn't have a very distressing winter thanks to the arrival of many birds. But as spring returned and the ship was prepared to head back to England, Hudson realized his fate was sealed. He made the necessary arrangements, distributed rations of biscuit, paid the wages owed, and waited to see what would happen. He didn’t have to wait long. The conspirators captured their captain, his son, a volunteer, the carpenter, and five sailors, placed them on a boat without arms, food, or tools, and abandoned them to the mercy of the ocean. The culprits made it back to England, but not all of them; two were killed in a clash with the Indians, another died of illness, while the others suffered greatly from starvation. In the end, no legal action was taken against them. Only in 1674 did the Company help find a position for Henry Hudson's son, "lost in the discovery of the North-west," who was completely without means.
![]() |
Hudson abandoned by his crew. |
The expeditions of Hudson were followed by those of Button and of Gibbons, to whom we owe, if not new discoveries, important observations on the tides, the variation of the weather and the temperature, and on a number of natural phenomena.
The expeditions of Hudson were succeeded by those of Button and Gibbons, to whom we owe, if not new discoveries, important observations on the tides, the variation in weather and temperature, as well as various natural phenomena.
In 1615, the English Company entrusted to Byleth, who had taken part in the last voyages, the command of a vessel of fifty tons. Her name, the Discovery, was of good augury. She carried, as pilot, the famous William Baffin, whose renown has eclipsed that of his captain. Setting sail from England on April 13th, the English explorers sighted Cape Farewell by the 6th of May, passed from the Island of Desolation to the Savage Islands, where they met with a great number of natives, and ascended north-westward as high as 64°. On July 10th, land appeared on the starboard, and the tide flowed from the north; from which they conceived so much hope of the passage sought for, that they gave to the cape, discovered on this spot, the name of Comfort. It was probably Cape Walsingham, for they ascertained, after doubling it, that the land inclined towards the north-east, and the east. It was at the entry of Davis' Strait, that their discoveries came to an end for this year. They returned to Plymouth on September 9th, without having lost a single man.
In 1615, the English Company put Byleth, who had participated in previous voyages, in charge of a fifty-ton ship. The ship, named the Discovery, had good fortune associated with it. It was piloted by the renowned William Baffin, whose fame overshadowed that of his captain. Leaving England on April 13th, the English explorers spotted Cape Farewell by May 6th, traveled from the Island of Desolation to the Savage Islands, where they encountered a large number of natives, and moved northwest as far as 64°. On July 10th, land appeared on the right, and the tide came in from the north; this led them to feel hopeful about finding the passage they were searching for, prompting them to name the cape they discovered there Comfort. It was likely Cape Walsingham, as they found out after rounding it that the land curved toward the northeast and east. Their explorations ended for that year at the entrance of Davis' Strait. They returned to Plymouth on September 9th, without losing a single man.
So strong were the hopes entertained by Byleth and Baffin, that they obtained permission to put to sea again in the same vessel the following year. On May 14th, 1616, after a voyage in which nothing worthy of remark occurred, the two captains penetrated into Davis' Strait, sighted Cape Henderson's Hope, the extreme point formerly reached by Davis, and ascended as high as 72° 40' to the Women's Island, thus named after some Esquimaux females whom they met with. On June 12th, Byleth and Baffin were forced by the ice to enter a bay on the coast. Some Esquimaux brought them a great quantity of horns, without doubt tusks of walruses, or horns of musk oxen; from which they named the bay Horn Sound. After remaining some days in this place, they were able to put to sea again. On setting out from 75° 40', they encountered a vast expanse of water free from ice, and penetrated, without much danger, beyond the 78° of latitude, to the entrance of the strait, which prolonged northwards the immense bay which they had just traversed, and which received the name of Baffin. Then turning to the west, and afterwards to the south-west, Byleth and Baffin discovered the Carey Islands, Jones Strait, Coburg Island, and Lancaster Strait, and afterwards they descended along the entire western shore of Baffin's Bay as far as Cumberland Land. Despairing then of being able to carry his discoveries further, Byleth, who had several men among his crew afflicted with scurvy, found himself obliged to return to the shores of England, where he disembarked at Dover, on August 30th.
So strong were the hopes held by Byleth and Baffin that they got permission to set sail again on the same ship the following year. On May 14, 1616, after a trip where nothing noteworthy happened, the two captains entered Davis' Strait, spotted Cape Henderson's Hope, the furthest point reached by Davis, and traveled as far as 72° 40' to Women's Island, named after some Eskimo women they encountered. On June 12, Byleth and Baffin were forced by the ice to enter a bay along the coast. Some Eskimos brought them a large number of horns, most likely walrus tusks or musk ox horns; that's how they named the bay Horn Sound. After staying there for a few days, they managed to set sail again. Leaving from 75° 40', they came across a vast area of open water, navigating without much trouble beyond 78° latitude, to the entrance of the strait that extended northward from the huge bay they had just crossed, which was named Baffin. Then, turning west and later southwest, Byleth and Baffin discovered the Carey Islands, Jones Strait, Coburg Island, and Lancaster Strait. Afterwards, they traveled down the entire western shore of Baffin's Bay as far as Cumberland Land. Feeling hopeless about continuing their discoveries, Byleth, who had several men in his crew suffering from scurvy, had to return to England, where he disembarked at Dover on August 30.
If this expedition terminated again in failure, in the sense that the north-west passage was not discovered, the results obtained were nevertheless considerable. Byleth and Baffin had prodigiously increased the knowledge of the seas and coasts in the quarters of Greenland. The captain and the pilot, in writing to the Director of the Company, assured him that the bay which they had visited was an excellent spot for fishing, in which thousands of whales, seals, and walruses, disported themselves. The event could not be long in amply proving the correctness of this information.
If this expedition ended in failure again, meaning the north-west passage wasn't found, the results were still significant. Byleth and Baffin greatly expanded the understanding of the seas and coasts around Greenland. In their letter to the Director of the Company, the captain and the pilot confirmed that the bay they visited was a great fishing spot, teeming with thousands of whales, seals, and walruses. It wouldn't take long for this information to be proven correct.
Let us now descend again upon the coast of America, as far as Canada, and see what had happened since the time of Jacques Cartier. This latter, we may remember, had made an attempt at colonization, which had not produced any important results. Nevertheless, some Frenchmen had remained in the country, had married there, and founded families of colonists. From time to time, they received reinforcements brought by fishing vessels from Dieppe or St. Malo. But it was difficult to establish a current of emigration. It was under these circumstances that a gentleman, named Samuel de Champlain, a veteran of the wars of Henry IV., and who, for two years and a half, had frequented the East Indies, was engaged by the Commander of Chastes with the Sieur de Pontgravé, to continue the discoveries of Jacques Cartier, and to choose the situations most favourable for the establishment of towns and centres of population. This is not the place for us to consider the manner in which Champlain understood the business of a colonizer, nor his great services, which might well entitle him to be called the father of Canada. We will, therefore, advisedly leave this aspect of his undertaking, not the least brilliant, in order simply to occupy ourselves with the discoveries which he effected in the interior of the continent.
Let’s now return to the coast of America, up to Canada, and see what has happened since Jacques Cartier’s time. He had attempted to establish a colony, which didn’t really lead to any significant outcomes. Still, some Frenchmen stayed in the area, got married, and started families of settlers. Occasionally, they received support from fishing boats coming from Dieppe or St. Malo. However, it was tough to create a steady flow of emigration. In this context, a man named Samuel de Champlain, a veteran of Henry IV's wars and someone who had spent two and a half years in the East Indies, was hired by the Commander of Chastes along with Sieur de Pontgravé to continue Jacques Cartier’s explorations and identify the best sites for establishing towns and communities. This isn’t the place to discuss Champlain’s approach to colonization or his significant contributions, which certainly earn him the title of the father of Canada. Therefore, we will deliberately set aside this aspect of his work, which is quite remarkable, and focus instead on the discoveries he made in the interior of the continent.
Setting sail from Honfleur, on March 15th, 1603, the two chiefs of the enterprise first ascended the St. Lawrence, as far as the harbour of Tadoussac, 240 miles from its mouth. They were welcomed by the populations, which had, however, "neither faith, nor law, and lived without God, and without religion, like brute beasts." At this place they quitted their ships, which could not have advanced further without danger, and reached in a boat the Fall of St. Louis, where Jacques Cartier had been stopped; they even penetrated a little into the interior, and then returned to France, where Champlain printed a narrative of the voyage for the king.
Setting sail from Honfleur on March 15, 1603, the two leaders of the expedition made their way up the St. Lawrence River to the harbor of Tadoussac, 240 miles from the river's mouth. They were greeted by the local people, who, however, had "neither faith, nor law, and lived without God and without religion, like brute beasts." At this point, they left their ships, which couldn't go any further without risking danger, and took a boat to the Fall of St. Louis, where Jacques Cartier had been halted; they even ventured a bit into the interior before returning to France, where Champlain published an account of the voyage for the king.
Henry IV. resolved to continue the enterprise. In the meantime M. de Chastes having died, his privilege was transferred to M. de Monts, with the title of Vice-admiral and Governor of Acadia. Champlain accompanied M. de Monts to Canada, and passed three whole years, whether in aiding by his counsels and his exertions the efforts of colonization, or in exploring the coasts of Acadia, the bearings of which he took beyond Cape Cod, or in making excursions into the interior and visiting the savage tribes which it was important to conciliate. In 1607, after a new voyage to France to recruit colonists, Champlain returned again to New France, and founded, in 1608, a town which was to become Quebec. The following year was devoted to again ascending the St. Lawrence, and ascertaining its course. On board of a pirogue, with two companions only, Champlain penetrated, with some Algonquins, to the Iroquois, and remained conqueror in a great battle fought on the borders of a lake which has received his name; he then descended the river Richelieu, as far as the St. Lawrence. In 1610, he made a fresh incursion into the territory of the Iroquois, at the head of his allies, the Algonquins, whom he had the greatest possible difficulty in making observe the European discipline. In this campaign he employed instruments of warfare which greatly astonished the savages, and easily secured him the victory. For the attack of a village, he constructed a cavalier of wood, which 200 of the most powerful men "carried before this village to within a pike's length, and displayed three arquebusiers well protected from the arrows and stones which might be shot or launched at them." A little later, we see him exploring the river Ottawa, and advancing, in the north of the continent, to within 225 miles of Hudson's Bay. After having fortified Montreal, in 1615, he twice ascended the Ottawa, explored Lake Huron, and arrived by land at Lake Ontario, which he crossed.
Henry IV decided to go ahead with the venture. Meanwhile, Mr. de Chastes passed away, and his privilege was handed over to Mr. de Monts, who was named Vice-Admiral and Governor of Acadia. Champlain joined Mr. de Monts in Canada and spent three full years either helping with colonization efforts through his advice and hard work or exploring the coasts of Acadia, which he mapped out beyond Cape Cod, or making trips into the interior to meet the local tribes that needed to be won over. In 1607, after another trip to France to recruit more colonists, Champlain returned to New France and founded a town in 1608 that would eventually become Quebec. The following year was spent again traveling up the St. Lawrence and figuring out its course. In a small canoe, with just two companions, Champlain ventured with some Algonquins to confront the Iroquois and emerged victorious in a significant battle by a lake that now bears his name; he then traveled down the Richelieu River until he reached the St. Lawrence. In 1610, he made another incursion into Iroquois territory, leading his allies, the Algonquins, whom he found very challenging to discipline in European military tactics. During this campaign, he used weapons that astonished the local tribes and easily led to his victory. To attack a village, he built a wooden fortification that 200 of the strongest men carried close to the village, where they displayed three arquebusiers well shielded from the arrows and stones that could be thrown at them. Shortly after, he was exploring the Ottawa River and moved northward to within 225 miles of Hudson's Bay. After fortifying Montreal in 1615, he ascended the Ottawa River twice, explored Lake Huron, and made his way overland to Lake Ontario, which he crossed.
![]() |
Siege of a village by Champlain. |
It is very difficult to divide into two parts a life so occupied as Champlain's. All his excursions, all his reconnaissances, had but one object, the development of the work to which he had consecrated his existence. Thus detached from what gives them their interest, they appear to us unimportant; and yet if the colonial policy of Louis XIV. and his successor had been different, we should possess in America a colony which assuredly would not yield in prosperity to the United States. Notwithstanding our abandonment, Canada has preserved a fervent love for the mother country.
It’s really hard to split Champlain's incredibly busy life into two parts. Every trip and every exploration he undertook had one goal: the growth of the work to which he dedicated his life. When we look at them without that context, they may seem insignificant; however, if the colonial policy of Louis XIV and his successor had been different, we would probably have a colony in America that could rival the prosperity of the United States. Despite being abandoned, Canada still holds a strong affection for its mother country.
We must now leap over a period of forty years, to arrive at Robert Cavelier de la Sale. During this time, the French establishments have acquired some importance in Canada, and have extended themselves over a great part of North America. Our hunters and trappers scour the woods, and bring, every year, with their load of furs, new information respecting the interior of the continent. In this latter task they are powerfully seconded by the missionaries, in the first rank of whom we must place Father Marquette, whom the extent of his voyages on the great lakes and as far as the Mississippi marks out for special acknowledgment. Two men, besides, deserve to be mentioned for the encouragements and facilities which they afforded to the explorers, viz., M. de Frontenac, Governor of New France, and Talon, intendant of justice and police. In 1678, there arrived in Canada, without any settled purpose, a young man named Cavelier de la Sale. "He was born at Rouen," says Father Charlevoix, "of a family in easy circumstances; but having passed some years with the Jesuits, he had had no share in the inheritance of his parents. He had a cultivated mind, he wished to distinguish himself, and he felt within himself sufficient genius and courage to ensure success. In reality, he was not deficient in resolution to enter upon, nor in perseverance to follow up, an undertaking, nor in firmness in contending against obstacles, nor in resource to repair his losses; but he knew not how to make himself loved, nor how to manage those of whom he stood in need, and when he had attained authority, he exercised it with harshness and arrogance. With such defects he could not be happy, and in fact he was not."
We now need to jump ahead forty years to reach Robert Cavelier de la Salle. During this time, French settlements have grown in importance in Canada and have expanded across much of North America. Our hunters and trappers explore the woods, bringing back new information about the interior of the continent every year, along with their loads of furs. They are strongly supported in this effort by missionaries, with Father Marquette standing out for his extensive travels on the Great Lakes and all the way down to the Mississippi. Additionally, two men deserve recognition for providing encouragement and support to the explorers: M. de Frontenac, the Governor of New France, and Talon, the intendant of justice and police. In 1678, a young man named Cavelier de la Salle arrived in Canada without any specific plans. "He was born in Rouen," says Father Charlevoix, "to a family that was relatively well-off; however, after spending some years with the Jesuits, he received none of his parents' inheritance. He had a developed intellect, wanted to make a name for himself, and believed he had enough talent and bravery to succeed. In reality, he had the determination to undertake and the perseverance to stick with a project, as well as the strength to face challenges and the ingenuity to recover from setbacks; but he didn’t know how to make people like him or how to handle those he needed, and once he gained authority, he ruled with harshness and arrogance. With such flaws, he couldn’t find happiness, and in fact, he didn’t."
Father Charlevoix's portrait appears to us somewhat too black, and he does not seem to estimate at its true value the great discovery which we owe to Cavelier de la Sale; a discovery, which has nothing like it, we do not say equal to it, except that of the river Amazon, by Orellana, in the 16th century, and that of the Congo, by Stanley, in the 19th. However this may be, no sooner had he arrived in the country, than he set himself, with extraordinary application, to study the native idioms, and to associate with the savages in order to render himself familiar with their manners and habits. At the same time he gathered from the trappers a mass of information on the situation of the rivers and lakes. He communicated his projects of exploration to M. de Frontenac, who encouraged him, and gave him the command of a fort constructed at the outlet of the lake into the St. Lawrence. In the meantime, one Jolyet arrived at Quebec. He brought the news that in company with Father Marquette and four other persons, he had reached a great river called the Mississippi, flowing towards the south. Cavelier de la Sale very soon understood what advantage might be derived from an artery of this importance, especially if the Mississippi had, as he believed, its mouth in the Gulf of Mexico. By the lakes and the Illinois, an affluent of the Mississippi, it was easy to effect a communication between the St. Lawrence, and the Sea of the Antilles. What marvellous profit would France derive from this discovery! La Sale explained the project which he had conceived to the Count of Frontenac, and obtained from him very pressing letters of recommendation to the Minister of Marine. On arriving in France, La Sale learned the death of Colbert; but he remitted to his son, the Marquis of Seignelay, who had succeeded him, the despatches of which he was the bearer. This project, which appeared to rest upon solid foundations, could not fail to please a young minister. Accordingly, Seignelay presented La Sale to the king, who caused letters of nobility to be prepared for him, granted him the Seignory of Catarocouy, and the government of the fort which he had built, with the monopoly of commerce in the countries which he might discover.
Father Charlevoix's portrait seems a bit too harsh, and he doesn't seem to fully appreciate the amazing discovery we owe to Cavelier de la Salle; a discovery that has no equal, except maybe the Amazon River discovered by Orellana in the 16th century and the Congo by Stanley in the 19th. Regardless, as soon as he arrived in the area, he devoted himself to learning the native languages and mingling with the locals to become familiar with their customs and lifestyles. At the same time, he gathered a wealth of information from trappers about the locations of rivers and lakes. He shared his exploration plans with M. de Frontenac, who encouraged him and appointed him to command a fort built at the outlet of the lake into the St. Lawrence. Meanwhile, a man named Jolyet arrived in Quebec. He brought news that he had traveled with Father Marquette and four others to a large river called the Mississippi, flowing southward. Cavelier de la Salle quickly recognized the potential benefits of such an important river, especially if, as he believed, it led to the Gulf of Mexico. Through the lakes and the Illinois River, a tributary of the Mississippi, he could easily connect the St. Lawrence to the Caribbean Sea. Just imagine the incredible profits France would gain from this discovery! La Salle detailed his plan to the Count of Frontenac, who provided him with strong letters of recommendation to the Minister of Marine. Upon reaching France, La Salle learned of Colbert's death; however, he presented the dispatches to Colbert's son, the Marquis of Seignelay, who had taken over. This project, which appeared to be based on solid grounds, was sure to appeal to a young minister. Accordingly, Seignelay introduced La Salle to the king, who ordered letters of nobility to be prepared for him, granted him the Seignory of Catarocouy, and gave him the governance of the fort he had built, along with a monopoly on trade in any lands he might discover.
La Sale had also found means to procure the patronage of the Prince de Conti, who asked him to take with him the Chevalier Tonti, son of the inventor of the Tontine, in whom he felt an interest. He was for La Sale a precious acquisition. Tonti, who had made a campaign in Sicily, where his hand had been carried off by the explosion of a grenade, was a brave and skilful officer, who always showed himself extremely devoted.
La Salle had also managed to gain the support of Prince de Conti, who asked him to bring along Chevalier Tonti, the son of the creator of the Tontine, someone he felt a connection to. Tonti was a valuable asset for La Salle. He had campaigned in Sicily, where he lost a hand in a grenade explosion, but he was a brave and skilled officer who always demonstrated his strong devotion.
La Sale and Tonti embarked at Rochelle, on July 14th, 1678, carrying with them about thirty men, workmen and soldiers, and a Recollet (monk), Father Hennepin, who accompanied them in all their voyages.
La Salle and Tonti set sail from Rochelle on July 14, 1678, with around thirty men, including workers and soldiers, along with a Recollect monk, Father Hennepin, who joined them on all their journeys.
Then La Sale, being conscious that the execution of his project required more considerable resources than those which were at his disposal, constructed a boat upon the Lake Erie, and devoted a whole year to scouring the country, visiting the Indians, and carrying on an active trade in furs, which he stored in his fort of Niagara, while Tonti pursued the same course in other directions. At length, towards the middle of August, of the year 1679, his boat, the Griffon, being prepared for sailing, he embarked on the Lake Erie, with thirty men, and three Fathers, Recollets, for Machillimackinac. In crossing the lakes St. Clair and Huron, he experienced a violent storm, which caused the desertion of some of his people, whom, however, Tonti brought back to him. La Sale arrived at Machillimackinac, and very soon entered the Green Bay. But during this time his creditors at Quebec had sold all that he possessed, and the Griffon, which he had despatched, laden with furs, to the fort of Niagara, was either lost or pillaged by the Indians; which of these took place has never been precisely ascertained. For himself, although the departure of the Griffon had displeased his companions, he continued his route, and reached the river St. Joseph, where he found an encampment of Miamis, and where Tonti speedily rejoined him. Their first care was to construct a fort on this spot. Then they crossed the dividing line of the water between the basin of the great lakes, and that of the Mississippi; they subsequently reached the river of the Illinois, an affluent on the left of that great river. With his small band of followers, upon whose fidelity he could not entirely depend, the situation of La Sale was critical, in the midst of an unknown country, and among a powerful nation, the Illinois, who, at first allies of France, had been prejudiced and excited against us by the Iroquois and the English, jealous of the progress of the Canadian colony.
Then La Salle, realizing that his project needed more resources than he had, built a boat on Lake Erie and spent an entire year exploring the area, visiting the Native Americans, and actively trading furs, which he stored in his fort at Niagara, while Tonti did the same in different areas. Finally, around mid-August 1679, his boat, the Griffon, was ready to set sail. He embarked on Lake Erie with thirty men and three Recollect Fathers headed for Michilimackinac. While crossing Lakes St. Clair and Huron, he faced a severe storm that led some of his crew to abandon him, but Tonti managed to bring them back. La Salle reached Michilimackinac and soon entered Green Bay. However, during this time, his creditors in Quebec sold everything he owned, and the Griffon, which he had sent loaded with furs to Fort Niagara, was either lost or stolen by the Native Americans; it's never been definitively determined which happened. Despite his companions being unhappy about the Griffon leaving, he continued on and reached the St. Joseph River, where he found a camp of Miamis, and Tonti quickly rejoined him. Their first priority was to build a fort at that location. They then crossed the water divide between the Great Lakes basin and the Mississippi basin, eventually reaching the Illinois River, a tributary on the left side of that great river. With his small group of followers, whose loyalty he couldn't fully trust, La Salle's situation was critical, surrounded by an unfamiliar land and a powerful nation, the Illinois, who, initially allies of France, had been turned against them by the Iroquois and the English, who were jealous of the growth of the Canadian colony.
Nevertheless, it was necessary, at all cost, to attach to himself these Indians, who from their situation, were able to hinder all communication between La Sale and Canada. In order to strike their imagination, Cavelier de la Sale proceeds to their encampment, where more than 3000 men are assembled. He has but twenty men, but he traverses their village haughtily, and stops at some distance. The Illinois, who have not yet declared war, are surprised. They advance towards him, and overwhelm him with pacific demonstrations. So versatile is the spirit of the savages! Such an impression does every mark of courage make upon them! Without delay, La Sale takes advantage of their friendly dispositions, and erects upon the very site of their camp, a small fort, which he calls Crèvecoeur, in allusion to the troubles which he has already experienced. There he leaves Tonti with all his people, and he himself, anxious about the fate of the Griffon, returns with three Frenchmen and one Indian, to the fort of Catarocouy, separated by 500 leagues from Crèvecoeur. Before setting out, he had detached with Father Hennepin, one of his companions named Dacan, on a mission to reascend the Mississippi beyond the river of the Illinois, and if possible, to its source. "These two travellers," says Father Charlevoix, "set out from the fort of Crèvecoeur, on February 28th, and having entered the Mississippi, ascended it as far as 46° of north latitude. There they were stopped by a considerable waterfall, extending quite across the river, to which Father Hennepin gave the name of St. Anthony of Padua. Then they fell, I know not by what mischance, into the hands of the Sioux, who kept them for a long time prisoners."
However, it was essential, at all costs, to win over these Native Americans, who could block all communication between La Salle and Canada. To capture their attention, Cavelier de la Salle made his way to their campsite, where more than 3,000 men had gathered. He had only twenty men, but he confidently walked through their village and stopped at a distance. The Illinois, who had not yet declared war, were taken aback. They approached him and welcomed him with friendly gestures. The spirits of these tribes can change so quickly! Every display of bravery leaves a strong impression on them! Without hesitation, La Salle seized the moment and built a small fort right at their campsite, naming it Crèvecoeur, referencing the troubles he had already faced. He left Tonti and all his people there, while he himself, concerned about the fate of the Griffon, returned with three Frenchmen and one Indian to the fort of Catarocouy, which was 500 leagues away from Crèvecoeur. Before setting off, he had sent Father Hennepin along with one of his companions named Dacan on a mission to travel up the Mississippi past the Illinois River, and if possible, all the way to its source. "These two travelers," says Father Charlevoix, "departed from the fort of Crèvecoeur on February 28th and entered the Mississippi, ascending it as far as 46° north latitude. There, they were halted by a significant waterfall, spanning the entire river, which Father Hennepin named St. Anthony of Padua. Then, by some misfortune, they found themselves captured by the Sioux, who held them as prisoners for a long time."
On his journey back to Catarocouy, La Sale, having discovered a new site appropriate to the construction of a fort, summoned Tonti thither, who immediately set to work, while La Sale continued his route. This is Fort St. Louis. On his arrival at Catarocouy, La Sale learned news which would have broken down a man of a less hardy temperament. Not only had the Griffon, on board of which he had furs of the value of 10,000 crowns, been lost, but a vessel which was bringing him from France a cargo worth 880l. had been shipwrecked, and his enemies had spread a report of his death. Having no further business at Catarocouy, and having proved by his presence that the reports of his disappearance were all false, he arrived again at the fort of Crèvecoeur, where he was much astonished to find no one.
On his journey back to Catarocouy, La Salle, after finding a new spot suitable for building a fort, called Tonti over, who quickly got to work while La Salle continued on his way. This became Fort St. Louis. When La Salle got to Catarocouy, he received news that would have overwhelmed someone less resilient. Not only had the Griffon, which carried furs worth 10,000 crowns, been lost, but a ship bringing him cargo from France valued at 880 l. had also been wrecked, and his enemies had spread rumors of his death. With no more business at Catarocouy, and having shown by his presence that the rumors of his disappearance were false, he returned to the fort of Crèvecoeur, where he was surprised to find nobody there.
This is what had happened. While the Chevalier Tonti was employed in the construction of Fort St. Louis, the garrison of Fort Crèvecoeur had mutinied, had pillaged the magazines, had done the same at Fort Miami, and then fled to Machillimackinac. Tonti, almost alone in face of the Illinois, who were roused against him by the depredations of his men, and judging that he could not resist in his fort of Crèvecoeur, had left it on September 11th, 1680, with the five Frenchmen who composed his garrison, and had retired as far as the bay of the Lake Michigan. After having placed a garrison at Crèvecoeur and at Fort St. Louis, La Sale came to Machillimackinac, where he rejoined Tonti, and together they set out again from thence towards the end of August for Catarocouy, whence they embarked on the Lake Erie with fifty-five persons, on August 28th, 1681. After a journey of 240 miles along the frozen river of the Illinois, they reached Fort Crèvecoeur, where the water, free from ice, permitted the use of their canoes. On February 6th, 1682, La Sale arrived at the confluence of the Illinois and the Mississippi. He descended the river, sighted the mouth of the Missouri, and that of the Ohio, where he raised a fort, penetrated into the country of the Arkansas, of which he took possession in the name of France, crossed the country of the Natchez, with whom he made a treaty of friendship, and finally passed out into the Gulf of Mexico on April 9th, after a navigation of 1050 miles in a mere bark. The anticipations so skilfully conceived by Cavelier de la Sale, were realized. He immediately took formal possession of the country, to which he gave the name of Louisiana, and called the immense river which he had just discovered the St. Louis.
This is what happened. While Chevalier Tonti was working on the construction of Fort St. Louis, the soldiers at Fort Crèvecoeur revolted, looted the supplies, did the same at Fort Miami, and then fled to Machillimackinac. Tonti, almost alone against the Illinois, who were stirred up against him by the actions of his men, decided he could not hold out in Fort Crèvecoeur. On September 11, 1680, he left with the five Frenchmen in his garrison and moved as far as the bay of Lake Michigan. After placing a garrison at Crèvecoeur and at Fort St. Louis, La Salle arrived at Machillimackinac, where he rejoined Tonti, and together they set out again towards the end of August for Catarocouy, from where they embarked on Lake Erie with fifty-five people on August 28, 1681. After a 240-mile journey along the frozen Illinois River, they reached Fort Crèvecoeur, where the ice-free water allowed them to use their canoes. On February 6, 1682, La Salle arrived at the spot where the Illinois and Mississippi Rivers meet. He traveled downstream, saw the mouths of the Missouri and Ohio Rivers, where he built a fort, entered the territory of the Arkansas, and claimed it for France, crossed the land of the Natchez, with whom he made a friendship treaty, and finally reached the Gulf of Mexico on April 9, after navigating 1,050 miles in a small boat. The plans expertly laid out by Cavelier de la Salle were realized. He officially claimed the territory, naming it Louisiana, and called the great river he had just discovered the St. Louis.
La Sale's return to Canada occupied not less than one year and a half. There is no ground for astonishment, when all the obstacles scattered in his path are considered. What energy, what strength of mind were requisite in one of the greatest travellers of whom France has reason to be proud, to succeed in such an enterprise!
La Sale's return to Canada took no less than a year and a half. There's no surprise in that when you consider all the challenges he faced along the way. What determination and mental strength were required of one of the greatest explorers that France can be proud of to accomplish such a feat!
Unhappily, a man, otherwise well intentioned, but who allowed himself to be prejudiced against La Sale by his numerous enemies, M. Lefèvre de la Barre, who had succeeded M. de Frontenac as governor of Canada, wrote to the Minister of Marine, that the discoveries of La Sale were not to be regarded as of much importance. "This traveller," he said "was actually, with about twenty French vagabonds and savages, at the extremity of the bay, where he played the part of sovereign, plundered and ransomed those of his own nation, exposed the people to the incursions of the Iroquois, and covered all these acts of violence with the pretext of the permission, which he had from His Majesty, to carry on commerce alone in the countries which he might be able to discover."
Unfortunately, a man who generally had good intentions but allowed his many enemies to bias him against La Salle, M. Lefèvre de la Barre, who took over as governor of Canada after M. de Frontenac, wrote to the Minister of Marine stating that La Salle's discoveries weren't that significant. "This traveler," he said, "was actually, with about twenty French drifters and locals, at the edge of the bay, where he acted like a ruler, looted and ransomed his own people, put everyone at risk from the Iroquois attacks, and justified all these violent actions by claiming he had permission from His Majesty to trade exclusively in the lands he could find."
Cavelier de la Sale could not allow himself to remain exposed to these calumnious imputations. On the one side, honour prompted him to return to France to exculpate himself; on the other, he would not leave others to reap the profit of his discoveries. He set out, therefore, and received from Seignelay a kindly welcome. The minister had not been much influenced by the letters of M. de la Barre; he was aware that men could not accomplish great achievements without wounding much self-love, nor without making numerous enemies. La Sale took the opportunity to explain to him his project of discovering the mouth of the Mississippi by sea, in order to open a way for French vessels, and to found an establishment there. The minister entered into these views, and gave him a commission which placed Frenchmen and savages under his orders, from Fort St. Louis to the sea. At the same time the commandant of the squadron which was to transport him to America, was to be under his authority, and to furnish him on his disembarkation with all the succours which he might require, provided that nothing was done to the prejudice of the king. Four vessels, one of them a frigate of forty guns, commanded by M. de Beaujeu were to carry 280 persons, including the crews, to the mouth of the Mississippi, to form the nucleus of the new colony. Soldiers and artisans had been very badly chosen, as was perceived when too late, and no one knew his business. Setting sail from La Rochelle, on July 24th, 1684, the little squadron was almost immediately obliged to return to port, the bowsprit of the frigate having broken suddenly in the very finest weather. This inexplicable accident was the commencement of misunderstanding between M. de Beaujeu and M. de la Sale. The former could scarcely be pleased to see himself subordinated to a private individual, and did not forgive Cavelier this. Nothing however would have been more easy than to decline the command. La Sale had not the gentleness of manner and the politeness necessary to conciliate his companions. The disagreement did but gather force during the voyage by reason of the obstacles raised by M. de Beaujeu to the rapidity and secrecy of the expedition. The annoyances of La Sale had indeed become so great when he arrived at St. Domingo, that he fell seriously ill. He recovered, however, and the expedition set sail again on November 25th. A month later, it was off Florida; but, as "La Sale had been assured that in the Gulf of Mexico, all the currents bore eastwards, he did not doubt that the mouth of the Mississippi must be far to the west; an error which was the source of all his misfortunes."
Cavelier de la Salle couldn't let himself be vulnerable to these false accusations. On one hand, his honor drove him to return to France to clear his name; on the other, he didn’t want to let others benefit from his discoveries. So, he set out and was warmly welcomed by Seignelay. The minister wasn’t swayed much by the letters from M. de la Barre; he understood that great achievements often come at the cost of bruising egos and creating many enemies. La Salle took this opportunity to share his plan of finding the mouth of the Mississippi by sea, aiming to create a route for French ships and establish a settlement there. The minister supported these ideas and gave him a commission that put both Frenchmen and Native Americans under his command, from Fort St. Louis to the sea. At the same time, the commander of the squadron set to take him to America was also to report to him and provide any assistance he might need upon arrival, as long as nothing harmed the king's interests. Four ships, including a forty-gun frigate captained by M. de Beaujeu, were tasked with transporting 280 people, crew included, to the mouth of the Mississippi to start the new colony. Unfortunately, the soldiers and craftsmen chosen were poorly selected, which became apparent too late, and nobody knew what they were doing. After setting sail from La Rochelle on July 24, 1684, the small fleet was forced to return almost immediately due to the frigate's bowsprit breaking unexpectedly in perfect weather. This baffling incident marked the beginning of the rift between M. de Beaujeu and M. de la Salle. The former was understandably displeased to find himself subordinate to a private individual and held a grudge against Cavelier. However, it would have been easy for him to refuse the command. La Salle lacked the charm and politeness needed to ease tensions with his crew. Their disagreements only intensified during the journey because of the obstacles M. de Beaujeu raised against the expedition's speed and secrecy. La Salle's frustrations grew so severe by the time they reached St. Domingo that he became seriously ill. He recovered, though, and the expedition set sail once more on November 25. A month later, they were off Florida; however, because La Salle had been told that in the Gulf of Mexico, all currents flowed eastward, he was convinced that the mouth of the Mississippi must be far to the west, an error that led to all his troubles.
La Sale then steered to the west, and passed by, without perceiving it, without deigning even to attend to certain signs which he was asked to observe, the mouth of the Mississippi. When he perceived his mistake, and entreated M. de Beaujeu to turn back, the latter would no longer consent. La Sale, seeing that he could make no impression upon the contradictory mind of his companion, decided to disembark his men and his provisions in the Bay of St. Bernard. Yet, in this very last act, Beaujeu manifested an amount of culpable ill-will, which did as little honour to his judgment as to his patriotism. Not only was he unwilling to land all the provisions, under the pretext that certain of them being at the bottom of the hold, he had no time to change his stowage, but further he gave shelter on board his own ship to the master and crew of the transport, laden with the stores, utensils, and implements necessary for a new establishment, people whom everything seems to convict of having purposely cast their vessel upon shore. At the same time, a number of savages took advantage of the disorder caused by the shipwreck of the transport, to plunder everything on which they could lay their hands. Nevertheless, La Sale, who had the talent of never appearing depressed by misfortune, and who found in his own genius resources adapted to the circumstances of the case, ordered the works of the establishment to be begun. In order to give courage to his companions, he more than once took part with his own hands in the work; but very slow progress was made, in consequence of the ignorance of the workmen. Struck with the resemblance of the language and habits of the Indians of these parts to those of the Mississippi, La Sale was very soon persuaded that he was not far distant from that river, and made several excursions in order to approach it. But, if he found a country beautiful and fertile, he did not make progress towards what he was in search of. He returned each time to the fort more gloomy and more harsh; and this was not the way to restore calm to spirits embittered by sufferings and the inutility of their efforts. Grain had been sown; but scarcely any came up for want of rain, and what had sprung up was soon laid waste by the savages and the deer. The hunters who wandered far from the camp were massacred by the Indians, and sickness found an easy prey in men overwhelmed with ennui, disappointment, and misery. In a short time, the number of the colonists fell to thirty-seven. At length, La Sale resolved to try a last effort to reach the Mississippi, and in descending the river to seek help from the nations with which he had made alliance. He set out on January 12th, 1687, with his brother, his two nephews, two missionaries, and twelve colonists. He was approaching the country of the Shawnees, when, in consequence of an altercation between one of his nephews and three of his companions, these latter assassinated the young man and his servant during their sleep, and resolved immediately to do the same with the chief of the enterprise. De la Sale, uneasy at not seeing his nephew return, set out to seek him on the morning of the 19th, with Father Anastase. The assassins, seeing him approach, lay in ambush in a thicket, and one of them shot him in the head, and stretched him on the ground stark dead. Thus perished Cavelier de la Sale, "a man of a capacity," says Father Charlevoix, "of a largeness of mind, of a courage and firmness of soul, which might have led him to the achievement of something great, if with so many great qualities, he had known how to master his gloomy and atrabilious disposition, and to soften the severity or rather the harshness of his nature...." Many calumnies had been spread abroad against him; but it is necessary so much the more to be on our guard against all these malevolent reports "as it is only too common to exaggerate the defects of the unfortunate, to impute to them even some which they had not, especially when they have given occasion for their misfortune, and have not known how to make themselves beloved. What is sadder for the memory of this celebrated man, is that he has been regretted by few persons, and that the ill-success of his undertakings—only of his last—has given him the air of an adventurer, among those who judge only by appearances. Unhappily, these are usually the most numerous, and in some degree the voice of the public."
La Salle then headed west and passed by, without realizing it and without bothering to pay attention to certain signs he was asked to notice, the mouth of the Mississippi. When he realized his mistake and asked M. de Beaujeu to turn back, the latter refused. Seeing he couldn't convince his stubborn companion, La Salle decided to unload his men and supplies in the Bay of St. Bernard. However, in this final act, Beaujeu displayed a significant amount of blameworthy ill-will, reflecting poorly on his judgment and patriotism. Not only was he unwilling to land all the provisions, claiming that some were at the bottom of the hold and he didn't have time to rearrange his storage, but he also allowed the captain and crew of the transport, loaded with supplies and tools for a new settlement, to stay on his ship—people whom everything suggested had intentionally run their vessel aground. At the same time, numerous natives took advantage of the chaos caused by the shipwreck to loot everything they could grab. Nevertheless, La Salle managed to stay positive despite the misfortunes, and with his resourcefulness, he ordered the construction of the settlement to begin. To encourage his companions, he often participated in the work himself, but progress was slow due to the workers' lack of knowledge. Noticing the similarities in language and habits between the local tribes and those by the Mississippi, La Salle quickly became convinced he was not far from that river and made several trips to find it. Yet, while he discovered a beautiful, fertile land, he made no headway toward his goal. Each time he returned to the fort more despondent and harsh, which didn't help lift the spirits of those worn down by suffering and frustration. Seeds had been sown, but hardly any germinated due to a lack of rain, and what did emerge was quickly destroyed by the natives and deer. Hunters who strayed too far from camp were killed by the natives, and illness took its toll on men already burdened by boredom, disappointment, and misery. Soon, the number of colonists dwindled to thirty-seven. Finally, La Salle decided to make one last attempt to reach the Mississippi and seek help from the allied nations along the way. He set out on January 12, 1687, with his brother, two nephews, two missionaries, and twelve colonists. He was nearing the Shawnee territory when a dispute broke out between one of his nephews and three companions, leading the latter to murder the young man and his servant while they were asleep and resolve to do the same to La Salle. Concerned about his nephew's absence, La Salle went to look for him on the morning of the 19th, accompanied by Father Anastase. The murderers, seeing him approach, lay in wait in a thicket, and one of them shot him in the head, leaving him dead on the ground. Thus perished Cavelier de La Salle, "a capable man," said Father Charlevoix, "with a large mind, courage, and strength of character, which could have led him to achieve something great, had he known how to overcome his gloomy and melancholic disposition, and soften the severity or rather the harshness of his nature..." Many slanders had been spread against him, but it is even more crucial to be cautious of these malicious rumors "as it is all too common to exaggerate the faults of the unfortunate, and to attribute even non-existent ones to them, especially when they have contributed to their misfortune and have not learned how to endear themselves to others. What is saddest for the memory of this renowned man is that he has been lamented by few, and the failure of his enterprises—only the last one—has given him the appearance of an adventurer among those who judge solely by appearances. Unfortunately, these types tend to be the most numerous, and somewhat reflect public opinion."
![]() |
Assassination of La Sale. |
We have but little to add to these last wise words. La Sale knew not how to obtain pardon for his first success. We have related subsequently by what concurrence of circumstances his second enterprise miscarried. He died, the victim it may be said, of the jealousy and malevolence of the Chevalier de Beaujeu. It is to this slight cause that we owe the failure to found in America a powerful colony, which would very soon have been found in a condition to compete with the English establishments.
We have very little to add to these final wise words. La Salle didn’t know how to ask for forgiveness for his initial success. We later explained how a series of circumstances led to the failure of his second venture. He died as a victim, one could say, of the jealousy and hostility of Chevalier de Beaujeu. It is due to this minor issue that we missed out on establishing a strong colony in America, which would have quickly been able to compete with the English settlements.
We have narrated the beginning of the English colonies. The events which took place in England were highly favourable to them. The religious persecutions, the revolutions of 1648 and 1688, furnished numerous recruits, who, animated by an excellent spirit, set themselves to work, and transported to the other side of the Atlantic the arts, the industry, and in a short time the prosperity, of the mother country. Very soon, the immense forests which covered Virginia, Pennsylvania, and Carolina, fell beneath the hatchet of the "Squatter," and the soil became cleared, while the hunters of the woods, driving back the Indians, made the interior of the country better known, and prepared the work of civilization.
We have told the story of the start of the English colonies. The events happening in England were very supportive of them. The religious persecutions and the revolutions of 1648 and 1688 brought in many new people who, driven by a strong spirit, got to work and brought the arts, industries, and soon the prosperity of the mother country across the Atlantic. Before long, the vast forests covering Virginia, Pennsylvania, and Carolina were cleared by the settlers, while those exploring the woods pushed back the Native Americans, making the interior of the country better known and laying the groundwork for civilization.
In Mexico, in the whole of Central America, in Peru, in Chili, and on the shores of the Atlantic, a different state of things prevailed. The Spaniards had extended their conquests; but, far from acting like the English, they had reduced the Indians to slavery. Instead of applying themselves to the cultivation appropriate to the variety of the climates and of the countries of which they had made themselves masters, they sought only in the produce of the mines the resources and prosperity which they should have endeavoured to obtain from the land. If a country can thus rapidly attain prodigious wealth, yet this factitious system cannot last long. With the mines a prosperity which does not renew itself, must ere long become exhausted. The Spaniards could not fail to experience the sad result.
In Mexico, throughout Central America, in Peru, in Chile, and along the Atlantic coast, a different situation existed. The Spaniards had expanded their conquests; however, unlike the English, they had enslaved the Indigenous people. Instead of focusing on farming suitable for the diverse climates and lands they had taken over, they relied solely on mining for their wealth and prosperity, which they should have sought from the land. While a country can achieve incredible wealth quickly this way, such an artificial system cannot last long. With the mines, prosperity that isn't sustainable will eventually run out. The Spaniards were bound to face the unfortunate consequences.
Thus then, at the end of the seventeenth century, a great part of the new world was known. In North America, Canada, the shores of the Atlantic and of the Gulf of Mexico, the valley of the Mississippi, the coasts of California and of New Mexico, were discovered or colonized. All the central part of the continent, from Rio del Norte, as far as Terra Firma, was subject, at least nominally, to the Spaniards. In the south, the savannahs and the forests of Brazil, the pampas of the Argentine, and the interior of Patagonia, escaped the observation of the explorers, as they were destined to do for a long time yet.
Thus, by the end of the seventeenth century, much of the new world was known. In North America, Canada, the shores of the Atlantic and the Gulf of Mexico, the Mississippi River valley, and the coasts of California and New Mexico were either discovered or colonized. The central part of the continent, from the Rio del Norte to Terra Firma, was under the control, at least theoretically, of the Spaniards. In the south, the savannahs and forests of Brazil, the pampas of Argentina, and the interior of Patagonia remained unnoticed by explorers, and that would continue for a long time.
In Africa, the long line of coasts, which are washed by the Atlantic and the Indian Oceans, had been patiently followed and observed by navigators. At some points only, colonists and missionaries had tried to penetrate the mystery of this vast continent. Senegal, Congo, the valley of the Nile, and Abyssinia, were all that were known with some degree of detail and of certainty.
In Africa, the extensive coastlines along the Atlantic and Indian Oceans have been closely monitored and studied by navigators. Only in certain areas have colonists and missionaries attempted to explore the mysteries of this enormous continent. Senegal, Congo, the Nile Valley, and Abyssinia were the only regions known with any level of detail and certainty.
If many of the countries of Asia, surveyed by the travellers of the middle ages, had not been revisited since that epoch, we had carefully explored the whole anterior part of that continent, India had been revealed to us, we had even founded some establishments there, China had been touched by our missionaries, and Japan, that famous Cipango which had exercised so great an attraction for our travellers of the preceding age, was at length known to us. Only Siberia and the whole north-east angle of Asia had escaped our investigations, and it was not yet known whether America was not connected with Asia, a mystery which was before long to be cleared up.
If many of the countries in Asia, explored by travelers in the Middle Ages, hadn't been revisited since that time, we would have thoroughly examined the entire earlier part of that continent. India had been revealed to us, and we even established some settlements there. China had been visited by our missionaries, and Japan, that famous Cipango that had fascinated our earlier travelers, was finally known to us. Only Siberia and the entire northeast corner of Asia had evaded our investigations, and it was still unclear whether America was connected to Asia, a mystery that would soon be resolved.
In Oceania, a number of archipelagos, of islands and separate islets, remained still to be discovered, but the islands of Sunda were colonized, the coasts of Australia and of New Zealand had been partially revealed, and the existence of that great continent which, according to Tasman, extended from Tierra del Fuego to New Zealand, began to be doubted; but it still required the long and careful researches of Cook to banish definitely into the domain of fable a chimera so long cherished.
In Oceania, many groups of islands and smaller islets were still waiting to be discovered, but the Sunda islands had been colonized, and the coastlines of Australia and New Zealand were partially known. The existence of the vast continent that Tasman claimed stretched from Tierra del Fuego to New Zealand started to be questioned; however, it took Cook's extensive and thorough explorations to finally dismiss this long-held myth into the realm of fiction.
Geography was on the point of transforming itself. The great discoveries made in astronomy were about to be applied to geography. The labours of Fernel and above all of Picard, upon the measure of a terrestrial degree between Paris and Amiens, had made it clear that the globe is not a sphere, but a spheroid, that is to say, a ball flattened at the poles and swollen at the equator, and thus were found at one stroke the form and the dimensions of the world which we inhabit. At length the labours of Picard, continued by La Hire and Cassini, were completed at the commencement of the following century. The astronomical observations, rendered possible by the calculation of the satellites of Jupiter, enabled us to rectify our maps. If this rectification had been already effected with regard to certain places, it became indispensable when the number of points of which the astronomical position had been observed, had been considerably increased; and this was to be the work of the next century. At the same time, historical geography was more studied; it began to take for its foundation the study of inscriptions, and archæology was about to become one of the most useful instruments of comparative geography.
Geography was on the verge of a major transformation. The significant discoveries in astronomy were about to be applied to geography. The work of Fernel and, most importantly, Picard, on measuring a degree of the Earth between Paris and Amiens, revealed that the globe is not a perfect sphere but a spheroid, meaning it’s a ball that’s flattened at the poles and bulging at the equator. This discovery provided, in one go, the shape and size of the world we live in. Eventually, Picard's work, which was continued by La Hire and Cassini, was completed at the start of the following century. Astronomical observations, made possible by calculating the satellites of Jupiter, allowed us to correct our maps. While some corrections had already been made for specific locations, it became crucial as the number of places with known astronomical positions grew significantly; this task would unfold in the next century. At the same time, historical geography gained more attention; it started to base itself on the study of inscriptions, and archaeology was about to become one of the most valuable tools for comparative geography.
In a word, the seventeenth century is an epoch of transition and of progress; it seeks and it finds the powerful means which its successor, the eighteenth century, was destined to put into operation. The era of the sciences has already opened, and with it the modern world commences.
In short, the seventeenth century is a time of change and progress; it looks for and discovers the strong tools that the next century, the eighteenth, would go on to use. The age of science has already begun, and with it, the modern world starts.
![]() |
Download ePUB
If you like this ebook, consider a donation!